zshall - the Z shell meta-man page



  • ZSHALL(1)			     General Commands Manual				ZSHALL(1)
    
    NAME
           zshall - the Z shell meta-man page
    
    OVERVIEW
           Because	zsh  contains  many features, the zsh manual has been split into a number of sec‐
           tions.  This manual page includes all the separate manual pages in the following order:
    
           zshroadmap   Informal introduction to the manual
           zshmisc	    Anything not fitting into the other sections
           zshexpn	    Zsh command and parameter expansion
           zshparam     Zsh parameters
           zshoptions   Zsh options
           zshbuiltins  Zsh built-in functions
           zshzle	    Zsh command line editing
           zshcompwid   Zsh completion widgets
           zshcompsys   Zsh completion system
           zshcompctl   Zsh completion control
           zshmodules   Zsh loadable modules
           zshcalsys    Zsh built-in calendar functions
           zshtcpsys    Zsh built-in TCP functions
           zshzftpsys   Zsh built-in FTP client
           zshcontrib   Additional zsh functions and utilities
    
    DESCRIPTION
           Zsh is a UNIX command interpreter (shell) usable as an interactive login shell  and  as	a
           shell  script  command  processor.  Of the standard shells, zsh most closely resembles ksh
           but includes many enhancements.	Zsh has command line editing,  builtin	spelling  correc‐
           tion, programmable command completion, shell functions (with autoloading), a history mech‐
           anism, and a host of other features.
    
    AUTHOR
           Zsh was originally written by Paul Falstad <[email protected]>.  Zsh is  now  maintained  by  the
           members	of  the  zsh-workers mailing list <[email protected]>.  The development is cur‐
           rently coordinated by Peter Stephenson <[email protected]>.  The coordinator can be contacted at
           <[email protected]>, but matters relating to the code should generally go to the mailing
           list.
    
    AVAILABILITY
           Zsh is available from the following anonymous FTP sites.  These mirror sites are kept fre‐
           quently	up to date.  The sites marked with (H) may be mirroring ftp.cs.elte.hu instead of
           the primary site.
    
           Primary site
    	      ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/
    	      http://www.zsh.org/pub/
    
           Australia
    	      ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/
    	      http://www.zsh.org/pub/
    	      http://mirror.dejanseo.com.au/pub/zsh/
    
           Hungary
    	      ftp://ftp.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/
    	      http://www.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/
    
           The up-to-date source code is available via  Git  from  Sourceforge.   See  http://source‐
           forge.net/projects/zsh/	for  details.	A  summary of instructions for the archive can be
           found at http://zsh.sourceforge.net/.
    
    MAILING LISTS
           Zsh has 3 mailing lists:
    
           <[email protected]>
    	      Announcements about releases, major changes in the shell and the monthly posting of
    	      the Zsh FAQ.  (moderated)
    
           <[email protected]>
    	      User discussions.
    
           <[email protected]>
    	      Hacking, development, bug reports and patches.
    
           To  subscribe  or  unsubscribe, send mail to the associated administrative address for the
           mailing list.
    
           <[email protected]>
           <[email protected]>
           <[email protected]>
           <[email protected]>
           <[email protected]>
           <[email protected]>
    
           YOU ONLY NEED TO JOIN ONE OF THE MAILING LISTS AS THEY ARE  NESTED.   All  submissions  to
           zsh-announce  are  automatically forwarded to zsh-users.  All submissions to zsh-users are
           automatically forwarded to zsh-workers.
    
           If you have problems subscribing/unsubscribing to any of the mailing lists, send  mail  to
           <[email protected]>.	The   mailing	lists	are   maintained   by	Karsten  Thygesen
           <[email protected]>.
    
           The mailing lists are archived; the  archives  can  be  accessed  via  the  administrative
           addresses  listed  above.   There  is  also  a hypertext archive, maintained by Geoff Wing
           <[email protected]>, available at http://www.zsh.org/mla/.
    
    THE ZSH FAQ
           Zsh has a list of  Frequently  Asked  Questions	(FAQ),	maintained  by	Peter  Stephenson
           <[email protected]>.	 It  is  regularly  posted  to	the  newsgroup	comp.unix.shell  and  the
           zsh-announce mailing list.  The latest version can be found at any of the Zsh  FTP  sites,
           or  at  http://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.   The contact address for FAQ-related matters is <faqmas‐
           [email protected]>.
    
    THE ZSH WEB PAGE
           Zsh has a web page which is located at http://www.zsh.org/.  This is maintained by Karsten
           Thygesen  <[email protected]>,  of SunSITE Denmark.  The contact address for web-related mat‐
           ters is <[email protected]>.
    
    THE ZSH USERGUIDE
           A userguide is currently in preparation.  It is intended to complement  the  manual,  with
           explanations  and  hints  on  issues where the manual can be cabbalistic, hierographic, or
           downright mystifying (for example, the word `hierographic' does not  exist).   It  can  be
           viewed in its current state at http://zsh.sourceforge.net/Guide/.  At the time of writing,
           chapters dealing with startup files and their contents and the new completion system  were
           essentially complete.
    
    THE ZSH WIKI
           A  `wiki'  website  for	zsh  has been created at http://www.zshwiki.org/.  This is a site
           which can be added to and modified directly by users without any special permission.   You
           can add your own zsh tips and configurations.
    
    INVOCATION
           The following flags are interpreted by the shell when invoked to determine where the shell
           will read commands from:
    
           -c     Take the first argument as a command to execute, rather than reading commands  from
    	      a  script  or standard input.  If any further arguments are given, the first one is
    	      assigned to $0, rather than being used as a positional parameter.
    
           -i     Force shell to be interactive.  It is still possible to specify a  script  to  exe‐
    	      cute.
    
           -s     Force  shell  to	read  commands	from  the  standard input.  If the -s flag is not
    	      present and an argument is given, the first argument is taken to be the pathname of
    	      a script to execute.
    
           If  there  are any remaining arguments after option processing, and neither of the options
           -c or -s was supplied, the first argument is taken as the file name of a script containing
           shell  commands	to be executed.  If the option PATH_SCRIPT is set, and the file name does
           not contain a directory path (i.e. there is no `/' in the name), first the current  direc‐
           tory and then the command path given by the variable PATH are searched for the script.  If
           the option is not set or the file name contains a `/' it is used directly.
    
           After the first one or two arguments  have  been  appropriated  as  described  above,  the
           remaining arguments are assigned to the positional parameters.
    
           For  further  options,  which  are  common  to  invocation and the set builtin, see zshop‐
           tions(1).
    
           Options may be specified by name using the  -o  option.	 -o  acts  like  a  single-letter
           option, but takes a following string as the option name.  For example,
    
    	      zsh -x -o shwordsplit scr
    
           runs  the  script  scr, setting the XTRACE option by the corresponding letter `-x' and the
           SH_WORD_SPLIT option by name.  Options may be turned off by name by using  +o  instead  of
           -o.   -o  can  be  stacked  up  with  preceding single-letter options, so for example `-xo
           shwordsplit' or `-xoshwordsplit' is equivalent to `-x -o shwordsplit'.
    
           Options may also be specified by name in GNU long  option  style,  `--option-name'.   When
           this  is  done,	`-' characters in the option name are permitted: they are translated into
           `_', and thus ignored.  So, for	example,  `zsh	--sh-word-split'  invokes  zsh	with  the
           SH_WORD_SPLIT  option turned on.  Like other option syntaxes, options can be turned off by
           replacing  the  initial	`-'  with  a  `+';  thus  `+-sh-word-split'  is   equivalent   to
           `--no-sh-word-split'.   Unlike  other  option  syntaxes,  GNU-style long options cannot be
           stacked with any other options, so for example `-x-shwordsplit' is an error,  rather  than
           being treated like `-x --shwordsplit'.
    
           The  special  GNU-style	option	`--version'  is  handled; it sends to standard output the
           shell's version information, then exits successfully.  `--help' is also handled; it  sends
           to  standard output a list of options that can be used when invoking the shell, then exits
           successfully.
    
           Option processing may be finished, allowing following arguments that start with `-' or `+'
           to  be treated as normal arguments, in two ways.  Firstly, a lone `-' (or `+') as an argu‐
           ment by itself ends option processing.  Secondly, a special option `--' (or  `+-'),  which
           may  be	specified  on  its own (which is the standard POSIX usage) or may be stacked with
           preceding options (so `-x-' is equivalent to `-x --').  Options are not	permitted  to  be
           stacked	after  `--' (so `-x-f' is an error), but note the GNU-style option form discussed
           above, where `--shwordsplit' is permitted and does not end option processing.
    
           Except when the sh/ksh emulation single-letter options are in effect, the option `-b'  (or
           `+b')  ends  option  processing.   `-b'	is  like  `--', except that further single-letter
           options can be stacked after the `-b' and will take effect as normal.
    
    COMPATIBILITY
           Zsh tries to emulate sh or ksh when it is invoked as sh or  ksh	respectively;  more  pre‐
           cisely,	it  looks  at the first letter of the name by which it was invoked, excluding any
           initial `r' (assumed to stand for `restricted'), and if that is `b', `s' or  `k'  it  will
           emulate	sh  or ksh.  Furthermore, if invoked as su (which happens on certain systems when
           the shell is executed by the su command), the shell will try to find an	alternative  name
           from the SHELL environment variable and perform emulation based on that.
    
           In  sh  and  ksh compatibility modes the following parameters are not special and not ini‐
           tialized by the shell: ARGC, argv, cdpath, fignore, fpath, HISTCHARS,  mailpath,  MANPATH,
           manpath, path, prompt, PROMPT, PROMPT2, PROMPT3, PROMPT4, psvar, status, watch.
    
           The usual zsh startup/shutdown scripts are not executed.  Login shells source /etc/profile
           followed by $HOME/.profile.  If the ENV environment variable is set on invocation, $ENV is
           sourced	after the profile scripts.  The value of ENV is subjected to parameter expansion,
           command substitution, and arithmetic expansion before being  interpreted  as  a	pathname.
           Note that the PRIVILEGED option also affects the execution of startup files.
    
           The  following  options	are  set  if  the  shell is invoked as sh or ksh: NO_BAD_PATTERN,
           NO_BANG_HIST, NO_BG_NICE, NO_EQUALS,  NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO,  GLOB_SUBST,	NO_GLOBAL_EXPORT,
           NO_HUP,	  INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS,    KSH_ARRAYS,	  NO_MULTIOS,	 NO_NOMATCH,   NO_NOTIFY,
           POSIX_BUILTINS,	  NO_PROMPT_PERCENT,	RM_STAR_SILENT,    SH_FILE_EXPANSION,	 SH_GLOB,
           SH_OPTION_LETTERS, SH_WORD_SPLIT.  Additionally the BSD_ECHO and IGNORE_BRACES options are
           set if zsh is invoked as sh.   Also,  the  KSH_OPTION_PRINT,  LOCAL_OPTIONS,  PROMPT_BANG,
           PROMPT_SUBST and SINGLE_LINE_ZLE options are set if zsh is invoked as ksh.
    
    RESTRICTED SHELL
           When the basename of the command used to invoke zsh starts with the letter `r' or the `-r'
           command line option is supplied at invocation, the shell  becomes  restricted.	Emulation
           mode is determined after stripping the letter `r' from the invocation name.  The following
           are disabled in restricted mode:
    
           ·      changing directories with the cd builtin
    
           ·      changing or unsetting the PATH, path, MODULE_PATH,  module_path,	SHELL,	HISTFILE,
    	      HISTSIZE,  GID,  EGID,  UID, EUID, USERNAME, LD_LIBRARY_PATH, LD_AOUT_LIBRARY_PATH,
    	      LD_PRELOAD and  LD_AOUT_PRELOAD parameters
    
           ·      specifying command names containing /
    
           ·      specifying command pathnames using hash
    
           ·      redirecting output to files
    
           ·      using the exec builtin command to replace the shell with another command
    
           ·      using jobs -Z to overwrite the shell process' argument and environment space
    
           ·      using the ARGV0 parameter to override argv[0] for external commands
    
           ·      turning off restricted mode with set +r or unsetopt RESTRICTED
    
           These restrictions are enforced after processing the startup  files.   The  startup  files
           should  set up PATH to point to a directory of commands which can be safely invoked in the
           restricted environment.	They may also add  further  restrictions  by  disabling  selected
           builtins.
    
           Restricted  mode  can  also  be activated any time by setting the RESTRICTED option.  This
           immediately enables all the restrictions described above even if the shell still  has  not
           processed all startup files.
    
    STARTUP/SHUTDOWN FILES
           Commands are first read from /etc/zshenv; this cannot be overridden.  Subsequent behaviour
           is modified by the RCS and GLOBAL_RCS options; the former affects all startup files, while
           the  second only affects global startup files (those shown here with an path starting with
           a /).  If one of the options is unset at any point, any subsequent startup file(s) of  the
           corresponding  type  will  not  be  read.   It  is also possible for a file in $ZDOTDIR to
           re-enable GLOBAL_RCS. Both RCS and GLOBAL_RCS are set by default.
    
           Commands are then read from $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv.  If the shell is a login shell, commands are
           read  from  /etc/zprofile and then $ZDOTDIR/.zprofile.  Then, if the shell is interactive,
           commands are read from /etc/zshrc and then $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc.  Finally, if the  shell  is	a
           login shell, /etc/zlogin and $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin are read.
    
           When  a	login  shell  exits,  the files $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout and then /etc/zlogout are read.
           This happens with either an explicit exit via the exit or logout commands, or an  implicit
           exit  by  reading  end-of-file from the terminal.  However, if the shell terminates due to
           exec'ing another process, the logout files are not read.  These are also affected  by  the
           RCS  and  GLOBAL_RCS options.  Note also that the RCS option affects the saving of history
           files, i.e. if RCS is unset when the shell exits, no history file will be saved.
    
           If ZDOTDIR is unset, HOME is used instead.  Files listed above as being in /etc may be  in
           another directory, depending on the installation.
    
           As  /etc/zshenv	is run for all instances of zsh, it is important that it be kept as small
           as possible.  In particular, it is a good idea to put code that does not need  to  be  run
           for  every  single  shell behind a test of the form `if [[ -o rcs ]]; then ...' so that it
           will not be executed when zsh is invoked with the `-f' option.
    
           Any of these files may be  pre-compiled	with  the  zcompile  builtin  command  (see  zsh‐
           builtins(1)).  If a compiled file exists (named for the original file plus the .zwc exten‐
           sion) and it is newer than the original file, the compiled file will be used instead.
    
    ZSHROADMAP(1)			     General Commands Manual			    ZSHROADMAP(1)
    
    NAME
           zshroadmap - informal introduction to the zsh  manual  The  Zsh	Manual,  like  the  shell
           itself, is large and often complicated.	This section of the manual provides some pointers
           to areas of the shell that are likely to be of particular interest to new users, and indi‐
           cates where in the rest of the manual the documentation is to be found.
    
    WHEN THE SHELL STARTS
           When  it  starts,  the  shell  reads commands from various files.  These can be created or
           edited to customize the shell.  See the section Startup/Shutdown Files in zsh(1).
    
           If no personal initialization files exist for the current user, a function is run to  help
           you  change  some  of the most common settings.	It won't appear if your administrator has
           disabled the zsh/newuser module.  The function is designed to  be  self-explanatory.   You
           can  run  it by hand with `autoload -Uz zsh-newuser-install; zsh-newuser-install -f'.  See
           also the section User Configuration Functions in zshcontrib(1).
    
    INTERACTIVE USE
           Interaction with the shell uses the builtin Zsh Line Editor, ZLE.  This	is  described  in
           detail in zshzle(1).
    
           The  first decision a user must make is whether to use the Emacs or Vi editing mode as the
           keys for editing are substantially different.  Emacs editing mode is probably more natural
           for beginners and can be selected explicitly with the command bindkey -e.
    
           A history mechanism for retrieving previously typed lines (most simply with the Up or Down
           arrow keys) is available; note that, unlike other shells, zsh will not  save  these  lines
           when the shell exits unless you set appropriate variables, and the number of history lines
           retained by default is quite small (30 lines).  See the description of the shell variables
           (referred  to  in the documentation as parameters) HISTFILE, HISTSIZE and SAVEHIST in zsh‐
           param(1).  Note that it's currently only possible to read and write files  saving  history
           when the shell is interactive, i.e. it does not work from scripts.
    
           The  shell now supports the UTF-8 character set (and also others if supported by the oper‐
           ating system).  This is (mostly) handled transparently by the shell,  but  the  degree  of
           support	in terminal emulators is variable.  There is some discussion of this in the shell
           FAQ, http://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.  Note in particular that for combining characters to be han‐
           dled  the option COMBINING_CHARS needs to be set.  Because the shell is now more sensitive
           to the definition of the character set, note that if you are upgrading from an older  ver‐
           sion  of the shell you should ensure that the appropriate variable, either LANG (to affect
           all aspects of the shell's operation) or LC_CTYPE (to affect only the handling of  charac‐
           ter  sets)  is  set  to	an  appropriate value.	This is true even if you are using a sin‐
           gle-byte character set including extensions of ASCII such as  ISO-8859-1  or  ISO-8859-15.
           See the description of LC_CTYPE in zshparam(1).
    
       Completion
           Completion  is  a  feature  present in many shells. It allows the user to type only a part
           (usually the prefix) of a word and have the shell fill in the rest.  The completion system
           in  zsh is programmable.  For example, the shell can be set to complete email addresses in
           arguments to the mail command from your ~/.abook/addressbook;  usernames,  hostnames,  and
           even  remote  paths  in	arguments  to scp, and so on.  Anything that can be written in or
           glued together with zsh can be the source of what the line editor offers as possible  com‐
           pletions.
    
           Zsh  has  two  completion  systems,  an old, so called compctl completion (named after the
           builtin command that serves as its complete and only  user  interface),	and  a	new  one,
           referred  to  as compsys, organized as library of builtin and user-defined functions.  The
           two systems differ in their interface for specifying the  completion  behavior.	 The  new
           system  is  more customizable and is supplied with completions for many commonly used com‐
           mands; it is therefore to be preferred.
    
           The completion system must be enabled explicitly when the shell starts.	For more informa‐
           tion see zshcompsys(1).
    
       Extending the line editor
           Apart  from  completion, the line editor is highly extensible by means of shell functions.
           Some useful functions are provided with the shell; they provide facilities such as:
    
           insert-composed-char
    	      composing characters not found on the keyboard
    
           match-words-by-style
    	      configuring what the line editor considers a word when moving or deleting by word
    
           history-beginning-search-backward-end, etc.
    	      alternative ways of searching the shell history
    
           replace-string, replace-pattern
    	      functions for replacing strings or patterns globally in the command line
    
           edit-command-line
    	      edit the command line with an external editor.
    
           See the section `ZLE Functions' in zshcontrib(1) for descriptions of these.
    
    OPTIONS
           The shell has a large number of options for  changing  its  behaviour.	These  cover  all
           aspects	of  the  shell;  browsing  the	full documentation is the only good way to become
           acquainted with the many possibilities.	See zshoptions(1).
    
    PATTERN MATCHING
           The shell has a rich set of patterns which are available for file matching  (described  in
           the documentation as `filename generation' and also known for historical reasons as `glob‐
           bing') and for use when programming.  These are described in the section `Filename Genera‐
           tion' in zshexpn(1).
    
           Of particular interest are the following patterns that are not commonly supported by other
           systems of pattern matching:
    
           **     for matching over multiple directories
    
           ~, ^   the ability to exclude patterns from matching when the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set
    
           (...)  glob qualifiers, included in parentheses at the end of the  pattern,  which  select
    	      files by type (such as directories) or attribute (such as size).
    
    GENERAL COMMENTS ON SYNTAX
           Although  the  syntax  of  zsh  is  in  ways similar to the Korn shell, and therefore more
           remotely to the original UNIX shell, the Bourne shell,  its  default  behaviour	does  not
           entirely  correspond  to  those shells.	General shell syntax is introduced in the section
           `Shell Grammar' in zshmisc(1).
    
           One commonly encountered difference is that variables substituted onto  the  command  line
           are  not  split	into words.  See the description of the shell option SH_WORD_SPLIT in the
           section `Parameter Expansion' in zshexpn(1).  In zsh, you can  either  explicitly  request
           the  splitting  (e.g.  ${=foo}) or use an array when you want a variable to expand to more
           than one word.  See the section `Array Parameters' in zshparam(1).
    
    PROGRAMMING
           The most convenient way of adding enhancements to the shell  is	typically  by  writing	a
           shell function and arranging for it to be autoloaded.  Functions are described in the sec‐
           tion `Functions' in zshmisc(1).	Users changing from the C shell and its relatives  should
           notice that aliases are less used in zsh as they don't perform argument substitution, only
           simple text replacement.
    
           A few general functions, other than those for the line editor described	above,	are  pro‐
           vided with the shell and are described in zshcontrib(1).  Features include:
    
           promptinit
    	      a prompt theme system for changing prompts easily, see the section `Prompt Themes'
    
           zsh-mime-setup
    	      a  MIME-handling system which dispatches commands according to the suffix of a file
    	      as done by graphical file managers
    
           zcalc  a calculator
    
           zargs  a version of xargs that makes the find command redundant
    
           zmv    a command for renaming files by means of shell patterns.
    
    ZSHMISC(1)			     General Commands Manual			       ZSHMISC(1)
    
    NAME
           zshmisc - everything and then some
    
    SIMPLE COMMANDS & PIPELINES
           A simple command is a sequence of optional parameter assignments followed  by  blank-sepa‐
           rated  words,  with  optional redirections interspersed.  For a description of assignment,
           see the beginning of zshparam(1).
    
           The first word is the command to be executed, and the remaining words, if any,  are  argu‐
           ments  to  the  command.  If a command name is given, the parameter assignments modify the
           environment of the command when it is executed.	The value of a simple command is its exit
           status, or 128 plus the signal number if terminated by a signal.  For example,
    
    	      echo foo
    
           is a simple command with arguments.
    
           A  pipeline is either a simple command, or a sequence of two or more simple commands where
           each command is separated from the next by `|' or `|&'.	Where commands are  separated  by
           `|',  the  standard  output of the first command is connected to the standard input of the
           next.  `|&' is shorthand for `2>&1 |', which connects both the  standard  output  and  the
           standard  error of the command to the standard input of the next.  The value of a pipeline
           is the value of the last command, unless the pipeline is preceded by `!' in which case the
           value is the logical inverse of the value of the last command.  For example,
    
    	      echo foo | sed 's/foo/bar/'
    
           is a pipeline, where the output (`foo' plus a newline) of the first command will be passed
           to the input of the second.
    
           If a pipeline is preceded by `coproc', it is executed as a coprocess; a	two-way  pipe  is
           established  between  it  and  the  parent shell.  The shell can read from or write to the
           coprocess by means of the `>&p' and `<&p' redirection operators or  with  `print  -p'  and
           `read  -p'.   A	pipeline  cannot be preceded by both `coproc' and `!'.	If job control is
           active, the coprocess can be treated in other than input and output as an  ordinary  back‐
           ground job.
    
           A sublist is either a single pipeline, or a sequence of two or more pipelines separated by
           `&&' or `||'.  If two pipelines are separated by `&&', the  second  pipeline  is  executed
           only  if  the  first  succeeds (returns a zero status).	If two pipelines are separated by
           `||', the second is executed only if the first fails (returns  a  nonzero  status).   Both
           operators have equal precedence and are left associative.  The value of the sublist is the
           value of the last pipeline executed.  For example,
    
    	      dmesg | grep panic && print yes
    
           is a sublist consisting of two pipelines, the second just a simple command which  will  be
           executed if and only if the grep command returns a zero status.	If it does not, the value
           of the sublist is that return status, else it is the status returned by the print  (almost
           certainly zero).
    
           A list is a sequence of zero or more sublists, in which each sublist is terminated by `;',
           `&', `&|', `&!', or a newline.  This terminator may optionally be omitted  from	the  last
           sublist	in the list when the list appears as a complex command inside `(...)' or `{...}'.
           When a sublist is terminated by `;' or newline, the shell waits for it  to  finish  before
           executing the next sublist.  If a sublist is terminated by a `&', `&|', or `&!', the shell
           executes the last pipeline in it in the background, and does not wait  for  it  to  finish
           (note the difference from other shells which execute the whole sublist in the background).
           A backgrounded pipeline returns a status of zero.
    
           More generally, a list can be seen as a set of any shell  commands  whatsoever,	including
           the  complex  commands  below;  this  is implied wherever the word `list' appears in later
           descriptions.  For example, the commands in a shell function form a special sort of list.
    
    PRECOMMAND MODIFIERS
           A simple command may be preceded by a precommand modifier, which will alter how	the  com‐
           mand  is  interpreted.	These  modifiers are shell builtin commands with the exception of
           nocorrect which is a reserved word.
    
           -      The command is executed with a `-' prepended to its argv[0] string.
    
           builtin
    	      The command word is taken to be the name of a builtin command, rather than a  shell
    	      function or external command.
    
           command [ -pvV ]
    	      The  command  word  is  taken  to be the name of an external command, rather than a
    	      shell function or builtin.   If the POSIX_BUILTINS option  is  set,  builtins  will
    	      also be executed but certain special properties of them are suppressed. The -p flag
    	      causes a default path to be searched instead of that in $path. With  the	-v  flag,
    	      command is similar to whence and with -V, it is equivalent to whence -v.
    
           exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ]
    	      The  following  command  together with any arguments is run in place of the current
    	      process, rather than as a sub-process.  The shell does not fork  and  is	replaced.
    	      The  shell does not invoke TRAPEXIT, nor does it source zlogout files.  The options
    	      are provided for compatibility with other shells.
    
    	      The -c option clears the environment.
    
    	      The -l option is equivalent to the - precommand modifier, to treat the  replacement
    	      command as a login shell; the command is executed with a - prepended to its argv[0]
    	      string.  This flag has no effect if used together with the -a option.
    
    	      The -a option is used to specify explicitly the argv[0] string  (the  name  of  the
    	      command as seen by the process itself) to be used by the replacement command and is
    	      directly equivalent to setting a value for the ARGV0 environment variable.
    
           nocorrect
    	      Spelling correction is not done on any of the words.  This must appear  before  any
    	      other  precommand modifier, as it is interpreted immediately, before any parsing is
    	      done.  It has no effect in non-interactive shells.
    
           noglob Filename generation (globbing) is not performed on any of the words.
    
    COMPLEX COMMANDS
           A complex command in zsh is one of the following:
    
           if list then list [ elif list then list ] ... [ else list ] fi
    	      The if list is executed, and if it returns a zero exit status,  the  then  list  is
    	      executed.  Otherwise, the elif list is executed and if its status is zero, the then
    	      list is executed.  If each elif list returns nonzero status, the else list is  exe‐
    	      cuted.
    
           for name ... [ in word ... ] term do list done
    	      where  term  is  at  least one newline or ;.  Expand the list of words, and set the
    	      parameter name to each of them in turn, executing list each time.  If the  in  word
    	      is omitted, use the positional parameters instead of the words.
    
    	      More  than  one parameter name can appear before the list of words.  If N names are
    	      given, then on each execution of the loop the next N words are assigned to the cor‐
    	      responding parameters.  If there are more names than remaining words, the remaining
    	      parameters are each set to the empty string.  Execution of the loop ends when there
    	      is  no  remaining  word to assign to the first name.  It is only possible for in to
    	      appear as the first name in the list, else it will be treated as marking the end of
    	      the list.
    
           for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) do list done
    	      The  arithmetic  expression  expr1  is evaluated first (see the section `Arithmetic
    	      Evaluation').  The arithmetic expression expr2 is  repeatedly  evaluated	until  it
    	      evaluates to zero and when non-zero, list is executed and the arithmetic expression
    	      expr3 evaluated.	If any expression is omitted, then it behaves as if it	evaluated
    	      to 1.
    
           while list do list done
    	      Execute the do list as long as the while list returns a zero exit status.
    
           until list do list done
    	      Execute the do list as long as until list returns a nonzero exit status.
    
           repeat word do list done
    	      word  is expanded and treated as an arithmetic expression, which must evaluate to a
    	      number n.  list is then executed n times.
    
    	      The repeat syntax is disabled by default when the shell starts in a mode	emulating
    	      another shell.  It can be enabled with the command `enable -r repeat'
    
           case word in [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&|;|) ] ... esac
    	      Execute  the list associated with the first pattern that matches word, if any.  The
    	      form of the patterns is the same as that used for  filename  generation.	 See  the
    	      section `Filename Generation'.
    
    	      Note  further that, unless the SH_GLOB option is set, the whole pattern with alter‐
    	      natives is treated by the shell as equivalent to a group of patterns within  paren‐
    	      theses,  although white space may appear about the parentheses and the vertical bar
    	      and will be stripped from the pattern at those  points.	White  space  may  appear
    	      elsewhere  in  the pattern; this is not stripped.  If the SH_GLOB option is set, so
    	      that an opening parenthesis can be unambiguously treated as part of the  case  syn‐
    	      tax,  the  expression is parsed into separate words and these are treated as strict
    	      alternatives (as in other shells).
    
    	      If the list that is executed is terminated with ;& rather than  ;;,  the	following
    	      list is also executed.  The rule for the terminator of the following list ;;, ;& or
    	      ;| is applied unless the esac is reached.
    
    	      If the list that is executed is terminated with ;| the shell continues to scan  the
    	      patterns looking for the next match, executing the corresponding list, and applying
    	      the rule for the corresponding terminator ;;, ;& or ;|.	Note  that  word  is  not
    	      re-expanded; all applicable patterns are tested with the same word.
    
           select name [ in word ... term ] do list done
    	      where  term  is  one or more newline or ; to terminate the words.  Print the set of
    	      words, each preceded by a number.  If the in word is omitted,  use  the  positional
    	      parameters.   The PROMPT3 prompt is printed and a line is read from the line editor
    	      if the shell is interactive and that is active, or else standard	input.	 If  this
    	      line  consists of the number of one of the listed words, then the parameter name is
    	      set to the word corresponding to this number.  If this line is empty, the selection
    	      list  is printed again.  Otherwise, the value of the parameter name is set to null.
    	      The contents of the line read from standard input is saved in the parameter  REPLY.
    	      list is executed for each selection until a break or end-of-file is encountered.
    
           ( list )
    	      Execute  list  in  a  subshell.	Traps  set by the trap builtin are reset to their
    	      default values while executing list.
    
           { list }
    	      Execute list.
    
           { try-list } always { always-list }
    	      First execute try-list.  Regardless of errors, or break, continue, or  return  com‐
    	      mands  encountered  within try-list, execute always-list.  Execution then continues
    	      from the result of the execution of try-list; in other words, any error, or  break,
    	      continue,  or  return  command is treated in the normal way, as if always-list were
    	      not present.  The two chunks of code are referred to as the  `try  block'  and  the
    	      `always block'.
    
    	      Optional	newlines  or  semicolons may appear after the always; note, however, that
    	      they may not appear between the preceding closing brace and the always.
    
    	      An `error' in this context is a condition such as a syntax error which  causes  the
    	      shell  to  abort execution of the current function, script, or list.  Syntax errors
    	      encountered while the shell is parsing the code do not cause the always-list to  be
    	      executed.  For example, an erroneously constructed if block in try-list would cause
    	      the shell to abort during parsing, so that always-list would not be executed, while
    	      an  erroneous  substitution  such  as  ${*foo*} would cause a run-time error, after
    	      which always-list would be executed.
    
    	      An error condition can be tested	and  reset  with  the  special	integer  variable
    	      TRY_BLOCK_ERROR.	 Outside  an  always-list the value is irrelevant, but it is ini‐
    	      tialised to -1.  Inside always-list, the value is 1 if an  error	occurred  in  the
    	      try-list, else 0.  If TRY_BLOCK_ERROR is set to 0 during the always-list, the error
    	      condition caused by the try-list is reset, and shell execution  continues  normally
    	      after the end of always-list.  Altering the value during the try-list is not useful
    	      (unless this forms part of an enclosing always block).
    
    	      Regardless of TRY_BLOCK_ERROR, after the end of always-list the normal shell status
    	      $?  is  the  value  returned  from try-list.  This will be non-zero if there was an
    	      error, even if TRY_BLOCK_ERROR was set to zero.
    
    	      The following executes the given code, ignoring any errors it causes.  This  is  an
    	      alternative  to  the  usual convention of protecting code by executing it in a sub‐
    	      shell.
    
    		     {
    			 # code which may cause an error
    		       } always {
    			 # This code is executed regardless of the error.
    			 (( TRY_BLOCK_ERROR = 0 ))
    		     }
    		     # The error condition has been reset.
    
    	      An exit command (or a return command executed at the outermost function level of	a
    	      script)  encountered  in	try-list  does	not  cause  the execution of always-list.
    	      Instead, the shell exits immediately after any EXIT trap has been executed.
    
           function word ... [ () ] [ term ] { list }
           word ... () [ term ] { list }
           word ... () [ term ] command
    	      where term is one or more newline or ;.  Define a function which is  referenced  by
    	      any  one	of word.  Normally, only one word is provided; multiple words are usually
    	      only useful for setting traps.  The body of the function is the list between the	{
    	      and }.  See the section `Functions'.
    
    	      If  the  option SH_GLOB is set for compatibility with other shells, then whitespace
    	      may appear between the left and right parentheses when  there  is  a  single  word;
    	      otherwise,  the  parentheses  will be treated as forming a globbing pattern in that
    	      case.
    
    	      In any of the forms above, a redirection may appear outside the function body,  for
    	      example
    
    		     func() { ... } 2>&1
    
    	      The  redirection	is  stored with the function and applied whenever the function is
    	      executed.  Any variables in the redirection are expanded at the point the  function
    	      is executed, but outside the function scope.
    
           time [ pipeline ]
    	      The  pipeline is executed, and timing statistics are reported on the standard error
    	      in the form specified by the TIMEFMT parameter.  If pipeline is omitted, print sta‐
    	      tistics about the shell process and its children.
    
           [[ exp ]]
    	      Evaluates  the  conditional  expression  exp and return a zero exit status if it is
    	      true.  See the section `Conditional Expressions' for a description of exp.
    
    ALTERNATE FORMS FOR COMPLEX COMMANDS
           Many of zsh's complex commands have alternate  forms.   These  are  non-standard  and  are
           likely  not to be obvious even to seasoned shell programmers; they should not be used any‐
           where that portability of shell code is a concern.
    
           The short versions below only work if sublist is  of  the  form	`{  list  }'  or  if  the
           SHORT_LOOPS  option is set.  For the if, while and until commands, in both these cases the
           test part of the loop must also be suitably delimited, such as by `[[ ... ]]' or  `((  ...
           ))',  else  the	end  of  the  test will not be recognized.  For the for, repeat, case and
           select commands no such special form for the arguments is necessary, but the other  condi‐
           tion (the special form of sublist or use of the SHORT_LOOPS option) still applies.
    
           if list { list } [ elif list { list } ] ... [ else { list } ]
    	      An alternate form of if.	The rules mean that
    
    		     if [[ -o ignorebraces ]] {
    		       print yes
    		     }
    
    	      works, but
    
    		     if true {	# Does not work!
    		       print yes
    		     }
    
    	      does not, since the test is not suitably delimited.
    
           if list sublist
    	      A  short	form of the alternate if.  The same limitations on the form of list apply
    	      as for the previous form.
    
           for name ... ( word ... ) sublist
    	      A short form of for.
    
           for name ... [ in word ... ] term sublist
    	      where term is at least one newline or ;.	Another short form of for.
    
           for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) sublist
    	      A short form of the arithmetic for command.
    
           foreach name ... ( word ... ) list end
    	      Another form of for.
    
           while list { list }
    	      An alternative form of while.  Note the limitations on the form of  list	mentioned
    	      above.
    
           until list { list }
    	      An  alternative  form of until.  Note the limitations on the form of list mentioned
    	      above.
    
           repeat word sublist
    	      This is a short form of repeat.
    
           case word { [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&|;|) ] ... }
    	      An alternative form of case.
    
           select name [ in word ... term ] sublist
    	      where term is at least one newline or ;.	A short form of select.
    
    RESERVED WORDS
           The following words are recognized as reserved words when used as the first word of a com‐
           mand unless quoted or disabled using disable -r:
    
           do  done esac then elif else fi for case if while function repeat time until select coproc
           nocorrect foreach end ! [[ { } declare export float integer local readonly typeset
    
           Additionally, `}' is recognized in any position if neither the  IGNORE_BRACES  option  nor
           the IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option is set.
    
    ERRORS
           Certain errors are treated as fatal by the shell: in an interactive shell, they cause con‐
           trol to return to the command line, and in a non-interactive shell they cause the shell to
           be  aborted.  In older versions of zsh, a non-interactive shell running a script would not
           abort completely, but would resume execution at the next  command  to  be  read	from  the
           script,	skipping the remainder of any functions or shell constructs such as loops or con‐
           ditions; this somewhat illogical behaviour can be recovered by  setting	the  option  CON‐
           TINUE_ON_ERROR.
    
           Fatal errors found in non-interactive shells include:
    
           ·      Failure to parse shell options passed when invoking the shell
    
           ·      Failure to change options with the set builtin
    
           ·      Parse errors of all sorts, including failures to parse mathematical expressions
    
           ·      Failures	to set or modify variable behaviour with typeset, local, declare, export,
    	      integer, float
    
           ·      Execution of incorrectly positioned loop control structures (continue, break)
    
           ·      Attempts to use regular expression with no regular expression module available
    
           ·      Disallowed operations when the RESTRICTED options is set
    
           ·      Failure to create a pipe needed for a pipeline
    
           ·      Failure to create a multio
    
           ·      Failure to autoload a module needed for a declared shell feature
    
           ·      Errors creating command or process substitutions
    
           ·      Syntax errors in glob qualifiers
    
           ·      File generation errors where not caught by the option BAD_PATTERN
    
           ·      All bad patterns used for matching within case statements
    
           ·      File generation failures where not caused by NO_MATCH or similar options
    
           ·      All file generation errors where the pattern was used to create a multio
    
           ·      Memory errors where detected by the shell
    
           ·      Invalid subscripts to shell variables
    
           ·      Attempts to assign read-only variables
    
           ·      Logical errors with variables such as assignment to the wrong type
    
           ·      Use of invalid variable names
    
           ·      Errors in variable substitution syntax
    
           ·      Failure to convert characters in $'...' expressions
    
           If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, more errors associated with  shell	builtin  commands
           are treated as fatal, as specified by the POSIX standard.
    
    COMMENTS
           In  non-interactive  shells, or in interactive shells with the INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option
           set, a word beginning with the third character of the histchars parameter (`#' by default)
           causes that word and all the following characters up to a newline to be ignored.
    
    ALIASING
           Every  eligible word in the shell input is checked to see if there is an alias defined for
           it.  If so, it is replaced by the text of the alias if it is in command	position  (if  it
           could  be the first word of a simple command), or if the alias is global.  If the replace‐
           ment text ends with a space, the next word in the shell input is always eligible for  pur‐
           poses of alias expansion.  An alias is defined using the alias builtin; global aliases may
           be defined using the -g option to that builtin.
    
           A word is defined as:
    
           ·      Any plain string or glob pattern
    
           ·      Any quoted string, using any quoting method (note that the quotes must be  part  of
    	      the alias definition for this to be eligible)
    
           ·      Any parameter reference or command substitution
    
           ·      Any  series  of  the  foregoing,	concatenated  without  whitespace or other tokens
    	      between them
    
           ·      Any reserved word (case, do, else, etc.)
    
           ·      With global aliasing, any command separator, any redirection operator, and  `('  or
    	      `)' when not part of a glob pattern
    
           It  is  not  presently possible to alias the `((' token that introduces arithmetic expres‐
           sions, because until a full statement has been parsed, it cannot be distinguished from two
           consecutive `(' tokens introducing nested subshells.
    
           When  POSIX_ALIASES  is	set,  only plain unquoted strings are eligible for aliasing.  The
           alias builtin does not reject ineligible aliases, but they are not expanded.
    
           Alias expansion is done on the shell input  before  any	other  expansion  except  history
           expansion.   Therefore,	if  an	alias is defined for the word foo, alias expansion may be
           avoided by quoting part of the word, e.g. \foo.	Any form of quoting works, although there
           is  nothing  to	prevent  an alias being defined for the quoted form such as \foo as well.
           Also, if a separator such as && is aliased, \&& turns into the two tokens \& and  &,  each
           of which may have been aliased separately.  Similarly for \<<, \>|, etc.
    
           For  use  with completion, which would remove an initial backslash followed by a character
           that isn't special, it may be more convenient to quote the word by starting with a  single
           quote, i.e. 'foo; completion will automatically add the trailing single quote.
    
           There is a commonly encountered problem with aliases illustrated by the following code:
    
    	      alias echobar='echo bar'; echobar
    
           This  prints  a message that the command echobar could not be found.  This happens because
           aliases are expanded when the code is read in; the entire line is read in one go, so  that
           when  echobar is executed it is too late to expand the newly defined alias.  This is often
           a problem in shell scripts, functions, and code executed with  `source'	or  `.'.   Conse‐
           quently, use of functions rather than aliases is recommended in non-interactive code.
    
           Note also the unhelpful interaction of aliases and function definitions:
    
    	      alias func='noglob func'
    	      func() {
    		  echo Do something with $*
    	      }
    
           Because aliases are expanded in function definitions, this causes the following command to
           be executed:
    
    	      noglob func() {
    		  echo Do something with $*
    	      }
    
           which defines noglob as well as func as functions with the body	given.	 To  avoid  this,
           either  quote  the  name  func  or  use the alternative function definition form `function
           func'.  Ensuring the alias is defined after the function works but is problematic  if  the
           code fragment might be re-executed.
    
    QUOTING
           A  character may be quoted (that is, made to stand for itself) by preceding it with a `\'.
           `\' followed by a newline is ignored.
    
           A string enclosed between `$'' and `'' is processed the same way as the	string	arguments
           of  the	print  builtin,  and the resulting string is considered to be entirely quoted.	A
           literal `'' character can be included in the string by using the `\'' escape.
    
           All characters enclosed between a pair of single quotes ('') that is not preceded by a `$'
           are quoted.  A single quote cannot appear within single quotes unless the option RC_QUOTES
           is set, in which case a pair of single quotes are turned into a single quote.   For  exam‐
           ple,
    
    	      print ''''
    
           outputs	nothing  apart from a newline if RC_QUOTES is not set, but one single quote if it
           is set.
    
           Inside double quotes (""), parameter and command substitution occur, and  `\'  quotes  the
           characters `\', ``', `"', and `$'.
    
    REDIRECTION
           If  a  command  is  followed by & and job control is not active, then the default standard
           input for the command is the empty file /dev/null.  Otherwise,  the  environment  for  the
           execution  of a command contains the file descriptors of the invoking shell as modified by
           input/output specifications.
    
           The following may appear anywhere in a simple command or may precede or follow  a  complex
           command.   Expansion  occurs  before  word or digit is used except as noted below.  If the
           result of substitution on word produces more than one  filename,  redirection  occurs  for
           each separate filename in turn.
    
           < word Open file word for reading as standard input.
    
           <> word
    	      Open  file  word	for  reading and writing as standard input.  If the file does not
    	      exist then it is created.
    
           > word Open file word for writing as standard output.  If the file does not exist then  it
    	      is  created.   If  the file exists, and the CLOBBER option is unset, this causes an
    	      error; otherwise, it is truncated to zero length.
    
           >| word
           >! word
    	      Same as >, except that the file is truncated to zero length if it exists,  even  if
    	      CLOBBER is unset.
    
           >> word
    	      Open file word for writing in append mode as standard output.  If the file does not
    	      exist, and the CLOBBER option is unset, this causes an error; otherwise,	the  file
    	      is created.
    
           >>| word
           >>! word
    	      Same  as	>>, except that the file is created if it does not exist, even if CLOBBER
    	      is unset.
    
           <<[-] word
    	      The shell input is read up  to  a  line  that  is  the  same  as	word,  or  to  an
    	      end-of-file.   No  parameter expansion, command substitution or filename generation
    	      is performed on word.  The resulting document, called a here-document, becomes  the
    	      standard input.
    
    	      If any character of word is quoted with single or double quotes or a `\', no inter‐
    	      pretation is placed upon the characters of the document.	Otherwise, parameter  and
    	      command  substitution occurs, `\' followed by a newline is removed, and `\' must be
    	      used to quote the characters `\', `$', ``' and the first character of word.
    
    	      Note that word itself does not undergo shell expansion.  Backquotes in word do  not
    	      have  their  usual  effect;  instead they behave similarly to double quotes, except
    	      that the backquotes themselves are passed through unchanged.  (This information  is
    	      given  for completeness and it is not recommended that backquotes be used.)  Quotes
    	      in the form $'...' have their standard effect of expanding  backslashed  references
    	      to special characters.
    
    	      If <<- is used, then all leading tabs are stripped from word and from the document.
    
           <<< word
    	      Perform  shell  expansion  on  word and pass the result to standard input.  This is
    	      known as a here-string.  Compare the use of word	in  here-documents  above,  where
    	      word does not undergo shell expansion.
    
           <& number
           >& number
    	      The standard input/output is duplicated from file descriptor number (see dup2(2)).
    
           <& -
           >& -   Close the standard input/output.
    
           <& p
           >& p   The input/output from/to the coprocess is moved to the standard input/output.
    
           >& word
           &> word
    	      (Except  where `>& word' matches one of the above syntaxes; `&>' can always be used
    	      to avoid this ambiguity.)  Redirects both standard output and standard error  (file
    	      descriptor  2)  in  the  manner of `> word'.  Note that this does not have the same
    	      effect as `> word 2>&1' in the presence of multios (see the section below).
    
           >&| word
           >&! word
           &>| word
           &>! word
    	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner
    	      of `>| word'.
    
           >>& word
           &>> word
    	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner
    	      of `>> word'.
    
           >>&| word
           >>&! word
           &>>| word
           &>>! word
    	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner
    	      of `>>| word'.
    
           If  one	of the above is preceded by a digit, then the file descriptor referred to is that
           specified by the digit instead of the default 0 or 1.  The order in which redirections are
           specified  is  significant.   The  shell  evaluates each redirection in terms of the (file
           descriptor, file) association at the time of evaluation.  For example:
    
    	      ... 1>fname 2>&1
    
           first associates file descriptor 1 with file fname.  It then associates file descriptor	2
           with  the  file associated with file descriptor 1 (that is, fname).  If the order of redi‐
           rections were reversed, file descriptor 2 would be associated with the terminal	(assuming
           file  descriptor  1  had  been)	and  then file descriptor 1 would be associated with file
           fname.
    
           The `|&' command separator described in Simple Commands & Pipelines  in	zshmisc(1)  is	a
           shorthand for `2>&1 |'.
    
           The  various  forms  of	process  substitution,	`<(list)',  and  `=(list)'  for input and
           `>(list)' for output, are often used together with redirection.	For example, if  word  in
           an  output  redirection	is  of the form `>(list)' then the output is piped to the command
           represented by list.  See Process Substitution in zshexpn(1).
    
    OPENING FILE DESCRIPTORS USING PARAMETERS
           When the shell is parsing arguments to a command, and the shell	option	IGNORE_BRACES  is
           not  set, a different form of redirection is allowed: instead of a digit before the opera‐
           tor there is a valid shell identifier enclosed in braces.  The shell will open a new  file
           descriptor that is guaranteed to be at least 10 and set the parameter named by the identi‐
           fier to the file descriptor opened.  No whitespace is allowed between  the  closing  brace
           and the redirection character.  For example:
    
    	      ... {myfd}>&1
    
           This  opens  a  new  file descriptor that is a duplicate of file descriptor 1 and sets the
           parameter myfd to the number of the file descriptor, which will be at least 10.	 The  new
           file descriptor can be written to using the syntax >&$myfd.
    
           The  syntax  {varid}>&-,  for  example  {myfd}>&-,  may be used to close a file descriptor
           opened in this fashion.	Note that the parameter given by varid must previously be set  to
           a file descriptor in this case.
    
           It  is  an  error to open or close a file descriptor in this fashion when the parameter is
           readonly.  However, it is not an error to read or write a file descriptor  using  <&$param
           or >&$param if param is readonly.
    
           If the option CLOBBER is unset, it is an error to open a file descriptor using a parameter
           that is already set to an open file descriptor previously  allocated  by  this  mechanism.
           Unsetting the parameter before using it for allocating a file descriptor avoids the error.
    
           Note that this mechanism merely allocates or closes a file descriptor; it does not perform
           any redirections from or to it.	It is usually convenient to allocate  a  file  descriptor
           prior  to  use  as  an  argument  to exec.  The syntax does not in any case work when used
           around complex commands such as parenthesised subshells or loops, where the opening  brace
           is interpreted as part of a command list to be executed in the current shell.
    
           The  following shows a typical sequence of allocation, use, and closing of a file descrip‐
           tor:
    
    	      integer myfd
    	      exec {myfd}>~/logs/mylogfile.txt
    	      print This is a log message. >&$myfd
    	      exec {myfd}>&-
    
           Note that the expansion of the variable in the expression >&$myfd occurs at the point  the
           redirection  is	opened.   This	is after the expansion of command arguments and after any
           redirections to the left on the command line have been processed.
    
    MULTIOS
           If the user tries to open a file descriptor for writing more than once,	the  shell  opens
           the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies its input to all the specified out‐
           puts, similar to tee, provided the MULTIOS option is set, as it is by default.  Thus:
    
    	      date >foo >bar
    
           writes the date to two files, named `foo' and `bar'.  Note that a pipe is an implicit  re‐
           direction; thus
    
    	      date >foo | cat
    
           writes the date to the file `foo', and also pipes it to cat.
    
           If  the	MULTIOS option is set, the word after a redirection operator is also subjected to
           filename generation (globbing).	Thus
    
    	      : > *
    
           will truncate all files in the current directory, assuming there's at least one.  (Without
           the MULTIOS option, it would create an empty file called `*'.)  Similarly, you can do
    
    	      echo exit 0 >> *.sh
    
           If  the	user  tries to open a file descriptor for reading more than once, the shell opens
           the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies all the  specified  inputs  to  its
           output in the order specified, similar to cat, provided the MULTIOS option is set.  Thus
    
    	      sort <foo <fubar
    
           or even
    
    	      sort <f{oo,ubar}
    
           is equivalent to `cat foo fubar | sort'.
    
           Expansion  of  the  redirection argument occurs at the point the redirection is opened, at
           the point described above for the expansion of the variable in >&$myfd.
    
           Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus
    
    	      cat bar | sort <foo
    
           is equivalent to `cat bar foo | sort' (note the order of the inputs).
    
           If the MULTIOS option is unset, each redirection replaces  the  previous  redirection  for
           that file descriptor.  However, all files redirected to are actually opened, so
    
    	      echo Hello > bar > baz
    
           when MULTIOS is unset will truncate `bar', and write `Hello' into `baz'.
    
           There  is  a  problem  when an output multio is attached to an external program.  A simple
           example shows this:
    
    	      cat file >file1 >file2
    	      cat file1 file2
    
           Here, it is possible that the second `cat' will not display the full contents of file1 and
           file2 (i.e. the original contents of file repeated twice).
    
           The  reason  for this is that the multios are spawned after the cat process is forked from
           the parent shell, so the parent shell does not wait for	the  multios  to  finish  writing
           data.   This  means  the  command  as shown can exit before file1 and file2 are completely
           written.  As a workaround, it is possible to run the cat process as part of a job  in  the
           current shell:
    
    	      { cat file } >file >file2
    
           Here, the {...} job will pause to wait for both files to be written.
    
    REDIRECTIONS WITH NO COMMAND
           When  a	simple	command  consists  of  one or more redirection operators and zero or more
           parameter assignments, but no command name, zsh can behave in several ways.
    
           If the parameter NULLCMD is not set or the option CSH_NULLCMD is set, an error is  caused.
           This is the csh behavior and CSH_NULLCMD is set by default when emulating csh.
    
           If  the	option SH_NULLCMD is set, the builtin `:' is inserted as a command with the given
           redirections.  This is the default when emulating sh or ksh.
    
           Otherwise, if the parameter NULLCMD is set, its value will be used as a command	with  the
           given redirections.  If both NULLCMD and READNULLCMD are set, then the value of the latter
           will be used instead of that of the former when the redirection is an input.  The  default
           for NULLCMD is `cat' and for READNULLCMD is `more'. Thus
    
    	      < file
    
           shows the contents of file on standard output, with paging if that is a terminal.  NULLCMD
           and READNULLCMD may refer to shell functions.
    
    COMMAND EXECUTION
           If a command name contains no slashes, the shell attempts to locate it.	If there exists a
           shell  function	by  that name, the function is invoked as described in the section `Func‐
           tions'.	If there exists a shell builtin by that name, the builtin is invoked.
    
           Otherwise, the shell searches each element of $path for a  directory  containing  an  exe‐
           cutable	file by that name.  If the search is unsuccessful, the shell prints an error mes‐
           sage and returns a nonzero exit status.
    
           If execution fails because the file is not in executable format, and the  file  is  not	a
           directory,  it is assumed to be a shell script.	/bin/sh is spawned to execute it.  If the
           program is a file beginning with `#!', the remainder of the first line specifies an inter‐
           preter  for  the  program.   The shell will execute the specified interpreter on operating
           systems that do not handle this executable format in the kernel.
    
           If no external command is found but a function command_not_found_handler exists the  shell
           executes this function with all command line arguments.	The function should return status
           zero if it successfully handled the command, or non-zero status if it failed.  In the lat‐
           ter  case  the  standard  handling  is applied: `command not found' is printed to standard
           error and the shell exits with status 127.  Note that the handler is executed  in  a  sub‐
           shell  forked  to execute an external command, hence changes to directories, shell parame‐
           ters, etc. have no effect on the main shell.
    
    FUNCTIONS
           Shell functions are defined with the function reserved word or the special  syntax  `func‐
           name  ()'.   Shell  functions are read in and stored internally.  Alias names are resolved
           when the function is read.  Functions are executed like commands with the arguments passed
           as positional parameters.  (See the section `Command Execution'.)
    
           Functions  execute in the same process as the caller and share all files and present work‐
           ing directory with the caller.  A trap on EXIT set inside a function is executed after the
           function completes in the environment of the caller.
    
           The return builtin is used to return from function calls.
    
           Function identifiers can be listed with the functions builtin.  Functions can be undefined
           with the unfunction builtin.
    
    AUTOLOADING FUNCTIONS
           A function can be marked as undefined using the autoload builtin  (or  `functions  -u'  or
           `typeset  -fu').   Such	a function has no body.  When the function is first executed, the
           shell searches for its definition using the elements  of  the  fpath  variable.	 Thus  to
           define functions for autoloading, a typical sequence is:
    
    	      fpath=(~/myfuncs $fpath)
    	      autoload myfunc1 myfunc2 ...
    
           The usual alias expansion during reading will be suppressed if the autoload builtin or its
           equivalent is given the option -U. This is recommended for the use of  functions  supplied
           with  the zsh distribution.  Note that for functions precompiled with the zcompile builtin
           command the flag -U must be provided when the .zwc file is created, as  the  corresponding
           information is compiled into the latter.
    
           For  each  element in fpath, the shell looks for three possible files, the newest of which
           is used to load the definition for the function:
    
           element.zwc
    	      A file created with the zcompile builtin command, which is expected to contain  the
    	      definitions  for all functions in the directory named element.  The file is treated
    	      in the same manner as a directory containing files for functions	and  is  searched
    	      for  the	definition  of the function.   If the definition is not found, the search
    	      for a definition proceeds with the other two possibilities described below.
    
    	      If element already includes a .zwc extension (i.e.  the  extension  was  explicitly
    	      given  by the user), element is searched for the definition of the function without
    	      comparing its age to that of other files; in fact, there does not need  to  be  any
    	      directory  named	element  without  the  suffix.	Thus including an element such as
    	      `/usr/local/funcs.zwc' in fpath will speed up the search for  functions,	with  the
    	      disadvantage  that  functions included must be explicitly recompiled by hand before
    	      the shell notices any changes.
    
           element/function.zwc
    	      A file created with zcompile, which is expected to contain the definition for func‐
    	      tion.   It  may  include	other function definitions as well, but those are neither
    	      loaded nor executed; a file found in this way is searched only for  the  definition
    	      of function.
    
           element/function
    	      A file of zsh command text, taken to be the definition for function.
    
           In  summary,  the order of searching is, first, in the parents of directories in fpath for
           the newer of either a compiled directory or a directory in fpath; second, if more than one
           of  these contains a definition for the function that is sought, the leftmost in the fpath
           is chosen; and third, within a directory, the newer of either a compiled  function  or  an
           ordinary function definition is used.
    
           If  the	KSH_AUTOLOAD  option is set, or the file contains only a simple definition of the
           function, the file's contents will be executed.	This will normally define the function in
           question,  but  may  also  perform initialization, which is executed in the context of the
           function execution, and may therefore define local parameters.  It  is  an  error  if  the
           function is not defined by loading the file.
    
           Otherwise,  the	function body (with no surrounding `funcname() {...}') is taken to be the
           complete contents of the file.  This form allows the file to be used directly as  an  exe‐
           cutable shell script.  If processing of the file results in the function being re-defined,
           the function itself is not re-executed.	To force the shell to perform initialization  and
           then call the function defined, the file should contain initialization code (which will be
           executed then discarded) in addition to a complete  function  definition  (which  will  be
           retained  for subsequent calls to the function), and a call to the shell function, includ‐
           ing any arguments, at the end.
    
           For example, suppose the autoload file func contains
    
    	      func() { print This is func; }
    	      print func is initialized
    
           then `func; func' with KSH_AUTOLOAD set will produce both messages on the first call,  but
           only  the message `This is func' on the second and subsequent calls.  Without KSH_AUTOLOAD
           set, it will produce the initialization message on the first call, and the  other  message
           on the second and subsequent calls.
    
           It is also possible to create a function that is not marked as autoloaded, but which loads
           its own definition by searching fpath, by using `autoload -X'  within  a  shell	function.
           For example, the following are equivalent:
    
    	      myfunc() {
    		autoload -X
    	      }
    	      myfunc args...
    
           and
    
    	      unfunction myfunc   # if myfunc was defined
    	      autoload myfunc
    	      myfunc args...
    
           In  fact, the functions command outputs `builtin autoload -X' as the body of an autoloaded
           function.  This is done so that
    
    	      eval "$(functions)"
    
           produces a reasonable result.  A true autoloaded function can be identified by  the  pres‐
           ence  of  the  comment  `# undefined' in the body, because all comments are discarded from
           defined functions.
    
           To load the definition of an autoloaded function myfunc without executing myfunc, use:
    
    	      autoload +X myfunc
    
    ANONYMOUS FUNCTIONS
           If no name is given for a function, it is `anonymous' and is  handled  specially.   Either
           form  of  function  definition may be used: a `()' with no preceding name, or a `function'
           with an immediately following open brace.  The function is  executed  immediately  at  the
           point  of  definition  and  is  not  stored  for  future use.  The function name is set to
           `(anon)'.
    
           Arguments to the function may be specified as words following the closing  brace  defining
           the  function,  hence  if  there are none no arguments (other than $0) are set.	This is a
           difference from the way other functions are parsed: normal  function  definitions  may  be
           followed by certain keywords such as `else' or `fi', which will be treated as arguments to
           anonymous functions, so that a newline or semicolon is needed to force keyword interpreta‐
           tion.
    
           Note  also  that the argument list of any enclosing script or function is hidden (as would
           be the case for any other function called at this point).
    
           Redirections may be applied to the anonymous function in the same  manner  as  to  a  cur‐
           rent-shell  structure  enclosed in braces.  The main use of anonymous functions is to pro‐
           vide a scope for local variables.  This is particularly convenient in  start-up	files  as
           these do not provide their own local variable scope.
    
           For example,
    
    	      variable=outside
    	      function {
    		local variable=inside
    		print "I am $variable with arguments $*"
    	      } this and that
    	      print "I am $variable"
    
           outputs the following:
    
    	      I am inside with arguments this and that
    	      I am outside
    
           Note  that function definitions with arguments that expand to nothing, for example `name=;
           function $name { ... }', are not  treated  as  anonymous  functions.   Instead,	they  are
           treated as normal function definitions where the definition is silently discarded.
    
    SPECIAL FUNCTIONS
           Certain functions, if defined, have special meaning to the shell.
    
       Hook Functions
           For  the  functions below, it is possible to define an array that has the same name as the
           function with `_functions' appended.  Any element in such an array is taken as the name of
           a  function  to execute; it is executed in the same context and with the same arguments as
           the basic function.  For example, if $chpwd_functions is an array  containing  the  values
           `mychpwd',  `chpwd_save_dirstack',  then  the  shell  attempts  to  execute  the functions
           `chpwd', `mychpwd' and `chpwd_save_dirstack', in that order.  Any function that	does  not
           exist is silently ignored.  A function found by this mechanism is referred to elsewhere as
           a `hook function'.  An error in any function causes subsequent functions not  to  be  run.
           Note further that an error in a precmd hook causes an immediately following periodic func‐
           tion not to run (though it may run at the next opportunity).
    
           chpwd  Executed whenever the current working directory is changed.
    
           periodic
    	      If the parameter PERIOD is set, this function is executed  every	$PERIOD  seconds,
    	      just  before a prompt.  Note that if multiple functions are defined using the array
    	      periodic_functions only one period is applied to the complete set of functions, and
    	      the scheduled time is not reset if the list of functions is altered.  Hence the set
    	      of functions is always called together.
    
           precmd Executed before each prompt.  Note that precommand functions  are  not  re-executed
    	      simply because the command line is redrawn, as happens, for example, when a notifi‐
    	      cation about an exiting job is displayed.
    
           preexec
    	      Executed just after a command has been read and is about to be  executed.   If  the
    	      history  mechanism is active (regardless of whether the line was discarded from the
    	      history buffer), the string that the user typed is passed as  the  first	argument,
    	      otherwise it is an empty string.	The actual command that will be executed (includ‐
    	      ing expanded aliases) is passed in two different forms: the second  argument  is	a
    	      single-line,  size-limited version of the command (with things like function bodies
    	      elided); the third argument contains the full text that is being executed.
    
           zshaddhistory
    	      Executed when a history line has been read interactively, but  before  it  is  exe‐
    	      cuted.   The  sole  argument  is the complete history line (so that any terminating
    	      newline will still be present).
    
    	      If any of the hook functions returns status 1 (or any non-zero value other than  2,
    	      though  this  is	not guaranteed for future versions of the shell) the history line
    	      will not be saved, although it lingers in the history until the next line  is  exe‐
    	      cuted, allowing you to reuse or edit it immediately.
    
    	      If any of the hook functions returns status 2 the history line will be saved on the
    	      internal history list, but not written to the history file.  In case of a conflict,
    	      the first non-zero status value is taken.
    
    	      A hook function may call `fc -p ...' to switch the history context so that the his‐
    	      tory is saved in a different file from the that in the global  HISTFILE  parameter.
    	      This  is handled specially: the history context is automatically restored after the
    	      processing of the history line is finished.
    
    	      The following example function works with one of the options INC_APPEND_HISTORY  or
    	      SHARE_HISTORY set, in order that the line is written out immediately after the his‐
    	      tory entry is added.  It first adds the history line to the normal history with the
    	      newline  stripped,  which  is  usually the correct behaviour.  Then it switches the
    	      history context so that the line will be written to a history file in  the  current
    	      directory.
    
    		     zshaddhistory() {
    		       print -sr -- ${1%%$'\n'}
    		       fc -p .zsh_local_history
    		     }
    
           zshexit
    	      Executed	at the point where the main shell is about to exit normally.  This is not
    	      called by exiting subshells, nor when the exec precommand modifier is  used  before
    	      an external command.  Also, unlike TRAPEXIT, it is not called when functions exit.
    
       Trap Functions
           The functions below are treated specially but do not have corresponding hook arrays.
    
           TRAPNAL
    	      If  defined and non-null, this function will be executed whenever the shell catches
    	      a signal SIGNAL, where NAL is a signal name as specified for the kill builtin.  The
    	      signal number will be passed as the first parameter to the function.
    
    	      If  a function of this form is defined and null, the shell and processes spawned by
    	      it will ignore SIGNAL.
    
    	      The return status from the function is handled specially.  If it is zero, the  sig‐
    	      nal  is assumed to have been handled, and execution continues normally.  Otherwise,
    	      the shell will behave as interrupted except that the return status of the  trap  is
    	      retained.
    
    	      Programs	terminated  by	uncaught signals typically return the status 128 plus the
    	      signal number.  Hence the following causes the handler for SIGINT to print  a  mes‐
    	      sage, then mimic the usual effect of the signal.
    
    		     TRAPINT() {
    		       print "Caught SIGINT, aborting."
    		       return $(( 128 + $1 ))
    		     }
    
    	      The  functions  TRAPZERR,  TRAPDEBUG  and  TRAPEXIT are never executed inside other
    	      traps.
    
           TRAPDEBUG
    	      If the option DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set (as it is by default), executed  before  each
    	      command;	otherwise  executed  after each command.  See the description of the trap
    	      builtin in zshbuiltins(1) for details of	additional  features  provided	in  debug
    	      traps.
    
           TRAPEXIT
    	      Executed when the shell exits, or when the current function exits if defined inside
    	      a function.  The value of $? at the start of execution is the exit  status  of  the
    	      shell or the return status of the function exiting.
    
           TRAPZERR
    	      Executed	whenever  a command has a non-zero exit status.  However, the function is
    	      not executed if the command occurred in a sublist followed by `&&'  or  `||';  only
    	      the  final  command  in a sublist of this type causes the trap to be executed.  The
    	      function TRAPERR acts the same as TRAPZERR on systems  where  there  is  no  SIGERR
    	      (this is the usual case).
    
           The  functions  beginning `TRAP' may alternatively be defined with the trap builtin:  this
           may be preferable for some uses.  Setting a trap with one form removes  any  trap  of  the
           other  form  for the same signal; removing a trap in either form removes all traps for the
           same signal.  The forms
    
    	      TRAPNAL() {
    	       # code
    	      }
    
           ('function traps') and
    
    	      trap '
    	       # code
    	      ' NAL
    
           ('list traps') are equivalent in most ways, the exceptions being the following:
    
           ·      Function traps have all the properties of normal functions, appearing in	the  list
    	      of  functions and being called with their own function context rather than the con‐
    	      text where the trap was triggered.
    
           ·      The return status from function traps is special, whereas a return from a list trap
    	      causes the surrounding context to return with the given status.
    
           ·      Function	traps  are  not reset within subshells, in accordance with zsh behaviour;
    	      list traps are reset, in accordance with POSIX behaviour.
    
    JOBS
           If the MONITOR option is set, an interactive shell associates a job  with  each	pipeline.
           It  keeps  a  table  of	current jobs, printed by the jobs command, and assigns them small
           integer numbers.  When a job is started asynchronously with `&', the shell prints  a  line
           to standard error which looks like:
    
    	      [1] 1234
    
           indicating  that  the  job  which  was started asynchronously was job number 1 and had one
           (top-level) process, whose process ID was 1234.
    
           If a job is started with `&|' or `&!', then  that  job  is  immediately	disowned.   After
           startup,  it does not have a place in the job table, and is not subject to the job control
           features described here.
    
           If you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit the key ^Z  (control-Z)
           which  sends  a	TSTP  signal  to  the current job:  this key may be redefined by the susp
           option of the external stty command.  The shell will then normally indicate that  the  job
           has been `suspended', and print another prompt.	You can then manipulate the state of this
           job, putting it in the background with the bg command, or run some other commands and then
           eventually  bring  the  job back into the foreground with the foreground command fg.  A ^Z
           takes effect immediately and is like an interrupt in that pending output and unread  input
           are discarded when it is typed.
    
           A job being run in the background will suspend if it tries to read from the terminal.
    
           Note  that  if  the  job running in the foreground is a shell function, then suspending it
           will have the effect of causing the shell to fork.  This  is  necessary	to  separate  the
           function's  state  from	that  of the parent shell performing the job control, so that the
           latter can return to the command line prompt.  As a result, even if fg is used to continue
           the  job the function will no longer be part of the parent shell, and any variables set by
           the function will not be visible in the parent shell.  Thus  the  behaviour  is	different
           from  the  case	where the function was never suspended.  Zsh is different from many other
           shells in this regard.
    
           The same behaviour is found when the shell is executing code as the right hand side  of	a
           pipeline  or  any  complex shell construct such as if, for, etc., in order that the entire
           block of code can be managed as a single job.  Background jobs  are  normally  allowed  to
           produce	output, but this can be disabled by giving the command `stty tostop'.  If you set
           this tty option, then background jobs will suspend when they try to  produce  output  like
           they do when they try to read input.
    
           When a command is suspended and continued later with the fg or wait builtins, zsh restores
           tty modes that were in effect when it was suspended.  This (intentionally) does not  apply
           if the command is continued via `kill -CONT', nor when it is continued with bg.
    
           There  are  several  ways  to refer to jobs in the shell.  A job can be referred to by the
           process ID of any process of the job or by one of the following:
    
           %number
    	      The job with the given number.
           %string
    	      Any job whose command line begins with string.
           %?string
    	      Any job whose command line contains string.
           %%     Current job.
           %+     Equivalent to `%%'.
           %-     Previous job.
    
           The shell learns immediately whenever a process changes state.  It  normally  informs  you
           whenever  a  job  becomes  blocked so that no further progress is possible.  If the NOTIFY
           option is not set, it waits until just before it prints a prompt before	it  informs  you.
           All  such  notifications  are sent directly to the terminal, not to the standard output or
           standard error.
    
           When the monitor mode is on, each background job that completes triggers any trap set  for
           CHLD.
    
           When  you  try  to leave the shell while jobs are running or suspended, you will be warned
           that `You have suspended (running) jobs'.  You may use the jobs command to see  what  they
           are.   If you do this or immediately try to exit again, the shell will not warn you a sec‐
           ond time; the suspended jobs will be terminated, and the  running  jobs	will  be  sent	a
           SIGHUP signal, if the HUP option is set.
    
           To  avoid  having  the shell terminate the running jobs, either use the nohup command (see
           nohup(1)) or the disown builtin.
    
    SIGNALS
           The INT and QUIT signals for an invoked command are ignored if the command is followed  by
           `&'  and  the MONITOR option is not active.  The shell itself always ignores the QUIT sig‐
           nal.  Otherwise, signals have the values inherited by the shell from its parent	(but  see
           the TRAPNAL special functions in the section `Functions').
    
           Certain	jobs are run asynchronously by the shell other than those explicitly put into the
           background; even in cases where the shell would usually wait for such  jobs,  an  explicit
           exit command or exit due to the option ERR_EXIT will cause the shell to exit without wait‐
           ing.  Examples of such asynchronous jobs are process substitution, see the section PROCESS
           SUBSTITUTION in the zshexpn(1) manual page, and the handler processes for multios, see the
           section MULTIOS in the zshmisc(1) manual page.
    
    ARITHMETIC EVALUATION
           The shell can perform integer and floating point arithmetic, either using the builtin let,
           or  via	a substitution of the form $((...)).  For integers, the shell is usually compiled
           to use 8-byte precision where this is available, otherwise precision is 4 bytes.  This can
           be  tested, for example, by giving the command `print - $(( 12345678901 ))'; if the number
           appears unchanged, the precision is at least 8 bytes.  Floating	point  arithmetic  always
           uses  the  `double' type with whatever corresponding precision is provided by the compiler
           and the library.
    
           The let builtin command takes arithmetic expressions as arguments; each is evaluated sepa‐
           rately.	 Since	many  of the arithmetic operators, as well as spaces, require quoting, an
           alternative form is provided: for any command which begins with a `((', all the characters
           until  a  matching  `))'  are treated as a quoted expression and arithmetic expansion per‐
           formed as for an argument of let.  More precisely, `((...))' is equivalent to `let "..."'.
           The  return  status is 0 if the arithmetic value of the expression is non-zero, 1 if it is
           zero, and 2 if an error occurred.
    
           For example, the following statement
    
    	      (( val = 2 + 1 ))
    
           is equivalent to
    
    	      let "val = 2 + 1"
    
           both assigning the value 3 to the shell variable val and returning a zero status.
    
           Integers can be in bases other than 10.	A leading `0x' or `0X' denotes hexadecimal and	a
           leading	`0b'  or `0B' binary.  Integers may also be of the form `base#n', where base is a
           decimal number between two and thirty-six representing the arithmetic base and n is a num‐
           ber  in	that  base  (for  example, `16#ff' is 255 in hexadecimal).  The base# may also be
           omitted, in which case base 10 is used.	For backwards compatibility the form `[base]n' is
           also accepted.
    
           An  integer  expression or a base given in the form `base#n' may contain underscores (`_')
           after the leading digit for visual guidance; these are ignored in  computation.	 Examples
           are 1_000_000 or 0xffff_ffff which are equivalent to 1000000 and 0xffffffff respectively.
    
           It  is  also  possible  to specify a base to be used for output in the form `[#base]', for
           example `[#16]'.  This is used when outputting arithmetical substitutions or when  assign‐
           ing  to	scalar	parameters, but an explicitly defined integer or floating point parameter
           will not be affected.  If an integer variable  is  implicitly  defined  by  an  arithmetic
           expression, any base specified in this way will be set as the variable's output arithmetic
           base as if the option `-i base' to the typeset builtin had been used.  The expression  has
           no  precedence  and  if	it  occurs  more than once in a mathematical expression, the last
           encountered is used.  For clarity it is recommended that it appear at the beginning of  an
           expression.  As an example:
    
    	      typeset -i 16 y
    	      print $(( [#8] x = 32, y = 32 ))
    	      print $x $y
    
           outputs first `8#40', the rightmost value in the given output base, and then `8#40 16#20',
           because y has been explicitly declared to have output base 16, while x (assuming  it  does
           not already exist) is implicitly typed by the arithmetic evaluation, where it acquires the
           output base 8.
    
           The base may be replaced or followed by an underscore, which may itself be followed  by	a
           positive  integer (if it is missing the value 3 is used).  This indicates that underscores
           should be inserted into the output string, grouping the number for  visual  clarity.   The
           following integer specifies the number of digits to group together.  For example:
    
    	      setopt cbases
    	      print $(( [#16_4] 65536 ** 2 ))
    
           outputs `0x1_0000_0000'.
    
           The  feature can be used with floating point numbers, in which case the base must be omit‐
           ted; grouping is away from the decimal point.  For example,
    
    	      zmodload zsh/mathfunc
    	      print $(( [#_] sqrt(1e7) ))
    
           outputs `3_162.277_660_168_379_5' (the number of decimal places shown may vary).
    
           If the C_BASES option is set, hexadecimal numbers are output in the standard C format, for
           example	`0xFF'	instead of the usual `16#FF'.  If the option OCTAL_ZEROES is also set (it
           is not by default), octal numbers will be treated similarly  and  hence	appear	as  `077'
           instead	of `8#77'.  This option has no effect on the output of bases other than hexadeci‐
           mal and octal, and these formats are always understood on input.
    
           When an output base is specified using the `[#base]' syntax, an	appropriate  base  prefix
           will be output if necessary, so that the value output is valid syntax for input.  If the #
           is doubled, for example `[##16]', then no base prefix is output.
    
           Floating point constants are recognized by the presence of a decimal point or an exponent.
           The decimal point may be the first character of the constant, but the exponent character e
           or E may not, as it will be taken for a parameter name.	All  numeric  parts  (before  and
           after  the  decimal  point  and in the exponent) may contain underscores after the leading
           digit for visual guidance; these are ignored in computation.
    
           An arithmetic expression uses nearly the same syntax and associativity of  expressions  as
           in C.
    
           In the native mode of operation, the following operators are supported (listed in decreas‐
           ing order of precedence):
    
           + - ! ~ ++ --
    	      unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}crement
           << >>  bitwise shift left, right
           &      bitwise AND
           ^      bitwise XOR
           |      bitwise OR
           **     exponentiation
           * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
           + -    addition, subtraction
           < > <= >=
    	      comparison
           == !=  equality and inequality
           &&     logical AND
           || ^^  logical OR, XOR
           ? :    ternary operator
           = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
    	      assignment
           ,      comma operator
    
           The operators `&&', `||', `&&=', and `||=' are short-circuiting, and only one of the  lat‐
           ter  two  expressions in a ternary operator is evaluated.  Note the precedence of the bit‐
           wise AND, OR, and XOR operators.
    
           With the option C_PRECEDENCES the precedences (but no other properties) of  the	operators
           are  altered  to  be  the  same as those in most other languages that support the relevant
           operators:
    
           + - ! ~ ++ --
    	      unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}crement
           **     exponentiation
           * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
           + -    addition, subtraction
           << >>  bitwise shift left, right
           < > <= >=
    	      comparison
           == !=  equality and inequality
           &      bitwise AND
           ^      bitwise XOR
           |      bitwise OR
           &&     logical AND
           ^^     logical XOR
           ||     logical OR
           ? :    ternary operator
           = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
    	      assignment
           ,      comma operator
    
           Note the precedence of exponentiation in both cases is  below  that  of	unary  operators,
           hence  `-3**2'  evaluates  as  `9', not `-9'.  Use parentheses where necessary: `-(3**2)'.
           This is for compatibility with other shells.
    
           Mathematical functions can be called with the  syntax  `func(args)',  where  the  function
           decides	if  the  args is used as a string or a comma-separated list of arithmetic expres‐
           sions. The shell currently defines no mathematical functions by default,  but  the  module
           zsh/mathfunc  may  be  loaded with the zmodload builtin to provide standard floating point
           mathematical functions.
    
           An expression of the form `##x' where x is any character sequence such as  `a',	`^A',  or
           `\M-\C-x'  gives  the  value of this character and an expression of the form `#name' gives
           the value of the first character of the contents of the parameter name.	Character  values
           are  according  to  the	character set used in the current locale; for multibyte character
           handling the option MULTIBYTE must  be  set.   Note  that  this	form  is  different  from
           `$#name',  a standard parameter substitution which gives the length of the parameter name.
           `#\' is accepted instead of `##', but its use is deprecated.
    
           Named parameters and subscripted arrays can be referenced by  name  within  an  arithmetic
           expression without using the parameter expansion syntax.  For example,
    
    	      ((val2 = val1 * 2))
    
           assigns twice the value of $val1 to the parameter named val2.
    
           An  internal integer representation of a named parameter can be specified with the integer
           builtin.  Arithmetic evaluation is performed on the value of each assignment  to  a  named
           parameter  declared integer in this manner.  Assigning a floating point number to an inte‐
           ger results in rounding down to the next integer.
    
           Likewise, floating point numbers can be declared with the float	builtin;  there  are  two
           types,  differing  only in their output format, as described for the typeset builtin.  The
           output format can be bypassed by using arithmetic substitution instead  of  the	parameter
           substitution,  i.e.  `${float}'	uses  the defined format, but `$((float))' uses a generic
           floating point format.
    
           Promotion of integer to floating point values is performed where necessary.  In	addition,
           if  any	operator which requires an integer (`~', `&', `|', `^', `%', `<<', `>>' and their
           equivalents with assignment) is given a floating  point	argument,  it  will  be  silently
           rounded down to the next integer.
    
           Users should beware that, in common with many other programming languages but not software
           designed for calculation, the evaluation of an expression in zsh is taken a term at a time
           and  promotion of integers to floating point does not occur in terms only containing inte‐
           gers.  A typical result of this is that a division such as 6/8 is truncated, in this being
           rounded down to 0.  The FORCE_FLOAT shell option can be used in scripts or functions where
           floating point evaluation is required throughout.
    
           Scalar variables can hold integer or floating point values at different times; there is no
           memory of the numeric type in this case.
    
           If a variable is first assigned in a numeric context without previously being declared, it
           will be implicitly typed as integer or float and retain that type either until the type is
           explicitly  changed or until the end of the scope.  This can have unforeseen consequences.
           For example, in the loop
    
    	      for (( f = 0; f < 1; f += 0.1 )); do
    	      # use $f
    	      done
    
           if f has not already been declared, the first assignment will cause it to be created as an
           integer,  and  consequently  the  operation  `f += 0.1' will always cause the result to be
           truncated to zero, so that the loop will fail.  A simple fix would be to turn the initial‐
           ization	into  `f = 0.0'.  It is therefore best to declare numeric variables with explicit
           types.
    
    CONDITIONAL EXPRESSIONS
           A conditional expression is used with the [[ compound command to test attributes of  files
           and  to	compare strings.  Each expression can be constructed from one or more of the fol‐
           lowing unary or binary expressions:
    
           -a file
    	      true if file exists.
    
           -b file
    	      true if file exists and is a block special file.
    
           -c file
    	      true if file exists and is a character special file.
    
           -d file
    	      true if file exists and is a directory.
    
           -e file
    	      true if file exists.
    
           -f file
    	      true if file exists and is a regular file.
    
           -g file
    	      true if file exists and has its setgid bit set.
    
           -h file
    	      true if file exists and is a symbolic link.
    
           -k file
    	      true if file exists and has its sticky bit set.
    
           -n string
    	      true if length of string is non-zero.
    
           -o option
    	      true if option named option is on.  option may be a single character, in which case
    	      it is a single letter option name.  (See the section `Specifying Options'.)
    
           -p file
    	      true if file exists and is a FIFO special file (named pipe).
    
           -r file
    	      true if file exists and is readable by current process.
    
           -s file
    	      true if file exists and has size greater than zero.
    
           -t fd  true  if	file  descriptor number fd is open and associated with a terminal device.
    	      (note: fd is not optional)
    
           -u file
    	      true if file exists and has its setuid bit set.
    
           -w file
    	      true if file exists and is writable by current process.
    
           -x file
    	      true if file exists and is executable by current process.  If file exists and is	a
    	      directory, then the current process has permission to search in the directory.
    
           -z string
    	      true if length of string is zero.
    
           -L file
    	      true if file exists and is a symbolic link.
    
           -O file
    	      true if file exists and is owned by the effective user ID of this process.
    
           -G file
    	      true if file exists and its group matches the effective group ID of this process.
    
           -S file
    	      true if file exists and is a socket.
    
           -N file
    	      true if file exists and its access time is not newer than its modification time.
    
           file1 -nt file2
    	      true if file1 exists and is newer than file2.
    
           file1 -ot file2
    	      true if file1 exists and is older than file2.
    
           file1 -ef file2
    	      true if file1 and file2 exist and refer to the same file.
    
           string = pattern
           string == pattern
    	      true  if string matches pattern.	The `==' form is the preferred one.  The `=' form
    	      is for backward compatibility and should be considered obsolete.
    
           string != pattern
    	      true if string does not match pattern.
    
           string =~ regexp
    	      true if string matches the regular expression regexp.  If the option  RE_MATCH_PCRE
    	      is  set  regexp  is  tested as a PCRE regular expression using the zsh/pcre module,
    	      else it is tested as a POSIX extended regular expression using the  zsh/regex  mod‐
    	      ule.   Upon  successful  match,  some  variables	will be updated; no variables are
    	      changed if the matching fails.
    
    	      If the option BASH_REMATCH is not set the scalar parameter MATCH is set to the sub‐
    	      string  that  matched the pattern and the integer parameters MBEGIN and MEND to the
    	      index of the start and end, respectively, of the match  in  string,  such  that  if
    	      string is contained in variable var the expression `${var[$MBEGIN,$MEND]}' is iden‐
    	      tical to `$MATCH'.  The setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS is  respected.	Likewise,
    	      the  array match is set to the substrings that matched parenthesised subexpressions
    	      and the arrays mbegin and mend to the indices  of  the  start  and  end  positions,
    	      respectively,  of  the  substrings  within string.  The arrays are not set if there
    	      were no parenthesised subexpresssions.  For example, if the string `a short string'
    	      is  matched  against  the  regular  expression `s(...)t', then (assuming the option
    	      KSH_ARRAYS is not set) MATCH, MBEGIN and MEND are `short', 3 and	7,  respectively,
    	      while  match, mbegin and mend are single entry arrays containing the strings `hor',
    	      `4' and `6', respectively.
    
    	      If the option BASH_REMATCH is set the array BASH_REMATCH is set  to  the	substring
    	      that matched the pattern followed by the substrings that matched parenthesised sub‐
    	      expressions within the pattern.
    
           string1 < string2
    	      true if string1 comes before string2 based on ASCII value of their characters.
    
           string1 > string2
    	      true if string1 comes after string2 based on ASCII value of their characters.
    
           exp1 -eq exp2
    	      true if exp1 is numerically equal to exp2.  Note that for  purely  numeric  compar‐
    	      isons  use  of the ((...)) builtin described in the section `ARITHMETIC EVALUATION'
    	      is more convenient than conditional expressions.
    
           exp1 -ne exp2
    	      true if exp1 is numerically not equal to exp2.
    
           exp1 -lt exp2
    	      true if exp1 is numerically less than exp2.
    
           exp1 -gt exp2
    	      true if exp1 is numerically greater than exp2.
    
           exp1 -le exp2
    	      true if exp1 is numerically less than or equal to exp2.
    
           exp1 -ge exp2
    	      true if exp1 is numerically greater than or equal to exp2.
    
           ( exp )
    	      true if exp is true.
    
           ! exp  true if exp is false.
    
           exp1 && exp2
    	      true if exp1 and exp2 are both true.
    
           exp1 || exp2
    	      true if either exp1 or exp2 is true.
    
           For compatibility, if there is a single argument that is  not  syntactically  significant,
           typically  a  variable,	the  condition	is  treated  as a test for whether the expression
           expands as a string of non-zero length.	In other words, [[ $var ]] is the same as  [[  -n
           $var ]].  It is recommended that the second, explicit, form be used where possible.
    
           Normal  shell  expansion  is  performed on the file, string and pattern arguments, but the
           result of each expansion is constrained to be a single word, similar to the effect of dou‐
           ble quotes.
    
           Filename  generation  is not performed on any form of argument to conditions.  However, it
           can be forced in any case where normal shell  expansion	is  valid  and	when  the  option
           EXTENDED_GLOB is in effect by using an explicit glob qualifier of the form (#q) at the end
           of the string.  A normal glob qualifier expression may appear  between  the  `q'  and  the
           closing	parenthesis; if none appears the expression has no effect beyond causing filename
           generation.  The results of filename generation are joined together to form a single word,
           as with the results of other forms of expansion.
    
           This special use of filename generation is only available with the [[ syntax.  If the con‐
           dition occurs within the [ or test builtin commands then globbing occurs instead  as  part
           of  normal  command line expansion before the condition is evaluated.  In this case it may
           generate multiple words which are likely to confuse the syntax of the test command.
    
           For example,
    
    	      [[ -n file*(#qN) ]]
    
           produces status zero if and only if there is at least one file in  the  current	directory
           beginning with the string `file'.  The globbing qualifier N ensures that the expression is
           empty if there is no matching file.
    
           Pattern metacharacters are active for the pattern arguments; the patterns are the same  as
           those  used  for filename generation, see zshexpn(1), but there is no special behaviour of
           `/' nor initial dots, and no glob qualifiers are allowed.
    
           In each of the above expressions, if file is of the form `/dev/fd/n', where n is an  inte‐
           ger,  then  the	test  applied  to the open file whose descriptor number is n, even if the
           underlying system does not support the /dev/fd directory.
    
           In the forms which do numeric comparison, the expressions exp undergo arithmetic expansion
           as if they were enclosed in $((...)).
    
           For example, the following:
    
    	      [[ ( -f foo || -f bar ) && $report = y* ]] && print File exists.
    
           tests  if  either  file	foo  or file bar exists, and if so, if the value of the parameter
           report begins with `y'; if the complete condition is true, the message `File  exists.'  is
           printed.
    
    EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES
           Prompt  sequences  undergo  a  special  form of expansion.  This type of expansion is also
           available using the -P option to the print builtin.
    
           If the PROMPT_SUBST option is set, the prompt  string  is  first  subjected  to	parameter
           expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion.  See zshexpn(1).
    
           Certain escape sequences may be recognised in the prompt string.
    
           If  the	PROMPT_BANG option is set, a `!' in the prompt is replaced by the current history
           event number.  A literal `!' may then be represented as `!!'.
    
           If the PROMPT_PERCENT option is set, certain escape sequences  that  start  with  `%'  are
           expanded.  Many escapes are followed by a single character, although some of these take an
           optional integer argument that should appear between the `%' and the next character of the
           sequence.   More  complicated escape sequences are available to provide conditional expan‐
           sion.
    
    SIMPLE PROMPT ESCAPES
       Special characters
           %%     A `%'.
    
           %)     A `)'.
    
       Login information
           %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on,	without  `/dev/'  prefix.   If	the  name
    	      starts with `/dev/tty', that prefix is stripped.
    
           %M     The full machine hostname.
    
           %m     The  hostname  up  to  the first `.'.  An integer may follow the `%' to specify how
    	      many components of the hostname are desired.  With  a  negative  integer,  trailing
    	      components of the hostname are shown.
    
           %n     $USERNAME.
    
           %y     The  line  (tty)	the  user is logged in on, without `/dev/' prefix.  This does not
    	      treat `/dev/tty' names specially.
    
       Shell state
           %#     A `#' if the shell is running  with  privileges,	a  `%'	if  not.   Equivalent  to
    	      `%(!.#.%%)'.   The  definition  of `privileged', for these purposes, is that either
    	      the effective user ID is zero, or, if POSIX.1e capabilities are supported, that  at
    	      least  one  capability  is raised in either the Effective or Inheritable capability
    	      vectors.
    
           %?     The return status of the last command executed just before the prompt.
    
           %_     The status of the parser, i.e. the shell constructs (like `if' and `for') that have
    	      been started on the command line. If given an integer number that many strings will
    	      be printed; zero or negative or no integer means print as many as there are.   This
    	      is most useful in prompts PS2 for continuation lines and PS4 for debugging with the
    	      XTRACE option; in the latter case it will also work non-interactively.
    
           %^     The status of the parser in reverse. This is the same as `%_' other than the  order
    	      of strings.  It is often used in RPS2.
    
           %d
           %/     Current working directory.  If an integer follows the `%', it specifies a number of
    	      trailing components of the current working directory to show; zero means the  whole
    	      path.   A  negative  integer  specifies leading components, i.e. %-1d specifies the
    	      first component.
    
           %~     As %d and %/, but if the current working directory starts with $HOME, that part  is
    	      replaced	by  a  `~'.  Furthermore, if it has a named directory as its prefix, that
    	      part is replaced by a `~' followed by the name of the directory, but  only  if  the
    	      result  is  shorter than the full path; see Dynamic and Static named directories in
    	      zshexpn(1).
    
           %e     Evaluation depth of the current sourced file, shell function,  or  eval.	 This  is
    	      incremented  or decremented every time the value of %N is set or reverted to a pre‐
    	      vious value, respectively.  This is most useful for debugging as part of $PS4.
    
           %h
           %!     Current history event number.
    
           %i     The line number currently being executed in the  script,	sourced  file,	or  shell
    	      function given by %N.  This is most useful for debugging as part of $PS4.
    
           %I     The  line  number  currently being executed in the file %x.  This is similar to %i,
    	      but the line number is always a line number in the file where the code was defined,
    	      even if the code is a shell function.
    
           %j     The number of jobs.
    
           %L     The current value of $SHLVL.
    
           %N     The  name of the script, sourced file, or shell function that zsh is currently exe‐
    	      cuting, whichever was started most recently.  If there is none, this is  equivalent
    	      to the parameter $0.  An integer may follow the `%' to specify a number of trailing
    	      path components to show; zero means the full path.  A  negative  integer	specifies
    	      leading components.
    
           %x     The  name  of  the  file containing the source code currently being executed.  This
    	      behaves as %N except that function and eval command names are  not  shown,  instead
    	      the file where they were defined.
    
           %c
           %.
           %C     Trailing component of the current working directory.  An integer may follow the `%'
    	      to get more than one component.  Unless `%C' is used,  tilde  contraction  is  per‐
    	      formed  first.   These  are  deprecated as %c and %C are equivalent to %1~ and %1/,
    	      respectively, while explicit positive integers have the same effect as for the lat‐
    	      ter two sequences.
    
       Date and time
           %D     The date in yy-mm-dd format.
    
           %T     Current time of day, in 24-hour format.
    
           %t
           %@     Current time of day, in 12-hour, am/pm format.
    
           %*     Current time of day in 24-hour format, with seconds.
    
           %w     The date in day-dd format.
    
           %W     The date in mm/dd/yy format.
    
           %D{string}
    	      string is formatted using the strftime function.	See strftime(3) for more details.
    	      Various zsh extensions provide numbers with no leading zero or space if the  number
    	      is a single digit:
    
    	      %f     a day of the month
    	      %K     the hour of the day on the 24-hour clock
    	      %L     the hour of the day on the 12-hour clock
    
    	      In addition, if the system supports the POSIX gettimeofday system call, %. provides
    	      decimal fractions of a second since the epoch  with  leading  zeroes.   By  default
    	      three decimal places are provided, but a number of digits up to 6 may be given fol‐
    	      lowing the %; hence %6.  outputs microseconds.  A typical example of  this  is  the
    	      format `%D{%H:%M:%S.%.}'.
    
    	      The  GNU extension that a `-' between the % and the format character causes a lead‐
    	      ing zero or space to be stripped is handled directly by the shell  for  the  format
    	      characters  d,  f, H, k, l, m, M, S and y; any other format characters are provided
    	      to the system's strftime(3) with any leading `-' present, so the handling is system
    	      dependent.   Further  GNU  (or other) extensions are also passed to strftime(3) and
    	      may work if the system supports them.
    
       Visual effects
           %B (%b)
    	      Start (stop) boldface mode.
    
           %E     Clear to end of line.
    
           %U (%u)
    	      Start (stop) underline mode.
    
           %S (%s)
    	      Start (stop) standout mode.
    
           %F (%f)
    	      Start (stop) using a different foreground colour, if  supported  by  the	terminal.
    	      The  colour  may be specified two ways: either as a numeric argument, as normal, or
    	      by a sequence in braces following the %F, for example %F{red}.  In the latter  case
    	      the values allowed are as described for the fg zle_highlight attribute; see Charac‐
    	      ter Highlighting in zshzle(1).  This means that numeric colours are allowed in  the
    	      second format also.
    
           %K (%k)
    	      Start  (stop) using a different bacKground colour.  The syntax is identical to that
    	      for %F and %f.
    
           %{...%}
    	      Include a string as a literal escape sequence.  The string within the braces should
    	      not change the cursor position.  Brace pairs can nest.
    
    	      A  positive numeric argument between the % and the { is treated as described for %G
    	      below.
    
           %G     Within a %{...%} sequence, include a `glitch': that is, assume that a single  char‐
    	      acter  width will be output.  This is useful when outputting characters that other‐
    	      wise cannot be correctly handled by the shell, such as the alternate character  set
    	      on  some	terminals.   The  characters in question can be included within a %{...%}
    	      sequence together with the appropriate number of %G sequences to indicate the  cor‐
    	      rect  width.   An integer between the `%' and `G' indicates a character width other
    	      than one.  Hence %{seq%2G%} outputs seq and assumes it takes up the  width  of  two
    	      standard characters.
    
    	      Multiple	uses  of  %G accumulate in the obvious fashion; the position of the %G is
    	      unimportant.  Negative integers are not handled.
    
    	      Note that when prompt truncation is in use it is advisable to divide up output into
    	      single  characters  within  each %{...%} group so that the correct truncation point
    	      can be found.
    
    CONDITIONAL SUBSTRINGS IN PROMPTS
           %v     The value of the first element of the psvar array  parameter.   Following  the  `%'
    	      with  an integer gives that element of the array.  Negative integers count from the
    	      end of the array.
    
           %(x.true-text.false-text)
    	      Specifies a ternary expression.  The character following the x  is  arbitrary;  the
    	      same character is used to separate the text for the `true' result from that for the
    	      `false' result.  This separator may not appear in the true-text, except as part  of
    	      a  %-escape  sequence.   A `)' may appear in the false-text as `%)'.  true-text and
    	      false-text may both contain arbitrarily-nested escape sequences, including  further
    	      ternary expressions.
    
    	      The  left  parenthesis  may  be preceded or followed by a positive integer n, which
    	      defaults to zero.  A negative integer will be multiplied by  -1,	except	as  noted
    	      below for `l'.  The test character x may be any of the following:
    
    	      !      True if the shell is running with privileges.
    	      #      True if the effective uid of the current process is n.
    	      ?      True if the exit status of the last command was n.
    	      _      True if at least n shell constructs were started.
    	      C
    	      /      True  if  the  current absolute path has at least n elements relative to the
    		     root directory, hence / is counted as 0 elements.
    	      c
    	      .
    	      ~      True if the current path, with prefix replacement, has at least  n  elements
    		     relative to the root directory, hence / is counted as 0 elements.
    	      D      True if the month is equal to n (January = 0).
    	      d      True if the day of the month is equal to n.
    	      e      True if the evaluation depth is at least n.
    	      g      True if the effective gid of the current process is n.
    	      j      True if the number of jobs is at least n.
    	      L      True if the SHLVL parameter is at least n.
    	      l      True if at least n characters have already been printed on the current line.
    		     When n is negative, true if at least abs(n)  characters  remain  before  the
    		     opposite margin (thus the left margin for RPROMPT).
    	      S      True if the SECONDS parameter is at least n.
    	      T      True if the time in hours is equal to n.
    	      t      True if the time in minutes is equal to n.
    	      v      True if the array psvar has at least n elements.
    	      V      True if element n of the array psvar is set and non-empty.
    	      w      True if the day of the week is equal to n (Sunday = 0).
    
           %<string<
           %>string>
           %[xstring]
    	      Specifies  truncation behaviour for the remainder of the prompt string.  The third,
    	      deprecated, form is equivalent to `%xstringx', i.e. x  may  be  `<'  or  `>'.   The
    	      string will be displayed in place of the truncated portion of any string; note this
    	      does not undergo prompt expansion.
    
    	      The numeric argument, which in the third form may appear immediately after the `[',
    	      specifies the maximum permitted length of the various strings that can be displayed
    	      in the prompt.  In the first two forms, this numeric argument may be  negative,  in
    	      which case the truncation length is determined by subtracting the absolute value of
    	      the numeric argument from the number of character positions remaining on	the  cur‐
    	      rent  prompt  line.  If this results in a zero or negative length, a length of 1 is
    	      used.  In other words, a negative argument arranges that after truncation at  least
    	      n characters remain before the right margin (left margin for RPROMPT).
    
    	      The forms with `<' truncate at the left of the string, and the forms with `>' trun‐
    	      cate at the right of  the  string.   For	example,  if  the  current  directory  is
    	      `/home/pike', the prompt `%8<..<%/' will expand to `..e/pike'.  In this string, the
    	      terminating character (`<', `>' or `]'), or in fact any character, may be quoted by
    	      a  preceding  `\';  note when using print -P, however, that this must be doubled as
    	      the string is also subject to standard print processing, in addition to  any  back‐
    	      slashes  removed	by a double quoted string:  the worst case is therefore `print -P
    	      "%<\\\\<<..."'.
    
    	      If the string is longer than the specified truncation length,  it  will  appear  in
    	      full, completely replacing the truncated string.
    
    	      The  part of the prompt string to be truncated runs to the end of the string, or to
    	      the end of the next enclosing group of the `%(' construct, or to the  next  trunca‐
    	      tion  encountered  at  the  same grouping level (i.e. truncations inside a `%(' are
    	      separate), which ever comes first.  In particular, a truncation with argument  zero
    	      (e.g.,  `%<<') marks the end of the range of the string to be truncated while turn‐
    	      ing off truncation from there on. For example, the prompt `%10<...<%~%<<%#  '  will
    	      print  a	truncated  representation  of the current directory, followed by a `%' or
    	      `#', followed by a space.   Without  the	`%<<',	those  two  characters	would  be
    	      included	in  the  string  to be truncated.  Note that `%-0<<' is not equivalent to
    	      `%<<' but specifies that the prompt is truncated at the right margin.
    
    	      Truncation applies only within each individual line of the prompt, as delimited  by
    	      embedded	newlines  (if  any).  If the total length of any line of the prompt after
    	      truncation is greater than the terminal width, or if the part to be truncated  con‐
    	      tains  embedded  newlines,  truncation  behavior	is  undefined and may change in a
    	      future version of the shell.  Use `%-n(l.true-text.false-text)' to remove parts  of
    	      the prompt when the available space is less than n.
    
    ZSHEXPN(1)			     General Commands Manual			       ZSHEXPN(1)
    
    NAME
           zshexpn - zsh expansion and substitution
    
    DESCRIPTION
           The following types of expansions are performed in the indicated order in five steps:
    
           History Expansion
    	      This is performed only in interactive shells.
    
           Alias Expansion
    	      Aliases  are  expanded  immediately  before the command line is parsed as explained
    	      under Aliasing in zshmisc(1).
    
           Process Substitution
           Parameter Expansion
           Command Substitution
           Arithmetic Expansion
           Brace Expansion
    	      These five are performed in one step in left-to-right fashion.  After these  expan‐
    	      sions, all unquoted occurrences of the characters `\', `'' and `"' are removed.
    
           Filename Expansion
    	      If the SH_FILE_EXPANSION option is set, the order of expansion is modified for com‐
    	      patibility with sh and ksh.  In that case filename expansion is  performed  immedi‐
    	      ately after alias expansion, preceding the set of five expansions mentioned above.
    
           Filename Generation
    	      This expansion, commonly referred to as globbing, is always done last.
    
           The following sections explain the types of expansion in detail.
    
    HISTORY EXPANSION
           History	expansion allows you to use words from previous command lines in the command line
           you are typing.	This simplifies spelling corrections and the  repetition  of  complicated
           commands or arguments.
    
           Immediately before execution, each command is saved in the history list, the size of which
           is controlled by the HISTSIZE parameter.  The one most recent command is  always  retained
           in  any	case.	Each  saved  command in the history list is called a history event and is
           assigned a number, beginning with 1 (one) when the shell starts up.   The  history  number
           that  you  may see in your prompt (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)) is the
           number that is to be assigned to the next command.
    
       Overview
           A history expansion begins with the first character of the histchars parameter,	which  is
           `!'  by	default,  and  may  occur anywhere on the command line; history expansions do not
           nest.  The `!' can be escaped with `\' or can be enclosed between a pair of single  quotes
           ('')  to  suppress  its special meaning.  Double quotes will not work for this.	Following
           this history character is an optional event designator (see the	section  `Event  Designa‐
           tors')  and  then an optional word designator (the section `Word Designators'); if neither
           of these designators is present, no history expansion occurs.
    
           Input lines containing history expansions are echoed after being expanded, but before  any
           other  expansions take place and before the command is executed.  It is this expanded form
           that is recorded as the history event for later references.
    
           By default, a history reference with no event designator refers to the same event  as  any
           preceding history reference on that command line; if it is the only history reference in a
           command, it refers to the previous command.  However, if the option CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY  is
           set,  then every history reference with no event specification always refers to the previ‐
           ous command.
    
           For example, `!' is the event designator for the previous command, so `!!:1' always refers
           to the first word of the previous command, and `!!$' always refers to the last word of the
           previous command.  With CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY set, then `!:1' and `!$' function in	the  same
           manner  as  `!!:1'  and	`!!$', respectively.  Conversely, if CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY is unset,
           then `!:1' and `!$' refer to the first and last words, respectively,  of  the  same  event
           referenced  by  the  nearest other history reference preceding them on the current command
           line, or to the previous command if there is no preceding reference.
    
           The character sequence `^foo^bar' (where `^' is	actually  the  second  character  of  the
           histchars  parameter)  repeats  the last command, replacing the string foo with bar.  More
           precisely, the sequence `^foo^bar^' is synonymous with `!!:s^foo^bar^', hence other  modi‐
           fiers   (see   the  section  `Modifiers')  may  follow  the  final  `^'.   In  particular,
           `^foo^bar^:G' performs a global substitution.
    
           If the shell encounters the character sequence `!"' in the input, the history mechanism is
           temporarily disabled until the current list (see zshmisc(1)) is fully parsed.  The `!"' is
           removed from the input, and any subsequent `!' characters have no special significance.
    
           A less convenient but more comprehensible form of command history support is  provided  by
           the fc builtin.
    
       Event Designators
           An  event  designator  is a reference to a command-line entry in the history list.  In the
           list below, remember that the initial `!' in each item may be changed to another character
           by setting the histchars parameter.
    
           !      Start  a	history  expansion, except when followed by a blank, newline, `=' or `('.
    	      If followed immediately by a word designator (see the section `Word  Designators'),
    	      this  forms  a  history  reference with no event designator (see the section `Over‐
    	      view').
    
           !!     Refer to the previous command.  By itself, this expansion repeats the previous com‐
    	      mand.
    
           !n     Refer to command-line n.
    
           !-n    Refer to the current command-line minus n.
    
           !str   Refer to the most recent command starting with str.
    
           !?str[?]
    	      Refer  to the most recent command containing str.  The trailing `?' is necessary if
    	      this reference is to be followed by a modifier or followed by any text that is  not
    	      to be considered part of str.
    
           !#     Refer  to  the  current command line typed in so far.  The line is treated as if it
    	      were complete up to and including the word before the one with the `!#' reference.
    
           !{...} Insulate a history reference from adjacent characters (if necessary).
    
       Word Designators
           A word designator indicates which word or words of a given command line are to be included
           in  a  history  reference.   A `:' usually separates the event specification from the word
           designator.  It may be omitted only if the word designator begins with a  `^',  `$',  `*',
           `-' or `%'.  Word designators include:
    
           0      The first input word (command).
           n      The nth argument.
           ^      The first argument.  That is, 1.
           $      The last argument.
           %      The word matched by (the most recent) ?str search.
           x-y    A range of words; x defaults to 0.
           *      All the arguments, or a null value if there are none.
           x*     Abbreviates `x-$'.
           x-     Like `x*' but omitting word $.
    
           Note  that a `%' word designator works only when used in one of `!%', `!:%' or `!?str?:%',
           and only when used after a !? expansion (possibly in an earlier command).   Anything  else
           results in an error, although the error may not be the most obvious one.
    
       Modifiers
           After the optional word designator, you can add a sequence of one or more of the following
           modifiers, each preceded by a `:'.  These modifiers also work on the  result  of  filename
           generation and parameter expansion, except where noted.
    
           a      Turn  a file name into an absolute path:	prepends the current directory, if neces‐
    	      sary, and resolves any use of `..' and `.' in the path.  Note that the  transforma‐
    	      tion takes place even if the file or any intervening directories do not exist.
    
           A      As  `a',	but also resolve use of symbolic links where possible.	Note that resolu‐
    	      tion of `..' occurs before resolution of symbolic links.	This call  is  equivalent
    	      to a unless your system has the realpath system call (modern systems do).
    
           c      Resolve a command name into an absolute path by searching the command path given by
    	      the PATH variable.  This does not work for  commands  containing	directory  parts.
    	      Note  also that this does not usually work as a glob qualifier unless a file of the
    	      same name is found in the current directory.
    
           e      Remove all but the part of the filename extension following the `.'; see the  defi‐
    	      nition  of the filename extension in the description of the r modifier below.  Note
    	      that according to that definition the result will be empty if the string ends  with
    	      a `.'.
    
           h      Remove a trailing pathname component, leaving the head.  This works like `dirname'.
    
           l      Convert the words to all lowercase.
    
           p      Print the new command but do not execute it.  Only works with history expansion.
    
           q      Quote  the  substituted  words, escaping further substitutions.  Works with history
    	      expansion and parameter expansion, though for parameters it is only useful  if  the
    	      resulting text is to be re-evaluated such as by eval.
    
           Q      Remove one level of quotes from the substituted words.
    
           r      Remove a filename extension leaving the root name.  Strings with no filename exten‐
    	      sion are not altered.  A filename extension is a `.'  followed  by  any  number  of
    	      characters  (including  zero) that are neither `.' nor `/' and that continue to the
    	      end of the string.  For  example,  the  extension  of  `foo.orig.c'  is  `.c',  and
    	      `dir.c/foo' has no extension.
    
           s/l/r[/]
    	      Substitute r for l as described below.  The substitution is done only for the first
    	      string that matches l.  For arrays and for filename  generation,	this  applies  to
    	      each word of the expanded text.  See below for further notes on substitutions.
    
    	      The  forms  `gs/l/r'  and  `s/l/r/:G'  perform global substitution, i.e. substitute
    	      every occurrence of r for l.  Note that the g or :G  must  appear  in  exactly  the
    	      position shown.
    
    	      See further notes on this form of substitution below.
    
           &      Repeat  the  previous  s substitution.  Like s, may be preceded immediately by a g.
    	      In parameter expansion the & must appear inside braces, and in filename  generation
    	      it must be quoted with a backslash.
    
           t      Remove  all  leading pathname components, leaving the tail.  This works like `base‐
    	      name'.
    
           u      Convert the words to all uppercase.
    
           x      Like q, but break into words at whitespace.  Does not work  with	parameter  expan‐
    	      sion.
    
           The  s/l/r/ substitution works as follows.  By default the left-hand side of substitutions
           are not patterns, but character strings.  Any character can be used as  the  delimiter  in
           place  of  `/'.	 A  backslash  quotes the delimiter character.	The character `&', in the
           right-hand-side r, is replaced by the text from the left-hand-side  l.	The  `&'  can  be
           quoted  with a backslash.  A null l uses the previous string either from the previous l or
           from the contextual scan string s from `!?s'.  You can omit the rightmost delimiter  if	a
           newline	immediately follows r; the rightmost `?' in a context scan can similarly be omit‐
           ted.  Note the same record of the last l and r is maintained across all	forms  of  expan‐
           sion.
    
           Note that if a `&' is used within glob qualifiers an extra backslash is needed as a & is a
           special character in this case.
    
           Also note that the order of expansions affects the interpretation of l and r.   When  used
           in  a  history expansion, which occurs before any other expansions, l and r are treated as
           literal strings (except as explained for HIST_SUBST_PATTERN below).  When used in  parame‐
           ter expansion, the replacement of r into the parameter's value is done first, and then any
           additional process, parameter, command, arithmetic, or brace references are applied, which
           may evaluate those substitutions and expansions more than once if l appears more than once
           in the starting value.  When used in a glob qualifier, any substitutions or expansions are
           performed once at the time the qualifier is parsed, even before the `:s' expression itself
           is divided into l and r sides.
    
           If the option HIST_SUBST_PATTERN is set, l is treated as  a  pattern  of  the  usual  form
           described  in  the  section FILENAME GENERATION below.  This can be used in all the places
           where modifiers are available; note, however, that in globbing qualifiers  parameter  sub‐
           stitution  has  already	taken  place,  so  parameters in the replacement string should be
           quoted to ensure they are replaced at the correct time.	Note also that	complicated  pat‐
           terns  used  in	globbing  qualifiers  may  need  the  extended	glob  qualifier  notation
           (#q:s/.../.../) in order for the shell to recognize the expression as  a  glob  qualifier.
           Further,  note that bad patterns in the substitution are not subject to the NO_BAD_PATTERN
           option so will cause an error.
    
           When HIST_SUBST_PATTERN is set, l may start with a # to indicate  that  the  pattern  must
           match  at  the  start  of the string to be substituted, and a % may appear at the start or
           after an # to indicate that the pattern must match at the end of the string to be  substi‐
           tuted.  The % or # may be quoted with two backslashes.
    
           For  example,  the  following  piece  of  filename  generation code with the EXTENDED_GLOB
           option:
    
    	      print *.c(#q:s/#%(#b)s(*).c/'S${match[1]}.C'/)
    
           takes the expansion of *.c and applies the glob	qualifiers  in	the  (#q...)  expression,
           which consists of a substitution modifier anchored to the start and end of each word (#%).
           This turns on backreferences ((#b)), so that the parenthesised subexpression is	available
           in  the	replacement  string as ${match[1]}.  The replacement string is quoted so that the
           parameter is not substituted before the start of filename generation.
    
           The following f, F, w and W modifiers work only with parameter expansion and filename gen‐
           eration.  They are listed here to provide a single point of reference for all modifiers.
    
           f      Repeats  the  immediately  (without a colon) following modifier until the resulting
    	      word doesn't change any more.
    
           F:expr:
    	      Like f, but repeats only n times if the expression expr evaluates to n.  Any  char‐
    	      acter  can  be  used instead of the `:'; if `(', `[', or `{' is used as the opening
    	      delimiter, the closing delimiter should be ')', `]', or `}', respectively.
    
           w      Makes the immediately following modifier work on each word in the string.
    
           W:sep: Like w but words are considered to be the parts of the string that are separated by
    	      sep.  Any character can be used instead of the `:'; opening parentheses are handled
    	      specially, see above.
    
    PROCESS SUBSTITUTION
           Each part of a command argument that takes the form `<(list)', `>(list)' or  `=(list)'  is
           subject	to  process  substitution.   The  expression may be preceded or followed by other
           strings except that, to prevent clashes with commonly occurring strings and patterns,  the
           last  form  must occur at the start of a command argument, and the forms are only expanded
           when first parsing command or assignment arguments.  Process  substitutions  may  be  used
           following redirection operators; in this case, the substitution must appear with no trail‐
           ing string.
    
           In the case of the < or > forms, the shell runs the commands in list as	a  subprocess  of
           the  job  executing the shell command line.  If the system supports the /dev/fd mechanism,
           the command argument is the name of the device file corresponding to  a	file  descriptor;
           otherwise,  if  the  system  supports  named pipes (FIFOs), the command argument will be a
           named pipe.  If the form with > is selected then writing on this special file will provide
           input  for  list.   If < is used, then the file passed as an argument will be connected to
           the output of the list process.	For example,
    
    	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) |
    	      tee >(process1) >(process2) >/dev/null
    
           cuts fields 1 and 3 from the files  file1  and  file2  respectively,  pastes  the  results
           together, and sends it to the processes process1 and process2.
    
           If  =(...) is used instead of <(...), then the file passed as an argument will be the name
           of a temporary file containing the output of the list process.  This may be  used  instead
           of the < form for a program that expects to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the input file.
    
           There  is  an  optimisation  for  substitutions of the form =(<<<arg), where arg is a sin‐
           gle-word argument to the here-string redirection <<<.  This form produces a file name con‐
           taining	the  value  of	arg after any substitutions have been performed.  This is handled
           entirely within the current shell.  This is effectively the reverse of  the  special  form
           $(<arg) which treats arg as a file name and replaces it with the file's contents.
    
           The  = form is useful as both the /dev/fd and the named pipe implementation of <(...) have
           drawbacks.  In the former case, some programmes may automatically close the file  descrip‐
           tor  in	question  before  examining the file on the command line, particularly if this is
           necessary for security reasons such as when the programme is running setuid.  In the  sec‐
           ond  case,  if  the  programme does not actually open the file, the subshell attempting to
           read from or write to the pipe will (in a typical implementation, different operating sys‐
           tems  may  have	different behaviour) block for ever and have to be killed explicitly.  In
           both cases, the shell actually supplies the information using a pipe, so  that  programmes
           that expect to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the file will not work.
    
           Also  note  that  the previous example can be more compactly and efficiently written (pro‐
           vided the MULTIOS option is set) as:
    
    	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) \
    	      > >(process1) > >(process2)
    
           The shell uses pipes instead of FIFOs to implement the latter two process substitutions in
           the above example.
    
           There  is an additional problem with >(process); when this is attached to an external com‐
           mand, the parent shell does not wait for process to finish and hence an	immediately  fol‐
           lowing  command	cannot	rely on the results being complete.  The problem and solution are
           the same as described in the section MULTIOS in zshmisc(1).  Hence in a simplified version
           of the example above:
    
    	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) > >(process)
    
           (note that no MULTIOS are involved), process will be run asynchronously as far as the par‐
           ent shell is concerned.	The workaround is:
    
    	      { paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) } > >(process)
    
           The extra processes here are spawned from the parent shell which will wait for their  com‐
           pletion.
    
           Another	problem  arises any time a job with a substitution that requires a temporary file
           is disowned by the shell, including the case where `&!' or `&|' appears at the  end  of	a
           command containing a substitution.  In that case the temporary file will not be cleaned up
           as the shell no longer has any memory of the job.  A workaround is to use a subshell,  for
           example,
    
    	      (mycmd =(myoutput)) &!
    
           as the forked subshell will wait for the command to finish then remove the temporary file.
    
           A general workaround to ensure a process substitution endures for an appropriate length of
           time is to pass it as a parameter to an anonymous shell function (a piece  of  shell  code
           that is run immediately with function scope).  For example, this code:
    
    	      () {
    		 print File $1:
    		 cat $1
    	      } =(print This be the verse)
    
           outputs something resembling the following
    
    	      File /tmp/zsh6nU0kS:
    	      This be the verse
    
           The  temporary  file created by the process substitution will be deleted when the function
           exits.
    
    PARAMETER EXPANSION
           The character `$' is used to  introduce	parameter  expansions.	 See  zshparam(1)  for	a
           description of parameters, including arrays, associative arrays, and subscript notation to
           access individual array elements.
    
           Note in particular the fact that words of unquoted parameters are not automatically  split
           on  whitespace unless the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is set; see references to this option below
           for more details.  This is an important difference from other shells.
    
           In the expansions discussed below that require a pattern, the form of the pattern  is  the
           same  as  that  used for filename generation; see the section `Filename Generation'.  Note
           that these patterns, along with the replacement text of any substitutions, are  themselves
           subject	to parameter expansion, command substitution, and arithmetic expansion.  In addi‐
           tion to the following operations, the colon modifiers described in the section `Modifiers'
           in  the section `History Expansion' can be applied:  for example, ${i:s/foo/bar/} performs
           string substitution on the expansion of parameter $i.
    
           ${name}
    	      The value, if any, of the parameter name is substituted.	The braces  are  required
    	      if the expansion is to be followed by a letter, digit, or underscore that is not to
    	      be interpreted as part of name.  In addition, more complicated forms  of	substitu‐
    	      tion  usually require the braces to be present; exceptions, which only apply if the
    	      option KSH_ARRAYS is not set, are a single subscript or any colon modifiers appear‐
    	      ing  after  the  name, or any of the characters `^', `=', `~', `#' or `+' appearing
    	      before the name, all of which work with or without braces.
    
    	      If name is an array parameter, and the KSH_ARRAYS option is not set, then the value
    	      of  each	element  of  name  is  substituted, one element per word.  Otherwise, the
    	      expansion results in one word only; with KSH_ARRAYS, this is the first  element  of
    	      an array.  No field splitting is done on the result unless the SH_WORD_SPLIT option
    	      is set.  See also the flags = and s:string:.
    
           ${+name}
    	      If name is the name of a set parameter `1' is substituted, otherwise `0' is substi‐
    	      tuted.
    
           ${name-word}
           ${name:-word}
    	      If  name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then substitute its value; oth‐
    	      erwise substitute word.  In the second form name may be omitted, in which case word
    	      is always substituted.
    
           ${name+word}
           ${name:+word}
    	      If  name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then substitute word; otherwise
    	      substitute nothing.
    
           ${name=word}
           ${name:=word}
           ${name::=word}
    	      In the first form, if name is unset then set it to word; in  the	second	form,  if
    	      name  is	unset or null then set it to word; and in the third form, unconditionally
    	      set name to word.  In all forms, the value of the parameter is then substituted.
    
           ${name?word}
           ${name:?word}
    	      In the first form, if name is set, or in the second form if name is  both  set  and
    	      non-null, then substitute its value; otherwise, print word and exit from the shell.
    	      Interactive shells instead return to the prompt.	If word is omitted, then a  stan‐
    	      dard message is printed.
    
           In  any	of  the  above expressions that test a variable and substitute an alternate word,
           note that you can use standard shell quoting in the word value to selectively override the
           splitting  done	by  the  SH_WORD_SPLIT	option	and  the = flag, but not splitting by the
           s:string: flag.
    
           In the following expressions, when name is an array and the substitution is not quoted, or
           if  the `(@)' flag or the name[@] syntax is used, matching and replacement is performed on
           each array element separately.
    
           ${name#pattern}
           ${name##pattern}
    	      If the pattern matches the beginning of the value  of  name,  then  substitute  the
    	      value  of  name  with  the  matched portion deleted; otherwise, just substitute the
    	      value of name.  In the first form, the smallest matching pattern is  preferred;  in
    	      the second form, the largest matching pattern is preferred.
    
           ${name%pattern}
           ${name%%pattern}
    	      If  the  pattern matches the end of the value of name, then substitute the value of
    	      name with the matched portion deleted; otherwise,  just  substitute  the	value  of
    	      name.  In the first form, the smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second
    	      form, the largest matching pattern is preferred.
    
           ${name:#pattern}
    	      If the pattern matches the value of name, then substitute the empty string;  other‐
    	      wise,  just  substitute  the value of name.  If name is an array the matching array
    	      elements are removed (use the `(M)' flag to remove the non-matched elements).
    
           ${name:|arrayname}
    	      If arrayname is the name (N.B., not contents) of an array variable, then	any  ele‐
    	      ments  contained	in  arrayname  are removed from the substitution of name.  If the
    	      substitution is scalar, either because name is a scalar variable or the  expression
    	      is  quoted, the elements of arrayname are instead tested against the entire expres‐
    	      sion.
    
           ${name:*arrayname}
    	      Similar to the preceding substitution, but in the opposite sense, so  that  entries
    	      present in both the original substitution and as elements of arrayname are retained
    	      and others removed.
    
           ${name:^arrayname}
           ${name:^^arrayname}
    	      Zips two arrays, such that the output array is twice as long as the shortest (long‐
    	      est  for `:^^') of name and arrayname, with the elements alternatingly being picked
    	      from them. For `:^', if one of the input arrays is longer,  the  output  will  stop
    	      when the end of the shorter array is reached.  Thus,
    
    		     a=(1 2 3 4); b=(a b); print ${a:^b}
    
    	      will  output  `1	a  2  b'.  For `:^^', then the input is repeated until all of the
    	      longer array has been used up and the above will output `1 a 2 b 3 a 4 b'.
    
    	      Either or both inputs may be a scalar, they will be treated as an array of length 1
    	      with  the  scalar as the only element. If either array is empty, the other array is
    	      output with no extra elements inserted.
    
    	      Currently the following code will output `a b' and `1' as  two  separate	elements,
    	      which  can  be unexpected. The second print provides a workaround which should con‐
    	      tinue to work if this is changed.
    
    		     a=(a b); b=(1 2); print -l "${a:^b}"; print -l "${${a:^b}}"
    
           ${name:offset}
           ${name:offset:length}
    	      This  syntax  gives  effects  similar  to  parameter  subscripting  in   the   form
    	      $name[start,end],  but  is  compatible with other shells; note that both offset and
    	      length are interpreted differently from the components of a subscript.
    
    	      If offset is non-negative, then if the variable name is  a  scalar  substitute  the
    	      contents	starting offset characters from the first character of the string, and if
    	      name is an array substitute elements starting offset elements from the  first  ele‐
    	      ment.   If  length is given, substitute that many characters or elements, otherwise
    	      the entire rest of the scalar or array.
    
    	      A positive offset is always treated as the offset of a character or element in name
    	      from the first character or element of the array (this is different from native zsh
    	      subscript notation).  Hence 0 refers to the first character or  element  regardless
    	      of the setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS.
    
    	      A  negative offset counts backwards from the end of the scalar or array, so that -1
    	      corresponds to the last character or element, and so on.
    
    	      When positive, length counts from the offset position toward the end of the  scalar
    	      or  array.   When  negative, length counts back from the end.  If this results in a
    	      position smaller than offset, a diagnostic is printed and nothing is substituted.
    
    	      The option MULTIBYTE is obeyed, i.e. the offset and length count multibyte  charac‐
    	      ters where appropriate.
    
    	      offset and length undergo the same set of shell substitutions as for scalar assign‐
    	      ment; in addition, they are then subject	to  arithmetic	evaluation.   Hence,  for
    	      example
    
    		     print ${foo:3}
    		     print ${foo: 1 + 2}
    		     print ${foo:$(( 1 + 2))}
    		     print ${foo:$(echo 1 + 2)}
    
    	      all have the same effect, extracting the string starting at the fourth character of
    	      $foo if the substitution would otherwise return a scalar, or the array starting  at
    	      the  fourth  element  if	$foo  would  return  an array.	Note that with the option
    	      KSH_ARRAYS $foo always returns a scalar (regardless of the use of the  offset  syn‐
    	      tax) and a form such as $foo[*]:3 is required to extract elements of an array named
    	      foo.
    
    	      If offset is negative, the - may not appear immediately after the : as  this  indi‐
    	      cates  the  ${name:-word}  form  of substitution.  Instead, a space may be inserted
    	      before the -.  Furthermore, neither offset nor length may begin with an  alphabetic
    	      character  or  & as these are used to indicate history-style modifiers.  To substi‐
    	      tute a value from a variable, the recommended approach is to precede it with a $ as
    	      this signifies the intention (parameter substitution can easily be rendered unread‐
    	      able); however, as arithmetic substitution  is  performed,  the  expression  ${var:
    	      offs} does work, retrieving the offset from $offs.
    
    	      For  further compatibility with other shells there is a special case for array off‐
    	      set 0.  This usually accesses to the first element of the array.	However,  if  the
    	      substitution  refers  the  positional parameter array, e.g. $@ or $*, then offset 0
    	      instead refers to $0, offset 1 refers to $1, and so on.  In other words, the  posi‐
    	      tional  parameter  array	is effectively extended by prepending $0.  Hence ${*:0:1}
    	      substitutes $0 and ${*:1:1} substitutes $1.
    
           ${name/pattern/repl}
           ${name//pattern/repl}
    	      Replace the longest possible match of pattern in the expansion of parameter name by
    	      string  repl.   The  first form replaces just the first occurrence, the second form
    	      all occurrences.	Both pattern and repl are subject to double-quoted  substitution,
    	      so  that	expressions  like  ${name/$opat/$npat} will work, but note the usual rule
    	      that pattern characters in $opat are not treated specially unless either the option
    	      GLOB_SUBST is set, or $opat is instead substituted as ${~opat}.
    
    	      The pattern may begin with a `#', in which case the pattern must match at the start
    	      of the string, or `%', in which case it must match at the end  of  the  string,  or
    	      `#%'  in	which  case the pattern must match the entire string.  The repl may be an
    	      empty string, in which case the final `/' may also be omitted.  To quote the  final
    	      `/'  in other cases it should be preceded by a single backslash; this is not neces‐
    	      sary if the `/' occurs inside a substituted parameter.  Note also that the `#', `%'
    	      and  `#%	are  not active if they occur inside a substituted parameter, even at the
    	      start.
    
    	      The first `/' may be preceded by a `:', in which case the match will  only  succeed
    	      if  it  matches  the  entire  word.   Note also the effect of the I and S parameter
    	      expansion flags below; however, the flags M, R, B, E and N are not useful.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     foo="twinkle twinkle little star" sub="t*e" rep="spy"
    		     print ${foo//${~sub}/$rep}
    		     print ${(S)foo//${~sub}/$rep}
    
    	      Here, the `~' ensures that the text of $sub is treated as a pattern rather  than	a
    	      plain  string.  In the first case, the longest match for t*e is substituted and the
    	      result is `spy star', while in the second case, the shortest matches are taken  and
    	      the result is `spy spy lispy star'.
    
           ${#spec}
    	      If  spec	is one of the above substitutions, substitute the length in characters of
    	      the result instead of the result itself.	If spec is an array  expression,  substi‐
    	      tute  the  number of elements of the result.  This has the side-effect that joining
    	      is skipped even in quoted forms, which may affect other  sub-expressions	in  spec.
    	      Note that `^', `=', and `~', below, must appear to the left of `#' when these forms
    	      are combined.
    
    	      If the option POSIX_IDENTIFIERS is not set, and spec is a  simple  name,	then  the
    	      braces  are  optional; this is true even for special parameters so e.g. $#- and $#*
    	      take the length of the string $- and the array $* respectively.	If  POSIX_IDENTI‐
    	      FIERS is set, then braces are required for the # to be treated in this fashion.
    
           ${^spec}
    	      Turn  on	the RC_EXPAND_PARAM option for the evaluation of spec; if the `^' is dou‐
    	      bled, turn it off.   When  this  option  is  set,  array	expansions  of	the  form
    	      foo${xx}bar,  where  the	parameter  xx  is  set	to  (a b c), are substituted with
    	      `fooabar foobbar foocbar' instead of the default `fooa b cbar'.  Note that an empty
    	      array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.
    
    	      Internally,  each  such  expansion  is converted into the equivalent list for brace
    	      expansion.  E.g.,  ${^var}  becomes  {$var[1],$var[2],...},  and	is  processed  as
    	      described  in  the  section  `Brace Expansion' below.  If word splitting is also in
    	      effect the $var[N] may themselves be split into different list elements.
    
           ${=spec}
    	      Perform word splitting using the rules for SH_WORD_SPLIT during the  evaluation  of
    	      spec,  but regardless of whether the parameter appears in double quotes; if the `='
    	      is doubled, turn it off.	This forces parameter expansions to be split  into  sepa‐
    	      rate  words before substitution, using IFS as a delimiter.  This is done by default
    	      in most other shells.
    
    	      Note that splitting is applied to word in the assignment forms of spec  before  the
    	      assignment to name is performed.	This affects the result of array assignments with
    	      the A flag.
    
           ${~spec}
    	      Turn on the GLOB_SUBST option for the evaluation of spec; if the	`~'  is  doubled,
    	      turn it off.  When this option is set, the string resulting from the expansion will
    	      be interpreted as a pattern anywhere that is possible, such as in  filename  expan‐
    	      sion and filename generation and pattern-matching contexts like the right hand side
    	      of the `=' and `!=' operators in conditions.
    
    	      In nested substitutions, note that the effect of the ~ applies to the result of the
    	      current  level  of substitution.	A surrounding pattern operation on the result may
    	      cancel it.  Hence, for example, if the parameter foo is set to  *,  ${~foo//\*/*.c}
    	      is  substituted  by  the pattern *.c, which may be expanded by filename generation,
    	      but ${${~foo}//\*/*.c} substitutes to the string *.c, which  will  not  be  further
    	      expanded.
    
           If  a  ${...}  type  parameter expression or a $(...) type command substitution is used in
           place of name above, it is expanded first and the result is used as if it were  the  value
           of  name.   Thus it is possible to perform nested operations:  ${${foo#head}%tail} substi‐
           tutes the value of $foo with both `head' and `tail' deleted.   The  form  with  $(...)  is
           often  useful  in combination with the flags described next; see the examples below.  Each
           name or nested ${...} in a parameter expansion may also be followed by a subscript expres‐
           sion as described in Array Parameters in zshparam(1).
    
           Note  that double quotes may appear around nested expressions, in which case only the part
           inside is treated as quoted; for example, ${(f)"$(foo)"} quotes the result of $(foo),  but
           the  flag `(f)' (see below) is applied using the rules for unquoted expansions.	Note fur‐
           ther that quotes are themselves nested in this context; for example, in "${(@f)"$(foo)"}",
           there  are two sets of quotes, one surrounding the whole expression, the other (redundant)
           surrounding the $(foo) as before.
    
       Parameter Expansion Flags
           If the opening brace is directly followed by an opening parenthesis, the string up to  the
           matching closing parenthesis will be taken as a list of flags.  In cases where repeating a
           flag is meaningful, the repetitions need not be consecutive; for example, `(q%q%q)'  means
           the same thing as the more readable `(%%qqq)'.  The following flags are supported:
    
           #      Evaluate	the resulting words as numeric expressions and output the characters cor‐
    	      responding to the resulting integer.  Note that this form is entirely distinct from
    	      use of the # without parentheses.
    
    	      If  the  MULTIBYTE  option  is  set and the number is greater than 127 (i.e. not an
    	      ASCII character) it is treated as a Unicode character.
    
           %      Expand all % escapes in the resulting words in the same  way  as	in  prompts  (see
    	      EXPANSION  OF  PROMPT  SEQUENCES	in zshmisc(1)). If this flag is given twice, full
    	      prompt expansion is done on the resulting words, depending on the  setting  of  the
    	      PROMPT_PERCENT, PROMPT_SUBST and PROMPT_BANG options.
    
           @      In  double quotes, array elements are put into separate words.  E.g., `"${(@)foo}"'
    	      is equivalent to `"${foo[@]}"' and `"${(@)foo[1,2]}"' is	the  same  as  `"$foo[1]"
    	      "$foo[2]"'.   This  is  distinct from field splitting by the f, s or z flags, which
    	      still applies within each array element.
    
           A      Create an array parameter with `${...=...}', `${...:=...}' or  `${...::=...}'.   If
    	      this flag is repeated (as in `AA'), create an associative array parameter.  Assign‐
    	      ment is made before sorting or padding; if field splitting is active, the word part
    	      is  split before assignment.  The name part may be a subscripted range for ordinary
    	      arrays; the word part  must  be  converted  to  an  array,  for  example	by  using
    	      `${(AA)=name=...}' to activate field splitting, when creating an associative array.
    
           a      Sort  in	array  index  order;  when  combined with `O' sort in reverse array index
    	      order.  Note that `a' is therefore equivalent to the default but `Oa' is useful for
    	      obtaining an array's elements in reverse order.
    
           b      Quote  with  backslashes only characters that are special to pattern matching. This
    	      is useful when the contents of the variable are  to  be  tested  using  GLOB_SUBST,
    	      including the ${~...} switch.
    
    	      Quoting  using  one  of  the q family of flags does not work for this purpose since
    	      quotes are not stripped from non-pattern characters by GLOB_SUBST.  In other words,
    
    		     pattern=${(q)str}
    		     [[ $str = ${~pattern} ]]
    
    	      works if $str is `a*b' but not if it is `a b', whereas
    
    		     pattern=${(b)str}
    		     [[ $str = ${~pattern} ]]
    
    	      is always true for any possible value of $str.
    
           c      With ${#name}, count the total number of characters in an array, as if the elements
    	      were  concatenated with spaces between them.  This is not a true join of the array,
    	      so other expressions used with this flag may have an effect on the elements of  the
    	      array before it is counted.
    
           C      Capitalize  the  resulting  words.   `Words'  in	this  case refers to sequences of
    	      alphanumeric characters separated by non-alphanumerics, not to  words  that  result
    	      from field splitting.
    
           D      Assume  the  string or array elements contain directories and attempt to substitute
    	      the leading part of these by names.  The remainder of the path (the whole of it  if
    	      the  leading  part was not substituted) is then quoted so that the whole string can
    	      be used as a shell argument.  This is the reverse of  `~'  substitution:	 see  the
    	      section FILENAME EXPANSION below.
    
           e      Perform  parameter  expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion on the
    	      result. Such expansions can be nested but too deep recursion may have unpredictable
    	      effects.
    
           f      Split the result of the expansion at newlines. This is a shorthand for `ps:\n:'.
    
           F      Join  the  words of arrays together using newline as a separator.  This is a short‐
    	      hand for `pj:\n:'.
    
           g:opts:
    	      Process escape sequences like the echo builtin when no  options  are  given  (g::).
    	      With  the  o  option,  octal escapes don't take a leading zero.  With the c option,
    	      sequences like `^X' are also processed.  With the e option,  processes  `\M-t'  and
    	      similar  sequences  like	the  print  builtin.   With  both of the o and e options,
    	      behaves like the print builtin except that in none of these modes  is  `\c'  inter‐
    	      preted.
    
           i      Sort case-insensitively.	May be combined with `n' or `O'.
    
           k      If  name refers to an associative array, substitute the keys (element names) rather
    	      than the values of the elements.	Used with subscripts (including ordinary arrays),
    	      force  indices  or keys to be substituted even if the subscript form refers to val‐
    	      ues.  However, this flag may not be combined with subscript ranges.
    
           L      Convert all letters in the result to lower case.
    
           n      Sort decimal integers numerically; if the first differing characters  of	two  test
    	      strings are not digits, sorting is lexical.   Integers with more initial zeroes are
    	      sorted before those with fewer or none.  Hence the  array  `foo1	foo02  foo2  foo3
    	      foo20 foo23' is sorted into the order shown.  May be combined with `i' or `O'.
    
           o      Sort the resulting words in ascending order; if this appears on its own the sorting
    	      is lexical and case-sensitive (unless  the  locale  renders  it  case-insensitive).
    	      Sorting  in  ascending  order is the default for other forms of sorting, so this is
    	      ignored if combined with `a', `i' or `n'.
    
           O      Sort the resulting words in descending order; `O' without `a', `i' or `n' sorts  in
    	      reverse  lexical	order.	May be combined with `a', `i' or `n' to reverse the order
    	      of sorting.
    
           P      This forces the value of the parameter name to be interpreted as a further  parame‐
    	      ter name, whose value will be used where appropriate.  Note that flags set with one
    	      of the typeset family of commands (in  particular  case  transformations)  are  not
    	      applied to the value of name used in this fashion.
    
    	      If used with a nested parameter or command substitution, the result of that will be
    	      taken as a parameter name in the same way.  For example, if you have `foo=bar'  and
    	      `bar=baz',  the  strings	${(P)foo},  ${(P)${foo}},  and	${(P)$(echo bar)} will be
    	      expanded to `baz'.
    
           q      Quote characters that are special to the shell in the resulting  words  with  back‐
    	      slashes;	unprintable or invalid characters are quoted using the $'\NNN' form, with
    	      separate quotes for each octet.
    
    	      If this flag is given twice, the resulting words are quoted in single quotes and if
    	      it  is  given three times, the words are quoted in double quotes; in these forms no
    	      special handling of unprintable or invalid characters is attempted.  If the flag is
    	      given four times, the words are quoted in single quotes preceded by a $.	Note that
    	      in all three of these forms quoting is done unconditionally, even if this does  not
    	      change the way the resulting string would be interpreted by the shell.
    
    	      If  a q- is given (only a single q may appear), a minimal form of single quoting is
    	      used that only quotes the string if needed to protect  special  characters.   Typi‐
    	      cally this form gives the most readable output.
    
           Q      Remove one level of quotes from the resulting words.
    
           t      Use  a string describing the type of the parameter where the value of the parameter
    	      would usually appear. This string consists of keywords separated by hyphens  (`-').
    	      The first keyword in the string describes the main type, it can be one of `scalar',
    	      `array', `integer', `float' or `association'. The other keywords describe the  type
    	      in more detail:
    
    	      local  for local parameters
    
    	      left   for left justified parameters
    
    	      right_blanks
    		     for right justified parameters with leading blanks
    
    	      right_zeros
    		     for right justified parameters with leading zeros
    
    	      lower  for  parameters  whose  value  is	converted  to  all  lower case when it is
    		     expanded
    
    	      upper  for parameters whose value is  converted  to  all	upper  case  when  it  is
    		     expanded
    
    	      readonly
    		     for readonly parameters
    
    	      tag    for tagged parameters
    
    	      export for exported parameters
    
    	      unique for arrays which keep only the first occurrence of duplicated values
    
    	      hide   for parameters with the `hide' flag
    
    	      hideval
    		     for parameters with the `hideval' flag
    
    	      special
    		     for special parameters defined by the shell
    
           u      Expand only the first occurrence of each unique word.
    
           U      Convert all letters in the result to upper case.
    
           v      Used  with  k,  substitute (as two consecutive words) both the key and the value of
    	      each associative array element.  Used with subscripts, force values to  be  substi‐
    	      tuted even if the subscript form refers to indices or keys.
    
           V      Make any special characters in the resulting words visible.
    
           w      With  ${#name},  count  words in arrays or strings; the s flag may be used to set a
    	      word delimiter.
    
           W      Similar to w with the difference that empty words between repeated  delimiters  are
    	      also counted.
    
           X      With  this  flag, parsing errors occurring with the Q, e and # flags or the pattern
    	      matching forms such as `${name#pattern}' are reported.  Without  the  flag,  errors
    	      are silently ignored.
    
           z      Split the result of the expansion into words using shell parsing to find the words,
    	      i.e. taking into account any quoting in the value.  Comments are not  treated  spe‐
    	      cially  but  as  ordinary  strings, similar to interactive shells with the INTERAC‐
    	      TIVE_COMMENTS option unset (however, see the Z flag below for related options)
    
    	      Note that this is done very late, even later than the `(s)' flag. So to access sin‐
    	      gle words in the result use nested expansions as in `${${(z)foo}[2]}'. Likewise, to
    	      remove the quotes in the resulting words use `${(Q)${(z)foo}}'.
    
           0      Split the result of the expansion on null bytes.	This is a shorthand for `ps:\0:'.
    
           The following flags (except p) are followed by one or more arguments as shown.  Any  char‐
           acter,  or  the matching pairs `(...)', `{...}', `[...]', or `<...>', may be used in place
           of a colon as delimiters, but note that when a  flag  takes  more  than	one  argument,	a
           matched pair of delimiters must surround each argument.
    
           p      Recognize the same escape sequences as the print builtin in string arguments to any
    	      of the flags described below that follow this argument.
    
    	      Alternatively, with this option string arguments may be in the form $var	in  which
    	      case  the  value	of  the  variable  is substituted.  Note this form is strict; the
    	      string argument does not undergo general parameter expansion.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     sep=:
    		     val=a:b:c
    		     print ${(ps.$sep.)val}
    
    	      splits the variable on a :.
    
           ~      Strings inserted into the expansion by any of the flags below are to be treated  as
    	      patterns.   This	applies to the string arguments of flags that follow ~ within the
    	      same set of parentheses.	Compare with ~	outside  parentheses,  which  forces  the
    	      entire substituted string to be treated as a pattern.  Hence, for example,
    
    		     [[ "?" = ${(~j.|.)array} ]]
    
    	      treats  `|' as a pattern and succeeds if and only if $array contains the string `?'
    	      as an element.  The ~ may be repeated to toggle  the  behaviour;	its  effect  only
    	      lasts to the end of the parenthesised group.
    
           j:string:
    	      Join  the  words	of  arrays  together using string as a separator.  Note that this
    	      occurs before field splitting by the s:string: flag or the SH_WORD_SPLIT option.
    
           l:expr::string1::string2:
    	      Pad the resulting words on the left.  Each word will be truncated if  required  and
    	      placed in a field expr characters wide.
    
    	      The arguments :string1: and :string2: are optional; neither, the first, or both may
    	      be given.  Note that the same pairs of delimiters must be  used  for  each  of  the
    	      three  arguments.   The space to the left will be filled with string1 (concatenated
    	      as often as needed) or spaces if string1 is not given.  If both string1 and string2
    	      are given, string2 is inserted once directly to the left of each word, truncated if
    	      necessary, before string1 is used to produce any remaining padding.
    
    	      If either of string1 or string2 is present but empty, i.e. there are two delimiters
    	      together at that point, the first character of $IFS is used instead.
    
    	      If  the  MULTIBYTE option is in effect, the flag m may also be given, in which case
    	      widths will be used for the calculation of padding; otherwise individual	multibyte
    	      characters are treated as occupying one unit of width.
    
    	      If  the  MULTIBYTE  option  is not in effect, each byte in the string is treated as
    	      occupying one unit of width.
    
    	      Control characters are always assumed to be one unit wide; this allows  the  mecha‐
    	      nism to be used for generating repetitions of control characters.
    
           m      Only  useful  together  with  one of the flags l or r or with the # length operator
    	      when the MULTIBYTE option is in effect.  Use the character width	reported  by  the
    	      system  in  calculating how much of the string it occupies or the overall length of
    	      the string.  Most printable characters have a width of one  unit,  however  certain
    	      Asian  character	sets  and certain special effects use wider characters; combining
    	      characters have zero width.  Non-printable characters are  arbitrarily  counted  as
    	      zero width; how they would actually be displayed will vary.
    
    	      If the m is repeated, the character either counts zero (if it has zero width), else
    	      one.  For printable character strings this has the effect of counting the number of
    	      glyphs  (visibly	separate characters), except for the case where combining charac‐
    	      ters themselves have non-zero width (true in certain alphabets).
    
           r:expr::string1::string2:
    	      As l, but pad the words on the right and insert string2 immediately to the right of
    	      the string to be padded.
    
    	      Left and right padding may be used together.  In this case the strategy is to apply
    	      left padding to the first half width of each of the resulting words, and right pad‐
    	      ding  to	the second half.  If the string to be padded has odd width the extra pad‐
    	      ding is applied on the left.
    
           s:string:
    	      Force field splitting at the separator string.  Note that a string of two  or  more
    	      characters  means  that  all  of them must match in sequence; this differs from the
    	      treatment of two or more characters in the IFS parameter.  See also the = flag  and
    	      the  SH_WORD_SPLIT  option.   An empty string may also be given in which case every
    	      character will be a separate element.
    
    	      For historical reasons, the usual behaviour that empty array elements are  retained
    	      inside  double quotes is disabled for arrays generated by splitting; hence the fol‐
    	      lowing:
    
    		     line="one::three"
    		     print -l "${(s.:.)line}"
    
    	      produces two lines of output for one and three and  elides  the  empty  field.   To
    	      override this behaviour, supply the `(@)' flag as well, i.e.  "${(@s.:.)line}".
    
           Z:opts:
    	      As  z  but takes a combination of option letters between a following pair of delim‐
    	      iter characters.	With no options the effect is identical to z.  (Z+c+) causes com‐
    	      ments  to  be  parsed  as  a  string and retained; any field in the resulting array
    	      beginning with an unquoted comment character is a comment.  (Z+C+) causes  comments
    	      to  be  parsed  and removed.  The rule for comments is standard: anything between a
    	      word starting with the third character of $HISTCHARS, default #,	up  to	the  next
    	      newline  is  a  comment.	(Z+n+) causes unquoted newlines to be treated as ordinary
    	      whitespace, else they are treated as if they are shell  code  delimiters	and  con‐
    	      verted to semicolons.  Options are combined within the same set of delimiters, e.g.
    	      (Z+Cn+).
    
           _:flags:
    	      The underscore (_) flag is reserved for future use.  As of this  revision  of  zsh,
    	      there  are  no  valid  flags; anything following an underscore, other than an empty
    	      pair of delimiters, is treated as an error, and the flag itself has no effect.
    
           The following flags are meaningful with the ${...#...} or ${...%...} forms.  The S  and	I
           flags may also be used with the ${.../...} forms.
    
           S      Search  substrings  as  well as beginnings or ends; with # start from the beginning
    	      and with % start from the end of the string.  With substitution via  ${.../...}  or
    	      ${...//...},  specifies  non-greedy matching, i.e. that the shortest instead of the
    	      longest match should be replaced.
    
           I:expr:
    	      Search the exprth match (where expr evaluates to a number).  This only applies when
    	      searching  for  substrings,  either  with  the S flag, or with ${.../...} (only the
    	      exprth match is substituted) or ${...//...} (all matches from  the  exprth  on  are
    	      substituted).  The default is to take the first match.
    
    	      The exprth match is counted such that there is either one or zero matches from each
    	      starting position in the string, although for global substitution matches  overlap‐
    	      ping previous replacements are ignored.  With the ${...%...} and ${...%%...} forms,
    	      the starting position for the match moves backwards  from  the  end  as  the  index
    	      increases, while with the other forms it moves forward from the start.
    
    	      Hence with the string
    		     which switch is the right switch for Ipswich?
    	      substitutions  of  the  form ${(SI:N:)string#w*ch} as N increases from 1 will match
    	      and remove `which', `witch', `witch' and `wich'; the form using `##' will match and
    	      remove  `which  switch is the right switch for Ipswich', `witch is the right switch
    	      for Ipswich', `witch for Ipswich' and `wich'. The form using `%'	will  remove  the
    	      same  matches as for `#', but in reverse order, and the form using `%%' will remove
    	      the same matches as for `##' in reverse order.
    
           B      Include the index of the beginning of the match in the result.
    
           E      Include the index of the end of the match in the result.
    
           M      Include the matched portion in the result.
    
           N      Include the length of the match in the result.
    
           R      Include the unmatched portion in the result (the Rest).
    
       Rules
           Here is a summary of the rules for substitution; this  assumes  that  braces  are  present
           around  the  substitution,  i.e.  ${...}.  Some particular examples are given below.  Note
           that the Zsh Development Group accepts no responsibility for any brain  damage  which  may
           occur during the reading of the following rules.
    
           1. Nested substitution
    	      If  multiple  nested  ${...}  forms are present, substitution is performed from the
    	      inside outwards.	At each level, the substitution takes account of whether the cur‐
    	      rent  value  is  a  scalar or an array, whether the whole substitution is in double
    	      quotes, and what flags are supplied to the current level of substitution,  just  as
    	      if  the nested substitution were the outermost.  The flags are not propagated up to
    	      enclosing substitutions; the nested substitution will return either a scalar or  an
    	      array as determined by the flags, possibly adjusted for quoting.	All the following
    	      steps take place where applicable at all levels of substitution.	Note that, unless
    	      the `(P)' flag is present, the flags and any subscripts apply directly to the value
    	      of the nested substitution; for example, the expansion  ${${foo}}  behaves  exactly
    	      the same as ${foo}.
    
    	      At  each	nested	level of substitution, the substituted words undergo all forms of
    	      single-word substitution (i.e. not filename generation), including command  substi‐
    	      tution,  arithmetic expansion and filename expansion (i.e. leading ~ and =).  Thus,
    	      for example, ${${:-=cat}:h} expands to the directory where the cat program resides.
    	      (Explanation:  the internal substitution has no parameter but a default value =cat,
    	      which is expanded by filename expansion to a full path; the outer substitution then
    	      applies the modifier :h and takes the directory part of the path.)
    
           2. Internal parameter flags
    	      Any parameter flags set by one of the typeset family of commands, in particular the
    	      L, R, Z, u and l flags for padding and capitalization, are applied directly to  the
    	      parameter  value.   Note these flags are options to the command, e.g. `typeset -Z';
    	      they are not the same as the flags used within parameter substitutions.
    
           3. Parameter subscripting
    	      If the value is a raw parameter reference with a subscript, such as ${var[3]},  the
    	      effect of subscripting is applied directly to the parameter.  Subscripts are evalu‐
    	      ated left to right; subsequent subscripts  apply	to  the  scalar  or  array  value
    	      yielded  by  the	previous subscript.  Thus if var is an array, ${var[1][2]} is the
    	      second character of the first word, but ${var[2,4][2]} is  the  entire  third  word
    	      (the  second  word  of  the range of words two through four of the original array).
    	      Any number of subscripts may appear.  Flags such as (k) and  (v)	which  alter  the
    	      result of subscripting are applied.
    
           4. Parameter name replacement
    	      The  effect  of any (P) flag, which treats the value so far as a parameter name and
    	      replaces it with the corresponding value, is applied.
    
           5. Double-quoted joining
    	      If the value after this process is an array, and the substitution appears in double
    	      quotes,  and  neither an (@) flag nor a # length operator is present at the current
    	      level, then words of the value are joined with the first character of the parameter
    	      $IFS,  by default a space, between each word (single word arrays are not modified).
    	      If the (j) flag is present, that is used for joining instead of $IFS.
    
           6. Nested subscripting
    	      Any remaining subscripts (i.e. of a nested  substitution)  are  evaluated  at  this
    	      point,  based  on  whether the value is an array or a scalar.  As with 3., multiple
    	      subscripts  can  appear.	 Note  that  ${foo[2,4][2]}   is   thus   equivalent   to
    	      ${${foo[2,4]}[2]}  and  also  to	"${${(@)foo[2,4]}[2]}"	(the  nested substitution
    	      returns an array in both cases), but not to "${${foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the nested substi‐
    	      tution returns a scalar because of the quotes).
    
           7. Modifiers
    	      Any  modifiers, as specified by a trailing `#', `%', `/' (possibly doubled) or by a
    	      set of modifiers of the form :... (see the section `Modifiers' in the section `His‐
    	      tory Expansion'), are applied to the words of the value at this level.
    
           8. Character evaluation
    	      Any (#) flag is applied, evaluating the result so far numerically as a character.
    
           9. Length
    	      Any initial # modifier, i.e. in the form ${#var}, is used to evaluate the length of
    	      the expression so far.
    
           10. Forced joining
    	      If the `(j)' flag is present, or no `(j)' flag is present but the string is  to  be
    	      split as given by rule 11., and joining did not take place at step 5., any words in
    	      the value are joined together using the given string or the first character of $IFS
    	      if none.	Note that the `(F)' flag implicitly supplies a string for joining in this
    	      manner.
    
           11. Simple word splitting
    	      If one of the `(s)' or `(f)' flags are present, or the `='  specifier  was  present
    	      (e.g. ${=var}), the word is split on occurrences of the specified string, or (for =
    	      with neither of the two flags present) any of the characters in $IFS.
    
    	      If no `(s)', `(f)' or `=' was given, but the word is  not  quoted  and  the  option
    	      SH_WORD_SPLIT  is set, the word is split on occurrences of any of the characters in
    	      $IFS.  Note this step, too, takes place at all levels of a nested substitution.
    
           12. Case modification
    	      Any case modification from one of the flags (L), (U) or (C) is applied.
    
           13. Escape sequence replacement
    	      First any replacements from the (g) flag are performed, then any prompt-style  for‐
    	      matting from the (%) family of flags is applied.
    
           14. Quote application
    	      Any quoting or unquoting using (q) and (Q) and related flags is applied.
    
           15. Directory naming
    	      Any directory name substitution using (D) flag is applied.
    
           16. Visibility enhancement
    	      Any modifications to make characters visible using the (V) flag are applied.
    
           17. Lexical word splitting
    	      If  the  '(z)'  flag  or one of the forms of the '(Z)' flag is present, the word is
    	      split as if it were a shell  command  line,  so  that  quotation	marks  and  other
    	      metacharacters  are  used  to  decide  what  constitutes a word.	Note this form of
    	      splitting is entirely distinct from that described by rule 11.:  it  does  not  use
    	      $IFS, and does not cause forced joining.
    
           18. Uniqueness
    	      If  the  result  is an array and the `(u)' flag was present, duplicate elements are
    	      removed from the array.
    
           19. Ordering
    	      If the result is still an array and one of the `(o)' or `(O)'  flags  was  present,
    	      the array is reordered.
    
           20. RC_EXPAND_PARAM
    	      At  this	point the decision is made whether any resulting array elements are to be
    	      combined element	by  element  with  surrounding	text,  as  given  by  either  the
    	      RC_EXPAND_PARAM option or the `^' flag.
    
           21. Re-evaluation
    	      Any `(e)' flag is applied to the value, forcing it to be re-examined for new param‐
    	      eter substitutions, but also for command and arithmetic substitutions.
    
           22. Padding
    	      Any padding of the value by the `(l.fill.)' or `(r.fill.)' flags is applied.
    
           23. Semantic joining
    	      In contexts where expansion semantics requires a single word to result,  all  words
    	      are  rejoined  with  the first character of IFS between.	So in `${(P)${(f)lines}}'
    	      the value of ${lines} is split at newlines, but then must be  joined  again  before
    	      the P flag can be applied.
    
    	      If a single word is not required, this rule is skipped.
    
           24. Empty argument removal
    	      If  the  substitution  does  not appear in double quotes, any resulting zero-length
    	      argument, whether from a scalar or an element of an array, is elided from the  list
    	      of arguments inserted into the command line.
    
    	      Strictly	speaking,  the removal happens later as the same happens with other forms
    	      of substitution; the point to note here is simply that it occurs after any  of  the
    	      above parameter operations.
    
       Examples
           The  flag  f  is  useful to split a double-quoted substitution line by line.  For example,
           ${(f)"$(<file)"} substitutes the contents of file divided so that each line is an  element
           of the resulting array.	Compare this with the effect of $(<file) alone, which divides the
           file up by words, or the same inside double quotes, which makes the entire content of  the
           file a single string.
    
           The  following  illustrates  the rules for nested parameter expansions.	Suppose that $foo
           contains the array (bar baz):
    
           "${(@)${foo}[1]}"
    	      This produces the result b.  First, the inner substitution "${foo}", which  has  no
    	      array  (@)  flag,  produces a single word result "bar baz".  The outer substitution
    	      "${(@)...[1]}" detects that this is a scalar, so that (despite the `(@)' flag)  the
    	      subscript picks the first character.
    
           "${${(@)foo}[1]}"
    	      This  produces  the result `bar'.  In this case, the inner substitution "${(@)foo}"
    	      produces the array `(bar baz)'.  The outer substitution  "${...[1]}"  detects  that
    	      this  is	an  array  and	picks the first word.  This is similar to the simple case
    	      "${foo[1]}".
    
           As an example of the rules for word splitting and joining, suppose $foo contains the array
           `(ax1 bx1)'.  Then
    
           ${(s/x/)foo}
    	      produces the words `a', `1 b' and `1'.
    
           ${(j/x/s/x/)foo}
    	      produces `a', `1', `b' and `1'.
    
           ${(s/x/)foo%%1*}
    	      produces `a' and ` b' (note the extra space).  As substitution occurs before either
    	      joining or splitting, the operation  first generates the modified  array	(ax  bx),
    	      which  is  joined  to  give  "ax bx", and then split to give `a', ` b' and `'.  The
    	      final empty string will then be elided, as it is not in double quotes.
    
    COMMAND SUBSTITUTION
           A command enclosed in parentheses preceded by a dollar sign, like `$(...)', or quoted with
           grave  accents, like ``...`', is replaced with its standard output, with any trailing new‐
           lines deleted.  If the substitution is not enclosed in double quotes, the output is broken
           into  words using the IFS parameter.  The substitution `$(cat foo)' may be replaced by the
           equivalent but faster `$(<foo)'.  In either case, if the option	GLOB_SUBST  is	set,  the
           output is eligible for filename generation.
    
    ARITHMETIC EXPANSION
           A  string  of  the form `$[exp]' or `$((exp))' is substituted with the value of the arith‐
           metic expression exp.  exp is subjected to parameter expansion, command	substitution  and
           arithmetic expansion before it is evaluated.  See the section `Arithmetic Evaluation'.
    
    BRACE EXPANSION
           A  string  of  the form `foo{xx,yy,zz}bar' is expanded to the individual words `fooxxbar',
           `fooyybar' and `foozzbar'.  Left-to-right order	is  preserved.	 This  construct  may  be
           nested.	Commas may be quoted in order to include them literally in a word.
    
           An  expression  of the form `{n1..n2}', where n1 and n2 are integers, is expanded to every
           number between n1 and n2 inclusive.  If either number begins with a zero, all the  result‐
           ing  numbers  will  be  padded with leading zeroes to that minimum width, but for negative
           numbers the - character is also included in the width.  If the numbers are  in  decreasing
           order the resulting sequence will also be in decreasing order.
    
           An  expression  of the form `{n1..n2..n3}', where n1, n2, and n3 are integers, is expanded
           as above, but only every n3th number starting from n1 is output.  If n3	is  negative  the
           numbers	are  output  in reverse order, this is slightly different from simply swapping n1
           and n2 in the case that the step n3 doesn't evenly divide the range.  Zero padding can  be
           specified in any of the three numbers, specifying it in the third can be useful to pad for
           example `{-99..100..01}' which is not possible to specify by putting a 0 on either of  the
           first two numbers (i.e. pad to two characters).
    
           An  expression of the form `{c1..c2}', where c1 and c2 are single characters (which may be
           multibyte characters), is expanded to every character in the range from c1 to c2 in  what‐
           ever  character	sequence  is  used internally.	For characters with code points below 128
           this is US ASCII (this is the only case most users will need).  If any intervening charac‐
           ter  is not printable, appropriate quotation is used to render it printable.  If the char‐
           acter sequence is reversed, the output is in reverse order, e.g. `{d..a}'  is  substituted
           as `d c b a'.
    
           If  a  brace  expression matches none of the above forms, it is left unchanged, unless the
           option BRACE_CCL (an abbreviation for `brace character class') is set.  In that	case,  it
           is  expanded  to  a  list  of the individual characters between the braces sorted into the
           order of the characters in the ASCII character set (multibyte characters are not currently
           handled).   The	syntax	is  similar  to a [...] expression in filename generation: `-' is
           treated specially to denote a range of characters, but `^' or `!' as the  first	character
           is treated normally.  For example, `{abcdef0-9}' expands to 16 words 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 a
           b c d e f.
    
           Note that brace expansion is not part of filename  generation  (globbing);  an  expression
           such  as */{foo,bar} is split into two separate words */foo and */bar before filename gen‐
           eration takes place.  In particular, note that this is liable  to  produce  a  `no  match'
           error  if  either  of  the  two	expressions does not match; this is to be contrasted with
           */(foo|bar), which is treated as a single pattern but otherwise has similar effects.
    
           To combine brace expansion with array expansion, see the ${^spec} form  described  in  the
           section Parameter Expansion above.
    
    FILENAME EXPANSION
           Each  word is checked to see if it begins with an unquoted `~'.	If it does, then the word
           up to a `/', or the end of the word if there is no `/', is checked to see  if  it  can  be
           substituted  in	one of the ways described here.  If so, then the `~' and the checked por‐
           tion are replaced with the appropriate substitute value.
    
           A `~' by itself is replaced by the value of $HOME.  A `~' followed by a `+' or  a  `-'  is
           replaced by current or previous working directory, respectively.
    
           A  `~' followed by a number is replaced by the directory at that position in the directory
           stack.  `~0' is equivalent to `~+', and `~1' is the top of the stack.  `~+' followed by	a
           number  is  replaced  by  the directory at that position in the directory stack.  `~+0' is
           equivalent to `~+', and `~+1' is the top of the stack.	`~-'  followed	by  a  number  is
           replaced  by the directory that many positions from the bottom of the stack.  `~-0' is the
           bottom of the stack.  The PUSHD_MINUS option exchanges the effects of `~+' and `~-'  where
           they are followed by a number.
    
       Dynamic named directories
           If  the function zsh_directory_name exists, or the shell variable zsh_directory_name_func‐
           tions exists and contains an array of function names,  then  the  functions  are  used  to
           implement  dynamic  directory  naming.  The functions are tried in order until one returns
           status zero, so it is important that functions test whether they can handle  the  case  in
           question and return an appropriate status.
    
           A  `~'  followed  by a string namstr in unquoted square brackets is treated specially as a
           dynamic directory name.	Note that the first unquoted closing square bracket always termi‐
           nates  namstr.	The  shell  function is passed two arguments: the string n (for name) and
           namstr.	It should either set the array reply to a single element which is  the	directory
           corresponding  to  the  name  and  return status zero (executing an assignment as the last
           statement is usually sufficient), or it should return status non-zero.  In the former case
           the  element  of  reply	is  used as the directory; in the latter case the substitution is
           deemed to have failed.  If all functions fail and the option  NOMATCH  is  set,	an  error
           results.
    
           The  functions  defined	as above are also used to see if a directory can be turned into a
           name, for example when printing the directory stack or when expanding %~ in  prompts.   In
           this case each function is passed two arguments: the string d (for directory) and the can‐
           didate for dynamic naming.  The function should either  return  non-zero  status,  if  the
           directory  cannot be named by the function, or it should set the array reply to consist of
           two elements: the first is the dynamic name for the  directory  (as  would  appear  within
           `~[...]'), and the second is the prefix length of the directory to be replaced.	For exam‐
           ple,  if  the  trial  directory	is  /home/myname/src/zsh  and  the   dynamic   name   for
           /home/myname/src (which has 16 characters) is s, then the function sets
    
    	      reply=(s 16)
    
           The  directory  name  so  returned is compared with possible static names for parts of the
           directory path, as described below; it is used if the prefix length  matched  (16  in  the
           example) is longer than that matched by any static name.
    
           It  is  not  a  requirement that a function implements both n and d calls; for example, it
           might be appropriate for certain dynamic forms of expansion not to be contracted to names.
           In  that  case  any  call  with	the first argument d should cause a non-zero status to be
           returned.
    
           The completion system calls `zsh_directory_name c' followed by equivalent  calls  to  ele‐
           ments  of  the  array  zsh_directory_name_functions,  if  it  exists, in order to complete
           dynamic names for directories.  The code for this should be as for  any	other  completion
           function as described in zshcompsys(1).
    
           As a working example, here is a function that expands any dynamic names beginning with the
           string p: to directories below /home/pws/perforce.  In this simple case a static name  for
           the directory would be just as effective.
    
    	      zsh_directory_name() {
    		emulate -L zsh
    		setopt extendedglob
    		local -a match mbegin mend
    		if [[ $1 = d ]]; then
    		  # turn the directory into a name
    		  if [[ $2 = (#b)(/home/pws/perforce/)([^/]##)* ]]; then
    		    typeset -ga reply
    		    reply=(p:$match[2] $(( ${#match[1]} + ${#match[2]} )) )
    		  else
    		    return 1
    		  fi
    		elif [[ $1 = n ]]; then
    		  # turn the name into a directory
    		  [[ $2 != (#b)p:(?*) ]] && return 1
    		  typeset -ga reply
    		  reply=(/home/pws/perforce/$match[1])
    		elif [[ $1 = c ]]; then
    		  # complete names
    		  local expl
    		  local -a dirs
    		  dirs=(/home/pws/perforce/*(/:t))
    		  dirs=(p:${^dirs})
    		  _wanted dynamic-dirs expl 'dynamic directory' compadd -S] -a dirs
    		  return
    		else
    		  return 1
    		fi
    		return 0
    	      }
    
       Static named directories
           A  `~'  followed  by anything not already covered consisting of any number of alphanumeric
           characters or underscore (`_'), hyphen (`-'), or dot (`.') is looked up as a named  direc‐
           tory,  and  replaced by the value of that named directory if found.  Named directories are
           typically home directories for users on the system.  They may also be defined if the  text
           after the `~' is the name of a string shell parameter whose value begins with a `/'.  Note
           that trailing slashes will be removed from the path to the directory (though the  original
           parameter is not modified).
    
           It is also possible to define directory names using the -d option to the hash builtin.
    
           When  the  shell  prints  a  path  (e.g. when expanding %~ in prompts or when printing the
           directory stack), the path is checked to see if it has a named directory  as  its  prefix.
           If  so,	then the prefix portion is replaced with a `~' followed by the name of the direc‐
           tory.  The shorter of the two ways of referring to the directory is used, i.e. either  the
           directory name or the full path; the name is used if they are the same length.  The param‐
           eters $PWD and $OLDPWD are never abbreviated in this fashion.
    
       `=' expansion
           If a word begins with an unquoted `=' and the EQUALS option is set, the remainder  of  the
           word  is  taken	as  the name of a command.  If a command exists by that name, the word is
           replaced by the full pathname of the command.
    
       Notes
           Filename expansion is performed on the right hand side of a parameter assignment,  includ‐
           ing  those  appearing  after commands of the typeset family.  In this case, the right hand
           side will be treated as a colon-separated list in the manner of	the  PATH  parameter,  so
           that a `~' or an `=' following a `:' is eligible for expansion.	All such behaviour can be
           disabled by quoting the `~', the `=', or the whole expression (but not simply the  colon);
           the EQUALS option is also respected.
    
           If  the	option MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST is set, any unquoted shell argument in the form `identi‐
           fier=expression' becomes eligible for file expansion as described in  the  previous  para‐
           graph.  Quoting the first `=' also inhibits this.
    
    FILENAME GENERATION
           If  a word contains an unquoted instance of one of the characters `*', `(', `|', `<', `[',
           or `?', it is regarded as a pattern for filename generation, unless  the  GLOB  option  is
           unset.	If the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set, the `^' and `#' characters also denote a pat‐
           tern; otherwise they are not treated specially by the shell.
    
           The word is replaced with a list of sorted filenames that match the pattern.  If no match‐
           ing  pattern  is  found,  the shell gives an error message, unless the NULL_GLOB option is
           set, in which case the word is deleted; or unless the NOMATCH option is	unset,	in  which
           case the word is left unchanged.
    
           In  filename generation, the character `/' must be matched explicitly; also, a `.' must be
           matched explicitly at the beginning of a pattern or after  a  `/',  unless  the	GLOB_DOTS
           option  is  set.   No filename generation pattern matches the files `.' or `..'.  In other
           instances of pattern matching, the `/' and `.' are not treated specially.
    
       Glob Operators
           *      Matches any string, including the null string.
    
           ?      Matches any character.
    
           [...]  Matches any of the enclosed characters.  Ranges of characters can be  specified  by
    	      separating two characters by a `-'.  A `-' or `]' may be matched by including it as
    	      the first character in the list.	There are also several named classes  of  charac‐
    	      ters,  in  the  form `[:name:]' with the following meanings.  The first set use the
    	      macros provided by the operating system to test for the  given  character  combina‐
    	      tions, including any modifications due to local language settings, see ctype(3):
    
    	      [:alnum:]
    		     The character is alphanumeric
    
    	      [:alpha:]
    		     The character is alphabetic
    
    	      [:ascii:]
    		     The  character is 7-bit, i.e. is a single-byte character without the top bit
    		     set.
    
    	      [:blank:]
    		     The character is either space or tab
    
    	      [:cntrl:]
    		     The character is a control character
    
    	      [:digit:]
    		     The character is a decimal digit
    
    	      [:graph:]
    		     The character is a printable character other than whitespace
    
    	      [:lower:]
    		     The character is a lowercase letter
    
    	      [:print:]
    		     The character is printable
    
    	      [:punct:]
    		     The character is printable but neither alphanumeric nor whitespace
    
    	      [:space:]
    		     The character is whitespace
    
    	      [:upper:]
    		     The character is an uppercase letter
    
    	      [:xdigit:]
    		     The character is a hexadecimal digit
    
    	      Another set of named classes is handled internally by the shell and is  not  sensi‐
    	      tive to the locale:
    
    	      [:IDENT:]
    		     The  character  is  allowed  to  form  part of a shell identifier, such as a
    		     parameter name
    
    	      [:IFS:]
    		     The character is used as an input field separator, i.e. is contained in  the
    		     IFS parameter
    
    	      [:IFSSPACE:]
    		     The character is an IFS white space character; see the documentation for IFS
    		     in the zshparam(1) manual page.
    
    	      [:INCOMPLETE:]
    		     Matches a byte that starts an incomplete  multibyte  character.   Note  that
    		     there  may be a sequence of more than one bytes that taken together form the
    		     prefix of a multibyte character.  To test for a potentially incomplete  byte
    		     sequence,	use  the  pattern  `[[:INCOMPLETE:]]*'.   This will never match a
    		     sequence starting with a valid multibyte character.
    
    	      [:INVALID:]
    		     Matches a byte that does not start a valid multibyte character.   Note  this
    		     may  be a continuation byte of an incomplete multibyte character as any part
    		     of a multibyte string consisting of invalid and incomplete multibyte charac‐
    		     ters is treated as single bytes.
    
    	      [:WORD:]
    		     The  character  is  treated as part of a word; this test is sensitive to the
    		     value of the WORDCHARS parameter
    
    	      Note that the square brackets are additional to those enclosing the  whole  set  of
    	      characters,  so to test for a single alphanumeric character you need `[[:alnum:]]'.
    	      Named character sets can be used alongside other types, e.g. `[[:alpha:]0-9]'.
    
           [^...]
           [!...] Like [...], except that it matches any character which is not in the given set.
    
           <[x]-[y]>
    	      Matches any number in the range x to y, inclusive.  Either of the  numbers  may  be
    	      omitted  to  make  the  range open-ended; hence `<->' matches any number.  To match
    	      individual digits, the [...] form is more efficient.
    
    	      Be careful when using other wildcards adjacent to patterns of this form; for  exam‐
    	      ple,  <0-9>*  will actually match any number whatsoever at the start of the string,
    	      since the `<0-9>' will match the first digit, and the `*' will  match  any  others.
    	      This is a trap for the unwary, but is in fact an inevitable consequence of the rule
    	      that  the  longest  possible  match   always   succeeds.	  Expressions	such   as
    	      `<0-9>[^[:digit:]]*' can be used instead.
    
           (...)  Matches  the  enclosed pattern.  This is used for grouping.  If the KSH_GLOB option
    	      is set, then a `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!' immediately preceding the `('  is  treated
    	      specially,  as  detailed	below.	The option SH_GLOB prevents bare parentheses from
    	      being used in this way, though the KSH_GLOB option is still available.
    
    	      Note that grouping cannot extend over multiple directories: it is an error to  have
    	      a  `/' within a group (this only applies for patterns used in filename generation).
    	      There is one exception:  a group of the form (pat/)# appearing as a  complete  path
    	      segment  can  match  a sequence of directories.  For example, foo/(a*/)#bar matches
    	      foo/bar, foo/any/bar, foo/any/anyother/bar, and so on.
    
           x|y    Matches either x or y.  This operator has lower precedence than any other.  The `|'
    	      character must be within parentheses, to avoid interpretation as a pipeline.
    
           ^x     (Requires  EXTENDED_GLOB	to be set.)  Matches anything except the pattern x.  This
    	      has a higher precedence than `/', so `^foo/bar'  will  search  directories  in  `.'
    	      except `./foo' for a file named `bar'.
    
           x~y    (Requires  EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Match anything that matches the pattern x but
    	      does not match y.  This has lower precedence  than  any  operator  except  `|',  so
    	      `*/*~foo/bar' will search for all files in all directories in `.'  and then exclude
    	      `foo/bar' if there was  such  a  match.	Multiple  patterns  can  be  excluded  by
    	      `foo~bar~baz'.  In the exclusion pattern (y), `/' and `.' are not treated specially
    	      the way they usually are in globbing.
    
           x#     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches zero or more occurrences of	the  pat‐
    	      tern  x.	This operator has high precedence; `12#' is equivalent to `1(2#)', rather
    	      than `(12)#'.  It is an error for an unquoted `#' to follow something which  cannot
    	      be  repeated; this includes an empty string, a pattern already followed by `##', or
    	      parentheses when part of a KSH_GLOB pattern (for example, `!(foo)#' is invalid  and
    	      must be replaced by `*(!(foo))').
    
           x##    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches one or more occurrences of the pattern
    	      x.  This operator has high precedence; `12##' is	equivalent  to	`1(2##)',  rather
    	      than  `(12)##'.  No more than two active `#' characters may appear together.  (Note
    	      the potential clash with glob qualifiers in the form `1(2##)' which  should  there‐
    	      fore be avoided.)
    
       ksh-like Glob Operators
           If  the	KSH_GLOB option is set, the effects of parentheses can be modified by a preceding
           `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  This character need not be unquoted to have	special  effects,
           but the `(' must be.
    
           @(...) Match the pattern in the parentheses.  (Like `(...)'.)
    
           *(...) Match  any  number of occurrences.  (Like `(...)#', except that recursive directory
    	      searching is not supported.)
    
           +(...) Match at least one occurrence.  (Like `(...)##', except  that  recursive	directory
    	      searching is not supported.)
    
           ?(...) Match zero or one occurrence.  (Like `(|...)'.)
    
           !(...) Match anything but the expression in parentheses.  (Like `(^(...))'.)
    
       Precedence
           The  precedence of the operators given above is (highest) `^', `/', `~', `|' (lowest); the
           remaining operators are simply treated from left to right as part of a  string,	with  `#'
           and `##' applying to the shortest possible preceding unit (i.e. a character, `?', `[...]',
           `<...>', or a parenthesised expression).  As mentioned above, a `/' used  as  a	directory
           separator  may  not appear inside parentheses, while a `|' must do so; in patterns used in
           other contexts than filename generation (for example, in case statements and tests  within
           `[[...]]'),  a  `/' is not special; and `/' is also not special after a `~' appearing out‐
           side parentheses in a filename pattern.
    
       Globbing Flags
           There are various flags which affect any text to their right up to the end of the  enclos‐
           ing  group  or  to the end of the pattern; they require the EXTENDED_GLOB option. All take
           the form (#X) where X may have one of the following forms:
    
           i      Case insensitive:  upper or lower case characters in the	pattern  match	upper  or
    	      lower case characters.
    
           l      Lower  case  characters  in the pattern match upper or lower case characters; upper
    	      case characters in the pattern still only match upper case characters.
    
           I      Case sensitive:  locally negates the effect of i or l from that point on.
    
           b      Activate backreferences for parenthesised groups in the pattern; this does not work
    	      in  filename  generation.   When	a  pattern  with  a  set of active parentheses is
    	      matched, the strings matched by the groups are stored  in  the  array  $match,  the
    	      indices  of  the beginning of the matched parentheses in the array $mbegin, and the
    	      indices of the end in the array $mend, with the first element of each array  corre‐
    	      sponding	to the first parenthesised group, and so on.  These arrays are not other‐
    	      wise special to the shell.  The indices use the same convention as  does	parameter
    	      substitution,  so that elements of $mend and $mbegin may be used in subscripts; the
    	      KSH_ARRAYS option is respected.  Sets of globbing flags are not  considered  paren‐
    	      thesised groups; only the first nine active parentheses can be referenced.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     foo="a string with a message"
    		     if [[ $foo = (a|an)' '(#b)(*)' '* ]]; then
    		       print ${foo[$mbegin[1],$mend[1]]}
    		     fi
    
    	      prints  `string  with  a'.   Note that the first parenthesis is before the (#b) and
    	      does not create a backreference.
    
    	      Backreferences work with all forms of pattern matching other than filename  genera‐
    	      tion,  but  note	that  when  performing	matches  on  an  entire  array,  such  as
    	      ${array#pattern}, or a global substitution, such as  ${param//pat/repl},	only  the
    	      data for the last match remains available.  In the case of global replacements this
    	      may still be useful.  See the example for the m flag below.
    
    	      The numbering of backreferences strictly follows the order of the opening parenthe‐
    	      ses  from  left to right in the pattern string, although sets of parentheses may be
    	      nested.  There are special rules for parentheses followed by `#' or `##'.  Only the
    	      last match of the parenthesis is remembered: for example, in `[[ abab = (#b)([ab])#
    	      ]]', only the final `b' is stored in match[1].  Thus extra parentheses may be  nec‐
    	      essary  to  match  the complete segment: for example, use `X((ab|cd)#)Y' to match a
    	      whole string of either `ab' or `cd'  between  `X'  and  `Y',  using  the	value  of
    	      $match[1] rather than $match[2].
    
    	      If  the  match  fails none of the parameters is altered, so in some cases it may be
    	      necessary to initialise them beforehand.	If some of  the  backreferences  fail  to
    	      match  -- which happens if they are in an alternate branch which fails to match, or
    	      if they are followed by # and matched zero times -- then the matched string is  set
    	      to the empty string, and the start and end indices are set to -1.
    
    	      Pattern matching with backreferences is slightly slower than without.
    
           B      Deactivate backreferences, negating the effect of the b flag from that point on.
    
           cN,M   The flag (#cN,M) can be used anywhere that the # or ## operators can be used except
    	      in the expressions `(*/)#' and `(*/)##' in filename generation, where `/' has  spe‐
    	      cial  meaning;  it  cannot  be combined with other globbing flags and a bad pattern
    	      error occurs if it is misplaced.	It is equivalent to the  form  {N,M}  in  regular
    	      expressions.   The previous character or group is required to match between N and M
    	      times, inclusive.  The form (#cN) requires exactly N matches; (#c,M) is  equivalent
    	      to specifying N as 0; (#cN,) specifies that there is no maximum limit on the number
    	      of matches.
    
           m      Set references to the match data for the entire string matched; this is similar  to
    	      backreferencing  and  does  not  work  in filename generation.  The flag must be in
    	      effect at the end of the pattern, i.e. not local to a group. The parameters $MATCH,
    	      $MBEGIN  and  $MEND  will  be  set  to the string matched and to the indices of the
    	      beginning and end of the string, respectively.  This is most  useful  in	parameter
    	      substitutions, as otherwise the string matched is obvious.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     arr=(veldt jynx grimps waqf zho buck)
    		     print ${arr//(#m)[aeiou]/${(U)MATCH}}
    
    	      forces  all  the	matches  (i.e.	all  vowels) into uppercase, printing `vEldt jynx
    	      grImps wAqf zhO bUck'.
    
    	      Unlike backreferences, there is no speed penalty for using match references,  other
    	      than  the extra substitutions required for the replacement strings in cases such as
    	      the example shown.
    
           M      Deactivate the m flag, hence no references to match data will be created.
    
           anum   Approximate matching: num errors are allowed in the string matched by the  pattern.
    	      The rules for this are described in the next subsection.
    
           s, e   Unlike the other flags, these have only a local effect, and each must appear on its
    	      own:  `(#s)' and `(#e)' are the only valid forms.  The `(#s)' flag succeeds only at
    	      the  start  of the test string, and the `(#e)' flag succeeds only at the end of the
    	      test string; they correspond to `^' and `$' in standard regular expressions.   They
    	      are useful for matching path segments in patterns other than those in filename gen‐
    	      eration (where path segments are in any case  treated  separately).   For  example,
    	      `*((#s)|/)test((#e)|/)*'	matches  a  path  segment  `test' in any of the following
    	      strings: test, test/at/start, at/end/test, in/test/middle.
    
    	      Another use is in parameter substitution; for example  `${array/(#s)A*Z(#e)}'  will
    	      remove only elements of an array which match the complete pattern `A*Z'.	There are
    	      other ways of performing many operations of this type, however the  combination  of
    	      the  substitution operations `/' and `//' with the `(#s)' and `(#e)' flags provides
    	      a single simple and memorable method.
    
    	      Note that assertions of the form `(^(#s))' also work, i.e. match anywhere except at
    	      the  start  of  the  string,  although  this  actually  means  `anything	except	a
    	      zero-length portion at the start of the string'; you need  to  use  `(""~(#s))'  to
    	      match a zero-length portion of the string not at the start.
    
           q      A  `q'  and  everything  up  to  the  closing parenthesis of the globbing flags are
    	      ignored by the pattern matching code.  This is intended to support the use of  glob
    	      qualifiers, see below.  The result is that the pattern `(#b)(*).c(#q.)' can be used
    	      both for globbing and for matching against a  string.   In  the  former  case,  the
    	      `(#q.)'  will  be  treated  as  a glob qualifier and the `(#b)' will not be useful,
    	      while in the latter case the `(#b)' is useful for backreferences	and  the  `(#q.)'
    	      will  be	ignored.   Note  that colon modifiers in the glob qualifiers are also not
    	      applied in ordinary pattern matching.
    
           u      Respect the current locale in determining the presence of multibyte characters in a
    	      pattern,	provided  the  shell was compiled with MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT.  This overrides
    	      the MULTIBYTE option; the default behaviour is taken from the option.   Compare  U.
    	      (Mnemonic:  typically  multibyte characters are from Unicode in the UTF-8 encoding,
    	      although any extension of ASCII supported by the system library may be used.)
    
           U      All characters are considered to be a single byte long.  The opposite of	u.   This
    	      overrides the MULTIBYTE option.
    
           For  example,  the  test  string fooxx can be matched by the pattern (#i)FOOXX, but not by
           (#l)FOOXX, (#i)FOO(#I)XX or ((#i)FOOX)X.  The string (#ia2)readme specifies  case-insensi‐
           tive matching of readme with up to two errors.
    
           When using the ksh syntax for grouping both KSH_GLOB and EXTENDED_GLOB must be set and the
           left parenthesis should be preceded by @.  Note also that the flags do not affect  letters
           inside  [...]  groups,  in  other  words  (#i)[a-z]  still matches only lowercase letters.
           Finally, note that when examining whole paths case-insensitively every directory  must  be
           searched  for  all  files  which  match, so that a pattern of the form (#i)/foo/bar/... is
           potentially slow.
    
       Approximate Matching
           When matching approximately, the shell keeps a count of the  errors  found,  which  cannot
           exceed the number specified in the (#anum) flags.  Four types of error are recognised:
    
           1.     Different characters, as in fooxbar and fooybar.
    
           2.     Transposition of characters, as in banana and abnana.
    
           3.     A  character  missing  in  the  target  string, as with the pattern road and target
    	      string rod.
    
           4.     An extra character appearing in the target string, as with stove and strove.
    
           Thus, the pattern (#a3)abcd matches dcba, with the errors occurring  by	using  the  first
           rule twice and the second once, grouping the string as [d][cb][a] and [a][bc][d].
    
           Non-literal  parts  of  the  pattern must match exactly, including characters in character
           ranges: hence (#a1)???  matches strings of length four, by applying rule  4  to	an  empty
           part  of  the  pattern,	but not strings of length two, since all the ? must match.  Other
           characters which must match exactly are initial dots in filenames  (unless  the	GLOB_DOTS
           option  is  set),  and all slashes in filenames, so that a/bc is two errors from ab/c (the
           slash cannot be transposed with another character).  Similarly, errors are  counted  sepa‐
           rately  for  non-contiguous  strings  in the pattern, so that (ab|cd)ef is two errors from
           aebf.
    
           When using exclusion via the ~ operator, approximate matching is  treated  entirely  sepa‐
           rately  for the excluded part and must be activated separately.	Thus, (#a1)README~READ_ME
           matches READ.ME but not READ_ME, as the trailing READ_ME is matched without approximation.
           However,  (#a1)README~(#a1)READ_ME  does  not match any pattern of the form READ?ME as all
           such forms are now excluded.
    
           Apart from exclusions, there is only one overall error count; however, the maximum  errors
           allowed	may  be  altered  locally,  and  this can be delimited by grouping.  For example,
           (#a1)cat((#a0)dog)fox allows one error in total, which may not occur in the  dog  section,
           and  the  pattern (#a1)cat(#a0)dog(#a1)fox is equivalent.  Note that the point at which an
           error is first found is the crucial one for establishing whether to use approximation; for
           example,  (#a1)abc(#a0)xyz  will  not  match abcdxyz, because the error occurs at the `x',
           where approximation is turned off.
    
           Entire  path  segments  may  be	matched  approximately,  so  that  `(#a1)/foo/d/is/avail‐
           able/at/the/bar'  allows  one error in any path segment.  This is much less efficient than
           without the (#a1), however, since every directory in the path must be scanned for a possi‐
           ble  approximate  match.   It is best to place the (#a1) after any path segments which are
           known to be correct.
    
       Recursive Globbing
           A pathname component of the form `(foo/)#' matches a  path  consisting  of  zero  or  more
           directories matching the pattern foo.
    
           As  a shorthand, `**/' is equivalent to `(*/)#'; note that this therefore matches files in
           the current directory as well as subdirectories.  Thus:
    
    	      ls (*/)#bar
    
           or
    
    	      ls **/bar
    
           does a recursive directory search for files named `bar' (potentially  including	the  file
           `bar'  in  the current directory).  This form does not follow symbolic links; the alterna‐
           tive form `***/' does, but is otherwise identical.  Neither of these can be combined  with
           other  forms  of  globbing  within  the same path segment; in that case, the `*' operators
           revert to their usual effect.
    
       Glob Qualifiers
           Patterns used for filename generation may end in a list of qualifiers enclosed  in  paren‐
           theses.	 The  qualifiers  specify  which filenames that otherwise match the given pattern
           will be inserted in the argument list.
    
           If the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is set, then a trailing set of parentheses containing no  `|'
           or  `(' characters (or `~' if it is special) is taken as a set of glob qualifiers.  A glob
           subexpression that would normally be taken as glob qualifiers, for example `(^x)', can  be
           forced to be treated as part of the glob pattern by doubling the parentheses, in this case
           producing `((^x))'.
    
           If the option EXTENDED_GLOB is set, a different syntax for glob qualifiers  is  available,
           namely  `(#qx)'	where x is any of the same glob qualifiers used in the other format.  The
           qualifiers must still appear at the end of the pattern.	However, with this syntax  multi‐
           ple  glob  qualifiers  may  be chained together.  They are treated as a logical AND of the
           individual sets of flags.  Also, as the syntax is  unambiguous,	the  expression  will  be
           treated	as glob qualifiers just as long any parentheses contained within it are balanced;
           appearance of `|', `(' or `~' does not negate the effect.  Note that  qualifiers  will  be
           recognised  in  this  form even if a bare glob qualifier exists at the end of the pattern,
           for example `*(#q*)(.)' will recognise executable regular files if both options	are  set;
           however,  mixed	syntax	should	probably  be  avoided for the sake of clarity.	Note that
           within conditions using the `[[' form the presence of a parenthesised  expression  (#q...)
           at  the	end  of  a string indicates that globbing should be performed; the expression may
           include glob qualifiers, but it is also valid if it is simply (#q).  This does  not  apply
           to  the	right hand side of pattern match operators as the syntax already has special sig‐
           nificance.
    
           A qualifier may be any one of the following:
    
           /      directories
    
           F      `full' (i.e. non-empty) directories.  Note that the opposite sense (^F) expands  to
    	      empty directories and all non-directories.  Use (/^F) for empty directories.
    
           .      plain files
    
           @      symbolic links
    
           =      sockets
    
           p      named pipes (FIFOs)
    
           *      executable plain files (0100 or 0010 or 0001)
    
           %      device files (character or block special)
    
           %b     block special files
    
           %c     character special files
    
           r      owner-readable files (0400)
    
           w      owner-writable files (0200)
    
           x      owner-executable files (0100)
    
           A      group-readable files (0040)
    
           I      group-writable files (0020)
    
           E      group-executable files (0010)
    
           R      world-readable files (0004)
    
           W      world-writable files (0002)
    
           X      world-executable files (0001)
    
           s      setuid files (04000)
    
           S      setgid files (02000)
    
           t      files with the sticky bit (01000)
    
           fspec  files  with access rights matching spec. This spec may be a octal number optionally
    	      preceded by a `=', a `+', or a `-'. If none  of  these  characters  is  given,  the
    	      behavior	is  the  same  as for `='. The octal number describes the mode bits to be
    	      expected, if combined with a  `=',  the  value  given  must  match  the  file-modes
    	      exactly,	with  a  `+',  at  least  the bits in the given number must be set in the
    	      file-modes, and with a `-', the bits in the number must not be set.  Giving  a  `?'
    	      instead of a octal digit anywhere in the number ensures that the corresponding bits
    	      in the file-modes are not checked, this is only useful in combination with `='.
    
    	      If the qualifier `f' is followed by any other character anything	up  to	the  next
    	      matching	character  (`[',  `{',	and `<' match `]', `}', and `>' respectively, any
    	      other character matches itself) is taken as a list  of  comma-separated  sub-specs.
    	      Each  sub-spec may be either an octal number as described above or a list of any of
    	      the characters `u', `g', `o', and `a', followed by a `=', a `+', or a `-', followed
    	      by  a list of any of the characters `r', `w', `x', `s', and `t', or an octal digit.
    	      The first list of characters specify which access rights are to be  checked.  If	a
    	      `u' is given, those for the owner of the file are used, if a `g' is given, those of
    	      the group are checked, a `o' means to test those of other users, and the	`a'  says
    	      to  test all three groups. The `=', `+', and `-' again says how the modes are to be
    	      checked and have the same meaning as described for the first form above. The second
    	      list  of	characters  finally  says which access rights are to be expected: `r' for
    	      read access, `w' for write access, `x' for the right to execute  the  file  (or  to
    	      search  a  directory),  `s'  for the setuid and setgid bits, and `t' for the sticky
    	      bit.
    
    	      Thus, `*(f70?)' gives the files for which the owner has read,  write,  and  execute
    	      permission,  and	for  which other group members have no rights, independent of the
    	      permissions for other users. The pattern `*(f-100)' gives all files for  which  the
    	      owner  does  not have execute permission, and `*(f:gu+w,o-rx:)' gives the files for
    	      which the owner and the other members of the group have at least write  permission,
    	      and for which other users don't have read or execute permission.
    
           estring
           +cmd   The  string  will  be executed as shell code.  The filename will be included in the
    	      list if and only if the code returns a zero status (usually the status of the  last
    	      command).
    
    	      In  the  first  form, the first character after the `e' will be used as a separator
    	      and anything up to the next matching separator will be taken  as the  string;  `[',
    	      `{',  and  `<'  match  `]',  `}',  and `>', respectively, while any other character
    	      matches itself. Note that expansions must be quoted in the string to  prevent  them
    	      from  being  expanded  before  globbing  is done.  string is then executed as shell
    	      code.  The string globqual is appended to the array zsh_eval_context  the  duration
    	      of execution.
    
    	      During  the execution of string the filename currently being tested is available in
    	      the parameter REPLY; the parameter may be altered to a string to be  inserted  into
    	      the list instead of the original filename.  In addition, the parameter reply may be
    	      set to an array or a string, which overrides the value of  REPLY.   If  set  to  an
    	      array, the latter is inserted into the command line word by word.
    
    	      For example, suppose a directory contains a single file `lonely'.  Then the expres‐
    	      sion `*(e:'reply=(${REPLY}{1,2})':)' will cause the words `lonely1'  and	`lonely2'
    	      to be inserted into the command line.  Note the quoting of string.
    
    	      The  form  +cmd has the same effect, but no delimiters appear around cmd.  Instead,
    	      cmd is taken as the longest  sequence  of  characters  following	the  +	that  are
    	      alphanumeric  or	underscore.   Typically  cmd will be the name of a shell function
    	      that contains the appropriate test.  For example,
    
    		     nt() { [[ $REPLY -nt $NTREF ]] }
    		     NTREF=reffile
    		     ls -l *(+nt)
    
    	      lists all files in the directory that have been modified more  recently  than  ref‐
    	      file.
    
           ddev   files on the device dev
    
           l[-|+]ct
    	      files having a link count less than ct (-), greater than ct (+), or equal to ct
    
           U      files owned by the effective user ID
    
           G      files owned by the effective group ID
    
           uid    files  owned  by	user  ID  id if that is a number.  Otherwise, id specifies a user
    	      name: the character after the `u' will be taken  as  a  separator  and  the  string
    	      between  it  and	the  next  matching  separator will be taken as a user name.  The
    	      starting separators `[', `{', and `<' match the final separators `]', `}', and `>',
    	      respectively;  any  other  character  matches itself.  The selected files are those
    	      owned by this user.  For example, `u:foo:' or `u[foo]' selects files owned by  user
    	      `foo'.
    
           gid    like uid but with group IDs or names
    
           a[Mwhms][-|+]n
    	      files  accessed  exactly	n  days  ago.	Files accessed within the last n days are
    	      selected using a negative value for n (-n).  Files accessed more than  n	days  ago
    	      are  selected  by a positive n value (+n).  Optional unit specifiers `M', `w', `h',
    	      `m' or `s' (e.g. `ah5') cause the check to be performed with months (of  30  days),
    	      weeks,  hours,  minutes  or seconds instead of days, respectively.  An explicit `d'
    	      for days is also allowed.
    
    	      Any fractional part of the difference between the access time and the current  part
    	      in  the  appropriate  units  is  ignored	in  the  comparison.  For instance, `echo
    	      *(ah-5)' would echo files accessed within the last five hours, while `echo *(ah+5)'
    	      would  echo  files  accessed at least six hours ago, as times strictly between five
    	      and six hours are treated as five hours.
    
           m[Mwhms][-|+]n
    	      like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file modification time.
    
           c[Mwhms][-|+]n
    	      like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file inode change time.
    
           L[+|-]n
    	      files less than n bytes (-), more than n bytes (+), or exactly n bytes in length.
    
    	      If this flag is directly followed by a size specifier `k' (`K'), `m' (`M'), or  `p'
    	      (`P')  (e.g.  `Lk-50')  the check is performed with kilobytes, megabytes, or blocks
    	      (of 512 bytes) instead.  (On some systems additional specifiers are  available  for
    	      gigabytes,  `g'  or  `G', and terabytes, `t' or `T'.) If a size specifier is used a
    	      file is regarded as "exactly" the size if the file size rounded up to the next unit
    	      is  equal  to  the  test	size.	Hence  `*(Lm1)' matches files from 1 byte up to 1
    	      Megabyte inclusive.  Note also that the set of files "less than" the test size only
    	      includes files that would not match the equality test; hence `*(Lm-1)' only matches
    	      files of zero size.
    
           ^      negates all qualifiers following it
    
           -      toggles between making the qualifiers work on symbolic links (the default) and  the
    	      files they point to
    
           M      sets the MARK_DIRS option for the current pattern
    
           T      appends  a  trailing  qualifier  mark to the filenames, analogous to the LIST_TYPES
    	      option, for the current pattern (overrides M)
    
           N      sets the NULL_GLOB option for the current pattern
    
           D      sets the GLOB_DOTS option for the current pattern
    
           n      sets the NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT option for the current pattern
    
           Yn     enables short-circuit mode: the pattern will expand to at  most  n  filenames.   If
    	      more  than  n  matches exist, only the first n matches in directory traversal order
    	      will be considered.
    
    	      Implies oN when no oc qualifier is used.
    
           oc     specifies how the names of the files should be sorted. If c is n they are sorted by
    	      name;  if it is L they are sorted depending on the size (length) of the files; if l
    	      they are sorted by the number of links; if a, m, or c they are sorted by	the  time
    	      of the last access, modification, or inode change respectively; if d, files in sub‐
    	      directories appear before those in the current  directory  at  each  level  of  the
    	      search  -- this is best combined with other criteria, for example `odon' to sort on
    	      names for files within the same directory; if N, no  sorting  is	performed.   Note
    	      that  a, m, and c compare the age against the current time, hence the first name in
    	      the list is the youngest file. Also note that the modifiers ^ and -  are	used,  so
    	      `*(^-oL)'  gives	a list of all files sorted by file size in descending order, fol‐
    	      lowing any symbolic links.  Unless oN is used, multiple order specifiers may  occur
    	      to resolve ties.
    
    	      The  default  sorting  is n (by name) unless the Y glob qualifier is used, in which
    	      case it is N (unsorted).
    
    	      oe and o+ are special cases; they are each followed by shell code, delimited as for
    	      the  e  glob qualifier and the + glob qualifier respectively (see above).  The code
    	      is executed for each matched file with the parameter REPLY set to the name  of  the
    	      file  on	entry  and globsort appended to zsh_eval_context.  The code should modify
    	      the parameter REPLY in some fashion.  On return, the value of the parameter is used
    	      instead  of the file name as the string on which to sort.  Unlike other sort opera‐
    	      tors, oe and o+ may be repeated, but note that the maximum number of sort operators
    	      of any kind that may appear in any glob expression is 12.
    
           Oc     like  `o',  but sorts in descending order; i.e. `*(^oc)' is the same as `*(Oc)' and
    	      `*(^Oc)' is the same as `*(oc)'; `Od' puts files in the  current	directory  before
    	      those in subdirectories at each level of the search.
    
           [beg[,end]]
    	      specifies  which	of the matched filenames should be included in the returned list.
    	      The syntax is the same as for array subscripts. beg and the  optional  end  may  be
    	      mathematical expressions. As in parameter subscripting they may be negative to make
    	      them count from the last match backward. E.g.: `*(-OL[1,3])' gives a  list  of  the
    	      names of the three largest files.
    
           Pstring
    	      The  string  will  be  prepended	to each glob match as a separate word.	string is
    	      delimited in the same way as arguments to the e  glob  qualifier	described  above.
    	      The  qualifier  can  be  repeated;  the  words are prepended separately so that the
    	      resulting command line contains the words in the same order they were given in  the
    	      list of glob qualifiers.
    
    	      A  typical  use  for  this is to prepend an option before all occurrences of a file
    	      name; for example, the pattern `*(P:-f:)' produces the command line  arguments  `-f
    	      file1 -f file2 ...'
    
    	      If  the  modifier  ^  is active, then string will be appended instead of prepended.
    	      Prepending and appending is done independently so both can be used on the same glob
    	      expression;  for	example  by  writing `*(P:foo:^P:bar:^P:baz:)' which produces the
    	      command line arguments `foo baz file1 bar ...'
    
           More than one of these lists can be combined, separated by commas. The whole list  matches
           if  at  least one of the sublists matches (they are `or'ed, the qualifiers in the sublists
           are `and'ed).  Some qualifiers, however, affect all matches generated, independent of  the
           sublist	in  which they are given.  These are the qualifiers `M', `T', `N', `D', `n', `o',
           `O' and the subscripts given in brackets (`[...]').
    
           If a `:' appears in a qualifier list, the remainder of the expression  in  parenthesis  is
           interpreted  as	a  modifier  (see  the section `Modifiers' in the section `History Expan‐
           sion').	Each modifier must be introduced by a separate `:'.  Note also	that  the  result
           after  modification  does  not have to be an existing file.  The name of any existing file
           can be followed by a modifier of the form `(:...)' even if no actual  filename  generation
           is performed, although note that the presence of the parentheses causes the entire expres‐
           sion to be subjected to any global pattern matching options such as NULL_GLOB. Thus:
    
    	      ls *(-/)
    
           lists all directories and symbolic links that point to directories, and
    
    	      ls *(-@)
    
           lists all broken symbolic links, and
    
    	      ls *(%W)
    
           lists all world-writable device files in the current directory, and
    
    	      ls *(W,X)
    
           lists all files in the current directory that are world-writable or world-executable, and
    
    	      echo /tmp/foo*(u0^@:t)
    
           outputs the basename of all root-owned files beginning with  the  string  `foo'	in  /tmp,
           ignoring symlinks, and
    
    	      ls *.*~(lex|parse).[ch](^D^l1)
    
           lists all files having a link count of one whose names contain a dot (but not those start‐
           ing with a dot, since GLOB_DOTS is explicitly  switched	off)  except  for  lex.c,  lex.h,
           parse.c and parse.h.
    
    	      print b*.pro(#q:s/pro/shmo/)(#q.:s/builtin/shmiltin/)
    
           demonstrates  how colon modifiers and other qualifiers may be chained together.	The ordi‐
           nary qualifier `.' is applied first, then the colon modifiers in order from left to right.
           So  if EXTENDED_GLOB is set and the base pattern matches the regular file builtin.pro, the
           shell will print `shmiltin.shmo'.
    
    ZSHPARAM(1)			     General Commands Manual			      ZSHPARAM(1)
    
    NAME
           zshparam - zsh parameters
    
    DESCRIPTION
           A parameter has a name, a value, and a number of attributes.  A name may be  any  sequence
           of  alphanumeric  characters and underscores, or the single characters `*', `@', `#', `?',
           `-', `$', or `!'.  A parameter whose name begins with an  alphanumeric  or  underscore  is
           also referred to as a variable.
    
           The  attributes	of  a parameter determine the type of its value, often referred to as the
           parameter type or variable type, and also control other processing that may be applied  to
           the value when it is referenced.  The value type may be a scalar (a string, an integer, or
           a floating point number), an array (indexed numerically),  or  an  associative  array  (an
           unordered set of name-value pairs, indexed by name, also referred to as a hash).
    
           Named  scalar  parameters  may  have  the  exported,  -x, attribute, to copy them into the
           process environment, which is then passed from the shell to  any  new  processes  that  it
           starts.	 Exported  parameters  are  called  environment variables. The shell also imports
           environment variables at startup time and automatically marks the corresponding parameters
           as  exported.   Some  environment  variables  are  not imported for reasons of security or
           because they would interfere with the correct operation of other shell features.
    
           Parameters may also be special, that is, they have a predetermined meaning to  the  shell.
           Special	parameters cannot have their type changed or their readonly attribute turned off,
           and if a special parameter is unset, then later recreated, the special properties will  be
           retained.
    
           To  declare  the  type  of a parameter, or to assign a string or numeric value to a scalar
           parameter, use the typeset builtin.
    
           The value of a scalar parameter may also be assigned by writing:
    
    	      name=value
    
           In scalar assignment, value is expanded as a single  string,  in  which	the  elements  of
           arrays  are  joined  together;  filename  expansion  is	not  performed	unless the option
           GLOB_ASSIGN is set.
    
           When the integer attribute, -i, or a floating point attribute, -E or -F, is set for  name,
           the value is subject to arithmetic evaluation.  Furthermore, by replacing `=' with `+=', a
           parameter can be incremented or appended to.   See  the	section  `Array  Parameters'  and
           Arithmetic Evaluation (in zshmisc(1)) for additional forms of assignment.
    
           Note  that  assignment  may implicitly change the attributes of a parameter.  For example,
           assigning a number to a variable in arithmetic evaluation may change its type  to  integer
           or float, and with GLOB_ASSIGN assigning a pattern to a variable may change its type to an
           array.
    
           To reference the value of a parameter, write `$name' or `${name}'.  See	Parameter  Expan‐
           sion  in  zshexpn(1)  for  complete details.  That section also explains the effect of the
           difference between scalar and array assignment on parameter expansion.
    
    ARRAY PARAMETERS
           To assign an array value, write one of:
    
    	      set -A name value ...
    	      name=(value ...)
    
           If no parameter name exists, an ordinary array parameter is  created.   If  the	parameter
           name exists and is a scalar, it is replaced by a new array.  To append to an array without
           changing the existing values, use the syntax:
    
    	      name+=(value ...)
    
           Ordinary array parameters may also be explicitly declared with:
    
    	      typeset -a name
    
           Associative arrays must be declared before assignment, by using:
    
    	      typeset -A name
    
           When name refers to an associative array, the list in  an  assignment  is  interpreted  as
           alternating keys and values:
    
    	      set -A name key value ...
    	      name=(key value ...)
    
           Every  key  must  have  a value in this case.  Note that this assigns to the entire array,
           deleting any elements that do not appear in the list.  The append syntax may also be  used
           with an associative array:
    
    	      name+=(key value ...)
    
           This  adds  a new key/value pair if the key is not already present, and replaces the value
           for the existing key if it is.
    
           To create an empty array (including associative arrays), use one of:
    
    	      set -A name
    	      name=()
    
       Array Subscripts
           Individual elements of an array may be selected using a subscript.   A  subscript  of  the
           form  `[exp]'  selects the single element exp, where exp is an arithmetic expression which
           will be subject to arithmetic expansion as if it were surrounded by `$((...))'.	The  ele‐
           ments  are  numbered  beginning	with 1, unless the KSH_ARRAYS option is set in which case
           they are numbered from zero.
    
           Subscripts may be used inside braces used to delimit a parameter name, thus `${foo[2]}' is
           equivalent to `$foo[2]'.  If the KSH_ARRAYS option is set, the braced form is the only one
           that works, as bracketed expressions otherwise are not treated as subscripts.
    
           If the KSH_ARRAYS option is not set, then by default accesses to an array element  with	a
           subscript that evaluates to zero return an empty string, while an attempt to write such an
           element is treated as an error.	For backward compatibility the KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT  option
           can  be set to cause subscript values 0 and 1 to be equivalent; see the description of the
           option in zshoptions(1).
    
           The same subscripting syntax is used for associative arrays,  except  that  no  arithmetic
           expansion  is applied to exp.  However, the parsing rules for arithmetic expressions still
           apply, which affects the way that certain special characters must be protected from inter‐
           pretation.  See Subscript Parsing below for details.
    
           A  subscript of the form `[*]' or `[@]' evaluates to all elements of an array; there is no
           difference between the two except when they  appear  within  double  quotes.   `"$foo[*]"'
           evaluates  to  `"$foo[1]  $foo[2]  ..."',  whereas  `"$foo[@]"'	evaluates  to  `"$foo[1]"
           "$foo[2]" ...'.	For associative arrays, `[*]' or `[@]' evaluate to all the values, in  no
           particular  order.  Note that this does not substitute the keys; see the documentation for
           the `k' flag under Parameter Expansion Flags in zshexpn(1) for complete details.  When  an
           array  parameter  is referenced as `$name' (with no subscript) it evaluates to `$name[*]',
           unless the KSH_ARRAYS option is set in which case it evaluates  to  `${name[0]}'  (for  an
           associative  array, this means the value of the key `0', which may not exist even if there
           are values for other keys).
    
           A subscript of the form `[exp1,exp2]' selects all elements in  the  range  exp1	to  exp2,
           inclusive. (Associative arrays are unordered, and so do not support ranges.) If one of the
           subscripts evaluates to a negative number, say -n, then the nth element from  the  end  of
           the  array  is  used.  Thus `$foo[-3]' is the third element from the end of the array foo,
           and `$foo[1,-1]' is the same as `$foo[*]'.
    
           Subscripting may also be performed on non-array values, in which case the subscripts spec‐
           ify  a  substring  to  be  extracted.   For example, if FOO is set to `foobar', then `echo
           $FOO[2,5]' prints `ooba'.  Note that some forms of subscripting	described  below  perform
           pattern	matching,  and	in that case the substring extends from the start of the match of
           the first subscript to the end of the match of the second subscript.  For example,
    
    	      string="abcdefghijklm"
    	      print ${string[(r)d?,(r)h?]}
    
           prints `defghi'.  This is an obvious  generalisation  of  the  rule  for  single-character
           matches.   For a single subscript, only a single character is referenced (not the range of
           characters covered by the match).
    
           Note that in substring operations the second subscript is handled differently by the r and
           R  subscript  flags:  the former takes the shortest match as the length and the latter the
           longest match.  Hence in the former case a * at the end is redundant while in  the  latter
           case it matches the whole remainder of the string.  This does not affect the result of the
           single subscript case as here the length of the match is irrelevant.
    
       Array Element Assignment
           A subscript may be used on the left side of an assignment like so:
    
    	      name[exp]=value
    
           In this form of assignment the element or range	specified  by  exp  is	replaced  by  the
           expression  on  the right side.	An array (but not an associative array) may be created by
           assignment to a range or element.  Arrays do not nest, so assigning a  parenthesized  list
           of values to an element or range changes the number of elements in the array, shifting the
           other elements to accommodate the new values.  (This  is  not  supported  for  associative
           arrays.)
    
           This syntax also works as an argument to the typeset command:
    
    	      typeset "name[exp]"=value
    
           The  value  may	not be a parenthesized list in this case; only single-element assignments
           may be made with typeset.  Note that quotes are necessary in  this  case  to  prevent  the
           brackets  from  being interpreted as filename generation operators.  The noglob precommand
           modifier could be used instead.
    
           To delete an element of an ordinary array, assign `()' to that element.	To delete an ele‐
           ment of an associative array, use the unset command:
    
    	      unset "name[exp]"
    
       Subscript Flags
           If  the	opening bracket, or the comma in a range, in any subscript expression is directly
           followed by an opening parenthesis, the string up to the matching closing one  is  consid‐
           ered to be a list of flags, as in `name[(flags)exp]'.
    
           The  flags s, n and b take an argument; the delimiter is shown below as `:', but any char‐
           acter, or the matching pairs `(...)', `{...}', `[...]', or `<...>', may be used, but  note
           that  `<...>'  can only be used if the subscript is inside a double quoted expression or a
           parameter substitution enclosed in braces as otherwise the expression is interpreted as	a
           redirection.
    
           The flags currently understood are:
    
           w      If  the parameter subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes subscripting work on
    	      words instead of characters.  The default word separator is whitespace.  This  flag
    	      may not be used with the i or I flag.
    
           s:string:
    	      This  gives  the string that separates words (for use with the w flag).  The delim‐
    	      iter character : is arbitrary; see above.
    
           p      Recognize the same escape sequences as the print builtin in the string argument  of
    	      a subsequent `s' flag.
    
           f      If  the parameter subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes subscripting work on
    	      lines instead of characters, i.e. with elements separated by newlines.  This  is	a
    	      shorthand for `pws:\n:'.
    
           r      Reverse  subscripting: if this flag is given, the exp is taken as a pattern and the
    	      result is the first matching array element, substring or word (if the parameter  is
    	      an  array,  if  it  is  a  scalar,  or if it is a scalar and the `w' flag is given,
    	      respectively).  The subscript used is the number of the matching element,  so  that
    	      pairs of subscripts such as `$foo[(r)??,3]' and `$foo[(r)??,(r)f*]' are possible if
    	      the parameter is not an associative array.  If  the  parameter  is  an  associative
    	      array,  only the value part of each pair is compared to the pattern, and the result
    	      is that value.
    
    	      If a search through an ordinary array failed, the search sets the subscript to  one
    	      past the end of the array, and hence ${array[(r)pattern]} will substitute the empty
    	      string.  Thus the success of a search can be tested by  using  the  (i)  flag,  for
    	      example (assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is not in effect):
    
    		     [[ ${array[(i)pattern]} -le ${#array} ]]
    
    	      If KSH_ARRAYS is in effect, the -le should be replaced by -lt.
    
           R      Like  `r',  but  gives  the last match.  For associative arrays, gives all possible
    	      matches. May be used for assigning to ordinary array elements, but not for  assign‐
    	      ing  to  associative  arrays.  On failure, for normal arrays this has the effect of
    	      returning the element corresponding to subscript 0; this is empty unless one of the
    	      options KSH_ARRAYS or KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT is in effect.
    
    	      Note that in subscripts with both `r' and `R' pattern characters are active even if
    	      they were substituted for a parameter (regardless  of  the  setting  of  GLOB_SUBST
    	      which controls this feature in normal pattern matching).	The flag `e' can be added
    	      to inhibit pattern matching.  As this flag does not inhibit other forms of  substi‐
    	      tution,  care  is still required; using a parameter to hold the key has the desired
    	      effect:
    
    		     key2='original key'
    		     print ${array[(Re)$key2]}
    
           i      Like `r', but gives the index of the match instead; this may not be combined with a
    	      second  argument.   On the left side of an assignment, behaves like `r'.	For asso‐
    	      ciative arrays, the key part of each pair is compared to the pattern, and the first
    	      matching	key  found is the result.  On failure substitutes the length of the array
    	      plus one, as discussed under the description of `r', or the  empty  string  for  an
    	      associative array.
    
           I      Like  `i',  but gives the index of the last match, or all possible matching keys in
    	      an associative array.  On failure substitutes 0, or the empty string for	an  asso‐
    	      ciative  array.	This  flag  is	best  when testing for values or keys that do not
    	      exist.
    
           k      If used in a subscript on an associative array, this flag causes	the  keys  to  be
    	      interpreted as patterns, and returns the value for the first key found where exp is
    	      matched by the key.  Note this could be any such key as no ordering of  associative
    	      arrays is defined.  This flag does not work on the left side of an assignment to an
    	      associative array element.  If used on another type of parameter, this behaves like
    	      `r'.
    
           K      On  an  associative  array  this	is  like  `k' but returns all values where exp is
    	      matched by the keys.  On other types of parameters this has the same effect as `R'.
    
           n:expr:
    	      If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them give the nth or  nth  last  match
    	      (if expr evaluates to n).  This flag is ignored when the array is associative.  The
    	      delimiter character : is arbitrary; see above.
    
           b:expr:
    	      If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them begin at the nth or nth last ele‐
    	      ment,  word,  or character (if expr evaluates to n).  This flag is ignored when the
    	      array is associative.  The delimiter character : is arbitrary; see above.
    
           e      This flag causes any pattern matching that would be performed on the  subscript  to
    	      use  plain string matching instead.  Hence `${array[(re)*]}' matches only the array
    	      element whose value is *.  Note that other forms of substitution such as	parameter
    	      substitution are not inhibited.
    
    	      This flag can also be used to force * or @ to be interpreted as a single key rather
    	      than as a reference to all values.  It may be used for either purpose on	the  left
    	      side of an assignment.
    
           See  Parameter  Expansion Flags (zshexpn(1)) for additional ways to manipulate the results
           of array subscripting.
    
       Subscript Parsing
           This discussion applies mainly to associative array key strings and to patterns	used  for
           reverse	subscripting  (the  `r',  `R', `i', etc. flags), but it may also affect parameter
           substitutions that appear as part of an arithmetic expression in an ordinary subscript.
    
           To avoid subscript parsing limitations in assignments to associative array  elements,  use
           the append syntax:
    
    		 aa+=('key with "*strange*" characters' 'value string')
    
           The  basic  rule  to remember when writing a subscript expression is that all text between
           the opening `[' and the closing `]' is interpreted as if it were  in  double  quotes  (see
           zshmisc(1)).   However, unlike double quotes which normally cannot nest, subscript expres‐
           sions may appear inside double-quoted strings or inside other  subscript  expressions  (or
           both!), so the rules have two important differences.
    
           The  first  difference  is  that brackets (`[' and `]') must appear as balanced pairs in a
           subscript expression unless they are preceded by a backslash (`\').  Therefore,	within	a
           subscript  expression  (and unlike true double-quoting) the sequence `[' becomes `[', and
           similarly `]' becomes `]'.  This applies even in cases where a backslash is not  normally
           required;  for  example,  the  pattern  `[^[]'  (to match any character other than an open
           bracket) should be written `[^[]' in a reverse-subscript  pattern.   However,  note  that
           `[^[]'  and  even  `[^[]' mean the same thing, because backslashes are always stripped
           when they appear before brackets!
    
           The same rule applies to parentheses (`(' and `)') and braces (`{'  and	`}'):  they  must
           appear  either  in balanced pairs or preceded by a backslash, and backslashes that protect
           parentheses or braces are removed during parsing.  This is  because  parameter  expansions
           may  be	surrounded  by	balanced  braces,  and subscript flags are introduced by balanced
           parentheses.
    
           The second difference is that a double-quote (`"') may  appear  as  part  of  a	subscript
           expression  without  being  preceded by a backslash, and therefore that the two characters
           `\"' remain as two characters in the subscript (in true double-quoting, `\"' becomes `"').
           However,  because  of the standard shell quoting rules, any double-quotes that appear must
           occur in balanced pairs unless preceded by a backslash.	This makes it more  difficult  to
           write  a  subscript expression that contains an odd number of double-quote characters, but
           the reason for this difference is so that when a subscript expression appears inside  true
           double-quotes, one can still write `\"' (rather than `\\\"') for `"'.
    
           To  use	an odd number of double quotes as a key in an assignment, use the typeset builtin
           and an enclosing pair of double quotes; to refer to the value of that key, again use  dou‐
           ble quotes:
    
    	      typeset -A aa
    	      typeset "aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"=QQQ
    	      print "$aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"
    
           It  is  important  to note that the quoting rules do not change when a parameter expansion
           with a subscript is nested inside another subscript expression.	That is, it is not neces‐
           sary to use additional backslashes within the inner subscript expression; they are removed
           only once, from the innermost subscript outwards.  Parameters are also expanded	from  the
           innermost  subscript  first,  as  each expansion is encountered left to right in the outer
           expression.
    
           A further complication arises from a way in which subscript parsing is not different  from
           double  quote  parsing.	As in true double-quoting, the sequences `\*', and `\@' remain as
           two characters when they appear in a subscript expression.  To use a literal `*' or `@' as
           an associative array key, the `e' flag must be used:
    
    	      typeset -A aa
    	      aa[(e)*]=star
    	      print $aa[(e)*]
    
           A  last	detail	must  be  considered  when reverse subscripting is performed.  Parameters
           appearing in the subscript expression are first expanded and then the complete  expression
           is  interpreted	as  a  pattern.   This	has  two  effects: first, parameters behave as if
           GLOB_SUBST were on (and it cannot be turned  off);  second,  backslashes  are  interpreted
           twice,  once  when  parsing  the array subscript and again when parsing the pattern.  In a
           reverse subscript, it's necessary to use four backslashes to cause a single  backslash  to
           match  literally  in the pattern.  For complex patterns, it is often easiest to assign the
           desired pattern to a parameter and then refer to that parameter in the subscript,  because
           then the backslashes, brackets, parentheses, etc., are seen only when the complete expres‐
           sion is converted to a pattern.	To match the value of a parameter literally in a  reverse
           subscript,  rather  than  as  a	pattern,  use  `${(q)name}' (see zshexpn(1)) to quote the
           expanded value.
    
           Note that the `k' and `K' flags are reverse subscripting for an ordinary  array,  but  are
           not reverse subscripting for an associative array!  (For an associative array, the keys in
           the array itself are interpreted as patterns by those flags;  the  subscript  is  a  plain
           string in that case.)
    
           One  final  note,  not  directly  related to subscripting: the numeric names of positional
           parameters (described below) are parsed specially, so for example `$2foo' is equivalent to
           `${2}foo'.   Therefore,	to  use subscript syntax to extract a substring from a positional
           parameter, the expansion must be surrounded by braces; for example, `${2[3,5]}'	evaluates
           to the third through fifth characters of the second positional parameter, but `$2[3,5]' is
           the entire second parameter concatenated with the filename generation pattern `[3,5]'.
    
    POSITIONAL PARAMETERS
           The positional parameters provide access to the command-line arguments of  a  shell  func‐
           tion,  shell  script, or the shell itself; see the section `Invocation', and also the sec‐
           tion `Functions'.  The parameter n, where n is a number, is the nth positional  parameter.
           The parameter `$0' is a special case, see the section `Parameters Set By The Shell'.
    
           The  parameters	*,  @  and argv are arrays containing all the positional parameters; thus
           `$argv[n]', etc., is equivalent to simply `$n'.	 Note  that  the  options  KSH_ARRAYS  or
           KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT  apply  to  these  arrays as well, so with either of those options set,
           `${argv[0]}' is equivalent to `$1' and so on.
    
           Positional parameters may be changed after the shell or function starts by using  the  set
           builtin,  by  assigning	to  the argv array, or by direct assignment of the form `n=value'
           where n is the number of the positional parameter to be changed.  This also creates  (with
           empty  values)  any  of	the  positions from 1 to n that do not already have values.  Note
           that, because the positional parameters form an array, an array	assignment  of	the  form
           `n=(value  ...)'  is  allowed,  and has the effect of shifting all the values at positions
           greater than n by as many positions as necessary to accommodate the new values.
    
    LOCAL PARAMETERS
           Shell function executions delimit scopes for shell parameters.	(Parameters  are  dynami‐
           cally scoped.)  The typeset builtin, and its alternative forms declare, integer, local and
           readonly (but not export), can be used to declare a parameter as being local to the inner‐
           most scope.
    
           When  a parameter is read or assigned to, the innermost existing parameter of that name is
           used.  (That is, the local parameter hides any less-local parameter.)  However,	assigning
           to  a  non-existent  parameter,	or declaring a new parameter with export, causes it to be
           created in the outermost scope.
    
           Local parameters disappear when their scope ends.  unset can be used to delete a parameter
           while it is still in scope; any outer parameter of the same name remains hidden.
    
           Special	parameters  may  also  be made local; they retain their special attributes unless
           either the existing or the newly-created parameter has the -h (hide) attribute.	This  may
           have  unexpected  effects:  there is no default value, so if there is no assignment at the
           point the variable is made local, it will be set to an empty value (or zero in the case of
           integers).  The following:
    
    	      typeset PATH=/new/directory:$PATH
    
           is  valid for temporarily allowing the shell or programmes called from it to find the pro‐
           grams in /new/directory inside a function.
    
           Note that the restriction in older versions  of	zsh  that  local  parameters  were  never
           exported has been removed.
    
    PARAMETERS SET BY THE SHELL
           In  the	parameter  lists that follow, the mark `<S>' indicates that the parameter is spe‐
           cial.  `<Z>' indicates that the parameter does not exist when the shell initializes in  sh
           or ksh emulation mode.
    
           The following parameters are automatically set by the shell:
    
           ! <S>  The  process  ID	of the last command started in the background with &, or put into
    	      the background with the bg builtin.
    
           # <S>  The number of positional parameters in decimal.  Note that some confusion may occur
    	      with the syntax $#param which substitutes the length of param.  Use ${#} to resolve
    	      ambiguities.  In particular, the sequence `$#-...' in an arithmetic  expression  is
    	      interpreted as the length of the parameter -, q.v.
    
           ARGC <S> <Z>
    	      Same as #.
    
           $ <S>  The  process ID of this shell.  Note that this indicates the original shell started
    	      by invoking zsh; all processes forked from the shells without executing a new  pro‐
    	      gram, such as subshells started by (...), substitute the same value.
    
           - <S>  Flags supplied to the shell on invocation or by the set or setopt commands.
    
           * <S>  An array containing the positional parameters.
    
           argv <S> <Z>
    	      Same  as *.  Assigning to argv changes the local positional parameters, but argv is
    	      not itself a local parameter.  Deleting argv with unset in any function deletes  it
    	      everywhere, although only the innermost positional parameter array is deleted (so *
    	      and @ in other scopes are not affected).
    
           @ <S>  Same as argv[@], even when argv is not set.
    
           ? <S>  The exit status returned by the last command.
    
           0 <S>  The name used to invoke the current shell, or as set by the -c command line  option
    	      upon  invocation.  If the FUNCTION_ARGZERO option is set, $0 is set upon entry to a
    	      shell function to the name of the function, and upon entry to a sourced  script  to
    	      the name of the script, and reset to its previous value when the function or script
    	      returns.
    
           status <S> <Z>
    	      Same as ?.
    
           pipestatus <S> <Z>
    	      An array containing the exit statuses returned by all commands in  the  last  pipe‐
    	      line.
    
           _ <S>  The  last  argument  of  the  previous command.  Also, this parameter is set in the
    	      environment of every command executed to the full pathname of the command.
    
           CPUTYPE
    	      The machine type (microprocessor class or machine  model),  as  determined  at  run
    	      time.
    
           EGID <S>
    	      The  effective  group  ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient privileges,
    	      you may change the effective group ID of the shell process  by  assigning  to  this
    	      parameter.   Also  (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single command
    	      with a different effective group ID by `(EGID=gid; command)'
    
    	      If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but  may  be  explicitly  set
    	      locally.
    
           EUID <S>
    	      The effective user ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient privileges, you
    	      may change the effective user ID of the shell process by assigning to this  parame‐
    	      ter.   Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single command with a
    	      different effective user ID by `(EUID=uid; command)'
    
    	      If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but  may  be  explicitly  set
    	      locally.
    
           ERRNO <S>
    	      The  value  of errno (see errno(3)) as set by the most recently failed system call.
    	      This value is system dependent and is intended for debugging purposes.  It is  also
    	      useful  with the zsh/system module which allows the number to be turned into a name
    	      or message.
    
           GID <S>
    	      The real group ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient privileges, you may
    	      change  the  group  ID  of  the shell process by assigning to this parameter.  Also
    	      (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single command under a	different
    	      group ID by `(GID=gid; command)'
    
    	      If  this	is  made  local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be explicitly set
    	      locally.
    
           HISTCMD
    	      The current history event number in an interactive shell, in other words the  event
    	      number  for  the	command  that caused $HISTCMD to be read.  If the current history
    	      event modifies the history, HISTCMD changes to the new maximum history  event  num‐
    	      ber.
    
           HOST   The current hostname.
    
           LINENO <S>
    	      The  line  number  of  the current line within the current script, sourced file, or
    	      shell function being executed, whichever was started most recently.  Note  that  in
    	      the  case  of shell functions the line number refers to the function as it appeared
    	      in the original definition, not necessarily as displayed by the functions builtin.
    
           LOGNAME
    	      If the corresponding variable is not set in the environment of  the  shell,  it  is
    	      initialized  to  the  login  name  corresponding to the current login session. This
    	      parameter is exported by default	but  this  can	be  disabled  using  the  typeset
    	      builtin.	The value is set to the string returned by the getlogin(3) system call if
    	      that is available.
    
           MACHTYPE
    	      The machine type (microprocessor class or machine model), as determined at  compile
    	      time.
    
           OLDPWD The  previous  working directory.  This is set when the shell initializes and when‐
    	      ever the directory changes.
    
           OPTARG <S>
    	      The value of the last option argument processed by the getopts command.
    
           OPTIND <S>
    	      The index of the last option argument processed by the getopts command.
    
           OSTYPE The operating system, as determined at compile time.
    
           PPID <S>
    	      The process ID of the parent of the shell.  As for $$, the value indicates the par‐
    	      ent of the original shell and does not change in subshells.
    
           PWD    The present working directory.  This is set when the shell initializes and whenever
    	      the directory changes.
    
           RANDOM <S>
    	      A pseudo-random integer from 0 to 32767, newly generated each time  this	parameter
    	      is  referenced.	The  random number generator can be seeded by assigning a numeric
    	      value to RANDOM.
    
    	      The values of RANDOM form an intentionally-repeatable pseudo-random sequence;  sub‐
    	      shells  that  reference RANDOM will result in identical pseudo-random values unless
    	      the value of RANDOM is referenced or seeded in the parent shell in between subshell
    	      invocations.
    
           SECONDS <S>
    	      The  number  of  seconds	since  shell invocation.  If this parameter is assigned a
    	      value, then the value returned upon reference will be the value that  was  assigned
    	      plus the number of seconds since the assignment.
    
    	      Unlike  other  special parameters, the type of the SECONDS parameter can be changed
    	      using the typeset command.  Only integer and one of the floating	point  types  are
    	      allowed.	 For  example,	`typeset -F SECONDS' causes the value to be reported as a
    	      floating point number.  The value is available to  microsecond  accuracy,  although
    	      the  shell  may show more or fewer digits depending on the use of typeset.  See the
    	      documentation for the builtin typeset in zshbuiltins(1) for more details.
    
           SHLVL <S>
    	      Incremented by one each time a new shell is started.
    
           signals
    	      An array containing the names of the signals.
    
           TRY_BLOCK_ERROR <S>
    	      In an always block, indicates whether the preceding list of code caused  an  error.
    	      The  value  is  1 to indicate an error, 0 otherwise.  It may be reset, clearing the
    	      error condition.	See Complex Commands in zshmisc(1)
    
           TRY_BLOCK_INTERRUPT <S>
    	      This variable works in a similar way to TRY_BLOCK_ERROR, but represents the  status
    	      of  an  interrupt  from  the signal SIGINT, which typically comes from the keyboard
    	      when the user types ^C.  If set to 0, any such interrupt will be reset;  otherwise,
    	      the interrupt is propagated after the always block.
    
    	      Note  that  it  is  possible  that an interrupt arrives during the execution of the
    	      always block; this interrupt is also propagated.
    
           TTY    The name of the tty associated with the shell, if any.
    
           TTYIDLE <S>
    	      The idle time of the tty associated with the shell in seconds or -1 if there is  no
    	      such tty.
    
           UID <S>
    	      The  real user ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient privileges, you may
    	      change the user ID of the shell by assigning to  this  parameter.   Also	(assuming
    	      sufficient privileges), you may start a single command under a different user ID by
    	      `(UID=uid; command)'
    
    	      If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but  may  be  explicitly  set
    	      locally.
    
           USERNAME <S>
    	      The  username  corresponding to the real user ID of the shell process.  If you have
    	      sufficient privileges, you may change the username (and also the user ID and  group
    	      ID)  of the shell by assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient privi‐
    	      leges), you may start a single command under a different username (and user ID  and
    	      group ID) by `(USERNAME=username; command)'
    
           VENDOR The vendor, as determined at compile time.
    
           zsh_eval_context <S> <Z> (ZSH_EVAL_CONTEXT <S>)
    	      An  array (colon-separated list) indicating the context of shell code that is being
    	      run.  Each time a piece of shell code that is stored within the shell is executed a
    	      string  is temporarily appended to the array to indicate the type of operation that
    	      is being performed.  Read in order the array gives an indication of  the	stack  of
    	      operations being performed with the most immediate context last.
    
    	      Note that the variable does not give information on syntactic context such as pipe‐
    	      lines or subshells.  Use $ZSH_SUBSHELL to detect subshells.
    
    	      The context is one of the following:
    	      cmdarg Code specified by the -c option to the command line that invoked the shell.
    
    	      cmdsubst
    		     Command substitution using the `...` or $(...) construct.
    
    	      equalsubst
    		     File substitution using the =(...) construct.
    
    	      eval   Code executed by the eval builtin.
    
    	      evalautofunc
    		     Code executed  with  the  KSH_AUTOLOAD  mechanism	in  order  to  define  an
    		     autoloaded function.
    
    	      fc     Code from the shell history executed by the -e option to the fc builtin.
    
    	      file   Lines  of	code  being  read directly from a file, for example by the source
    		     builtin.
    
    	      filecode
    		     Lines of code being read from a .zwc  file  instead  of  directly	from  the
    		     source file.
    
    	      globqual
    		     Code executed by the e or + glob qualifier.
    
    	      globsort
    		     Code executed to order files by the o glob qualifier.
    
    	      insubst
    		     File substitution using the <(...) construct.
    
    	      loadautofunc
    		     Code read directly from a file to define an autoloaded function.
    
    	      outsubst
    		     File substitution using the >(...) construct.
    
    	      sched  Code executed by the sched builtin.
    
    	      shfunc A shell function.
    
    	      stty   Code  passed  to  stty  by  the STTY environment variable.  Normally this is
    		     passed directly to the system's stty command, so this value is  unlikely  to
    		     be seen in practice.
    
    	      style  Code  executed  as  part of a style retrieved by the zstyle builtin from the
    		     zsh/zutil module.
    
    	      toplevel
    		     The highest execution level of a script or interactive shell.
    
    	      trap   Code executed as a trap defined by the trap builtin.  Traps defined as func‐
    		     tions  have  the  context shfunc.	As traps are asynchronous they may have a
    		     different hierarchy from other code.
    
    	      zpty   Code executed by the zpty builtin from the zsh/zpty module.
    
    	      zregexparse-guard
    		     Code executed as a guard by the zregexparse command from the zsh/zutil  mod‐
    		     ule.
    
    	      zregexparse-action
    		     Code  executed  as  an  action by the zregexparse command from the zsh/zutil
    		     module.
    
           ZSH_NAME
    	      Expands to the basename of the command used to invoke this instance of zsh.
    
           ZSH_PATCHLEVEL
    	      The revision string for the version number of the ChangeLog file in the zsh distri‐
    	      bution.  This is most useful in order to keep track of versions of the shell during
    	      development between releases; hence most users should not use it and should instead
    	      rely on $ZSH_VERSION.
    
           zsh_scheduled_events
    	      See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           ZSH_SUBSHELL
    	      Readonly	integer.  Initially zero, incremented each time the shell forks to create
    	      a subshell for executing code.  Hence `(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL)'  and  `print  $(print
    	      $ZSH_SUBSHELL)' output 1, while `( (print $ZSH_SUBSHELL) )' outputs 2.
    
           ZSH_VERSION
    	      The version number of the release of zsh.
    
    PARAMETERS USED BY THE SHELL
           The following parameters are used by the shell.	Again, `<S>' indicates that the parameter
           is special and `<Z>' indicates that the parameter does not exist when the  shell  initial‐
           izes in sh or ksh emulation mode.
    
           In  cases  where  there	are  two parameters with an upper- and lowercase form of the same
           name, such as path and PATH, the lowercase form is an array and the uppercase  form  is	a
           scalar  with  the  elements  of the array joined together by colons.  These are similar to
           tied parameters created via `typeset -T'.  The normal use for the colon-separated form  is
           for  exporting to the environment, while the array form is easier to manipulate within the
           shell.  Note that unsetting either of the pair will unset the  other;  they  retain  their
           special properties when recreated, and recreating one of the pair will recreate the other.
    
           ARGV0  If  exported,  its value is used as the argv[0] of external commands.  Usually used
    	      in constructs like `ARGV0=emacs nethack'.
    
           BAUD   The rate in bits per second at which data reaches the terminal.	The  line  editor
    	      will  use this value in order to compensate for a slow terminal by delaying updates
    	      to the display until necessary.  If the parameter is unset or the value is zero the
    	      compensation mechanism is turned off.  The parameter is not set by default.
    
    	      This  parameter  may be profitably set in some circumstances, e.g.  for slow modems
    	      dialing into a communications server, or on a slow wide area network.  It should be
    	      set to the baud rate of the slowest part of the link for best performance.
    
           cdpath <S> <Z> (CDPATH <S>)
    	      An  array  (colon-separated list) of directories specifying the search path for the
    	      cd command.
    
           COLUMNS <S>
    	      The number of columns for this terminal session.	Used for  printing  select  lists
    	      and for the line editor.
    
           CORRECT_IGNORE
    	      If  set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction.  Any potential correc‐
    	      tion that matches the pattern is ignored.  For example, if the value is  `_*'  then
    	      completion  functions  (which,  by  convention, have names beginning with `_') will
    	      never be offered as spelling corrections.  The pattern does not apply to	the  cor‐
    	      rection  of  file  names, as applied by the CORRECT_ALL option (so with the example
    	      just given files beginning with `_' in the current directory would  still  be  com‐
    	      pleted).
    
           CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE
    	      If set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction of file names.  Any file
    	      name that matches the pattern is never offered as a correction.	For  example,  if
    	      the  value  is  `.*'  then dot file names will never be offered as spelling correc‐
    	      tions.  This is useful with the CORRECT_ALL option.
    
           DIRSTACKSIZE
    	      The maximum size of the directory stack, by default there  is  no  limit.   If  the
    	      stack  gets  larger  than this, it will be truncated automatically.  This is useful
    	      with the AUTO_PUSHD option.
    
           ENV    If the ENV environment variable is set when zsh is invoked as sh or  ksh,  $ENV  is
    	      sourced  after  the  profile  scripts.   The value of ENV is subjected to parameter
    	      expansion, command substitution, and arithmetic expansion before being  interpreted
    	      as a pathname.  Note that ENV is not used unless zsh is emulating sh or ksh.
    
           FCEDIT The  default editor for the fc builtin.  If FCEDIT is not set, the parameter EDITOR
    	      is used; if that is not set either, a builtin default, usually vi, is used.
    
           fignore <S> <Z> (FIGNORE <S>)
    	      An array (colon separated list) containing the suffixes of files to be ignored dur‐
    	      ing filename completion.	However, if completion only generates files with suffixes
    	      in this list, then these files are completed anyway.
    
           fpath <S> <Z> (FPATH <S>)
    	      An array (colon separated list) of directories specifying the search path for func‐
    	      tion  definitions.   This path is searched when a function with the -u attribute is
    	      referenced.  If an executable file is found, then it is read and	executed  in  the
    	      current environment.
    
           histchars <S>
    	      Three  characters  used by the shell's history and lexical analysis mechanism.  The
    	      first character signals the start of a history expansion (default `!').  The second
    	      character  signals  the  start  of a quick history substitution (default `^').  The
    	      third character is the comment character (default `#').
    
    	      The characters must be in the ASCII character set; any attempt to set histchars  to
    	      characters with a locale-dependent meaning will be rejected with an error message.
    
           HISTCHARS <S> <Z>
    	      Same as histchars.  (Deprecated.)
    
           HISTFILE
    	      The  file  to  save  the history in when an interactive shell exits.  If unset, the
    	      history is not saved.
    
           HISTORY_IGNORE
    	      If set, is treated as a pattern at the time history files are written.  Any  poten‐
    	      tial  history entry that matches the pattern is skipped.	For example, if the value
    	      is `fc *' then commands that invoke the interactive history editor are never  writ‐
    	      ten to the history file.
    
    	      Note  that HISTORY_IGNORE defines a single pattern: to specify alternatives use the
    	      `(first|second|...)' syntax.
    
    	      Compare the HIST_NO_STORE option or the zshaddhistory hook, either of  which  would
    	      prevent  such  commands from being added to the interactive history at all.  If you
    	      wish to use HISTORY_IGNORE to stop history being added in the first place, you  can
    	      define the following hook:
    
    		     zshaddhistory() {
    		       emulate -L zsh
    		       ## uncomment if HISTORY_IGNORE
    		       ## should use EXTENDED_GLOB syntax
    		       # setopt extendedglob
    		       [[ $1 != ${~HISTORY_IGNORE} ]]
    		     }
    
           HISTSIZE <S>
    	      The  maximum  number of events stored in the internal history list.  If you use the
    	      HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST option, setting this value larger	than  the  SAVEHIST  size
    	      will give you the difference as a cushion for saving duplicated history events.
    
    	      If  this	is  made  local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be explicitly set
    	      locally.
    
           HOME <S>
    	      The default argument for the cd command.	This is  not  set  automatically  by  the
    	      shell  in  sh, ksh or csh emulation, but it is typically present in the environment
    	      anyway, and if it becomes set it has its usual special behaviour.
    
           IFS <S>
    	      Internal field separators (by default space, tab, newline and NUL), that	are  used
    	      to  separate  words which result from command or parameter expansion and words read
    	      by the read builtin.  Any characters from the  set  space,  tab  and  newline  that
    	      appear  in the IFS are called IFS white space.  One or more IFS white space charac‐
    	      ters or one non-IFS white space character together  with	any  adjacent  IFS  white
    	      space  character	delimit  a  field.  If an IFS white space character appears twice
    	      consecutively in the IFS, this character is treated as if it were not an IFS  white
    	      space character.
    
    	      If  the  parameter is unset, the default is used.  Note this has a different effect
    	      from setting the parameter to an empty string.
    
           KEYBOARD_HACK
    	      This variable defines a character to be removed from the end of  the  command  line
    	      before interpreting it (interactive shells only). It is intended to fix the problem
    	      with keys placed annoyingly close to return and replaces the SUNKEYBOARDHACK option
    	      which  did this for backquotes only.  Should the chosen character be one of single‐
    	      quote, doublequote or backquote, there must also be an odd number of  them  on  the
    	      command line for the last one to be removed.
    
    	      For  backward  compatibility,  if the SUNKEYBOARDHACK option is explicitly set, the
    	      value of KEYBOARD_HACK reverts to backquote.  If the option  is  explicitly  unset,
    	      this variable is set to empty.
    
           KEYTIMEOUT
    	      The  time  the shell waits, in hundredths of seconds, for another key to be pressed
    	      when reading bound multi-character sequences.
    
           LANG <S>
    	      This variable determines the locale category  for  any  category	not  specifically
    	      selected via a variable starting with `LC_'.
    
           LC_ALL <S>
    	      This  variable  overrides  the value of the `LANG' variable and the value of any of
    	      the other variables starting with `LC_'.
    
           LC_COLLATE <S>
    	      This variable determines the locale category for	character  collation  information
    	      within ranges in glob brackets and for sorting.
    
           LC_CTYPE <S>
    	      This  variable determines the locale category for character handling functions.  If
    	      the MULTIBYTE option is in effect this variable or LANG should contain a value that
    	      reflects	the  character	set  in  use,  even if it is a single-byte character set,
    	      unless only the 7-bit subset (ASCII) is used.  For example, if the character set is
    	      ISO-8859-1,  a suitable value might be en_US.iso88591 (certain Linux distributions)
    	      or en_US.ISO8859-1 (MacOS).
    
           LC_MESSAGES <S>
    	      This variable determines the language in which messages should  be  written.   Note
    	      that zsh does not use message catalogs.
    
           LC_NUMERIC <S>
    	      This variable affects the decimal point character and thousands separator character
    	      for the formatted input/output functions and  string  conversion	functions.   Note
    	      that zsh ignores this setting when parsing floating point mathematical expressions.
    
           LC_TIME <S>
    	      This variable determines the locale category for date and time formatting in prompt
    	      escape sequences.
    
           LINES <S>
    	      The number of lines for this terminal session.  Used for printing select lists  and
    	      for the line editor.
    
           LISTMAX
    	      In  the  line  editor,  the  number of matches to list without asking first. If the
    	      value is negative, the list will be shown if it spans at	most  as  many	lines  as
    	      given by the absolute value.  If set to zero, the shell asks only if the top of the
    	      listing would scroll off the screen.
    
           LOGCHECK
    	      The interval in seconds between checks for login/logout activity	using  the  watch
    	      parameter.
    
           MAIL   If  this	parameter is set and mailpath is not set, the shell looks for mail in the
    	      specified file.
    
           MAILCHECK
    	      The interval in seconds between checks for new mail.
    
           mailpath <S> <Z> (MAILPATH <S>)
    	      An array (colon-separated list) of filenames to check for new mail.  Each  filename
    	      can  be  followed  by  a	`?' and a message that will be printed.  The message will
    	      undergo parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion with the
    	      variable	$_ defined as the name of the file that has changed.  The default message
    	      is `You have new mail'.  If an element is a directory instead of a file  the  shell
    	      will recursively check every file in every subdirectory of the element.
    
           manpath <S> <Z> (MANPATH <S> <Z>)
    	      An  array (colon-separated list) whose value is not used by the shell.  The manpath
    	      array can be useful, however, since setting it also sets MANPATH, and vice versa.
    
           match
           mbegin
           mend   Arrays set by the shell when the b globbing flag is used in pattern  matches.   See
    	      the  subsection Globbing flags in the documentation for Filename Generation in zsh‐
    	      expn(1).
    
           MATCH
           MBEGIN
           MEND   Set by the shell when the m globbing flag is used in pattern matches.  See the sub‐
    	      section Globbing flags in the documentation for Filename Generation in zshexpn(1).
    
           module_path <S> <Z> (MODULE_PATH <S>)
    	      An  array  (colon-separated list) of directories that zmodload searches for dynami‐
    	      cally loadable modules.  This  is  initialized  to  a  standard  pathname,  usually
    	      `/usr/local/lib/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION'.   (The `/usr/local/lib' part varies from instal‐
    	      lation to installation.)	For security reasons, any value set  in  the  environment
    	      when the shell is started will be ignored.
    
    	      These parameters only exist if the installation supports dynamic module loading.
    
           NULLCMD <S>
    	      The command name to assume if a redirection is specified with no command.  Defaults
    	      to cat.  For sh/ksh behavior, change this to :.  For csh-like behavior, unset  this
    	      parameter; the shell will print an error message if null commands are entered.
    
           path <S> <Z> (PATH <S>)
    	      An  array  (colon-separated list) of directories to search for commands.	When this
    	      parameter is set, each directory is scanned and all files found are put in  a  hash
    	      table.
    
           POSTEDIT <S>
    	      This  string is output whenever the line editor exits.  It usually contains termcap
    	      strings to reset the terminal.
    
           PROMPT <S> <Z>
           PROMPT2 <S> <Z>
           PROMPT3 <S> <Z>
           PROMPT4 <S> <Z>
    	      Same as PS1, PS2, PS3 and PS4, respectively.
    
           prompt <S> <Z>
    	      Same as PS1.
    
           PROMPT_EOL_MARK
    	      When the PROMPT_CR and PROMPT_SP options are set, the PROMPT_EOL_MARK parameter can
    	      be used to customize how the end of partial lines are shown.  This parameter under‐
    	      goes prompt expansion, with the PROMPT_PERCENT option set.  If not set, the default
    	      behavior is equivalent to the value `%B%S%#%s%b'.
    
           PS1 <S>
    	      The  primary  prompt string, printed before a command is read.  It undergoes a spe‐
    	      cial form of expansion before being displayed; see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in
    	      zshmisc(1).  The default is `%m%# '.
    
           PS2 <S>
    	      The  secondary  prompt, printed when the shell needs more information to complete a
    	      command.	It is expanded in the same way as PS1.	The default is `%_> ', which dis‐
    	      plays any shell constructs or quotation marks which are currently being processed.
    
           PS3 <S>
    	      Selection prompt used within a select loop.  It is expanded in the same way as PS1.
    	      The default is `?# '.
    
           PS4 <S>
    	      The execution trace prompt.  Default is `+%N:%i> ', which displays the name of  the
    	      current shell structure and the line number within it.  In sh or ksh emulation, the
    	      default is `+ '.
    
           psvar <S> <Z> (PSVAR <S>)
    	      An array (colon-separated list) whose elements can be used in PROMPT strings.  Set‐
    	      ting psvar also sets PSVAR, and vice versa.
    
           READNULLCMD <S>
    	      The  command name to assume if a single input redirection is specified with no com‐
    	      mand.  Defaults to more.
    
           REPORTTIME
    	      If nonnegative, commands whose combined user and system execution  times	(measured
    	      in  seconds)  are  greater than this value have timing statistics printed for them.
    	      Output is suppressed for commands executed within the line editor,  including  com‐
    	      pletion;	commands  explicitly marked with the time keyword still cause the summary
    	      to be printed in this case.
    
           REPLY  This parameter is reserved by  convention  to  pass  string  values  between  shell
    	      scripts  and  shell builtins in situations where a function call or redirection are
    	      impossible or undesirable.  The read builtin and the select complex command may set
    	      REPLY,  and  filename  generation  both sets and examines its value when evaluating
    	      certain expressions.  Some modules also employ REPLY for similar purposes.
    
           reply  As REPLY, but for array values rather than strings.
    
           RPROMPT <S>
           RPS1 <S>
    	      This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side of  the  screen  when  the  primary
    	      prompt  is  being displayed on the left.	This does not work if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
    	      option is set.  It is expanded in the same way as PS1.
    
           RPROMPT2 <S>
           RPS2 <S>
    	      This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side of the screen  when  the	secondary
    	      prompt  is  being displayed on the left.	This does not work if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
    	      option is set.  It is expanded in the same way as PS2.
    
           SAVEHIST
    	      The maximum number of history events to save in the history file.
    
    	      If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but  may  be  explicitly  set
    	      locally.
    
           SPROMPT <S>
    	      The  prompt  used for spelling correction.  The sequence `%R' expands to the string
    	      which presumably needs spelling correction, and `%r' expands to the  proposed  cor‐
    	      rection.	All other prompt escapes are also allowed.
    
           STTY   If  this	parameter is set in a command's environment, the shell runs the stty com‐
    	      mand with the value of this parameter as arguments in order to set up the  terminal
    	      before  executing  the  command. The modes apply only to the command, and are reset
    	      when it finishes or is suspended. If the command is suspended and  continued  later
    	      with the fg or wait builtins it will see the modes specified by STTY, as if it were
    	      not suspended.  This (intentionally) does not apply if the command is continued via
    	      `kill -CONT'.  STTY is ignored if the command is run in the background, or if it is
    	      in the environment of the shell but not explicitly assigned to in the  input  line.
    	      This  avoids  running  stty at every external command by accidentally exporting it.
    	      Also note that STTY should not be used for window size specifications;  these  will
    	      not be local to the command.
    
           TERM <S>
    	      The  type  of terminal in use.  This is used when looking up termcap sequences.  An
    	      assignment to TERM causes zsh to re-initialize the terminal, even if the value does
    	      not  change  (e.g., `TERM=$TERM').  It is necessary to make such an assignment upon
    	      any change to the terminal definition database or terminal type in  order  for  the
    	      new settings to take effect.
    
           TERMINFO <S>
    	      A  reference  to	a  compiled  description  of the terminal, used by the `terminfo'
    	      library when the system has it; see terminfo(5).	If set, this causes the shell  to
    	      reinitialise the terminal, making the workaround `TERM=$TERM' unnecessary.
    
           TIMEFMT
    	      The  format  of process time reports with the time keyword.  The default is `%J  %U
    	      user %S system %P cpu %*E  total'.   Recognizes  the  following  escape  sequences,
    	      although	not  all may be available on all systems, and some that are available may
    	      not be useful:
    
    	      %%     A `%'.
    	      %U     CPU seconds spent in user mode.
    	      %S     CPU seconds spent in kernel mode.
    	      %E     Elapsed time in seconds.
    	      %P     The CPU percentage, computed as 100*(%U+%S)/%E.
    	      %W     Number of times the process was swapped.
    	      %X     The average amount in (shared) text space used in kilobytes.
    	      %D     The average amount in (unshared) data/stack space used in kilobytes.
    	      %K     The total space used (%X+%D) in kilobytes.
    	      %M     The  maximum memory the process had in use at any time in megabytes.
    	      %F     The number of major page faults (page needed to be brought from disk).
    	      %R     The number of minor page faults.
    	      %I     The number of input operations.
    	      %O     The number of output operations.
    	      %r     The number of socket messages received.
    	      %s     The number of socket messages sent.
    	      %k     The number of signals received.
    	      %w     Number of voluntary context switches (waits).
    	      %c     Number of involuntary context switches.
    	      %J     The name of this job.
    
    	      A star may be inserted between the percent sign  and  flags  printing  time.   This
    	      cause  the  time to be printed in `hh:mm:ss.ttt' format (hours and minutes are only
    	      printed if they are not zero).
    
           TMOUT  If this parameter is nonzero, the shell will receive an ALRM signal if a command is
    	      not entered within the specified number of seconds after issuing a prompt. If there
    	      is a trap on SIGALRM, it will be executed and a new alarm is  scheduled  using  the
    	      value  of the TMOUT parameter after executing the trap.  If no trap is set, and the
    	      idle time of the terminal is not less than the value of the  TMOUT  parameter,  zsh
    	      terminates.   Otherwise  a  new  alarm is scheduled to TMOUT seconds after the last
    	      keypress.
    
           TMPPREFIX
    	      A pathname prefix which the shell will use for all temporary files.  Note that this
    	      should  include  an  initial part for the file name as well as any directory names.
    	      The default is `/tmp/zsh'.
    
           watch <S> <Z> (WATCH <S>)
    	      An array (colon-separated list) of login/logout events to report.
    
    	      If it contains the single word `all', then all login/logout  events  are	reported.
    	      If  it contains the single word `notme', then all events are reported as with `all'
    	      except $USERNAME.
    
    	      An entry in this list may consist of a username, an `@' followed by a remote  host‐
    	      name,  and  a `%' followed by a line (tty).  Any of these may be a pattern (be sure
    	      to quote this during the assignment to watch so that it does not	immediately  per‐
    	      form  file  generation); the setting of the EXTENDED_GLOB option is respected.  Any
    	      or all of these components may be present in an  entry;  if  a  login/logout  event
    	      matches all of them, it is reported.
    
    	      For example, with the EXTENDED_GLOB option set, the following:
    
    		     watch=('^(pws|barts)')
    
    	      causes reports for activity assoicated with any user other than pws or barts.
    
           WATCHFMT
    	      The  format  of login/logout reports if the watch parameter is set.  Default is `%n
    	      has %a %l from %m'.  Recognizes the following escape sequences:
    
    	      %n     The name of the user that logged in/out.
    
    	      %a     The observed action, i.e. "logged on" or "logged off".
    
    	      %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on.
    
    	      %M     The full hostname of the remote host.
    
    	      %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.	If only the IP address	is  available  or
    		     the  utmp field contains the name of an X-windows display, the whole name is
    		     printed.
    
    		     NOTE: The `%m' and `%M' escapes will work only if there is a host name field
    		     in  the  utmp  on	your  machine.	 Otherwise  they  are treated as ordinary
    		     strings.
    
    	      %S (%s)
    		     Start (stop) standout mode.
    
    	      %U (%u)
    		     Start (stop) underline mode.
    
    	      %B (%b)
    		     Start (stop) boldface mode.
    
    	      %t
    	      %@     The time, in 12-hour, am/pm format.
    
    	      %T     The time, in 24-hour format.
    
    	      %w     The date in `day-dd' format.
    
    	      %W     The date in `mm/dd/yy' format.
    
    	      %D     The date in `yy-mm-dd' format.
    
    	      %D{string}
    		     The date formatted as string using the strftime function,	with  zsh  exten‐
    		     sions as described by EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).
    
    	      %(x:true-text:false-text)
    		     Specifies a ternary expression.  The character following the x is arbitrary;
    		     the same character is used to separate the text for the "true"  result  from
    		     that  for	the "false" result.  Both the separator and the right parenthesis
    		     may be escaped with a backslash.  Ternary expressions may be nested.
    
    		     The test character x may be any one of `l', `n', `m' or `M', which  indicate
    		     a	`true'	result	if  the  corresponding	escape	sequence  would  return a
    		     non-empty value; or it may be `a', which indicates a `true'  result  if  the
    		     watched  user has logged in, or `false' if he has logged out.  Other charac‐
    		     ters evaluate to neither true nor false; the entire expression is omitted in
    		     this case.
    
    		     If  the  result  is `true', then the true-text is formatted according to the
    		     rules above and printed, and the false-text is  skipped.	If  `false',  the
    		     true-text is skipped and the false-text is formatted and printed.	Either or
    		     both of the branches may be empty, but both separators must  be  present  in
    		     any case.
    
           WORDCHARS <S>
    	      A list of non-alphanumeric characters considered part of a word by the line editor.
    
           ZBEEP  If  set, this gives a string of characters, which can use all the same codes as the
    	      bindkey command as described in the zsh/zle module  entry  in  zshmodules(1),  that
    	      will be output to the terminal instead of beeping.  This may have a visible instead
    	      of an audible effect; for example, the string `\e[?5h\e[?5l' on a  vt100	or  xterm
    	      will  have  the  effect  of  flashing  reverse video on and off (if you usually use
    	      reverse video, you should use  the  string  `\e[?5l\e[?5h'  instead).   This  takes
    	      precedence over the NOBEEP option.
    
           ZDOTDIR
    	      The directory to search for shell startup files (.zshrc, etc), if not $HOME.
    
           zle_bracketed_paste
    	      Many  terminal  emulators  have a feature that allows applications to identify when
    	      text is pasted into the terminal rather than being typed normally.  For  ZLE,  this
    	      means  that special characters such as tabs and newlines can be inserted instead of
    	      invoking editor commands.  Furthermore, pasted text forms a single undo  event  and
    	      if the region is active, pasted text will replace the region.
    
    	      This two-element array contains the terminal escape sequences for enabling and dis‐
    	      abling the feature. These escape sequences are used to enable bracketed paste  when
    	      ZLE  is  active  and  disable  it  at other times.  Unsetting the parameter has the
    	      effect of ensuring that bracketed paste remains disabled.
    
           zle_highlight
    	      An array describing contexts in which ZLE should highlight  the  input  text.   See
    	      Character Highlighting in zshzle(1).
    
           ZLE_LINE_ABORTED
    	      This  parameter  is  set	by the line editor when an error occurs.  It contains the
    	      line  that  was  being  edited  at  the  point  of  the  error.	`print	 -zr   --
    	      $ZLE_LINE_ABORTED'  can  be used to recover the line.  Only the most recent line of
    	      this kind is remembered.
    
           ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS
           ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS
    	      These parameters are used by the line editor.  In  certain  circumstances  suffixes
    	      (typically space or slash) added by the completion system will be removed automati‐
    	      cally, either because the next editing command was not an insertable character,  or
    	      because the character was marked as requiring the suffix to be removed.
    
    	      These variables can contain the sets of characters that will cause the suffix to be
    	      removed.	If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set, those characters will cause the suffix
    	      to  be  removed;	if ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set, those characters will cause the
    	      suffix to be removed and replaced by a space.
    
    	      If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is not set, the default behaviour is equivalent to:
    
    		     ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$' \t\n;&|'
    
    	      If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set but is empty, no characters have this  behaviour.
    	      ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS takes precedence, so that the following:
    
    		     ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$'&|'
    
    	      causes  the  characters  `&'  and `|' to remove the suffix but to replace it with a
    	      space.
    
    	      To illustrate the difference, suppose  that  the	option	AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH  is  in
    	      effect and the directory DIR has just been completed, with an appended /, following
    	      which the user types `&'.  The default  result  is  `DIR&'.   With  ZLE_REMOVE_SUF‐
    	      FIX_CHARS set but without including `&' the result is `DIR/&'.  With ZLE_SPACE_SUF‐
    	      FIX_CHARS set to include `&' the result is `DIR &'.
    
    	      Note that certain completions may provide their own suffix removal  or  replacement
    	      behaviour  which	overrides  the	values described here.	See the completion system
    	      documentation in zshcompsys(1).
    
           ZLE_RPROMPT_INDENT <S>
    	      If set, used to give the indentation between the	right  hand  side  of  the  right
    	      prompt  in  the  line editor as given by RPS1 or RPROMPT and the right hand side of
    	      the screen.  If not set, the value 1 is used.
    
    	      Typically this will be used to set the value to 0 so that the prompt appears  flush
    	      with  the right hand side of the screen.	This is not the default as many terminals
    	      do not handle this correctly, in particular when the prompt appears at the  extreme
    	      bottom  right  of  the  screen.  Recent virtual terminals are more likely to handle
    	      this case correctly.  Some experimentation is necessary.
    
    ZSHOPTIONS(1)			     General Commands Manual			    ZSHOPTIONS(1)
    
    NAME
           zshoptions - zsh options
    
    SPECIFYING OPTIONS
           Options are primarily referred to by name.  These names are case  insensitive  and  under‐
           scores are ignored.  For example, `allexport' is equivalent to `A__lleXP_ort'.
    
           The sense of an option name may be inverted by preceding it with `no', so `setopt No_Beep'
           is equivalent to `unsetopt beep'.  This inversion can only be done once, so `nonobeep'  is
           not  a  synonym for `beep'.  Similarly, `tify' is not a synonym for `nonotify' (the inver‐
           sion of `notify').
    
           Some options also have one or more single letter names.	There are two sets of single let‐
           ter  options:  one  used  by  default,  and  another used to emulate sh/ksh (used when the
           SH_OPTION_LETTERS option is set).  The single letter options can be used on the shell com‐
           mand  line, or with the set, setopt and unsetopt builtins, as normal Unix options preceded
           by `-'.
    
           The sense of the single letter options may be inverted by using `+' instead of `-'.   Some
           of  the	single letter option names refer to an option being off, in which case the inver‐
           sion of that name refers to the option being on.  For example, `+n' is the short  name  of
           `exec', and `-n' is the short name of its inversion, `noexec'.
    
           In  strings of single letter options supplied to the shell at startup, trailing whitespace
           will be ignored; for example the string `-f    ' will be treated just  as  `-f',  but  the
           string  `-f  i' is an error.  This is because many systems which implement the `#!' mecha‐
           nism for calling scripts do not strip trailing whitespace.
    
    DESCRIPTION OF OPTIONS
           In the following list, options set by default in all emulations are marked <D>; those  set
           by default only in csh, ksh, sh, or zsh emulations are marked <C>, <K>, <S>, <Z> as appro‐
           priate.	When listing options (by `setopt', `unsetopt',	`set  -o'  or  `set  +o'),  those
           turned	on   by   default   appear  in	the  list  prefixed  with  `no'.   Hence  (unless
           KSH_OPTION_PRINT is set), `setopt' shows all options whose settings are changed	from  the
           default.
    
       Changing Directories
           AUTO_CD (-J)
    	      If  a command is issued that can't be executed as a normal command, and the command
    	      is the name of a directory, perform the cd command to that directory.  This  option
    	      is only applicable if the option SHIN_STDIN is set, i.e. if commands are being read
    	      from standard input.  The option is designed for interactive use; it is recommended
    	      that cd be used explicitly in scripts to avoid ambiguity.
    
           AUTO_PUSHD (-N)
    	      Make cd push the old directory onto the directory stack.
    
           CDABLE_VARS (-T)
    	      If  the  argument to a cd command (or an implied cd with the AUTO_CD option set) is
    	      not a directory, and does not begin with a slash, try to expand the  expression  as
    	      if it were preceded by a `~' (see the section `Filename Expansion').
    
           CHASE_DOTS
    	      When  changing  to a directory containing a path segment `..' which would otherwise
    	      be treated as canceling the previous segment in the path (in other words,  `foo/..'
    	      would  be removed from the path, or if `..' is the first part of the path, the last
    	      part of the current working directory would be removed), instead resolve	the  path
    	      to the physical directory.  This option is overridden by CHASE_LINKS.
    
    	      For  example,  suppose  /foo/bar is a link to the directory /alt/rod.  Without this
    	      option set, `cd /foo/bar/..' changes to /foo; with it set, it changes to /alt.  The
    	      same  applies  if the current directory is /foo/bar and `cd ..' is used.	Note that
    	      all other symbolic links in the path will also be resolved.
    
           CHASE_LINKS (-w)
    	      Resolve symbolic links to their true values when changing directory.  This also has
    	      the  effect of CHASE_DOTS, i.e. a `..' path segment will be treated as referring to
    	      the physical parent, even if the preceding path segment is a symbolic link.
    
           POSIX_CD <K> <S>
    	      Modifies the behaviour of cd, chdir and pushd commands to make them more compatible
    	      with  the  POSIX	standard. The behaviour with the option unset is described in the
    	      documentation for the cd builtin in zshbuiltins(1).  If  the  option  is	set,  the
    	      shell  does  not test for directories beneath the local directory (`.') until after
    	      all directories in cdpath have been tested.
    
    	      Also, if the option is set, the conditions under which the  shell  prints  the  new
    	      directory  after changing to it are modified.  It is no longer restricted to inter‐
    	      active shells (although printing of the directory stack with pushd is still limited
    	      to  interactive  shells); and any use of a component of CDPATH, including a `.' but
    	      excluding an empty component that is otherwise treated as `.', causes the directory
    	      to be printed.
    
           PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS
    	      Don't push multiple copies of the same directory onto the directory stack.
    
           PUSHD_MINUS
    	      Exchanges  the  meanings of `+' and `-' when used with a number to specify a direc‐
    	      tory in the stack.
    
           PUSHD_SILENT (-E)
    	      Do not print the directory stack after pushd or popd.
    
           PUSHD_TO_HOME (-D)
    	      Have pushd with no arguments act like `pushd $HOME'.
    
       Completion
           ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT <D>
    	      If unset, key functions that list completions try to return to the last  prompt  if
    	      given  a	numeric argument. If set these functions try to return to the last prompt
    	      if given no numeric argument.
    
           ALWAYS_TO_END
    	      If a completion is performed with the cursor within a word, and a  full  completion
    	      is  inserted,  the  cursor is moved to the end of the word.  That is, the cursor is
    	      moved to the end of the word if either a single match is inserted or  menu  comple‐
    	      tion is performed.
    
           AUTO_LIST (-9) <D>
    	      Automatically list choices on an ambiguous completion.
    
           AUTO_MENU <D>
    	      Automatically  use menu completion after the second consecutive request for comple‐
    	      tion, for example by pressing the tab key repeatedly. This option is overridden  by
    	      MENU_COMPLETE.
    
           AUTO_NAME_DIRS
    	      Any parameter that is set to the absolute name of a directory immediately becomes a
    	      name for that directory,	that  will  be	used  by  the  `%~'  and  related  prompt
    	      sequences,  and  will  be available when completion is performed on a word starting
    	      with `~'.  (Otherwise, the parameter must be used in the form `~param' first.)
    
           AUTO_PARAM_KEYS <D>
    	      If a parameter name was completed and a  following  character  (normally	a  space)
    	      automatically  inserted,	and the next character typed is one of those that have to
    	      come directly after the name (like `}', `:', etc.), the automatically added charac‐
    	      ter  is  deleted, so that the character typed comes immediately after the parameter
    	      name.  Completion in a brace expansion is affected similarly: the  added	character
    	      is a `,', which will be removed if `}' is typed next.
    
           AUTO_PARAM_SLASH <D>
    	      If  a  parameter	is completed whose content is the name of a directory, then add a
    	      trailing slash instead of a space.
    
           AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH <D>
    	      When the last character resulting from a completion is a slash and the next charac‐
    	      ter typed is a word delimiter, a slash, or a character that ends a command (such as
    	      a semicolon or an ampersand), remove the slash.
    
           BASH_AUTO_LIST
    	      On an ambiguous completion, automatically list choices when the completion function
    	      is  called twice in succession.  This takes precedence over AUTO_LIST.  The setting
    	      of LIST_AMBIGUOUS is respected.  If AUTO_MENU is set, the menu behaviour will  then
    	      start with the third press.  Note that this will not work with MENU_COMPLETE, since
    	      repeated completion calls immediately cycle through the list in that case.
    
           COMPLETE_ALIASES
    	      Prevents aliases on the command line from being internally substituted before  com‐
    	      pletion  is attempted.  The effect is to make the alias a distinct command for com‐
    	      pletion purposes.
    
           COMPLETE_IN_WORD
    	      If unset, the cursor is set to the end of the word if completion is started. Other‐
    	      wise it stays there and completion is done from both ends.
    
           GLOB_COMPLETE
    	      When  the  current  word	has a glob pattern, do not insert all the words resulting
    	      from the expansion but generate matches as for completion and  cycle  through  them
    	      like  MENU_COMPLETE.  The matches are generated as if a `*' was added to the end of
    	      the word, or inserted at the cursor when COMPLETE_IN_WORD is  set.   This  actually
    	      uses  pattern  matching,	not  globbing, so it works not only for files but for any
    	      completion, such as options, user names, etc.
    
    	      Note that when  the  pattern  matcher  is  used,	matching  control  (for  example,
    	      case-insensitive	or  anchored  matching)  cannot  be  used.   This limitation only
    	      applies when the current word contains a pattern; simply turning on  the	GLOB_COM‐
    	      PLETE option does not have this effect.
    
           HASH_LIST_ALL <D>
    	      Whenever	a  command  completion or spelling correction is attempted, make sure the
    	      entire command path is hashed first.  This makes the first  completion  slower  but
    	      avoids false reports of spelling errors.
    
           LIST_AMBIGUOUS <D>
    	      This  option  works  when  AUTO_LIST or BASH_AUTO_LIST is also set.  If there is an
    	      unambiguous prefix to insert on the command line, that is done without a completion
    	      list  being displayed; in other words, auto-listing behaviour only takes place when
    	      nothing would be inserted.  In the case of BASH_AUTO_LIST, this means that the list
    	      will be delayed to the third call of the function.
    
           LIST_BEEP <D>
    	      Beep  on an ambiguous completion.  More accurately, this forces the completion wid‐
    	      gets to return status 1 on an ambiguous completion, which causes the shell to  beep
    	      if the option BEEP is also set; this may be modified if completion is called from a
    	      user-defined widget.
    
           LIST_PACKED
    	      Try to make the completion list smaller (occupying  less	lines)	by  printing  the
    	      matches in columns with different widths.
    
           LIST_ROWS_FIRST
    	      Lay  out	the  matches in completion lists sorted horizontally, that is, the second
    	      match is to the right of the first one, not under it as usual.
    
           LIST_TYPES (-X) <D>
    	      When listing files that are possible completions, show the type of each file with a
    	      trailing identifying mark.
    
           MENU_COMPLETE (-Y)
    	      On an ambiguous completion, instead of listing possibilities or beeping, insert the
    	      first match immediately.	Then when completion is requested again, remove the first
    	      match and insert the second match, etc.  When there are no more matches, go back to
    	      the first one again.  reverse-menu-complete may be used to loop through the list in
    	      the other direction. This option overrides AUTO_MENU.
    
           REC_EXACT (-S)
    	      In completion, recognize exact matches even if they are ambiguous.
    
       Expansion and Globbing
           BAD_PATTERN (+2) <C> <Z>
    	      If  a pattern for filename generation is badly formed, print an error message.  (If
    	      this option is unset, the pattern will be left unchanged.)
    
           BARE_GLOB_QUAL <Z>
    	      In a glob pattern, treat a trailing set of parentheses as a qualifier list,  if  it
    	      contains	no  `|',  `('  or (if special) `~' characters.	See the section `Filename
    	      Generation'.
    
           BRACE_CCL
    	      Expand expressions in braces which would not otherwise undergo brace expansion to a
    	      lexically ordered list of all the characters.  See the section `Brace Expansion'.
    
           CASE_GLOB <D>
    	      Make  globbing  (filename  generation)  sensitive to case.  Note that other uses of
    	      patterns are always sensitive to case.  If the option is unset, the presence of any
    	      character  which	is  special  to  filename  generation will cause case-insensitive
    	      matching.  For example, cvs(/) can match the directory CVS owing to the presence of
    	      the globbing flag (unless the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is unset).
    
           CASE_MATCH <D>
    	      Make  regular  expressions  using  the zsh/regex module (including matches with =~)
    	      sensitive to case.
    
           CSH_NULL_GLOB <C>
    	      If a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the  pattern	from  the
    	      argument	list; do not report an error unless all the patterns in a command have no
    	      matches.	Overrides NOMATCH.
    
           EQUALS <Z>
    	      Perform = filename expansion.  (See the section `Filename Expansion'.)
    
           EXTENDED_GLOB
    	      Treat the `#', `~' and `^' characters as part of patterns for filename  generation,
    	      etc.  (An initial unquoted `~' always produces named directory expansion.)
    
           FORCE_FLOAT
    	      Constants  in  arithmetic evaluation will be treated as floating point even without
    	      the use of a decimal point; the values of integer variables will	be  converted  to
    	      floating	point  when used in arithmetic expressions.  Integers in any base will be
    	      converted.
    
           GLOB (+F, ksh: +f) <D>
    	      Perform filename generation (globbing).  (See the section `Filename Generation'.)
    
           GLOB_ASSIGN <C>
    	      If this option is set, filename generation (globbing) is	performed  on  the  right
    	      hand side of scalar parameter assignments of the form `name=pattern (e.g. `foo=*').
    	      If the result has more than one word the parameter will become an array with  those
    	      words as arguments. This option is provided for backwards compatibility only: glob‐
    	      bing is always performed on the right hand side of array assignments  of	the  form
    	      `name=(value)' (e.g. `foo=(*)') and this form is recommended for clarity; with this
    	      option set, it is not possible to predict whether the result will be an array or	a
    	      scalar.
    
           GLOB_DOTS (-4)
    	      Do not require a leading `.' in a filename to be matched explicitly.
    
           GLOB_SUBST <C> <K> <S>
    	      Treat any characters resulting from parameter expansion as being eligible for file‐
    	      name expansion and filename generation, and any characters resulting  from  command
    	      substitution  as	being  eligible  for  filename generation.  Braces (and commas in
    	      between) do not become eligible for expansion.
    
           HIST_SUBST_PATTERN
    	      Substitutions using the :s and :& history  modifiers  are  performed  with  pattern
    	      matching	instead  of  string matching.  This occurs wherever history modifiers are
    	      valid, including glob qualifiers and parameters.	See the section Modifiers in zsh‐
    	      expn(1).
    
           IGNORE_BRACES (-I) <S>
    	      Do  not  perform	brace  expansion.   For historical reasons this also includes the
    	      effect of the IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option.
    
           IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES
    	      When neither this option nor IGNORE_BRACES is set, a sole close brace character `}'
    	      is  syntactically  significant at any point on a command line.  This has the effect
    	      that no semicolon or newline is necessary before the brace terminating  a  function
    	      or  current shell construct.  When either option is set, a closing brace is syntac‐
    	      tically significant only in command position.  Unlike  IGNORE_BRACES,  this  option
    	      does not disable brace expansion.
    
    	      For  example,  with  both  options unset a function may be defined in the following
    	      fashion:
    
    		     args() { echo $# }
    
    	      while if either option is set, this does not work and something equivalent  to  the
    	      following is required:
    
    		     args() { echo $#; }
    
           KSH_GLOB <K>
    	      In  pattern  matching, the interpretation of parentheses is affected by a preceding
    	      `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  See the section `Filename Generation'.
    
           MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST
    	      All unquoted arguments of the form `anything=expression' appearing after	the  com‐
    	      mand  name  have filename expansion (that is, where expression has a leading `~' or
    	      `=') performed on expression as if it were a parameter assignment.  The argument is
    	      not  otherwise treated specially; it is passed to the command as a single argument,
    	      and  not	used  as  an  actual  parameter  assignment.   For   example,	in   echo
    	      foo=~/bar:~/rod,	both  occurrences of ~ would be replaced.  Note that this happens
    	      anyway with typeset and similar statements.
    
    	      This option respects the setting of the KSH_TYPESET option.   In	other  words,  if
    	      both  options  are  in  effect, arguments looking like assignments will not undergo
    	      word splitting.
    
           MARK_DIRS (-8, ksh: -X)
    	      Append a trailing `/' to all directory names  resulting  from  filename  generation
    	      (globbing).
    
           MULTIBYTE <D>
    	      Respect  multibyte  characters  when  found  in  strings.  When this option is set,
    	      strings are examined using the system library to determine how many  bytes  form	a
    	      character,  depending  on  the current locale.  This affects the way characters are
    	      counted in pattern matching, parameter values and various delimiters.
    
    	      The option is on by default if the shell was compiled with MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT;  oth‐
    	      erwise it is off by default and has no effect if turned on.
    
    	      If  the  option is off a single byte is always treated as a single character.  This
    	      setting is designed purely for examining strings known  to  contain  raw	bytes  or
    	      other values that may not be characters in the current locale.  It is not necessary
    	      to unset the option merely because the character set for the  current  locale  does
    	      not contain multibyte characters.
    
    	      The  option  does  not  affect the shell's editor,  which always uses the locale to
    	      determine multibyte characters.  This is because the character set displayed by the
    	      terminal emulator is independent of shell settings.
    
           NOMATCH (+3) <C> <Z>
    	      If  a  pattern  for  filename generation has no matches, print an error, instead of
    	      leaving it unchanged in the argument list.  This also applies to file expansion  of
    	      an initial `~' or `='.
    
           NULL_GLOB (-G)
    	      If  a  pattern  for filename generation has no matches, delete the pattern from the
    	      argument list instead of reporting an error.  Overrides NOMATCH.
    
           NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT
    	      If numeric filenames are matched by a filename generation pattern, sort  the  file‐
    	      names numerically rather than lexicographically.
    
           RC_EXPAND_PARAM (-P)
    	      Array  expansions  of the form `foo${xx}bar', where the parameter xx is set to (a b
    	      c), are substituted with `fooabar foobbar foocbar' instead of the default  `fooa	b
    	      cbar'.  Note that an empty array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.
    
           REMATCH_PCRE <Z>
    	      If  set,	regular expression matching with the =~ operator will use Perl-Compatible
    	      Regular Expressions from the PCRE library,  if  available.   If  not  set,  regular
    	      expressions will use the extended regexp syntax provided by the system libraries.
    
           SH_GLOB <K> <S>
    	      Disables	the  special  meaning of `(', `|', `)' and '<' for globbing the result of
    	      parameter and command substitutions, and in  some  other	places	where  the  shell
    	      accepts  patterns.   If  SH_GLOB	is  set but KSH_GLOB is not, the shell allows the
    	      interpretation of subshell expressions enclosed in parentheses in some cases  where
    	      there is no space before the opening parenthesis, e.g. !(true) is interpreted as if
    	      there were a space after the !.  This option is set by default if zsh is invoked as
    	      sh or ksh.
    
           UNSET (+u, ksh: +u) <K> <S> <Z>
    	      Treat unset parameters as if they were empty when substituting.  Otherwise they are
    	      treated as an error.
    
           WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL
    	      Print a warning message when a global parameter is created  in  a  function  by  an
    	      assignment.  This often indicates that a parameter has not been declared local when
    	      it should have been.  Parameters explicitly declared global from within a  function
    	      using  typeset  -g  do  not  cause a warning.  Note that there is no warning when a
    	      local parameter is assigned to in a nested function, which  may  also  indicate  an
    	      error.
    
       History
           APPEND_HISTORY <D>
    	      If  this	is  set, zsh sessions will append their history list to the history file,
    	      rather than replace it. Thus, multiple parallel zsh sessions will all have the  new
    	      entries  from their history lists added to the history file, in the order that they
    	      exit.  The file will still be periodically re-written to trim it when the number of
    	      lines   grows   20%   beyond  the  value	specified  by  $SAVEHIST  (see	also  the
    	      HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).
    
           BANG_HIST (+K) <C> <Z>
    	      Perform textual history expansion, csh-style, treating the character `!' specially.
    
           EXTENDED_HISTORY <C>
    	      Save each command's beginning timestamp (in seconds since the epoch) and the  dura‐
    	      tion (in seconds) to the history file.  The format of this prefixed data is:
    
    	      `: <beginning time>:<elapsed seconds>;<command>'.
    
           HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER
    	      Add  `|'	to output redirections in the history.	This allows history references to
    	      clobber files even when CLOBBER is unset.
    
           HIST_BEEP <D>
    	      Beep in ZLE when a widget attempts to access a history entry which isn't there.
    
           HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST
    	      If the internal history needs to be trimmed to add the current command  line,  set‐
    	      ting  this  option  will	cause the oldest history event that has a duplicate to be
    	      lost before losing a unique event from the list.	You should be  sure  to  set  the
    	      value  of  HISTSIZE to a larger number than SAVEHIST in order to give you some room
    	      for  the	duplicated  events,  otherwise	this  option  will   behave   just   like
    	      HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS once the history fills up with unique events.
    
           HIST_FCNTL_LOCK
    	      When writing out the history file, by default zsh uses ad-hoc file locking to avoid
    	      known problems with locking on some operating systems.  With this option locking is
    	      done  by	means  of  the	system's  fcntl call, where this method is available.  On
    	      recent operating systems this may provide better performance, in particular  avoid‐
    	      ing history corruption when files are stored on NFS.
    
           HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS
    	      When searching for history entries in the line editor, do not display duplicates of
    	      a line previously found, even if the duplicates are not contiguous.
    
           HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS
    	      If a new command line being added to the history list duplicates an older one,  the
    	      older command is removed from the list (even if it is not the previous event).
    
           HIST_IGNORE_DUPS (-h)
    	      Do not enter command lines into the history list if they are duplicates of the pre‐
    	      vious event.
    
           HIST_IGNORE_SPACE (-g)
    	      Remove command lines from the history list when the first character on the line  is
    	      a space, or when one of the expanded aliases contains a leading space.  Only normal
    	      aliases (not global or suffix aliases) have this behaviour.  Note that the  command
    	      lingers  in  the	internal history until the next command is entered before it van‐
    	      ishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or edit the line.  If you want to make it van‐
    	      ish right away without entering another command, type a space and press return.
    
           HIST_LEX_WORDS
    	      By  default,  shell  history  that is read in from files is split into words on all
    	      white space.  This means that arguments with quoted whitespace  are  not	correctly
    	      handled,	with  the consequence that references to words in history lines that have
    	      been read from a file may be inaccurate.	When this option is set,  words  read  in
    	      from  a  history	file  are divided up in a similar fashion to normal shell command
    	      line handling.  Although this produces more accurately delimited words, if the size
    	      of  the  history	file  is large this can be slow.  Trial and error is necessary to
    	      decide.
    
           HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS
    	      Remove function definitions from the history list.  Note that the function  lingers
    	      in  the  internal  history  until  the  next command is entered before it vanishes,
    	      allowing you to briefly reuse or edit the definition.
    
           HIST_NO_STORE
    	      Remove the history (fc -l) command from the history list when invoked.   Note  that
    	      the  command  lingers  in  the  internal	history until the next command is entered
    	      before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or edit the line.
    
           HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
    	      Remove superfluous blanks from each command line being added to the history list.
    
           HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY <D>
    	      When the history file is re-written, we normally write out a copy of the file named
    	      $HISTFILE.new  and  then	rename	it  over the old one.  However, if this option is
    	      unset, we instead truncate the old history file  and  write  out	the  new  version
    	      in-place.  If one of the history-appending options is enabled, this option only has
    	      an effect when the enlarged history file needs to be re-written to trim it down  to
    	      size.   Disable  this only if you have special needs, as doing so makes it possible
    	      to lose history entries if zsh gets interrupted during the save.
    
    	      When writing out a copy of the history file, zsh preserves the old  file's  permis‐
    	      sions  and  group  information, but will refuse to write out a new file if it would
    	      change the history file's owner.
    
           HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS
    	      When writing out the history file, older commands that  duplicate  newer	ones  are
    	      omitted.
    
           HIST_VERIFY
    	      Whenever	the  user  enters  a  line with history expansion, don't execute the line
    	      directly; instead, perform history expansion and reload the line into  the  editing
    	      buffer.
    
           INC_APPEND_HISTORY
    	      This  options  works like APPEND_HISTORY except that new history lines are added to
    	      the $HISTFILE incrementally (as soon as they  are  entered),  rather  than  waiting
    	      until  the  shell exits.	The file will still be periodically re-written to trim it
    	      when the number of lines grows 20% beyond the value  specified  by  $SAVEHIST  (see
    	      also the HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).
    
           INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME
    	      This  option  is a variant of INC_APPEND_HISTORY in which, where possible, the his‐
    	      tory entry is written out to the file after the command is finished,  so	that  the
    	      time   taken  by	the  command  is  recorded  correctly  in  the	history  file  in
    	      EXTENDED_HISTORY format.	This means that the history entry will not  be	available
    	      immediately from other instances of the shell that are using the same history file.
    
    	      This  option is only useful if INC_APPEND_HISTORY and SHARE_HISTORY are turned off.
    	      The three options should be considered mutually exclusive.
    
           SHARE_HISTORY <K>
    
    	      This option both imports new commands from the history file, and also  causes  your
    	      typed  commands  to  be appended to the history file (the latter is like specifying
    	      INC_APPEND_HISTORY, which should be turned off if this option is in  effect).   The
    	      history  lines are also output with timestamps ala EXTENDED_HISTORY (which makes it
    	      easier to find the spot where we left off reading the file after it  gets  re-writ‐
    	      ten).
    
    	      By default, history movement commands visit the imported lines as well as the local
    	      lines, but you can toggle this on and off with the set-local-history  zle  binding.
    	      It  is  also  possible  to  create a zle widget that will make some commands ignore
    	      imported commands, and some include them.
    
    	      If you find that you want more control over when commands  get  imported,  you  may
    	      wish  to turn SHARE_HISTORY off, INC_APPEND_HISTORY or INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME (see
    	      above) on, and then manually import commands whenever you need them using `fc -RI'.
    
       Initialisation
           ALL_EXPORT (-a, ksh: -a)
    	      All parameters subsequently defined are automatically exported.
    
           GLOBAL_EXPORT <Z>
    	      If this option is set, passing the -x flag to the builtins declare, float, integer,
    	      readonly	and  typeset (but not local) will also set the -g flag;  hence parameters
    	      exported to the environment will not be  made  local  to	the  enclosing	function,
    	      unless  they  were  already  or  the flag +g is given explicitly.  If the option is
    	      unset, exported parameters will be made local in just the same  way  as  any  other
    	      parameter.
    
    	      This  option  is	set  by default for backward compatibility; it is not recommended
    	      that its behaviour be relied upon.  Note that the builtin export always  sets  both
    	      the -x and -g flags, and hence its effect extends beyond the scope of the enclosing
    	      function; this is the most portable way to achieve this behaviour.
    
           GLOBAL_RCS (-d) <D>
    	      If this option is unset, the startup files /etc/zprofile,  /etc/zshrc,  /etc/zlogin
    	      and  /etc/zlogout  will not be run.  It can be disabled and re-enabled at any time,
    	      including inside local startup files (.zshrc, etc.).
    
           RCS (+f) <D>
    	      After /etc/zshenv is sourced on startup, source the .zshenv, /etc/zprofile,  .zpro‐
    	      file, /etc/zshrc, .zshrc, /etc/zlogin, .zlogin, and .zlogout files, as described in
    	      the section `Files'.  If this option  is	unset,	the  /etc/zshenv  file	is  still
    	      sourced,	but  any  of the others will not be; it can be set at any time to prevent
    	      the remaining startup files after the currently executing one from being sourced.
    
       Input/Output
           ALIASES <D>
    	      Expand aliases.
    
           CLOBBER (+C, ksh: +C) <D>
    	      Allows `>' redirection to truncate existing files.  Otherwise `>!' or `>|' must  be
    	      used to truncate a file.
    
    	      If  the  option  is not set, and the option APPEND_CREATE is also not set, `>>!' or
    	      `>>|' must be used to create a file.  If either option is set, `>>' may be used.
    
           CORRECT (-0)
    	      Try to correct the spelling of commands.	Note that, when the HASH_LIST_ALL  option
    	      is  not set or when some directories in the path are not readable, this may falsely
    	      report spelling errors the first time some commands are used.
    
    	      The shell variable CORRECT_IGNORE may be set to a pattern to match words that  will
    	      never be offered as corrections.
    
           CORRECT_ALL (-O)
    	      Try to correct the spelling of all arguments in a line.
    
    	      The  shell variable CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE may be set to a pattern to match file names
    	      that will never be offered as corrections.
    
           DVORAK Use the Dvorak keyboard instead of the standard qwerty  keyboard	as  a  basis  for
    	      examining  spelling  mistakes  for  the  CORRECT	and  CORRECT_ALL  options and the
    	      spell-word editor command.
    
           FLOW_CONTROL <D>
    	      If this option is unset, output flow control  via  start/stop  characters  (usually
    	      assigned to ^S/^Q) is disabled in the shell's editor.
    
           IGNORE_EOF (-7)
    	      Do  not  exit on end-of-file.  Require the use of exit or logout instead.  However,
    	      ten consecutive EOFs will cause the shell to exit anyway, to avoid the shell  hang‐
    	      ing if its tty goes away.
    
    	      Also, if this option is set and the Zsh Line Editor is used, widgets implemented by
    	      shell functions can be bound to EOF (normally Control-D) without printing the  nor‐
    	      mal  warning  message.  This works only for normal widgets, not for completion wid‐
    	      gets.
    
           INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS (-k) <K> <S>
    	      Allow comments even in interactive shells.
    
           HASH_CMDS <D>
    	      Note the location of each command the first time it is executed.	Subsequent  invo‐
    	      cations  of  the	same command will use the saved location, avoiding a path search.
    	      If this option is unset, no path hashing is done at all.	However, when CORRECT  is
    	      set, commands whose names do not appear in the functions or aliases hash tables are
    	      hashed in order to avoid reporting them as spelling errors.
    
           HASH_DIRS <D>
    	      Whenever a command name is hashed, hash the directory containing it, as well as all
    	      directories that occur earlier in the path.  Has no effect if neither HASH_CMDS nor
    	      CORRECT is set.
    
           HASH_EXECUTABLES_ONLY
    	      When hashing commands because of HASH_CMDS, check that the file  to  be  hashed  is
    	      actually	an executable.	This option is unset by default as if the path contains a
    	      large number of commands, or consists of many remote files,  the	additional  tests
    	      can  take a long time.  Trial and error is needed to show if this option is benefi‐
    	      cial.
    
           MAIL_WARNING (-U)
    	      Print a warning message if a mail file has  been	accessed  since  the  shell  last
    	      checked.
    
           PATH_DIRS (-Q)
    	      Perform  a  path	search	even  on  command  names  with	slashes in them.  Thus if
    	      `/usr/local/bin' is in the user's path, and he or she types `X11/xinit',	the  com‐
    	      mand  `/usr/local/bin/X11/xinit'	will  be executed (assuming it exists).  Commands
    	      explicitly beginning with `/', `./' or `../' are not subject to  the  path  search.
    	      This also applies to the `.' and source builtins.
    
    	      Note  that subdirectories of the current directory are always searched for executa‐
    	      bles specified in this form.  This takes place before any search indicated by  this
    	      option,  and  regardless of whether `.' or the current directory appear in the com‐
    	      mand search path.
    
           PATH_SCRIPT <K> <S>
    	      If this option is not set, a script passed as the first non-option argument to  the
    	      shell  must  contain  the name of the file to open.  If this option is set, and the
    	      script does not specify a directory path, the script is looked  for  first  in  the
    	      current directory, then in the command path.  See the section INVOCATION in zsh(1).
    
           PRINT_EIGHT_BIT
    	      Print  eight bit characters literally in completion lists, etc.  This option is not
    	      necessary if your system correctly returns the printability of eight bit characters
    	      (see ctype(3)).
    
           PRINT_EXIT_VALUE (-1)
    	      Print the exit value of programs with non-zero exit status.  This is only available
    	      at the command line in interactive shells.
    
           RC_QUOTES
    	      Allow the character sequence `''' to signify a single quote  within  singly  quoted
    	      strings.	Note this does not apply in quoted strings using the format $'...', where
    	      a backslashed single quote can be used.
    
           RM_STAR_SILENT (-H) <K> <S>
    	      Do not query the user before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*'.
    
           RM_STAR_WAIT
    	      If querying the user before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*', first wait ten seconds
    	      and  ignore  anything  typed  in that time.  This avoids the problem of reflexively
    	      answering `yes' to the query when one didn't really mean it.  The  wait  and  query
    	      can always be avoided by expanding the `*' in ZLE (with tab).
    
           SHORT_LOOPS <C> <Z>
    	      Allow the short forms of for, repeat, select, if, and function constructs.
    
           SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK (-L)
    	      If  a  line ends with a backquote, and there are an odd number of backquotes on the
    	      line, ignore the trailing backquote.  This is useful on some  keyboards  where  the
    	      return  key is too small, and the backquote key lies annoyingly close to it.  As an
    	      alternative the variable KEYBOARD_HACK lets you choose the character to be removed.
    
       Job Control
           AUTO_CONTINUE
    	      With this option set, stopped jobs that are removed from the  job  table	with  the
    	      disown builtin command are automatically sent a CONT signal to make them running.
    
           AUTO_RESUME (-W)
    	      Treat  single word simple commands without redirection as candidates for resumption
    	      of an existing job.
    
           BG_NICE (-6) <C> <Z>
    	      Run all background jobs at a lower priority.  This option is set by default.
    
           CHECK_JOBS <Z>
    	      Report the status of background and suspended jobs before exiting a shell with  job
    	      control;	a  second  attempt to exit the shell will succeed.  NO_CHECK_JOBS is best
    	      used only in combination with NO_HUP, else such jobs will be killed automatically.
    
    	      The check is omitted if the commands run from the previous command line included	a
    	      `jobs'  command, since it is assumed the user is aware that there are background or
    	      suspended jobs.  A `jobs' command run from one of the hook functions defined in the
    	      section SPECIAL FUNCTIONS in zshmisc(1) is not counted for this purpose.
    
           HUP <Z>
    	      Send the HUP signal to running jobs when the shell exits.
    
           LONG_LIST_JOBS (-R)
    	      List jobs in the long format by default.
    
           MONITOR (-m, ksh: -m)
    	      Allow job control.  Set by default in interactive shells.
    
           NOTIFY (-5, ksh: -b) <Z>
    	      Report  the  status  of background jobs immediately, rather than waiting until just
    	      before printing a prompt.
    
           POSIX_JOBS <K> <S>
    	      This option makes job control more compliant with the POSIX standard.
    
    	      When the option is not set, the MONITOR option is unset on entry to  subshells,  so
    	      that  job  control is no longer active.  When the option is set, the MONITOR option
    	      and job control remain active in the subshell, but note that the	subshell  has  no
    	      access to jobs in the parent shell.
    
    	      When  the option is not set, jobs put in the background or foreground with bg or fg
    	      are displayed with the same information that would be reported by jobs.	When  the
    	      option  is  set,	only  the  text  is  printed.  The output from jobs itself is not
    	      affected by the option.
    
    	      When the option is not set, job information from the parent shell is saved for out‐
    	      put  within  a  subshell (for example, within a pipeline).  When the option is set,
    	      the output of jobs is empty until a job is started within the subshell.
    
    	      In previous versions of the shell, it was necessary to enable POSIX_JOBS	in  order
    	      for  the	builtin  command  wait	to  return the status of background jobs that had
    	      already exited.  This is no longer the case.
    
       Prompting
           PROMPT_BANG <K>
    	      If set, `!' is treated specially in prompt  expansion.   See  EXPANSION  OF  PROMPT
    	      SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).
    
           PROMPT_CR (+V) <D>
    	      Print  a carriage return just before printing a prompt in the line editor.  This is
    	      on by default as multi-line editing is only possible if the editor knows where  the
    	      start of the line appears.
    
           PROMPT_SP <D>
    	      Attempt  to  preserve  a partial line (i.e. a line that did not end with a newline)
    	      that would otherwise be covered up by the  command  prompt  due  to  the	PROMPT_CR
    	      option.	This  works  by  outputting  some  cursor-control characters, including a
    	      series of spaces, that should make the terminal wrap to the next line when  a  par‐
    	      tial  line is present (note that this is only successful if your terminal has auto‐
    	      matic margins, which is typical).
    
    	      When a partial line is preserved, by default you will see an inverse+bold character
    	      at  the  end  of	the partial line:  a `%' for a normal user or a `#' for root.  If
    	      set, the shell parameter PROMPT_EOL_MARK can be used to customize how  the  end  of
    	      partial lines are shown.
    
    	      NOTE: if the PROMPT_CR option is not set, enabling this option will have no effect.
    	      This option is on by default.
    
           PROMPT_PERCENT <C> <Z>
    	      If set, `%' is treated specially in prompt  expansion.   See  EXPANSION  OF  PROMPT
    	      SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).
    
           PROMPT_SUBST <K> <S>
    	      If set, parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion are per‐
    	      formed in prompts.  Substitutions within prompts do not affect the command status.
    
           TRANSIENT_RPROMPT
    	      Remove any right prompt from display when accepting a command line.   This  may  be
    	      useful with terminals with other cut/paste methods.
    
       Scripts and Functions
           C_BASES
    	      Output  hexadecimal numbers in the standard C format, for example `0xFF' instead of
    	      the usual `16#FF'.  If the option OCTAL_ZEROES is also set (it is not by	default),
    	      octal  numbers  will  be	treated  similarly  and  hence appear as `077' instead of
    	      `8#77'.  This option has no effect on the choice of the output  base,  nor  on  the
    	      output  of bases other than hexadecimal and octal.  Note that these formats will be
    	      understood on input irrespective of the setting of C_BASES.
    
           C_PRECEDENCES
    	      This alters the precedence of arithmetic operators to be more like C and other pro‐
    	      gramming languages; the section ARITHMETIC EVALUATION in zshmisc(1) has an explicit
    	      list.
    
           DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD
    	      Run the DEBUG trap before each command; otherwise it is  run  after  each  command.
    	      Setting  this  option mimics the behaviour of ksh 93; with the option unset the be‐
    	      haviour is that of ksh 88.
    
           ERR_EXIT (-e, ksh: -e)
    	      If a command has a non-zero exit status, execute the ZERR trap, if set,  and  exit.
    	      This is disabled while running initialization scripts.
    
    	      The behaviour is also disabled inside DEBUG traps.  In this case the option is han‐
    	      dled specially: it is unset on entry to the trap.  If the  option  DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD
    	      is  set,	as it is by default, and the option ERR_EXIT is found to have been set on
    	      exit, then the command for which the DEBUG trap is being executed is skipped.   The
    	      option is restored after the trap exits.
    
    	      Exiting  due  to	ERR_EXIT has certain interactions with asynchronous jobs noted in
    	      the section JOBS in in zshmisc(1).
    
           ERR_RETURN
    	      If a command has a non-zero exit status,	return	immediately  from  the	enclosing
    	      function.   The  logic  is  identical to that for ERR_EXIT, except that an implicit
    	      return statement is executed instead of an exit.	This will trigger an exit at  the
    	      outermost level of a non-interactive script.
    
           EVAL_LINENO <Z>
    	      If  set,	line  numbers of expressions evaluated using the builtin eval are tracked
    	      separately of the enclosing environment.	This applies both to the parameter LINENO
    	      and  the	line  number  output  by the prompt escape %i.	If the option is set, the
    	      prompt escape %N will output the string `(eval)' instead of the script or  function
    	      name  as an indication.	(The two prompt escapes are typically used in the parame‐
    	      ter PS4 to be output when the option XTRACE is set.)  If EVAL_LINENO is unset,  the
    	      line  number  of	the surrounding script or function is retained during the evalua‐
    	      tion.
    
           EXEC (+n, ksh: +n) <D>
    	      Do execute commands.  Without this option, commands are read and checked for syntax
    	      errors,  but  not  executed.   This  option  cannot be turned off in an interactive
    	      shell, except when `-n' is supplied to the shell at startup.
    
           FUNCTION_ARGZERO <C> <Z>
    	      When executing a shell function or sourcing a script, set  $0  temporarily  to  the
    	      name  of	the  function/script.  Note that toggling FUNCTION_ARGZERO from on to off
    	      (or off to on) does not change the current value of $0.  Only the state upon  entry
    	      to the function or script has an effect.	Compare POSIX_ARGZERO.
    
           LOCAL_LOOPS
    	      When  this  option is not set, the effect of break and continue commands may propa‐
    	      gate outside function scope, affecting loops in calling functions.  When the option
    	      is  set  in  a  calling function, a break or a continue that is not caught within a
    	      called function (regardless of the setting of the option within that function) pro‐
    	      duces a warning and the effect is cancelled.
    
           LOCAL_OPTIONS <K>
    	      If  this	option	is set at the point of return from a shell function, most options
    	      (including this one) which were in force upon entry to the function  are	restored;
    	      options  that are not restored are PRIVILEGED and RESTRICTED.  Otherwise, only this
    	      option, and the LOCAL_LOOPS, XTRACE  and	PRINT_EXIT_VALUE  options  are	restored.
    	      Hence if this is explicitly unset by a shell function the other options in force at
    	      the point of return will remain so.  A shell function can also guarantee	itself	a
    	      known  shell  configuration  with a formulation like `emulate -L zsh'; the -L acti‐
    	      vates LOCAL_OPTIONS.
    
           LOCAL_PATTERNS
    	      If this option is set at the point of return from a shell function,  the	state  of
    	      pattern disables, as set with the builtin command `disable -p', is restored to what
    	      it was when the function was entered.  The behaviour of this option is  similar  to
    	      the  effect of LOCAL_OPTIONS on options; hence `emulate -L sh' (or indeed any other
    	      emulation with the -L option) activates LOCAL_PATTERNS.
    
           LOCAL_TRAPS <K>
    	      If this option is set when a signal trap is set inside a function, then the  previ‐
    	      ous  status  of  the trap for that signal will be restored when the function exits.
    	      Note that this option must be set prior to altering the trap behaviour in  a  func‐
    	      tion;  unlike  LOCAL_OPTIONS,  the  value  on exit from the function is irrelevant.
    	      However, it does not need to be set before any global trap for that to be correctly
    	      restored by a function.  For example,
    
    		     unsetopt localtraps
    		     trap - INT
    		     fn() { setopt localtraps; trap '' INT; sleep 3; }
    
    	      will restore normal handling of SIGINT after the function exits.
    
           MULTI_FUNC_DEF <Z>
    	      Allow  definitions of multiple functions at once in the form `fn1 fn2...()'; if the
    	      option is not set, this causes a parse error.   Definition  of  multiple	functions
    	      with the function keyword is always allowed.  Multiple function definitions are not
    	      often used and can cause obscure errors.
    
           MULTIOS <Z>
    	      Perform implicit tees or cats when multiple redirections	are  attempted	(see  the
    	      section `Redirection').
    
           OCTAL_ZEROES <S>
    	      Interpret  any  integer  constant  beginning  with  a  0	as  octal,  per  IEEE Std
    	      1003.2-1992 (ISO 9945-2:1993).  This is not enabled by default as it  causes  prob‐
    	      lems with parsing of, for example, date and time strings with leading zeroes.
    
    	      Sequences of digits indicating a numeric base such as the `08' component in `08#77'
    	      are always interpreted as decimal, regardless of leading zeroes.
    
           PIPE_FAIL
    	      By default, when a pipeline exits  the  exit  status  recorded  by  the  shell  and
    	      returned by the shell variable $? reflects that of the rightmost element of a pipe‐
    	      line.  If this option is set, the exit status instead reflects the  status  of  the
    	      rightmost element of the pipeline that was non-zero, or zero if all elements exited
    	      with zero status.
    
           SOURCE_TRACE
    	      If set, zsh will print an informational message announcing the name of each file it
    	      loads.  The format of the output is similar to that for the XTRACE option, with the
    	      message <sourcetrace>.  A file may be loaded by the shell itself when it starts  up
    	      and  shuts  down	(Startup/Shutdown  Files) or by the use of the `source' and `dot'
    	      builtin commands.
    
           TYPESET_SILENT
    	      If this is unset, executing any of the `typeset' family of commands with no options
    	      and  a list of parameters that have no values to be assigned but already exist will
    	      display the value of the parameter.  If the option is set, they will only be  shown
    	      when  parameters	are  selected with the `-m' option.  The option `-p' is available
    	      whether or not the option is set.
    
           VERBOSE (-v, ksh: -v)
    	      Print shell input lines as they are read.
    
           XTRACE (-x, ksh: -x)
    	      Print commands and their arguments as they are executed.	The output is preceded by
    	      the  value  of  $PS4,  formatted	as  described  in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT
    	      SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).
    
       Shell Emulation
           APPEND_CREATE <K> <S>
    	      This option only applies when NO_CLOBBER (-C) is in effect.
    
    	      If this option is not set, the shell will report an error when a append redirection
    	      (>>)  is used on a file that does not already exists (the traditional zsh behaviour
    	      of NO_CLOBBER).  If the option is set, no error is reported (POSIX behaviour).
    
           BASH_REMATCH
    	      When set, matches performed with the =~ operator will set  the  BASH_REMATCH  array
    	      variable,  instead  of the default MATCH and match variables.  The first element of
    	      the BASH_REMATCH array will contain the entire matched text and subsequent elements
    	      will contain extracted substrings.  This option makes more sense when KSH_ARRAYS is
    	      also set, so that the entire matched portion is stored at index  0  and  the  first
    	      substring  is  at  index	1.   Without this option, the MATCH variable contains the
    	      entire matched text and the match array variable contains substrings.
    
           BSD_ECHO <S>
    	      Make the echo builtin compatible with the BSD echo(1) command.  This disables back‐
    	      slashed escape sequences in echo strings unless the -e option is specified.
    
           CONTINUE_ON_ERROR
    	      If  a  fatal  error  is encountered (see the section ERRORS in zshmisc(1)), and the
    	      code is running in a script, the shell will resume execution at the next	statement
    	      in  the script at the top level, in other words outside all functions or shell con‐
    	      structs such as loops and conditions.  This mimics  the  behaviour  of  interactive
    	      shells,  where  the  shell returns to the line editor to read a new command; it was
    	      the normal behaviour in versions of zsh before 5.0.1.
    
           CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY <C>
    	      A history reference without an event specifier will always refer	to  the  previous
    	      command.	Without this option, such a history reference refers to the same event as
    	      the previous history reference on the current command line, defaulting to the  pre‐
    	      vious command.
    
           CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS <C>
    	      Allow loop bodies to take the form `list; end' instead of `do list; done'.
    
           CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES <C>
    	      Changes  the  rules for single- and double-quoted text to match that of csh.  These
    	      require that embedded newlines be preceded by a backslash; unescaped newlines  will
    	      cause  an error message.	In double-quoted strings, it is made impossible to escape
    	      `$', ``' or `"' (and `\' itself no longer needs escaping).   Command  substitutions
    	      are only expanded once, and cannot be nested.
    
           CSH_NULLCMD <C>
    	      Do  not use the values of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when running redirections with no
    	      command.	This make such redirections fail (see the section `Redirection').
    
           KSH_ARRAYS <K> <S>
    	      Emulate ksh array handling as closely as possible.  If this option  is  set,  array
    	      elements are numbered from zero, an array parameter without subscript refers to the
    	      first element instead of the whole array, and braces are required to delimit a sub‐
    	      script (`${path[2]}' rather than just `$path[2]').
    
           KSH_AUTOLOAD <K> <S>
    	      Emulate  ksh  function autoloading.  This means that when a function is autoloaded,
    	      the corresponding file is merely executed, and must  define  the	function  itself.
    	      (By  default,  the  function  is defined to the contents of the file.  However, the
    	      most common ksh-style case - of the file containing only a simple definition of the
    	      function - is always handled in the ksh-compatible manner.)
    
           KSH_OPTION_PRINT <K>
    	      Alters  the  way options settings are printed: instead of separate lists of set and
    	      unset options, all options are shown, marked `on' if they are  in  the  non-default
    	      state, `off' otherwise.
    
           KSH_TYPESET
    	      This  option  is	now  obsolete:	a better appropximation to the behaviour of other
    	      shells is obtained with the reserved word  interface  to	declare,  export,  float,
    	      integer,	local,	readonly  and typeset.	Note that the option is only applied when
    	      the reserved word interface is not in use.
    
    	      Alters the way arguments to the typeset  family  of  commands,  including  declare,
    	      export,  float,  integer,  local and readonly, are processed.  Without this option,
    	      zsh will perform normal word splitting after command  and  parameter  expansion  in
    	      arguments  of  an  assignment; with it, word splitting does not take place in those
    	      cases.
    
           KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT
    	      Treat use of a subscript of value zero in array or string expressions as	a  refer‐
    	      ence  to	the  first  element,  i.e.  the element that usually has the subscript 1.
    	      Ignored if KSH_ARRAYS is also set.
    
    	      If neither this option nor KSH_ARRAYS is set, accesses to an element of an array or
    	      string with subscript zero return an empty element or string, while attempts to set
    	      element zero of an array or string are treated as an error.  However,  attempts  to
    	      set  an otherwise valid subscript range that includes zero will succeed.	For exam‐
    	      ple, if KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT is not set,
    
    		     array[0]=(element)
    
    	      is an error, while
    
    		     array[0,1]=(element)
    
    	      is not and will replace the first element of the array.
    
    	      This option is for compatibility with older versions of the shell and is not recom‐
    	      mended in new code.
    
           POSIX_ALIASES <K> <S>
    	      When this option is set, reserved words are not candidates for alias expansion:  it
    	      is still possible to declare any of them as an alias, but the alias will	never  be
    	      expanded.   Reserved  words  are	described  in  the section RESERVED WORDS in zsh‐
    	      misc(1).
    
    	      Alias expansion takes place while text is being read; hence when this option is set
    	      it  does not take effect until the end of any function or other piece of shell code
    	      parsed as one unit.  Note this may cause differences from other  shells  even  when
    	      the  option  is  in  effect.  For example, when running a command with `zsh -c', or
    	      even `zsh -o posixaliases -c', the entire command argument is parsed as  one  unit,
    	      so  aliases  defined within the argument are not available even in later lines.  If
    	      in doubt, avoid use of aliases in non-interactive code.
    
           POSIX_ARGZERO
    	      This option may be used to temporarily disable FUNCTION_ARGZERO and thereby restore
    	      the  value  of $0 to the name used to invoke the shell (or as set by the -c command
    	      line option).  For compatibility with previous versions of  the  shell,  emulations
    	      use  NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO	instead  of POSIX_ARGZERO, which may result in unexpected
    	      scoping of $0 if the emulation mode is changed inside a  function  or  script.   To
    	      avoid this, explicitly enable POSIX_ARGZERO in the emulate command:
    
    		     emulate sh -o POSIX_ARGZERO
    
    	      Note  that  NO_POSIX_ARGZERO  has  no  effect  unless  FUNCTION_ARGZERO was already
    	      enabled upon entry to the function or script.
    
           POSIX_BUILTINS <K> <S>
    	      When this option is set the command builtin can be used to  execute  shell  builtin
    	      commands.   Parameter  assignments  specified  before  shell  functions and special
    	      builtins are kept after the command completes unless the special	builtin  is  pre‐
    	      fixed  with  the	command  builtin.   Special  builtins  are ., :, break, continue,
    	      declare, eval, exit, export, integer, local, readonly, return, set, shift,  source,
    	      times, trap and unset.
    
    	      In  addition,  various  error conditions associated with the above builtins or exec
    	      cause a non-interactive shell to exit and an interactive shell  to  return  to  its
    	      top-level processing.
    
    	      Furthermore,  the getopts builtin behaves in a POSIX-compatible fashion in that the
    	      associated variable OPTIND is not made local to functions.
    
           POSIX_IDENTIFIERS <K> <S>
    	      When this option is set, only the ASCII characters a to z, A to Z, 0 to 9 and _ may
    	      be used in identifiers (names of shell parameters and modules).
    
    	      In  addition,  setting this option limits the effect of parameter substitution with
    	      no braces, so that the expression $# is treated as the parameter $#  even  if  fol‐
    	      lowed  by  a valid parameter name.  When it is unset, zsh allows expressions of the
    	      form $#name to refer to the length of $name, even for special variables, for  exam‐
    	      ple in expressions such as $#- and $#*.
    
    	      When  the  option  is  unset and multibyte character support is enabled (i.e. it is
    	      compiled in and the option MULTIBYTE is set), then  additionally	any  alphanumeric
    	      characters  in  the  local  character  set  may  be used in identifiers.	Note that
    	      scripts and functions written with this feature are not  portable,  and  also  that
    	      both options must be set before the script or function is parsed; setting them dur‐
    	      ing execution is not sufficient as  the  syntax  variable=value  has  already  been
    	      parsed as a command rather than an assignment.
    
    	      If  multibyte  character	support  is  not  compiled  into the shell this option is
    	      ignored; all octets with the top bit set may  be	used  in  identifiers.	 This  is
    	      non-standard but is the traditional zsh behaviour.
    
           POSIX_STRINGS <K> <S>
    	      This  option  affects  processing of quoted strings.  Currently it only affects the
    	      behaviour of null characters, i.e. character 0 in the portable character set corre‐
    	      sponding to US ASCII.
    
    	      When  this  option  is not set, null characters embedded within strings of the form
    	      $'...' are treated as ordinary characters. The entire string is  maintained  within
    	      the  shell  and  output to files where necessary, although owing to restrictions of
    	      the library interface the string is truncated at the null character in file  names,
    	      environment variables, or in arguments to external programs.
    
    	      When  this option is set, the $'...' expression is truncated at the null character.
    	      Note that remaining parts of the same string beyond the termination of  the  quotes
    	      are not truncated.
    
    	      For  example, the command line argument a$'b\0c'd is treated with the option off as
    	      the characters a, b, null, c, d, and with the option on as the characters a, b, d.
    
           POSIX_TRAPS <K> <S>
    	      When this option is set, the usual zsh behaviour of executing  traps  for  EXIT  on
    	      exit  from  shell  functions  is suppressed.  In that case, manipulating EXIT traps
    	      always alters the global trap for exiting the  shell;  the  LOCAL_TRAPS  option  is
    	      ignored for the EXIT trap.  Furthermore, a return statement executed in a trap with
    	      no argument passes back from the function the value from the  surrounding  context,
    	      not from code executed within the trap.
    
           SH_FILE_EXPANSION <K> <S>
    	      Perform  filename expansion (e.g., ~ expansion) before parameter expansion, command
    	      substitution, arithmetic expansion and brace expansion.  If this option  is  unset,
    	      it  is  performed  after	brace expansion, so things like `~$USERNAME' and `~{pfal‐
    	      stad,rc}' will work.
    
           SH_NULLCMD <K> <S>
    	      Do not use the values of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when doing redirections,  use  `:'
    	      instead (see the section `Redirection').
    
           SH_OPTION_LETTERS <K> <S>
    	      If this option is set the shell tries to interpret single letter options (which are
    	      used with set and setopt) like ksh does.	This also affects the value of the - spe‐
    	      cial parameter.
    
           SH_WORD_SPLIT (-y) <K> <S>
    	      Causes field splitting to be performed on unquoted parameter expansions.	Note that
    	      this option has nothing to do with word splitting.   (See  the  section  `Parameter
    	      Expansion'.)
    
           TRAPS_ASYNC
    	      While  waiting  for  a  program  to exit, handle signals and run traps immediately.
    	      Otherwise the trap is run after a child process has exited.   Note  this	does  not
    	      affect  the  point at which traps are run for any case other than when the shell is
    	      waiting for a child process.
    
       Shell State
           INTERACTIVE (-i, ksh: -i)
    	      This is an interactive shell.  This option is set upon initialisation if the  stan‐
    	      dard input is a tty and commands are being read from standard input.  (See the dis‐
    	      cussion of SHIN_STDIN.)  This heuristic may be overridden by specifying a state for
    	      this  option on the command line.  The value of this option can only be changed via
    	      flags supplied at invocation of the shell.  It cannot be changed once zsh  is  run‐
    	      ning.
    
           LOGIN (-l, ksh: -l)
    	      This  is	a login shell.	If this option is not explicitly set, the shell becomes a
    	      login shell if the first character of the argv[0] passed to the shell is a `-'.
    
           PRIVILEGED (-p, ksh: -p)
    	      Turn on privileged mode. Typically this is used when script is to be run with  ele‐
    	      vated privileges. This should be done as follows directly with the -p option to zsh
    	      so that it takes effect during startup.
    
    		     #!/bin/zsh -p
    
    	      The option is enabled automatically on startup if the effective user (group) ID  is
    	      not  equal to the real user (group) ID. In this case, turning the option off causes
    	      the effective user and group IDs to be set to the real user and group IDs. Be aware
    	      that if that fails the shell may be running with different IDs than was intended so
    	      a script should check for failure and act accordingly, for example:
    
    		     unsetopt privileged || exit
    
    	      The PRIVILEGED option disables sourcing user startup files.  If zsh is  invoked  as
    	      `sh'  or	`ksh' with this option set, /etc/suid_profile is sourced (after /etc/pro‐
    	      file on interactive shells). Sourcing ~/.profile is disabled and	the  contents  of
    	      the  ENV	variable is ignored. This option cannot be changed using the -m option of
    	      setopt and unsetopt, and changing it inside a function always changes  it  globally
    	      regardless of the LOCAL_OPTIONS option.
    
           RESTRICTED (-r)
    	      Enables restricted mode.	This option cannot be changed using unsetopt, and setting
    	      it inside a function always changes it globally  regardless  of  the  LOCAL_OPTIONS
    	      option.  See the section `Restricted Shell'.
    
           SHIN_STDIN (-s, ksh: -s)
    	      Commands	are  being read from the standard input.  Commands are read from standard
    	      input if no command is specified with -c and no file of commands is specified.   If
    	      SHIN_STDIN is set explicitly on the command line, any argument that would otherwise
    	      have been taken as a file to run will instead be treated	as  a  normal  positional
    	      parameter.  Note that setting or unsetting this option on the command line does not
    	      necessarily affect the state the option will have while the shell is running - that
    	      is  purely  an  indicator  of  whether or not commands are actually being read from
    	      standard input.  The value of this option can only be changed via flags supplied at
    	      invocation of the shell.	It cannot be changed once zsh is running.
    
           SINGLE_COMMAND (-t, ksh: -t)
    	      If  the  shell  is reading from standard input, it exits after a single command has
    	      been executed.  This also makes the shell non-interactive, unless  the  INTERACTIVE
    	      option is explicitly set on the command line.  The value of this option can only be
    	      changed via flags supplied at invocation of the shell.  It cannot be  changed  once
    	      zsh is running.
    
       Zle
           BEEP (+B) <D>
    	      Beep on error in ZLE.
    
           COMBINING_CHARS
    	      Assume that the terminal displays combining characters correctly.  Specifically, if
    	      a base alphanumeric character is followed by one	or  more  zero-width  punctuation
    	      characters,  assume  that  the zero-width characters will be displayed as modifica‐
    	      tions to the base character within the same width.  Not all terminals handle  this.
    	      If this option is not set, zero-width characters are displayed separately with spe‐
    	      cial mark-up.
    
    	      If this option is set, the pattern test [[:WORD:]] matches a zero-width punctuation
    	      character  on  the assumption that it will be used as part of a word in combination
    	      with a word character.  Otherwise the base shell does not handle combining  charac‐
    	      ters specially.
    
           EMACS  If ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent effect of `bindkey -e'.
    	      In addition, the VI option is unset.  Turning it off has	no  effect.   The  option
    	      setting  is  not guaranteed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided
    	      for compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.
    
           OVERSTRIKE
    	      Start up the line editor in overstrike mode.
    
           SINGLE_LINE_ZLE (-M) <K>
    	      Use single-line command line editing instead of multi-line.
    
    	      Note that although this is on by default in ksh emulation it only provides superfi‐
    	      cial  compatibility  with  the ksh line editor and reduces the effectiveness of the
    	      zsh line editor.	As it has no effect on shell syntax, many users may wish to  dis‐
    	      able this option when using ksh emulation interactively.
    
           VI     If ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent effect of `bindkey -v'.
    	      In addition, the EMACS option is unset.  Turning it off has no effect.  The  option
    	      setting  is  not guaranteed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided
    	      for compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.
    
           ZLE (-Z)
    	      Use the zsh line editor.	Set by default in interactive shells connected to a  ter‐
    	      minal.
    
    OPTION ALIASES
           Some  options have alternative names.  These aliases are never used for output, but can be
           used just like normal option names when specifying options to the shell.
    
           BRACE_EXPAND
    	      NO_IGNORE_BRACES (ksh and bash compatibility)
    
           DOT_GLOB
    	      GLOB_DOTS (bash compatibility)
    
           HASH_ALL
    	      HASH_CMDS (bash compatibility)
    
           HIST_APPEND
    	      APPEND_HISTORY (bash compatibility)
    
           HIST_EXPAND
    	      BANG_HIST (bash compatibility)
    
           LOG    NO_HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS (ksh compatibility)
    
           MAIL_WARN
    	      MAIL_WARNING (bash compatibility)
    
           ONE_CMD
    	      SINGLE_COMMAND (bash compatibility)
    
           PHYSICAL
    	      CHASE_LINKS (ksh and bash compatibility)
    
           PROMPT_VARS
    	      PROMPT_SUBST (bash compatibility)
    
           STDIN  SHIN_STDIN (ksh compatibility)
    
           TRACK_ALL
    	      HASH_CMDS (ksh compatibility)
    
    SINGLE LETTER OPTIONS
       Default set
           -0     CORRECT
           -1     PRINT_EXIT_VALUE
           -2     NO_BAD_PATTERN
           -3     NO_NOMATCH
           -4     GLOB_DOTS
           -5     NOTIFY
           -6     BG_NICE
           -7     IGNORE_EOF
           -8     MARK_DIRS
           -9     AUTO_LIST
           -B     NO_BEEP
           -C     NO_CLOBBER
           -D     PUSHD_TO_HOME
           -E     PUSHD_SILENT
           -F     NO_GLOB
           -G     NULL_GLOB
           -H     RM_STAR_SILENT
           -I     IGNORE_BRACES
           -J     AUTO_CD
           -K     NO_BANG_HIST
           -L     SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK
           -M     SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
           -N     AUTO_PUSHD
           -O     CORRECT_ALL
           -P     RC_EXPAND_PARAM
           -Q     PATH_DIRS
           -R     LONG_LIST_JOBS
           -S     REC_EXACT
           -T     CDABLE_VARS
           -U     MAIL_WARNING
           -V     NO_PROMPT_CR
           -W     AUTO_RESUME
           -X     LIST_TYPES
           -Y     MENU_COMPLETE
           -Z     ZLE
           -a     ALL_EXPORT
           -e     ERR_EXIT
           -f     NO_RCS
           -g     HIST_IGNORE_SPACE
           -h     HIST_IGNORE_DUPS
           -i     INTERACTIVE
           -k     INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
           -l     LOGIN
           -m     MONITOR
           -n     NO_EXEC
           -p     PRIVILEGED
           -r     RESTRICTED
           -s     SHIN_STDIN
           -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
           -u     NO_UNSET
           -v     VERBOSE
           -w     CHASE_LINKS
           -x     XTRACE
           -y     SH_WORD_SPLIT
    
       sh/ksh emulation set
           -C     NO_CLOBBER
           -T     TRAPS_ASYNC
           -X     MARK_DIRS
           -a     ALL_EXPORT
           -b     NOTIFY
           -e     ERR_EXIT
           -f     NO_GLOB
           -i     INTERACTIVE
           -l     LOGIN
           -m     MONITOR
           -n     NO_EXEC
           -p     PRIVILEGED
           -r     RESTRICTED
           -s     SHIN_STDIN
           -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
           -u     NO_UNSET
           -v     VERBOSE
           -x     XTRACE
    
       Also note
           -A     Used by set for setting arrays
           -b     Used on the command line to specify end of option processing
           -c     Used on the command line to specify a single command
           -m     Used by setopt for pattern-matching option setting
           -o     Used in all places to allow use of long option names
           -s     Used by set to sort positional parameters
    
    ZSHBUILTINS(1)			     General Commands Manual			   ZSHBUILTINS(1)
    
    NAME
           zshbuiltins - zsh built-in commands
    
    SHELL BUILTIN COMMANDS
           Some shell builtin commands take options as described in  individual  entries;  these  are
           often  referred	to  in	the  list below as `flags' to avoid confusion with shell options,
           which may also have an effect on the behaviour of builtin commands.  In this  introductory
           section, `option' always has the meaning of an option to a command that should be familiar
           to most command line users.
    
           Typically, options are single letters preceded by a hyphen  (-).   Options  that  take  an
           argument  accept  it  either immediately following the option letter or after white space,
           for example `print -C3 *' or `print -C 3 *' are equivalent.  Arguments to options are  not
           the same as arguments to the command; the documentation indicates which is which.  Options
           that do not take an argument may be combined in a single word, for example `print  -ca  *'
           and `print -c -a *' are equivalent.
    
           Some  shell  builtin  commands  also take options that begin with `+' instead of `-'.  The
           list below makes clear which commands these are.
    
           Options (together with their individual arguments, if any) must appear in a  group  before
           any  non-option	arguments; once the first non-option argument has been found, option pro‐
           cessing is terminated.
    
           All builtin commands other than precommand modifiers, even those that have no options, can
           be  given  the argument `--' to terminate option processing.  This indicates that the fol‐
           lowing words are non-option arguments, but is otherwise ignored.  This is useful in  cases
           where  arguments  to the command may begin with `-'.  For historical reasons, most builtin
           commands also recognize a single `-' in a separate word for this purpose; note  that  this
           is less standard and use of `--' is recommended.
    
           - simple command
    	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers' in zshmisc(1).
    
           . file [ arg ... ]
    	      Read commands from file and execute them in the current shell environment.
    
    	      If  file	does  not contain a slash, or if PATH_DIRS is set, the shell looks in the
    	      components of $path to find the directory containing file.  Files  in  the  current
    	      directory  are  not  read  unless  `.' appears somewhere in $path.  If a file named
    	      `file.zwc' is found, is newer than file, and is the compiled form (created with the
    	      zcompile builtin) of file, then commands are read from that file instead of file.
    
    	      If  any  arguments  arg  are  given, they become the positional parameters; the old
    	      positional parameters are restored when the file is done executing.   If	file  was
    	      not  found the return status is 127; if file was found but contained a syntax error
    	      the return status is 126; else the return status is the exit  status  of	the  last
    	      command executed.
    
           : [ arg ... ]
    	      This  command  does nothing, although normal argument expansions is performed which
    	      may have effects on shell parameters.  A zero exit status is returned.
    
           alias [ {+|-}gmrsL ] [ name[=value] ... ]
    	      For each name with a corresponding value, define	an  alias  with  that  value.	A
    	      trailing space in value causes the next word to be checked for alias expansion.  If
    	      the -g flag is present, define a global alias; global aliases are expanded even  if
    	      they do not occur in command position.
    
    	      If  the -s flag is present, define a suffix alias: if the command word on a command
    	      line is in the form `text.name', where text is any non-empty string, it is replaced
    	      by  the text `value text.name'.  Note that name is treated as a literal string, not
    	      a pattern.  A trailing space in value is not special in this case.  For example,
    
    		     alias -s ps=gv
    
    	      will cause the command `*.ps' to be expanded to `gv *.ps'.  As alias  expansion  is
    	      carried  out  earlier  than  globbing,  the  `*.ps'  will then be expanded.  Suffix
    	      aliases constitute a different name space from other aliases (so in the above exam‐
    	      ple  it  is  still possible to create an alias for the command ps) and the two sets
    	      are never listed together.
    
    	      For each name with no value, print the value of name, if any.  With  no  arguments,
    	      print  all  currently defined aliases other than suffix aliases.	If the -m flag is
    	      given the arguments are taken as patterns (they should be quoted to  preserve  them
    	      from  being  interpreted as glob patterns), and the aliases matching these patterns
    	      are printed.  When printing aliases and one of the -g, -r or -s flags  is  present,
    	      restrict the printing to global, regular or suffix aliases, respectively; a regular
    	      alias is one which is neither a global nor a suffix alias.   Using `+'  instead  of
    	      `-',  or	ending	the  option  list  with  a single `+', prevents the values of the
    	      aliases from being printed.
    
    	      If the -L flag is present, then print each alias in a manner suitable  for  putting
    	      in a startup script.  The exit status is nonzero if a name (with no value) is given
    	      for which no alias has been defined.
    
    	      For more on aliases, include common problems, see  the  section  ALIASING  in  zsh‐
    	      misc(1).
    
           autoload [ {+|-}TUXkmtz ] [ -w ] [ name ... ]
    	      Equivalent to functions -u, with the exception of -X/+X and -w.
    
    	      The  flag -X may be used only inside a shell function, and may not be followed by a
    	      name.  It causes the calling function to be marked for autoloading and then immedi‐
    	      ately loaded and executed, with the current array of positional parameters as argu‐
    	      ments.  This replaces the previous definition of the function.  If no function def‐
    	      inition is found, an error is printed and the function remains undefined and marked
    	      for autoloading.
    
    	      The flag +X attempts to load each name as an autoloaded function, but does not exe‐
    	      cute  it.   The  exit  status  is zero (success) if the function was not previously
    	      defined and a definition for it was found.  This does not replace any existing def‐
    	      inition  of the function.  The exit status is nonzero (failure) if the function was
    	      already defined or when no definition was found.	In the latter case  the  function
    	      remains undefined and marked for autoloading.  If ksh-style autoloading is enabled,
    	      the function created will contain the contents of the file plus a call to the func‐
    	      tion  itself  appended  to  it, thus giving normal ksh autoloading behaviour on the
    	      first call to the function.  If the -m flag is also given each name is treated as a
    	      pattern  and  all  functions already marked for autoload that match the pattern are
    	      loaded.
    
    	      With the -w flag, the names are taken as names of files compiled with the  zcompile
    	      builtin, and all functions defined in them are marked for autoloading.
    
    	      The  flags -z and -k mark the function to be autoloaded using the zsh or ksh style,
    	      as if the option KSH_AUTOLOAD were unset or  were  set,  respectively.   The  flags
    	      override the setting of the option at the time the function is loaded.
    
    	      Note  that  the  autoload  command makes no attempt to ensure the shell options set
    	      during the loading or execution of the file have any particular value.   For  this,
    	      the emulate command can be used:
    
    		     emulate zsh -c 'autoload -Uz func'
    
    	      arranges	that  when  func is loaded the shell is in native zsh emulation, and this
    	      emulation is also applied when func is run.
    
           bg [ job ... ]
           job ... &
    	      Put each specified job in the background, or the current job if none is specified.
    
           bindkey
    	      See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).
    
           break [ n ]
    	      Exit from an enclosing for, while, until, select or repeat loop. If  an  arithmetic
    	      expression n is specified, then break n levels instead of just one.
    
           builtin name [ args ... ]
    	      Executes the builtin name, with the given args.
    
           bye    Same as exit.
    
           cap    See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           cd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]
           cd [ -qsLP ] old new
           cd [ -qsLP ] {+|-}n
    	      Change  the  current directory.  In the first form, change the current directory to
    	      arg, or to the value of $HOME if arg is not specified.  If arg is  `-',  change  to
    	      the previous directory.
    
    	      Otherwise,  if arg begins with a slash, attempt to change to the directory given by
    	      arg.
    
    	      If arg does not begin with a slash, the behaviour depends on  whether  the  current
    	      directory  `.'  occurs  in the list of directories contained in the shell parameter
    	      cdpath.  If it does not, first attempt to change to the  directory  arg  under  the
    	      current  directory,  and	if that fails but cdpath is set and contains at least one
    	      element attempt to change to the directory arg under each component  of  cdpath  in
    	      turn  until  successful.	If `.' occurs in cdpath, then cdpath is searched strictly
    	      in order so that `.' is only tried at the appropriate point.
    
    	      The order of testing cdpath is modified if the option POSIX_CD is set, as described
    	      in the documentation for the option.
    
    	      If  no directory is found, the option CDABLE_VARS is set, and a parameter named arg
    	      exists whose value begins with a slash, treat its value as the directory.  In  that
    	      case, the parameter is added to the named directory hash table.
    
    	      The  second form of cd substitutes the string new for the string old in the name of
    	      the current directory, and tries to change to this new directory.
    
    	      The third form of cd extracts an entry from the directory  stack,  and  changes  to
    	      that  directory.	An argument of the form `+n' identifies a stack entry by counting
    	      from the left of the list shown by the dirs command, starting with zero.	An  argu‐
    	      ment of the form `-n' counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the
    	      meanings of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.
    
    	      If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd and the functions in
    	      the  array  chpwd_functions are not called.  This is useful for calls to cd that do
    	      not change the environment seen by an interactive user.
    
    	      If the -s option is specified, cd refuses to change the current  directory  if  the
    	      given  pathname  contains  symlinks.   If the -P option is given or the CHASE_LINKS
    	      option is set, symbolic links are resolved to their true values.	If the -L  option
    	      is given symbolic links are retained in the directory (and not resolved) regardless
    	      of the state of the CHASE_LINKS option.
    
           chdir  Same as cd.
    
           clone  See the section `The zsh/clone Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           command [ -pvV ] simple command
    	      The simple command argument is taken as an external command instead of  a  function
    	      or builtin and is executed. If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, builtins will also
    	      be executed but certain special properties of them  are  suppressed.  The  -p  flag
    	      causes  a  default  path to be searched instead of that in $path. With the -v flag,
    	      command is similar to whence and with -V, it is equivalent to whence -v.
    
    	      See also the section `Precommand Modifiers' in zshmisc(1).
    
           comparguments
    	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           compcall
    	      See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           compctl
    	      See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           compdescribe
    	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           compfiles
    	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           compgroups
    	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           compquote
    	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           comptags
    	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           comptry
    	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           compvalues
    	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           continue [ n ]
    	      Resume the next iteration of the enclosing for,  while,  until,  select  or  repeat
    	      loop. If an arithmetic expression n is specified, break out of n-1 loops and resume
    	      at the nth enclosing loop.
    
           declare
    	      Same as typeset.
    
           dirs [ -c ] [ arg ... ]
           dirs [ -lpv ]
    	      With no arguments, print the contents of	the  directory	stack.	 Directories  are
    	      added  to  this  stack with the pushd command, and removed with the cd or popd com‐
    	      mands.  If arguments are specified, load them onto the directory	stack,	replacing
    	      anything that was there, and push the current directory onto the stack.
    
    	      -c     clear the directory stack.
    
    	      -l     print  directory  names in full instead of using of using ~ expressions (see
    		     Dynamic and Static named directories in zshexpn(1)).
    
    	      -p     print directory entries one per line.
    
    	      -v     number the directories in the stack when printing.
    
           disable [ -afmprs ] name ...
    	      Temporarily disable the named hash table elements or patterns.  The default  is  to
    	      disable builtin commands.  This allows you to use an external command with the same
    	      name as a builtin command.  The -a option causes	disable  to  act  on  regular  or
    	      global  aliases.	 The  -s  option causes disable to act on suffix aliases.  The -f
    	      option causes disable to act on shell functions.	The -r options causes disable  to
    	      act on reserved words.  Without arguments all disabled hash table elements from the
    	      corresponding hash table are printed.  With the -m flag the arguments are taken  as
    	      patterns	(which	should	be quoted to prevent them from undergoing filename expan‐
    	      sion), and all hash table elements from the corresponding hash table matching these
    	      patterns are disabled.  Disabled objects can be enabled with the enable command.
    
    	      With  the  option  -p,  name ... refer to elements of the shell's pattern syntax as
    	      described in the section `Filename Generation'.  Certain elements can  be  disabled
    	      separately, as given below.
    
    	      Note   that   patterns  not  allowed  by	the  current  settings	for  the  options
    	      EXTENDED_GLOB, KSH_GLOB and SH_GLOB are never enabled, regardless  of  the  setting
    	      here.   For  example,  if EXTENDED_GLOB is not active, the pattern ^ is ineffective
    	      even if `disable -p "^"' has not been issued.  The list below indicates any  option
    	      settings	that  restrict	the  use of the pattern.  It should be noted that setting
    	      SH_GLOB has a wider effect than merely disabling patterns as  certain  expressions,
    	      in particular those involving parentheses, are parsed differently.
    
    	      The following patterns may be disabled; all the strings need quoting on the command
    	      line to prevent them from being interpreted immediately as patterns  and	the  pat‐
    	      terns are shown below in single quotes as a reminder.
    
    	      '?'    The  pattern  character  ?  wherever  it  occurs, including when preceding a
    		     parenthesis with KSH_GLOB.
    
    	      '*'    The pattern character * wherever it occurs, including recursive globbing and
    		     when preceding a parenthesis with KSH_GLOB.
    
    	      '['    Character classes.
    
    	      '<' (NO_SH_GLOB)
    		     Numeric ranges.
    
    	      '|' (NO_SH_GLOB)
    		     Alternation  in grouped patterns, case statements, or KSH_GLOB parenthesised
    		     expressions.
    
    	      '(' (NO_SH_GLOB)
    		     Grouping using single parentheses.  Disabling this does not disable the  use
    		     of  parentheses  for KSH_GLOB where they are introduced by a special charac‐
    		     ter, nor for glob qualifiers (use `setopt NO_BARE_GLOB_QUAL' to disable glob
    		     qualifiers that use parentheses only).
    
    	      '~' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
    		     Exclusion in the form A~B.
    
    	      '^' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
    		     Exclusion in the form A^B.
    
    	      '#' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
    		     The  pattern character # wherever it occurs, both for repetition of a previ‐
    		     ous pattern and for indicating globbing flags.
    
    	      '?(' (KSH_GLOB)
    		     The grouping form ?(...).	Note this is also disabled if '?' is disabled.
    
    	      '*(' (KSH_GLOB)
    		     The grouping form *(...).	Note this is also disabled if '*' is disabled.
    
    	      '+(' (KSH_GLOB)
    		     The grouping form +(...).
    
    	      '!(' (KSH_GLOB)
    		     The grouping form !(...).
    
    	      '@(' (KSH_GLOB)
    		     The grouping form @(...).
    
           disown [ job ... ]
           job ... &|
           job ... &!
    	      Remove the specified jobs from the job table; the shell will no longer report their
    	      status,  and  will  not  complain if you try to exit an interactive shell with them
    	      running or stopped.  If no job is specified, disown the current job.
    
    	      If the jobs are currently stopped and the AUTO_CONTINUE option is not set, a  warn‐
    	      ing  is  printed	containing  information about how to make them running after they
    	      have been disowned.  If one of the latter two forms is used, the jobs will automat‐
    	      ically be made running, independent of the setting of the AUTO_CONTINUE option.
    
           echo [ -neE ] [ arg ... ]
    	      Write each arg on the standard output, with a space separating each one.	If the -n
    	      flag is not present, print a newline at the end.	 echo  recognizes  the	following
    	      escape sequences:
    
    	      \a     bell character
    	      \b     backspace
    	      \c     suppress final newline
    	      \e     escape
    	      \f     form feed
    	      \n     linefeed (newline)
    	      \r     carriage return
    	      \t     horizontal tab
    	      \v     vertical tab
    	      \\     backslash
    	      \0NNN  character code in octal
    	      \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
    	      \uNNNN unicode character code in hexadecimal
    	      \UNNNNNNNN
    		     unicode character code in hexadecimal
    
    	      The -E flag, or the BSD_ECHO option, can be used to disable these escape sequences.
    	      In the latter case, -e flag can be used to enable them.
    
           echotc See the section `The zsh/termcap Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           echoti See the section `The zsh/terminfo Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           emulate [ -LR ] [ {zsh|sh|ksh|csh} [ flags ... ] ]
    	      Without any argument print current emulation mode.
    
    	      With single argument set up zsh options to emulate the specified shell as  much  as
    	      possible.   csh  will  never  be fully emulated.	If the argument is not one of the
    	      shells listed above, zsh will be used as a default; more precisely, the tests  per‐
    	      formed  on  the  argument  are the same as those used to determine the emulation at
    	      startup based on the shell name, see the section	COMPATIBILITY  in  zsh(1)  .   In
    	      addition	to setting shell options, the command also restores the pristine state of
    	      pattern enables, as if all patterns had been enabled using enable -p.
    
    	      If the emulate command occurs inside a function that has been marked for	execution
    	      tracing  with  functions	-t then the xtrace option will be turned on regardless of
    	      emulation mode or other options.	Note that code executed inside	the  function  by
    	      the  .,  source, or eval commands is not considered to be running directly from the
    	      function, hence does not provoke this behaviour.
    
    	      If the -R switch is given, all settable options are reset to  their  default  value
    	      corresponding  to the specified emulation mode, except for certain options describ‐
    	      ing the interactive environment; otherwise, only	those  options	likely	to  cause
    	      portability  problems  in  scripts  and functions are altered.  If the -L switch is
    	      given, the options LOCAL_OPTIONS, LOCAL_PATTERNS and LOCAL_TRAPS	will  be  set  as
    	      well,  causing  the  effects  of	the emulate command and any setopt, disable -p or
    	      enable -p, and trap commands to be local to the immediately surrounding shell func‐
    	      tion,  if  any; normally these options are turned off in all emulation modes except
    	      ksh. The -L switch is mutually exclusive with the use of -c in flags.
    
    	      The flags may be any of the invocation-time flags described in the section  INVOCA‐
    	      TION  in zsh(1), except that `-o EMACS' and `-o VI' may not be used.  Flags such as
    	      `+r'/`+o RESTRICTED' may be prohibited in some circumstances.
    
    	      If -c arg appears in flags, arg is evaluated while the requested emulation is  tem‐
    	      porarily	in  effect.  In this case the emulation mode and all options are restored
    	      to their previous values before emulate returns.	The -R	switch	may  precede  the
    	      name of the shell to emulate; note this has a meaning distinct from including -R in
    	      flags.
    
    	      Use of -c enables `sticky' emulation mode for functions defined within  the  evalu‐
    	      ated  expression:  the emulation mode is associated thereafter with the function so
    	      that whenever the function is executed the emulation (respecting the -R switch,  if
    	      present) and all options are set (and pattern disables cleared) before entry to the
    	      function, and the state is restored after exit.  If the function is called when the
    	      sticky  emulation is already in effect, either within an `emulate shell -c' expres‐
    	      sion or within another function with the same sticky emulation, entry and exit from
    	      the  function do not cause options to be altered (except due to standard processing
    	      such as the LOCAL_OPTIONS option).  This	also  applies  to  functions  marked  for
    	      autoload	within	the  sticky  emulation;  the  appropriate  set of options will be
    	      applied at the point the function is loaded as well as when it is run.
    
    	      For example:
    
    		     emulate sh -c 'fni() { setopt cshnullglob; }
    		     fno() { fni; }'
    		     fno
    
    	      The two functions fni and fno are defined with sticky sh emulation.   fno  is  then
    	      executed,  causing  options associated with emulations to be set to their values in
    	      sh.  fno then calls fni; because fni is also marked for  sticky  sh  emulation,  no
    	      option  changes  take place on entry to or exit from it.	Hence the option cshnull‐
    	      glob, turned off by sh emulation, will be turned on within fni  and  remain  on  on
    	      return  to  fno.	 On  exit  from  fno,  the emulation mode and all options will be
    	      restored to the state they were in before entry to the temporary emulation.
    
    	      The documentation above is typically sufficient for the intended purpose of execut‐
    	      ing  code designed for other shells in a suitable environment.  More detailed rules
    	      follow.
    	      1.     The sticky emulation environment provided by `emulate shell -c' is identical
    		     to  that  provided  by  entry to a function marked for sticky emulation as a
    		     consequence of being defined in such an environment.   Hence,  for  example,
    		     the  sticky  emulation is inherited by subfunctions defined within functions
    		     with sticky emulation.
    	      2.     No change of options takes place on entry to or exit from functions that are
    		     not  marked  for sticky emulation, other than those that would normally take
    		     place, even if those functions are called within sticky emulation.
    	      3.     No special handling is provided for functions marked for  autoload  nor  for
    		     functions present in wordcode created by the zcompile command.
    	      4.     The presence or absence of the -R switch to emulate corresponds to different
    		     sticky emulation modes, so for example `emulate sh -c', `emulate -R  sh  -c'
    		     and `emulate csh -c' are treated as three distinct sticky emulations.
    	      5.     Difference in shell options supplied in addition to the basic emulation also
    		     mean the sticky emulations are different, so for example  `emulate  zsh  -c'
    		     and `emulate zsh -o cbases -c' are treated as distinct sticky emulations.
    
           enable [ -afmprs ] name ...
    	      Enable  the  named  hash	table elements, presumably disabled earlier with disable.
    	      The default is to enable builtin commands.  The -a option causes enable to  act  on
    	      regular  or  global aliases.  The -s option causes enable to act on suffix aliases.
    	      The -f option causes enable to act on shell functions.  The -r option causes enable
    	      to  act  on reserved words.  Without arguments all enabled hash table elements from
    	      the corresponding hash table are printed.  With the -m flag the arguments are taken
    	      as  patterns  (should be quoted) and all hash table elements from the corresponding
    	      hash table matching these patterns are enabled.  Enabled objects	can  be  disabled
    	      with the disable builtin command.
    
    	      enable -p reenables patterns disabled with disable -p.  Note that it does not over‐
    	      ride globbing options; for example, `enable -p "~"'  does  not  cause  the  pattern
    	      character  ~  to	be active unless the EXTENDED_GLOB option is also set.	To enable
    	      all possible patterns (so that they may be individually disabled with disable  -p),
    	      use `setopt EXTENDED_GLOB KSH_GLOB NO_SH_GLOB'.
    
           eval [ arg ... ]
    	      Read  the  arguments  as input to the shell and execute the resulting command(s) in
    	      the current shell process.  The return status is the same as if  the  commands  had
    	      been  executed  directly by the shell; if there are no args or they contain no com‐
    	      mands (i.e. are an empty string or whitespace) the return status is zero.
    
           exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ] [ command [ arg ... ] ]
    	      Replace the current shell with an external command rather than  forking.	 With  -c
    	      clear  the environment; with -l prepend - to the argv[0] string of the command exe‐
    	      cuted (to simulate a login shell); with -a argv0 set the argv[0] string of the com‐
    	      mand executed.  See the section `Precommand Modifiers' in zshmisc(1).
    
    	      If  command  is  omitted	but any redirections are specified, then the redirections
    	      will take effect in the current shell.
    
           exit [ n ]
    	      Exit the shell with the exit status specified by an  arithmetic  expression  n;  if
    	      none is specified, use the exit status from the last command executed.  An EOF con‐
    	      dition will also cause the shell to exit, unless the IGNORE_EOF option is set.
    
    	      See notes at the end of the section JOBS in in zshmisc(1) for some  possibly  unex‐
    	      pected interactions of the exit command with jobs.
    
           export [ name[=value] ... ]
    	      The  specified  names  are marked for automatic export to the environment of subse‐
    	      quently executed commands.  Equivalent to typeset -gx.  If  a  parameter	specified
    	      does not already exist, it is created in the global scope.
    
           false [ arg ... ]
    	      Do nothing and return an exit status of 1.
    
           fc [ -e ename ] [ -LI ] [ -m match ] [ old=new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]
           fc -l [ -LI ] [ -nrdfEiD ] [ -t timefmt ] [ -m match ]
    	     [ old=new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]
           fc -p [ -a ] [ filename [ histsize [ savehistsize ] ] ]
           fc -P
           fc -ARWI [ filename ]
    	      The  fc  command controls the interactive history mechanism.  Note that reading and
    	      writing of history options is only performed if the shell is interactive.   Usually
    	      this  is	detected  automatically,  but it can be forced by setting the interactive
    	      option when starting the shell.
    
    	      The first two forms of this command select a range of events  from  first  to  last
    	      from  the  history list.	The arguments first and last may be specified as a number
    	      or as a string.  A negative number is used as an	offset	to  the  current  history
    	      event  number.   A  string specifies the most recent event beginning with the given
    	      string.  All substitutions old=new, if any, are then performed on the text  of  the
    	      events.
    
    	      In addition to the the number range,
    	      -I     restricts to only internal events (not from $HISTFILE)
    	      -L     restricts	to only local events (not from other shells, see SHARE_HISTORY in
    		     zshoptions(1) -- note that  $HISTFILE  is	considered  local  when  read  at
    		     startup)
    	      -m     takes  the  first argument as a pattern (should be quoted) and only the his‐
    		     tory events matching this pattern are considered
    
    	      If first is not specified, it will be set to -1 (the most recent event), or to  -16
    	      if  the -l flag is given.  If last is not specified, it will be set to first, or to
    	      -1 if the -l flag is given.  However, if the current event has added entries to the
    	      history  with  `print -s' or `fc -R', then the default last for -l includes all new
    	      history entries since the current event began.
    
    	      When the -l flag is given, the resulting events  are  listed  on	standard  output.
    	      Otherwise  the  editor  program ename is invoked on a file containing these history
    	      events.  If ename is not given, the value of the parameter FCEDIT is used; if  that
    	      is  not set the value of the parameter EDITOR is used; if that is not set a builtin
    	      default, usually `vi' is used.  If ename is `-', no editor is invoked.  When  edit‐
    	      ing is complete, the edited command is executed.
    
    	      The  flag -r reverses the order of the events and the flag -n suppresses event num‐
    	      bers when listing.
    
    	      Also when listing,
    	      -d     prints timestamps for each event
    	      -f     prints full time-date stamps in the US `MM/DD/YY hh:mm' format
    	      -E     prints full time-date stamps in the European `dd.mm.yyyy hh:mm' format
    	      -i     prints full time-date stamps in ISO8601 `yyyy-mm-dd hh:mm' format
    	      -t fmt prints time and date stamps in the given format; fmt is formatted	with  the
    		     strftime  function  with  the  zsh  extensions  described for the %D{string}
    		     prompt format in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT  SEQUENCES  in  zshmisc(1).
    		     The  resulting  formatted string must be no more than 256 characters or will
    		     not be printed
    	      -D     prints elapsed times; may be combined with one of the options above
    
    	      `fc -p' pushes the current history list onto a stack and switches to a new  history
    	      list.   If the -a option is also specified, this history list will be automatically
    	      popped when the current function scope is exited, which is a much  better  solution
    	      than creating a trap function to call `fc -P' manually.  If no arguments are speci‐
    	      fied, the history list is left empty, $HISTFILE is unset, and $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST
    	      are  set	to  their  default values.  If one argument is given, $HISTFILE is set to
    	      that filename, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are left unchanged, and the	history  file  is
    	      read  in (if it exists) to initialize the new list.  If a second argument is speci‐
    	      fied, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are instead set to the single specified numeric  value.
    	      Finally,	if  a  third  argument is specified, $SAVEHIST is set to a separate value
    	      from $HISTSIZE.  You are free to change these environment values for the	new  his‐
    	      tory list however you desire in order to manipulate the new history list.
    
    	      `fc  -P' pops the history list back to an older list saved by `fc -p'.  The current
    	      list is saved to its $HISTFILE before it is destroyed (assuming that $HISTFILE  and
    	      $SAVEHIST  are  set appropriately, of course).  The values of $HISTFILE, $HISTSIZE,
    	      and $SAVEHIST are restored to the values they had when `fc -p'  was  called.   Note
    	      that  this  restoration  can  conflict with making these variables "local", so your
    	      best bet is to avoid local declarations for these variables in functions	that  use
    	      `fc -p'.	The one other guaranteed-safe combination is declaring these variables to
    	      be local at the top of your function and using the automatic option (-a)	with  `fc
    	      -p'.   Finally,  note  that it is legal to manually pop a push marked for automatic
    	      popping if you need to do so before the function exits.
    
    	      `fc -R' reads the history from the given file, `fc -W' writes the  history  out  to
    	      the given file, and `fc -A' appends the history out to the given file.  If no file‐
    	      name is specified, the $HISTFILE is assumed.  If the -I option is added to -R, only
    	      those  events  that  are not already contained within the internal history list are
    	      added.  If the -I option is added to -A or -W, only those events that are new since
    	      last  incremental  append/write  to  the history file are appended/written.  In any
    	      case, the created file will have no more than $SAVEHIST entries.
    
           fg [ job ... ]
           job ...
    	      Bring each specified job in turn to the foreground.  If no job is specified, resume
    	      the current job.
    
           float [ {+|-}Hghlprtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZ [ n ] ] [ name[=value] ... ]
    	      Equivalent  to typeset -E, except that options irrelevant to floating point numbers
    	      are not permitted.
    
           functions [ {+|-}UkmtTuz ] [ -x num ] [ name ... ]
           functions -M mathfn [ min [ max [ shellfn ] ] ]
           functions -M [ -m pattern ... ]
           functions +M [ -m ] mathfn ...
    	      Equivalent to typeset -f, with the exception of the -x and -M options.
    
    	      The -x option indicates that any functions output will have each	leading  tab  for
    	      indentation,  added by the shell to show syntactic structure, expanded to the given
    	      number num of spaces.  num can also be 0 to suppress all indentation.
    
    	      Use of the -M option may not be combined with any of the options handled by typeset
    	      -f.
    
    	      functions  -M  mathfn  defines mathfn as the name of a mathematical function recog‐
    	      nised in all forms of arithmetical expressions; see the section `Arithmetic Evalua‐
    	      tion'  in  zshmisc(1).   By  default  mathfn may take any number of comma-separated
    	      arguments.  If min is given, it must have exactly min args; if min and max are both
    	      given,  it  must have at least min and at most max args.	max may be -1 to indicate
    	      that there is no upper limit.
    
    	      By default the function is implemented by a shell function of  the  same	name;  if
    	      shellfn  is  specified  it gives the name of the corresponding shell function while
    	      mathfn remains the name used in arithmetical expressions.  The name of the function
    	      in  $0  is  mathfn  (not shellfn as would usually be the case), provided the option
    	      FUNCTION_ARGZERO is in effect.  The positional parameters  in  the  shell  function
    	      correspond  to  the arguments of the mathematical function call.	The result of the
    	      last arithmetical expression evaluated inside the shell function (even if it  is	a
    	      form  that  normally  only  returns  a status) gives the result of the mathematical
    	      function.
    
    	      functions -M with no arguments lists all such user-defined functions  in	the  same
    	      form  as	a definition.  With the additional option -m and a list of arguments, all
    	      functions whose mathfn matches one of the pattern arguments are listed.
    
    	      function +M removes the list of mathematical functions; with the additional  option
    	      -m the arguments are treated as patterns and all functions whose mathfn matches the
    	      pattern are removed.  Note that the shell function implementing  the  behaviour  is
    	      not removed (regardless of whether its name coincides with mathfn).
    
    	      For example, the following prints the cube of 3:
    
    		     zmath_cube() { (( $1 * $1 * $1 )) }
    		     functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
    		     print $(( cube(3) ))
    
           getcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           getln [ -AclneE ] name ...
    	      Read  the  top  value from the buffer stack and put it in the shell parameter name.
    	      Equivalent to read -zr.
    
           getopts optstring name [ arg ... ]
    	      Checks the args for legal options.  If the args are  omitted,  use  the  positional
    	      parameters.   A  valid option argument begins with a `+' or a `-'.  An argument not
    	      beginning with a `+' or a `-', or the argument `--', ends the options.  Note that a
    	      single  `-' is not considered a valid option argument.  optstring contains the let‐
    	      ters that getopts recognizes.  If a letter  is  followed	by  a  `:',  that  option
    	      requires an argument.  The options can be separated from the argument by blanks.
    
    	      Each  time  it  is  invoked, getopts places the option letter it finds in the shell
    	      parameter name, prepended with a `+' when arg begins with a `+'.	The index of  the
    	      next arg is stored in OPTIND.  The option argument, if any, is stored in OPTARG.
    
    	      The  first  option to be examined may be changed by explicitly assigning to OPTIND.
    	      OPTIND has an initial value of 1, and is normally set to 1 upon entry  to  a  shell
    	      function	and  restored  upon exit (this is disabled by the POSIX_BUILTINS option).
    	      OPTARG is not reset and retains its value from the most recent call to getopts.  If
    	      either  of OPTIND or OPTARG is explicitly unset, it remains unset, and the index or
    	      option argument is not stored.  The option itself is still stored in name  in  this
    	      case.
    
    	      A leading `:' in optstring causes getopts to store the letter of any invalid option
    	      in OPTARG, and to set name to `?' for an unknown option and to `:' when a  required
    	      argument	is missing.  Otherwise, getopts sets name to `?' and prints an error mes‐
    	      sage when an option is invalid.  The exit status is nonzero when there are no  more
    	      options.
    
           hash [ -Ldfmrv ] [ name[=value] ] ...
    	      hash can be used to directly modify the contents of the command hash table, and the
    	      named directory hash table.  Normally one would modify these  tables  by	modifying
    	      one's PATH (for the command hash table) or by creating appropriate shell parameters
    	      (for the named directory hash table).  The choice of  hash  table  to  work  on  is
    	      determined by the -d option; without the option the command hash table is used, and
    	      with the option the named directory hash table is used.
    
    	      Given no arguments, and neither the -r or -f options, the selected hash table  will
    	      be listed in full.
    
    	      The  -r  option  causes  the  selected hash table to be emptied.	It will be subse‐
    	      quently rebuilt in the normal fashion.  The -f option causes the selected hash  ta‐
    	      ble  to  be  fully rebuilt immediately.  For the command hash table this hashes all
    	      the absolute directories in the PATH, and for the named directory hash  table  this
    	      adds  all users' home directories.  These two options cannot be used with any argu‐
    	      ments.
    
    	      The -m option causes the arguments to be taken as patterns (which should be quoted)
    	      and  the	elements  of the hash table matching those patterns are printed.  This is
    	      the only way to display a limited selection of hash table elements.
    
    	      For each name with a corresponding value, put `name' in the  selected  hash  table,
    	      associating  it  with  the pathname `value'.  In the command hash table, this means
    	      that whenever `name' is used as a command argument, the shell will try  to  execute
    	      the  file  given	by  `value'.   In the named directory hash table, this means that
    	      `value' may be referred to as `~name'.
    
    	      For each name with no corresponding value, attempt to add name to the  hash  table,
    	      checking	what  the  appropriate value is in the normal manner for that hash table.
    	      If an appropriate value can't be found, then the hash table will be unchanged.
    
    	      The -v option causes hash table entries to be listed as they are added by  explicit
    	      specification.  If has no effect if used with -f.
    
    	      If  the  -L flag is present, then each hash table entry is printed in the form of a
    	      call to hash.
    
           history
    	      Same as fc -l.
    
           integer [ {+|-}Hghlprtux ] [ {+|-}LRZi [ n ] ] [ name[=value] ... ]
    	      Equivalent to typeset -i, except that options irrelevant to integers are	not  per‐
    	      mitted.
    
           jobs [ -dlprs ] [ job ... ]
           jobs -Z string
    	      Lists information about each given job, or all jobs if job is omitted.  The -l flag
    	      lists process IDs, and the -p flag lists process groups.	If the -r flag is  speci‐
    	      fied only running jobs will be listed and if the -s flag is given only stopped jobs
    	      are shown.  If the -d flag is given, the directory from which the job  was  started
    	      (which may not be the current directory of the job) will also be shown.
    
    	      The  -Z  option  replaces the shell's argument and environment space with the given
    	      string, truncated if necessary to fit.  This will normally be visible in ps (ps(1))
    	      listings.  This feature is typically used by daemons, to indicate their state.
    
           kill [ -s signal_name | -n signal_number | -sig ] job ...
           kill -l [ sig ... ]
    	      Sends  either SIGTERM or the specified signal to the given jobs or processes.  Sig‐
    	      nals are given by number or by names, with or without the  `SIG'	prefix.   If  the
    	      signal  being sent is not `KILL' or `CONT', then the job will be sent a `CONT' sig‐
    	      nal if it is stopped.  The argument job can be the process ID of a job not  in  the
    	      job  list.   In  the second form, kill -l, if sig is not specified the signal names
    	      are listed.  Otherwise, for each sig that is a name, the corresponding signal  num‐
    	      ber  is  listed.	For each sig that is a signal number or a number representing the
    	      exit status of a process which was terminated or stopped by a signal  the  name  of
    	      the signal is printed.
    
    	      On  some	systems, alternative signal names are allowed for a few signals.  Typical
    	      examples are SIGCHLD and SIGCLD or SIGPOLL and SIGIO, assuming they  correspond  to
    	      the same signal number.  kill -l will only list the preferred form, however kill -l
    	      alt will show if the alternative form corresponds to a signal number.  For example,
    	      under  Linux  kill  -l  IO and kill -l POLL both output 29, hence kill -IO and kill
    	      -POLL have the same effect.
    
    	      Many systems will allow process IDs to be negative to kill a process group or  zero
    	      to kill the current process group.
    
           let arg ...
    	      Evaluate each arg as an arithmetic expression.  See the section `Arithmetic Evalua‐
    	      tion' in zshmisc(1) for a description of arithmetic expressions.	The  exit  status
    	      is  0  if the value of the last expression is nonzero, 1 if it is zero, and 2 if an
    	      error occurred.
    
           limit [ -hs ] [ resource [ limit ] ] ...
    	      Set or display resource limits.  Unless the -s flag is  given,  the  limit  applies
    	      only  the  children  of  the  shell.   If  -s is given without other arguments, the
    	      resource limits of the current shell is set to the previously set  resource  limits
    	      of the children.
    
    	      If  limit  is  not specified, print the current limit placed on resource, otherwise
    	      set the limit to the specified value.  If the -h flag is	given,	use  hard  limits
    	      instead of soft limits.  If no resource is given, print all limits.
    
    	      When  looping  over  multiple  resources,  the  shell  will abort immediately if it
    	      detects a badly formed argument.	However, if it fails to  set  a  limit	for  some
    	      other reason it will continue trying to set the remaining limits.
    
    	      resource can be one of:
    
    	      addressspace
    		     Maximum amount of address space used.
    	      aiomemorylocked
    		     Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM for AIO operations.
    	      aiooperations
    		     Maximum number of AIO operations.
    	      cachedthreads
    		     Maximum number of cached threads.
    	      coredumpsize
    		     Maximum size of a core dump.
    	      cputime
    		     Maximum CPU seconds per process.
    	      datasize
    		     Maximum data size (including stack) for each process.
    	      descriptors
    		     Maximum value for a file descriptor.
    	      filesize
    		     Largest single file allowed.
    	      kqueues
    		     Maximum number of kqueues allocated.
    	      maxproc
    		     Maximum number of processes.
    	      maxpthreads
    		     Maximum number of threads per process.
    	      memorylocked
    		     Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM.
    	      memoryuse
    		     Maximum resident set size.
    	      msgqueue
    		     Maximum number of bytes in POSIX message queues.
    	      posixlocks
    		     Maximum number of POSIX locks per user.
    	      pseudoterminals
    		     Maximum number of pseudo-terminals.
    	      resident
    		     Maximum resident set size.
    	      sigpending
    		     Maximum number of pending signals.
    	      sockbufsize
    		     Maximum size of all socket buffers.
    	      stacksize
    		     Maximum stack size for each process.
    	      swapsize
    		     Maximum amount of swap used.
    	      vmemorysize
    		     Maximum amount of virtual memory.
    
    	      Which  of  these resource limits are available depends on the system.  resource can
    	      be abbreviated to any unambiguous prefix.  It can also be an integer, which  corre‐
    	      sponds to the integer defined for the resource by the operating system.
    
    	      If argument corresponds to a number which is out of the range of the resources con‐
    	      figured into the shell, the shell will try to read or write the limit  anyway,  and
    	      will  report  an	error  if this fails.  As the shell does not store such resources
    	      internally, an attempt to set the limit will fail unless the -s option is present.
    
    	      limit is a number, with an optional scaling factor, as follows:
    
    	      nh     hours
    	      nk     kilobytes (default)
    	      nm     megabytes or minutes
    	      [mm:]ss
    		     minutes and seconds
    
    	      The limit command is not made available by default when the shell starts in a  mode
    	      emulating  another  shell.   It can be made available with the command `zmodload -F
    	      zsh/rlimits b:limit'.
    
           local [ {+|-}AHUahlprtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZi [ n ] ] [ name[=value] ... ]
    	      Same as typeset, except that the options -g, and -f are  not  permitted.	 In  this
    	      case  the  -x  option does not force the use of -g, i.e. exported variables will be
    	      local to functions.
    
           log    List all users currently logged in who are affected by the current setting  of  the
    	      watch parameter.
    
           logout [ n ]
    	      Same as exit, except that it only works in a login shell.
    
           noglob simple command
    	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers' in zshmisc(1).
    
           popd [ -q ] [ {+|-}n ]
    	      Remove  an  entry  from the directory stack, and perform a cd to the new top direc‐
    	      tory.  With no argument, the current top entry is removed.  An argument of the form
    	      `+n'  identifies	a  stack entry by counting from the left of the list shown by the
    	      dirs command, starting with zero.  An argument of  the  form  -n	counts	from  the
    	      right.   If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the meanings of `+' and `-' in this con‐
    	      text are swapped.
    
    	      If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd and the functions in
    	      the  array  $chpwd_functions  are  not  called,  and the new directory stack is not
    	      printed.	This is useful for calls to popd that do not change the environment  seen
    	      by an interactive user.
    
           print [ -abcDilmnNoOpPrsSz ] [ -u n ] [ -f format ] [ -C cols ]
    	     [ -xX tab-stop ] [ -R [ -en ]] [ arg ... ]
    	      With  the  `-f'  option  the arguments are printed as described by printf.  With no
    	      flags or with the flag `-', the arguments are printed on	the  standard  output  as
    	      described  by  echo, with the following differences: the escape sequence `\M-x' (or
    	      `\Mx') metafies the character x (sets the highest bit), `\C-x' (or `\Cx')  produces
    	      a  control  character  (`\C-@'  and  `\C-?' give the characters NULL and delete), a
    	      character code in octal is represented by `\NNN' (instead of `\0NNN'), and `\E'  is
    	      a synonym for `\e'.  Finally, if not in an escape sequence, `\' escapes the follow‐
    	      ing character and is not printed.
    
    	      -a     Print arguments with the column incrementing first.  Only useful with the -c
    		     and -C options.
    
    	      -b     Recognize	all the escape sequences defined for the bindkey command, see the
    		     section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).
    
    	      -c     Print the arguments in columns.  Unless -a  is  also  given,  arguments  are
    		     printed with the row incrementing first.
    
    	      -C cols
    		     Print the arguments in cols columns.  Unless -a is also given, arguments are
    		     printed with the row incrementing first.
    
    	      -D     Treat the arguments as paths, replacing directory prefixes  with  ~  expres‐
    		     sions corresponding to directory names, as appropriate.
    
    	      -i     If given together with -o or -O, sorting is performed case-independently.
    
    	      -l     Print the arguments separated by newlines instead of spaces.
    
    	      -m     Take  the first argument as a pattern (should be quoted), and remove it from
    		     the argument list together with subsequent arguments that do not match  this
    		     pattern.
    
    	      -n     Do not add a newline to the output.
    
    	      -N     Print the arguments separated and terminated by nulls.
    
    	      -o     Print the arguments sorted in ascending order.
    
    	      -O     Print the arguments sorted in descending order.
    
    	      -p     Print the arguments to the input of the coprocess.
    
    	      -P     Perform prompt expansion (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)).
    
    	      -r     Ignore the escape conventions of echo.
    
    	      -R     Emulate the BSD echo command, which does not process escape sequences unless
    		     the -e flag is given.  The -n flag suppresses the	trailing  newline.   Only
    		     the -e and -n flags are recognized after -R; all other arguments and options
    		     are printed.
    
    	      -s     Place the results in the history list instead of  on  the	standard  output.
    		     Each  argument  to the print command is treated as a single word in the his‐
    		     tory, regardless of its content.
    
    	      -S     Place the results in the history list instead of on the standard output.  In
    		     this  case only a single argument is allowed; it will be split into words as
    		     if it were a full shell command line.  The effect is similar to reading  the
    		     line from a history file with the HIST_LEX_WORDS option active.
    
    	      -u n   Print the arguments to file descriptor n.
    
    	      -x tab-stop
    		     Expand  leading tabs on each line of output in the printed string assuming a
    		     tab stop every tab-stop characters.  This is appropriate for formatting code
    		     that  may	be indented with tabs.	Note that leading tabs of any argument to
    		     print, not just the first, are expanded, even if print is	using  spaces  to
    		     separate  arguments (the column count is maintained across arguments but may
    		     be incorrect on output owing to previous unexpanded tabs).
    
    		     The start of the output of each print command is assumed to be aligned  with
    		     a tab stop.  Widths of multibyte characters are handled if the option MULTI‐
    		     BYTE is in effect.  This option is ignored if other formatting  options  are
    		     in  effect,  namely  column  alignment or printf style, or if output is to a
    		     special location such as shell history or the command line editor.
    
    	      -X tab-stop
    		     This is similar to -x, except that  all  tabs  in	the  printed  string  are
    		     expanded.	 This  is  appropriate if tabs in the arguments are being used to
    		     produce a table format.
    
    	      -z     Push the arguments onto the editing buffer stack, separated by spaces.
    
    	      If any of `-m', `-o' or `-O' are used in combination with `-f'  and  there  are  no
    	      arguments (after the removal process in the case of `-m') then nothing is printed.
    
           printf format [ arg ... ]
    	      Print the arguments according to the format specification. Formatting rules are the
    	      same as used in C. The same escape sequences as for echo are recognised in the for‐
    	      mat.  All  C conversion specifications ending in one of csdiouxXeEfgGn are handled.
    	      In addition to this, `%b' can be used instead of `%s' to cause escape sequences  in
    	      the  argument to be recognised and `%q' can be used to quote the argument in such a
    	      way that allows it to be reused as shell input. With the numeric format specifiers,
    	      if  the  corresponding argument starts with a quote character, the numeric value of
    	      the following character is used as the number to print; otherwise the  argument  is
    	      evaluated  as  an arithmetic expression. See the section `Arithmetic Evaluation' in
    	      zshmisc(1) for a description of arithmetic expressions. With `%n', the  correspond‐
    	      ing argument is taken as an identifier which is created as an integer parameter.
    
    	      Normally,  conversion specifications are applied to each argument in order but they
    	      can explicitly specify the nth argument is to be used by replacing `%' by `%n$' and
    	      `*'  by  `*n$'.	It is recommended that you do not mix references of this explicit
    	      style with the normal style and the handling of such mixed styles may be subject to
    	      future change.
    
    	      If  arguments remain unused after formatting, the format string is reused until all
    	      arguments have been consumed. With the print builtin, this  can  be  suppressed  by
    	      using  the  -r  option. If more arguments are required by the format than have been
    	      specified, the behaviour is as if zero or an empty string had been specified as the
    	      argument.
    
           pushd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]
           pushd [ -qsLP ] old new
           pushd [ -qsLP ] {+|-}n
    	      Change the current directory, and push the old current directory onto the directory
    	      stack.  In the first form, change the current directory to  arg.	 If  arg  is  not
    	      specified,  change  to the second directory on the stack (that is, exchange the top
    	      two entries), or change to $HOME if the PUSHD_TO_HOME option is set or if there  is
    	      only  one  entry on the stack.  Otherwise, arg is interpreted as it would be by cd.
    	      The meaning of old and new in the second form is also the same as for cd.
    
    	      The third form of pushd changes directory by rotating the directory list.  An argu‐
    	      ment  of	the  form  `+n' identifies a stack entry by counting from the left of the
    	      list shown by the dirs command, starting with zero.  An argument of the  form  `-n'
    	      counts  from  the right.	If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the meanings of `+' and
    	      `-' in this context are swapped.
    
    	      If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd and the functions in
    	      the  array  $chpwd_functions  are  not  called,  and the new directory stack is not
    	      printed.	This is useful for calls to pushd that do not change the environment seen
    	      by an interactive user.
    
    	      If the option -q is not specified and the shell option PUSHD_SILENT is not set, the
    	      directory stack will be printed after a pushd is performed.
    
    	      The options -s, -L and -P have the same meanings as for the cd builtin.
    
           pushln [ arg ... ]
    	      Equivalent to print -nz.
    
           pwd [ -rLP ]
    	      Print the absolute pathname of the current working directory.  If the -r or the  -P
    	      flag  is	specified, or the CHASE_LINKS option is set and the -L flag is not given,
    	      the printed path will not contain symbolic links.
    
           r      Same as fc -e -.
    
           read [ -rszpqAclneE ] [ -t [ num ] ] [ -k [ num ] ] [ -d delim ]
    	    [ -u n ] [ name[?prompt] ] [ name ...  ]
    	      Read one line and break it into fields using the characters in $IFS as  separators,
    	      except  as  noted below.	The first field is assigned to the first name, the second
    	      field to the second name, etc., with leftover fields assigned to the last name.  If
    	      name is omitted then REPLY is used for scalars and reply for arrays.
    
    	      -r     Raw  mode: a `\' at the end of a line does not signify line continuation and
    		     backslashes in the line don't quote the  following  character  and  are  not
    		     removed.
    
    	      -s     Don't echo back characters if reading from the terminal.
    
    	      -q     Read  only one character from the terminal and set name to `y' if this char‐
    		     acter was `y' or `Y' and to `n' otherwise.  With this flag  set  the  return
    		     status  is  zero  only  if the character was `y' or `Y'.  This option may be
    		     used with a timeout (see -t); if the read times out, or  encounters  end  of
    		     file,  status  2 is returned.  Input is read from the terminal unless one of
    		     -u or -p is present.  This option may also be used within zle widgets.
    
    	      -k [ num ]
    		     Read only one (or num) characters.  All are  assigned  to	the  first  name,
    		     without  word splitting.  This flag is ignored when -q is present.  Input is
    		     read from the terminal unless one of -u or -p is present.	This  option  may
    		     also be used within zle widgets.
    
    		     Note  that despite the mnemonic `key' this option does read full characters,
    		     which may consist of multiple bytes if the option MULTIBYTE is set.
    
    	      -z     Read one entry from the editor buffer stack and assign it to the first name,
    		     without  word  splitting.	 Text is pushed onto the stack with `print -z' or
    		     with push-line from the line editor (see zshzle(1)).  This flag  is  ignored
    		     when the -k or -q flags are present.
    
    	      -e
    	      -E     The  input  read is printed (echoed) to the standard output.  If the -e flag
    		     is used, no input is assigned to the parameters.
    
    	      -A     The first name is taken as the name of an array and all words  are  assigned
    		     to it.
    
    	      -c
    	      -l     These flags are allowed only if called inside a function used for completion
    		     (specified with the -K flag to compctl).  If the -c flag is given, the words
    		     of  the current command are read. If the -l flag is given, the whole line is
    		     assigned as a scalar.  If both flags are present,	-l  is	used  and  -c  is
    		     ignored.
    
    	      -n     Together with -c, the number of the word the cursor is on is read.  With -l,
    		     the index of the character the cursor is on is read.  Note that the  command
    		     name is word number 1, not word 0, and that when the cursor is at the end of
    		     the line, its character index is the length of the line plus one.
    
    	      -u n   Input is read from file descriptor n.
    
    	      -p     Input is read from the coprocess.
    
    	      -d delim
    		     Input is terminated by the first character of delim instead of by newline.
    
    	      -t [ num ]
    		     Test if input is available before attempting to read.  If num is present, it
    		     must  begin  with a digit and will be evaluated to give a number of seconds,
    		     which may be a floating point number; in this case the  read  times  out  if
    		     input is not available within this time.  If num is not present, it is taken
    		     to be zero, so that read returns immediately if no input is  available.   If
    		     no input is available, return status 1 and do not set any variables.
    
    		     This  option  is  not available when reading from the editor buffer with -z,
    		     when called from within completion with -c or -l, with -q which  clears  the
    		     input  queue  before reading, or within zle where other mechanisms should be
    		     used to test for input.
    
    		     Note that read does not attempt to alter the  input  processing  mode.   The
    		     default  mode is canonical input, in which an entire line is read at a time,
    		     so usually `read -t' will not read anything until an entire  line	has  been
    		     typed.   However,	when reading from the terminal with -k input is processed
    		     one key at a time; in this case, only availability of the first character is
    		     tested, so that e.g. `read -t -k 2' can still block on the second character.
    		     Use two instances of `read -t -k' if this is not what is wanted.
    
    	      If the first argument contains a `?', the remainder of  this  word  is  used  as	a
    	      prompt on standard error when the shell is interactive.
    
    	      The value (exit status) of read is 1 when an end-of-file is encountered, or when -c
    	      or -l is present and the command is not called  from  a  compctl	function,  or  as
    	      described for -q.  Otherwise the value is 0.
    
    	      The  behavior of some combinations of the -k, -p, -q, -u and -z flags is undefined.
    	      Presently -q cancels all the others, -p cancels -u, -k cancels -z, and otherwise -z
    	      cancels both -p and -u.
    
    	      The -c or -l flags cancel any and all of -kpquz.
    
           readonly
    	      Same as typeset -r.
    
           rehash Same as hash -r.
    
           return [ n ]
    	      Causes  a  shell	function  or `.' script to return to the invoking script with the
    	      return status specified by an arithmetic expression n. If n is omitted, the  return
    	      status is that of the last command executed.
    
    	      If  return  was executed from a trap in a TRAPNAL function, the effect is different
    	      for zero and non-zero return status.  With zero status (or after an implicit return
    	      at  the  end of the trap), the shell will return to whatever it was previously pro‐
    	      cessing; with a non-zero status, the shell will behave as interrupted  except  that
    	      the return status of the trap is retained.  Note that the numeric value of the sig‐
    	      nal which caused the trap is passed as the first argument, so the statement `return
    	      $((128+$1))' will return the same status as if the signal had not been trapped.
    
           sched  See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           set [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o [ option_name ] ] ... [ {+|-}A [ name ] ]
    	   [ arg ... ]
    	      Set  the options for the shell and/or set the positional parameters, or declare and
    	      set an array.  If the -s option is given, it causes the specified arguments  to  be
    	      sorted  before assigning them to the positional parameters (or to the array name if
    	      -A is used).  With +s sort arguments in descending order.  For the meaning  of  the
    	      other  flags,  see  zshoptions(1).   Flags  may  be  specified by name using the -o
    	      option. If no option name is supplied  with  -o,	the  current  option  states  are
    	      printed:	 see  the description of setopt below for more information on the format.
    	      With +o they are printed in a form that can be used as input to the shell.
    
    	      If the -A flag is specified, name is set to an array containing the given args;  if
    	      no name is specified, all arrays are printed together with their values.
    
    	      If  +A  is  used and name is an array, the given arguments will replace the initial
    	      elements of that array; if no name is specified, all  arrays  are  printed  without
    	      their values.
    
    	      The  behaviour  of arguments after -A name or +A name depends on whether the option
    	      KSH_ARRAYS is set.  If it is not set, all arguments following name are  treated  as
    	      values  for  the	array,	regardless  of	their form.  If the option is set, normal
    	      option processing continues at that point; only regular arguments  are  treated  as
    	      values for the array.  This means that
    
    		     set -A array -x -- foo
    
    	      sets  array  to `-x -- foo' if KSH_ARRAYS is not set, but sets the array to foo and
    	      turns on the option `-x' if it is set.
    
    	      If the -A flag is not present, but there are  arguments  beyond  the  options,  the
    	      positional  parameters are set.  If the option list (if any) is terminated by `--',
    	      and there are no further arguments, the positional parameters will be unset.
    
    	      If no arguments and no `--' are given, then the names and values of all  parameters
    	      are  printed on the standard output.  If the only argument is `+', the names of all
    	      parameters are printed.
    
    	      For historical reasons, `set -' is treated as `set +xv' and `set -  args'  as  `set
    	      +xv -- args' when in any other emulation mode than zsh's native mode.
    
           setcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           setopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ -m ] [ name ... ]
    	      Set  the options for the shell.  All options specified either with flags or by name
    	      are set.
    
    	      If no arguments are supplied, the names of all options currently set  are  printed.
    	      The  form  is chosen so as to minimize the differences from the default options for
    	      the current emulation (the default emulation being native  zsh,  shown  as  <Z>  in
    	      zshoptions(1)).	Options  that  are on by default for the emulation are shown with
    	      the prefix no only if they are off, while other options are shown without the  pre‐
    	      fix  no  and  only if they are on.  In addition to options changed from the default
    	      state by the user, any options activated automatically by the shell  (for  example,
    	      SHIN_STDIN  or INTERACTIVE) will be shown in the list.  The format is further modi‐
    	      fied by the option KSH_OPTION_PRINT, however the	rationale  for	choosing  options
    	      with or without the no prefix remains the same in this case.
    
    	      If the -m flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns (which should be quoted
    	      to protect them from filename expansion), and all options with names matching these
    	      patterns are set.
    
    	      Note that a bad option name does not cause execution of subsequent shell code to be
    	      aborted; this is behaviour is different from that of `set -o'.  This is because set
    	      is regarded as a special builtin by the POSIX standard, but setopt is not.
    
           shift [ -p ] [ n ] [ name ... ]
    	      The  positional  parameters  ${n+1} ... are renamed to $1 ..., where n is an arith‐
    	      metic expression that defaults to 1.  If any names are given then the  arrays  with
    	      these names are shifted instead of the positional parameters.
    
    	      If  the  option  -p  is  given  arguments are instead removed (popped) from the end
    	      rather than the start of the array.
    
           source file [ arg ... ]
    	      Same as `.', except that the current directory is always	searched  and  is  always
    	      searched first, before directories in $path.
    
           stat   See the section `The zsh/stat Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           suspend [ -f ]
    	      Suspend the execution of the shell (send it a SIGTSTP) until it receives a SIGCONT.
    	      Unless the -f option is given, this will refuse to suspend a login shell.
    
           test [ arg ... ]
           [ [ arg ... ] ]
    	      Like the system version of test.	Added for compatibility; use conditional  expres‐
    	      sions  instead  (see  the section `Conditional Expressions').  The main differences
    	      between the conditional expression syntax and the test and [ builtins  are:   these
    	      commands	are not handled syntactically, so for example an empty variable expansion
    	      may cause an argument to be omitted; syntax errors cause status 2  to  be  returned
    	      instead  of a shell error; and arithmetic operators expect integer arguments rather
    	      than arithmetic expressions.
    
    	      The command attempts to implement POSIX and its extensions where these  are  speci‐
    	      fied.   Unfortunately  there are intrinsic ambiguities in the syntax; in particular
    	      there is no distinction between test operators and strings that resemble them.  The
    	      standard attempts to resolve these for small numbers of arguments (up to four); for
    	      five or more arguments compatibility cannot be relied on.  Users are urged wherever
    	      possible to use the `[[' test syntax which does not have these ambiguities.
    
           times  Print  the  accumulated  user  and system times for the shell and for processes run
    	      from the shell.
    
           trap [ arg ] [ sig ... ]
    	      arg is a series of commands (usually quoted to protect it from immediate evaluation
    	      by  the  shell)  to be read and executed when the shell receives any of the signals
    	      specified by one or more sig args.  Each sig can be given as a number,  or  as  the
    	      name  of	a signal either with or without the string SIG in front (e.g. 1, HUP, and
    	      SIGHUP are all the same signal).
    
    	      If arg is `-', then the specified signals are reset to their defaults,  or,  if  no
    	      sig args are present, all traps are reset.
    
    	      If arg is an empty string, then the specified signals are ignored by the shell (and
    	      by the commands it invokes).
    
    	      If arg is omitted but one or more sig args are provided (i.e.  the  first  argument
    	      is a valid signal number or name), the effect is the same as if arg had been speci‐
    	      fied as `-'.
    
    	      The trap command with no arguments prints a list of commands associated  with  each
    	      signal.
    
    	      If  sig  is  ZERR  then arg will be executed after each command with a nonzero exit
    	      status.  ERR is an alias for ZERR on systems that have no SIGERR	signal	(this  is
    	      the usual case).
    
    	      If  sig  is  DEBUG  then	arg  will  be  executed before each command if the option
    	      DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set (as it is by default), else after each  command.	 Here,	a
    	      `command' is what is described as a `sublist' in the shell grammar, see the section
    	      SIMPLE COMMANDS & PIPELINES in zshmisc(1).   If  DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD  is  set  various
    	      additional  features are available.  First, it is possible to skip the next command
    	      by setting the option ERR_EXIT; see the  description  of	the  ERR_EXIT  option  in
    	      zshoptions(1).  Also, the shell parameter ZSH_DEBUG_CMD is set to the string corre‐
    	      sponding to the command to be executed following the trap.  Note that  this  string
    	      is  reconstructed from the internal format and may not be formatted the same way as
    	      the original text.  The parameter is unset after the trap is executed.
    
    	      If sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap statement is executed inside the body of  a  func‐
    	      tion,  then the command arg is executed after the function completes.  The value of
    	      $? at the start of execution is the exit status of the shell or the  return  status
    	      of  the  function  exiting.  If sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap statement is not exe‐
    	      cuted inside the body of a function, then the command  arg  is  executed	when  the
    	      shell terminates; the trap runs before any zshexit hook functions.
    
    	      ZERR,  DEBUG,  and  EXIT traps are not executed inside other traps.  ZERR and DEBUG
    	      traps are kept within subshells, while other traps are reset.
    
    	      Note that traps defined with the trap builtin are  slightly  different  from  those
    	      defined  as `TRAPNAL () { ... }', as the latter have their own function environment
    	      (line numbers, local variables, etc.) while the former use the environment  of  the
    	      command in which they were called.  For example,
    
    		     trap 'print $LINENO' DEBUG
    
    	      will print the line number of a command executed after it has run, while
    
    		     TRAPDEBUG() { print $LINENO; }
    
    	      will always print the number zero.
    
    	      Alternative  signal  names  are  allowed as described under kill above.  Defining a
    	      trap under either name causes any trap under an alternative  name  to  be  removed.
    	      However, it is recommended that for consistency users stick exclusively to one name
    	      or another.
    
           true [ arg ... ]
    	      Do nothing and return an exit status of 0.
    
           ttyctl [ -fu ]
    	      The -f option freezes  the  tty  (i.e.  terminal	or  terminal  emulator),  and  -u
    	      unfreezes  it.   When  the  tty  is  frozen, no changes made to the tty settings by
    	      external programs will be honored by the shell, except for changes in the  size  of
    	      the  screen;  the  shell will simply reset the settings to their previous values as
    	      soon as each command exits or is suspended.  Thus, stty and similar  programs  have
    	      no  effect  when	the  tty  is frozen.  Freezing the tty does not cause the current
    	      state to be remembered: instead, it causes  future  changes  to  the  state  to  be
    	      blocked.
    
    	      Without options it reports whether the terminal is frozen or not.
    
    	      Note  that,  regardless  of  whether  the  tty is frozen or not, the shell needs to
    	      change the settings when the line editor starts, so unfreezing  the  tty	does  not
    	      guarantee settings made on the command line are preserved.  Strings of commands run
    	      between editing the command line will see a consistent tty  state.   See	also  the
    	      shell  variable  STTY  for  a means of initialising the tty before running external
    	      commands.
    
           type [ -wfpamsS ] name ...
    	      Equivalent to whence -v.
    
           typeset [ {+|-}AHUaghlmprtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZi [ n ] ]
    	       [ + ] [ name[=value] ... ]
           typeset -T [ {+|-}Uglprux ] [ {+|-}LRZ [ n ] ]
    	       [ + | SCALAR[=value] array[=(value ...)] [ sep ] ]
           typeset -f [ {+|-}TUkmtuz ] [ + ] [ name ... ]
    	      Set or display attributes and values for shell parameters.
    
    	      A parameter is created for each name that does not  already  refer  to  one.   When
    	      inside  a  function,  a  new  parameter  is created for every name (even those that
    	      already exist), and is unset again when the function completes.  See `Local Parame‐
    	      ters'  in  zshparam(1).	The  same  rules apply to special shell parameters, which
    	      retain their special attributes when made local.
    
    	      For each name=value assignment, the parameter name is set to value.  All	forms  of
    	      the command handle scalar assignment.
    
    	      If  any  of  the reserved words declare, export, float, integer, local, readonly or
    	      typeset is matched when the line is parsed (N.B. not when it is executed) the shell
    	      will  try  to  parse  arguments as assignments, except that the `+=' syntax and the
    	      GLOB_ASSIGN option are not supported.  This has two major differences  from  normal
    	      command  line  argument  parsing:  array	assignment is possible, and scalar values
    	      after = are not split further into words even if expanded (regardless of	the  set‐
    	      ting of the KSH_TYPESET option; this option is obsolete).  Here is an example:
    
    		     # Reserved word parsing
    		     typeset svar=$(echo one word) avar=(several words)
    
    	      The  above  creates  a  scalar parameter svar and an array parameter avar as if the
    	      assignments had been
    
    		     svar="one word"
    		     avar=(several words)
    
    	      On the other hand:
    
    		     # Normal builtin interface
    		     builtin typeset svar=$(echo two words)
    
    	      The builtin keyword causes the above to use the standard builtin interface to type‐
    	      set  in  which  argument parsing is perfomed in the same way as for other commands.
    	      This example creates a scalar svar containing the  value	two  and  another  scalar
    	      parameter  words	with no value.	An array value in this case would either cause an
    	      error or be treated as an obscure set of glob qualifiers.
    
    	      Arbitrary arguments are allowed if they take the form of assignments after  command
    	      line expansion; however, these only perform scalar assignment:
    
    		     var='svar=val'
    		     typeset $var
    
    	      The  above sets the scalar parameter svar to the value val.  Parentheses around the
    	      value within var would not cause array assignment as they will be treated as  ordi‐
    	      nary  characters	when  $var is substituted.  Any non-trivial expansion in the name
    	      part of the assignment causes the argument to be treated in this fashion:
    
    		     typeset {var1,var2,var3}=name
    
    	      The above syntax is valid, and has the expected effect of setting the three parame‐
    	      ters  to	the  same  value, but the command line is parsed as a set of three normal
    	      command line arguments to typeset after expansion.  Hence it  is	not  possible  to
    	      assign to multiple arrays by this means.
    
    	      Note  that  each	interface  to any of the commands my be disabled separately.  For
    	      example, `disable -r typeset' disables the  reserved  word  interface  to  typeset,
    	      exposing the builtin interface, while `disable typeset' disables the builtin.
    
    	      If  the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not set, for each remaining name that refers
    	      to a parameter that is already set, the name and value of the parameter are printed
    	      in  the form of an assignment.  Nothing is printed for newly-created parameters, or
    	      when any attribute flags listed below are given along with  the  name.   Using  `+'
    	      instead of minus to introduce an attribute turns it off.
    
    	      If no name is present, the names and values of all parameters are printed.  In this
    	      case the attribute flags restrict the display to only those  parameters  that  have
    	      the  specified attributes, and using `+' rather than `-' to introduce the flag sup‐
    	      presses printing of the values of parameters when there is no parameter name.
    
    	      If no attribute flags are given, and either no name arguments are  present  or  the
    	      flag  +m	is  used,  then  each parameter name printed is preceded by a list of the
    	      attributes of that parameter (array, association, exported, float,  integer,  read‐
    	      only,  or  undefined for autoloaded parameters not yet loaded).  If +m is used with
    	      attribute flags, and all those flags are introduced with +, the matching	parameter
    	      names are printed but their values are not.
    
    	      The following control flags change the behavior of typeset:
    
    	      +      If  `+'  appears  by  itself in a separate word as the last option, then the
    		     names of all parameters (functions with -f)  are  printed,  but  the  values
    		     (function bodies) are not.  No name arguments may appear, and it is an error
    		     for any other options to follow `+'.   The  effect  of  `+'  is  as  if  all
    		     attribute flags which precede it were given with a `+' prefix.  For example,
    		     `typeset -U +' is equivalent to `typeset +U' and displays the names  of  all
    		     arrays  having  the uniqueness attribute, whereas `typeset -f -U +' displays
    		     the names of all autoloadable functions.  If + is the only option, then type
    		     information  (array,  readonly, etc.) is also printed for each parameter, in
    		     the same manner as `typeset +m "*"'.
    
    	      -g     The -g (global) means that any resulting parameter will not be restricted to
    		     local  scope.   Note  that this does not necessarily mean that the parameter
    		     will be global, as the flag will apply to any existing  parameter	(even  if
    		     unset)  from an enclosing function.  This flag does not affect the parameter
    		     after creation, hence it has no effect when listing existing parameters, nor
    		     does the flag +g have any effect except in combination with -m (see below).
    
    	      -m     If  the -m flag is given the name arguments are taken as patterns (use quot‐
    		     ing to prevent these from being interpreted  as  file  patterns).	 With  no
    		     attribute	flags, all parameters (or functions with the -f flag) with match‐
    		     ing names are printed (the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not used  in  this
    		     case).
    
    		     If  the  +g  flag	is combined with -m, a new local parameter is created for
    		     every matching parameter that is not already local.   Otherwise  -m  applies
    		     all other flags or assignments to the existing parameters.
    
    		     Except when assignments are made with name=value, using +m forces the match‐
    		     ing parameters and their attributes to be printed, even inside  a	function.
    		     Note  that  -m is ignored if no patterns are given, so `typeset -m' displays
    		     attributes but `typeset -a +m' does not.
    
    	      -p     If the -p option is given, parameters and values are printed in the form  of
    		     a	typeset  command  and an assignment (which will be printed separately for
    		     arrays and associative arrays), regardless of other flags and options.  Note
    		     that  the	-H  flag  on  parameters is respected; no value will be shown for
    		     these parameters.
    
    		     As the intention of this option is to produce output that	can  restore  the
    		     current  state,  readonly	specials (whose values cannot be changed) are not
    		     shown and assignments to arrays are shown before the typeset  rendering  the
    		     array readonly.
    
    	      -T [ scalar[=value] array[=(value ...)] [ sep ] ]
    		     This  flag  has a different meaning when used with -f; see below.	Otherwise
    		     the -T option requires zero, two, or three arguments to be present.  With no
    		     arguments,  the  list  of parameters created in this fashion is shown.  With
    		     two or three arguments, the first two are the name of a  scalar  and  of  an
    		     array  parameter (in that order) that will be tied together in the manner of
    		     $PATH and $path.  The optional third argument is a single-character  separa‐
    		     tor which will be used to join the elements of the array to form the scalar;
    		     if absent, a colon is used, as with $PATH.  Only the first character of  the
    		     separator	is  significant; any remaining characters are ignored.	Multibyte
    		     characters are not yet supported.
    
    		     Only one of the scalar and array parameters may be assigned an initial value
    		     (the restrictions on assignment forms described above also apply).
    
    		     Both  the	scalar	and  the  array  may be manipulated as normal.	If one is
    		     unset, the other will automatically be unset too.	There is no way of  unty‐
    		     ing  the variables without unsetting them, nor of converting the type of one
    		     of them with another typeset command; +T does not work, assigning	an  array
    		     to  scalar is an error, and assigning a scalar to array sets it to be a sin‐
    		     gle-element array.
    
    		     Note that both `typeset -xT ...'  and `export -T ...'  work,  but	only  the
    		     scalar  will  be marked for export.  Setting the value using the scalar ver‐
    		     sion causes a split on all separators (which cannot be quoted).  It is  pos‐
    		     sible to apply -T to two previously tied variables but with a different sep‐
    		     arator character, in which case the variables remain joined  as  before  but
    		     the separator is changed.
    
    	      Attribute  flags	that  transform  the  final  value  (-L, -R, -Z, -l, -u) are only
    	      applied to the expanded value at the point  of  a  parameter  expansion  expression
    	      using  `$'.   They  are not applied when a parameter is retrieved internally by the
    	      shell for any purpose.
    
    	      The following attribute flags may be specified:
    
    	      -A     The names refer to associative array parameters; see `Array  Parameters'  in
    		     zshparam(1).
    
    	      -L [ n ]
    		     Left  justify and remove leading blanks from the value when the parameter is
    		     expanded.	If n is nonzero, it defines the width of  the  field.	If  n  is
    		     zero, the width is determined by the width of the value of the first assign‐
    		     ment.  In the case of numeric parameters, the length of the  complete  value
    		     assigned to the parameter is used to determine the width, not the value that
    		     would be output.
    
    		     The width is the count of characters, which may be multibyte  characters  if
    		     the  MULTIBYTE option is in effect.  Note that the screen width of the char‐
    		     acter is not taken into account; if  this	is  required,  use  padding  with
    		     parameter expansion flags ${(ml...)...} as described in `Parameter Expansion
    		     Flags' in zshexpn(1).
    
    		     When the parameter is expanded, it is filled on the  right  with  blanks  or
    		     truncated	if necessary to fit the field.	Note truncation can lead to unex‐
    		     pected results with numeric parameters.  Leading zeros are removed if the -Z
    		     flag is also set.
    
    	      -R [ n ]
    		     Similar  to  -L, except that right justification is used; when the parameter
    		     is expanded, the field is left filled with blanks or truncated from the end.
    		     May not be combined with the -Z flag.
    
    	      -U     For  arrays (but not for associative arrays), keep only the first occurrence
    		     of each duplicated value.	This may also be set for colon-separated  special
    		     parameters  like  PATH  or  FIGNORE, etc.	This flag has a different meaning
    		     when used with -f; see below.
    
    	      -Z [ n ]
    		     Specially handled if set along with the -L flag.  Otherwise, similar to  -R,
    		     except  that  leading  zeros  are	used for padding instead of blanks if the
    		     first non-blank character is a digit.  Numeric parameters are specially han‐
    		     dled:  they  are always eligible for padding with zeroes, and the zeroes are
    		     inserted at an appropriate place in the output.
    
    	      -a     The names refer to array parameters.  An array parameter may be created this
    		     way,  but it may not be assigned to in the typeset statement.  When display‐
    		     ing, both normal and associative arrays are shown.
    
    	      -f     The names refer to functions rather than parameters.  No assignments can  be
    		     made,  and  the  only  other valid flags are -t, -T, -k, -u, -U and -z.  The
    		     flag -t turns on execution tracing for this function; the flag -T	does  the
    		     same,  but  turns	off  tracing on any function called from the present one,
    		     unless that function also has the -t or -T flag.  The -u and -U flags  cause
    		     the function to be marked for autoloading; -U also causes alias expansion to
    		     be suppressed when the function is loaded.   The  fpath  parameter  will  be
    		     searched  to  find the function definition when the function is first refer‐
    		     enced; see the section `Functions'. The -k and -z flags make the function be
    		     loaded  using ksh-style or zsh-style autoloading respectively. If neither is
    		     given, the setting of the KSH_AUTOLOAD option determines how the function is
    		     loaded.
    
    		     Note  that  the  builtin  functions  provides the same basic capabilities as
    		     typeset -f but gives access to a few extra options.
    
    	      -h     Hide: only useful for special parameters (those marked `<S>' in the table in
    		     zshparam(1)),  and  for  local  parameters  with  the same name as a special
    		     parameter, though harmless  for  others.	A  special  parameter  with  this
    		     attribute	will  not  retain its special effect when made local.  Thus after
    		     `typeset -h PATH', a function containing `typeset PATH' will create an ordi‐
    		     nary  local  parameter  without the usual behaviour of PATH.  Alternatively,
    		     the local parameter may itself be given this attribute; hence inside a func‐
    		     tion  `typeset  -h PATH' creates an ordinary local parameter and the special
    		     PATH parameter is not altered in any way.	It is also possible to	create	a
    		     local  parameter using `typeset +h special', where the local copy of special
    		     will retain its special properties regardless of having  the  -h  attribute.
    		     Global  special  parameters  loaded  from	shell modules (currently those in
    		     zsh/mapfile and zsh/parameter) are automatically given the -h  attribute  to
    		     avoid name clashes.
    
    	      -H     Hide value: specifies that typeset will not display the value of the parame‐
    		     ter when listing parameters; the display for such parameters is always as if
    		     the `+' flag had been given.  Use of the parameter is in other respects nor‐
    		     mal, and the option does not apply if the parameter is specified by name, or
    		     by  pattern with the -m option.  This is on by default for the parameters in
    		     the zsh/parameter and zsh/mapfile modules.  Note, however, that  unlike  the
    		     -h flag this is also useful for non-special parameters.
    
    	      -i [ n ]
    		     Use an internal integer representation.  If n is nonzero it defines the out‐
    		     put arithmetic base, otherwise it is determined  by  the  first  assignment.
    		     Bases from 2 to 36 inclusive are allowed.
    
    	      -E [ n ]
    		     Use  an  internal double-precision floating point representation.	On output
    		     the variable will be converted to scientific notation.  If n is  nonzero  it
    		     defines the number of significant figures to display; the default is ten.
    
    	      -F [ n ]
    		     Use  an  internal double-precision floating point representation.	On output
    		     the variable will be converted to fixed-point decimal  notation.	If  n  is
    		     nonzero  it defines the number of digits to display after the decimal point;
    		     the default is ten.
    
    	      -l     Convert the result to lower case whenever the parameter  is  expanded.   The
    		     value is not converted when assigned.
    
    	      -r     The given names are marked readonly.  Note that if name is a special parame‐
    		     ter, the readonly attribute can be turned on, but cannot then be turned off.
    
    		     If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, the readonly attribute is more restric‐
    		     tive:  unset  variables  can be marked readonly and cannot then be set; fur‐
    		     thermore, the readonly attribute cannot be removed from any variable.   Note
    		     that  in  zsh  (unlike  other shells) it is still possible to create a local
    		     variable of the same name as this is considered a different variable (though
    		     this variable, too, can be marked readonly).
    
    	      -t     Tags the named parameters.  Tags have no special meaning to the shell.  This
    		     flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see above.
    
    	      -u     Convert the result to upper case whenever the parameter  is  expanded.   The
    		     value  is	not  converted	when assigned.	This flag has a different meaning
    		     when used with -f; see above.
    
    	      -x     Mark for automatic export to the environment of subsequently  executed  com‐
    		     mands.   If  the  option  GLOBAL_EXPORT  is set, this implies the option -g,
    		     unless +g is also explicitly given; in other words the parameter is not made
    		     local  to	the  enclosing function.  This is for compatibility with previous
    		     versions of zsh.
    
           ulimit [ -HSa ] [ { -bcdfiklmnpqrsTtvwx | -N resource } [ limit ] ... ]
    	      Set or display resource limits of the shell and the processes started by the shell.
    	      The value of limit can be a number in the unit specified below or one of the values
    	      `unlimited', which removes the limit on the resource, or	`hard',  which	uses  the
    	      current value of the hard limit on the resource.
    
    	      By default, only soft limits are manipulated. If the -H flag is given use hard lim‐
    	      its instead of soft limits.  If the -S flag is given together with the -H flag  set
    	      both hard and soft limits.
    
    	      If no options are used, the file size limit (-f) is assumed.
    
    	      If limit is omitted the current value of the specified resources are printed.  When
    	      more than one resource value is printed, the limit name and unit is printed  before
    	      each value.
    
    	      When  looping  over  multiple  resources,  the  shell  will abort immediately if it
    	      detects a badly formed argument.	However, if it fails to  set  a  limit	for  some
    	      other reason it will continue trying to set the remaining limits.
    
    	      Not  all	the  following resources are supported on all systems.	Running ulimit -a
    	      will show which are supported.
    
    	      -a     Lists all of the current resource limits.
    	      -b     Socket buffer size in bytes (N.B. not kilobytes)
    	      -c     512-byte blocks on the size of core dumps.
    	      -d     Kilobytes on the size of the data segment.
    	      -f     512-byte blocks on the size of files written.
    	      -i     The number of pending signals.
    	      -k     The number of kqueues allocated.
    	      -l     Kilobytes on the size of locked-in memory.
    	      -m     Kilobytes on the size of physical memory.
    	      -n     open file descriptors.
    	      -p     The number of pseudo-terminals.
    	      -q     Bytes in POSIX message queues.
    	      -r     Maximum real time priority.  On some systems where this  is  not  available,
    		     such as NetBSD, this has the same effect as -T for compatibility with sh.
    	      -s     Kilobytes on the size of the stack.
    	      -T     The number of simultaneous threads available to the user.
    	      -t     CPU seconds to be used.
    	      -u     The number of processes available to the user.
    	      -v     Kilobytes on the size of virtual memory.  On some systems this refers to the
    		     limit called `address space'.
    	      -w     Kilobytes on the size of swapped out memory.
    	      -x     The number of locks on files.
    
    	      A resource may also be specified by  integer  in	the  form  `-N	resource',  where
    	      resource	corresponds to the integer defined for the resource by the operating sys‐
    	      tem.  This may be used to set the limits for resources known to the shell which  do
    	      not  correspond to option letters.  Such limits will be shown by number in the out‐
    	      put of `ulimit -a'.
    
    	      The number may alternatively be out of the range of limits compiled into the shell.
    	      The  shell  will try to read or write the limit anyway, and will report an error if
    	      this fails.
    
           umask [ -S ] [ mask ]
    	      The umask is set to mask.  mask can be either an octal number or a  symbolic  value
    	      as  described  in chmod(1).  If mask is omitted, the current value is printed.  The
    	      -S option causes the mask to be printed as a symbolic value.  Otherwise,	the  mask
    	      is  printed as an octal number.  Note that in the symbolic form the permissions you
    	      specify are those which are to be allowed (not denied) to the users specified.
    
           unalias [ -ams ] name ...
    	      Removes aliases.	This command works the same as unhash  -a,  except  that  the  -a
    	      option  removes  all  regular  or global aliases, or with -s all suffix aliases: in
    	      this case no name arguments may appear.  The options -m (remove by pattern) and  -s
    	      without  -a  (remove listed suffix aliases) behave as for unhash -a.  Note that the
    	      meaning of -a is different between unalias and unhash.
    
           unfunction
    	      Same as unhash -f.
    
           unhash [ -adfms ] name ...
    	      Remove the element named name from an internal hash table.  The default  is  remove
    	      elements	from the command hash table.  The -a option causes unhash to remove regu‐
    	      lar or global aliases; note when removing a global aliases that the  argument  must
    	      be  quoted  to  prevent  it from being expanded before being passed to the command.
    	      The -s option causes unhash to remove suffix aliases.  The -f option causes  unhash
    	      to  remove  shell functions.  The -d options causes unhash to remove named directo‐
    	      ries.  If the -m flag is given the arguments  are  taken	as  patterns  (should  be
    	      quoted)  and  all elements of the corresponding hash table with matching names will
    	      be removed.
    
           unlimit [ -hs ] resource ...
    	      The resource limit for each resource is set to the hard limit.  If the -h  flag  is
    	      given  and  the  shell has appropriate privileges, the hard resource limit for each
    	      resource is removed.  The resources of the shell process are only changed if the -s
    	      flag is given.
    
    	      The  unlimit  command  is  not made available by default when the shell starts in a
    	      mode emulating another shell.  It can be made available with the command	`zmodload
    	      -F zsh/rlimits b:unlimit'.
    
           unset [ -fmv ] name ...
    	      Each  named  parameter is unset.	Local parameters remain local even if unset; they
    	      appear unset within scope, but the previous value  will  still  reappear	when  the
    	      scope ends.
    
    	      Individual elements of associative array parameters may be unset by using subscript
    	      syntax on name, which should be quoted (or the entire command prefixed with noglob)
    	      to protect the subscript from filename generation.
    
    	      If  the -m flag is specified the arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted)
    	      and all parameters with matching names are unset.  Note that this  cannot  be  used
    	      when unsetting associative array elements, as the subscript will be treated as part
    	      of the pattern.
    
    	      The -v flag specifies that name refers to parameters. This is  the  default  behav‐
    	      iour.
    
    	      unset -f is equivalent to unfunction.
    
           unsetopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
    	      Unset  the  options  for	the shell.  All options specified either with flags or by
    	      name are unset.  If no arguments are supplied, the names of all  options	currently
    	      unset  are  printed.   If  the -m flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns
    	      (which should be quoted to preserve them from being interpreted as glob  patterns),
    	      and all options with names matching these patterns are unset.
    
           vared  See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).
    
           wait [ job ... ]
    	      Wait  for  the specified jobs or processes.  If job is not given then all currently
    	      active child processes are waited for.  Each job can be either a job  specification
    	      or  the process ID of a job in the job table.  The exit status from this command is
    	      that of the job waited for.
    
    	      It is possible to wait for recent processes (specified by process ID, not  by  job)
    	      that  were running in the background even if the process has exited.  Typically the
    	      process ID will be recorded by capturing the value of the variable  $!  immediately
    	      after  the process has been started.  There is a limit on the number of process IDs
    	      remembered by the shell; this is given by the value  of  the  system  configuration
    	      parameter  CHILD_MAX.  When this limit is reached, older process IDs are discarded,
    	      least recently started processes first.
    
    	      Note there is no protection against the process ID wrapping, i.e. if  the  wait  is
    	      not executed soon enough there is a chance the process waited for is the wrong one.
    	      A conflict implies both process IDs have been generated by the shell, as other pro‐
    	      cesses  are  not	recorded, and that the user is potentially interested in both, so
    	      this problem is intrinsic to process IDs.
    
           whence [ -vcwfpamsS ] [ -x num ] name ...
    	      For each name, indicate how it would be interpreted if used as a command name.
    
    	      whence is most useful when name is only the last path component of a command,  i.e.
    	      does  not  include a `/'; in particular, pattern matching only succeeds if just the
    	      non-directory component of the command is passed.
    
    	      -v     Produce a more verbose report.
    
    	      -c     Print the results in a csh-like format.  This takes precedence over -v.
    
    	      -w     For each name, print `name: word' where word is one of alias, builtin,  com‐
    		     mand,  function,  hashed, reserved or none, according as name corresponds to
    		     an alias, a built-in command, an external command, a shell function, a  com‐
    		     mand  defined  with the hash builtin, a reserved word, or is not recognised.
    		     This takes precedence over -v and -c.
    
    	      -f     Causes the contents of a shell function to be displayed, which would  other‐
    		     wise not happen unless the -c flag were used.
    
    	      -p     Do a path search for name even if it is an alias, reserved word, shell func‐
    		     tion or builtin.
    
    	      -a     Do a search for all occurrences of name throughout the command  path.   Nor‐
    		     mally only the first occurrence is printed.
    
    	      -m     The  arguments  are taken as patterns (pattern characters should be quoted),
    		     and the information is displayed for each command matching one of these pat‐
    		     terns.
    
    	      -s     If a pathname contains symlinks, print the symlink-free pathname as well.
    
    	      -S     As  -s,  but  if  the pathname had to be resolved by following multiple sym‐
    		     links, the intermediate steps are printed, too.   The  symlink  resolved  at
    		     each step might be anywhere in the path.
    
    	      -x num Expand  tabs  when outputting shell functions using the -c option.  This has
    		     the same effect as the -x option to the functions builtin.
    
           where [ -wpmsS ] [ -x num ] name ...
    	      Equivalent to whence -ca.
    
           which [ -wpamsS ] [ -x num ] name ...
    	      Equivalent to whence -c.
    
           zcompile [ -U ] [ -z | -k ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
           zcompile -ca [ -m ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
           zcompile -t file [ name ... ]
    	      This builtin command can be used to compile functions or scripts, storing the  com‐
    	      piled  form  in  a  file,  and to examine files containing the compiled form.  This
    	      allows faster autoloading of functions and execution of scripts by avoiding parsing
    	      of the text when the files are read.
    
    	      The first form (without the -c, -a or -t options) creates a compiled file.  If only
    	      the file argument is given, the output file has the name	`file.zwc'  and  will  be
    	      placed  in  the  same directory as the file.  The shell will load the compiled file
    	      instead of the normal function file when the function is autoloaded; see	the  sec‐
    	      tion  `Autoloading  Functions'  in  zshmisc(1)  for a description of how autoloaded
    	      functions are searched.  The extension .zwc stands for `zsh word code'.
    
    	      If there is at least one name argument, all the named files are compiled	into  the
    	      output file given as the first argument.	If file does not end in .zwc, this exten‐
    	      sion is automatically appended.  Files containing multiple compiled  functions  are
    	      called  `digest'	files, and are intended to be used as elements of the FPATH/fpath
    	      special array.
    
    	      The second form, with the -c or -a options, writes the compiled definitions for all
    	      the  named  functions  into  file.   For	-c, the names must be functions currently
    	      defined in the shell, not those marked for autoloading.  Undefined  functions  that
    	      are marked for autoloading may be written by using the -a option, in which case the
    	      fpath is searched and the contents of the definition files for those functions,  if
    	      found,  are compiled into file.  If both -c and -a are given, names of both defined
    	      functions and functions marked for autoloading may be given.  In either  case,  the
    	      functions  in  files  written with the -c or -a option will be autoloaded as if the
    	      KSH_AUTOLOAD option were unset.
    
    	      The reason for handling loaded and not-yet-loaded functions with different  options
    	      is  that some definition files for autoloading define multiple functions, including
    	      the function with the same name as the file, and, at the end, call  that	function.
    	      In such cases the output of `zcompile -c' does not include the additional functions
    	      defined in the file, and any other initialization code in the file is lost.   Using
    	      `zcompile -a' captures all this extra information.
    
    	      If  the -m option is combined with -c or -a, the names are used as patterns and all
    	      functions whose names match one of these patterns will be written. If  no  name  is
    	      given,  the  definitions of all functions currently defined or marked as autoloaded
    	      will be written.
    
    	      Note the second form cannot be used for compiling functions that	include  redirec‐
    	      tions  as  part  of the definition rather than within the body of the function; for
    	      example
    
    		     fn1() { { ... } >~/logfile }
    
    	      can be compiled but
    
    		     fn1() { ... } >~/logfile
    
    	      cannot.  It is possible to use the first form of zcompile to  compile  autoloadable
    	      functions that include the full function definition instead of just the body of the
    	      function.
    
    	      The third form, with the -t option, examines an existing	compiled  file.   Without
    	      further  arguments,  the	names  of the original files compiled into it are listed.
    	      The first line of output shows the version of the shell which compiled the file and
    	      how  the	file will be used (i.e. by reading it directly or by mapping it into mem‐
    	      ory).  With arguments, nothing is output and the return status is set  to  zero  if
    	      definitions for all names were found in the compiled file, and non-zero if the def‐
    	      inition for at least one name was not found.
    
    	      Other options:
    
    	      -U     Aliases are not expanded when compiling the named files.
    
    	      -R     When the compiled file is read, its contents are  copied  into  the  shell's
    		     memory,  rather  than memory-mapped (see -M).  This happens automatically on
    		     systems that do not support memory mapping.
    
    		     When compiling scripts instead of autoloadable functions, it is often desir‐
    		     able  to  use  this  option; otherwise the whole file, including the code to
    		     define functions which have already been defined, will remain mapped, conse‐
    		     quently wasting memory.
    
    	      -M     The  compiled file is mapped into the shell's memory when read. This is done
    		     in such a way that multiple instances of the shell running on the same  host
    		     will  share  this	mapped file.  If neither -R nor -M is given, the zcompile
    		     builtin decides what to do based on the size of the compiled file.
    
    	      -k
    	      -z     These options are used when the compiled file contains functions  which  are
    		     to  be autoloaded. If -z is given, the function will be autoloaded as if the
    		     KSH_AUTOLOAD option is not set, even if it is set at the time  the  compiled
    		     file  is  read,  while if the -k is given, the function will be loaded as if
    		     KSH_AUTOLOAD is set.  These options also take precedence over any -k  or  -z
    		     options  specified  to  the autoload builtin. If neither of these options is
    		     given, the function will be loaded as  determined	by  the  setting  of  the
    		     KSH_AUTOLOAD option at the time the compiled file is read.
    
    		     These  options may also appear as many times as necessary between the listed
    		     names to specify the loading style of all following  functions,  up  to  the
    		     next -k or -z.
    
    		     The  created  file  always contains two versions of the compiled format, one
    		     for big-endian machines and one for small-endian machines.   The  upshot  of
    		     this  is  that the compiled file is machine independent and if it is read or
    		     mapped, only one half of the file is actually used (and mapped).
    
           zformat
    	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           zftp   See the section `The zsh/zftp Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           zle    See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).
    
           zmodload [ -dL ] [ ... ]
           zmodload -F [ -alLme -P param ] module [ [+-]feature ... ]
           zmodload -e [ -A ] [ ... ]
           zmodload [ -a [ -bcpf [ -I ] ] ] [ -iL ] ...
           zmodload -u [ -abcdpf [ -I ] ] [ -iL ] ...
           zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
           zmodload -R modalias ...
    	      Performs operations relating to zsh's loadable modules.  Loading of  modules  while
    	      the  shell  is running (`dynamical loading') is not available on all operating sys‐
    	      tems, or on all installations on a particular operating system, although the  zmod‐
    	      load command itself is always available and can be used to manipulate modules built
    	      into versions of the shell executable without dynamical loading.
    
    	      Without arguments the names of all currently loaded  binary  modules  are  printed.
    	      The  -L option causes this list to be in the form of a series of zmodload commands.
    	      Forms with arguments are:
    
    	      zmodload [ -i ] name ...
    	      zmodload -u [ -i ] name ...
    		     In the simplest case, zmodload loads a binary module.  The module must be in
    		     a	file  with a name consisting of the specified name followed by a standard
    		     suffix, usually `.so' (`.sl' on HPUX).   If  the  module  to  be  loaded  is
    		     already  loaded  the  duplicate  module  is ignored.  If zmodload detects an
    		     inconsistency, such as an invalid module name or circular	dependency  list,
    		     the  current code block is aborted.   Hence `zmodload module 2>/dev/null' is
    		     sufficient to test whether a module is available.	If it is  available,  the
    		     module is loaded if necessary, while if it is not available, non-zero status
    		     is silently returned.  The option -i is accepted for compatibility  but  has
    		     no effect.
    
    		     The  named  module is searched for in the same way a command is, using $mod‐
    		     ule_path instead of $path.  However, the path search is performed even  when
    		     the  module  name contains a `/', which it usually does.  There is no way to
    		     prevent the path search.
    
    		     If the module supports features (see below), zmodload tries  to  enable  all
    		     features  when  loading a module.	If the module was successfully loaded but
    		     not all features could be enabled, zmodload returns status 2.
    
    		     With -u, zmodload unloads modules.  The same name must  be  given	that  was
    		     given  when the module was loaded, but it is not necessary for the module to
    		     exist in the file system.	The -i option suppresses the error if the  module
    		     is already unloaded (or was never loaded).
    
    		     Each  module  has	a  boot  and  a cleanup function.  The module will not be
    		     loaded if its boot function fails.  Similarly a module can only be  unloaded
    		     if its cleanup function runs successfully.
    
    	      zmodload -F [ -almLe -P param ] module [ [+-]feature ... ]
    		     zmodload -F allows more selective control over the features provided by mod‐
    		     ules.  With no options apart from -F, the module named module is loaded,  if
    		     it  was  not already loaded, and the list of features is set to the required
    		     state.  If no features are specified, the module is loaded, if  it  was  not
    		     already loaded, but the state of features is unchanged.  Each feature may be
    		     preceded by a + to turn the feature on, or -  to  turn  it  off;  the  +  is
    		     assumed  if  neither  character is present.  Any feature not explicitly men‐
    		     tioned is left in its current state; if the module was not previously loaded
    		     this  means  any  such  features will remain disabled.  The return status is
    		     zero if all features were set, 1 if the module failed to load, and 2 if some
    		     features  could  not  be  set  (for  example,  a parameter couldn't be added
    		     because there was a different parameter of the same name) but the module was
    		     loaded.
    
    		     The  standard  features  are builtins, conditions, parameters and math func‐
    		     tions; these are indicated by the prefix `b:', `c:' (`C:' for an infix  con‐
    		     dition),  `p:'  and `f:', respectively, followed by the name that the corre‐
    		     sponding feature would have in the shell.	For example,  `b:strftime'  indi‐
    		     cates  a  builtin	named  strftime  and p:EPOCHSECONDS indicates a parameter
    		     named EPOCHSECONDS.  The module may provide other (`abstract')  features  of
    		     its own as indicated by its documentation; these have no prefix.
    
    		     With -l or -L, features provided by the module are listed.  With -l alone, a
    		     list of features together with their states is shown, one feature per  line.
    		     With  -L  alone,  a zmodload -F command that would cause enabled features of
    		     the module to be turned on is shown.  With -lL, a zmodload -F  command  that
    		     would  cause all the features to be set to their current state is shown.  If
    		     one of these combinations is given with the option -P param then the parame‐
    		     ter  param  is  set  to  an array of features, either features together with
    		     their state or (if -L alone is given) enabled features.
    
    		     With the option -L the module name may  be  omitted;  then  a  list  of  all
    		     enabled  features	for all modules providing features is printed in the form
    		     of zmodload -F commands.  If -l is also given, the state of both enabled and
    		     disabled features is output in that form.
    
    		     A	set of features may be provided together with -l or -L and a module name;
    		     in that case only the state of those features is considered.   Each  feature
    		     may  be  preceded	by  + or - but the character has no effect.  If no set of
    		     features is provided, all features are considered.
    
    		     With -e, the command first tests that the module is loaded; if  it  is  not,
    		     status  1	is returned.  If the module is loaded, the list of features given
    		     as an argument is examined.  Any feature given  with  no  prefix  is  simply
    		     tested  to  see if the module provides it; any feature given with a prefix +
    		     or - is tested to see if is provided and in the given state.  If  the  tests
    		     on all features in the list succeed, status 0 is returned, else status 1.
    
    		     With  -m,	each entry in the given list of features is taken as a pattern to
    		     be matched against the list of features provided by the module.  An  initial
    		     +	or  -  must  be  given	explicitly.  This may not be combined with the -a
    		     option as autoloads must be specified explicitly.
    
    		     With -a, the given list of features is marked for autoload from  the  speci‐
    		     fied  module,  which may not yet be loaded.  An optional + may appear before
    		     the feature name.	If the feature is prefixed with -, any existing  autoload
    		     is removed.  The options -l and -L may be used to list autoloads.	Autoload‐
    		     ing is specific to individual features; when the module is loaded	only  the
    		     requested feature is enabled.  Autoload requests are preserved if the module
    		     is subsequently unloaded until an explicit `zmodload -Fa module -feature' is
    		     issued.  It is not an error to request an autoload for a feature of a module
    		     that is already loaded.
    
    		     When the module is loaded each autoload  is  checked  against  the  features
    		     actually provided by the module; if the feature is not provided the autoload
    		     request is deleted.  A warning message is output; if  the	module	is  being
    		     loaded  to  provide  a  different	feature, and that autoload is successful,
    		     there is no effect on the status of the current command.  If the  module  is
    		     already  loaded  at  the  time when zmodload -Fa is run, an error message is
    		     printed and status 1 returned.
    
    		     zmodload -Fa can be used with the -l, -L, -e and -P options for listing  and
    		     testing  the existence of autoloadable features.  In this case -l is ignored
    		     if -L is specified.  zmodload -FaL with no module name lists  autoloads  for
    		     all modules.
    
    		     Note that only standard features as described above can be autoloaded; other
    		     features require the module to be loaded before enabling.
    
    	      zmodload -d [ -L ] [ name ]
    	      zmodload -d name dep ...
    	      zmodload -ud name [ dep ... ]
    		     The -d option can be used to specify module dependencies.	The modules named
    		     in  the  second  and  subsequent  arguments will be loaded before the module
    		     named in the first argument.
    
    		     With -d and one argument, all dependencies for that module are listed.  With
    		     -d and no arguments, all module dependencies are listed.  This listing is by
    		     default in a Makefile-like format.  The -L option changes this format  to	a
    		     list of zmodload -d commands.
    
    		     If  -d and -u are both used, dependencies are removed.  If only one argument
    		     is given, all dependencies for that module are removed.
    
    	      zmodload -ab [ -L ]
    	      zmodload -ab [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
    	      zmodload -ub [ -i ] builtin ...
    		     The -ab option  defines  autoloaded  builtins.   It  defines  the	specified
    		     builtins.	When any of those builtins is called, the module specified in the
    		     first argument is loaded and all its features  are  enabled  (for	selective
    		     control  of  features use `zmodload -F -a' as described above).  If only the
    		     name is given, one builtin is defined, with the same name as the module.  -i
    		     suppresses  the  error  if the builtin is already defined or autoloaded, but
    		     not if another builtin of the same name is already defined.
    
    		     With -ab and no arguments, all autoloaded builtins are listed, with the mod‐
    		     ule name (if different) shown in parentheses after the builtin name.  The -L
    		     option changes this format to a list of zmodload -a commands.
    
    		     If -b is used together with the -u option, it  removes  builtins  previously
    		     defined  with  -ab.  This is only possible if the builtin is not yet loaded.
    		     -i suppresses the	error  if  the	builtin  is  already  removed  (or  never
    		     existed).
    
    		     Autoload  requests are retained if the module is subsequently unloaded until
    		     an explicit `zmodload -ub builtin' is issued.
    
    	      zmodload -ac [ -IL ]
    	      zmodload -ac [ -iI ] name [ cond ... ]
    	      zmodload -uc [ -iI ] cond ...
    		     The -ac option is used  to  define  autoloaded  condition	codes.	The  cond
    		     strings give the names of the conditions defined by the module. The optional
    		     -I option is used to define infix condition names. Without this option  pre‐
    		     fix condition names are defined.
    
    		     If  given	no  condition names, all defined names are listed (as a series of
    		     zmodload commands if the -L option is given).
    
    		     The -uc option removes definitions for autoloaded conditions.
    
    	      zmodload -ap [ -L ]
    	      zmodload -ap [ -i ] name [ parameter ... ]
    	      zmodload -up [ -i ] parameter ...
    		     The -p option is like the -b and -c options,  but	makes  zmodload  work  on
    		     autoloaded parameters instead.
    
    	      zmodload -af [ -L ]
    	      zmodload -af [ -i ] name [ function ... ]
    	      zmodload -uf [ -i ] function ...
    		     The -f option is like the -b, -p, and -c options, but makes zmodload work on
    		     autoloaded math functions instead.
    
    	      zmodload -a [ -L ]
    	      zmodload -a [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
    	      zmodload -ua [ -i ] builtin ...
    		     Equivalent to -ab and -ub.
    
    	      zmodload -e [ -A ] [ string ... ]
    		     The -e option without arguments lists all loaded modules; if the  -A  option
    		     is  also  given,  module  aliases	corresponding  to loaded modules are also
    		     shown.  If arguments are provided, nothing is printed; the return status  is
    		     set  to  zero  if all strings given as arguments are names of loaded modules
    		     and to one if at least on string is not the name of a loaded  module.   This
    		     can  be  used to test for the availability of things implemented by modules.
    		     In this case, any aliases are automatically resolved and the -A flag is  not
    		     used.
    
    	      zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
    		     For each argument, if both modalias and module are given, define modalias to
    		     be an alias for the module module.  If the module modalias  is  ever  subse‐
    		     quently  requested,  either  via a call to zmodload or implicitly, the shell
    		     will attempt to load module instead.  If module is not given, show the defi‐
    		     nition  of  modalias.   If  no  arguments are given, list all defined module
    		     aliases.  When listing, if the -L flag was also given, list  the  definition
    		     as a zmodload command to recreate the alias.
    
    		     The  existence  of  aliases for modules is completely independent of whether
    		     the name resolved is actually loaded as a module: while  the  alias  exists,
    		     loading and unloading the module under any alias has exactly the same effect
    		     as using the resolved name, and does not affect the connection  between  the
    		     alias and the resolved name which can be removed either by zmodload -R or by
    		     redefining the alias.  Chains of aliases (i.e. where the first resolved name
    		     is  itself  an  alias)  are valid so long as these are not circular.  As the
    		     aliases take the same format as module names, they may include path  separa‐
    		     tors:   in this case, there is no requirement for any part of the path named
    		     to exist as the alias will be resolved first.  For example,  `any/old/alias'
    		     is always a valid alias.
    
    		     Dependencies  added  to  aliased  modules are actually added to the resolved
    		     module; these remain if the alias is removed.  It	is  valid  to  create  an
    		     alias  whose name is one of the standard shell modules and which resolves to
    		     a different module.  However, if a module has dependencies, it will  not  be
    		     possible  to  use	the module name as an alias as the module will already be
    		     marked as a loadable module in its own right.
    
    		     Apart from the above, aliases can be used in the zmodload	command  anywhere
    		     module  names  are required.  However, aliases will not be shown in lists of
    		     loaded modules with a bare `zmodload'.
    
    	      zmodload -R modalias ...
    		     For each modalias argument that was previously defined as a module alias via
    		     zmodload  -A,  delete the alias.  If any was not defined, an error is caused
    		     and the remainder of the line is ignored.
    
    	      Note that zsh makes no distinction between modules that were linked into the  shell
    	      and  modules that are loaded dynamically. In both cases this builtin command has to
    	      be used to make available the builtins and other things defined by modules  (unless
    	      the  module is autoloaded on these definitions). This is true even for systems that
    	      don't support dynamic loading of modules.
    
           zparseopts
    	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           zprof  See the section `The zsh/zprof Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           zpty   See the section `The zsh/zpty Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           zregexparse
    	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           zsocket
    	      See the section `The zsh/net/socket Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           zstyle See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
           ztcp   See the section `The zsh/net/tcp Module' in zshmodules(1).
    
    ZSHZLE(1)			     General Commands Manual				ZSHZLE(1)
    
    NAME
           zshzle - zsh command line editor
    
    DESCRIPTION
           If the ZLE option is set (which it is by default in  interactive  shells)  and  the  shell
           input is attached to the terminal, the user is able to edit command lines.
    
           There are two display modes.  The first, multiline mode, is the default.  It only works if
           the TERM parameter is set to a valid terminal type that can move the cursor up.	The  sec‐
           ond, single line mode, is used if TERM is invalid or incapable of moving the cursor up, or
           if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE option is set.  This mode is similar to ksh, and	uses  no  termcap
           sequences.  If TERM is "emacs", the ZLE option will be unset by default.
    
           The  parameters	BAUD, COLUMNS, and LINES are also used by the line editor. See Parameters
           Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).
    
           The parameter zle_highlight is also used by the line editor;  see  Character  Highlighting
           below.	Highlighting of special characters and the region between the cursor and the mark
           (as set with set-mark-command in Emacs mode, or by visual-mode in Vi mode) is  enabled  by
           default;  consult  this reference for more information.	Irascible conservatives will wish
           to know that all highlighting may be disabled by the following setting:
    
    	      zle_highlight=(none)
    
           In many places, references are made to the numeric  argument.   This  can  by  default  be
           entered	in  emacs  mode  by  holding  the alt key and typing a number, or pressing escape
           before each digit, and in vi command mode by typing the number before entering a  command.
           Generally  the  numeric argument causes the next command entered to be repeated the speci‐
           fied number of times, unless otherwise noted below. See also the Arguments  subsection  of
           the  Widgets section for some other ways the numeric argument can be modified. The default
           bindings mentioned here use the digit-argument widget.
    
    KEYMAPS
           A keymap in ZLE contains a set of bindings between key sequences and  ZLE  commands.   The
           empty key sequence cannot be bound.
    
           There can be any number of keymaps at any time, and each keymap has one or more names.  If
           all of a keymap's names are deleted, it disappears.  bindkey can  be  used  to  manipulate
           keymap names.
    
           Initially, there are eight keymaps:
    
           emacs  EMACS emulation
           viins  vi emulation - insert mode
           vicmd  vi emulation - command mode
           viopp  vi emulation - operator pending
           visual vi emulation - selection active
           isearch
    	      incremental search mode
           command
    	      read a command name
           .safe  fallback keymap
    
           The  `.safe'  keymap  is  special.   It	can  never  be altered, and the name can never be
           removed.  However, it can be linked to other names, which can be removed.  In  the  future
           other  special keymaps may be added; users should avoid using names beginning with `.' for
           their own keymaps.
    
           In addition to these names, either `emacs' or `viins' is also linked to the  name  `main'.
           If  one	of  the  VISUAL  or EDITOR environment variables contain the string `vi' when the
           shell starts up then it will be `viins', otherwise it will be `emacs'.  bindkey's  -e  and
           -v options provide a convenient way to override this default choice.
    
           When  the  editor  starts  up,  it  will select the `main' keymap.  If that keymap doesn't
           exist, it will use `.safe' instead.
    
           In the `.safe' keymap, each single key is bound to self-insert, except for ^J (line  feed)
           and ^M (return) which are bound to accept-line.	This is deliberately not pleasant to use;
           if you are using it, it means you deleted the main keymap, and you should put it back.
    
       Reading Commands
           When ZLE is reading a command from the terminal, it may read a sequence that is	bound  to
           some  command and is also a prefix of a longer bound string.  In this case ZLE will wait a
           certain time to see if more characters are typed, and if not  (or  they	don't  match  any
           longer  string)	it  will  execute the binding.	This timeout is defined by the KEYTIMEOUT
           parameter; its default is 0.4 sec.  There is no timeout if the prefix string is not itself
           bound to a command.
    
           The  key  timeout is also applied when ZLE is reading the bytes from a multibyte character
           string when it is in the appropriate mode.  (This requires that	the  shell  was  compiled
           with  multibyte	mode  enabled;	typically  also  the locale has characters with the UTF-8
           encoding, although any multibyte encoding known to the operating system is supported.)  If
           the  second  or a subsequent byte is not read within the timeout period, the shell acts as
           if ? were typed and resets the input state.
    
           As well as ZLE commands, key sequences can be bound to other strings,  by  using  `bindkey
           -s'.   When  such  a sequence is read, the replacement string is pushed back as input, and
           the command reading process starts again using these  fake  keystrokes.	 This  input  can
           itself  invoke  further replacement strings, but in order to detect loops the process will
           be stopped if there are twenty such replacements without a real command being read.
    
           A key sequence typed by the user can be turned into a command name for use in user-defined
           widgets	with  the read-command widget, described in the subsection `Miscellaneous' of the
           section `Standard Widgets' below.
    
       Local Keymaps
           While for normal editing a single keymap is used exclusively, in many modes a local keymap
           allows for some keys to be customised. For example, in an incremental search mode, a bind‐
           ing in the isearch keymap will override a binding in the main keymap but all keys that are
           not overridden can still be used.
    
           If  a key sequence is defined in a local keymap, it will hide a key sequence in the global
           keymap that is a prefix of that sequence. An example of this occurs with the binding of iw
           in viopp as this hides the binding of i in vicmd. However, a longer sequence in the global
           keymap that shares the same prefix can still apply so for example the binding  of  ^Xa  in
           the global keymap will be unaffected by the binding of ^Xb in the local keymap.
    
    ZLE BUILTINS
           The  ZLE  module  contains three related builtin commands. The bindkey command manipulates
           keymaps and key bindings; the vared command invokes ZLE on the value of a shell parameter;
           and the zle command manipulates editing widgets and allows command line access to ZLE com‐
           mands from within shell functions.
    
           bindkey [ options ] -l [ -L ] [ keymap ... ]
           bindkey [ options ] -d
           bindkey [ options ] -D keymap ...
           bindkey [ options ] -A old-keymap new-keymap
           bindkey [ options ] -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
           bindkey [ options ] -m
           bindkey [ options ] -r in-string ...
           bindkey [ options ] -s in-string out-string ...
           bindkey [ options ] in-string command ...
           bindkey [ options ] [ in-string ]
    	      bindkey's options can be divided into three categories: keymap  selection  for  the
    	      current  command,  operation  selection,	and others.  The keymap selection options
    	      are:
    
    	      -e     Selects keymap `emacs' for any operations by the current command,	and  also
    		     links  `emacs' to `main' so that it is selected by default the next time the
    		     editor starts.
    
    	      -v     Selects keymap `viins' for any operations by the current command,	and  also
    		     links  `viins' to `main' so that it is selected by default the next time the
    		     editor starts.
    
    	      -a     Selects keymap `vicmd' for any operations by the current command.
    
    	      -M keymap
    		     The keymap specifies a keymap name that is selected for  any  operations  by
    		     the current command.
    
    	      If  a  keymap  selection	is  required  and none of the options above are used, the
    	      `main' keymap is used.  Some operations do not permit  a	keymap	to  be	selected,
    	      namely:
    
    	      -l     List  all existing keymap names; if any arguments are given, list just those
    		     keymaps.
    
    		     If the -L option is also used, list in the form of bindkey commands to  cre‐
    		     ate or link the keymaps.  `bindkey -lL main' shows which keymap is linked to
    		     `main', if any, and hence if the  standard  emacs	or  vi	emulation  is  in
    		     effect.   This  option  does  not show the .safe keymap because it cannot be
    		     created in that fashion; however, neither is `bindkey -lL .safe' reported as
    		     an error, it simply outputs nothing.
    
    	      -d     Delete all existing keymaps and reset to the default state.
    
    	      -D keymap ...
    		     Delete the named keymaps.
    
    	      -A old-keymap new-keymap
    		     Make  the	new-keymap name an alias for old-keymap, so that both names refer
    		     to the same keymap.  The names have equal standing; if  either  is  deleted,
    		     the  other  remains.  If there is already a keymap with the new-keymap name,
    		     it is deleted.
    
    	      -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
    		     Create a new keymap, named new-keymap.  If a keymap already has  that  name,
    		     it  is  deleted.  If an old-keymap name is given, the new keymap is initial‐
    		     ized to be a duplicate of it, otherwise the new keymap will be empty.
    
    	      To use a newly created keymap, it should be linked to main.  Hence the sequence  of
    	      commands	to  create and use a new keymap `mymap' initialized from the emacs keymap
    	      (which remains unchanged) is:
    
    		     bindkey -N mymap emacs
    		     bindkey -A mymap main
    
    	      Note that while `bindkey -A newmap main' will work when newmap is emacs  or  viins,
    	      it  will	not  work  for vicmd, as switching from vi insert to command mode becomes
    	      impossible.
    
    	      The following operations act on the `main' keymap if no keymap selection option was
    	      given:
    
    	      -m     Add the built-in set of meta-key bindings to the selected keymap.	Only keys
    		     that are unbound or bound to self-insert are affected.
    
    	      -r in-string ...
    		     Unbind the specified in-strings in the selected  keymap.	This  is  exactly
    		     equivalent to binding the strings to undefined-key.
    
    		     When -R is also used, interpret the in-strings as ranges.
    
    		     When -p is also used, the in-strings specify prefixes.  Any binding that has
    		     the given in-string as a prefix, not including the binding for the in-string
    		     itself, if any, will be removed.  For example,
    
    			    bindkey -rpM viins '^['
    
    		     will  remove  all	bindings in the vi-insert keymap beginning with an escape
    		     character (probably cursor keys), but leave the binding for the escape char‐
    		     acter  itself  (probably vi-cmd-mode).  This is incompatible with the option
    		     -R.
    
    	      -s in-string out-string ...
    		     Bind each in-string to each out-string.  When in-string is typed, out-string
    		     will  be  pushed  back  and treated as input to the line editor.  When -R is
    		     also used, interpret the in-strings as ranges.
    
    		     Note that both in-string and out-string are subject  to  the  same  form  of
    		     interpretation, as described below.
    
    	      in-string command ...
    		     Bind  each  in-string  to	each  command.	 When  -R  is used, interpret the
    		     in-strings as ranges.
    
    	      [ in-string ]
    		     List key bindings.  If an in-string is specified, the binding of that string
    		     in  the  selected	keymap	is displayed.  Otherwise, all key bindings in the
    		     selected keymap are displayed.  (As a special case, if the -e or  -v  option
    		     is used alone, the keymap is not displayed - the implicit linking of keymaps
    		     is the only thing that happens.)
    
    		     When the option -p is used, the in-string	must  be  present.   The  listing
    		     shows  all  bindings  which  have	the  given  key sequence as a prefix, not
    		     including any bindings for the key sequence itself.
    
    		     When the -L option is used, the list is in the form of bindkey  commands  to
    		     create the key bindings.
    
    	      When  the  -R  option is used as noted above, a valid range consists of two charac‐
    	      ters, with an optional `-' between them.	All characters between the two specified,
    	      inclusive, are bound as specified.
    
    	      For either in-string or out-string, the following escape sequences are recognised:
    
    	      \a     bell character
    	      \b     backspace
    	      \e, \E escape
    	      \f     form feed
    	      \n     linefeed (newline)
    	      \r     carriage return
    	      \t     horizontal tab
    	      \v     vertical tab
    	      \NNN   character code in octal
    	      \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
    	      \uNNNN unicode character code in hexadecimal
    	      \UNNNNNNNN
    		     unicode character code in hexadecimal
    	      \M[-]X character with meta bit set
    	      \C[-]X control character
    	      ^X     control character
    
    	      In  all  other  cases,  `\'  escapes the following character.  Delete is written as
    	      `^?'.  Note that `\M^?' and `^\M?' are not the same, and that (unlike  emacs),  the
    	      bindings	`\M-X'	and `\eX' are entirely distinct, although they are initialized to
    	      the same bindings by `bindkey -m'.
    
           vared [ -Aache ] [ -p prompt ] [ -r rprompt ]
    	     [ -M main-keymap ] [ -m vicmd-keymap ]
    	     [ -i init-widget ] [ -f finish-widget ]
    	     [ -t tty ] name
    	      The value of the parameter name is loaded into the edit buffer, and the line editor
    	      is invoked.  When the editor exits, name is set to the string value returned by the
    	      editor.  When the -c flag is given, the parameter is created if it doesn't  already
    	      exist.   The  -a	flag may be given with -c to create an array parameter, or the -A
    	      flag to create an associative array.  If the type of an existing parameter does not
    	      match the type to be created, the parameter is unset and recreated.
    
    	      If an array or array slice is being edited, separator characters as defined in $IFS
    	      will be shown quoted with a backslash, as will backslashes themselves.  Conversely,
    	      when the edited text is split into an array, a backslash quotes an immediately fol‐
    	      lowing separator character or backslash; no other special handling of  backslashes,
    	      or any handling of quotes, is performed.
    
    	      Individual elements of existing array or associative array parameters may be edited
    	      by using subscript syntax on name.  New elements are  created  automatically,  even
    	      without -c.
    
    	      If  the  -p flag is given, the following string will be taken as the prompt to dis‐
    	      play at the left.  If the -r flag is given, the following string gives  the  prompt
    	      to  display at the right.  If the -h flag is specified, the history can be accessed
    	      from ZLE. If the -e flag is given, typing ^D (Control-D) on an  empty  line  causes
    	      vared to exit immediately with a non-zero return value.
    
    	      The  -M option gives a keymap to link to the main keymap during editing, and the -m
    	      option gives a keymap to link to the vicmd keymap  during  editing.   For  vi-style
    	      editing,	this  allows  a  pair  of  keymaps  to	override  viins  and  vicmd.  For
    	      emacs-style editing, only -M is normally needed but the  -m  option  may	still  be
    	      used.  On exit, the previous keymaps will be restored.
    
    	      Vared  calls the usual `zle-line-init' and `zle-line-finish' hooks before and after
    	      it takes control. Using the -i and -f options, it is possible to replace these with
    	      other custom widgets.
    
    	      If  `-t  tty'  is given, tty is the name of a terminal device to be used instead of
    	      the default /dev/tty.  If tty does not refer to a terminal an error is reported.
    
           zle
           zle -l [ -L | -a ] [ string ... ]
           zle -D widget ...
           zle -A old-widget new-widget
           zle -N widget [ function ]
           zle -C widget completion-widget function
           zle -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
           zle -M string
           zle -U string
           zle -K keymap
           zle -F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
           zle -I
           zle -T [ tc function | -r tc | -L ]
           zle widget [ -n num ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...
    	      The zle builtin performs a number of different actions concerning ZLE.
    
    	      With no options and no arguments, only the return status will be set.  It  is  zero
    	      if  ZLE is currently active and widgets could be invoked using this builtin command
    	      and non-zero otherwise.  Note that even if non-zero status  is  returned,  zle  may
    	      still  be active as part of the completion system; this does not allow direct calls
    	      to ZLE widgets.
    
    	      Otherwise, which operation it performs depends on its options:
    
    	      -l [ -L | -a ] [ string ]
    		     List all existing user-defined widgets.  If the -L option is used,  list  in
    		     the form of zle commands to create the widgets.
    
    		     When combined with the -a option, all widget names are listed, including the
    		     builtin ones. In this case the -L option is ignored.
    
    		     If at least one string is given, and -a is present or -L is not used,  noth‐
    		     ing  will	be  printed.   The  return status will be zero if all strings are
    		     names of existing widgets and non-zero if at least one string is not a  name
    		     of  a  defined widget.  If -a is also present, all widget names are used for
    		     the comparison including builtin widgets, else only user-defined widgets are
    		     used.
    
    		     If  at  least  one string is present and the -L option is used, user-defined
    		     widgets matching any string are listed in the form of zle commands to create
    		     the widgets.
    
    	      -D widget ...
    		     Delete the named widgets.
    
    	      -A old-widget new-widget
    		     Make  the	new-widget name an alias for old-widget, so that both names refer
    		     to the same widget.  The names have equal standing; if  either  is  deleted,
    		     the  other  remains.  If there is already a widget with the new-widget name,
    		     it is deleted.
    
    	      -N widget [ function ]
    		     Create a user-defined widget.  If there is already a widget with the  speci‐
    		     fied  name,  it  is overwritten.  When the new widget is invoked from within
    		     the editor, the specified shell function is called.  If no function name  is
    		     specified, it defaults to the same name as the widget.  For further informa‐
    		     tion, see the section `Widgets' below.
    
    	      -C widget completion-widget function
    		     Create a user-defined completion widget named widget. The completion  widget
    		     will  behave like the built-in completion-widget whose name is given as com‐
    		     pletion-widget. To generate the completions,  the	shell  function  function
    		     will be called.  For further information, see zshcompwid(1).
    
    	      -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
    		     Redisplay	the command line; this is to be called from within a user-defined
    		     widget to allow changes to become visible.  If a display-string is given and
    		     not  empty,  this	is  shown  in the status line (immediately below the line
    		     being edited).
    
    		     If the optional strings are given they are listed below the  prompt  in  the
    		     same way as completion lists are printed. If no strings are given but the -c
    		     option is used such a list is cleared.
    
    		     Note that this option is only useful for widgets that do  not  exit  immedi‐
    		     ately  after  using  it because the strings displayed will be erased immedi‐
    		     ately after return from the widget.
    
    		     This command can safely be called outside user defined widgets;  if  zle  is
    		     active,  the display will be refreshed, while if zle is not active, the com‐
    		     mand has no effect.  In this case there will usually be no other arguments.
    
    		     The status is zero if zle was active, else one.
    
    	      -M string
    		     As with the -R option, the string will be displayed below the command  line;
    		     unlike  the  -R  option, the string will not be put into the status line but
    		     will instead be printed normally below the  prompt.   This  means	that  the
    		     string  will  still be displayed after the widget returns (until it is over‐
    		     written by subsequent commands).
    
    	      -U string
    		     This pushes the characters in the string onto the input stack of ZLE.  After
    		     the  widget currently executed finishes ZLE will behave as if the characters
    		     in the string were typed by the user.
    
    		     As ZLE uses a stack, if this option  is  used  repeatedly	the  last  string
    		     pushed  onto  the stack will be processed first.  However, the characters in
    		     each string will be processed in the order  in  which  they  appear  in  the
    		     string.
    
    	      -K keymap
    		     Selects  the  keymap  named  keymap.   An error message will be displayed if
    		     there is no such keymap.
    
    		     This keymap selection affects the	interpretation	of  following  keystrokes
    		     within  this  invocation  of  ZLE.  Any following invocation (e.g., the next
    		     command line) will start as usual with the `main' keymap selected.
    
    	      -F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
    		     Only available if your system supports one of the `poll' or `select'  system
    		     calls; most modern systems do.
    
    		     Installs  handler	(the  name of a shell function) to handle input from file
    		     descriptor fd.  Installing a handler for an  fd  which  is  already  handled
    		     causes  the existing handler to be replaced.  Any number of handlers for any
    		     number of readable file descriptors may be installed.  Note that  zle  makes
    		     no attempt to check whether this fd is actually readable when installing the
    		     handler.  The user must make their own arrangements for  handling	the  file
    		     descriptor when zle is not active.
    
    		     When  zle	is attempting to read data, it will examine both the terminal and
    		     the list of handled fd's.	If data becomes available on a	handled  fd,  zle
    		     calls  handler with the fd which is ready for reading as the first argument.
    		     Under normal circumstances this is the only argument, but if  an  error  was
    		     detected, a second argument provides details: `hup' for a disconnect, `nval'
    		     for a closed or otherwise invalid descriptor, or `err' for any other  condi‐
    		     tion.  Systems that support only the `select' system call always use `err'.
    
    		     If the option -w is also given, the handler is instead a line editor widget,
    		     typically a shell function made into a widget using `zle -N'.  In that  case
    		     handler  can  use	all  the  facilities of zle to update the current editing
    		     line.  Note, however, that as handling fd takes place at a low level changes
    		     to  the  display  will not automatically appear; the widget should call `zle
    		     -R' to force redisplay.  As of this writing, widget handlers only support	a
    		     single  argument and thus are never passed a string for error state, so wid‐
    		     gets must be prepared to test the descriptor themselves.
    
    		     If either type of handler produces output to the terminal,  it  should  call
    		     `zle  -I'	before doing so (see below).  Handlers should not attempt to read
    		     from the terminal.
    
    		     If no handler is given, but an fd is present, any handler	for  that  fd  is
    		     removed.	If  there  is  none,  an error message is printed and status 1 is
    		     returned.
    
    		     If no arguments are given, or the -L option is supplied, a list of  handlers
    		     is printed in a form which can be stored for later execution.
    
    		     An  fd  (but  not	a handler) may optionally be given with the -L option; in
    		     this case, the function will list the handler if any, else  silently  return
    		     status 1.
    
    		     Note  that  this  feature	should be used with care.  Activity on one of the
    		     fd's which is not properly handled can cause the terminal	to  become  unus‐
    		     able.   Removing  an  fd  handler from within a signal trap may cause unpre‐
    		     dictable behavior.
    
    		     Here is a simple example of using this feature.  A connection  to	a  remote
    		     TCP  port	is  created  using  the  ztcp command; see the description of the
    		     zsh/net/tcp module in zshmodules(1).  Then a handler is installed which sim‐
    		     ply  prints  out  any  data  which  arrives  on  this connection.	Note that
    		     `select' will indicate that the file descriptor needs handling if the remote
    		     side has closed the connection; we handle that by testing for a failed read.
    
    			    if ztcp pwspc 2811; then
    			      tcpfd=$REPLY
    			      handler() {
    				zle -I
    				local line
    				if ! read -r line <&$1; then
    				  # select marks this fd if we reach EOF,
    				  # so handle this specially.
    				  print "[Read on fd $1 failed, removing.]" >&2
    				  zle -F $1
    				  return 1
    				fi
    				print -r - $line
    			      }
    			      zle -F $tcpfd handler
    			    fi
    
    	      -I     Unusually,  this  option  is  most useful outside ordinary widget functions,
    		     though it may be used within if normal output to the terminal  is	required.
    		     It  invalidates the current zle display in preparation for output; typically
    		     this will be from a trap function.  It has no effect if zle is  not  active.
    		     When  a  trap exits, the shell checks to see if the display needs restoring,
    		     hence the following will print output in such a way as not  to  disturb  the
    		     line being edited:
    
    			    TRAPUSR1() {
    			      # Invalidate zle display
    			      [[ -o zle ]] && zle -I
    			      # Show output
    			      print Hello
    			    }
    
    		     In  general, the trap function may need to test whether zle is active before
    		     using this method (as shown in the example), since the  zsh/zle  module  may
    		     not even be loaded; if it is not, the command can be skipped.
    
    		     It  is possible to call `zle -I' several times before control is returned to
    		     the editor; the display will only be invalidated the first time to  minimise
    		     disruption.
    
    		     Note  that  there	are normally better ways of manipulating the display from
    		     within zle widgets; see, for example, `zle -R' above.
    
    		     The returned status is zero if zle was invalidated,  even	though	this  may
    		     have  been  by  a previous call to `zle -I' or by a system notification.  To
    		     test if a zle widget may be called at this point, execute zle with no  argu‐
    		     ments and examine the return status.
    
    	      -T     This is used to add, list or remove internal transformations on the process‐
    		     ing performed by the line editor.	It is typically used only  for	debugging
    		     or testing and is therefore of little interest to the general user.
    
    		     `zle  -T  transformation  func' specifies that the given transformation (see
    		     below) is effected by shell function func.
    
    		     `zle -Tr transformation' removes the given transformation if it was  present
    		     (it is not an error if none was).
    
    		     `zle -TL' can be used to list all transformations currently in operation.
    
    		     Currently the only transformation is tc.  This is used instead of outputting
    		     termcap codes to the terminal.  When the transformation is in operation  the
    		     shell  function is passed the termcap code that would be output as its first
    		     argument; if the operation required a numeric argument, that is passed as	a
    		     second  argument.	 The  function should set the shell variable REPLY to the
    		     transformed termcap code.	Typically this is used	to  produce  some  simply
    		     formatted	version  of the code and optional argument for debugging or test‐
    		     ing.  Note that this transformation is not  applied  to  other  non-printing
    		     characters such as carriage returns and newlines.
    
    	      widget [ -n num ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...
    		     Invoke the specified widget.  This can only be done when ZLE is active; nor‐
    		     mally this will be within a user-defined widget.
    
    		     With the options -n and -N, the current numeric argument will be  saved  and
    		     then  restored  after the call to widget; `-n num' sets the numeric argument
    		     temporarily to num, while `-N' sets it to the default, i.e. as if there were
    		     none.
    
    		     With  the	option	-K,  keymap will be used as the current keymap during the
    		     execution of the widget.  The previous keymap will be restored when the wid‐
    		     get exits.
    
    		     Normally,	calling  a  widget in this way does not set the special parameter
    		     WIDGET and related parameters, so that the environment  appears  as  if  the
    		     top-level	widget called by the user were still active.  With the option -w,
    		     WIDGET and related parameters are set to reflect the widget  being  executed
    		     by the zle call.
    
    		     Any  further  arguments  will be passed to the widget; note that as standard
    		     argument handling is performed, any general argument list should be preceded
    		     by  --.   If  it  is  a  shell function, these are passed down as positional
    		     parameters; for builtin widgets it is up to the widget in question  what  it
    		     does  with  them.	 Currently  arguments  are  only handled by the incremen‐
    		     tal-search commands, the history-search-forward and -backward and the corre‐
    		     sponding  functions prefixed by vi-, and by universal-argument.  No error is
    		     flagged if the command does not use the arguments,  or  only  uses  some  of
    		     them.
    
    		     The  return  status reflects the success or failure of the operation carried
    		     out by the widget, or if it is a user-defined widget the  return  status  of
    		     the shell function.
    
    		     A	non-zero  return  status  causes the shell to beep when the widget exits,
    		     unless the BEEP options was unset or the widget was called via the zle  com‐
    		     mand.   Thus  if a user defined widget requires an immediate beep, it should
    		     call the beep widget directly.
    
    WIDGETS
           All actions in the editor are performed by `widgets'.  A widget's job is simply to perform
           some  small  action.   The  ZLE commands that key sequences in keymaps are bound to are in
           fact widgets.  Widgets can be user-defined or built in.
    
           The standard widgets built into ZLE are listed in Standard Widgets below.  Other  built-in
           widgets can be defined by other modules (see zshmodules(1)).  Each built-in widget has two
           names: its normal canonical name, and the same name preceded by a `.'.  The  `.'  name  is
           special:  it can't be rebound to a different widget.  This makes the widget available even
           when its usual name has been redefined.
    
           User-defined widgets are defined using `zle -N', and implemented as shell functions.  When
           the  widget  is	executed,  the	corresponding shell function is executed, and can perform
           editing (or other) actions.  It is recommended that user-defined widgets should	not  have
           names starting with `.'.
    
    USER-DEFINED WIDGETS
           User-defined  widgets,  being implemented as shell functions, can execute any normal shell
           command.  They can also run other widgets (whether built-in or user-defined) using the zle
           builtin	command.   The	standard input of the function is closed to prevent external com‐
           mands from unintentionally blocking ZLE by reading from the terminal, but read -k or  read
           -q  can	be  used  to  read characters.	Finally, they can examine and edit the ZLE buffer
           being edited by reading and setting the special parameters described below.
    
           These special parameters are always available in widget functions, but are not in any  way
           special	outside ZLE.  If they have some normal value outside ZLE, that value is temporar‐
           ily inaccessible, but will return when the widget function exits.  These  special  parame‐
           ters in fact have local scope, like parameters created in a function using local.
    
           Inside  completion  widgets  and  traps	called	while ZLE is active, these parameters are
           available read-only.
    
           Note that the parameters appear as local to any ZLE widget in which they appear.  Hence if
           it is desired to override them this needs to be done within a nested function:
    
    	      widget-function() {
    		# $WIDGET here refers to the special variable
    		# that is local inside widget-function
    		() {
    		   # This anonymous nested function allows WIDGET
    		   # to be used as a local variable.  The -h
    		   # removes the special status of the variable.
    		   local -h WIDGET
    		}
    	      }
    
           BUFFER (scalar)
    	      The entire contents of the edit buffer.  If it is written to, the cursor remains at
    	      the same offset, unless that would put it outside the buffer.
    
           BUFFERLINES (integer)
    	      The number of screen lines needed for the edit buffer currently displayed on screen
    	      (i.e.  without  any  changes to the preceding parameters done after the last redis‐
    	      play); read-only.
    
           CONTEXT (scalar)
    	      The context in which zle was called to read a line; read-only.  One of the values:
    
    	      start  The start of a command line (at prompt PS1).
    
    	      cont   A continuation to a command line (at prompt PS2).
    
    	      select In a select loop.
    
    	      vared  Editing a variable in vared.
    
           CURSOR (integer)
    	      The offset of the cursor, within the edit buffer.  This is in the range 0 to $#BUF‐
    	      FER,  and is by definition equal to $#LBUFFER.  Attempts to move the cursor outside
    	      the buffer will result in the cursor being moved to the appropriate end of the buf‐
    	      fer.
    
           CUTBUFFER (scalar)
    	      The last item cut using one of the `kill-' commands; the string which the next yank
    	      would insert in the line.  Later entries in the kill ring are in	the  array  kill‐
    	      ring.   Note  that  the command `zle copy-region-as-kill string' can be used to set
    	      the text of the cut buffer from a shell function and cycle the  kill  ring  in  the
    	      same way as interactively killing text.
    
           HISTNO (integer)
    	      The  current history number.  Setting this has the same effect as moving up or down
    	      in the history to the corresponding history line.  An attempt to set it is  ignored
    	      if the line is not stored in the history.  Note this is not the same as the parame‐
    	      ter HISTCMD, which always gives the number of the history line being added  to  the
    	      main shell's history.  HISTNO refers to the line being retrieved within zle.
    
           KEYMAP (scalar)
    	      The name of the currently selected keymap; read-only.
    
           KEYS (scalar)
    	      The keys typed to invoke this widget, as a literal string; read-only.
    
           killring (array)
    	      The  array  of  previously killed items, with the most recently killed first.  This
    	      gives the items that would be retrieved by a yank-pop in	the  same  order.   Note,
    	      however,	that  the most recently killed item is in $CUTBUFFER; $killring shows the
    	      array of previous entries.
    
    	      The default size for the kill ring is eight, however the length may be  changed  by
    	      normal  array  operations.   Any	empty  string  in the kill ring is ignored by the
    	      yank-pop command, hence the size of the array effectively sets the  maximum  length
    	      of  the  kill  ring, while the number of non-zero strings gives the current length,
    	      both as seen by the user at the command line.
    
           LASTABORTEDSEARCH (scalar)
    	      The last search string used by an interactive search that was aborted by	the  user
    	      (status 3 returned by the search widget).
    
           LASTSEARCH (scalar)
    	      The  last search string used by an interactive search; read-only.  This is set even
    	      if the search failed (status 0, 1 or 2 returned by the search widget), but  not  if
    	      it was aborted by the user.
    
           LASTWIDGET (scalar)
    	      The name of the last widget that was executed; read-only.
    
           LBUFFER (scalar)
    	      The  part  of  the  buffer  that lies to the left of the cursor position.  If it is
    	      assigned to, only that part of the buffer  is  replaced,	and  the  cursor  remains
    	      between the new $LBUFFER and the old $RBUFFER.
    
           MARK (integer)
    	      Like CURSOR, but for the mark. With vi-mode operators that wait for a movement com‐
    	      mand to select a region of text, setting MARK allows the	selection  to  extend  in
    	      both directions from the the initial cursor position.
    
           NUMERIC (integer)
    	      The  numeric  argument.  If no numeric argument was given, this parameter is unset.
    	      When this is set inside a widget function, builtin  widgets  called  with  the  zle
    	      builtin  command	will use the value assigned. If it is unset inside a widget func‐
    	      tion, builtin widgets called behave as if no numeric argument was given.
    
           PENDING (integer)
    	      The number of bytes pending for input, i.e. the number of bytes which have  already
    	      been  typed  and can immediately be read. On systems where the shell is not able to
    	      get this information, this parameter will always have a value of zero.  Read-only.
    
           PREBUFFER (scalar)
    	      In a multi-line input at the secondary prompt, this  read-only  parameter  contains
    	      the contents of the lines before the one the cursor is currently in.
    
           PREDISPLAY (scalar)
    	      Text  to	be displayed before the start of the editable text buffer.  This does not
    	      have to be a complete line; to display a complete line, a newline must be  appended
    	      explicitly.   The  text  is reset on each new invocation (but not recursive invoca‐
    	      tion) of zle.
    
           POSTDISPLAY (scalar)
    	      Text to be displayed after the end of the editable text buffer.  This does not have
    	      to  be  a  complete  line;  to display a complete line, a newline must be prepended
    	      explicitly.  The text is reset on each new invocation (but  not  recursive  invoca‐
    	      tion) of zle.
    
           RBUFFER (scalar)
    	      The  part  of  the  buffer that lies to the right of the cursor position.  If it is
    	      assigned to, only that part of the buffer  is  replaced,	and  the  cursor  remains
    	      between the old $LBUFFER and the new $RBUFFER.
    
           REGION_ACTIVE (integer)
    	      Indicates  if the region is currently active.  It can be assigned 0 or 1 to deacti‐
    	      vate and activate the region respectively. A value of 2  activates  the  region  in
    	      line-wise  mode with the highlighted text extending for whole lines only; see Char‐
    	      acter Highlighting below.
    
           region_highlight (array)
    	      Each element of this array may be set to a string that describes	highlighting  for
    	      an  arbitrary  region  of  the command line that will take effect the next time the
    	      command line is redisplayed.  Highlighting of the non-editable parts of the command
    	      line in PREDISPLAY and POSTDISPLAY are possible, but note that the P flag is needed
    	      for character indexing to include PREDISPLAY.
    
    	      Each string consists of the following parts:
    
    	      ·      Optionally, a `P' to signify that the  start  and	end  offset  that  follow
    		     include  any  string set by the PREDISPLAY special parameter; this is needed
    		     if the predisplay string itself is to be highlighted.  Whitespace may follow
    		     the `P'.
    
    	      ·      A start offset in the same units as CURSOR, terminated by whitespace.
    
    	      ·      An end offset in the same units as CURSOR, terminated by whitespace.
    
    	      ·      A	highlight  specification  in  the same format as used for contexts in the
    		     parameter zle_highlight, see the section `Character Highlighting' below; for
    		     example, standout or fg=red,bold
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     region_highlight=("P0 20 bold")
    
    	      specifies  that  the  first  twenty characters of the text including any predisplay
    	      string should be highlighted in bold.
    
    	      Note that the effect of region_highlight is not saved and disappears as soon as the
    	      line is accepted.
    
    	      The  final  highlighting	on  the command line depends on both region_highlight and
    	      zle_highlight; see the section CHARACTER HIGHLIGHTING below for details.
    
           UNDO_CHANGE_NO (integer)
    	      A number representing the state of the undo history.  The only use of this is pass‐
    	      ing  as an argument to the undo widget in order to undo back to the recorded point.
    	      Read-only.
    
           UNDO_LIMIT_NO (integer)
    	      A number	corresponding  to  an  existing  change  in  the  undo	history;  compare
    	      UNDO_CHANGE_NO.  If this is set to a value greater than zero, the undo command will
    	      not allow the line to be undone beyond the given change number.  It is still possi‐
    	      ble  to  use `zle undo change' in a widget to undo beyond that point; in that case,
    	      it will not be possible to undo at all until UNDO_LIMIT_NO is reduced.  Set to 0 to
    	      disable the limit.
    
    	      A  typical  use of this variable in a widget function is as follows (note the addi‐
    	      tional function scope is required):
    
    		     () {
    		       local UNDO_LIMIT_NO=$UNDO_CHANGE_NO
    		       # Perform some form of recursive edit.
    		     }
    
           WIDGET (scalar)
    	      The name of the widget currently being executed; read-only.
    
           WIDGETFUNC (scalar)
    	      The name of the shell function that implements a widget defined with either zle  -N
    	      or  zle  -C.  In the former case, this is the second argument to the zle -N command
    	      that defined the widget, or the first argument if there was no second argument.  In
    	      the  latter  case this is the third argument to the zle -C command that defined the
    	      widget.  Read-only.
    
           WIDGETSTYLE (scalar)
    	      Describes the implementation behind the completion widget currently being executed;
    	      the  second argument that followed zle -C when the widget was defined.  This is the
    	      name of a builtin completion widget.  For widgets defined with zle -N this  is  set
    	      to the empty string.  Read-only.
    
           YANK_ACTIVE (integer)
           YANK_START (integer)
           YANK_END (integer)
    	      These three parameters indicate whether text has just been yanked (pasted) into the
    	      buffer.  YANK_START and YANK_END are in the same unit  sas  CURSOR,  and	are  only
    	      valid when YANK_ACTIVE is non-zero.
    
    	      All three are read-only.
    
           ZLE_STATE (scalar)
    	      Contains a set of space-separated words that describe the current zle state.
    
    	      Currently,  the  states  shown  are the insert mode as set by the overwrite-mode or
    	      vi-replace widgets and whether history commands will visit imported entries as con‐
    	      trolled  by  the set-local-history widget.  The string contains `insert' if charac‐
    	      ters to be inserted on the command line move existing characters to  the	right  or
    	      `overwrite' if characters to be inserted overwrite existing characters. It contains
    	      `localhistory' if only local history commands will be visited or `globalhistory' if
    	      imported history commands will also be visited.
    
    	      The substrings are sorted in alphabetical order so that if you want to test for two
    	      specific substrings in a future-proof way, you can do match by doing:
    
    		     if [[ $ZLE_STATE == *globalhistory*insert* ]]; then ...; fi
    
       Special Widgets
           There are a few user-defined widgets which are special to  the  shell.	If  they  do  not
           exist,  no special action is taken.  The environment provided is identical to that for any
           other editing widget.
    
           zle-isearch-exit
    	      Executed at the end of incremental search at the point where the isearch prompt  is
    	      removed from the display.  See zle-isearch-update for an example.
    
           zle-isearch-update
    	      Executed	within incremental search when the display is about to be redrawn.  Addi‐
    	      tional output below the incremental search prompt can be generated  by  using  `zle
    	      -M' within the widget.  For example,
    
    		     zle-isearch-update() { zle -M "Line $HISTNO"; }
    		     zle -N zle-isearch-update
    
    	      Note  the  line  output by `zle -M' is not deleted on exit from incremental search.
    	      This can be done from a zle-isearch-exit widget:
    
    		     zle-isearch-exit() { zle -M ""; }
    		     zle -N zle-isearch-exit
    
           zle-line-init
    	      Executed every time the line editor is started to read a new line  of  input.   The
    	      following example puts the line editor into vi command mode when it starts up.
    
    		     zle-line-init() { zle -K vicmd; }
    		     zle -N zle-line-init
    
    	      (The  command inside the function sets the keymap directly; it is equivalent to zle
    	      vi-cmd-mode.)
    
           zle-line-finish
    	      This is similar to zle-line-init but is executed every time  the	line  editor  has
    	      finished reading a line of input.
    
           zle-history-line-set
    	      Executed when the history line changes.
    
           zle-keymap-select
    	      Executed every time the keymap changes, i.e. the special parameter KEYMAP is set to
    	      a different value, while the line editor is active.  Initialising the  keymap  when
    	      the line editor starts does not cause the widget to be called.
    
    	      The  value  $KEYMAP within the function reflects the new keymap.	The old keymap is
    	      passed as the sole argument.
    
    	      This can be used for detecting switches between the vi command (vicmd)  and  insert
    	      (usually main) keymaps.
    
    STANDARD WIDGETS
           The  following  is a list of all the standard widgets, and their default bindings in emacs
           mode, vi command mode and vi insert  mode  (the	`emacs',  `vicmd'  and	`viins'  keymaps,
           respectively).
    
           Note  that  cursor keys are bound to movement keys in all three keymaps; the shell assumes
           that the cursor keys send the key sequences  reported  by  the  terminal-handling  library
           (termcap  or terminfo).	The key sequences shown in the list are those based on the VT100,
           common on many modern terminals, but in fact these are not necessarily bound.  In the case
           of  the	viins keymap, the initial escape character of the sequences serves also to return
           to the vicmd keymap: whether this happens is determined by the KEYTIMEOUT  parameter,  see
           zshparam(1).
    
       Movement
           vi-backward-blank-word (unbound) (B) (unbound)
    	      Move  backward  one  word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank charac‐
    	      ters.
    
           vi-backward-blank-word-end (unbound) (gE) (unbound)
    	      Move to the end of the previous word, where a  word  is  defined	as  a  series  of
    	      non-blank characters.
    
           backward-char (^B ESC-[D) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Move backward one character.
    
           vi-backward-char (unbound) (^H h ^?) (ESC-[D)
    	      Move backward one character, without changing lines.
    
           backward-word (ESC-B ESC-b) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Move to the beginning of the previous word.
    
           emacs-backward-word
    	      Move to the beginning of the previous word.
    
           vi-backward-word (unbound) (b) (unbound)
    	      Move to the beginning of the previous word, vi-style.
    
           vi-backward-word-end (unbound) (ge) (unbound)
    	      Move to the end of the previous word, vi-style.
    
           beginning-of-line (^A) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Move  to	the beginning of the line.  If already at the beginning of the line, move
    	      to the beginning of the previous line, if any.
    
           vi-beginning-of-line
    	      Move to the beginning of the line, without changing lines.
    
           down-line (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Move down a line in the buffer.
    
           end-of-line (^E) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the line, move to the end of
    	      the next line, if any.
    
           vi-end-of-line (unbound) ($) (unbound)
    	      Move  to	the end of the line.  If an argument is given to this command, the cursor
    	      will be moved to the end of the line (argument - 1) lines down.
    
           vi-forward-blank-word (unbound) (W) (unbound)
    	      Move forward one word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.
    
           vi-forward-blank-word-end (unbound) (E) (unbound)
    	      Move to the end of the current word, or, if at the end of the current word, to  the
    	      end of the next word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.
    
           forward-char (^F ESC-[C) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Move forward one character.
    
           vi-forward-char (unbound) (space l) (ESC-[C)
    	      Move forward one character.
    
           vi-find-next-char (^X^F) (f) (unbound)
    	      Read  a  character  from the keyboard, and move to the next occurrence of it in the
    	      line.
    
           vi-find-next-char-skip (unbound) (t) (unbound)
    	      Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the position just before	the  next
    	      occurrence of it in the line.
    
           vi-find-prev-char (unbound) (F) (unbound)
    	      Read  a  character  from the keyboard, and move to the previous occurrence of it in
    	      the line.
    
           vi-find-prev-char-skip (unbound) (T) (unbound)
    	      Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the position just after the  previ‐
    	      ous occurrence of it in the line.
    
           vi-first-non-blank (unbound) (^) (unbound)
    	      Move to the first non-blank character in the line.
    
           vi-forward-word (unbound) (w) (unbound)
    	      Move forward one word, vi-style.
    
           forward-word (ESC-F ESC-f) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Move  to	the beginning of the next word.  The editor's idea of a word is specified
    	      with the WORDCHARS parameter.
    
           emacs-forward-word
    	      Move to the end of the next word.
    
           vi-forward-word-end (unbound) (e) (unbound)
    	      Move to the end of the next word.
    
           vi-goto-column (ESC-|) (|) (unbound)
    	      Move to the column specified by the numeric argument.
    
           vi-goto-mark (unbound) (`) (unbound)
    	      Move to the specified mark.
    
           vi-goto-mark-line (unbound) (') (unbound)
    	      Move to beginning of the line containing the specified mark.
    
           vi-repeat-find (unbound) (;) (unbound)
    	      Repeat the last vi-find command.
    
           vi-rev-repeat-find (unbound) (,) (unbound)
    	      Repeat the last vi-find command in the opposite direction.
    
           up-line (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Move up a line in the buffer.
    
       History Control
           beginning-of-buffer-or-history (ESC-<) (gg) (unbound)
    	      Move to the beginning of the buffer, or if already there, move to the  first  event
    	      in the history list.
    
           beginning-of-line-hist
    	      Move to the beginning of the line.  If already at the beginning of the buffer, move
    	      to the previous history line.
    
           beginning-of-history
    	      Move to the first event in the history list.
    
           down-line-or-history (^N ESC-[B) (j) (ESC-[B)
    	      Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line, move to the  next
    	      event in the history list.
    
           vi-down-line-or-history (unbound) (+) (unbound)
    	      Move  down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line, move to the next
    	      event in the history list.  Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.
    
           down-line-or-search
    	      Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line, search forward in
    	      the history for a line beginning with the first word in the buffer.
    
    	      If  called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is
    	      taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.
    
           down-history (unbound) (^N) (unbound)
    	      Move to the next event in the history list.
    
           history-beginning-search-backward
    	      Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the current line up to the
    	      cursor.  This leaves the cursor in its original position.
    
           end-of-buffer-or-history (ESC->) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Move  to	the end of the buffer, or if already there, move to the last event in the
    	      history list.
    
           end-of-line-hist
    	      Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the buffer, move to the next
    	      history line.
    
           end-of-history
    	      Move to the last event in the history list.
    
           vi-fetch-history (unbound) (G) (unbound)
    	      Fetch  the  history  line  specified by the numeric argument.  This defaults to the
    	      current history line (i.e. the one that isn't history yet).
    
           history-incremental-search-backward (^R ^Xr) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Search backward incrementally for a specified string.  The search is  case-insensi‐
    	      tive  if	the search string does not have uppercase letters and no numeric argument
    	      was given.  The string may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning  of
    	      the line.  When called from a user-defined function returns the following statuses:
    	      0, if the search succeeded; 1, if the search failed; 2, if the search  term  was	a
    	      bad pattern; 3, if the search was aborted by the send-break command.
    
    	      A  restricted  set  of editing functions is available in the mini-buffer.  Keys are
    	      looked up in the special isearch keymap, and if not found there in the main  keymap
    	      (note  that  by  default	the  isearch  keymap  is empty).  An interrupt signal, as
    	      defined by the stty setting, will stop the search and go back to the original line.
    	      An undefined key will have the same effect.  Note that the following always perform
    	      the same task within incremental searches and cannot be replaced	by  user  defined
    	      widgets, nor can the set of functions be extended.  The supported functions are:
    
    	      accept-and-hold
    	      accept-and-infer-next-history
    	      accept-line
    	      accept-line-and-down-history
    		     Perform  the  usual  function after exiting incremental search.  The command
    		     line displayed is executed.
    
    	      backward-delete-char
    	      vi-backward-delete-char
    		     Back up one place in the search history.  If the search  has  been  repeated
    		     this does not immediately erase a character in the minibuffer.
    
    	      accept-search
    		     Exit  incremental	search, retaining the command line but performing no fur‐
    		     ther action.  Note that this function is not bound by  default  and  has  no
    		     effect outside incremental search.
    
    	      backward-delete-word
    	      backward-kill-word
    	      vi-backward-kill-word
    		     Back up one character in the minibuffer; if multiple searches have been per‐
    		     formed since the character was inserted the search history is rewound to the
    		     point  just  before the character was entered.  Hence this has the effect of
    		     repeating backward-delete-char.
    
    	      clear-screen
    		     Clear the screen, remaining in incremental search mode.
    
    	      history-incremental-search-backward
    		     Find the next  occurrence	of  the  contents  of  the  mini-buffer.  If  the
    		     mini-buffer is empty, the most recent previously used search string is rein‐
    		     stated.
    
    	      history-incremental-search-forward
    		     Invert the sense of the search.
    
    	      magic-space
    		     Inserts a non-magical space.
    
    	      quoted-insert
    	      vi-quoted-insert
    		     Quote the character to insert into the minibuffer.
    
    	      redisplay
    		     Redisplay the command line, remaining in incremental search mode.
    
    	      vi-cmd-mode
    		     Select the `vicmd' keymap; the `main' keymap (insert mode) will be  selected
    		     initially.
    
    		     In  addition,  the  modifications that were made while in vi insert mode are
    		     merged to form a single undo event.
    
    	      vi-repeat-search
    	      vi-rev-repeat-search
    		     Repeat the search.   The  direction  of  the  search  is  indicated  in  the
    		     mini-buffer.
    
    	      Any  character  that  is not bound to one of the above functions, or self-insert or
    	      self-insert-unmeta, will cause the mode to be exited.  The character is then looked
    	      up and executed in the keymap in effect at that point.
    
    	      When  called from a widget function by the zle command, the incremental search com‐
    	      mands can take a string argument.  This will be treated as a string of keys, as for
    	      arguments  to  the bindkey command, and used as initial input for the command.  Any
    	      characters in the string which  are  unused  by  the  incremental  search  will  be
    	      silently ignored.  For example,
    
    		     zle history-incremental-search-backward forceps
    
    	      will  search  backwards  for  forceps, leaving the minibuffer containing the string
    	      `forceps'.
    
           history-incremental-search-forward (^S ^Xs) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Search forward incrementally for a specified string.  The search	is  case-insensi‐
    	      tive  if	the search string does not have uppercase letters and no numeric argument
    	      was given.  The string may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning  of
    	      the  line.   The	functions  available  in the mini-buffer are the same as for his‐
    	      tory-incremental-search-backward.
    
           history-incremental-pattern-search-backward
           history-incremental-pattern-search-forward
    	      These widgets behave similarly to the corresponding widgets with no  -pattern,  but
    	      the search string typed by the user is treated as a pattern, respecting the current
    	      settings of the various options affecting pattern matching.  See	FILENAME  GENERA‐
    	      TION in zshexpn(1) for a description of patterns.  If no numeric argument was given
    	      lowercase letters in the search string may match uppercase letters in the  history.
    	      The string may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.
    
    	      The  prompt  changes  to	indicate an invalid pattern; this may simply indicate the
    	      pattern is not yet complete.
    
    	      Note that only non-overlapping matches are reported, so an  expression  with  wild‐
    	      cards may return fewer matches on a line than are visible by inspection.
    
           history-search-backward (ESC-P ESC-p) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the first word in the buf‐
    	      fer.
    
    	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument  is
    	      taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.
    
           vi-history-search-backward (unbound) (/) (unbound)
    	      Search  backward	in the history for a specified string.	The string may begin with
    	      `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.
    
    	      A restricted set of editing functions is available in the mini-buffer.   An  inter‐
    	      rupt  signal, as defined by the stty setting,  will stop the search.  The functions
    	      available in  the  mini-buffer  are:  accept-line,  backward-delete-char,  vi-back‐
    	      ward-delete-char,  backward-kill-word,  vi-backward-kill-word, clear-screen, redis‐
    	      play, quoted-insert and vi-quoted-insert.
    
    	      vi-cmd-mode is treated the same as accept-line, and magic-space  is  treated  as	a
    	      space.   Any other character that is not bound to self-insert or self-insert-unmeta
    	      will beep and be ignored. If the function is called from vi command mode, the bind‐
    	      ings of the current insert mode will be used.
    
    	      If  called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is
    	      taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.
    
           history-search-forward (ESC-N ESC-n) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the first word in the  buf‐
    	      fer.
    
    	      If  called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is
    	      taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.
    
           vi-history-search-forward (unbound) (?) (unbound)
    	      Search forward in the history for a specified string.  The string  may  begin  with
    	      `^'  to  anchor the search to the beginning of the line. The functions available in
    	      the mini-buffer are the same as for vi-history-search-backward.  Argument  handling
    	      is also the same as for that command.
    
           infer-next-history (^X^N) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Search  in the history list for a line matching the current one and fetch the event
    	      following it.
    
           insert-last-word (ESC-_ ESC-.) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Insert the last word from the previous history event at the cursor position.  If	a
    	      positive	numeric  argument is given, insert that word from the end of the previous
    	      history event.  If the argument is zero or negative insert that word from the  left
    	      (zero inserts the previous command word).  Repeating this command replaces the word
    	      just inserted with the last word from the history event prior to the one just used;
    	      numeric arguments can be used in the same way to pick a word from that event.
    
    	      When  called  from a shell function invoked from a user-defined widget, the command
    	      can take one to three arguments.	The first argument  specifies  a  history  offset
    	      which  applies  to successive calls to this widget: if it is -1, the default behav‐
    	      iour is used, while if it is 1, successive calls will  move  forwards  through  the
    	      history.	The value 0 can be used to indicate that the history line examined by the
    	      previous execution of the command will be reexamined.  Note that	negative  numbers
    	      should be preceded by a `--' argument to avoid confusing them with options.
    
    	      If  two  arguments  are given, the second specifies the word on the command line in
    	      normal array index notation (as a more natural alternative  to  the  numeric  argu‐
    	      ment).  Hence 1 is the first word, and -1 (the default) is the last word.
    
    	      If  a third argument is given, its value is ignored, but it is used to signify that
    	      the history offset is relative to the current history line,  rather  than  the  one
    	      remembered after the previous invocations of insert-last-word.
    
    	      For example, the default behaviour of the command corresponds to
    
    		     zle insert-last-word -- -1 -1
    
    	      while the command
    
    		     zle insert-last-word -- -1 1 -
    
    	      always copies the first word of the line in the history immediately before the line
    	      being edited.  This has the side effect that later invocations of the  widget  will
    	      be relative to that line.
    
           vi-repeat-search (unbound) (n) (unbound)
    	      Repeat the last vi history search.
    
           vi-rev-repeat-search (unbound) (N) (unbound)
    	      Repeat the last vi history search, but in reverse.
    
           up-line-or-history (^P ESC-[A) (k) (ESC-[A)
    	      Move  up	a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line, move to the previous
    	      event in the history list.
    
           vi-up-line-or-history (unbound) (-) (unbound)
    	      Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line, move to  the  previous
    	      event in the history list.  Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.
    
           up-line-or-search
    	      Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line, search backward in the
    	      history for a line beginning with the first word in the buffer.
    
    	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument  is
    	      taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.
    
           up-history (unbound) (^P) (unbound)
    	      Move to the previous event in the history list.
    
           history-beginning-search-forward
    	      Search  forward in the history for a line beginning with the current line up to the
    	      cursor.  This leaves the cursor in its original position.
    
           set-local-history
    	      By default, history movement commands visit the imported lines as well as the local
    	      lines.  This  widget  lets  you  toggle this on and off, or set it with the numeric
    	      argument. Zero for both local and imported lines and nonzero for only local lines.
    
       Modifying Text
           vi-add-eol (unbound) (A) (unbound)
    	      Move to the end of the line and enter insert mode.
    
           vi-add-next (unbound) (a) (unbound)
    	      Enter insert mode after the current cursor position, without changing lines.
    
           backward-delete-char (^H ^?) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Delete the character behind the cursor.
    
           vi-backward-delete-char (unbound) (X) (^H)
    	      Delete the character behind the cursor, without changing lines.  If in insert mode,
    	      this won't delete past the point where insert mode was last entered.
    
           backward-delete-word
    	      Delete the word behind the cursor.
    
           backward-kill-line
    	      Kill from the beginning of the line to the cursor position.
    
           backward-kill-word (^W ESC-^H ESC-^?) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Kill the word behind the cursor.
    
           vi-backward-kill-word (unbound) (unbound) (^W)
    	      Kill the word behind the cursor, without going past the point where insert mode was
    	      last entered.
    
           capitalize-word (ESC-C ESC-c) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Capitalize the current word and move past it.
    
           vi-change (unbound) (c) (unbound)
    	      Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill from the cursor position to the
    	      endpoint	of  the  movement.  Then enter insert mode.  If the command is vi-change,
    	      change the current line.
    
    	      For  compatibility  with	vi,  if  the  command  is  vi-forward-word   or   vi-for‐
    	      ward-blank-word,	the  whitespace after the word is not included. If you prefer the
    	      more consistent behaviour with the whitespace included use the following key  bind‐
    	      ing:
    
    		     bindkey -a -s cw dwi
    
           vi-change-eol (unbound) (C) (unbound)
    	      Kill to the end of the line and enter insert mode.
    
           vi-change-whole-line (unbound) (S) (unbound)
    	      Kill the current line and enter insert mode.
    
           copy-region-as-kill (ESC-W ESC-w) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Copy the area from the cursor to the mark to the kill buffer.
    
    	      If  called  from a ZLE widget function in the form `zle copy-region-as-kill string'
    	      then string will be taken as the text to copy to the kill buffer.  The cursor,  the
    	      mark and the text on the command line are not used in this case.
    
           copy-prev-word (ESC-^_) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Duplicate the word to the left of the cursor.
    
           copy-prev-shell-word
    	      Like  copy-prev-word,  but  the  word  is  found	by  using  shell parsing, whereas
    	      copy-prev-word looks for blanks. This makes a difference when the  word  is  quoted
    	      and contains spaces.
    
           vi-delete (unbound) (d) (unbound)
    	      Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill from the cursor position to the
    	      endpoint of the movement.  If the command is vi-delete, kill the current line.
    
           delete-char
    	      Delete the character under the cursor.
    
           vi-delete-char (unbound) (x) (unbound)
    	      Delete the character under the cursor, without going past the end of the line.
    
           delete-word
    	      Delete the current word.
    
           down-case-word (ESC-L ESC-l) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Convert the current word to all lowercase and move past it.
    
           kill-word (ESC-D ESC-d) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Kill the current word.
    
           gosmacs-transpose-chars
    	      Exchange the two characters behind the cursor.
    
           vi-indent (unbound) (>) (unbound)
    	      Indent a number of lines.
    
           vi-insert (unbound) (i) (unbound)
    	      Enter insert mode.
    
           vi-insert-bol (unbound) (I) (unbound)
    	      Move to the first non-blank character on the line and enter insert mode.
    
           vi-join (^X^J) (J) (unbound)
    	      Join the current line with the next one.
    
           kill-line (^K) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.  If already on the end  of  the  line,
    	      kill the newline character.
    
           vi-kill-line (unbound) (unbound) (^U)
    	      Kill from the cursor back to wherever insert mode was last entered.
    
           vi-kill-eol (unbound) (D) (unbound)
    	      Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.
    
           kill-region
    	      Kill from the cursor to the mark.
    
           kill-buffer (^X^K) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Kill the entire buffer.
    
           kill-whole-line (^U) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Kill the current line.
    
           vi-match-bracket (^X^B) (%) (unbound)
    	      Move  to the bracket character (one of {}, () or []) that matches the one under the
    	      cursor.  If the cursor is not on a bracket character, move  forward  without  going
    	      past the end of the line to find one, and then go to the matching bracket.
    
           vi-open-line-above (unbound) (O) (unbound)
    	      Open a line above the cursor and enter insert mode.
    
           vi-open-line-below (unbound) (o) (unbound)
    	      Open a line below the cursor and enter insert mode.
    
           vi-oper-swap-case (unbound) (g~) (unbound)
    	      Read a movement command from the keyboard, and swap the case of all characters from
    	      the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.  If the  movement  command  is
    	      vi-oper-swap-case, swap the case of all characters on the current line.
    
           overwrite-mode (^X^O) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Toggle between overwrite mode and insert mode.
    
           vi-put-before (unbound) (P) (unbound)
    	      Insert  the contents of the kill buffer before the cursor.  If the kill buffer con‐
    	      tains a sequence of lines (as opposed to characters), paste it  above  the  current
    	      line.
    
           vi-put-after (unbound) (p) (unbound)
    	      Insert  the  contents of the kill buffer after the cursor.  If the kill buffer con‐
    	      tains a sequence of lines (as opposed to characters), paste it  below  the  current
    	      line.
    
           put-replace-selection (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Replace  the  contents  of the current region or selection with the contents of the
    	      kill buffer. If the kill buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to charac‐
    	      ters), the current line will be split by the pasted lines.
    
           quoted-insert (^V) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Insert  the next character typed into the buffer literally.  An interrupt character
    	      will not be inserted.
    
           vi-quoted-insert (unbound) (unbound) (^Q ^V)
    	      Display a `^' at the cursor position, and insert the next character typed into  the
    	      buffer literally.  An interrupt character will not be inserted.
    
           quote-line (ESC-') (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Quote  the current line; that is, put a `'' character at the beginning and the end,
    	      and convert all `'' characters to `'\'''.
    
           quote-region (ESC-") (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Quote the region from the cursor to the mark.
    
           vi-replace (unbound) (R) (unbound)
    	      Enter overwrite mode.
    
           vi-repeat-change (unbound) (.) (unbound)
    	      Repeat the last vi mode text modification.  If a count was used with the	modifica‐
    	      tion,  it  is  remembered.   If  a count is given to this command, it overrides the
    	      remembered count, and is remembered for future uses of this command.  The cut  buf‐
    	      fer specification is similarly remembered.
    
           vi-replace-chars (unbound) (r) (unbound)
    	      Replace the character under the cursor with a character read from the keyboard.
    
           self-insert  (printable characters) (unbound) (printable characters and some control char‐
           acters)
    	      Insert a character into the buffer at the cursor position.
    
           self-insert-unmeta (ESC-^I ESC-^J ESC-^M) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Insert a character into the buffer after stripping the meta bit and  converting  ^M
    	      to ^J.
    
           vi-substitute (unbound) (s) (unbound)
    	      Substitute the next character(s).
    
           vi-swap-case (unbound) (~) (unbound)
    	      Swap the case of the character under the cursor and move past it.
    
           transpose-chars (^T) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Exchange	the  two  characters  to  the  left of the cursor if at end of line, else
    	      exchange the character under the cursor with the character to the left.
    
           transpose-words (ESC-T ESC-t) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Exchange the current word with the one before it.
    
           vi-unindent (unbound) (<) (unbound)
    	      Unindent a number of lines.
    
           up-case-word (ESC-U ESC-u) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Convert the current word to all caps and move past it.
    
           yank (^Y) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Insert the contents of the kill buffer at the cursor position.
    
           yank-pop (ESC-y) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Remove the text just yanked, rotate the kill-ring (the history of previously killed
    	      text) and yank the new top.  Only works following yank, vi-put-before, vi-put-after
    	      or yank-pop.
    
           vi-yank (unbound) (y) (unbound)
    	      Read a movement command from the keyboard, and copy  the	region	from  the  cursor
    	      position	to  the endpoint of the movement into the kill buffer.	If the command is
    	      vi-yank, copy the current line.
    
           vi-yank-whole-line (unbound) (Y) (unbound)
    	      Copy the current line into the kill buffer.
    
           vi-yank-eol
    	      Copy the region from the cursor position to the end of the line into the kill  buf‐
    	      fer.  Arguably, this is what Y should do in vi, but it isn't what it actually does.
    
       Arguments
           digit-argument (ESC-0..ESC-9) (1-9) (unbound)
    	      Start   a   new	numeric   argument,   or  add  to  the	current  one.	See  also
    	      vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line.  This only works if bound to a key  sequence  ending
    	      in a decimal digit.
    
    	      Inside  a  widget  function, a call to this function treats the last key of the key
    	      sequence which called the widget as the digit.
    
           neg-argument (ESC--) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Changes the sign of the following argument.
    
           universal-argument
    	      Multiply the argument of the next command by 4.  Alternatively, if this command  is
    	      followed	by  an	integer  (positive or negative), use that as the argument for the
    	      next command.  Thus digits cannot be repeated using this command.  For example,  if
    	      this  command occurs twice, followed immediately by forward-char, move forward six‐
    	      teen spaces; if instead it is followed by -2, then forward-char, move backward  two
    	      spaces.
    
    	      Inside a widget function, if passed an argument, i.e. `zle universal-argument num',
    	      the numeric argument will be set to num; this is equivalent to `NUMERIC=num'.
    
           argument-base
    	      Use the existing numeric argument as a numeric base, which must be in the  range	2
    	      to  36  inclusive.   Subsequent  use  of digit-argument and universal-argument will
    	      input a new numeric argument in the given base.  The usual  hexadecimal  convention
    	      is  used:  the  letter  a  or  A	corresponds to 10, and so on.  Arguments in bases
    	      requiring digits from 10 upwards are more conveniently input  with  universal-argu‐
    	      ment, since ESC-a etc. are not usually bound to digit-argument.
    
    	      The function can be used with a command argument inside a user-defined widget.  The
    	      following code sets the base to 16 and lets the user input a  hexadecimal  argument
    	      until a key out of the digit range is typed:
    
    		     zle argument-base 16
    		     zle universal-argument
    
       Completion
           accept-and-menu-complete
    	      In a menu completion, insert the current completion into the buffer, and advance to
    	      the next possible completion.
    
           complete-word
    	      Attempt completion on the current word.
    
           delete-char-or-list (^D) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Delete the character under the cursor.  If the cursor is at the end  of  the  line,
    	      list possible completions for the current word.
    
           expand-cmd-path
    	      Expand the current command to its full pathname.
    
           expand-or-complete (TAB) (unbound) (TAB)
    	      Attempt shell expansion on the current word.  If that fails, attempt completion.
    
           expand-or-complete-prefix
    	      Attempt shell expansion on the current word up to cursor.
    
           expand-history (ESC-space ESC-!) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Perform history expansion on the edit buffer.
    
           expand-word (^X*) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Attempt shell expansion on the current word.
    
           list-choices (ESC-^D) (^D =) (^D)
    	      List possible completions for the current word.
    
           list-expand (^Xg ^XG) (^G) (^G)
    	      List the expansion of the current word.
    
           magic-space
    	      Perform  history expansion and insert a space into the buffer.  This is intended to
    	      be bound to space.
    
           menu-complete
    	      Like complete-word, except that menu completion is  used.   See  the  MENU_COMPLETE
    	      option.
    
           menu-expand-or-complete
    	      Like expand-or-complete, except that menu completion is used.
    
           reverse-menu-complete
    	      Perform  menu  completion,  like menu-complete, except that if a menu completion is
    	      already in progress, move to the previous completion rather than the next.
    
           end-of-list
    	      When a previous completion displayed a list below the prompt, this  widget  can  be
    	      used to move the prompt below the list.
    
       Miscellaneous
           accept-and-hold (ESC-A ESC-a) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Push the contents of the buffer on the buffer stack and execute it.
    
           accept-and-infer-next-history
    	      Execute the contents of the buffer.  Then search the history list for a line match‐
    	      ing the current one and push the event following onto the buffer stack.
    
           accept-line (^J ^M) (^J ^M) (^J ^M)
    	      Finish editing the buffer.  Normally this causes the buffer to  be  executed  as	a
    	      shell command.
    
           accept-line-and-down-history (^O) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Execute the current line, and push the next history event on the buffer stack.
    
           auto-suffix-remove
    	      If  the previous action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to the word on the com‐
    	      mand line, remove it.  Otherwise do nothing.  Removing the suffix ends  any  active
    	      menu completion or menu selection.
    
    	      This widget is intended to be called from user-defined widgets to enforce a desired
    	      suffix-removal behavior.
    
           auto-suffix-retain
    	      If the previous action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to the word on the  com‐
    	      mand  line,  force it to be preserved.  Otherwise do nothing.  Retaining the suffix
    	      ends any active menu completion or menu selection.
    
    	      This widget is intended to be called from user-defined widgets to enforce a desired
    	      suffix-preservation behavior.
    
           beep   Beep, unless the BEEP option is unset.
    
           bracketed-paste
    	      This  widget  is	invoked  when  text is pasted to the terminal emulator. It is not
    	      intended to be bound to actual keys but instead to the special  sequence	generated
    	      by  the  terminal  emulator  when  text is pasted.  If a numeric argument is given,
    	      shell quoting will be applied to the pasted text before it is inserted. When called
    	      from  a  widget  function,  an argument can be given to specify a variable to which
    	      pasted text is assigned.
    
    	      See also the zle_bracketed_paste parameter.
    
           vi-cmd-mode (^X^V) (unbound) (^[)
    	      Enter command mode; that is, select the `vicmd' keymap.	Yes,  this  is	bound  by
    	      default in emacs mode.
    
           vi-caps-lock-panic
    	      Hang  until  any lowercase key is pressed.  This is for vi users without the mental
    	      capacity to keep track of their caps lock key (like the author).
    
           clear-screen (^L ESC-^L) (^L) (^L)
    	      Clear the screen and redraw the prompt.
    
           deactivate-region
    	      Make the current region inactive. This disables vim-style visual selection mode  if
    	      it is active.
    
           describe-key-briefly
    	      Reads a key sequence, then prints the function bound to that sequence.
    
           exchange-point-and-mark (^X^X) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Exchange the cursor position (point) with the position of the mark.  Unless a nega‐
    	      tive numeric argument is given, the region between point and mark is  activated  so
    	      that  it	can  be  highlighted.  If a zero numeric argument is given, the region is
    	      activated but point and mark are not swapped.
    
           execute-named-cmd (ESC-x) (:) (unbound)
    	      Read the name of an editor command and execute it.  A  restricted  set  of  editing
    	      functions  is available in the mini-buffer.  Keys are looked up in the special com‐
    	      mand keymap, and if not found there in the main keymap.  An  interrupt  signal,  as
    	      defined  by  the	stty  setting,	will abort the function.  Note that the following
    	      always perform the same task within the executed-named-cmd environment  and  cannot
    	      be replaced by user defined widgets, nor can the set of functions be extended.  The
    	      allowed functions are: backward-delete-char, vi-backward-delete-char, clear-screen,
    	      redisplay,    quoted-insert,    vi-quoted-insert,    backward-kill-word,	 vi-back‐
    	      ward-kill-word, kill-whole-line,	vi-kill-line,  backward-kill-line,  list-choices,
    	      delete-char-or-list,    complete-word,	accept-line,	expand-or-complete    and
    	      expand-or-complete-prefix.
    
    	      kill-region  kills  the  last  word,  and  vi-cmd-mode  is  treated  the	same   as
    	      accept-line.  The space and tab characters, if not bound to one of these functions,
    	      will complete the name and then list the possibilities if the AUTO_LIST  option  is
    	      set.   Any  other  character that is not bound to self-insert or self-insert-unmeta
    	      will beep and be ignored.  The bindings of the current insert mode will be used.
    
    	      Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.
    
           execute-last-named-cmd (ESC-z) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Redo the last function executed with execute-named-cmd.
    
    	      Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.
    
           get-line (ESC-G ESC-g) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Pop the top line off the buffer stack and insert it at the cursor position.
    
           pound-insert (unbound) (#) (unbound)
    	      If there is no # character at the beginning of the buffer, add one to the beginning
    	      of  each line.  If there is one, remove a # from each line that has one.	In either
    	      case, accept the current line.  The INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option  must  be  set  for
    	      this to have any usefulness.
    
           vi-pound-insert
    	      If there is no # character at the beginning of the current line, add one.  If there
    	      is one, remove it.  The INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option must be set for  this  to  have
    	      any usefulness.
    
           push-input
    	      Push the entire current multiline construct onto the buffer stack and return to the
    	      top-level (PS1) prompt.  If the current parser construct is  only  a  single  line,
    	      this  is	exactly like push-line.  Next time the editor starts up or is popped with
    	      get-line, the construct will be popped off the top of the buffer stack  and  loaded
    	      into the editing buffer.
    
           push-line (^Q ESC-Q ESC-q) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Push  the current buffer onto the buffer stack and clear the buffer.  Next time the
    	      editor starts up, the buffer will be popped off the top of  the  buffer  stack  and
    	      loaded into the editing buffer.
    
           push-line-or-edit
    	      At  the  top-level  (PS1)  prompt,  equivalent  to push-line.  At a secondary (PS2)
    	      prompt, move the entire current multiline construct into the  editor  buffer.   The
    	      latter is equivalent to push-input followed by get-line.
    
           read-command
    	      Only  useful  from  a  user-defined  widget.  A keystroke is read just as in normal
    	      operation, but instead of the command being executed the name of the  command  that
    	      would  be executed is stored in the shell parameter REPLY.  This can be used as the
    	      argument of a future zle command.  If the key sequence is not bound,  status  1  is
    	      returned;  typically,  however, REPLY is set to undefined-key to indicate a useless
    	      key sequence.
    
           recursive-edit
    	      Only useful from a user-defined widget.  At this point in the function, the  editor
    	      regains control until one of the standard widgets which would normally cause zle to
    	      exit (typically an accept-line caused by	hitting  the  return  key)  is	executed.
    	      Instead,	control  returns  to  the  user-defined  widget.   The status returned is
    	      non-zero if the return was caused by an error, but  the  function  still	continues
    	      executing and hence may tidy up.	This makes it safe for the user-defined widget to
    	      alter the command line or key bindings temporarily.
    
    	      The following widget, caps-lock, serves as an example.
    		     self-insert-ucase() {
    		       LBUFFER+=${(U)KEYS[-1]}
    		     }
    
    		     integer stat
    
    		     zle -N self-insert self-insert-ucase
    		     zle -A caps-lock save-caps-lock
    		     zle -A accept-line caps-lock
    
    		     zle recursive-edit
    		     stat=$?
    
    		     zle -A .self-insert self-insert
    		     zle -A save-caps-lock caps-lock
    		     zle -D save-caps-lock
    
    		     (( stat )) && zle send-break
    
    		     return $stat
    	      This causes typed letters to be inserted capitalised until either accept-line (i.e.
    	      typically  the  return  key) is typed or the caps-lock widget is invoked again; the
    	      later is handled by saving the old definition of caps-lock  as  save-caps-lock  and
    	      then  rebinding  it  to  invoke accept-line.  Note that an error from the recursive
    	      edit is detected as a non-zero return status and propagated by using the send-break
    	      widget.
    
           redisplay (unbound) (^R) (^R)
    	      Redisplays the edit buffer.
    
           reset-prompt (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Force  the prompts on both the left and right of the screen to be re-expanded, then
    	      redisplay the edit buffer.  This reflects changes  both  to  the	prompt	variables
    	      themselves and changes in the expansion of the values (for example, changes in time
    	      or directory, or changes to the value of variables referred to by the prompt).
    
    	      Otherwise, the prompt is only expanded each time zle starts, and when  the  display
    	      as been interrupted by output from another part of the shell (such as a job notifi‐
    	      cation) which causes the command line to be reprinted.
    
           send-break (^G ESC-^G) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Abort the current  editor  function,  e.g.  execute-named-command,  or  the  editor
    	      itself,  e.g. if you are in vared. Otherwise abort the parsing of the current line;
    	      in this case the aborted line is available in the shell variable	ZLE_LINE_ABORTED.
    	      If the editor is aborted from within vared, the variable ZLE_VARED_ABORTED is set.
    
           run-help (ESC-H ESC-h) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Push  the  buffer  onto  the  buffer stack, and execute the command `run-help cmd',
    	      where cmd is the current command.  run-help is normally aliased to man.
    
           vi-set-buffer (unbound) (") (unbound)
    	      Specify a buffer to be used in the following command.  There are	37  buffers  that
    	      can  be  specified: the 26 `named' buffers "a to "z, the `yank' buffer "0, the nine
    	      `queued' buffers "1 to "9 and the `black hole' buffer "_.  The  named  buffers  can
    	      also be specified as "A to "Z.
    
    	      When  a  buffer  is specified for a cut, change or yank command, the text concerned
    	      replaces the previous contents of the specified buffer. If a named buffer is speci‐
    	      fied using a capital, the newly cut text is appended to the buffer instead of over‐
    	      writing it. When using the "_ buffer, nothing  happens.  This  can  be  useful  for
    	      deleting text without affecting the normal registers.
    
    	      If no buffer is specified for a cut or change command, "1 is used, and the contents
    	      of "1 to "8 are each shifted along one buffer; the contents of "9 is  lost.  If  no
    	      buffer  is specified for a yank command, "0 is used. Finally, a paste command with‐
    	      out a specified buffer will paste the text from the most recent command  regardless
    	      of any buffer that might have been used with that command.
    
    	      When called from a widget function by the zle command, the buffer can optionally be
    	      specified with an argument. For example,
    
    		     zle vi-set-buffer A
    
           vi-set-mark (unbound) (m) (unbound)
    	      Set the specified mark at the cursor position.
    
           set-mark-command (^@) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Set the mark at the cursor position.  If called with a negative  numeric	argument,
    	      do  not  set the mark but deactivate the region so that it is no longer highlighted
    	      (it is still usable for other purposes).	Otherwise the region is marked as active.
    
           spell-word (ESC-$ ESC-S ESC-s) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Attempt spelling correction on the current word.
    
           split-undo
    	      Breaks the undo sequence at the current change.  This  is  useful  in  vi  mode  as
    	      changes  made  in  insert  mode are coalesced on entering command mode.  Similarly,
    	      undo will normally revert as one all the changes made by a user-defined widget.
    
           undefined-key
    	      This command is executed when a key sequence that is not bound to  any  command  is
    	      typed.  By default it beeps.
    
           undo (^_ ^Xu ^X^U) (u) (unbound)
    	      Incrementally  undo  the	last  text modification.  When called from a user-defined
    	      widget, takes an optional argument indicating a previous state of the undo  history
    	      as  returned  by	the  UNDO_CHANGE_NO variable; modifications are undone until that
    	      state is reached, subject to any limit imposed by the UNDO_LIMIT_NO variable.
    
    	      Note that when invoked from vi command mode, the full prior change made  in  insert
    	      mode is reverted, the changes having been merged when command mode was selected.
    
           redo (unbound) (^R) (unbound)
    	      Incrementally redo undone text modifications.
    
           vi-undo-change (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Undo the last text modification.	If repeated, redo the modification.
    
           visual-mode (unbound) (v) (unbound)
    	      Toggle  vim-style  visual  selection  mode.  If  line-wise visual mode is currently
    	      enabled then it is changed to being character-wise. If used following an	operator,
    	      it  forces  the subsequent movement command to be treated as a character-wise move‐
    	      ment.
    
           visual-line-mode (unbound) (V) (unbound)
    	      Toggle vim-style line-wise visual selection mode. If character-wise visual mode  is
    	      currently enabled then it is changed to being line-wise. If used following an oper‐
    	      ator, it forces the subsequent movement command to be treated as a line-wise  move‐
    	      ment.
    
           what-cursor-position (^X=) (ga) (unbound)
    	      Print the character under the cursor, its code as an octal, decimal and hexadecimal
    	      number, the current cursor position within the buffer and the column of the  cursor
    	      in the current line.
    
           where-is
    	      Read  the  name  of  an  editor command and print the listing of key sequences that
    	      invoke the specified command.  A restricted set of editing functions  is	available
    	      in  the  mini-buffer.  Keys are looked up in the special command keymap, and if not
    	      found there in the main keymap.
    
           which-command (ESC-?) (unbound) (unbound)
    	      Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the command `which-command cmd'.
    	      where cmd is the current command.  which-command is normally aliased to whence.
    
           vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line (unbound) (0) (unbound)
    	      If the last command executed was a digit as part of an argument, continue the argu‐
    	      ment.  Otherwise, execute vi-beginning-of-line.
    
       Text Objects
           Text objects are commands that can be used to select a block of	text  according  to  some
           criteria.  They are a feature of the vim text editor and so are primarily intended for use
           with vi operators or from visual selection mode. However,  they	can  also  be  used  from
           vi-insert or emacs mode. Key bindings listed below apply to the viopp and visual keymaps.
    
           select-a-blank-word (aW)
    	      Select  a  word  including  adjacent blanks, where a word is defined as a series of
    	      non-blank characters. With a numeric argument, multiple words will be selected.
    
           select-a-shell-word (aa)
    	      Select the current command argument applying the normal rules for quoting.
    
           select-a-word (aw)
    	      Select a word including adjacent blanks, using the normal vi-style word definition.
    	      With a numeric argument, multiple words will be selected.
    
           select-in-blank-word (iW)
    	      Select  a word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters. With a
    	      numeric argument, multiple words will be selected.
    
           select-in-shell-word (ia)
    	      Select the current command argument applying the normal rules for quoting.  If  the
    	      argument	begins and ends with matching quote characters, these are not included in
    	      the selection.
    
           select-in-word (iw)
    	      Select a word, using the normal vi-style word definition. With a numeric	argument,
    	      multiple words will be selected.
    
    CHARACTER HIGHLIGHTING
           The line editor has the ability to highlight characters or regions of the line that have a
           particular significance.  This is controlled by the array parameter zle_highlight,  if  it
           has been set by the user.
    
           If  the parameter contains the single entry none all highlighting is turned off.  Note the
           parameter is still expected to be an array.
    
           Otherwise each entry of the array should consist of a word indicating a context for  high‐
           lighting,  then a colon, then a comma-separated list of the types of highlighting to apply
           in that context.
    
           The contexts available for highlighting are the following:
    
           default
    	      Any text within the command line not affected by any other highlighting.	Text out‐
    	      side the editable area of the command line is not affected.
    
           isearch
    	      When  one of the incremental history search widgets is active, the area of the com‐
    	      mand line matched by the search string or pattern.
    
           region The region between the cursor (point) and the mark as  set  with	set-mark-command.
    	      The  region is only highlighted if it is active, which is the case if set-mark-com‐
    	      mand or exchange-point-and-mark has been called and the line has	not  been  subse‐
    	      quently modified.  The region can be deactivated by calling set-mark-command with a
    	      negative numeric argument, or reactivated by calling exchange-point-and-mark with a
    	      zero numeric argument.  Note that whether or not the region is active has no effect
    	      on its use within widgets, it simply determines whether it is highlighted.
    
           special
    	      Individual characters that have no direct printable representation but are shown in
    	      a special manner by the line editor.  These characters are described below.
    
           suffix This  context is used in completion for characters that are marked as suffixes that
    	      will be removed if the completion ends at that  point,  the  most  obvious  example
    	      being  a	slash  (/)  after  a directory name.  Note that suffix removal is config‐
    	      urable; the circumstances under which the suffix will be	removed  may  differ  for
    	      different completions.
    
           paste  Following a command to paste text, the characters that were inserted.
    
           When region_highlight is set, the contexts that describe a region -- isearch, region, suf‐
           fix, and paste -- are applied first, then region_highlight is applied, then the	remaining
           zle_highlight  contexts	are  applied.	If a particular character is affected by multiple
           specifications, the last specification wins.
    
           zle_highlight may contain additional fields for	controlling  how  terminal  sequences  to
           change  colours	are output.  Each of the following is followed by a colon and a string in
           the same form as for key bindings.  This will not be necessary for the  vast  majority  of
           terminals as the defaults shown in parentheses are widely used.
    
           fg_start_code (\e[3)
    	      The start of the escape sequence for the foreground colour.  This is followed by an
    	      ASCII digit representing the colour.
    
           fg_default_code (9)
    	      The number to use instead of the colour to reset the default foreground colour.
    
           fg_end_code (m)
    	      The end of the escape sequence for the foreground colour.
    
           bg_start_code (\e[4)
    	      The start of the escape sequence for the background colour.  This is followed by an
    	      ASCII digit representing the colour.
    
           bg_default_code (9)
    	      The number to use instead of the colour to reset the default background colour.
    
           bg_end_code (m)
    	      The end of the escape sequence for the background colour.
    
           The  available  types of highlighting are the following.  Note that not all types of high‐
           lighting are available on all terminals:
    
           none   No highlighting is applied to the given context.	It is  not  useful  for  this  to
    	      appear with other types of highlighting; it is used to override a default.
    
           fg=colour
    	      The foreground colour should be set to colour, a decimal integer or the name of one
    	      of the eight most widely-supported colours.
    
    	      Not all terminals support this and, of those that do, not all provide facilities to
    	      test  the  support,  hence the user should decide based on the terminal type.  Most
    	      terminals support the colours black, red, green, yellow, blue,  magenta,	cyan  and
    	      white,  which can be set by name.  In addition. default may be used to set the ter‐
    	      minal's default foreground colour.  Abbreviations are  allowed;  b  or  bl  selects
    	      black.   Some  terminals	may  generate additional colours if the bold attribute is
    	      also present.
    
    	      On recent terminals and on systems with an up-to-date terminal database the  number
    	      of colours supported may be tested by the command `echotc Co'; if this succeeds, it
    	      indicates a limit on the number of colours which will be enforced by the line  edi‐
    	      tor.   The  number  of  colours  is in any case limited to 256 (i.e. the range 0 to
    	      255).
    
    	      Colour is also known as color.
    
           bg=colour
    	      The background colour should be set to colour.  This works similarly to  the  fore‐
    	      ground colour, except the background is not usually affected by the bold attribute.
    
           bold   The  characters  in  the given context are shown in a bold font.	Not all terminals
    	      distinguish bold fonts.
    
           standout
    	      The characters in the given context are shown in the terminal's standout mode.  The
    	      actual  effect  is specific to the terminal; on many terminals it is inverse video.
    	      On some such terminals, where the cursor does not blink it  appears  with  standout
    	      mode negated, making it less than clear where the cursor actually is.  On such ter‐
    	      minals one of the other effects may be preferable for highlighting the  region  and
    	      matched search string.
    
           underline
    	      The  characters in the given context are shown underlined.  Some terminals show the
    	      foreground in a different colour instead; in this case whitespace will not be high‐
    	      lighted.
    
           The characters described above as `special' are as follows.  The formatting described here
           is used irrespective of whether the characters are highlighted:
    
           ASCII control characters
    	      Control characters in the ASCII range are shown as `^' followed by the base charac‐
    	      ter.
    
           Unprintable multibyte characters
    	      This  item applies to control characters not in the ASCII range, plus other charac‐
    	      ters as follows.	If the MULTIBYTE option is in effect, multibyte characters not in
    	      the  ASCII character set that are reported as having zero width are treated as com‐
    	      bining characters when the option COMBINING_CHARS is on.	If the option is off,  or
    	      if  a  character appears where a combining character is not valid, the character is
    	      treated as unprintable.
    
    	      Unprintable multibyte characters are shown as a hexadecimal  number  between  angle
    	      brackets.  The number is the code point of the character in the wide character set;
    	      this may or may not be Unicode, depending on the operating system.
    
           Invalid multibyte characters
    	      If the MULTIBYTE option is in effect, any sequence of one or more bytes  that  does
    	      not  form  a valid character in the current character set is treated as a series of
    	      bytes each shown as a special character.	This case can be distinguished from other
    	      unprintable  characters  as  the	bytes  are  represented as two hexadecimal digits
    	      between angle brackets, as distinct from the four or eight digits that are used for
    	      unprintable characters that are nonetheless valid in the current character set.
    
    	      Not  all	systems support this: for it to work, the system's representation of wide
    	      characters must be code values from the Universal Character Set, as defined by  IS0
    	      10646 (also known as Unicode).
    
           Wrapped double-width characters
    	      When  a double-width character appears in the final column of a line, it is instead
    	      shown on the next line. The empty space left in  the  original  position	is  high‐
    	      lighted as a special character.
    
           If  zle_highlight  is  not  set	or no value applies to a particular context, the defaults
           applied are equivalent to
    
    	      zle_highlight=(region:standout special:standout
    	      suffix:bold isearch:underline)
    
           i.e. both the region and special characters are shown in standout mode.
    
           Within widgets, arbitrary regions may be highlighted by setting the special array  parame‐
           ter region_highlight; see above.
    
    ZSHCOMPWID(1)			     General Commands Manual			    ZSHCOMPWID(1)
    
    NAME
           zshcompwid - zsh completion widgets
    
    DESCRIPTION
           The  shell's  programmable  completion  mechanism can be manipulated in two ways; here the
           low-level features supporting the newer, function-based mechanism are defined.  A complete
           set  of	shell  functions based on these features is described in zshcompsys(1), and users
           with no interest in adding to that system (or, potentially, writing their own -- see  dic‐
           tionary	entry  for  `hubris') should skip the current section.	The older system based on
           the compctl builtin command is described in zshcompctl(1).
    
           Completion widgets are defined by the -C option to the zle builtin command provided by the
           zsh/zle module (see zshzle(1)). For example,
    
    	      zle -C complete expand-or-complete completer
    
           defines	a widget named `complete'.  The second argument is the name of any of the builtin
           widgets	that  handle  completions:  complete-word,   expand-or-complete,   expand-or-com‐
           plete-prefix, menu-complete, menu-expand-or-complete, reverse-menu-complete, list-choices,
           or delete-char-or-list.	Note that this will still work even if the widget in question has
           been re-bound.
    
           When this newly defined widget is bound to a key using the bindkey builtin command defined
           in the zsh/zle module (see zshzle(1)), typing that key will call the shell function  `com‐
           pleter'.  This  function  is  responsible  for  generating  the possible matches using the
           builtins described below.  As with other ZLE widgets, the  function  is	called	with  its
           standard input closed.
    
           Once  the  function  returns,  the completion code takes over control again and treats the
           matches in the same manner as the specified builtin widget, in  this  case  expand-or-com‐
           plete.
    
    COMPLETION SPECIAL PARAMETERS
           The  parameters ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS and ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS are used by the comple‐
           tion mechanism, but are not special. See Parameters Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).
    
           Inside completion widgets, and any functions called from them, some parameters  have  spe‐
           cial meaning; outside these functions they are not special to the shell in any way.  These
           parameters are used to pass information between the completion  code  and  the  completion
           widget.	Some  of  the  builtin commands and the condition codes use or change the current
           values of these parameters.  Any existing values will be hidden during execution  of  com‐
           pletion	widgets;  except  for  compstate,  the parameters are reset on each function exit
           (including nested function calls from within the completion widget) to the values they had
           when the function was entered.
    
           CURRENT
    	      This is the number of the current word, i.e. the word the cursor is currently on in
    	      the words array.	Note that this value is only correct if the ksharrays  option  is
    	      not set.
    
           IPREFIX
    	      Initially this will be set to the empty string.  This parameter functions like PRE‐
    	      FIX; it contains a string which precedes the one in PREFIX and  is  not  considered
    	      part of the list of matches.  Typically, a string is transferred from the beginning
    	      of PREFIX to the end of IPREFIX, for example:
    
    		     IPREFIX=${PREFIX%%\=*}=
    		     PREFIX=${PREFIX#*=}
    
    	      causes the part of the prefix up to and including the first equal sign  not  to  be
    	      treated as part of a matched string.  This can be done automatically by the compset
    	      builtin, see below.
    
           ISUFFIX
    	      As IPREFIX, but for a suffix that should not be considered  part	of  the  matches;
    	      note that the ISUFFIX string follows the SUFFIX string.
    
           PREFIX Initially  this  will  be set to the part of the current word from the beginning of
    	      the word up to the position of the cursor; it may be altered to give a common  pre‐
    	      fix for all matches.
    
           QIPREFIX
    	      This  parameter  is  read-only  and contains the quoted string up to the word being
    	      completed. E.g. when completing `"foo', this parameter contains the  double  quote.
    	      If  the -q option of compset is used (see below), and the original string was `"foo
    	      bar' with the cursor on the `bar', this parameter contains `"foo '.
    
           QISUFFIX
    	      Like QIPREFIX, but containing the suffix.
    
           SUFFIX Initially this will be set to the part of the current word from the cursor position
    	      to  the end; it may be altered to give a common suffix for all matches.  It is most
    	      useful when the option COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set, as otherwise the whole word on  the
    	      command line is treated as a prefix.
    
           compstate
    	      This  is an associative array with various keys and values that the completion code
    	      uses to exchange information with the completion widget.	The keys are:
    
    	      all_quotes
    		     The -q option of the compset builtin command (see	below)	allows	a  quoted
    		     string  to  be  broken into separate words; if the cursor is on one of those
    		     words, that word will be completed, possibly invoking  `compset  -q'  recur‐
    		     sively.   With  this  key it is possible to test the types of quoted strings
    		     which are currently broken into parts in this fashion.  Its  value  contains
    		     one  character for each quoting level.  The characters are a single quote or
    		     a double quote for strings quoted with these characters, a dollars sign  for
    		     strings  quoted  with $'...' and a backslash for strings not starting with a
    		     quote character.  The first character in the value always corresponds to the
    		     innermost quoting level.
    
    	      context
    		     This will be set by the completion code to the overall context in which com‐
    		     pletion is attempted. Possible values are:
    
    		     array_value
    			    when completing inside the value of an array parameter assignment; in
    			    this case the words array contains the words inside the parentheses.
    
    		     brace_parameter
    			    when  completing  the  name  of  a parameter in a parameter expansion
    			    beginning with ${.	This context will also	be  set  when  completing
    			    parameter flags following ${(; the full command line argument is pre‐
    			    sented and the handler must test the value to be completed to  ascer‐
    			    tain that this is the case.
    
    		     assign_parameter
    			    when completing the name of a parameter in a parameter assignment.
    
    		     command
    			    when  completing  for a normal command (either in command position or
    			    for an argument of the command).
    
    		     condition
    			    when completing inside a `[[...]]' conditional  expression;  in  this
    			    case  the  words array contains only the words inside the conditional
    			    expression.
    
    		     math   when completing in a mathematical environment  such  as  a	`((...))'
    			    construct.
    
    		     parameter
    			    when  completing  the  name  of  a parameter in a parameter expansion
    			    beginning with $ but not ${.
    
    		     redirect
    			    when completing after a redirection operator.
    
    		     subscript
    			    when completing inside a parameter subscript.
    
    		     value  when completing the value of a parameter assignment.
    
    	      exact  Controls the behaviour when the REC_EXACT option is set.  It will be set  to
    		     accept if an exact match would be accepted, and will be unset otherwise.
    
    		     If  it  was  set when at least one match equal to the string on the line was
    		     generated, the match is accepted.
    
    	      exact_string
    		     The string of an exact match if one was found, otherwise unset.
    
    	      ignored
    		     The number of words that were ignored because they matched one of	the  pat‐
    		     terns given with the -F option to the compadd builtin command.
    
    	      insert This controls the manner in which a match is inserted into the command line.
    		     On entry to the widget function, if it is unset the command line is  not  to
    		     be changed; if set to unambiguous, any prefix common to all matches is to be
    		     inserted; if set  to  automenu-unambiguous,  the  common  prefix  is  to  be
    		     inserted  and the next invocation of the completion code may start menu com‐
    		     pletion (due to the AUTO_MENU option being set); if set to menu or  automenu
    		     menu  completion will be started for the matches currently generated (in the
    		     latter case this will happen because the AUTO_MENU is set).  The  value  may
    		     also  contain  the  string `tab' when the completion code would normally not
    		     really do completion, but only insert the TAB character.
    
    		     On exit it may be set to any of the values above (where setting  it  to  the
    		     empty string is the same as unsetting it), or to a number, in which case the
    		     match whose number is given will be inserted into the command  line.   Nega‐
    		     tive  numbers  count  backward  from the last match (with `-1' selecting the
    		     last match) and out-of-range values are wrapped around, so that a	value  of
    		     zero  selects  the  last match and a value one more than the maximum selects
    		     the first. Unless the value of this key  ends  in	a  space,  the	match  is
    		     inserted  as  in  a  menu completion, i.e. without automatically appending a
    		     space.
    
    		     Both menu and automenu may also specify the number of the match  to  insert,
    		     given  after  a colon.  For example, `menu:2' says to start menu completion,
    		     beginning with the second match.
    
    		     Note that a value containing the substring `tab' makes the matches generated
    		     be ignored and only the TAB be inserted.
    
    		     Finally,  it  may	also  be set to all, which makes all matches generated be
    		     inserted into the line.
    
    	      insert_positions
    		     When the completion system inserts an  unambiguous  string  into  the  line,
    		     there may be multiple places where characters are missing or where the char‐
    		     acter inserted differs from at least one match.  The value of this key  con‐
    		     tains  a  colon  separated  list of all these positions, as indexes into the
    		     command line.
    
    	      last_prompt
    		     If this is set to a non-empty string for every match added,  the  completion
    		     code will move the cursor back to the previous prompt after the list of com‐
    		     pletions has been displayed.  Initially this is set or  unset  according  to
    		     the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.
    
    	      list   This  controls  whether or how the list of matches will be displayed.  If it
    		     is unset or empty they will never be listed; if its value begins with  list,
    		     they  will  always  be listed; if it begins with autolist or ambiguous, they
    		     will be listed when the AUTO_LIST	or  LIST_AMBIGUOUS  options  respectively
    		     would normally cause them to be.
    
    		     If  the  substring  force appears in the value, this makes the list be shown
    		     even if there is only one match. Normally, the list would be shown  only  if
    		     there are at least two matches.
    
    		     The value contains the substring packed if the LIST_PACKED option is set. If
    		     this substring is given for all matches added to a group,	this  group  will
    		     show  the	LIST_PACKED  behavior.	The  same is done for the LIST_ROWS_FIRST
    		     option with the substring rows.
    
    		     Finally, if the value contains the string explanations, only the explanation
    		     strings,  if  any, will be listed and if it contains messages, only the mes‐
    		     sages (added with the -x option of compadd) will be listed.  If it  contains
    		     both  explanations  and  messages	both kinds of explanation strings will be
    		     listed.  It will be set appropriately on entry to a  completion  widget  and
    		     may be changed there.
    
    	      list_lines
    		     This  gives  the number of lines that are needed to display the full list of
    		     completions.  Note that to calculate the total number of  lines  to  display
    		     you  need	to  add  the  number of lines needed for the command line to this
    		     value, this is available as the value of the BUFFERLINES special parameter.
    
    	      list_max
    		     Initially this is set to the value of the LISTMAX parameter.  It may be  set
    		     to  any  other  value;  when the widget exits this value will be used in the
    		     same way as the value of LISTMAX.
    
    	      nmatches
    		     The number of matches generated and accepted by the completion code so far.
    
    	      old_insert
    		     On entry to the widget this will be set to the number of the match of an old
    		     list  of completions that is currently inserted into the command line. If no
    		     match has been inserted, this is unset.
    
    		     As with old_list, the value of this key will only	be  used  if  it  is  the
    		     string  keep. If it was set to this value by the widget and there was an old
    		     match inserted into the command line, this match will be  kept  and  if  the
    		     value  of	the  insert  key specifies that another match should be inserted,
    		     this will be inserted after the old one.
    
    	      old_list
    		     This is set to yes if there is still a valid list of completions from a pre‐
    		     vious  completion	at  the time the widget is invoked.  This will usually be
    		     the case if and only if the previous editing operation was a completion wid‐
    		     get  or  one  of the builtin completion functions.  If there is a valid list
    		     and it is also currently shown on the screen,  the  value	of  this  key  is
    		     shown.
    
    		     After the widget has exited the value of this key is only used if it was set
    		     to keep.  In this case the completion code will continue  to  use	this  old
    		     list.  If the widget generated new matches, they will not be used.
    
    	      parameter
    		     The  name of the parameter when completing in a subscript or in the value of
    		     a parameter assignment.
    
    	      pattern_insert
    		     Normally this is set to menu, which specifies that menu completion  will  be
    		     used  whenever a set of matches was generated using pattern matching.  If it
    		     is set to any other non-empty string by the user and menu completion is  not
    		     selected  by  other option settings, the code will instead insert any common
    		     prefix for the generated matches as with normal completion.
    
    	      pattern_match
    		     Locally controls the behaviour given by the GLOB_COMPLETE option.	Initially
    		     it  is  set  to `*' if and only if the option is set.  The completion widget
    		     may set it to this value, to an empty string (which has the same  effect  as
    		     unsetting	it),  or  to  any  other  non-empty  string.  If it is non-empty,
    		     unquoted metacharacters on the command line will be treated as patterns;  if
    		     it  is  `*', then additionally a wildcard `*' is assumed at the cursor posi‐
    		     tion; if it is empty or unset, metacharacters will be treated literally.
    
    		     Note that the matcher specifications given to the	compadd  builtin  command
    		     are not used if this is set to a non-empty string.
    
    	      quote  When  completing  inside quotes, this contains the quotation character (i.e.
    		     either a single quote, a double quote, or	a  backtick).	Otherwise  it  is
    		     unset.
    
    	      quoting
    		     When  completing  inside  single  quotes,	this is set to the string single;
    		     inside double quotes, the string double; inside backticks, the string  back‐
    		     tick.  Otherwise it is unset.
    
    	      redirect
    		     The redirection operator when completing in a redirection position, i.e. one
    		     of <, >, etc.
    
    	      restore
    		     This is set to auto before a function is entered, which forces  the  special
    		     parameters  mentioned  above  (words,  CURRENT, PREFIX, IPREFIX, SUFFIX, and
    		     ISUFFIX) to be restored to their previous values when  the  function  exits.
    		     If  a  function  unsets  it or sets it to any other string, they will not be
    		     restored.
    
    	      to_end Specifies the occasions on which the cursor is moved to the end of a  string
    		     when  a  match is inserted.  On entry to a widget function, it may be single
    		     if this will happen when a single unambiguous match was inserted or match if
    		     it  will  happen  any time a match is inserted (for example, by menu comple‐
    		     tion; this is likely to be the effect of the ALWAYS_TO_END option).
    
    		     On exit, it may be set to single as above.  It may also be set to always, or
    		     to the empty string or unset; in those cases the cursor will be moved to the
    		     end of the string always or never respectively.  Any other string is treated
    		     as match.
    
    	      unambiguous
    		     This  key	is  read-only  and will always be set to the common (unambiguous)
    		     prefix the completion code has generated for all matches added so far.
    
    	      unambiguous_cursor
    		     This gives the position the cursor would be placed at if the  common  prefix
    		     in the unambiguous key were inserted, relative to the value of that key. The
    		     cursor would be placed before the character whose index  is  given  by  this
    		     key.
    
    	      unambiguous_positions
    		     This  contains  all positions where characters in the unambiguous string are
    		     missing or where the character inserted differs from at  least  one  of  the
    		     matches.	The  positions	are given as indexes into the string given by the
    		     value of the unambiguous key.
    
    	      vared  If completion is called while editing a line using the  vared  builtin,  the
    		     value  of	this key is set to the name of the parameter given as an argument
    		     to vared.	This key is only set while a vared command is active.
    
           words  This array contains the words present on the command line currently being edited.
    
    COMPLETION BUILTIN COMMANDS
           compadd [ -akqQfenUlo12C ] [ -F array ]
    	       [-P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
    	       [-p hidden-prefix ] [ -s hidden-suffix ]
    	       [-i ignored-prefix ] [ -I ignored-suffix ]
    	       [-W file-prefix ] [ -d array ]
    	       [-J name ] [ -V name ] [ -X explanation ] [ -x message ]
    	       [-r remove-chars ] [ -R remove-func ]
    	       [-D array ] [ -O array ] [ -A array ]
    	       [-E number ]
    	       [-M match-spec ] [ -- ] [ words ... ]
    
    	      This builtin command can be used to add matches directly and control all the infor‐
    	      mation  the  completion  code stores with each possible match. The return status is
    	      zero if at least one match was added and non-zero if no matches were added.
    
    	      The completion code breaks the string to complete into seven fields in the order:
    
    		     <ipre><apre><hpre><word><hsuf><asuf><isuf>
    
    	      The first field is an ignored prefix taken from the command line, the  contents  of
    	      the IPREFIX parameter plus the string given with the -i option. With the -U option,
    	      only the string from the -i option is used. The field <apre> is an optional  prefix
    	      string  given  with the -P option.  The <hpre> field is a string that is considered
    	      part of the match but that should not be shown when listing completions, given with
    	      the  -p  option; for example, functions that do filename generation might specify a
    	      common path prefix this way.  <word> is the part of the match that should appear in
    	      the list of completions, i.e. one of the words given at the end of the compadd com‐
    	      mand line. The suffixes <hsuf>,  <asuf>  and  <isuf>  correspond	to  the  prefixes
    	      <hpre>, <apre> and <ipre> and are given by the options -s, -S and -I, respectively.
    
    	      The supported flags are:
    
    	      -P prefix
    		     This gives a string to be inserted before the given words.  The string given
    		     is not considered as part of the match and any shell  metacharacters  in  it
    		     will not be quoted when the string is inserted.
    
    	      -S suffix
    		     Like -P, but gives a string to be inserted after the match.
    
    	      -p hidden-prefix
    		     This gives a string that should be inserted into the command line before the
    		     match but that should not appear in the  list  of	matches.  Unless  the  -U
    		     option  is  given,  this string must be matched as part of the string on the
    		     command line.
    
    	      -s hidden-suffix
    		     Like `-p', but gives a string to insert after the match.
    
    	      -i ignored-prefix
    		     This gives a string to insert into the command line just before  any  string
    		     given  with the `-P' option.  Without `-P' the string is inserted before the
    		     string given with `-p' or directly before the match.
    
    	      -I ignored-suffix
    		     Like -i, but gives an ignored suffix.
    
    	      -a     With this flag the words are taken as  names  of  arrays  and  the  possible
    		     matches  are  their values.  If only some elements of the arrays are needed,
    		     the words may also contain subscripts, as in `foo[2,-1]'.
    
    	      -k     With this flag the words are taken as names of associative  arrays  and  the
    		     possible matches are their keys.  As for -a, the words may also contain sub‐
    		     scripts, as in `foo[(R)*bar*]'.
    
    	      -d array
    		     This adds per-match display strings. The array should  contain  one  element
    		     per  word	given.	The  completion  code will then display the first element
    		     instead of the first word, and so on. The array may be given as the name  of
    		     an  array parameter or directly as a space-separated list of words in paren‐
    		     theses.
    
    		     If there are fewer display strings than words, the leftover  words  will  be
    		     displayed	unchanged  and	if there are more display strings than words, the
    		     leftover display strings will be silently ignored.
    
    	      -l     This option only has an effect if used together with the -d option. If it is
    		     given, the display strings are listed one per line, not arrayed in columns.
    
    	      -o     This  option  only has an effect if used together with the -d option.  If it
    		     is given, the order of the output is determined by the match strings;   oth‐
    		     erwise  it  is  determined by the display strings (i.e. the strings given by
    		     the -d option).
    
    	      -J name
    		     Gives the name of the group of matches the words should be stored in.
    
    	      -V name
    		     Like -J but naming an unsorted group. These are in a  different  name  space
    		     than groups created with the -J flag.
    
    	      -1     If  given	together with the -V option, makes only consecutive duplicates in
    		     the group be removed. If combined with the -J option, this  has  no  visible
    		     effect.  Note  that  groups with and without this flag are in different name
    		     spaces.
    
    	      -2     If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all  duplicates	be  kept.
    		     Again, groups with and without this flag are in different name spaces.
    
    	      -X explanation
    		     The  explanation  string will be printed with the list of matches, above the
    		     group currently selected.
    
    	      -x message
    		     Like -X, but the message will be printed even if there are no matches in the
    		     group.
    
    	      -q     The suffix given with -S will be automatically removed if the next character
    		     typed is a blank or does not insert anything, or if the suffix  consists  of
    		     only one character and the next character typed is the same character.
    
    	      -r remove-chars
    		     This is a more versatile form of the -q option.  The suffix given with -S or
    		     the slash automatically added after completing directories will be automati‐
    		     cally  removed  if  the  next  character typed inserts one of the characters
    		     given in the remove-chars.  This string is parsed as a characters class  and
    		     understands the backslash sequences used by the print command.  For example,
    		     `-r "a-z\t"' removes the suffix if the next character typed inserts a  lower
    		     case  character  or  a  TAB,  and `-r "^0-9"' removes the suffix if the next
    		     character typed inserts anything but a digit. One extra  backslash  sequence
    		     is  understood  in  this  string: `\-' stands for all characters that insert
    		     nothing. Thus `-S "=" -q' is the same as `-S "=" -r "= \t\n\-"'.
    
    		     This option may also be used without the -S option; then  any  automatically
    		     added space will be removed when one of the characters in the list is typed.
    
    	      -R remove-func
    		     This  is  another form of the -r option. When a suffix has been inserted and
    		     the completion accepted, the function remove-func will be called  after  the
    		     next  character typed.  It is passed the length of the suffix as an argument
    		     and can use the special parameters available  in  ordinary  (non-completion)
    		     zle widgets (see zshzle(1)) to analyse and modify the command line.
    
    	      -f     If  this  flag  is  given, all of the matches built from words are marked as
    		     being the names of files.	They are not required to be actual filenames, but
    		     if they are, and the option LIST_TYPES is set, the characters describing the
    		     types of the files in the completion lists will be shown. This also forces a
    		     slash to be added when the name of a directory is completed.
    
    	      -e     This flag can be used to tell the completion code that the matches added are
    		     parameter	names  for  a	parameter   expansion.	 This	will   make   the
    		     AUTO_PARAM_SLASH and AUTO_PARAM_KEYS options be used for the matches.
    
    	      -W file-prefix
    		     This  string  is  a  pathname  that will be prepended to each of the matches
    		     formed by the given words together with  any  prefix  specified  by  the  -p
    		     option  to form a complete filename for testing.  Hence it is only useful if
    		     combined with the -f flag, as the tests will not otherwise be performed.
    
    	      -F array
    		     Specifies an array containing patterns. Words matching one of these patterns
    		     are ignored, i.e. not considered to be possible matches.
    
    		     The  array  may  be the name of an array parameter or a list of literal pat‐
    		     terns enclosed in parentheses and quoted, as in `-F "(*?.o *?.h)"'.  If  the
    		     name  of  an array is given, the elements of the array are taken as the pat‐
    		     terns.
    
    	      -Q     This flag instructs the completion code not to quote any  metacharacters  in
    		     the words when inserting them into the command line.
    
    	      -M match-spec
    		     This  gives  local  match	specifications	as described below in the section
    		     `Completion Matching Control'. This option may be given more than once.   In
    		     this case all match-specs given are concatenated with spaces between them to
    		     form the specification string to use.  Note that they will only be  used  if
    		     the -U option is not given.
    
    	      -n     Specifies	that  the words added are to be used as possible matches, but are
    		     not to appear in the completion listing.
    
    	      -U     If this flag is given, all words given will be accepted and no matching will
    		     be  done  by the completion code. Normally this is used in functions that do
    		     the matching themselves.
    
    	      -O array
    		     If this option is given, the words are not added to the set of possible com‐
    		     pletions.	 Instead, matching is done as usual and all of the words given as
    		     arguments that match the string on the command line will be  stored  in  the
    		     array parameter whose name is given as array.
    
    	      -A array
    		     As  the  -O  option,  except  that instead of those of the words which match
    		     being stored in array, the strings generated internally  by  the  completion
    		     code  are	stored.  For  example,	with  a  matching  specification  of  `-M
    		     "L:|no="', the string `nof' on the command line and the string `foo' as  one
    		     of  the  words,  this option stores the string `nofoo' in the array, whereas
    		     the -O option stores the `foo' originally given.
    
    	      -D array
    		     As with -O, the words are not added to  the  set  of  possible  completions.
    		     Instead, the completion code tests whether each word in turn matches what is
    		     on the line.  If the nth word does not match, the nth element of  the  array
    		     is  removed.   Elements  for  which  the  corresponding  word is matched are
    		     retained.
    
    	      -C     This option adds a special match which expands to	all  other  matches  when
    		     inserted into the line, even those that are added after this option is used.
    		     Together with the -d option it is possible to specify a string  that  should
    		     be  displayed in the list for this special match.	If no string is given, it
    		     will be shown as a string containing the strings that would be inserted  for
    		     the other matches, truncated to the width of the screen.
    
    	      -E number
    		     This  option  adds number empty matches after the words have been added.  An
    		     empty match takes up space in completion listings but will never be inserted
    		     in  the  line  and can't be selected with menu completion or menu selection.
    		     This makes empty matches only useful to format completion lists and to  make
    		     explanatory  string be shown in completion lists (since empty matches can be
    		     given display strings with the -d option).  And because all  but  one  empty
    		     string would otherwise be removed, this option implies the -V and -2 options
    		     (even if an explicit -J option is given).	This can be important to note  as
    		     it affects the name space into which matches are added.
    
    	      -
    	      --     This flag ends the list of flags and options. All arguments after it will be
    		     taken as the words to use as matches even if they begin with hyphens.
    
    	      Except for the -M flag, if any of these flags is given more than	once,  the  first
    	      one (and its argument) will be used.
    
           compset -p number
           compset -P [ number ] pattern
           compset -s number
           compset -S [ number ] pattern
           compset -n begin [ end ]
           compset -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
           compset -q
    	      This  command  simplifies  modification of the special parameters, while its return
    	      status allows tests on them to be carried out.
    
    	      The options are:
    
    	      -p number
    		     If the contents of the PREFIX parameter is longer	than  number  characters,
    		     the first number characters are removed from it and appended to the contents
    		     of the IPREFIX parameter.
    
    	      -P [ number ] pattern
    		     If the value of the PREFIX parameter begins with anything that  matches  the
    		     pattern, the matched portion is removed from PREFIX and appended to IPREFIX.
    
    		     Without  the  optional  number, the longest match is taken, but if number is
    		     given, anything up to the numberth match is moved.  If the number	is  nega‐
    		     tive,  the  numberth longest match is moved. For example, if PREFIX contains
    		     the string `a=b=c', then compset -P '*\=' will move the string  `a=b='  into
    		     the  IPREFIX  parameter,  but  compset  -P 1 '*\=' will move only the string
    		     `a='.
    
    	      -s number
    		     As -p, but transfer the last number characters from the value of  SUFFIX  to
    		     the front of the value of ISUFFIX.
    
    	      -S [ number ] pattern
    		     As -P, but match the last portion of SUFFIX and transfer the matched portion
    		     to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.
    
    	      -n begin [ end ]
    		     If the current word position  as  specified  by  the  parameter  CURRENT  is
    		     greater  than  or equal to begin, anything up to the beginth word is removed
    		     from the words array and the value of the parameter CURRENT  is  decremented
    		     by begin.
    
    		     If  the  optional end is given, the modification is done only if the current
    		     word position is also less than or equal to end. In  this	case,  the  words
    		     from position end onwards are also removed from the words array.
    
    		     Both  begin and end may be negative to count backwards from the last element
    		     of the words array.
    
    	      -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
    		     If one of the elements of the words array before the one at the index  given
    		     by  the value of the parameter CURRENT matches the pattern beg-pat, all ele‐
    		     ments up to and including the matching one are removed from the words  array
    		     and the value of CURRENT is changed to point to the same word in the changed
    		     array.
    
    		     If the optional pattern end-pat is also given, and there is  an  element  in
    		     the  words  array matching this pattern, the parameters are modified only if
    		     the index of this word is higher than the one given by the CURRENT parameter
    		     (so  that	the  matching word has to be after the cursor). In this case, the
    		     words starting with the one matching end-pat are also removed from the words
    		     array. If words contains no word matching end-pat, the testing and modifica‐
    		     tion is performed as if it were not given.
    
    	      -q     The word currently being completed is split on spaces into  separate  words,
    		     respecting  the  usual  shell  quoting conventions.  The resulting words are
    		     stored in the words array, and CURRENT, PREFIX, SUFFIX, QIPREFIX, and QISUF‐
    		     FIX are modified to reflect the word part that is completed.
    
    	      In  all  the  above  cases  the return status is zero if the test succeeded and the
    	      parameters were modified and non-zero  otherwise.  This  allows  one  to	use  this
    	      builtin in tests such as:
    
    		     if compset -P '*\='; then ...
    
    	      This  forces  anything up to and including the last equal sign to be ignored by the
    	      completion code.
    
           compcall [ -TD ]
    	      This allows the use of completions defined with the  compctl  builtin  from  within
    	      completion  widgets.   The  list	of  matches  will  be  generated as if one of the
    	      non-widget completion functions (complete-word, etc.)  had been called, except that
    	      only  compctls  given for specific commands are used. To force the code to try com‐
    	      pletions defined with the -T  option  of	compctl  and/or  the  default  completion
    	      (whether	defined  by compctl -D or the builtin default) in the appropriate places,
    	      the -T and/or -D flags can be passed to compcall.
    
    	      The return status can be used to test if a matching compctl definition  was  found.
    	      It is non-zero if a compctl was found and zero otherwise.
    
    	      Note that this builtin is defined by the zsh/compctl module.
    
    COMPLETION CONDITION CODES
           The following additional condition codes for use within the [[ ... ]] construct are avail‐
           able in completion widgets.  These work on the special parameters.  All of these tests can
           also  be performed by the compset builtin, but in the case of the condition codes the con‐
           tents of the special parameters are not modified.
    
           -prefix [ number ] pattern
    	      true if the test for the -P option of compset would succeed.
    
           -suffix [ number ] pattern
    	      true if the test for the -S option of compset would succeed.
    
           -after beg-pat
    	      true if the test of the -N option with only the beg-pat given would succeed.
    
           -between beg-pat end-pat
    	      true if the test for the -N option with both patterns would succeed.
    
    COMPLETION MATCHING CONTROL
           It is possible by use of the -M option of the compadd builtin command to specify  how  the
           characters  in  the string to be completed (referred to here as the command line) map onto
           the characters in the list of matches produced by the completion code (referred to here as
           the  trial  completions).  Note	that this is not used if the command line contains a glob
           pattern and the GLOB_COMPLETE option is set or the pattern_match of the compstate  special
           association is set to a non-empty string.
    
           The  match-spec	given as the argument to the -M option (see `Completion Builtin Commands'
           above) consists of one or  more	matching  descriptions	separated  by  whitespace.   Each
           description  consists  of  a  letter  followed by a colon and then the patterns describing
           which character sequences on the line match which character sequences in the trial comple‐
           tion.   Any  sequence  of  characters  not  handled in this fashion must match exactly, as
           usual.
    
           The forms of match-spec understood are as follows. In each case, the form  with	an  upper
           case  initial  character retains the string already typed on the command line as the final
           result of completion, while with a lower case initial character the string on the  command
           line is changed into the corresponding part of the trial completion.
    
           m:lpat=tpat
           M:lpat=tpat
    	      Here,  lpat  is  a  pattern that matches on the command line, corresponding to tpat
    	      which matches in the trial completion.
    
           l:lanchor|lpat=tpat
           L:lanchor|lpat=tpat
           l:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
           L:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
           b:lpat=tpat
           B:lpat=tpat
    	      These letters are for patterns that are anchored by another  pattern  on	the  left
    	      side. Matching for lpat and tpat is as for m and M, but the pattern lpat matched on
    	      the command line must be preceded by the pattern lanchor.  The lanchor can be blank
    	      to  anchor  the match to the start of the command line string; otherwise the anchor
    	      can occur anywhere, but must match in both the command line  and	trial  completion
    	      strings.
    
    	      If  no  lpat  is	given  but  a ranchor is, this matches the gap between substrings
    	      matched by lanchor and ranchor. Unlike lanchor, the ranchor only needs to match the
    	      trial completion string.
    
    	      The  b  and  B forms are similar to l and L with an empty anchor, but need to match
    	      only the beginning of the trial completion or the word on the command line, respec‐
    	      tively.
    
           r:lpat|ranchor=tpat
           R:lpat|ranchor=tpat
           r:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
           R:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
           e:lpat=tpat
           E:lpat=tpat
    	      As  l,  L,  b and B, with the difference that the command line and trial completion
    	      patterns are anchored on the right side.	Here an empty ranchor and  the	e  and	E
    	      forms force the match to the end of the trial completion or command line string.
    
           Each  lpat,  tpat or anchor is either an empty string or consists of a sequence of literal
           characters (which may be quoted with a backslash), question marks, character classes,  and
           correspondence  classes;  ordinary  shell patterns are not used.  Literal characters match
           only themselves, question marks match any character, and character classes are  formed  as
           for globbing and match any character in the given set.
    
           Correspondence  classes are defined like character classes, but with two differences: they
           are delimited by a pair of braces, and negated classes are not allowed, so the  characters
           !  and  ^  have no special meaning directly after the opening brace.  They indicate that a
           range of characters on the line match a range of characters in the trial  completion,  but
           (unlike	ordinary character classes) paired according to the corresponding position in the
           sequence.  For example, to make any ASCII lower case letter on the line match  the  corre‐
           sponding  upper case letter in the trial completion, you can use `m:{a-z}={A-Z}' (however,
           see below for the recommended form for this).  More than one pair of classes can occur, in
           which  case the first class before the = corresponds to the first after it, and so on.  If
           one side has more such classes than the other side, the superfluous  classes  behave  like
           normal character classes.  In anchor patterns correspondence classes also behave like nor‐
           mal character classes.
    
           The standard `[:name:]' forms described for standard shell patterns (see the section FILE‐
           NAME  GENERATION  in  zshexpn(1))  may  appear in correspondence classes as well as normal
           character classes.  The only special behaviour in correspondence classes is if the form on
           the  left  and the form on the right are each one of [:upper:], [:lower:].  In these cases
           the character in the word and the character on the line must be the same up to  a  differ‐
           ence  in case.  Hence to make any lower case character on the line match the corresponding
           upper case character in the trial  completion  you  can	use  `m:{[:lower:]}={[:upper:]}'.
           Although  the  matching system does not yet handle multibyte characters, this is likely to
           be a future extension, at which point this syntax will handle arbitrary	alphabets;  hence
           this  form,  rather  than  the  use of explicit ranges, is the recommended form.  In other
           cases `[:name:]' forms are allowed.  If the two forms on the left and right are the  same,
           the  characters	must  match  exactly.	In  remaining  cases, the corresponding tests are
           applied to both characters, but they are not otherwise constrained; any matching character
           in  one	set goes with any matching character in the other set:	this is equivalent to the
           behaviour of ordinary character classes.
    
           The pattern tpat may also be one or two stars, `*' or `**'. This means that the pattern on
           the  command line can match any number of characters in the trial completion. In this case
           the pattern must be anchored (on either side); in the case of a single  star,  the  anchor
           then  determines how much of the trial completion is to be included -- only the characters
           up to the next appearance of the anchor	will  be  matched.  With  two  stars,  substrings
           matched by the anchor can be matched, too.
    
           Examples:
    
           The  keys  of the options association defined by the parameter module are the option names
           in all-lower-case form, without underscores, and without the optional no at the	beginning
           even  though the builtins setopt and unsetopt understand option names with upper case let‐
           ters, underscores, and the optional no.	The following alters the matching rules  so  that
           the  prefix  no	and any underscore are ignored when trying to match the trial completions
           generated and upper case letters on the line match the corresponding lower case letters in
           the words:
    
    	      compadd -M 'L:|[nN][oO]= M:_= M:{[:upper:]}={[:lower:]}' - \
    		${(k)options}
    
           The  first part says that the pattern `[nN][oO]' at the beginning (the empty anchor before
           the pipe symbol) of the string on the line matches the empty string in the list	of  words
           generated  by  completion, so it will be ignored if present. The second part does the same
           for an underscore anywhere in the command line string, and the third part uses  correspon‐
           dence  classes  so  that any upper case letter on the line matches the corresponding lower
           case letter in the word. The use of the upper case forms of the	specification  characters
           (L  and	M) guarantees that what has already been typed on the command line (in particular
           the prefix no) will not be deleted.
    
           Note that the use of L in the first part means that it matches only when at the	beginning
           of  both  the command line string and the trial completion. I.e., the string `_NO_f' would
           not be completed to `_NO_foo', nor would `NONO_f' be completed to  `NONO_foo'  because  of
           the  leading  underscore  or the second `NO' on the line which makes the pattern fail even
           though they are otherwise ignored. To fix this, one would use `B:[nN][oO]=' instead of the
           first  part.  As  described  above, this matches at the beginning of the trial completion,
           independent of other characters or substrings at the beginning of the  command  line  word
           which are ignored by the same or other match-specs.
    
           The  second  example  makes  completion case insensitive.  This is just the same as in the
           option example, except here we wish to retain the characters in the list of completions:
    
    	      compadd -M 'm:{[:lower:]}={[:upper:]}' ...
    
           This makes lower case letters match their upper case counterparts.   To	make  upper  case
           letters match the lower case forms as well:
    
    	      compadd -M 'm:{[:lower:][:upper:]}={[:upper:][:lower:]}' ...
    
           A  nice	example for the use of * patterns is partial word completion. Sometimes you would
           like to make strings like `c.s.u' complete to strings like  `comp.source.unix',	i.e.  the
           word  on  the command line consists of multiple parts, separated by a dot in this example,
           where each part should be completed separately -- note, however, that the case where  each
           part  of  the  word,  i.e. `comp', `source' and `unix' in this example, is to be completed
           from separate sets of matches is a different problem to be solved by the implementation of
           the completion widget.  The example can be handled by:
    
    	      compadd -M 'r:|.=* r:|=*' \
    		- comp.sources.unix comp.sources.misc ...
    
           The first specification says that lpat is the empty string, while anchor is a dot; tpat is
           *, so this can match anything except for the `.' from the anchor in the	trial  completion
           word.   So in `c.s.u', the matcher sees `c', followed by the empty string, followed by the
           anchor `.', and likewise for the second dot, and replaces the  empty  strings  before  the
           anchors,  giving  `c[omp].s[ources].u[nix]', where the last part of the completion is just
           as normal.
    
           With  the  pattern  shown  above,  the  string	`c.u'	could	not   be   completed   to
           `comp.sources.unix'  because the single star means that no dot (matched by the anchor) can
           be skipped. By using two stars as in `r:|.=**',	however,  `c.u'  could	be  completed  to
           `comp.sources.unix'.  This  also  shows	that in some cases, especially if the anchor is a
           real pattern, like a character class, the form with two stars may result in  more  matches
           than one would like.
    
           The  second  specification is needed to make this work when the cursor is in the middle of
           the string on the command line and the option COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set. In  this	case  the
           completion  code would normally try to match trial completions that end with the string as
           typed so far, i.e. it will only insert new characters at the cursor position  rather  than
           at the end.  However in our example we would like the code to recognise matches which con‐
           tain extra characters after the string on the line (the `nix' in the example).	Hence  we
           say  that  the empty string at the end of the string on the line matches any characters at
           the end of the trial completion.
    
           More generally, the specification
    
    	      compadd -M 'r:|[.,_-]=* r:|=*' ...
    
           allows one to complete words with abbreviations before any of the characters in the square
           brackets.   For	example,  to complete veryverylongfile.c rather than veryverylongheader.h
           with the above in effect, you can just type very.c before attempting completion.
    
           The specifications with both a left and a right anchor  are  useful  to	complete  partial
           words whose parts are not separated by some special character. For example, in some places
           strings have to be completed that are formed  `LikeThis'  (i.e.	the  separate  parts  are
           determined  by  a  leading  upper  case	letter) or maybe one has to complete strings with
           trailing numbers. Here one could use the simple form with only one anchor as in:
    
    	      compadd -M 'r:|[[:upper:]0-9]=* r:|=*' LikeTHIS FooHoo 5foo123 5bar234
    
           But with this, the string `H' would neither complete to `FooHoo' nor to `LikeTHIS' because
           in  each  case  there  is  an  upper case letter before the `H' and that is matched by the
           anchor. Likewise, a `2' would not be completed. In both cases this  could  be  changed  by
           using `r:|[[:upper:]0-9]=**', but then `H' completes to both `LikeTHIS' and `FooHoo' and a
           `2' matches the other strings because characters can be inserted before every  upper  case
           letter and digit. To avoid this one would use:
    
    	      compadd -M 'r:[^[:upper:]0-9]||[[:upper:]0-9]=** r:|=*' \
    		  LikeTHIS FooHoo foo123 bar234
    
           By  using  these two anchors, a `H' matches only upper case `H's that are immediately pre‐
           ceded by something matching the left anchor `[^[:upper:]0-9]'. The effect is,  of  course,
           that `H' matches only the string `FooHoo', a `2' matches only `bar234' and so on.
    
           When  using  the  completion system (see zshcompsys(1)), users can define match specifica‐
           tions that are to be used for specific contexts by  using  the  matcher	and  matcher-list
           styles. The values for the latter will be used everywhere.
    
    COMPLETION WIDGET EXAMPLE
           The first step is to define the widget:
    
    	      zle -C complete complete-word complete-files
    
           Then the widget can be bound to a key using the bindkey builtin command:
    
    	      bindkey '^X\t' complete
    
           After  that  the  shell function complete-files will be invoked after typing control-X and
           TAB. The function should then generate the matches, e.g.:
    
    	      complete-files () { compadd - * }
    
           This function will complete files in the current directory matching the current word.
    
    ZSHCOMPSYS(1)			     General Commands Manual			    ZSHCOMPSYS(1)
    
    NAME
           zshcompsys - zsh completion system
    
    DESCRIPTION
           This describes the shell code for the `new' completion system, referred to as compsys.  It
           is written in shell functions based on the features described in zshcompwid(1).
    
           The  features are contextual, sensitive to the point at which completion is started.  Many
           completions are already provided.  For this reason, a user can perform a great many  tasks
           without	knowing any details beyond how to initialize the system, which is described below
           in INITIALIZATION.
    
           The context that decides what completion is to be performed may be
           ·      an argument or option position: these describe the position on the command line  at
    	      which  completion  is  requested.   For  example `first argument to rmdir, the word
    	      being completed names a directory';
    
           ·      a special context, denoting an element in the shell's syntax.  For example `a  word
    	      in command position' or `an array subscript'.
    
           A full context specification contains other elements, as we shall describe.
    
           Besides	commands  names  and  contexts,  the system employs two more concepts, styles and
           tags.  These provide ways for the user to configure the system's behaviour.
    
           Tags play a dual role.  They serve as a classification system for the  matches,	typically
           indicating  a  class  of  object that the user may need to distinguish.	For example, when
           completing arguments of the ls command the user may prefer to try  files  before  directo‐
           ries,  so  both of these are tags.  They also appear as the rightmost element in a context
           specification.
    
           Styles modify various operations of the completion system, such as output formatting,  but
           also  what  kinds  of completers are used (and in what order), or which tags are examined.
           Styles may accept arguments and are manipulated using the zstyle command described in  see
           zshmodules(1).
    
           In  summary,  tags  describe what the completion objects are, and style how they are to be
           completed.  At various points of execution,  the  completion  system  checks  what  styles
           and/or  tags  are  defined  for the current context, and uses that to modify its behavior.
           The full description of context handling, which determines how tags and other elements  of
           the  context  influence	the  behaviour of styles, is described below in COMPLETION SYSTEM
           CONFIGURATION.
    
           When a completion is requested, a dispatcher function is called; see  the  description  of
           _main_complete in the list of control functions below. This dispatcher decides which func‐
           tion should be called to produce the completions, and calls it. The result  is  passed  to
           one  or more completers, functions that implement individual completion strategies: simple
           completion, error correction, completion with error correction, menu selection, etc.
    
           More generally, the shell functions contained in the completion system are of two types:
           ·      those beginning `comp' are to be called directly; there are only a few of these;
    
           ·      those beginning `_' are called by the completion code.  The shell functions of this
    	      set,  which  implement  completion  behaviour  and  may be bound to keystrokes, are
    	      referred to as `widgets'.  These proliferate as new completions are required.
    
    INITIALIZATION
           If the system was installed completely, it should be enough to  call  the  shell  function
           compinit  from  your  initialization  file;  see  the next section.  However, the function
           compinstall can be run by a user to configure various aspects of the completion system.
    
           Usually, compinstall will insert code into .zshrc, although if that  is	not  writable  it
           will save it in another file and tell you that file's location.	Note that it is up to you
           to make sure that the lines added to .zshrc are actually run; you may, for  example,  need
           to  move them to an earlier place in the file if .zshrc usually returns early.  So long as
           you keep them all together (including the comment lines at the start and finish), you  can
           rerun  compinstall  and	it  will correctly locate and modify these lines.  Note, however,
           that any code you add to this section by hand is likely to be lost if  you  rerun  compin‐
           stall, although lines using the command `zstyle' should be gracefully handled.
    
           The  new code will take effect next time you start the shell, or run .zshrc by hand; there
           is also an option to make them take  effect  immediately.   However,  if  compinstall  has
           removed definitions, you will need to restart the shell to see the changes.
    
           To run compinstall you will need to make sure it is in a directory mentioned in your fpath
           parameter, which should already be the case if zsh was properly configured as long as your
           startup	files  do  not	remove	the  appropriate directories from fpath.  Then it must be
           autoloaded (`autoload -U compinstall' is recommended).  You can abort the installation any
           time  you  are being prompted for information, and your .zshrc will not be altered at all;
           changes only take place right at the end, where you are specifically asked  for	confirma‐
           tion.
    
       Use of compinit
           This  section  describes the use of compinit to initialize completion for the current ses‐
           sion when called directly; if you have run compinstall it  will	be  called  automatically
           from your .zshrc.
    
           To  initialize the system, the function compinit should be in a directory mentioned in the
           fpath parameter, and should be autoloaded (`autoload -U	compinit'  is  recommended),  and
           then  run simply as `compinit'.	This will define a few utility functions, arrange for all
           the necessary shell functions to be autoloaded, and will then re-define all  widgets  that
           do  completion to use the new system.  If you use the menu-select widget, which is part of
           the zsh/complist module, you should make sure that that module is loaded before	the  call
           to  compinit so that that widget is also re-defined.  If completion styles (see below) are
           set up to perform expansion as well as completion by default, and the TAB key is bound  to
           expand-or-complete, compinit will rebind it to complete-word; this is necessary to use the
           correct form of expansion.
    
           Should you need to use the original completion commands, you can still bind  keys  to  the
           old widgets by putting a `.' in front of the widget name, e.g. `.expand-or-complete'.
    
           To speed up the running of compinit, it can be made to produce a dumped configuration that
           will be read in on future invocations; this is the default, but can be turned off by call‐
           ing  compinit  with the option -D.  The dumped file is .zcompdump in the same directory as
           the startup files (i.e. $ZDOTDIR or $HOME); alternatively, an explicit file  name  can  be
           given  by  `compinit  -d  dumpfile'.  The next invocation of compinit will read the dumped
           file instead of performing a full initialization.
    
           If the number of completion files changes, compinit will recognise this and produce a  new
           dump  file.   However,  if  the name of a function or the arguments in the first line of a
           #compdef function (as described below) change, it is easiest to delete the  dump  file  by
           hand  so  that compinit will re-create it the next time it is run.  The check performed to
           see if there are new functions can be omitted by giving the option -C.  In this	case  the
           dump file will only be created if there isn't one already.
    
           The  dumping is actually done by another function, compdump, but you will only need to run
           this yourself if you change the configuration (e.g. using compdef) and then want  to  dump
           the new one.  The name of the old dumped file will be remembered for this purpose.
    
           If  the	parameter _compdir is set, compinit uses it as a directory where completion func‐
           tions can be found; this is only necessary if they are not already in the function  search
           path.
    
           For  security  reasons  compinit  also checks if the completion system would use files not
           owned by root or by the	current  user,	or  files  in  directories  that  are  world-  or
           group-writable  or  that  are  not owned by root or by the current user.  If such files or
           directories are found, compinit will ask if the completion system should really	be  used.
           To  avoid  these tests and make all files found be used without asking, use the option -u,
           and to make compinit silently ignore all insecure files and directories use the option -i.
           This security check is skipped entirely when the -C option is given.
    
           The  security check can be retried at any time by running the function compaudit.  This is
           the same check used by compinit, but when it is executed directly any changes to fpath are
           made  local  to the function so they do not persist.  The directories to be checked may be
           passed as arguments; if none are given, compaudit uses fpath and _compdir to find  comple‐
           tion  system  directories, adding missing ones to fpath as necessary.  To force a check of
           exactly the directories currently named in fpath, set _compdir to an empty  string  before
           calling compaudit or compinit.
    
           The  function bashcompinit provides compatibility with bash's programmable completion sys‐
           tem.  When run it will define the functions, compgen and complete which correspond to  the
           bash  builtins with the same names.  It will then be possible to use completion specifica‐
           tions and functions written for bash.
    
       Autoloaded files
           The convention for autoloaded functions used in completion is  that  they  start  with  an
           underscore;  as already mentioned, the fpath/FPATH parameter must contain the directory in
           which they are stored.  If zsh was properly installed on  your  system,	then  fpath/FPATH
           automatically contains the required directories for the standard functions.
    
           For  incomplete	installations,	if  compinit does not find enough files beginning with an
           underscore (fewer than twenty) in the search path, it will try to find more by adding  the
           directory  _compdir  to the search path.  If that directory has a subdirectory named Base,
           all subdirectories will be added to the path.  Furthermore, if the subdirectory Base has a
           subdirectory named Core, compinit will add all subdirectories of the subdirectories to the
           path: this allows the functions to be in the same format as in the  zsh	source	distribu‐
           tion.
    
           When  compinit is run, it searches all such files accessible via fpath/FPATH and reads the
           first line of each of them.  This line should contain one of  the  tags	described  below.
           Files whose first line does not start with one of these tags are not considered to be part
           of the completion system and will not be treated specially.
    
           The tags are:
    
           #compdef name ... [ -{p|P} pattern ... [ -N name ... ] ]
    	      The file will be made autoloadable and the function defined in it  will  be  called
    	      when  completing	names,	each of which is either the name of a command whose argu‐
    	      ments are to be completed or one of a number of special contexts in the form  -con‐
    	      text- described below.
    
    	      Each  name may also be of the form `cmd=service'.  When completing the command cmd,
    	      the function typically behaves as if the command (or special context)  service  was
    	      being  completed	instead.   This provides a way of altering the behaviour of func‐
    	      tions that can perform many different completions.  It is  implemented  by  setting
    	      the parameter $service when calling the function; the function may choose to inter‐
    	      pret this how it wishes, and simpler functions will probably ignore it.
    
    	      If the #compdef line contains one of the options -p or -P, the words following  are
    	      taken to be patterns.  The function will be called when completion is attempted for
    	      a command or context that matches one of the patterns.  The options -p and  -P  are
    	      used  to	specify  patterns  to  be tried before or after other completions respec‐
    	      tively.  Hence -P may be used to specify default actions.
    
    	      The option -N is used after a list following -p or -P; it specifies that	remaining
    	      words  no  longer  define  patterns.   It  is  possible to toggle between the three
    	      options as many times as necessary.
    
           #compdef -k style key-sequence ...
    	      This option creates a widget behaving like the builtin widget style and binds it to
    	      the given key-sequences, if any.	The style must be one of the builtin widgets that
    	      perform completion, namely complete-word, delete-char-or-list,  expand-or-complete,
    	      expand-or-complete-prefix, list-choices, menu-complete, menu-expand-or-complete, or
    	      reverse-menu-complete.  If the zsh/complist module is  loaded  (see  zshmodules(1))
    	      the widget menu-select is also available.
    
    	      When one of the key-sequences is typed, the function in the file will be invoked to
    	      generate the matches.  Note that a key will not be re-bound if it already was (that
    	      is,  was	bound to something other than undefined-key).  The widget created has the
    	      same name as the file and can be bound to any other keys using bindkey as usual.
    
           #compdef -K widget-name style key-sequence [ name style seq ... ]
    	      This is similar to -k except that only one key-sequence argument may be  given  for
    	      each  widget-name  style	pair.	However, the entire set of three arguments may be
    	      repeated with a different set of arguments.   Note  in  particular  that	the  wid‐
    	      get-name	must be distinct in each set.  If it does not begin with `_' this will be
    	      added.  The widget-name should not clash with the  name  of  any	existing  widget:
    	      names based on the name of the function are most useful.	For example,
    
    		     #compdef -K _foo_complete complete-word "^X^C" \
    		       _foo_list list-choices "^X^D"
    
    	      (all  on	one line) defines a widget _foo_complete for completion, bound to `^X^C',
    	      and a widget _foo_list for listing, bound to `^X^D'.
    
           #autoload [ options ]
    	      Functions with the #autoload tag are marked for autoloading but are  not	otherwise
    	      treated  specially.  Typically they are to be called from within one of the comple‐
    	      tion functions.  Any options supplied will be passed to  the  autoload  builtin;	a
    	      typical use is +X to force the function to be loaded immediately.  Note that the -U
    	      and -z flags are always added implicitly.
    
           The # is part of the tag name and no white space is allowed after it.  The  #compdef  tags
           use  the  compdef  function  described  below; the main difference is that the name of the
           function is supplied implicitly.
    
           The special contexts for which completion functions can be defined are:
    
           -array-value-
    	      The right hand side of an array-assignment (`name=(...)')
    
           -brace-parameter-
    	      The name of a parameter expansion within braces (`${...}')
    
           -assign-parameter-
    	      The name of a parameter in an assignment, i.e. on the left hand side of an `='
    
           -command-
    	      A word in command position
    
           -condition-
    	      A word inside a condition (`[[...]]')
    
           -default-
    	      Any word for which no other completion is defined
    
           -equal-
    	      A word beginning with an equals sign
    
           -first-
    	      This is tried before any other completion function.  The function  called  may  set
    	      the  _compskip  parameter  to  one of various values: all: no further completion is
    	      attempted; a string containing the substring patterns: no pattern completion  func‐
    	      tions will be called; a string containing default: the function for the `-default-'
    	      context will not be called, but functions defined for commands will be.
    
           -math- Inside mathematical contexts, such as `((...))'
    
           -parameter-
    	      The name of a parameter expansion (`$...')
    
           -redirect-
    	      The word after a redirection operator.
    
           -subscript-
    	      The contents of a parameter subscript.
    
           -tilde-
    	      After an initial tilde (`~'), but before the first slash in the word.
    
           -value-
    	      On the right hand side of an assignment.
    
           Default implementations are supplied for each of these contexts.  In most cases	the  con‐
           text  -context-	is implemented by a corresponding function _context, for example the con‐
           text `-tilde-' and the function `_tilde').
    
           The contexts -redirect- and -value- allow  extra  context-specific  information.   (Inter‐
           nally,  this is handled by the functions for each context calling the function _dispatch.)
           The extra information is added separated by commas.
    
           For the -redirect- context, the extra information is in the form  `-redirect-,op,command',
           where  op  is the redirection operator and command is the name of the command on the line.
           If there is no command on the line yet, the command field will be empty.
    
           For the -value- context, the form is `-value-,name,command', where name is the name of the
           parameter on the left hand side of the assignment.  In the case of elements of an associa‐
           tive array, for example `assoc=(key <TAB>', name is expanded to	`name-key'.   In  certain
           special contexts, such as completing after `make CFLAGS=', the command part gives the name
           of the command, here make; otherwise it is empty.
    
           It is not necessary to define fully specific completions as the	functions  provided  will
           try to generate completions by progressively replacing the elements with `-default-'.  For
           example, when completing after `foo=<TAB>', _value will try the names `-value-,foo,' (note
           the empty command part), `-value-,foo,-default-' and`-value-,-default-,-default-', in that
           order, until it finds a function to handle the context.
    
           As an example:
    
    	      compdef '_files -g "*.log"' '-redirect-,2>,-default-'
    
           completes files matching `*.log' after `2> <TAB>' for any command with  no  more  specific
           handler defined.
    
           Also:
    
    	      compdef _foo -value-,-default-,-default-
    
           specifies that _foo provides completions for the values of parameters for which no special
           function has been defined.  This is usually handled by the function _value itself.
    
           The same lookup rules are used when looking up styles (as described below); for example
    
    	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:-redirect-,2>,*:*' file-patterns '*.log'
    
           is another way to make completion after `2> <TAB>' complete files matching `*.log'.
    
       Functions
           The following function is defined by compinit and may be called directly.
    
           compdef [ -ane ] function name ... [ -{p|P} pattern ... [ -N name ...]]
           compdef -d name ...
           compdef -k [ -an ] function style key-sequence [ key-sequence ... ]
           compdef -K [ -an ] function name style key-seq [ name style seq ... ]
    	      The first form defines the function to call for completion in the given contexts as
    	      described for the #compdef tag above.
    
    	      Alternatively,  all  the	arguments  may have the form `cmd=service'.  Here service
    	      should already have been defined by `cmd1=service'  lines  in  #compdef  files,  as
    	      described  above.   The  argument for cmd will be completed in the same way as ser‐
    	      vice.
    
    	      The function argument may alternatively be a string  containing  almost  any  shell
    	      code.   If  the string contains an equal sign, the above will take precedence.  The
    	      option -e may be used to specify the first argument is to  be  evaluated	as  shell
    	      code even if it contains an equal sign.  The string will be executed using the eval
    	      builtin command to generate completions.	This provides a way of avoiding having to
    	      define a new completion function.  For example, to complete files ending in `.h' as
    	      arguments to the command foo:
    
    		     compdef '_files -g "*.h"' foo
    
    	      The option -n prevents any completions already defined for the command  or  context
    	      from being overwritten.
    
    	      The option -d deletes any completion defined for the command or contexts listed.
    
    	      The names may also contain -p, -P and -N options as described for the #compdef tag.
    	      The effect on the argument list is identical, switching between definitions of pat‐
    	      terns tried initially, patterns tried finally, and normal commands and contexts.
    
    	      The  parameter $_compskip may be set by any function defined for a pattern context.
    	      If it is set to a value containing  the  substring  `patterns'  none  of	the  pat‐
    	      tern-functions  will  be	called;  if it is set to a value containing the substring
    	      `all', no other function will be called.
    
    	      The form with -k defines a widget with the same name as the function that  will  be
    	      called  for each of the key-sequences; this is like the #compdef -k tag.	The func‐
    	      tion should generate the completions needed and  will  otherwise	behave	like  the
    	      builtin  widget  whose name is given as the style argument.  The widgets usable for
    	      this are: complete-word,	delete-char-or-list,  expand-or-complete,  expand-or-com‐
    	      plete-prefix,    list-choices,	menu-complete,	  menu-expand-or-complete,    and
    	      reverse-menu-complete, as well as menu-select if the zsh/complist module is loaded.
    	      The  option  -n prevents the key being bound if it is already to bound to something
    	      other than undefined-key.
    
    	      The form with -K is similar and defines multiple widgets based on  the  same  func‐
    	      tion,  each  of  which  requires	the  set  of  three  arguments	name,  style  and
    	      key-sequence, where the latter two are as for -k and the first  must  be	a  unique
    	      widget name beginning with an underscore.
    
    	      Wherever	applicable,  the -a option makes the function autoloadable, equivalent to
    	      autoload -U function.
    
           The function compdef can be used to associate existing completion functions with new  com‐
           mands.  For example,
    
    	      compdef _pids foo
    
           uses the function _pids to complete process IDs for the command foo.
    
           Note also the _gnu_generic function described below, which can be used to complete options
           for commands that understand the `--help' option.
    
    COMPLETION SYSTEM CONFIGURATION
           This section gives a short overview of how the completion  system  works,  and  then  more
           detail on how users can configure how and when matches are generated.
    
       Overview
           When  completion  is  attempted somewhere on the command line the completion system begins
           building the context.  The context represents everything that the shell	knows  about  the
           meaning	of  the  command  line	and  the significance of the cursor position.  This takes
           account of a number of things including the command word (such as  `grep'  or  `zsh')  and
           options to which the current word may be an argument (such as the `-o' option to zsh which
           takes a shell option as an argument).
    
           The context starts out very generic ("we are beginning a  completion")  and  becomes  more
           specific  as more is learned ("the current word is in a position that is usually a command
           name" or "the current word might be a variable name" and so on).   Therefore  the  context
           will vary during the same call to the completion system.
    
           This  context  information  is condensed into a string consisting of multiple fields sepa‐
           rated by colons, referred to simply as `the context' in the remainder  of  the  documenta‐
           tion.  Note that a user of the completion system rarely needs to compose a context string,
           unless for example a new function is being written to perform completion for  a	new  com‐
           mand.   What  a user may need to do is compose a style pattern, which is matched against a
           context when needed to look up context-sensitive options  that  configure  the  completion
           system.
    
           The  next  few paragraphs explain how a context is composed within the completion function
           suite.  Following that is discussion of how styles are  defined.   Styles  determine  such
           things  as  how	the  matches are generated, similarly to shell options but with much more
           control.  They are defined with the zstyle builtin command (see zshmodules(1)).
    
           The context string always consists of a fixed set of fields, separated by colons and  with
           a  leading colon before the first.  Fields which are not yet known are left empty, but the
           surrounding colons appear anyway.  The fields are always in  the  order	:completion:func‐
           tion:completer:command:argument:tag.  These have the following meaning:
    
           ·      The  literal  string  completion,  saying that this style is used by the completion
    	      system.  This distinguishes the context from those used by, for example,	zle  wid‐
    	      gets and ZFTP functions.
    
           ·      The  function,  if completion is called from a named widget rather than through the
    	      normal completion system.  Typically this is blank, but it is set by  special  wid‐
    	      gets  such  as  predict-on and the various functions in the Widget directory of the
    	      distribution to the name of that function, often in an abbreviated form.
    
           ·      The completer currently active, the name of the function without the leading under‐
    	      score and with other underscores converted to hyphens.  A `completer' is in overall
    	      control of how completion is to be performed; `complete' is the simplest, but other
    	      completers  exist to perform related tasks such as correction, or to modify the be‐
    	      haviour of a later completer.  See the section `Control Functions' below	for  more
    	      information.
    
           ·      The  command  or a special -context-, just at it appears following the #compdef tag
    	      or the compdef function.	Completion functions for commands that have  sub-commands
    	      usually  modify  this  field to contain the name of the command followed by a minus
    	      sign and the sub-command.  For example, the completion function for the cvs command
    	      sets this field to cvs-add when completing arguments to the add subcommand.
    
           ·      The  argument; this indicates which command line or option argument we are complet‐
    	      ing.  For command arguments this generally takes the form argument-n,  where  n  is
    	      the  number  of  the  argument,  and for arguments to options the form option-opt-n
    	      where n is the number of the argument to option opt.  However,  this  is	only  the
    	      case  if the command line is parsed with standard UNIX-style options and arguments,
    	      so many completions do not set this.
    
           ·      The tag.	As described previously, tags are used to discriminate between the  types
    	      of matches a completion function can generate in a certain context.  Any completion
    	      function may use any tag name it likes, but a list of the more common ones is given
    	      below.
    
           The  context  is  gradually  put together as the functions are executed, starting with the
           main entry point, which adds :completion: and the function element if necessary.  The com‐
           pleter  then  adds  the completer element.  The contextual completion adds the command and
           argument options.  Finally, the tag is added when the types of completion are known.   For
           example, the context name
    
    	      :completion::complete:dvips:option-o-1:files
    
           says  that  normal  completion was attempted as the first argument to the option -o of the
           command dvips:
    
    	      dvips -o ...
    
           and the completion function will generate filenames.
    
           Usually completion will be tried for all possible tags in an order given by the completion
           function.   However, this can be altered by using the tag-order style.  Completion is then
           restricted to the list of given tags in the given order.
    
           The _complete_help bindable command shows all the contexts and tags available for  comple‐
           tion  at  a  particular	point.	 This  provides  an  easy  way of finding information for
           tag-order and other styles.  It is described in the section `Bindable Commands' below.
    
           When looking up styles the completion system uses full context names, including	the  tag.
           Looking	up  the  value of a style therefore consists of two things: the context, which is
           matched to the most specific (best fitting) style pattern,  and	the  name  of  the  style
           itself, which must be matched exactly.  The following examples demonstrate that style pat‐
           terns may be loosely defined for styles that apply  broadly,  or  as  tightly  defined  as
           desired for styles that apply in narrower circumstances.
    
           For example, many completion functions can generate matches in a simple and a verbose form
           and use the verbose style to decide which form should be used.  To make all such functions
           use the verbose form, put
    
    	      zstyle ':completion:*' verbose yes
    
           in  a startup file (probably .zshrc).  This gives the verbose style the value yes in every
           context inside the completion system, unless that context has a more specific  definition.
           It  is  best to avoid giving the context as `*' in case the style has some meaning outside
           the completion system.
    
           Many such general purpose styles can be configured simply by using the  compinstall  func‐
           tion.
    
           A  more specific example of the use of the verbose style is by the completion for the kill
           builtin.  If the style is set, the builtin lists full job texts and process command lines;
           otherwise  it  shows  the  bare	job numbers and PIDs.  To turn the style off for this use
           only:
    
    	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:*' verbose no
    
           For even more control, the style can use one of the tags `jobs' or `processes'.	 To  turn
           off verbose display only for jobs:
    
    	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:jobs' verbose no
    
           The  -e option to zstyle even allows completion function code to appear as the argument to
           a style; this requires some understanding of the internals of  completion  functions  (see
           see zshcompwid(1))).  For example,
    
    	      zstyle -e ':completion:*' hosts 'reply=($myhosts)'
    
           This  forces the value of the hosts style to be read from the variable myhosts each time a
           host name is needed; this is useful if the value of myhosts can change  dynamically.   For
           another	useful	example, see the example in the description of the file-list style below.
           This form can be slow and should be avoided for commonly examined styles such as menu  and
           list-rows-first.
    
           Note  that the order in which styles are defined does not matter; the style mechanism uses
           the most specific possible match for a particular style to determine the  set  of  values.
           More  precisely,  strings  are  preferred  over	patterns (for example, `:completion::com‐
           plete:::foo' is more specific than `:completion::complete:::*'), and longer  patterns  are
           preferred over shorter patterns.
    
           A  good rule of thumb is that any completion style pattern that needs to include more than
           one wildcard (*) and that does not end in a tag name, should include all six  colons  (:),
           possibly surrounding additional wildcards.
    
           Style  names like those of tags are arbitrary and depend on the completion function.  How‐
           ever, the following two sections list some of the most common tags and styles.
    
       Standard Tags
           Some of the following are only used when looking up particular styles and do not refer  to
           a type of match.
    
           accounts
    	      used to look up the users-hosts style
    
           all-expansions
    	      used by the _expand completer when adding the single string containing all possible
    	      expansions
    
           all-files
    	      for the names of	all  files  (as  distinct  from  a  particular	subset,  see  the
    	      globbed-files tag).
    
           arguments
    	      for arguments to a command
    
           arrays for names of array parameters
    
           association-keys
    	      for keys of associative arrays; used when completing inside a subscript to a param‐
    	      eter of this type
    
           bookmarks
    	      when completing bookmarks (e.g. for URLs and the zftp function suite)
    
           builtins
    	      for names of builtin commands
    
           characters
    	      for single characters in arguments of commands such as stty.   Also used when  com‐
    	      pleting character classes after an opening bracket
    
           colormapids
    	      for X colormap ids
    
           colors for color names
    
           commands
    	      for  names  of  external	commands.  Also used by complex commands such as cvs when
    	      completing names subcommands.
    
           contexts
    	      for contexts in arguments to the zstyle builtin command
    
           corrections
    	      used by the _approximate and _correct completers for possible corrections
    
           cursors
    	      for cursor names used by X programs
    
           default
    	      used in some contexts to provide a way of supplying a default  when  more  specific
    	      tags  are  also  valid.  Note that this tag is used when only the function field of
    	      the context name is set
    
           descriptions
    	      used when looking up the value of the format style  to  generate	descriptions  for
    	      types of matches
    
           devices
    	      for names of device special files
    
           directories
    	      for names of directories -- local-directories is used instead when completing argu‐
    	      ments of cd and related builtin commands when the cdpath array is set
    
           directory-stack
    	      for entries in the directory stack
    
           displays
    	      for X display names
    
           domains
    	      for network domains
    
           expansions
    	      used by the _expand completer for individual words (as opposed to the complete  set
    	      of expansions) resulting from the expansion of a word on the command line
    
           extensions
    	      for X server extensions
    
           file-descriptors
    	      for numbers of open file descriptors
    
           files  the generic file-matching tag used by functions completing filenames
    
           fonts  for X font names
    
           fstypes
    	      for file system types (e.g. for the mount command)
    
           functions
    	      names  of  functions  --	normally  shell  functions, although certain commands may
    	      understand other kinds of function
    
           globbed-files
    	      for filenames when the name has been generated by pattern matching
    
           groups for names of user groups
    
           history-words
    	      for words from the history
    
           hosts  for hostnames
    
           indexes
    	      for array indexes
    
           jobs   for jobs (as listed by the `jobs' builtin)
    
           interfaces
    	      for network interfaces
    
           keymaps
    	      for names of zsh keymaps
    
           keysyms
    	      for names of X keysyms
    
           libraries
    	      for names of system libraries
    
           limits for system limits
    
           local-directories
    	      for names of directories that are subdirectories of the current  working	directory
    	      when completing arguments of cd and related builtin commands (compare path-directo‐
    	      ries) -- when the cdpath array is unset, directories is used instead
    
           manuals
    	      for names of manual pages
    
           mailboxes
    	      for e-mail folders
    
           maps   for map names (e.g. NIS maps)
    
           messages
    	      used to look up the format style for messages
    
           modifiers
    	      for names of X modifiers
    
           modules
    	      for modules (e.g. zsh modules)
    
           my-accounts
    	      used to look up the users-hosts style
    
           named-directories
    	      for named directories (you wouldn't have guessed that, would you?)
    
           names  for all kinds of names
    
           newsgroups
    	      for USENET groups
    
           nicknames
    	      for nicknames of NIS maps
    
           options
    	      for command options
    
           original
    	      used by the _approximate, _correct and _expand completers when offering the  origi‐
    	      nal string as a match
    
           other-accounts
    	      used to look up the users-hosts style
    
           other-files
    	      for  the	names of any non-directory files.  This is used instead of all-files when
    	      the list-dirs-first style is in effect.
    
           packages
    	      for packages (e.g. rpm or installed Debian packages)
    
           parameters
    	      for names of parameters
    
           path-directories
    	      for names of directories found by searching the cdpath array when completing  argu‐
    	      ments of cd and related builtin commands (compare local-directories)
    
           paths  used to look up the values of the expand, ambiguous and special-dirs styles
    
           pods   for perl pods (documentation files)
    
           ports  for communication ports
    
           prefixes
    	      for prefixes (like those of a URL)
    
           printers
    	      for print queue names
    
           processes
    	      for process identifiers
    
           processes-names
    	      used  to	look up the command style when generating the names of processes for kil‐
    	      lall
    
           sequences
    	      for sequences (e.g. mh sequences)
    
           sessions
    	      for sessions in the zftp function suite
    
           signals
    	      for signal names
    
           strings
    	      for strings (e.g. the replacement strings for the cd builtin command)
    
           styles for styles used by the zstyle builtin command
    
           suffixes
    	      for filename extensions
    
           tags   for tags (e.g. rpm tags)
    
           targets
    	      for makefile targets
    
           time-zones
    	      for time zones (e.g. when setting the TZ parameter)
    
           types  for types of whatever (e.g. address types for the xhost command)
    
           urls   used to look up the urls and local styles when completing URLs
    
           users  for usernames
    
           values for one of a set of values in certain lists
    
           variant
    	      used by _pick_variant to look up the command to run when determining  what  program
    	      is installed for a particular command name.
    
           visuals
    	      for X visuals
    
           warnings
    	      used to look up the format style for warnings
    
           widgets
    	      for zsh widget names
    
           windows
    	      for IDs of X windows
    
           zsh-options
    	      for shell options
    
       Standard Styles
           Note  that  the	values	of  several of these styles represent boolean values.  Any of the
           strings `true', `on', `yes', and `1' can be used for the  value	`true'	and  any  of  the
           strings	`false',  `off', `no', and `0' for the value `false'.  The behavior for any other
           value is undefined except where explicitly mentioned.  The default  value  may  be  either
           `true' or `false' if the style is not set.
    
           Some  of  these	styles are tested first for every possible tag corresponding to a type of
           match, and if no style was found, for the default tag.  The most notable  styles  of  this
           type  are  menu, list-colors and styles controlling completion listing such as list-packed
           and last-prompt.  When tested for the default tag, only the function field of the  context
           will be set so that a style using the default tag will normally be defined along the lines
           of:
    
    	      zstyle ':completion:*:default' menu ...
    
           accept-exact
    	      This is tested for the default tag in addition to the tags valid	for  the  current
    	      context.	 If  it  is set to `true' and any of the trial matches is the same as the
    	      string on the command line, this match will immediately be  accepted  (even  if  it
    	      would otherwise be considered ambiguous).
    
    	      When  completing	pathnames  (where the tag used is `paths') this style accepts any
    	      number of patterns as the value in  addition  to	the  boolean  values.	Pathnames
    	      matching	one  of  these	patterns will be accepted immediately even if the command
    	      line contains some more partially typed pathname components and these match no file
    	      under the directory accepted.
    
    	      This  style is also used by the _expand completer to decide if words beginning with
    	      a tilde or parameter expansion should be	expanded.   For  example,  if  there  are
    	      parameters  foo and foobar, the string `$foo' will only be expanded if accept-exact
    	      is set to `true'; otherwise the completion system will be allowed to complete  $foo
    	      to  $foobar. If the style is set to `continue', _expand will add the expansion as a
    	      match and the completion system will also be allowed to continue.
    
           accept-exact-dirs
    	      This is used by filename completion.  Unlike accept-exact  it  is  a  boolean.   By
    	      default,	filename completion examines all components of a path to see if there are
    	      completions of that component, even if the component matches an existing directory.
    	      For  example,  when completion after /usr/bin/, the function examines possible com‐
    	      pletions to /usr.
    
    	      When this style is `true', any prefix of a path that matches an existing	directory
    	      is  accepted without any attempt to complete it further.	Hence, in the given exam‐
    	      ple, the path /usr/bin/ is accepted immediately and completion tried in that direc‐
    	      tory.
    
    	      If  you wish to inhibit this behaviour entirely, set the path-completion style (see
    	      below) to `false'.
    
           add-space
    	      This style is used by the _expand completer.  If it  is  `true'  (the  default),	a
    	      space  will be inserted after all words resulting from the expansion, or a slash in
    	      the case of directory names.  If the value is `file', the completer will only add a
    	      space  to names of existing files.  Either a boolean `true' or the value `file' may
    	      be combined with `subst', in which case the completer will not add a space to words
    	      generated from the expansion of a substitution of the form `$(...)' or `${...}'.
    
    	      The  _prefix  completer  uses  this  style as a simple boolean value to decide if a
    	      space should be inserted before the suffix.
    
           ambiguous
    	      This applies when completing non-final components of filename paths, in other words
    	      those  with  a  trailing	slash.	 If it is set, the cursor is left after the first
    	      ambiguous component, even if menu completion is in use.  The style is always tested
    	      with the paths tag.
    
           assign-list
    	      When  completing	after  an equals sign that is being treated as an assignment, the
    	      completion system normally completes only one filename.  In some	cases  the  value
    	      may  be  a  list of filenames separated by colons, as with PATH and similar parame‐
    	      ters.  This style can be set to a list of  patterns  matching  the  names  of  such
    	      parameters.
    
    	      The  default  is	to  complete  lists  when the word on the line already contains a
    	      colon.
    
           auto-description
    	      If set, this style's value will be used as the description for options that are not
    	      described  by  the  completion  functions, but that have exactly one argument.  The
    	      sequence `%d' in the value will be replaced by the description for  this	argument.
    	      Depending  on personal preferences, it may be useful to set this style to something
    	      like `specify: %d'.  Note that this may not work for some commands.
    
           avoid-completer
    	      This is used by the _all_matches completer to decide if the  string  consisting  of
    	      all  matches should be added to the list currently being generated.  Its value is a
    	      list of names of completers.  If any of these is the name  of  the  completer  that
    	      generated the matches in this completion, the string will not be added.
    
    	      The default value for this style is `_expand _old_list _correct _approximate', i.e.
    	      it contains the completers for which a string with all matches will almost never be
    	      wanted.
    
           cache-path
    	      This style defines the path where any cache files containing dumped completion data
    	      are stored.  It  defaults  to  `$ZDOTDIR/.zcompcache',  or  `$HOME/.zcompcache'  if
    	      $ZDOTDIR	is  not  defined.   The  completion  cache  will  not  be used unless the
    	      use-cache style is set.
    
           cache-policy
    	      This style defines the function that will be used  to  determine	whether  a  cache
    	      needs rebuilding.  See the section on the _cache_invalid function below.
    
           call-command
    	      This  style is used in the function for commands such as make and ant where calling
    	      the command directly to generate matches suffers problems such as being slow or, as
    	      in  the  case of make can potentially cause actions in the makefile to be executed.
    	      If it is set to `true' the command is called to generate matches. The default value
    	      of this style is `false'.
    
           command
    	      In many places, completion functions need to call external commands to generate the
    	      list of completions.  This style can be used to override the command that is called
    	      in  some	such  cases.   The elements of the value are joined with spaces to form a
    	      command line to execute.	The value can also start with a hyphen, in which case the
    	      usual  command  will be added to the end; this is most useful for putting `builtin'
    	      or `command' in front to make sure the appropriate version of a command is  called,
    	      for  example  to	avoid  calling a shell function with the same name as an external
    	      command.
    
    	      As an example, the completion function for process IDs uses  this  style	with  the
    	      processes  tag to generate the IDs to complete and the list of processes to display
    	      (if the verbose style is `true').  The list produced by  the  command  should  look
    	      like  the  output  of  the  ps  command.	 The  first line is not displayed, but is
    	      searched for the string `PID' (or `pid') to find the position of the process IDs in
    	      the following lines.  If the line does not contain `PID', the first numbers in each
    	      of the other lines are taken as the process IDs to complete.
    
    	      Note that the completion function generally has to call the specified  command  for
    	      each  attempt to generate the completion list.  Hence care should be taken to spec‐
    	      ify only commands that take a short time to run, and in  particular  to  avoid  any
    	      that may never terminate.
    
           command-path
    	      This  is a list of directories to search for commands to complete.  The default for
    	      this style is the value of the special parameter path.
    
           commands
    	      This is used by the function completing sub-commands for the system  initialisation
    	      scripts  (residing  in  /etc/init.d  or somewhere not too far away from that).  Its
    	      values give the default commands to complete for those commands for which the  com‐
    	      pletion  function  isn't able to find them out automatically.  The default for this
    	      style are the two strings `start' and `stop'.
    
           complete
    	      This is used by the _expand_alias function when invoked as a bindable command.   If
    	      set  to `true' and the word on the command line is not the name of an alias, match‐
    	      ing alias names will be completed.
    
           complete-options
    	      This is used by the completer for cd, chdir and pushd.  For these commands a  -  is
    	      used  to introduce a directory stack entry and completion of these is far more com‐
    	      mon than completing options.  Hence unless  the  value  of  this	style  is  `true'
    	      options  will  not be completed, even after an initial -.  If it is `true', options
    	      will be completed after an initial - unless there is a preceding -- on the  command
    	      line.
    
           completer
    	      The  strings  given  as  the value of this style provide the names of the completer
    	      functions to use. The available completer functions are described  in  the  section
    	      `Control Functions' below.
    
    	      Each  string may be either the name of a completer function or a string of the form
    	      `function:name'.	In the first case the completer field of the context will contain
    	      the  name of the completer without the leading underscore and with all other under‐
    	      scores replaced by hyphens.  In the second case the function is  the  name  of  the
    	      completer  to  call, but the context will contain the user-defined name in the com‐
    	      pleter field of the context.  If the name starts with a hyphen, the string for  the
    	      context  will be build from the name of the completer function as in the first case
    	      with the name appended to it.  For example:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _complete:-foo
    
    	      Here, completion will call the _complete completer twice, once using `complete' and
    	      once  using  `complete-foo' in the completer field of the context.  Normally, using
    	      the same completer more than once only  makes  sense  when  used	with  the  `func‐
    	      tions:name'  form, because otherwise the context name will be the same in all calls
    	      to the completer; possible exceptions to this rule are  the  _ignored  and  _prefix
    	      completers.
    
    	      The  default  value for this style is `_complete _ignored': only completion will be
    	      done, first using the ignored-patterns style and the $fignore array and then  with‐
    	      out ignoring matches.
    
           condition
    	      This  style  is  used  by  the  _list  completer function to decide if insertion of
    	      matches should be delayed unconditionally. The default is `true'.
    
           delimiters
    	      This style is used when adding a delimiter for use with history modifiers  or  glob
    	      qualifiers  that	have delimited arguments.  It is an array of preferred delimiters
    	      to add.  Non-special characters are preferred as the completion system  may  other‐
    	      wise become confused.  The default list is :, +, /, -, %.  The list may be empty to
    	      force a delimiter to be typed.
    
           disabled
    	      If this is set to `true', the _expand_alias completer and bindable command will try
    	      to expand disabled aliases, too.	The default is `false'.
    
           domains
    	      A  list  of  names  of  network domains for completion.  If this is not set, domain
    	      names will be taken from the file /etc/resolv.conf.
    
           environ
    	      The environ style is used when completing for `sudo'.  It is set	to  an	array  of
    	      `VAR=value'  assignments	to be exported into the local environment before the com‐
    	      pletion for the target command is invoked.
    	      zstyle ':completion:*:sudo::' environ \
    		PATH="/sbin:/usr/sbin:$PATH" HOME="/root"
    
           expand This style is used when completing strings consisting of multiple  parts,  such  as
    	      path names.
    
    	      If one of its values is the string `prefix', the partially typed word from the line
    	      will be expanded as far as possible even if trailing parts cannot be completed.
    
    	      If one of its values is the string `suffix', matching names  for	components  after
    	      the  first  ambiguous one will also be added.  This means that the resulting string
    	      is the longest unambiguous string possible.  However, menu completion can  be  used
    	      to cycle through all matches.
    
           fake   This  style may be set for any completion context.  It specifies additional strings
    	      that will always be completed  in  that  context.   The  form  of  each  string  is
    	      `value:description';  the  colon	and  description  may be omitted, but any literal
    	      colons in value must be quoted with a backslash.	Any description provided is shown
    	      alongside the value in completion listings.
    
    	      It  is  important  to  use  a sufficiently restrictive context when specifying fake
    	      strings.	Note that the styles fake-files and  fake-parameters  provide  additional
    	      features when completing files or parameters.
    
           fake-always
    	      This  works identically to the fake style except that the ignored-patterns style is
    	      not applied to it.  This makes it possible to override a set of matches  completely
    	      by setting the ignored patterns to `*'.
    
    	      The  following shows a way of supplementing any tag with arbitrary data, but having
    	      it behave for display purposes like a separate tag.  In this  example  we  use  the
    	      features	of  the tag-order style to divide the named-directories tag into two when
    	      performing completion with the standard completer complete  for  arguments  of  cd.
    	      The  tag	named-directories-normal  behaves  as  normal, but the tag named-directo‐
    	      ries-mine contains a fixed set of directories.  This has the effect of  adding  the
    	      match group `extra directories' with the given completions.
    
    		     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*' tag-order \
    		       'named-directories:-mine:extra\ directories
    		       named-directories:-normal:named\ directories *'
    		     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
    		       fake-always mydir1 mydir2
    		     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
    		       ignored-patterns '*'
    
           fake-files
    	      This  style  is used when completing files and looked up without a tag.  Its values
    	      are of the form `dir:names...'.  This will add the names (strings separated by spa‐
    	      ces)  as	possible  matches  when  completing in the directory dir, even if no such
    	      files really exist.  The dir may be a pattern; pattern characters or colons in  dir
    	      should be quoted with a backslash to be treated literally.
    
    	      This  can  be  useful  on systems that support special file systems whose top-level
    	      pathnames can not be listed or generated with glob patterns.  It can also  be  used
    	      for directories for which one does not have read permission.
    
    	      The pattern form can be used to add a certain `magic' entry to all directories on a
    	      particular file system.
    
           fake-parameters
    	      This is used by the completion function for parameter names.  Its values are  names
    	      of  parameters that might not yet be set but should be completed nonetheless.  Each
    	      name may also be followed by a colon and a string specifying the type of the param‐
    	      eter  (like  `scalar',  `array' or `integer').  If the type is given, the name will
    	      only be completed if parameters of that type are required in  the  particular  con‐
    	      text.  Names for which no type is specified will always be completed.
    
           file-list
    	      This  style  controls  whether files completed using the standard builtin mechanism
    	      are to be listed with a long list similar to ls -l.  Note that  this  feature  uses
    	      the  shell  module zsh/stat for file information; this loads the builtin stat which
    	      will replace any external stat executable.  To avoid this the following code can be
    	      included in an initialization file:
    
    		     zmodload -i zsh/stat
    		     disable stat
    
    	      The  style  may  either  be  set to a `true' value (or `all'), or one of the values
    	      `insert' or `list', indicating that files are to be listed in long  format  in  all
    	      circumstances, or when attempting to insert a file name, or when listing file names
    	      without attempting to insert one.
    
    	      More generally, the value may be an array of any of the  above  values,  optionally
    	      followed	by  =num.   If	num is present it gives the maximum number of matches for
    	      which long listing style will be used.  For example,
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' file-list list=20 insert=10
    
    	      specifies that long format will be used when listing up to 20 files or inserting	a
    	      file  with  up to 10 matches (assuming a listing is to be shown at all, for example
    	      on an ambiguous completion), else short format will be used.
    
    		     zstyle -e ':completion:*' file-list \
    			    '(( ${+NUMERIC} )) && reply=(true)'
    
    	      specifies that long format will be used any time a numeric  argument  is	supplied,
    	      else short format.
    
           file-patterns
    	      This  is	used  by  the standard function for completing filenames, _files.  If the
    	      style is unset up to three  tags	are  offered,  `globbed-files',`directories'  and
    	      `all-files',  depending  on  the	types of files	expected by the caller of _files.
    	      The first two (`globbed-files' and `directories') are normally offered together  to
    	      make it easier to complete files in sub-directories.
    
    	      The  file-patterns  style  provides alternatives to the default tags, which are not
    	      used.  Its value consists of elements of the form `pattern:tag';	each  string  may
    	      contain any number of such specifications separated by spaces.
    
    	      The  pattern is a pattern that is to be used to generate filenames.  Any occurrence
    	      of the sequence `%p' is replaced by any pattern(s) passed by the	function  calling
    	      _files.  Colons in the pattern must be preceded by a backslash to make them distin‐
    	      guishable from the colon before the tag.	If more than one pattern is  needed,  the
    	      patterns can be given inside braces, separated by commas.
    
    	      The  tags of all strings in the value will be offered by _files and used when look‐
    	      ing up other styles.  Any tags in the same word will be offered at  the  same  time
    	      and before later words.  If no `:tag' is given the `files' tag will be used.
    
    	      The  tag	may also be followed by an optional second colon and a description, which
    	      will be used for the `%d' in the value of the format style (if that is set) instead
    	      of the default description supplied by the completion function.  If the description
    	      given here contains itself a `%d', that is replaced with the  description  supplied
    	      by the completion function.
    
    	      For  example,  to make the rm command first complete only names of object files and
    	      then the names of all files if there is no matching object file:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:rm:*:*' file-patterns \
    			 '*.o:object-files' '%p:all-files'
    
    	      To alter the default behaviour of file completion -- offer files matching a pattern
    	      and  directories	on  the  first	attempt, then all files -- to offer only matching
    	      files on the first attempt, then directories, and finally all files:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \
    			 '%p:globbed-files' '*(-/):directories' '*:all-files'
    
    	      This works even where there is no special pattern: _files matches all  files  using
    	      the  pattern  `*' at the first step and stops when it sees this pattern.	Note also
    	      it will never try a pattern more than once for a single completion attempt.
    
    	      During the execution of  completion  functions,  the  EXTENDED_GLOB  option  is  in
    	      effect, so the characters `#', `~' and `^' have special meanings in the patterns.
    
           file-sort
    	      The  standard  filename completion function uses this style without a tag to deter‐
    	      mine in which order the names should be listed; menu completion will cycle  through
    	      them in the same order.  The possible values are: `size' to sort by the size of the
    	      file; `links' to sort by the number of links to the file; `modification' (or `time'
    	      or  `date')  to  sort  by  the last modification time; `access' to sort by the last
    	      access time; and `inode' (or `change') to sort by the last inode change  time.   If
    	      the  style  is set to any other value, or is unset, files will be sorted alphabeti‐
    	      cally by name.  If the value contains the string `reverse', sorting is done in  the
    	      opposite	order.	If the value contains the string `follow', timestamps are associ‐
    	      ated with the targets of symbolic links; the default is to use  the  timestamps  of
    	      the links themselves.
    
           filter This  is	used  by  the  LDAP  plugin  for e-mail address completion to specify the
    	      attributes to match against when filtering entries.  So for example, if  the  style
    	      is set to `sn', matching is done against surnames.  Standard LDAP filtering is used
    	      so normal completion matching is bypassed.  If this style  is  not  set,	the  LDAP
    	      plugin  is  skipped.   You may also need to set the command style to specify how to
    	      connect to your LDAP server.
    
           force-list
    	      This forces a list of completions to be shown at any point where listing	is  done,
    	      even  in	cases  where the list would usually be suppressed.  For example, normally
    	      the list is only shown if there are at least two	different  matches.   By  setting
    	      this style to `always', the list will always be shown, even if there is only a sin‐
    	      gle match that will immediately be accepted.  The style may also be set to  a  num‐
    	      ber.   In this case the list will be shown if there are at least that many matches,
    	      even if they would all insert the same string.
    
    	      This style is tested for the default tag as well as for each tag valid for the cur‐
    	      rent completion.	Hence the listing can be forced only for certain types of match.
    
           format If  this	is set for the descriptions tag, its value is used as a string to display
    	      above matches in completion lists.  The  sequence  `%d'  in  this  string  will  be
    	      replaced	with a short description of what these matches are.  This string may also
    	      contain the following sequences to specify output attributes as  described  in  the
    	      section  EXPANSION  OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1): `%B', `%S', `%U', `%F', `%K'
    	      and their lower case counterparts, as well as `%{...%}'.	`%F', `%K' and	`%{...%}'
    	      take  arguments  in the same form as prompt expansion.  Note that the sequence `%G'
    	      is not available; an argument to `%{' should be used instead.
    
    	      The style is tested with each tag valid for the current  completion  before  it  is
    	      tested for the descriptions tag.	Hence different format strings can be defined for
    	      different types of match.
    
    	      Note also that some completer functions define additional `%'-sequences.	These are
    	      described for the completer functions that make use of them.
    
    	      Some  completion	functions display messages that may be customised by setting this
    	      style for the messages tag.  Here, the `%d' is replaced with a message given by the
    	      completion function.
    
    	      Finally,	the  format  string  is  looked up with the warnings tag, for use when no
    	      matches could be generated at all.  In this case the  `%d'  is  replaced	with  the
    	      descriptions  for the matches that were expected separated by spaces.  The sequence
    	      `%D' is replaced with the same descriptions separated by newlines.
    
    	      It is possible to use printf-style field width specifiers  with  `%d'  and  similar
    	      escape  sequences.   This  is  handled  by  the  zformat	builtin  command from the
    	      zsh/zutil module, see zshmodules(1).
    
           glob   This is used by the _expand completer.  If it is set to `true' (the default), glob‐
    	      bing will be attempted on the words resulting from a previous substitution (see the
    	      substitute style) or else the original string from the line.
    
           global If this is set to `true' (the default), the _expand_alias  completer  and  bindable
    	      command will try to expand global aliases.
    
           group-name
    	      The  completion  system can group different types of matches, which appear in sepa‐
    	      rate lists.  This style can be used to give the  names  of  groups  for  particular
    	      tags.   For  example,  in command position the completion system generates names of
    	      builtin and external commands, names of aliases, shell functions and parameters and
    	      reserved	words  as  possible completions.  To have the external commands and shell
    	      functions listed separately:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:commands' \
    			    group-name commands
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:functions' \
    			    group-name functions
    
    	      As a consequence, any match with the same tag will be displayed in the same group.
    
    	      If the name given is the empty string the name of the tag for the matches  will  be
    	      used  as	the  name  of the group.  So, to have all different types of matches dis‐
    	      played separately, one can just set:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' group-name ''
    
    	      All matches for which no group name is  defined  will  be  put  in  a  group  named
    	      -default-.
    
           group-order
    	      This  style  is additional to the group-name style to specify the order for display
    	      of the groups defined by that style (compare tag-order, which determines which com‐
    	      pletions	appear at all).  The groups named are shown in the given order; any other
    	      groups are shown in the order defined by the completion function.
    
    	      For example, to have names of builtin commands, shell functions and  external  com‐
    	      mands appear in that order when completing in command position:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:*' group-order \
    			    builtins functions commands
    
           groups A list of names of UNIX groups.  If this is not set, group names are taken from the
    	      YP database or the file `/etc/group'.
    
           hidden If this is set to `true', matches  for  the  given  context  will  not  be  listed,
    	      although	any  description for the matches set with the format style will be shown.
    	      If it is set to `all', not even the description will be displayed.
    
    	      Note that the matches will still be completed; they are just not shown in the list.
    	      To  avoid  having  matches considered as possible completions at all, the tag-order
    	      style can be modified as described below.
    
           hosts  A list of names of hosts that should be completed.  If this is not  set,	hostnames
    	      are taken from the file `/etc/hosts'.
    
           hosts-ports
    	      This  style  is  used  by commands that need or accept hostnames and network ports.
    	      The strings in the value should be of the form `host:port'.  Valid ports are deter‐
    	      mined by the presence of hostnames; multiple ports for the same host may appear.
    
           ignore-line
    	      This  is	tested	for  each  tag valid for the current completion.  If it is set to
    	      `true', none of the words that are already on the line will be considered as possi‐
    	      ble  completions.  If it is set to `current', the word the cursor is on will not be
    	      considered as a possible completion.  The value `current-shown' is similar but only
    	      applies  if  the list of completions is currently shown on the screen.  Finally, if
    	      the style is set to `other', all words on the line except for the current one  will
    	      be excluded from the possible completions.
    
    	      The  values  `current'  and  `current-shown'  are  a  bit  like the opposite of the
    	      accept-exact style:  only strings with missing characters will be completed.
    
    	      Note that you almost certainly don't want to set this to `true' or  `other'  for	a
    	      general context such as `:completion:*'.	This is because it would disallow comple‐
    	      tion of, for example, options multiple  times  even  if  the  command  in  question
    	      accepts the option more than once.
    
           ignore-parents
    	      The  style is tested without a tag by the function completing pathnames in order to
    	      determine whether to ignore the names of directories already mentioned in the  cur‐
    	      rent  word,  or  the name of the current working directory.  The value must include
    	      one or both of the following strings:
    
    	      parent The name of any directory whose path is already contained in the word on the
    		     line  is ignored.	For example, when completing after foo/../, the directory
    		     foo will not be considered a valid completion.
    
    	      pwd    The name of the current working directory will not be completed; hence,  for
    		     example,  completion  after  ../ will not use the name of the current direc‐
    		     tory.
    
    	      In addition, the value may include one or both of:
    
    	      ..     Ignore the specified directories only when the word on the line contains the
    		     substring `../'.
    
    	      directory
    		     Ignore  the  specified  directories  only when names of directories are com‐
    		     pleted, not when completing names of files.
    
    	      Excluded values act in a similar fashion to values of the  ignored-patterns  style,
    	      so they can be restored to consideration by the _ignored completer.
    
           extra-verbose
    	      If  set,	the completion listing is more verbose at the cost of a probable decrease
    	      in completion speed.  Completion performance will suffer if this style  is  set  to
    	      `true'.
    
           ignored-patterns
    	      A  list  of  patterns;  any  trial  completion matching one of the patterns will be
    	      excluded from consideration.  The _ignored completer can appear in the list of com‐
    	      pleters to restore the ignored matches.  This is a more configurable version of the
    	      shell parameter $fignore.
    
    	      Note that the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set during the execution of completion  func‐
    	      tions, so the characters `#', `~' and `^' have special meanings in the patterns.
    
           insert This  style  is  used by the _all_matches completer to decide whether to insert the
    	      list of all matches unconditionally instead of adding the list as another match.
    
           insert-ids
    	      When completing process IDs, for example as arguments to the kill and wait builtins
    	      the  name  of  a command may be converted to the appropriate process ID.	A problem
    	      arises when the process name typed is not unique.  By default (or if this style  is
    	      set explicitly to `menu') the name will be converted immediately to a set of possi‐
    	      ble IDs, and menu completion will be started to cycle through them.
    
    	      If the value of the style is `single', the shell will wait until the user has typed
    	      enough  to make the command unique before converting the name to an ID; attempts at
    	      completion will be unsuccessful until that  point.   If  the  value  is  any  other
    	      string, menu completion will be started when the string typed by the user is longer
    	      than the common prefix to the corresponding IDs.
    
           insert-tab
    	      If this is set to `true', the completion system will insert a TAB character (assum‐
    	      ing  that was used to start completion) instead of performing completion when there
    	      is no non-blank character to the left of the cursor.  If it is set to `false', com‐
    	      pletion will be done even there.
    
    	      The  value  may  also  contain  the substrings `pending' or `pending=val'.  In this
    	      case, the typed character will be inserted  instead  of  starting  completion  when
    	      there is unprocessed input pending.  If a val is given, completion will not be done
    	      if there are at least that many characters of unprocessed  input.   This	is  often
    	      useful  when  pasting  characters into a terminal.  Note however, that it relies on
    	      the $PENDING special parameter from the zsh/zle module being set properly which  is
    	      not guaranteed on all platforms.
    
    	      The  default  value  of  this  style  is	`true' except for completion within vared
    	      builtin command where it is `false'.
    
           insert-unambiguous
    	      This is used by the _match and _approximate completers.  These completers are often
    	      used  with  menu completion since the word typed may bear little resemblance to the
    	      final completion.  However, if this style is `true', the completer will start  menu
    	      completion  only if it could find no unambiguous initial string at least as long as
    	      the original string typed by the user.
    
    	      In the case of the _approximate completer, the completer field in the context  will
    	      already  have  been  set to one of correct-num or approximate-num, where num is the
    	      number of errors that were accepted.
    
    	      In the case of the _match completer, the style may also be set to the string  `pat‐
    	      tern'.   Then  the pattern on the line is left unchanged if it does not match unam‐
    	      biguously.
    
           keep-prefix
    	      This style is used by the _expand completer.  If it is `true', the  completer  will
    	      try  to  keep a prefix containing a tilde or parameter expansion.  Hence, for exam‐
    	      ple, the string `~/f*' would be expanded to `~/foo'  instead  of	`/home/user/foo'.
    	      If  the  style  is  set  to  `changed'  (the default), the prefix will only be left
    	      unchanged if there were other changes between the expanded words and  the  original
    	      word  from  the  command	line.	Any  other value forces the prefix to be expanded
    	      unconditionally.
    
    	      The behaviour of _expand when this style is `true' is to cause _expand to  give  up
    	      when a single expansion with the restored prefix is the same as the original; hence
    	      any remaining completers may be called.
    
           last-prompt
    	      This is a more flexible form of the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.  If  it  is  `true',
    	      the  completion  system  will try to return the cursor to the previous command line
    	      after displaying a completion list.  It is tested for all tags valid for	the  cur‐
    	      rent completion, then the default tag.  The cursor will be moved back to the previ‐
    	      ous line if this style is `true' for all types of  match.   Note	that  unlike  the
    	      ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option this is independent of the numeric argument.
    
           known-hosts-files
    	      This  style  should  contain  a  list of files to search for host names and (if the
    	      use-ip style is set) IP addresses in  a  format  compatible  with  ssh  known_hosts
    	      files.  If it is not set, the files /etc/ssh/ssh_known_hosts and ~/.ssh/known_hosts
    	      are used.
    
           list   This style is used by the _history_complete_word bindable command.  If it is set to
    	      `true' it has no effect.	If it is set to `false' matches will not be listed.  This
    	      overrides the setting of the options controlling listing behaviour,  in  particular
    	      AUTO_LIST.  The context always starts with `:completion:history-words'.
    
           list-colors
    	      If  the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used to set color specifi‐
    	      cations.	This mechanism replaces the use of the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parame‐
    	      ters  described  in the section `The zsh/complist Module' in zshmodules(1), but the
    	      syntax is the same.
    
    	      If this style is set for the default tag, the strings in the  value  are	taken  as
    	      specifications  that  are  to be used everywhere.  If it is set for other tags, the
    	      specifications are used only for matches of the type described  by  the  tag.   For
    	      this to work best, the group-name style must be set to an empty string.
    
    	      In  addition  to setting styles for specific tags, it is also possible to use group
    	      names specified explicitly by the group-name tag together with the `(group)' syntax
    	      allowed  by  the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters and simply using the default
    	      tag.
    
    	      It is possible to use any color specifications already set up for the  GNU  version
    	      of the ls command:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:default' list-colors \
    			    ${(s.:.)LS_COLORS}
    
    	      The  default  colors  are the same as for the GNU ls command and can be obtained by
    	      setting the style to an empty string (i.e. '').
    
           list-dirs-first
    	      This is used by file completion.	If set, directories to be  completed  are  listed
    	      separately  from and before completion for other files, regardless of tag ordering.
    	      In addition, the tag other-files is used in place of all-files  for  the	remaining
    	      files, to indicate that no directories are presented with that tag.
    
           list-grouped
    	      If  this style is `true' (the default), the completion system will try to make cer‐
    	      tain completion listings more compact by grouping matches.   For	example,  options
    	      for commands that have the same description (shown when the verbose style is set to
    	      `true') will appear as a single entry.  However, menu  selection	can  be  used  to
    	      cycle through all the matches.
    
           list-packed
    	      This  is	tested	for  each tag valid in the current context as well as the default
    	      tag.  If it is set to `true', the corresponding matches appear in  listings  as  if
    	      the  LIST_PACKED	option	were  set.  If it is set to `false', they are listed nor‐
    	      mally.
    
           list-prompt
    	      If this style is set for the default tag, completion lists that don't  fit  on  the
    	      screen  can  be scrolled (see the description of the zsh/complist module in zshmod‐
    	      ules(1)).  The value, if not the	empty  string,	will  be  displayed  after  every
    	      screenful  and  the  shell  will prompt for a key press; if the style is set to the
    	      empty string, a default prompt will be used.
    
    	      The value may contain the escape sequences: `%l' or `%L', which will be replaced by
    	      the  number of the last line displayed and the total number of lines; `%m' or `%M',
    	      the number of the  last match shown and the total number of matches; and	`%p'  and
    	      `%P',  `Top'  when  at  the beginning of the list, `Bottom' when at the end and the
    	      position shown as a percentage of the total length otherwise.   In  each	case  the
    	      form  with the uppercase letter will be replaced by a string of fixed width, padded
    	      to the  right with spaces, while the lowercase form will be replaced by a  variable
    	      width  string.   As in other prompt strings, the escape sequences `%S', `%s', `%B',
    	      `%b', `%U', `%u' for entering and leaving the  display  modes  standout,	bold  and
    	      underline,  and  `%F',  `%f',  `%K',  `%k'  for  changing the foreground background
    	      colour, are also available, as is the form `%{...%}' for enclosing escape sequences
    	      which display with zero (or, with a numeric argument, some other) width.
    
    	      After  deleting this prompt the variable LISTPROMPT should be unset for the removal
    	      to take effect.
    
           list-rows-first
    	      This style is tested in the same	way  as  the  list-packed  style  and  determines
    	      whether  matches are to be listed in a rows-first fashion as if the LIST_ROWS_FIRST
    	      option were set.
    
           list-suffixes
    	      This style is used by the function that completes filenames.  If it is `true',  and
    	      completion  is  attempted  on a string containing multiple partially typed pathname
    	      components, all ambiguous components will be shown.  Otherwise, completion stops at
    	      the first ambiguous component.
    
           list-separator
    	      The  value  of  this  style is used in completion listing to separate the string to
    	      complete from a description when	possible  (e.g.  when  completing  options).   It
    	      defaults to `--' (two hyphens).
    
           local  This is for use with functions that complete URLs for which the corresponding files
    	      are available directly from the file system.  Its value  should  consist	of  three
    	      strings:	a  hostname,  the  path  to the default web pages for the server, and the
    	      directory name used by a user placing web pages within their home area.
    
    	      For example:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' local toast \
    			 /var/http/public/toast public_html
    
    	      Completion after	`http://toast/stuff/'  will  look  for	files  in  the	directory
    	      /var/http/public/toast/stuff,   while completion after `http://toast/~yousir/' will
    	      look for files in the directory ~yousir/public_html.
    
           mail-directory
    	      If set, zsh will assume that mailbox files can be found in the directory specified.
    	      It defaults to `~/Mail'.
    
           match-original
    	      This  is	used  by  the _match completer.  If it is set to only, _match will try to
    	      generate matches without inserting a `*' at the cursor position.	 If  set  to  any
    	      other  non-empty value, it will first try to generate matches without inserting the
    	      `*' and if that yields no matches, it will try again with the `*' inserted.  If  it
    	      is  unset  or set to the empty string, matching will only be performed with the `*'
    	      inserted.
    
           matcher
    	      This style is tested separately for each tag valid in  the  current  context.   Its
    	      value is tried before any match specifications given by the matcher-list style.  It
    	      should be in the form described in the section  `Completion  Matching  Control'  in
    	      zshcompwid(1).  For examples of this, see the description of the tag-order style.
    
           matcher-list
    	      This  style  can	be  set  to a list of match specifications that are to be applied
    	      everywhere. Match specifications are described in the section `Completion  Matching
    	      Control'	in  zshcompwid(1).  The completion system will try them one after another
    	      for each completer selected.  For example, to try first simple completion  and,  if
    	      that generates no matches, case-insensitive completion:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
    
    	      By  default  each specification replaces the previous one; however, if a specifica‐
    	      tion is prefixed with +, it is added to the existing list.  Hence it is possible to
    	      create increasingly general specifications without repetition:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list \
    			    '' '+m:{a-z}={A-Z}' '+m:{A-Z}={a-z}'
    
    	      It  is  possible	to create match specifications valid for particular completers by
    	      using the third field of the context.  This applies only to completers  that  over‐
    	      ride  the  global  matcher-list, which as of this writing includes only _prefix and
    	      _ignored.  For example, to use the  completers  _complete  and  _prefix  but  allow
    	      case-insensitive completion only with _complete:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _prefix
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*:*:*' matcher-list \
    			    '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
    
    	      User-defined  names,  as	explained  for	the completer style, are available.  This
    	      makes it possible to try the same completer more than  once  with  different  match
    	      specifications  each  time.   For example, to try normal completion without a match
    	      specification, then normal completion with case-insensitive matching, then  correc‐
    	      tion, and finally partial-word completion:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
    			 _complete _correct _complete:foo
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*:*:*' matcher-list \
    			 '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:foo:*:*:*' matcher-list \
    			 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z} r:|[-_./]=* r:|=*'
    
    	      If  the style is unset in any context no match specification is applied.	Note also
    	      that some completers such as _correct and _approximate do not use the match  speci‐
    	      fications at all, though these completers will only ever be called once even if the
    	      matcher-list contains more than one element.
    
    	      Where multiple specifications are useful, note that the entire completion  is  done
    	      for each element of matcher-list, which can quickly reduce the shell's performance.
    	      As a rough rule of thumb, one to three strings will  give  acceptable  performance.
    	      On  the  other  hand,  putting multiple space-separated values into the same string
    	      does not have an appreciable impact on performance.
    
    	      If there is no current matcher or it is empty, and the option  NO_CASE_GLOB  is  in
    	      effect,  the  matching for files is performed case-insensitively in any case.  How‐
    	      ever, any matcher must explicitly specify  case-insensitive  matching  if  that  is
    	      required.
    
           max-errors
    	      This  is used by the _approximate and _correct completer functions to determine the
    	      maximum number of errors to allow.  The completer will try to generate  completions
    	      by  first  allowing  one error, then two errors, and so on, until either a match or
    	      matches were found or the maximum number of errors given by  this  style	has  been
    	      reached.
    
    	      If  the  value for this style contains the string `numeric', the completer function
    	      will take any numeric argument as the maximum number of errors allowed.  For  exam‐
    	      ple, with
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 2 numeric
    
    	      two errors are allowed if no numeric argument is given, but with a numeric argument
    	      of six (as in `ESC-6 TAB'), up to six errors are accepted.  Hence with a	value  of
    	      `0  numeric',  no correcting completion will be attempted unless a numeric argument
    	      is given.
    
    	      If the value contains the string `not-numeric', the completer will not try to  gen‐
    	      erate corrected completions when given a numeric argument, so in this case the num‐
    	      ber given should be greater than zero.  For example, `2 not-numeric' specifies that
    	      correcting  completion  with two errors will usually be performed, but if a numeric
    	      argument is given, correcting completion will not be performed.
    
    	      The default value for this style is `2 numeric'.
    
           max-matches-width
    	      This style is used to determine the trade off between the width of the display used
    	      for  matches and the width used for their descriptions when the verbose style is in
    	      effect.  The value gives the number of display columns to reserve for the  matches.
    	      The default is half the width of the screen.
    
    	      This has the most impact when several matches have the same description and so will
    	      be grouped together.  Increasing the style will allow more matches  to  be  grouped
    	      together; decreasing it will allow more of the description to be visible.
    
           menu   If this is `true' in the context of any of the tags defined for the current comple‐
    	      tion menu completion will be used.  The value for a specific tag will  take  prece‐
    	      dence over that for the `default' tag.
    
    	      If  none	of  the  values  found	in  this way is `true' but at least one is set to
    	      `auto', the shell behaves as if the AUTO_MENU option is set.
    
    	      If one of the values is explicitly set to `false', menu completion will be  explic‐
    	      itly turned off, overriding the MENU_COMPLETE option and other settings.
    
    	      In  the form `yes=num', where `yes' may be any of the `true' values (`yes', `true',
    	      `on' and `1'), menu completion will be turned on if there are at least num matches.
    	      In  the form `yes=long', menu completion will be turned on if the list does not fit
    	      on the screen.  This does not activate menu completion if the widget normally  only
    	      lists completions, but menu completion can be activated in that case with the value
    	      `yes=long-list' (Typically, the value `select=long-list' described  later  is  more
    	      useful as it provides control over scrolling.)
    
    	      Similarly, with any of the `false' values (as in `no=10'), menu completion will not
    	      be used if there are num or more matches.
    
    	      The value of this widget also  controls  menu  selection,  as  implemented  by  the
    	      zsh/complist  module.   The following values may appear either alongside or instead
    	      of the values above.
    
    	      If the value contains the string `select', menu selection will be started  uncondi‐
    	      tionally.
    
    	      In the form `select=num', menu selection will only be started if there are at least
    	      num matches.  If the values for more than one tag provide a  number,  the  smallest
    	      number is taken.
    
    	      Menu  selection  can  be	turned	off explicitly by defining a value containing the
    	      string`no-select'.
    
    	      It is also possible to start menu selection only if the list of  matches	does  not
    	      fit  on  the screen by using the value `select=long'.  To start menu selection even
    	      if the current widget only performs listing, use the value `select=long-list'.
    
    	      To turn on menu completion or menu selection when a there are a certain  number  of
    	      matches  or  the	list  of  matches  does not fit on the screen, both of `yes=' and
    	      `select=' may be	given  twice,  once  with  a  number  and  once  with  `long'  or
    	      `long-list'.
    
    	      Finally,	it is possible to activate two special modes of menu selection.  The word
    	      `interactive' in the value causes interactive mode to be entered	immediately  when
    	      menu  selection  is started; see the description of the zsh/complist module in zsh‐
    	      modules(1) for a description of interactive mode.  Including  the  string  `search'
    	      does  the same for incremental search mode.  To select backward incremental search,
    	      include the string `search-backward'.
    
           muttrc If set, gives the location of the mutt configuration file.  It defaults to `~/.mut‐
    	      trc'.
    
           numbers
    	      This  is used with the jobs tag.	If it is `true', the shell will complete job num‐
    	      bers instead of the shortest unambiguous prefix of the job command  text.   If  the
    	      value  is  a  number, job numbers will only be used if that many words from the job
    	      descriptions are required to resolve ambiguities.  For example,  if  the	value  is
    	      `1',  strings  will only be used if all jobs differ in the first word on their com‐
    	      mand lines.
    
           old-list
    	      This is used by the _oldlist completer.  If it is set to	`always',  then  standard
    	      widgets which perform listing will retain the current list of matches, however they
    	      were generated; this can be turned off explicitly with the  value  `never',  giving
    	      the  behaviour without the _oldlist completer.  If the style is unset, or any other
    	      value, then the existing list of completions is displayed if  it	is  not  already;
    	      otherwise, the standard completion list is generated; this is the default behaviour
    	      of _oldlist.  However, if there is an old list and this style contains the name  of
    	      the completer function that generated the list, then the old list will be used even
    	      if it was generated by a widget which does not do listing.
    
    	      For example, suppose you type ^Xc to use the _correct_word widget, which	generates
    	      a list of corrections for the word under the cursor.  Usually, typing ^D would gen‐
    	      erate a standard list of completions for the word on the	command  line,	and  show
    	      that.   With  _oldlist, it will instead show the list of corrections already gener‐
    	      ated.
    
    	      As another example consider the _match completer: with the insert-unambiguous style
    	      set  to  `true'  it inserts only a common prefix string, if there is any.  However,
    	      this may remove parts of the original pattern, so  that  further	completion  could
    	      produce  more  matches  than on the first attempt.  By using the _oldlist completer
    	      and setting this style to _match, the  list  of  matches	generated  on  the  first
    	      attempt will be used again.
    
           old-matches
    	      This  is	used  by  the  _all_matches completer to decide if an old list of matches
    	      should be used if one exists.  This is selected by one of the `true' values  or  by
    	      the  string `only'.  If the value is `only', _all_matches will only use an old list
    	      and won't have any effect on the list of matches currently being generated.
    
    	      If this style is set it is generally unwise  to  call  the  _all_matches	completer
    	      unconditionally.	 One possible use is for either this style or the completer style
    	      to be defined with the -e option to zstyle to make the style conditional.
    
           old-menu
    	      This is used by the _oldlist completer.  It controls how	menu  completion  behaves
    	      when  a  completion has already been inserted and the user types a standard comple‐
    	      tion key such as TAB.  The default behaviour of _oldlist is  that  menu  completion
    	      always  continues  with  the existing list of completions.  If this style is set to
    	      `false', however, a new completion is started if the old list was  generated  by	a
    	      different completion command; this is the behaviour without the _oldlist completer.
    
    	      For  example, suppose you type ^Xc to generate a list of corrections, and menu com‐
    	      pletion is started in one of the usual ways.  Usually, or with this  style  set  to
    	      `false', typing TAB at this point would start trying to complete the line as it now
    	      appears.	With _oldlist, it instead continues to cycle through the list of  correc‐
    	      tions.
    
           original
    	      This  is used by the _approximate and _correct completers to decide if the original
    	      string should be added as a possible completion.	Normally, this is  done  only  if
    	      there are at least two possible corrections, but if this style is set to `true', it
    	      is always added.	Note that the style will be examined with the completer field  in
    	      the  context name set to correct-num or approximate-num, where num is the number of
    	      errors that were accepted.
    
           packageset
    	      This style is used when completing arguments of the Debian `dpkg' program.  It con‐
    	      tains an override for the default package set for a given context.  For example,
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:dpkg:option--status-1:*' \
    				    packageset avail
    
    	      causes available packages, rather than only installed packages, to be completed for
    	      `dpkg --status'.
    
           path   The function that completes color names uses this style with the colors  tag.   The
    	      value  should  be the pathname of a file containing color names in the format of an
    	      X11 rgb.txt file.  If the style is not set but this file is found in one of various
    	      standard locations it will be used as the default.
    
           path-completion
    	      This  is used by filename completion.  By default, filename completion examines all
    	      components of a path to see if there are completions of that component.  For  exam‐
    	      ple,  /u/b/z  can  be  completed to /usr/bin/zsh.  Explicitly setting this style to
    	      `false' inhibits this behaviour for path components up to the / before the  cursor;
    	      this overrides the setting of accept-exact-dirs.
    
    	      Even with the style set to `false', it is still possible to complete multiple paths
    	      by setting the option COMPLETE_IN_WORD and moving the cursor back to the first com‐
    	      ponent  in  the  path  to  be  completed.   For example, /u/b/z can be completed to
    	      /usr/bin/zsh if the cursor is after the /u.
    
           pine-directory
    	      If set, specifies the  directory	containing  PINE  mailbox  files.   There  is  no
    	      default,	since recursively searching this directory is inconvenient for anyone who
    	      doesn't use PINE.
    
           ports  A list of Internet service names (network ports) to complete.  If this is not  set,
    	      service names are taken from the file `/etc/services'.
    
           prefix-hidden
    	      This  is used for certain completions which share a common prefix, for example com‐
    	      mand options beginning with dashes.  If it is `true', the prefix will not be  shown
    	      in the list of matches.
    
    	      The default value for this style is `false'.
    
           prefix-needed
    	      This  style  is  also  relevant  for matches with a common prefix.  If it is set to
    	      `true' this common prefix must be typed by the user to generate the matches.
    
    	      The style is applicable to the options, signals, jobs,  functions,  and  parameters
    	      completion tags.
    
    	      For  command  options,  this means that the initial `-', `+', or `--' must be typed
    	      explicitly before option names will be completed.
    
    	      For signals, an initial `-' is required before signal names will be completed.
    
    	      For jobs, an initial `%' is required before job names will be completed.
    
    	      For function and parameter names, an initial `_' or `.' is required before function
    	      or parameter names starting with those characters will be completed.
    
    	      The default value for this style is `false' for function and parameter completions,
    	      and  `true' otherwise.
    
           preserve-prefix
    	      This style is used when completing path names.   Its  value  should  be  a  pattern
    	      matching	an  initial  prefix of the word to complete that should be left unchanged
    	      under all circumstances.	For example, on  some  Unices  an  initial  `//'  (double
    	      slash)  has  a special meaning; setting this style to the string `//' will preserve
    	      it.  As another example, setting this style to `?:/' under Cygwin would allow  com‐
    	      pletion after `a:/...' and so on.
    
           range  This is used by the _history completer and the _history_complete_word bindable com‐
    	      mand to decide which words should be completed.
    
    	      If it is a single number, only the last N words from the history will be completed.
    
    	      If it is a range of the form `max:slice', the last slice words will  be  completed;
    	      then  if	that yields no matches, the slice words before those will be tried and so
    	      on.  This process stops either when at least one match has been found, or max words
    	      have been tried.
    
    	      The default is to complete all words from the history at once.
    
           recursive-files
    	      If  this	style  is  set,  its  value  is an array of patterns to be tested against
    	      `$PWD/': note the trailing slash, which allows directories in  the  pattern  to  be
    	      delimited  unambiguously	by  including slashes on both sides.  If an ordinary file
    	      completion fails and the word on the command line does not  yet  have  a	directory
    	      part  to	its name, the style is retrieved using the same tag as for the completion
    	      just attempted, then the elements tested against $PWD/ in turn.	If  one  matches,
    	      then  the  shell	reattempts  completion by prepending the word on the command line
    	      with each directory in the expansion of **/*(/) in turn.	Typically the elements of
    	      the style will be set to restrict the number of directories beneath the current one
    	      to a manageable number, for example `*/.git/*'.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' recursive-files '*/zsh/*'
    
    	      If the current directory is /home/pws/zsh/Src, then zle_trTAB can be  completed  to
    	      Zle/zle_tricky.c.
    
           regular
    	      This  style is used by the _expand_alias completer and bindable command.	If set to
    	      `true' (the default), regular aliases will be expanded but only  in  command  posi‐
    	      tion.   If it is set to `false', regular aliases will never be expanded.	 If it is
    	      set to `always', regular aliases will be expanded even if not in command position.
    
           rehash If this is set when completing external commands, the internal list (hash) of  com‐
    	      mands  will  be  updated for each search by issuing the rehash command.  There is a
    	      speed penalty for this which is only likely to be noticeable  when  directories  in
    	      the path have slow file access.
    
           remote-access
    	      If  set to `false', certain commands will be prevented from making Internet connec‐
    	      tions to retrieve remote information.  This includes the	completion  for  the  CVS
    	      command.
    
    	      It  is  not always possible to know if connections are in fact to a remote site, so
    	      some may be prevented unnecessarily.
    
           remove-all-dups
    	      The _history_complete_word bindable command and the _history completer use this  to
    	      decide  if  all  duplicate  matches should be removed, rather than just consecutive
    	      duplicates.
    
           select-prompt
    	      If this is set for the default tag, its value will be displayed during menu  selec‐
    	      tion (see the menu style above) when the completion list does not fit on the screen
    	      as a whole.  The same escapes as for the list-prompt style are  understood,  except
    	      that  the  numbers  refer to the match or line the mark is on.  A default prompt is
    	      used when the value is the empty string.
    
           select-scroll
    	      This style is tested for the default tag and determines how a  completion  list  is
    	      scrolled	during	a  menu  selection (see the menu style above) when the completion
    	      list does not fit on the screen as a whole.  If the value is `0' (zero),	the  list
    	      is  scrolled  by half-screenfuls; if it is a positive integer, the list is scrolled
    	      by the given number of lines; if it is a negative number, the list is scrolled by a
    	      screenful minus the absolute value of the given number of lines.	The default is to
    	      scroll by single lines.
    
           separate-sections
    	      This style is used with the manuals tag when completing names of manual pages.   If
    	      it  is  `true', entries for different sections are added separately using tag names
    	      of the form `manual.X', where X is the section number.  When the	group-name  style
    	      is  also	in  effect,  pages  from different sections will appear separately.  This
    	      style is also used similarly with the words style when  completing  words  for  the
    	      dict command. It allows words from different dictionary databases to be added sepa‐
    	      rately.  The default for this style is `false'.
    
           show-ambiguity
    	      If the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used to highlight the first
    	      ambiguous  character  in	completion  lists. The value is either a color indication
    	      such as those supported by the list-colors style or, with  a  value  of  `true',	a
    	      default of underlining is selected. The highlighting is only applied if the comple‐
    	      tion display strings correspond to the actual matches.
    
           show-completer
    	      Tested whenever a new completer is tried.  If it is `true', the  completion  system
    	      outputs  a  progress  message  in  the listing area showing what completer is being
    	      tried.  The message will be overwritten by any output when  completions  are  found
    	      and is removed after completion is finished.
    
           single-ignored
    	      This  is used by the _ignored completer when there is only one match.  If its value
    	      is `show', the single match will be displayed but not inserted.  If  the	value  is
    	      `menu', then the single match and the original string are both added as matches and
    	      menu completion is started, making it easy to select either of them.
    
           sort   Many completion widgets call _description at some point which decides  whether  the
    	      matches  are added sorted or unsorted (often indirectly via _wanted or _requested).
    	      This style can be set explicitly to one of the usual `true' or `false' values as an
    	      override.   If it is not set for the context, the standard behaviour of the calling
    	      widget is used.
    
    	      The style is tested first against the full context including the tag, and  if  that
    	      fails to produce a value against the context without the tag.
    
    	      If  the  calling	widget explicitly requests unsorted matches, this is usually hon‐
    	      oured.  However, the default (unsorted) behaviour of  completion	for  the  command
    	      history may be overridden by setting the style to `true'.
    
    	      In  the  _expand	completer,  if it is set to `true', the expansions generated will
    	      always be sorted.  If it is set to `menu', then the expansions are only sorted when
    	      they  are  offered  as single strings but not in the string containing all possible
    	      expansions.
    
           special-dirs
    	      Normally, the completion code will not produce the directory names `.' and `..'  as
    	      possible	completions.   If  this  style is set to `true', it will add both `.' and
    	      `..' as possible completions; if it is set to `..', only `..' will be added.
    
    	      The following example sets special-dirs to `..' when the current prefix  is  empty,
    	      is  a  single  `.', or consists only of a path beginning with `../'.  Otherwise the
    	      value is `false'.
    
    		     zstyle -e ':completion:*' special-dirs \
    			'[[ $PREFIX = (../)#(|.|..) ]] && reply=(..)'
    
           squeeze-slashes
    	      If set  to  `true',  sequences  of  slashes  in  filename  paths	(for  example  in
    	      `foo//bar') will be treated as a single slash.  This is the usual behaviour of UNIX
    	      paths.  However, by default the file completion function behaves as if there were a
    	      `*' between the slashes.
    
           stop   If  set  to `true', the _history_complete_word bindable command will stop once when
    	      reaching the beginning or end of the history.  Invoking _history_complete_word will
    	      then  wrap  around  to  the  opposite  end of the history.  If this style is set to
    	      `false' (the default), _history_complete_word will loop immediately as  in  a  menu
    	      completion.
    
           strip-comments
    	      If  set  to `true', this style causes non-essential comment text to be removed from
    	      completion matches.  Currently it is only used  when  completing	e-mail	addresses
    	      where  it  removes  any display name from the addresses, cutting them down to plain
    	      user@host form.
    
           subst-globs-only
    	      This is used by the _expand completer.  If it is set to `true', the expansion  will
    	      only  be	used if it resulted from globbing; hence, if expansions resulted from the
    	      use of the substitute style described below, but these were not further changed  by
    	      globbing, the expansions will be rejected.
    
    	      The default for this style is `false'.
    
           substitute
    	      This  boolean style controls whether the _expand completer will first try to expand
    	      all substitutions in the string (such as `$(...)' and `${...}').
    
    	      The default is `true'.
    
           suffix This is used by the _expand completer if the word starts with a tilde or contains a
    	      parameter  expansion.  If it is set to `true', the word will only be expanded if it
    	      doesn't have a suffix, i.e. if it is something like `~foo' or  `$foo'  rather  than
    	      `~foo/'  or  `$foo/bar', unless that suffix itself contains characters eligible for
    	      expansion.  The default for this style is `true'.
    
           tag-order
    	      This provides a mechanism for sorting how the tags available in a  particular  con‐
    	      text will be used.
    
    	      The  values  for	the style are sets of space-separated lists of tags.  The tags in
    	      each value will be tried at the same time; if no match is found, the next value  is
    	      used.  (See the file-patterns style for an exception to this behavior.)
    
    	      For example:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:-command-:*:*' tag-order \
    			 'commands functions'
    
    	      specifies  that  completion  in command position first offers external commands and
    	      shell functions.	Remaining tags will be tried if no completions are found.
    
    	      In addition to tag names, each string in the value may take one  of  the	following
    	      forms:
    
    	      -      If  any value consists of only a hyphen, then only the tags specified in the
    		     other values are generated.  Normally all tags not explicitly  selected  are
    		     tried  last  if the specified tags fail to generate any matches.  This means
    		     that a single value consisting only of a single hyphen turns off completion.
    
    	      ! tags...
    		     A string starting with an exclamation mark specifies names of tags that  are
    		     not  to  be  used.  The effect is the same as if all other possible tags for
    		     the context had been listed.
    
    	      tag:label ...
    		     Here, tag is one of the standard  tags  and  label  is  an  arbitrary  name.
    		     Matches  are  generated  as  normal  but  the name label is used in contexts
    		     instead of tag.  This is not useful in words starting with !.
    
    		     If the label starts with a hyphen, the tag is prepended to the label to form
    		     the  name	used  for lookup.  This can be used to make the completion system
    		     try a certain tag more than once, supplying  different  style  settings  for
    		     each attempt; see below for an example.
    
    	      tag:label:description
    		     As  before, but description will replace the `%d' in the value of the format
    		     style instead of the default description supplied by  the	completion  func‐
    		     tion.   Spaces  in  the description must be quoted with a backslash.  A `%d'
    		     appearing in description is replaced with the description given by the  com‐
    		     pletion function.
    
    	      In  any of the forms above the tag may be a pattern or several patterns in the form
    	      `{pat1,pat2...}'.  In this case all matching tags will be used except for any given
    	      explicitly in the same string.
    
    	      One  use	of  these features is to try one tag more than once, setting other styles
    	      differently on each attempt, but still to use all the other tags without having  to
    	      repeat  them  all.   For	example,  to make completion of function names in command
    	      position ignore all the completion functions starting with an underscore the  first
    	      time completion is tried:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:*' tag-order \
    			 'functions:-non-comp *' functions
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:functions-non-comp' \
    			 ignored-patterns '_*'
    
    	      On  the  first  attempt,	all  tags  will  be offered but the functions tag will be
    	      replaced by functions-non-comp.  The ignored-patterns style is set for this tag  to
    	      exclude functions starting with an underscore.  If there are no matches, the second
    	      value of the tag-order style is used which completes functions  using  the  default
    	      tag, this time presumably including all function names.
    
    	      The matches for one tag can be split into different groups.  For example:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' tag-order \
    			 'options:-long:long\ options
    			  options:-short:short\ options
    			  options:-single-letter:single\ letter\ options'
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:options-long' \
    			  ignored-patterns '[-+](|-|[^-]*)'
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:options-short' \
    			  ignored-patterns '--*' '[-+]?'
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:options-single-letter' \
    			  ignored-patterns '???*'
    
    	      With the group-names style set, options beginning with `--', options beginning with
    	      a single `-' or `+' but containing multiple characters, and  single-letter  options
    	      will be displayed in separate groups with different descriptions.
    
    	      Another  use of patterns is to try multiple match specifications one after another.
    	      The matcher-list style offers something similar, but it is tested very early in the
    	      completion  system and hence can't be set for single commands nor for more specific
    	      contexts.  Here is how to try normal completion  without	any  match  specification
    	      and,  if	that  generates  no  matches,  try  again with case-insensitive matching,
    	      restricting the effect to arguments of the command foo:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:foo:*:*' tag-order '*' '*:-case'
    		     zstyle ':completion:*-case' matcher 'm:{a-z}={A-Z}'
    
    	      First, all the tags offered when completing after foo are tried  using  the  normal
    	      tag  name.   If  that  generates no matches, the second value of tag-order is used,
    	      which tries all tags again except that this time each has  -case	appended  to  its
    	      name  for  lookup  of styles.  Hence this time the value for the matcher style from
    	      the second call to zstyle in the example is used to make	completion  case-insensi‐
    	      tive.
    
    	      It is possible to use the -e option of the zstyle builtin command to specify condi‐
    	      tions for the use of particular tags.  For example:
    
    		     zstyle -e '*:-command-:*' tag-order '
    			 if [[ -n $PREFIX$SUFFIX ]]; then
    			   reply=( )
    			 else
    			   reply=( - )
    			 fi'
    
    	      Completion in command position will be attempted only if the string typed so far is
    	      not empty.  This is tested using the PREFIX special parameter; see zshcompwid for a
    	      description of parameters which are special  inside  completion  widgets.   Setting
    	      reply  to an empty array provides the default behaviour of trying all tags at once;
    	      setting it to an array containing only a hyphen disables the use of  all	tags  and
    	      hence of all completions.
    
    	      If  no tag-order style has been defined for a context, the strings `(|*-)argument-*
    	      (|*-)option-* values' and `options' plus all tags offered by the	completion  func‐
    	      tion  will  be  used  to	provide a sensible default behavior that causes arguments
    	      (whether normal command arguments or arguments of options) to be	completed  before
    	      option names for most commands.
    
           urls   This is used together with the urls tag by functions completing URLs.
    
    	      If  the value consists of more than one string, or if the only string does not name
    	      a file or directory, the strings are used as the URLs to complete.
    
    	      If the value contains only one string which is the name of a normal file	the  URLs
    	      are  taken  from	that file (where the URLs may be separated by white space or new‐
    	      lines).
    
    	      Finally, if the only string in the value names a directory, the directory hierarchy
    	      rooted  at this directory gives the completions.	The top level directory should be
    	      the file access method, such as `http', `ftp', `bookmark' and so on.  In many cases
    	      the  next  level	of  directories  will be a filename.  The directory hierarchy can
    	      descend as deep as necessary.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' urls ~/.urls
    		     mkdir -p ~/.urls/ftp/ftp.zsh.org/pub
    
    	      allows completion of all the components  of  the	URL  ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub  after
    	      suitable commands such as `netscape' or `lynx'.  Note, however, that access methods
    	      and files are completed separately, so if the hosts style is set hosts can be  com‐
    	      pleted without reference to the urls style.
    
    	      See  the	description in the function _urls itself for more information (e.g. `more
    	      $^fpath/_urls(N)').
    
           use-cache
    	      If this is set, the completion caching layer is activated for any completions which
    	      use  it (via the _store_cache, _retrieve_cache, and _cache_invalid functions).  The
    	      directory containing the cache files can be changed with the cache-path style.
    
           use-compctl
    	      If this style is set to a string not equal to false, 0, no, and off, the completion
    	      system  may use any completion specifications defined with the compctl builtin com‐
    	      mand.  If the style is unset, this is  done  only  if  the  zsh/compctl  module  is
    	      loaded.	The  string  may  also	contain  the substring `first' to use completions
    	      defined with `compctl -T', and  the  substring  `default'  to  use  the  completion
    	      defined with `compctl -D'.
    
    	      Note  that  this	is only intended to smooth the transition from compctl to the new
    	      completion system and may disappear in the future.
    
    	      Note also that the definitions from compctl will only be used if there is  no  spe‐
    	      cific  completion function for the command in question.  For example, if there is a
    	      function _foo to complete arguments to the  command  foo,  compctl  will	never  be
    	      invoked  for  foo.   However,  the  compctl  version will be tried if foo only uses
    	      default completion.
    
           use-ip By default, the function _hosts that completes host names strips IP addresses  from
    	      entries  read  from  host  databases  such  as NIS and ssh files.  If this style is
    	      `true', the corresponding IP addresses can be completed as well.	This style is not
    	      use  in  any  context where the hosts style is set; note also it must be set before
    	      the cache of host names is generated (typically the first completion attempt).
    
           users  This may be set to a list of usernames to be completed.  If it is not set all user‐
    	      names  will  be  completed.  Note that if it is set only that list of users will be
    	      completed; this is because on some systems querying all users can take  a  prohibi‐
    	      tive amount of time.
    
           users-hosts
    	      The  values  of  this style should be of the form `user@host' or `user:host'. It is
    	      used for commands that need pairs of user- and hostnames.  These commands will com‐
    	      plete  usernames from this style (only), and will restrict subsequent hostname com‐
    	      pletion to hosts paired with that user in one of the values of the style.
    
    	      It is possible to group values for sets of commands which  allow	a  remote  login,
    	      such  as	rlogin and ssh, by using the my-accounts tag.  Similarly, values for sets
    	      of commands which usually refer to the accounts of other people, such as	talk  and
    	      finger,  can  be grouped by using the other-accounts tag.  More ambivalent commands
    	      may use the accounts tag.
    
           users-hosts-ports
    	      Like users-hosts but used for commands like telnet and containing  strings  of  the
    	      form `user@host:port'.
    
           verbose
    	      If set, as it is by default, the completion listing is more verbose.  In particular
    	      many commands show descriptions for options if this style is `true'.
    
           word   This is used by the _list completer, which prevents the  insertion  of  completions
    	      until a second completion attempt when the line has not changed.	The normal way of
    	      finding out if the line has changed is to compare its entire contents  between  the
    	      two  occasions.	If this style is `true', the comparison is instead performed only
    	      on the current word.  Hence if completion is performed on  another  word	with  the
    	      same contents, completion will not be delayed.
    
    CONTROL FUNCTIONS
           The  initialization  script compinit redefines all the widgets which perform completion to
           call the supplied widget function _main_complete.  This function acts as a wrapper calling
           the  so-called  `completer'  functions that generate matches.  If _main_complete is called
           with arguments, these are taken as the names of completer functions to be  called  in  the
           order  given.   If  no  arguments are given, the set of functions to try is taken from the
           completer style.  For example, to use normal completion and  correction	if  that  doesn't
           generate any matches:
    
    	      zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct
    
           after  calling  compinit.  The  default value for this style is `_complete _ignored', i.e.
           normally only ordinary completion is tried, first with the effect of the  ignored-patterns
           style and then without it.  The _main_complete function uses the return status of the com‐
           pleter functions to decide if other completers should be called.  If the return status  is
           zero, no other completers are tried and the _main_complete function returns.
    
           If  the	first  argument  to  _main_complete is a single hyphen, the arguments will not be
           taken as names of completers.  Instead, the second argument gives a name  to  use  in  the
           completer  field  of the context and the other arguments give a command name and arguments
           to call to generate the matches.
    
           The following completer functions are contained in the distribution,  although  users  may
           write  their  own.   Note that in contexts the leading underscore is stripped, for example
           basic completion is performed in the context `:completion::complete:...'.
    
           _all_matches
    	      This completer can be used to add a string consisting of all other matches.  As  it
    	      influences later completers it must appear as the first completer in the list.  The
    	      list of all matches is affected  by  the	avoid-completer  and  old-matches  styles
    	      described above.
    
    	      It  may be useful to use the _generic function described below to bind _all_matches
    	      to its own keystroke, for example:
    
    		     zle -C all-matches complete-word _generic
    		     bindkey '^Xa' all-matches
    		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' old-matches only
    		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer _all_matches
    
    	      Note that this does not generate completions by itself:  first use any of the stan‐
    	      dard  ways  of  generating a list of completions, then use ^Xa to show all matches.
    	      It is possible instead to add a standard completer to the list and request that the
    	      list of all matches should be directly inserted:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer \
    			    _all_matches _complete
    		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' insert true
    
    	      In this case the old-matches style should not be set.
    
           _approximate
    	      This  is	similar  to  the  basic _complete completer but allows the completions to
    	      undergo corrections.  The  maximum  number  of  errors  can  be  specified  by  the
    	      max-errors style; see the description of approximate matching in zshexpn(1) for how
    	      errors are counted.  Normally this completer will only be tried  after  the  normal
    	      _complete completer:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _approximate
    
    	      This  will  give	correcting  completion if and only if normal completion yields no
    	      possible completions.  When corrected completions are  found,  the  completer  will
    	      normally start menu completion allowing you to cycle through these strings.
    
    	      This  completer uses the tags corrections and original when generating the possible
    	      corrections and the original string.  The format style for the former  may  contain
    	      the  additional  sequences  `%e'	and  `%o' which will be replaced by the number of
    	      errors accepted to generate the corrections and the original string, respectively.
    
    	      The completer progressively increases the number of errors allowed up to the  limit
    	      by  the max-errors style, hence if a completion is found with one error, no comple‐
    	      tions with two errors will be shown, and so on.  It modifies the completer name  in
    	      the context to indicate the number of errors being tried: on the first try the com‐
    	      pleter field contains `approximate-1', on the second try	`approximate-2',  and  so
    	      on.
    
    	      When  _approximate  is called from another function, the number of errors to accept
    	      may be passed with the -a option.  The argument  is  in  the  same  format  as  the
    	      max-errors style, all in one string.
    
    	      Note  that this completer (and the _correct completer mentioned below) can be quite
    	      expensive to call, especially when a large number of errors are allowed.	 One  way
    	      to  avoid  this  is  to set up the completer style using the -e option to zstyle so
    	      that some completers are only used when completion is attempted a  second  time  on
    	      the same string, e.g.:
    
    		     zstyle -e ':completion:*' completer '
    		       if [[ $_last_try != "$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR" ]]; then
    			 _last_try="$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR"
    			 reply=(_complete _match _prefix)
    		       else
    			 reply=(_ignored _correct _approximate)
    		       fi'
    
    	      This  uses  the  HISTNO parameter and the BUFFER and CURSOR special parameters that
    	      are available inside zle and completion widgets to find out  if  the  command  line
    	      hasn't  changed  since  the  last  time  completion  was	tried.	Only then are the
    	      _ignored, _correct and _approximate completers called.
    
           _complete
    	      This completer generates all possible completions in  a  context-sensitive  manner,
    	      i.e.  using  the settings defined with the compdef function explained above and the
    	      current settings of all special parameters.  This gives the normal  completion  be‐
    	      haviour.
    
    	      To  complete  arguments  of  commands, _complete uses the utility function _normal,
    	      which is in turn responsible for finding the particular function; it  is	described
    	      below.   Various contexts of the form -context- are handled specifically. These are
    	      all mentioned above as possible arguments to the #compdef tag.
    
    	      Before trying to find a function for a specific context, _complete  checks  if  the
    	      parameter  `compcontext'	is set. Setting `compcontext' allows the usual completion
    	      dispatching to be overridden which is useful in places such as a function that uses
    	      vared  for input. If it is set to an array, the elements are taken to be the possi‐
    	      ble matches which will be completed using the  tag  `values'  and  the  description
    	      `value'.	If  it	is set to an associative array, the keys are used as the possible
    	      completions and the values (if non-empty) are used as descriptions for the matches.
    	      If  `compcontext'  is  set  to a string containing colons, it should be of the form
    	      `tag:descr:action'.  In this case the tag and descr give the tag and description to
    	      use  and the action indicates what should be completed in one of the forms accepted
    	      by the _arguments utility function described below.
    
    	      Finally, if `compcontext' is set to a string without colons, the value is taken  as
    	      the  name  of  the context to use and the function defined for that context will be
    	      called.  For this purpose, there is a special  context  named  -command-line-  that
    	      completes  whole command lines (commands and their arguments).  This is not used by
    	      the completion system itself but is nonetheless handled when explicitly called.
    
           _correct
    	      Generate corrections, but not completions, for the current word; this is similar to
    	      _approximate  but  will  not  allow any number of extra characters at the cursor as
    	      that completer does.  The effect is similar to  spell-checking.	It  is	based  on
    	      _approximate, but the completer field in the context name is correct.
    
    	      For example, with:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:::::' completer \
    			    _complete _correct _approximate
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:correct:::' max-errors 2 not-numeric
    		     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 3 numeric
    
    	      correction  will	accept up to two errors.  If a numeric argument is given, correc‐
    	      tion will not be performed, but correcting completion will be, and will  accept  as
    	      many  errors  as	given by the numeric argument.	Without a numeric argument, first
    	      correction and then correcting completion will be tried, with the first one accept‐
    	      ing two errors and the second one accepting three errors.
    
    	      When  _correct is called as a function, the number of errors to accept may be given
    	      following the -a option.	The argument is in the same form a values to  the  accept
    	      style, all in one string.
    
    	      This  completer  function is intended to be used without the _approximate completer
    	      or, as in the example, just before it.  Using it after the  _approximate	completer
    	      is  useless  since _approximate will at least generate the corrected strings gener‐
    	      ated by the _correct completer -- and probably more.
    
           _expand
    	      This completer function does not really perform completion, but instead  checks  if
    	      the  word  on  the  command  line  is  eligible  for expansion and, if it is, gives
    	      detailed control over how this expansion is done.  For this to happen, the  comple‐
    	      tion  system  needs  to  be invoked with complete-word, not expand-or-complete (the
    	      default binding for TAB), as otherwise the string will be expanded by  the  shell's
    	      internal	mechanism  before  the completion system is started.  Note also this com‐
    	      pleter should be called before the _complete completer function.
    
    	      The tags used when generating expansions are all-expansions for the string contain‐
    	      ing all possible expansions, expansions when adding the possible expansions as sin‐
    	      gle matches and original when adding the original string from the line.  The  order
    	      in  which  these	strings  are  generated,  if  at  all,	can  be controlled by the
    	      group-order and tag-order styles, as usual.
    
    	      The format string for all-expansions and for expansions may  contain  the  sequence
    	      `%o' which will be replaced by the original string from the line.
    
    	      The  kind  of  expansion	to  be	tried  is  controlled by the substitute, glob and
    	      subst-globs-only styles.
    
    	      It is also possible to call _expand as a function,  in  which  case  the	different
    	      modes  may  be  selected	with  options:	-s for substitute, -g for glob and -o for
    	      subst-globs-only.
    
           _expand_alias
    	      If the word the cursor is on is an alias, it is expanded and  no	other  completers
    	      are  called.   The types of aliases which are to be expanded can be controlled with
    	      the styles regular, global and disabled.
    
    	      This function is also a bindable	command,  see  the  section  `Bindable	Commands'
    	      below.
    
           _extensions
    	      If  the  cursor  follows	the  string  `*.', filename extensions are completed. The
    	      extensions are taken from files in current directory or a  directory  specified  at
    	      the beginning of the current word. For exact matches, completion continues to allow
    	      other completers such as _expand to expand the pattern. The standard add-space  and
    	      prefix-hidden styles are observed.
    
           _history
    	      Complete words from the shell's command  history.  This completer can be controlled
    	      by the remove-all-dups, and sort styles as for the _history_complete_word  bindable
    	      command, see the section `Bindable Commands' below and the section `Completion Sys‐
    	      tem Configuration' above.
    
           _ignored
    	      The ignored-patterns style can be set to a list  of  patterns  which  are  compared
    	      against possible completions; matching ones are removed.	With this completer those
    	      matches can be reinstated, as if no ignored-patterns style were set.  The completer
    	      actually	generates its own list of matches; which completers are invoked is deter‐
    	      mined in the same way as for the _prefix completer.  The	single-ignored	style  is
    	      also available as described above.
    
           _list  This  completer  allows  the insertion of matches to be delayed until completion is
    	      attempted a second time without the word on the line being changed.  On  the  first
    	      attempt, only the list of matches will be shown.	It is affected by the styles con‐
    	      dition and word, see the section `Completion System Configuration' above.
    
           _match This completer is intended to be used after the _complete  completer.   It  behaves
    	      similarly  but  the  string  on  the command line may be a pattern to match against
    	      trial completions.  This gives the effect of the GLOB_COMPLETE option.
    
    	      Normally completion will be performed by taking the pattern from the line,  insert‐
    	      ing  a `*' at the cursor position and comparing the resulting pattern with the pos‐
    	      sible completions generated.  This can be modified with  the  match-original  style
    	      described above.
    
    	      The  generated matches will be offered in a menu completion unless the insert-unam‐
    	      biguous style is set to `true'; see the description above  for  other  options  for
    	      this style.
    
    	      Note  that  matcher specifications defined globally or used by the completion func‐
    	      tions (the styles matcher-list and matcher) will not be used.
    
           _menu  This completer was written as simple example function to show how  menu  completion
    	      can  be enabled in shell code. However, it has the notable effect of disabling menu
    	      selection which can be useful with _generic based widgets. It should be used as the
    	      first  completer	in the list.  Note that this is independent of the setting of the
    	      MENU_COMPLETE option and does not work with the other menu completion widgets  such
    	      as reverse-menu-complete, or accept-and-menu-complete.
    
           _oldlist
    	      This completer controls how the standard completion widgets behave when there is an
    	      existing list of completions which may have been generated by a special  completion
    	      (i.e.  a	separately-bound  completion command).	It allows the ordinary completion
    	      keys to continue to use the list of completions thus generated, instead of  produc‐
    	      ing a new list of ordinary contextual completions.  It should appear in the list of
    	      completers before any of the widgets which generate matches.  It uses  two  styles:
    	      old-list and old-menu, see the section `Completion System Configuration' above.
    
           _prefix
    	      This  completer can be used to try completion with the suffix (everything after the
    	      cursor) ignored.	In other words, the suffix will not be considered to be  part  of
    	      the  word to complete.  The effect is similar to the expand-or-complete-prefix com‐
    	      mand.
    
    	      The completer style is used to decide which other completers are to  be  called  to
    	      generate	matches.  If this style is unset, the list of completers set for the cur‐
    	      rent context is used -- except, of course, the _prefix completer itself.	 Further‐
    	      more, if this completer appears more than once in the list of completers only those
    	      completers not already tried by the last invocation of _prefix will be called.
    
    	      For example, consider this global completer style:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
    			 _complete _prefix _correct _prefix:foo
    
    	      Here, the _prefix completer tries normal completion but ignoring	the  suffix.   If
    	      that  doesn't  generate any matches, and neither does the call to the _correct com‐
    	      pleter after it, _prefix will be called a second time and, now only trying  correc‐
    	      tion  with  the suffix ignored.  On the second invocation the completer part of the
    	      context appears as `foo'.
    
    	      To use _prefix as the last resort  and  try  only  normal  completion  when  it  is
    	      invoked:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete ... _prefix
    		     zstyle ':completion::prefix:*' completer _complete
    
    	      The  add-space  style  is also respected.  If it is set to `true' then _prefix will
    	      insert a space between the matches generated (if any) and the suffix.
    
    	      Note that this completer is only useful if the COMPLETE_IN_WORD option is set; oth‐
    	      erwise,  the cursor will be moved to the end of the current word before the comple‐
    	      tion code is called and hence there will be no suffix.
    
           _user_expand
    	      This completer behaves similarly to the  _expand	completer  but	instead  performs
    	      expansions  defined by users.  The styles add-space and sort styles specific to the
    	      _expand completer are usable with _user_expand in addition to other styles  handled
    	      more generally by the completion system.	The tag all-expansions is also available.
    
    	      The  expansion depends on the array style user-expand being defined for the current
    	      context; remember that the context for completers is less specific  than	that  for
    	      contextual completion as the full context has not yet been determined.  Elements of
    	      the array may have one of the following forms:
    	      $hash
    
    		     hash is the name of an associative array.	Note this is not a full parameter
    		     expression, merely a $, suitably quoted to prevent immediate expansion, fol‐
    		     lowed by the name of an associative array.   If  the  trial  expansion  word
    		     matches a key in hash, the resulting expansion is the corresponding value.
    	      _func
    
    		     _func  is	the  name of a shell function whose name must begin with _ but is
    		     not otherwise special to the completion system.  The function is called with
    		     the  trial word as an argument.  If the word is to be expanded, the function
    		     should set the array reply to a list of expansions.  Optionally, it can  set
    		     REPLY  to	a  word  that will be used as a description for the set of expan‐
    		     sions.  The return status of the function is irrelevant.
    BINDABLE COMMANDS
           In addition to the context-dependent completions provided, which are expected to  work  in
           an  intuitively	obvious way, there are a few widgets implementing special behaviour which
           can be bound separately to keys.  The following is a list of these and their default bind‐
           ings.
    
           _bash_completions
    	      This  function  is used by two widgets, _bash_complete-word and _bash_list-choices.
    	      It exists to provide compatibility with completion  bindings  in	bash.	The  last
    	      character  of  the  binding  determines what is completed: `!', command names; `$',
    	      environment variables; `@', host names; `/', file names; `~' user names.	In  bash,
    	      the  binding preceded by `\e' gives completion, and preceded by `^X' lists options.
    	      As some of these bindings clash with standard zsh bindings, only	`\e~'  and  `^X~'
    	      are  bound  by  default.	 To add the rest, the following should be added to .zshrc
    	      after compinit has been run:
    
    		     for key in '!' '$' '@' '/' '~'; do
    		       bindkey "\e$key" _bash_complete-word
    		       bindkey "^X$key" _bash_list-choices
    		     done
    
    	      This includes the bindings for `~' in case they were  already  bound  to	something
    	      else; the completion code does not override user bindings.
    
           _correct_filename (^XC)
    	      Correct  the  filename path at the cursor position.  Allows up to six errors in the
    	      name.  Can also be called with an argument to correct  a	filename  path,  indepen‐
    	      dently of zle; the correction is printed on standard output.
    
           _correct_word (^Xc)
    	      Performs	correction of the current argument using the usual contextual completions
    	      as possible choices. This stores the string `correct-word' in the function field of
    	      the context name and then calls the _correct completer.
    
           _expand_alias (^Xa)
    	      This function can be used as a completer and as a bindable command.  It expands the
    	      word the cursor is on if it is an alias.	The types of alias expanded can  be  con‐
    	      trolled with the styles regular, global and disabled.
    
    	      When  used  as  a  bindable  command  there  is  one additional feature that can be
    	      selected by setting the complete style to `true'.  In this case, if the word is not
    	      the name of an alias, _expand_alias tries to complete the word to a full alias name
    	      without expanding it.  It leaves the cursor directly after the  completed  word  so
    	      that invoking _expand_alias once more will expand the now-complete alias name.
    
           _expand_word (^Xe)
    	      Performs	expansion  on  the  current word:  equivalent to the standard expand-word
    	      command, but using the _expand completer.  Before calling it, the function field of
    	      the context is set to `expand-word'.
    
           _generic
    	      This function is not defined as a widget and not bound by default.  However, it can
    	      be used to define a widget and will then store the name of the widget in the  func‐
    	      tion  field of the context and call the completion system.  This allows custom com‐
    	      pletion widgets with their own set of style settings to  be  defined  easily.   For
    	      example,	to define a widget that performs normal completion and starts menu selec‐
    	      tion:
    
    		     zle -C foo complete-word _generic
    		     bindkey '...' foo
    		     zstyle ':completion:foo:*' menu yes select=1
    
    	      Note in particular that the completer style may be set for the context in order  to
    	      change  the  set	of  functions  used to generate possible matches.  If _generic is
    	      called with arguments, those are passed through to _main_complete as  the  list  of
    	      completers in place of those defined by the completer style.
    
           _history_complete_word (\e/)
    	      Complete	 words	 from	the   shell's	command  history.  This  uses  the  list,
    	      remove-all-dups, sort, and stop styles.
    
           _most_recent_file (^Xm)
    	      Complete the name of the most recently modified file matching the  pattern  on  the
    	      command line (which may be blank).  If given a numeric argument N, complete the Nth
    	      most recently modified file.  Note the completion, if any, is always unique.
    
           _next_tags (^Xn)
    	      This command alters the set of matches used to that for the next	tag,  or  set  of
    	      tags,  either  as  given by the tag-order style or as set by default; these matches
    	      would otherwise not be available.  Successive  invocations  of  the  command  cycle
    	      through all possible sets of tags.
    
           _read_comp (^X^R)
    	      Prompt  the  user  for  a string, and use that to perform completion on the current
    	      word.  There are two possibilities for the string.  First, it can be a set of words
    	      beginning  `_',  for example `_files -/', in which case the function with any argu‐
    	      ments will be called to generate the completions.  Unambiguous parts of  the  func‐
    	      tion  name  will	be completed automatically (normal completion is not available at
    	      this point) until a space is typed.
    
    	      Second, any other string will be passed as a set of arguments to compadd and should
    	      hence be an expression specifying what should be completed.
    
    	      A  very  restricted  set	of editing commands is available when reading the string:
    	      `DEL' and `^H' delete the last character; `^U' deletes the line, and `^C' and  `^G'
    	      abort  the  function,  while `RET' accepts the completion.  Note the string is used
    	      verbatim as a command line, so arguments must be quoted in accordance with standard
    	      shell rules.
    
    	      Once  a  string  has  been  read, the next call to _read_comp will use the existing
    	      string instead of reading a new one.  To force  a  new  string  to  be  read,  call
    	      _read_comp with a numeric argument.
    
           _complete_debug (^X?)
    	      This  widget performs ordinary completion, but captures in a temporary file a trace
    	      of the shell commands executed by the completion system.	Each  completion  attempt
    	      gets its own file.  A command to view each of these files is pushed onto the editor
    	      buffer stack.
    
           _complete_help (^Xh)
    	      This widget displays information about the context names, the tags, and the comple‐
    	      tion  functions  used  when  completing  at the current cursor position. If given a
    	      numeric argument other than 1 (as in `ESC-2 ^Xh'), then the  styles  used  and  the
    	      contexts for which they are used will be shown, too.
    
    	      Note  that the information about styles may be incomplete; it depends on the infor‐
    	      mation available from the completion functions called, which in turn is  determined
    	      by the user's own styles and other settings.
    
           _complete_help_generic
    	      Unlike  other  commands  listed  here,  this must be created as a normal ZLE widget
    	      rather than a completion widget (i.e. with zle -N).  It is used for generating help
    	      with a widget bound to the _generic widget that is described above.
    
    	      If this widget is created using the name of the function, as it is by default, then
    	      when executed it will read a key sequence.  This is expected to be bound to a  call
    	      to  a  completion function that uses the _generic widget.  That widget will be exe‐
    	      cuted, and information provided in the same format that the  _complete_help  widget
    	      displays for contextual completion.
    
    	      If  the widget's name contains debug, for example if it is created as `zle -N _com‐
    	      plete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic', it will read and execute the keystring
    	      for  a generic widget as before, but then generate debugging information as done by
    	      _complete_debug for contextual completion.
    
    	      If the widget's name contains noread, it will not  read  a  keystring  but  instead
    	      arrange  that  the next use of a generic widget run in the same shell will have the
    	      effect as described above.
    
    	      The widget works by setting the shell parameter ZSH_TRACE_GENERIC_WIDGET	which  is
    	      read by _generic.  Unsetting the parameter cancels any pending effect of the noread
    	      form.
    
    	      For example, after executing the following:
    
    		     zle -N _complete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic
    		     bindkey '^x:' _complete_debug_generic
    
    	      typing `C-x :' followed by the key sequence for a generic widget will  cause  trace
    	      output for that widget to be saved to a file.
    
           _complete_tag (^Xt)
    	      This  widget  completes  symbol tags created by the etags or ctags programmes (note
    	      there is no connection with the completion system's tags) stored in a file TAGS, in
    	      the  format  used  by etags, or tags, in the format created by ctags.  It will look
    	      back up the path hierarchy for the first occurrence of either file; if both  exist,
    	      the  file  TAGS is preferred.  You can specify the full path to a TAGS or tags file
    	      by setting the parameter $TAGSFILE or $tagsfile  respectively.   The  corresponding
    	      completion tags used are etags and vtags, after emacs and vi respectively.
    
    UTILITY FUNCTIONS
           Descriptions follow for utility functions that may be useful when writing completion func‐
           tions.  If functions are installed in subdirectories, most of these  reside  in	the  Base
           subdirectory.   Like  the  example functions for commands in the distribution, the utility
           functions generating matches all follow the convention of returning status  zero  if  they
           generated completions and non-zero if no matching completions could be added.
    
           Two more features are offered by the _main_complete function.  The arrays compprefuncs and
           comppostfuncs may contain names of functions that are to be called immediately  before  or
           after completion has been tried.  A function will only be called once unless it explicitly
           reinserts itself into the array.
    
           _all_labels [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ command arg ... ]
    	      This is a convenient interface to the _next_label function below, implementing  the
    	      loop shown in the _next_label example.  The command and its arguments are called to
    	      generate the matches.  The options stored in the parameter name will  automatically
    	      be  inserted  into the args passed to the command.  Normally, they are put directly
    	      after the command, but if one of the args is a single  hyphen,  they  are  inserted
    	      directly	before that.  If the hyphen is the last argument, it will be removed from
    	      the argument list before the command is called.  This allows _all_labels to be used
    	      in almost all cases where the matches can be generated by a single call to the com‐
    	      padd builtin command or by a call to one of the utility functions.
    
    	      For example:
    
    		     local expl
    		     ...
    		     if _requested foo; then
    		       ...
    		       _all_labels foo expl '...' compadd ... - $matches
    		     fi
    
    	      Will complete the strings from the matches parameter, using compadd with additional
    	      options which will take precedence over those generated by _all_labels.
    
           _alternative [ -O name ] [ -C name ] spec ...
    	      This  function is useful in simple cases where multiple tags are available.  Essen‐
    	      tially it implements a loop like the one described for the _tags function below.
    
    	      The tags to use and the action to perform if a tag is requested are described using
    	      the  specs  which  are of the form: `tag:descr:action'.  The tags are offered using
    	      _tags and if the tag is requested, the action is executed with the  given  descrip‐
    	      tion  descr.   The actions are those accepted by the _arguments function (described
    	      below), excluding the `->state' and `=...' forms.
    
    	      For example, the action may be a simple function call:
    
    		     _alternative \
    			 'users:user:_users' \
    			 'hosts:host:_hosts'
    
    	      offers usernames and hostnames as possible matches, generated  by  the  _users  and
    	      _hosts functions respectively.
    
    	      Like  _arguments, this function uses _all_labels to execute the actions, which will
    	      loop over all sets of tags.  Special handling is only required if there is an addi‐
    	      tional valid tag, for example inside a function called from _alternative.
    
    	      The  option  `-O	name'  is used in the same way as by the _arguments function.  In
    	      other words, the elements of the name array will be passed to compadd when  execut‐
    	      ing an action.
    
    	      Like  _tags  this  function supports the -C option to give a different name for the
    	      argument context field.
    
           _arguments [ -nswWCRS ] [ -A pat ] [ -O name ] [ -M matchspec ]
    		  [ : ] spec ...
           _arguments [ opt ... ] -- [ -i pats ] [ -s pair ] [ helpspec ... ]
    	      This function can be used to give a complete specification  for  completion  for	a
    	      command whose arguments follow standard UNIX option and argument conventions.
    
    	      Options overview
    
    	      Options  to  _arguments itself must be in separate words, i.e. -s -w, not -sw.  The
    	      options are followed by specs that describe options and arguments of  the  analyzed
    	      command.	 specs	that  describe	option	flags  must  precede  specs that describe
    	      non-option ("positional" or "normal") arguments of the  analyzed	line.	To  avoid
    	      ambiguity, all options to _arguments itself may be separated from the spec forms by
    	      a single colon.
    
    	      The `--' form is used to intuit spec forms from the  help  output  of  the  command
    	      being  analyzed,	and is described in detail below.  The opts for the `--' form are
    	      otherwise the same options as the first form.  Note that `-s' following `--' has	a
    	      distinct meaning from `-s' preceding `--', and both may appear.
    
    	      The  option  switches  -s, -S, -A, -w, and -W affect how _arguments parses the ana‐
    	      lyzed command line's options.  These switches are useful for commands with standard
    	      argument parsing.
    
    	      The options of _arguments have the following meanings:
    
    	      -n     With  this  option, _arguments sets the parameter NORMARG to the position of
    		     the first normal argument in the $words array, i.e. the position  after  the
    		     end  of  the options.  If that argument has not been reached, NORMARG is set
    		     to -1.  The caller should declare `integer NORMARG'  if  the  -n  option  is
    		     passed; otherwise the parameter is not used.
    
    	      -s     Enable  option  stacking  for  single-letter  options, whereby multiple sin‐
    		     gle-letter options may be combined into a single word.  For example, the two
    		     options `-x' and `-y' may be combined into a single word `-xy'.  By default,
    		     every word corresponds to a single option name (`-xy'  is	a  single  option
    		     named `xy').
    
    		     Options  beginning with a single hyphen or plus sign are eligible for stack‐
    		     ing; words beginning with two hyphens are not.
    
    		     Note that -s after -- has a different meaning, which is  documented  in  the
    		     segment entitled `Deriving spec forms from the help output'.
    
    	      -w     In  combination  with  -s,  allow option stacking even if one or more of the
    		     options take arguments.  For example, if -x takes an argument, with  no  -s,
    		     `-xy'  is	considered  as	a  single  (unhandled) option; with -s, -xy is an
    		     option with the argument `y'; with both -s and -w, -xy may be the option  -x
    		     and the option -y with arguments still to come.
    
    	      -W     This  option  takes  -w  a  stage	further:  it is possible to complete sin‐
    		     gle-letter options even after an argument that  occurs  in  the  same  word.
    		     However,  it  depends on the action performed whether options will really be
    		     completed at this point.  For more control,  use  a  utility  function  like
    		     _guard as part of the action.
    
    	      -C     Modify  the  curcontext parameter for an action of the form `->state'.  This
    		     is discussed in detail below.
    
    	      -R     Return status 300 instead of zero when a $state is to  be	handled,  in  the
    		     `->string' syntax.
    
    	      -S     Do  not  complete options after a `--' appearing on the line, and ignore the
    		     `--'.  For example, with -S, in the line
    
    			    foobar -x -- -y
    
    		     the `-x' is considered an option, the `-y' is considered  an  argument,  and
    		     the `--' is considered to be neither.
    
    	      -A pat Do  not  complete	options  after the first non-option argument on the line.
    		     pat is a pattern matching all strings which are not to  be  taken	as  argu‐
    		     ments.   For  example,  to make _arguments stop completing options after the
    		     first normal argument, but ignoring all strings starting with a hyphen  even
    		     if they are not described by one of the optspecs, the form is `-A "-*"'.
    
    	      -O name
    		     Pass the elements of the array name as arguments to functions called to exe‐
    		     cute actions.  This is discussed in detail below.
    
    	      -M matchspec
    		     Use the match specification matchspec for completing option names	and  val‐
    		     ues.   The  default  matchspec  allows partial word completion after `_' and
    		     `-', such as completing `-f-b' to `-foo-bar'.  The default matchspec is:
    		     r:|[_-]=* r:|=*
    
    	      specs: overview
    
    	      Each of the following forms is a spec describing	individual  sets  of  options  or
    	      arguments on the command line being analyzed.
    
    	      n:message:action
    	      n::message:action
    		     This  describes the n'th normal argument.	The message will be printed above
    		     the matches generated and the action indicates what can be completed in this
    		     position  (see below).  If there are two colons before the message the argu‐
    		     ment is optional.	If the message contains only white space, nothing will be
    		     printed  above  the  matches  unless  the	action adds an explanation string
    		     itself.
    
    	      :message:action
    	      ::message:action
    		     Similar, but describes the next argument, whatever number	that  happens  to
    		     be.   If  all  arguments are specified in this form in the correct order the
    		     numbers are unnecessary.
    
    	      *:message:action
    	      *::message:action
    	      *:::message:action
    		     This describes how arguments (usually non-option arguments, those not begin‐
    		     ning  with  -  or +) are to be completed when neither of the first two forms
    		     was provided.  Any number of arguments can be completed in this fashion.
    
    		     With two colons before the message, the words special array and the  CURRENT
    		     special  parameter  are  modified to refer only to the normal arguments when
    		     the action is executed or evaluated.  With three colons before  the  message
    		     they  are	modified  to  refer  only to the normal arguments covered by this
    		     description.
    
    	      optspec
    	      optspec:...
    		     This describes an option.	The colon indicates  handling  for  one  or  more
    		     arguments to the option; if it is not present, the option is assumed to take
    		     no arguments.
    
    		     The following forms are available for the initial optspec,  whether  or  not
    		     the option has arguments.
    
    		     *optspec
    			    Here optspec is one of the remaining forms below.  This indicates the
    			    following optspec may be repeated.	Otherwise  if  the  corresponding
    			    option is already present on the command line to the left of the cur‐
    			    sor it will not be offered again.
    
    		     -optname
    		     +optname
    			    In the simplest form the optspec is just the  option  name	beginning
    			    with  a minus or a plus sign, such as `-foo'.  The first argument for
    			    the option (if any) must follow as a separate word directly after the
    			    option.
    
    			    Either  of	`-+optname'  and  `+-optname' can be used to specify that
    			    -optname and +optname are both valid.
    
    			    In all the remaining forms, the leading `-' may  be  replaced  by  or
    			    paired with `+' in this way.
    
    		     -optname-
    			    The  first argument of the option must come directly after the option
    			    name in the same word.  For example, `-foo-:...' specifies	that  the
    			    completed option and argument will look like `-fooarg'.
    
    		     -optname+
    			    The  first	argument may appear immediately after optname in the same
    			    word, or may appear as a separate word after the option.   For  exam‐
    			    ple,  `-foo+:...'  specifies  that	the completed option and argument
    			    will look like either `-fooarg' or `-foo arg'.
    
    		     -optname=
    			    The argument may appear as the next word, or  in  same  word  as  the
    			    option  name provided that it is separated from it by an equals sign,
    			    for example `-foo=arg' or `-foo arg'.
    
    		     -optname=-
    			    The argument to the option must appear after an equals  sign  in  the
    			    same word, and may not be given in the next argument.
    
    		     optspec[explanation]
    			    An	explanation  string may be appended to any of the preceding forms
    			    of optspec by enclosing it in brackets, as in `-q[query operation]'.
    
    			    The verbose style is used to decide whether the  explanation  strings
    			    are displayed with the option in a completion listing.
    
    			    If	no bracketed explanation string is given but the auto-description
    			    style is set and only one argument is described for this optspec, the
    			    value  of the style is displayed, with any appearance of the sequence
    			    `%d' in it replaced by the message of the first optarg  that  follows
    			    the optspec; see below.
    
    		     It  is  possible  for  options with a literal `+' or `=' to appear, but that
    		     character must be quoted, for example `-\+'.
    
    		     Each optarg following an optspec must take one of the following forms:
    
    		     :message:action
    		     ::message:action
    			    An argument to the option; message and  action  are  treated  as  for
    			    ordinary  arguments.   In  the first form, the argument is mandatory,
    			    and in the second form it is optional.
    
    			    This group may be repeated for options which take multiple arguments.
    			    In other words, :message1:action1:message2:action2 specifies that the
    			    option takes two arguments.
    
    		     :*pattern:message:action
    		     :*pattern::message:action
    		     :*pattern:::message:action
    			    This describes multiple arguments.	 Only  the  last  optarg  for  an
    			    option  taking  multiple arguments may be given in this form.  If the
    			    pattern is empty (i.e. :*:), all the remaining words on the line  are
    			    to	be completed as described by the action; otherwise, all the words
    			    up to and including a word matching the pattern are to  be	completed
    			    using the action.
    
    			    Multiple  colons  are  treated  as for the `*:...' forms for ordinary
    			    arguments:	when the message is preceded by  two  colons,  the  words
    			    special  array  and the CURRENT special parameter are modified during
    			    the execution or evaluation of the action to refer only to the  words
    			    after  the	option.  When preceded by three colons, they are modified
    			    to refer only to the words covered by this description.
    
    	      Any literal colon in an optname, message, or action must be  preceded  by  a  back‐
    	      slash, `\:'.
    
    	      Each  of	the  forms above may be preceded by a list in parentheses of option names
    	      and argument numbers.  If the given option is on the command line, the options  and
    	      arguments indicated in parentheses will not be offered.  For example, `(-two -three
    	      1)-one:...' completes the option `-one'; if this appears on the command  line,  the
    	      options -two and -three and the first ordinary argument will not be completed after
    	      it.  `(-foo):...' specifies an ordinary argument completion; -foo will not be  com‐
    	      pleted if that argument is already present.
    
    	      Other  items  may  appear in the list of excluded options to indicate various other
    	      items that should not be applied when the current specification is matched: a  sin‐
    	      gle  star  (*) for the rest arguments (i.e. a specification of the form `*:...'); a
    	      colon (:) for all normal (non-option-) arguments; and a hyphen (-) for all options.
    	      For  example,  if `(*)' appears before an option and the option appears on the com‐
    	      mand line, the list of remaining arguments (those shown in the above  table  begin‐
    	      ning with `*:') will not be completed.
    
    	      To aid in reuse of specifications, it is possible to precede any of the forms above
    	      with `!'; then the form will no longer be completed,  although  if  the  option  or
    	      argument	appears on the command line they will be skipped as normal.  The main use
    	      for this is when the arguments are given by an  array,  and  _arguments  is  called
    	      repeatedly   for	 more	specific   contexts:   on   the  first	call  `_arguments
    	      $global_options' is used, and on subsequent calls `_arguments !$^global_options'.
    
    	      specs: actions
    
    	      In each of the forms above the action determines how completions should  be  gener‐
    	      ated.  Except for the `->string' form below, the action will be executed by calling
    	      the _all_labels function to process all tag labels.  No special handling of tags is
    	      needed unless a function call introduces a new one.
    
    	      The functions called to execute actions will be called with the the elements of the
    	      array named by the `-O name' option as arguments.  This can be used,  for  example,
    	      to pass the same set of options for the compadd builtin to all actions.
    
    	      The forms for action are as follows.
    
    	       (single unquoted space)
    		     This  is  useful  where  an  argument  is required but it is not possible or
    		     desirable to generate matches for it.  The message will be displayed but  no
    		     completions listed.  Note that even in this case the colon at the end of the
    		     message is needed; it may only be omitted when  neither  a  message  nor  an
    		     action is given.
    
    	      (item1 item2 ...)
    		     One of a list of possible matches, for example:
    
    			    :foo:(foo bar baz)
    
    	      ((item1\:desc1 ...))
    		     Similar  to  the above, but with descriptions for each possible match.  Note
    		     the backslash before the colon.  For example,
    
    			    :foo:((a\:bar b\:baz))
    
    		     The matches will be listed together with their descriptions if the  descrip‐
    		     tion style is set with the values tag in the context.
    
    	      ->string
    		     In  this  form,  _arguments  processes  the  arguments  and options and then
    		     returns control to the calling function with parameters set to indicate  the
    		     state  of	processing;  the calling function then makes its own arrangements
    		     for generating completions.  For example, functions that implement  a  state
    		     machine can use this type of action.
    
    		     Where  _arguments	encounters action in the `->string' format, it will strip
    		     all leading and trailing whitespace from string and set the array	state  to
    		     the set of all strings for which an action is to be performed.  The elements
    		     of the array state_descr are assigned the corresponding message  field  from
    		     each optarg containing such an action.
    
    		     By  default  and in common with all other well behaved completion functions,
    		     _arguments returns status zero if it was able to add  matches  and  non-zero
    		     otherwise.  However,  if  the  -R	option	is given, _arguments will instead
    		     return a status of 300 to indicate that $state is to be handled.
    
    		     In addition to $state and $state_descr,  _arguments  also	sets  the  global
    		     parameters `context', `line' and `opt_args' as described below, and does not
    		     reset any changes made to the special parameters such as PREFIX  and  words.
    		     This  gives the calling function the choice of resetting these parameters or
    		     propagating changes in them.
    
    		     A function  calling  _arguments  with  at	least  one  action  containing	a
    		     `->string' must therefore declare appropriate local parameters:
    
    			    local context state state_descr line
    			    typeset -A opt_args
    
    		     to prevent _arguments from altering the global environment.
    
    	      {eval-string}
    		     A	string	in braces is evaluated as shell code to generate matches.  If the
    		     eval-string itself does not begin with an opening parenthesis or brace it is
    		     split into separate words before execution.
    
    	      = action
    		     If  the action starts with `= ' (an equals sign followed by a space), _argu‐
    		     ments will insert the contents of the argument field of the current  context
    		     as  the new first element in the words special array and increment the value
    		     of the CURRENT special parameter.	This has the effect of inserting a  dummy
    		     word  onto the completion command line while not changing the point at which
    		     completion is taking place.
    
    		     This is most useful with one of the specifiers that restrict  the	words  on
    		     the command line on which the action is to operate (the two- and three-colon
    		     forms above).  One particular use is when an action itself causes _arguments
    		     on a restricted range; it is necessary to use this trick to insert an appro‐
    		     priate command name into the range for the second call to _arguments  to  be
    		     able to parse the line.
    
    	       word...
    	      word...
    		     This  covers  all forms other than those above.  If the action starts with a
    		     space, the remaining list of words will be invoked unchanged.
    
    		     Otherwise it will be invoked with some extra strings placed after the  first
    		     word;  these  are to be passed down as options to the compadd builtin.  They
    		     ensure that the state specified by _arguments, in	particular  the  descrip‐
    		     tions  of	options and arguments, is correctly passed to the completion com‐
    		     mand.  These additional arguments are taken from the array parameter `expl';
    		     this will be set up before executing the action and hence may be referred to
    		     inside it, typically in an expansion of the form `$expl[@]' which	preserves
    		     empty elements of the array.
    
    	      During  the  performance	of  the action the array `line' will be set to the normal
    	      arguments from the command line, i.e. the words from the	command  line  after  the
    	      command  name excluding all options and their arguments.	Options are stored in the
    	      associative array `opt_args' with option names as keys and their arguments  as  the
    	      values.	For  options  that  have  more	than  one argument these are given as one
    	      string, separated by colons.  All colons in the  original  arguments  are  preceded
    	      with backslashes.
    
    	      The parameter `context' is set when returning to the calling function to perform an
    	      action of the form `->string'.  It is set to an array of elements corresponding  to
    	      the  elements of $state.	Each element is a suitable name for the argument field of
    	      the context: either a string of the form `option-opt-n' for the  n'th  argument  of
    	      the  option  -opt, or a string of the form `argument-n' for the n'th argument.  For
    	      `rest' arguments, that is those in the list at the end not handled by  position,	n
    	      is  the string `rest'.  For example, when completing the argument of the -o option,
    	      the name is `option-o-1', while for the second normal (non-option-) argument it  is
    	      `argument-2'.
    
    	      Furthermore, during the evaluation of the action the context name in the curcontext
    	      parameter is altered to append the same string that is stored in the context param‐
    	      eter.
    
    	      The  option -C tells _arguments to modify the curcontext parameter for an action of
    	      the form `->state'.  This is the standard parameter used to keep track of the  cur‐
    	      rent  context.   Here  it  (and  not the context array) should be made local to the
    	      calling function to avoid passing back the modified value and should be initialised
    	      to the current value at the start of the function:
    
    		     local curcontext="$curcontext"
    
    	      This is useful where it is not possible for multiple states to be valid together.
    
    	      Specifying multiple sets of options
    
    	      It is possible to specify multiple sets of options and arguments with the sets sep‐
    	      arated by single hyphens.  The specifications before the first hyphen (if any)  are
    	      shared  by  all  the  remaining sets.  The first word in every other set provides a
    	      name for the set which may appear in  exclusion  lists  in  specifications,  either
    	      alone  or  before one of the possible values described above.  In the second case a
    	      `-' should appear between this name and the remainder.
    
    	      For example:
    
    		     _arguments \
    			 -a \
    		       - set1 \
    			 -c \
    		       - set2 \
    			 -d \
    			 ':arg:(x2 y2)'
    
    	      This defines two sets.  When the command line contains the option  `-c',	the  `-d'
    	      option  and the argument will not be considered possible completions.  When it con‐
    	      tains `-d' or an argument, the option `-c' will not be considered.  However,  after
    	      `-a' both sets will still be considered valid.
    
    	      If  the  name  given for one of the mutually exclusive sets is of the form `(name)'
    	      then only one value from each set will ever be completed; more formally, all speci‐
    	      fications are mutually exclusive to all other specifications in the same set.  This
    	      is useful for defining multiple sets of options which are mutually exclusive and in
    	      which the options are aliases for each other.  For example:
    
    		     _arguments \
    			 -a -b \
    		       - '(compress)' \
    			 {-c,--compress}'[compress]' \
    		       - '(uncompress)' \
    			 {-d,--decompress}'[decompress]'
    
    	      As  the  completion code has to parse the command line separately for each set this
    	      form of argument is slow and should only be used when necessary.	A useful alterna‐
    	      tive  is	often  an  option specification with rest-arguments (as in `-foo:*:...');
    	      here the option -foo swallows up all remaining arguments as described by the optarg
    	      definitions.
    
    	      Deriving spec forms from the help output
    
    	      The  option  `--' allows _arguments to work out the names of long options that sup‐
    	      port the `--help' option which is standard in many GNU commands.	The command  word
    	      is  called  with	the  argument  `--help' and the output examined for option names.
    	      Clearly, it can be dangerous to pass this to commands which may  not  support  this
    	      option as the behaviour of the command is unspecified.
    
    	      In  addition  to options, `_arguments --' will try to deduce the types of arguments
    	      available for options when the form `--opt=val' is valid.  It is also  possible  to
    	      provide  hints by examining the help text of the command and adding helpspec of the
    	      form `pattern:message:action'; note that other _arguments spec forms are not  used.
    	      The  pattern  is matched against the help text for an option, and if it matches the
    	      message and action are used as for other argument specifiers.  The special case  of
    	      `*:'  means  both  message  and  action  are empty, which has the effect of causing
    	      options having no description in the help output to be ordered in listings ahead of
    	      options that have a description.
    
    	      For example:
    
    		     _arguments -- '*\*:toggle:(yes no)' \
    				   '*=FILE*:file:_files' \
    				   '*=DIR*:directory:_files -/' \
    				   '*=PATH*:directory:_files -/'
    
    	      Here, `yes' and `no' will be completed as the argument of options whose description
    	      ends in a star; file names will be completed for options that contain the substring
    	      `=FILE'  in  the	description;  and directories will be completed for options whose
    	      description contains `=DIR' or `=PATH'.  The last three are in fact the default and
    	      so  need	not  be  given explicitly, although it is possible to override the use of
    	      these patterns.  A typical help text which uses this feature is:
    
    		       -C, --directory=DIR	    change to directory DIR
    
    	      so that the above specifications will  cause  directories  to  be  completed  after
    	      `--directory', though not after `-C'.
    
    	      Note  also  that	_arguments tries to find out automatically if the argument for an
    	      option is optional.  This can be specified explicitly by doubling the colon  before
    	      the message.
    
    	      If  the pattern ends in `(-)', this will be removed from the pattern and the action
    	      will be used only directly after the `=', not in the next word.  This is the behav‐
    	      iour of a normal specification defined with the form `=-'.
    
    	      The  `_arguments	--'  can be followed by the option `-i patterns' to give patterns
    	      for options which are not to be completed.  The patterns can be given as	the  name
    	      of an array parameter or as a literal list in parentheses.  For example,
    
    		     _arguments -- -i \
    			 "(--(en|dis)able-FEATURE*)"
    
    	      will  cause completion to ignore the options `--enable-FEATURE' and `--disable-FEA‐
    	      TURE' (this example is useful with GNU configure).
    
    	      The `_arguments --' form can also be followed by the option `-s pair'  to  describe
    	      option  aliases.	 The  pair  consists of a list of alternating patterns and corre‐
    	      sponding replacements, enclosed in parens and quoted so  that  it  forms	a  single
    	      argument word in the _arguments call.
    
    	      For   example,   some  configure-script  help  output  describes	options  only  as
    	      `--enable-foo', but the script also accepts the negated form  `--disable-foo'.   To
    	      allow completion of the second form:
    
    		     _arguments -- -s "((#s)--enable- --disable-)"
    
    	      Miscellaneous notes
    
    	      Finally, note that _arguments generally expects to be the primary function handling
    	      any completion for which it is used.  It may have side  effects  which  change  the
    	      treatment  of  any  matches  added  by other functions called after it.  To combine
    	      _arguments with other functions, those functions should  be  called  either  before
    	      _arguments, as an action within a spec, or in handlers for `->state' actions.
    
    	      Here is a more general example of the use of _arguments:
    
    		     _arguments '-l+:left border:' \
    				'-format:paper size:(letter A4)' \
    				'*-copy:output file:_files::resolution:(300 600)' \
    				':postscript file:_files -g \*.\(ps\|eps\)' \
    				'*:page number:'
    
    	      This  describes  three  options: `-l', `-format', and `-copy'.  The first takes one
    	      argument described as `left border' for which no completion will be offered because
    	      of  the  empty  action.  Its argument may come directly after the `-l' or it may be
    	      given as the next word on the line.
    
    	      The `-format' option takes one argument in the next word, described as `paper size'
    	      for which only the strings `letter' and `A4' will be completed.
    
    	      The  `-copy'  option  may  appear  more than once on the command line and takes two
    	      arguments.  The first is mandatory and will be completed as a filename.  The second
    	      is  optional  (because of the second colon before the description `resolution') and
    	      will be completed from the strings `300' and `600'.
    
    	      The last two descriptions say what should be completed  as  arguments.   The  first
    	      describes  the first argument as a `postscript file' and makes files ending in `ps'
    	      or `eps' be completed.  The last description gives all other arguments the descrip‐
    	      tion `page numbers' but does not offer completions.
    
           _cache_invalid cache_identifier
    	      This  function  returns  status  zero if the completions cache corresponding to the
    	      given cache identifier needs rebuilding.	It determines  this  by  looking  up  the
    	      cache-policy  style  for	the current context.  This should provide a function name
    	      which is run with the full path to the relevant cache file as the only argument.
    
    	      Example:
    
    		     _example_caching_policy () {
    			 # rebuild if cache is more than a week old
    			 local -a oldp
    			 oldp=( "$1"(Nm+7) )
    			 (( $#oldp ))
    		     }
    
           _call_function return name [ arg ... ]
    	      If a function name exists, it is called with the arguments args.	The return  argu‐
    	      ment  gives  the	name  of a parameter in which the return status from the function
    	      name should be stored; if return is empty or a single hyphen it is ignored.
    
    	      The return status of _call_function itself is zero if the function name exists  and
    	      was called and non-zero otherwise.
    
           _call_program tag string ...
    	      This  function provides a mechanism for the user to override the use of an external
    	      command.	It looks up the command style with the supplied tag.   If  the	style  is
    	      set,  its  value	is  used as the command to execute.  The strings from the call to
    	      _call_program, or from the style if set, are concatenated with spaces between  them
    	      and  the	resulting string is evaluated.	The return status is the return status of
    	      the command called.
    
           _combination [ -s pattern ] tag style spec ... field opts ...
    	      This function is used to complete combinations of values,   for  example	pairs  of
    	      hostnames  and  usernames.   The	style  argument gives the style which defines the
    	      pairs; it is looked up in a context with the tag specified.
    
    	      The  style  name	consists  of  field  names  separated  by  hyphens,  for  example
    	      `users-hosts-ports'.   For  each	field for a value is already known, a spec of the
    	      form `field=pattern' is given.  For example, if the command line so far specifies a
    	      user `pws', the argument `users=pws' should appear.
    
    	      The  next  argument with no equals sign is taken as the name of the field for which
    	      completions should be generated (presumably not one of the  fields  for  which  the
    	      value is known).
    
    	      The matches generated will be taken from the value of the style.	These should con‐
    	      tain the possible values for the combinations  in  the  appropriate  order  (users,
    	      hosts,  ports  in the example above).  The different fields the values for the dif‐
    	      ferent fields are separated by colons.  This can be altered with the option  -s  to
    	      _combination  which  specifies  a pattern.  Typically this is a character class, as
    	      for example `-s "[:@]"' in the case of the users-hosts style.	Each  `field=pat‐
    	      tern'  specification restricts the completions which apply to elements of the style
    	      with appropriately matching fields.
    
    	      If no style with the given name is defined for the given tag, or	if  none  of  the
    	      strings  in style's value match, but a function name of the required field preceded
    	      by an underscore is defined, that function will be called to generate the  matches.
    	      For example, if there is no `users-hosts-ports' or no matching hostname when a host
    	      is required, the function `_hosts' will automatically be called.
    
    	      If the same name is used for more than one field, in both the  `field=pattern'  and
    	      the  argument  that  gives the name of the field to be completed, the number of the
    	      field (starting with one) may be given after the fieldname, separated from it by	a
    	      colon.
    
    	      All  arguments  after the required field name are passed to compadd when generating
    	      matches from the style value, or to the  functions  for  the  fields  if	they  are
    	      called.
    
           _describe [-12JVx] [ -oO | -t tag ] descr name1 [ name2 ] [ opt ... ]
    		 [ -- name1 [ name2 ] [ opt ... ] ... ]
    	      This  function associates completions with descriptions.	Multiple groups separated
    	      by -- can be supplied, potentially with different completion options opts.
    
    	      The descr is taken as a string to display above the matches if the format style for
    	      the  descriptions  tag is set.  This is followed by one or two names of arrays fol‐
    	      lowed by options to pass to compadd.  The first array contains the possible comple‐
    	      tions  with  their  descriptions in the form `completion:description'.  Any literal
    	      colons in completion must be quoted with a backslash.  If a second array is  given,
    	      it  should  have	the same number of elements as the first; in this case the corre‐
    	      sponding elements are added as  possible	completions  instead  of  the  completion
    	      strings  from  the  first  array.  The completion list will retain the descriptions
    	      from the first array.  Finally, a set of completion options can appear.
    
    	      If the option `-o' appears before the first argument, the  matches  added  will  be
    	      treated as names of command options (N.B. not shell options), typically following a
    	      `-', `--' or `+' on the command line.  In this case _describe uses the  prefix-hid‐
    	      den, prefix-needed and verbose styles to find out if the strings should be added as
    	      completions and if the descriptions should be shown.  Without the `-o' option, only
    	      the  verbose  style  is used to decide how descriptions are shown.  If `-O' is used
    	      instead of `-o', command options are completed as above but _describe will not han‐
    	      dle the prefix-needed style.
    
    	      With  the  -t option a tag can be specified.  The default is `values' or, if the -o
    	      option is given, `options'.
    
    	      The options -1, -2, -J, -V, -x are passed to _next_label.
    
    	      If selected by the list-grouped style,  strings  with  the  same	description  will
    	      appear together in the list.
    
    	      _describe  uses  the  _all_labels  function to generate the matches, so it does not
    	      need to appear inside a loop over tag labels.
    
           _description [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ spec ... ]
    	      This function is not to be confused with the previous one; it is used as	a  helper
    	      function	for  creating options to compadd.  It is buried inside many of the higher
    	      level completion functions and so often does not need to be called directly.
    
    	      The styles listed below are tested in the current context using the given tag.  The
    	      resulting options for compadd are put into the array named name (this is tradition‐
    	      ally `expl', but this convention is not enforced).  The description for the  corre‐
    	      sponding set of matches is passed to the function in descr.
    
    	      The  styles  tested  are: format, hidden, matcher, ignored-patterns and group-name.
    	      The format style is first tested for the given tag and then  for	the  descriptions
    	      tag if no value was found, while the remainder are only tested for the tag given as
    	      the first argument.  The function also calls _setup which tests some more styles.
    
    	      The string returned by the format style (if any)	will  be  modified  so	that  the
    	      sequence	`%d'  is  replaced  by	the descr given as the third argument without any
    	      leading or trailing white space.	If, after removing the white space, the descr  is
    	      the  empty  string,  the format style will not be used and the options put into the
    	      name array will not contain  an  explanation  string  to	be  displayed  above  the
    	      matches.
    
    	      If  _description	is  called  with  more than three arguments, the additional specs
    	      should be of the form `char:str'.  These supply escape  sequence	replacements  for
    	      the format style: every appearance of `%char' will be replaced by string.
    
    	      If  the  -x option is given, the description will be passed to compadd using the -x
    	      option instead of the default -X.  This means that the  description  will  be  dis‐
    	      played even if there are no corresponding matches.
    
    	      The  options  placed  in	the  array  name take account of the group-name style, so
    	      matches are placed in a separate group where necessary.  The group normally has its
    	      elements	sorted	(by  passing the option -J to compadd), but if an option starting
    	      with `-V', `-J', `-1', or `-2' is passed	to  _description,  that  option  will  be
    	      included	in  the  array.   Hence  it  is  possible  for the completion group to be
    	      unsorted by giving the option `-V', `-1V', or `-2V'.
    
    	      In most cases, the function will be used like this:
    
    		     local expl
    		     _description files expl file
    		     compadd "$expl[@]" - "$files[@]"
    
    	      Note the use of the parameter expl, the hyphen, and the list  of	matches.   Almost
    	      all  calls  to  compadd  within  the  completion	system use a similar format; this
    	      ensures that user-specified styles are correctly passed down to the builtins  which
    	      implement the internals of completion.
    
           _dispatch context string ...
    	      This sets the current context to context and looks for completion functions to han‐
    	      dle this context by hunting through the list of command names or	special  contexts
    	      (as  described  above for compdef) given as strings.  The first completion function
    	      to be defined for one of the contexts in the list  is  used  to  generate  matches.
    	      Typically,  the  last string is -default- to cause the function for default comple‐
    	      tion to be used as a fallback.
    
    	      The function sets the parameter $service to the string being tried,  and	sets  the
    	      context/command  field  (the  fourth)  of  the $curcontext parameter to the context
    	      given as the first argument.
    
           _files The function _files calls _path_files with all the arguments it was  passed  except
    	      for  -g  and  -/.   The  use  of	these  two  options depends on the setting of the
    	      file-patterns style.
    
    	      This function accepts the full set of options  allowed  by  _path_files,	described
    	      below.
    
           _gnu_generic
    	      This  function  is a simple wrapper around the _arguments function described above.
    	      It can be used to determine automatically the long options understood  by  commands
    	      that  produce a list when passed the option `--help'.  It is intended to be used as
    	      a top-level completion function in its own right.  For example,  to  enable  option
    	      completion for the commands foo and bar, use
    
    		     compdef _gnu_generic foo bar
    
    	      after the call to compinit.
    
    	      The  completion  system  as  supplied  is conservative in its use of this function,
    	      since it is important to be sure the command understands the option `--help'.
    
           _guard [ options ] pattern descr
    	      This function displays descr if pattern matches the string to be completed.  It  is
    	      intended	to  be used in the action for the specifications passed to _arguments and
    	      similar functions.
    
    	      The return status is zero if the message was displayed and the word to complete  is
    	      not empty, and non-zero otherwise.
    
    	      The  pattern  may  be preceded by any of the options understood by compadd that are
    	      passed down from _description, namely -M, -J, -V, -1, -2, -n, -F and  -X.   All  of
    	      these options will be ignored.  This fits in conveniently with the argument-passing
    	      conventions of actions for _arguments.
    
    	      As an example, consider a command taking the options -n and -none, where -n must be
    	      followed by a numeric value in the same word.  By using:
    
    		     _arguments '-n-: :_guard "[0-9]#" "numeric value"' '-none'
    
    	      _arguments  can  be  made  to both display the message `numeric value' and complete
    	      options after `-n<TAB>'.	If the `-n' is already followed by  one  or  more  digits
    	      (the  pattern  passed to _guard) only the message will be displayed; if the `-n' is
    	      followed by another character, only options are completed.
    
           _message [ -r12 ] [ -VJ group ] descr
           _message -e [ tag ] descr
    	      The descr is used in the same way as the third argument to the  _description  func‐
    	      tion,  except that the resulting string will always be shown whether or not matches
    	      were generated.  This is useful for displaying a help message in	places	where  no
    	      completions can be generated.
    
    	      The  format  style  is  examined with the messages tag to find a message; the usual
    	      tag, descriptions, is used only if the style is not set with the former.
    
    	      If the -r option is given, no style is used; the descr is taken  literally  as  the
    	      string  to  display.  This is most useful when the descr comes from a pre-processed
    	      argument list which already contains an expanded description.
    
    	      The -12VJ options and the group are passed to compadd and hence determine the group
    	      the message string is added to.
    
    	      The second -e form gives a description for completions with the tag tag to be shown
    	      even if there are no matches for that tag.  This form is called  by  _arguments  in
    	      the  event  that	there  is  no action for an option specification.  The tag can be
    	      omitted and if so the tag is taken from the parameter $curtag; this  is  maintained
    	      by  the  completion  system  and	so is usually correct.	Note that if there are no
    	      matches at the time this function is called, compstate[insert] is cleared, so addi‐
    	      tional matches generated later are not inserted on the command line.
    
           _multi_parts sep array
    	      The  argument sep is a separator character.  The array may be either the name of an
    	      array parameter or a literal array in the form `(foo bar)', a parenthesised list of
    	      words  separated	by whitespace.	The possible completions are the strings from the
    	      array.  However, each chunk delimited by sep will  be  completed	separately.   For
    	      example, the _tar function uses `_multi_parts / patharray' to complete partial file
    	      paths from the given array of complete file paths.
    
    	      The -i option causes _multi_parts to insert a unique match even  if  that  requires
    	      multiple	separators  to	be  inserted.  This is not usually the expected behaviour
    	      with filenames, but certain other types of completion, for  example  those  with	a
    	      fixed set of possibilities, may be more suited to this form.
    
    	      Like  other  utility  functions,	this function accepts the `-V', `-J', `-1', `-2',
    	      `-n', `-f', `-X', `-M', `-P', `-S', `-r', `-R', and `-q' options and passes them to
    	      the compadd builtin.
    
           _next_label [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ option ... ]
    	      This function is used to implement the loop over different tag labels for a partic‐
    	      ular tag as described above for the tag-order style.  On each call it checks to see
    	      if  there  are  any  more tag labels; if there is it returns status zero, otherwise
    	      non-zero.  As this function requires a current tag to be set, it must always follow
    	      a call to _tags or _requested.
    
    	      The  -x12VJ  options  and  the first three arguments are passed to the _description
    	      function.  Where appropriate the tag will be replaced by a tag label in this  call.
    	      Any  description	given  in the tag-order style is preferred to the descr passed to
    	      _next_label.
    
    	      The options given after the descr are set in the parameter given by name, and hence
    	      are to be passed to compadd or whatever function is called to add the matches.
    
    	      Here  is	a  typical  use of this function for the tag foo.  The call to _requested
    	      determines if tag foo is required at all; the loop  over	_next_label  handles  any
    	      labels defined for the tag in the tag-order style.
    
    		     local expl ret=1
    		     ...
    		     if _requested foo; then
    		       ...
    		       while _next_label foo expl '...'; do
    			 compadd "$expl[@]" ... && ret=0
    		       done
    		       ...
    		     fi
    		     return ret
    
           _normal
    	      This is the standard function called to handle completion outside any special -con‐
    	      text-.  It is called both to complete the command word and also the arguments for a
    	      command.	 In the second case, _normal looks for a special completion for that com‐
    	      mand, and if there is none it uses the completion for the -default- context.
    
    	      A second use is to reexamine the command line specified by the $words array and the
    	      $CURRENT parameter after those have been modified.  For example, the function _pre‐
    	      command, which completes after pre-command specifiers such as  nohup,  removes  the
    	      first word from the words array, decrements the CURRENT parameter, then calls _nor‐
    	      mal again.  The effect is that `nohup cmd ...' is treated in the same way  as  `cmd
    	      ...'.
    
    	      If  the  command name matches one of the patterns given by one of the options -p or
    	      -P to compdef, the corresponding completion function is called and then the parame‐
    	      ter _compskip is checked.  If it is set completion is terminated at that point even
    	      if no matches have been found.  This is the same effect as in the -first- context.
    
           _options
    	      This can be used to complete the names of shell options.	 It  provides  a  matcher
    	      specification   that  ignores  a	leading  `no',	ignores  underscores  and  allows
    	      upper-case letters to match their lower-case  counterparts  (for	example,  `glob',
    	      `noglob',  `NO_GLOB'  are all completed).  Any arguments are propagated to the com‐
    	      padd builtin.
    
           _options_set and _options_unset
    	      These functions complete only set or unset options, with the same matching specifi‐
    	      cation used in the _options function.
    
    	      Note  that  you  need  to  uncomment a few lines in the _main_complete function for
    	      these functions to work properly.  The lines in question	are  used  to  store  the
    	      option  settings in effect before the completion widget locally sets the options it
    	      needs.  Hence these functions are not generally used by the completion system.
    
           _parameters
    	      This is used to complete the names of shell parameters.
    
    	      The option `-g pattern' limits the completion to parameters whose type matches  the
    	      pattern.	The type of a parameter is that shown by `print ${(t)param}', hence judi‐
    	      cious use of `*' in pattern is probably necessary.
    
    	      All other arguments are passed to the compadd builtin.
    
           _path_files
    	      This function is used throughout the completion system to complete  filenames.   It
    	      allows  completion  of  partial paths.  For example, the string `/u/i/s/sig' may be
    	      completed to `/usr/include/sys/signal.h'.
    
    	      The options accepted by both _path_files and _files are:
    
    	      -f     Complete all filenames.  This is the default.
    
    	      -/     Specifies that only directories should be completed.
    
    	      -g pattern
    		     Specifies that only files matching the pattern should be completed.
    
    	      -W paths
    		     Specifies path prefixes that are to be prepended to the string from the com‐
    		     mand  line to generate the filenames but that should not be inserted as com‐
    		     pletions nor shown in completion listings.  Here, paths may be the  name  of
    		     an  array	parameter,  a literal list of paths enclosed in parentheses or an
    		     absolute pathname.
    
    	      -F ignored-files
    		     This behaves as for the corresponding option to  the  compadd  builtin.   It
    		     gives  direct control over which filenames should be ignored.  If the option
    		     is not present, the ignored-patterns style is used.
    
    	      Both _path_files and _files also accept the following options which are  passed  to
    	      compadd:	`-J',  `-V',  `-1',  `-2',  `-n', `-X', `-M', `-P', `-S', `-q', `-r', and
    	      `-R'.
    
    	      Finally, the _path_files function  uses the styles expand, ambiguous, special-dirs,
    	      list-suffixes and file-sort described above.
    
           _pick_variant [ -b builtin-label ] [ -c command ] [ -r name ]
    		     label=pattern ... label [ arg ... ]
    	      This  function  is  used to resolve situations where a single command name requires
    	      more than one type of handling, either because it has  more  than  one  variant  or
    	      because there is a name clash between two different commands.
    
    	      The  command  to run is taken from the first element of the array words unless this
    	      is overridden by the option -c.  This command is run and	its  output  is  compared
    	      with  a series of patterns.  Arguments to be passed to the command can be specified
    	      at the end after all the other arguments.  The patterns to try in order  are  given
    	      by  the  arguments  label=pattern; if the output of `command arg ...' contains pat‐
    	      tern, then label is selected as the label for the command variant.  If none of  the
    	      patterns match, the final command label is selected and status 1 is returned.
    
    	      If  the `-b builtin-label' is given, the command is tested to see if it is provided
    	      as a shell builtin, possibly autoloaded; if so, the label builtin-label is selected
    	      as the label for the variant.
    
    	      If the `-r name' is given, the label picked is stored in the parameter named name.
    
    	      The  results  are  also cached in the _cmd_variant associative array indexed by the
    	      name of the command run.
    
           _regex_arguments name spec ...
    	      This function generates a completion function name which matches the specifications
    	      specs, a set of regular expressions as described below.  After running _regex_argu‐
    	      ments, the function name should be called as a  normal  completion  function.   The
    	      pattern to be matched is given by the contents of the words array up to the current
    	      cursor position joined together with null characters; no quotation is applied.
    
    	      The arguments are grouped as sets of alternatives separated by `|', which are tried
    	      one  after the other until one matches.  Each alternative consists of a one or more
    	      specifications which are tried left to  right,  with  each  pattern  matched  being
    	      stripped	in  turn  from the command line being tested, until all of the group suc‐
    	      ceeds or until one fails; in the latter case, the next alternative is tried.   This
    	      structure  can  be  repeated to arbitrary depth by using parentheses; matching pro‐
    	      ceeds from inside to outside.
    
    	      A special procedure is applied if no test succeeds but the remaining  command  line
    	      string contains no null character (implying the remaining word is the one for which
    	      completions are to be generated).  The  completion  target  is  restricted  to  the
    	      remaining  word  and  any  actions for the corresponding patterns are executed.  In
    	      this case, nothing is stripped from the command line string.  The order of  evalua‐
    	      tion  of	the actions can be determined by the tag-order style; the various formats
    	      supported by _alternative can be used in action.	The descr is used for setting  up
    	      the array parameter expl.
    
    	      Specification  arguments	take one of following forms, in which metacharacters such
    	      as `(', `)', `#' and `|' should be quoted.
    
    	      /pattern/ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
    		     This is a single primitive component.  The function tests whether	the  com‐
    		     bined pattern `(#b)((#B)pattern)lookahead*' matches the command line string.
    		     If so, `guard' is evaluated and its return status is examined  to	determine
    		     if  the  test has succeeded.  The pattern string `[]' is guaranteed never to
    		     match.  The lookahead is not stripped from the command line before the  next
    		     pattern is examined.
    
    		     The  argument  starting  with : is used in the same manner as an argument to
    		     _alternative.
    
    		     A component is used as follows: pattern is tested to see  if  the	component
    		     already  exists  on  the command line.  If it does, any following specifica‐
    		     tions are examined to find something to complete.	If a component is reached
    		     but  no  such  pattern exists yet on the command line, the string containing
    		     the action is used to generate matches to insert at that point.
    
    	      /pattern/+ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
    		     This is similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the left part  of  the  command  line
    		     string  (i.e. the part already matched by previous patterns) is also consid‐
    		     ered part of the completion target.
    
    	      /pattern/- [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
    		     This is similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the actions of the current and previ‐
    		     ously  matched  patterns are ignored even if the following `pattern' matches
    		     the empty string.
    
    	      ( spec )
    		     Parentheses may be used to groups specs; note each parenthesis is	a  single
    		     argument to _regex_arguments.
    
    	      spec # This allows any number of repetitions of spec.
    
    	      spec spec
    		     The two specs are to be matched one after the other as described above.
    
    	      spec | spec
    		     Either of the two specs can be matched.
    
    	      The  function _regex_words can be used as a helper function to generate matches for
    	      a set of alternative words possibly with their own  arguments  as  a  command  line
    	      argument.
    
    	      Examples:
    
    		     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
    			 /$'[^\0]#\0'/ :'compadd aaa'
    
    	      This  generates  a  function _tst that completes aaa as its only argument.  The tag
    	      and description for the action have been omitted for brevity (this works but is not
    	      recommended in normal use).  The first component matches the command word, which is
    	      arbitrary; the second matches  any argument.  As the argument  is  also  arbitrary,
    	      any following component would not depend on aaa being present.
    
    		     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
    			 /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa'
    
    	      This  is	a  more typical use; it is similar, but any following patterns would only
    	      match if aaa was present as the first argument.
    
    		     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \( \
    			 /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \
    			 /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#
    
    	      In this example, an indefinite number of command arguments may be  completed.   Odd
    	      arguments  are completed as aaa and even arguments as bbb.  Completion fails unless
    	      the set of aaa and bbb arguments before the current one is matched correctly.
    
    		     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
    			 \( /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \| \
    			 /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#
    
    	      This is similar, but either aaa or bbb may be completed for any argument.  In  this
    	      case  _regex_words  could  be  used to generate a suitable expression for the argu‐
    	      ments.
    
           _regex_words tag description spec ...
    	      This function can be used to generate arguments for  the	_regex_arguments  command
    	      which  may  be inserted at any point where a set of rules is expected.  The tag and
    	      description give a standard tag and description pertaining to the current  context.
    	      Each  spec contains two or three arguments separated by a colon: note that there is
    	      no leading colon in this case.
    
    	      Each spec gives one of a set of words that may be completed at this point, together
    	      with arguments.  It is thus roughly equivalent to the _arguments function when used
    	      in normal (non-regex) completion.
    
    	      The part of the spec before the first colon is the word to be completed.	This  may
    	      contain  a  *;  the  entire word, before and after the * is completed, but only the
    	      text before the * is required for the context to be matched, so that further  argu‐
    	      ments may be completed after the abbreviated form.
    
    	      The second part of spec is a description for the word being completed.
    
    	      The  optional  third  part  of the spec describes how words following the one being
    	      completed are themselves to be completed.  It will be evaluated in order	to  avoid
    	      problems	with  quoting.	 This  means that typically it contains a reference to an
    	      array containing previously generated regex arguments.
    
    	      The option -t term specifies a terminator for the word instead of the usual  space.
    	      This  is	handled as an auto-removable suffix in the manner of the option -s sep to
    	      _values.
    
    	      The result of the processing by _regex_words is placed in the  array  reply,  which
    	      should  be  made	local to the calling function.	If the set of words and arguments
    	      may be matched repeatedly, a # should be appended to the generated  array  at  that
    	      point.
    
    	      For example:
    
    		     local -a reply
    		     _regex_words mydb-commands 'mydb commands' \
    		       'add:add an entry to mydb:$mydb_add_cmds' \
    		       'show:show entries in mydb'
    		     _regex_arguments _mydb "$reply[@]"
    		     _mydb "$@"
    
    	      This  shows  a completion function for a command mydb which takes two command argu‐
    	      ments, add and show.  show takes no arguments, while the	arguments  for	add  have
    	      already  been prepared in an array mydb_add_cmds, quite possibly by a previous call
    	      to _regex_words.
    
           _requested [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag [ name descr [ command [ arg ... ] ]
    	      This function is called to decide whether a tag already registered  by  a  call  to
    	      _tags  (see  below)  has	been requested by the user and hence completion should be
    	      performed for it.  It returns status zero if the tag is requested and non-zero oth‐
    	      erwise.	The  function  is typically used as part of a loop over different tags as
    	      follows:
    
    		     _tags foo bar baz
    		     while _tags; do
    		       if _requested foo; then
    			 ... # perform completion for foo
    		       fi
    		       ... # test the tags bar and baz in the same way
    		       ... # exit loop if matches were generated
    		     done
    
    	      Note that the test for whether matches were generated is not  performed  until  the
    	      end  of  the  _tags  loop.  This is so that the user can set the tag-order style to
    	      specify a set of tags to be completed at the same time.
    
    	      If name and descr are given, _requested calls the _description function with  these
    	      arguments together with the options passed to _requested.
    
    	      If  command  is given, the _all_labels function will be called immediately with the
    	      same arguments.  In simple cases this makes it possible to perform the test for the
    	      tag and the matching in one go.  For example:
    
    		     local expl ret=1
    		     _tags foo bar baz
    		     while _tags; do
    		       _requested foo expl 'description' \
    			   compadd foobar foobaz && ret=0
    		       ...
    		       (( ret )) || break
    		     done
    
    	      If  the command is not compadd, it must nevertheless be prepared to handle the same
    	      options.
    
           _retrieve_cache cache_identifier
    	      This function retrieves completion information from the file given by cache_identi‐
    	      fier,  stored  in  a  directory specified by the cache-path style which defaults to
    	      ~/.zcompcache.  The return status is zero if retrieval  was  successful.	 It  will
    	      only attempt retrieval if the use-cache style is set, so you can call this function
    	      without worrying about whether the user wanted to use the caching layer.
    
    	      See _store_cache below for more details.
    
           _sep_parts
    	      This function is passed alternating arrays and separators as arguments.  The arrays
    	      specify  completions  for  parts of strings to be separated by the separators.  The
    	      arrays may be the names of array parameters or a quoted list of words in	parenthe‐
    	      ses.   For  example,  with  the array `hosts=(ftp news)' the call `_sep_parts '(foo
    	      bar)' @ hosts' will complete the string  `f' to  `foo'  and  the	string	`b@n'  to
    	      `bar@news'.
    
    	      This function accepts the compadd options `-V', `-J', `-1', `-2', `-n', `-X', `-M',
    	      `-P', `-S', `-r', `-R', and `-q' and passes them on to the compadd builtin used  to
    	      add the matches.
    
           _sequence [ -s sep ] [ -n max ] [ -d ] function [ - ] ...
    	      This  function  is a wrapper to other functions for completing items in a separated
    	      list. The same function is used to complete each item in the list. The separator is
    	      specified  with  the  -s option. If -s is omitted it will use `,'. Duplicate values
    	      are not matched unless -d is specified. If there is a fixed or  maximum  number  of
    	      items in the list, this can be specified with the -n option.
    
    	      Common compadd options are passed on to the function. It is possible to use compadd
    	      directly with _sequence, though _values may be more appropriate in this situation.
    
           _setup tag [ group ]
    	      This function sets up the special parameters used by the completion  system  appro‐
    	      priately	for the tag given as the first argument.  It uses the styles list-colors,
    	      list-packed, list-rows-first, last-prompt, accept-exact, menu and force-list.
    
    	      The optional group supplies the name of the group in  which  the	matches  will  be
    	      placed.  If it is not given, the tag is used as the group name.
    
    	      This  function  is called automatically from _description and hence is not normally
    	      called explicitly.
    
           _store_cache cache_identifier param ...
    	      This function, together  with  _retrieve_cache  and  _cache_invalid,  implements	a
    	      caching  layer  which  can  be  used  in any completion function.  Data obtained by
    	      costly operations are stored in parameters; this function then dumps the values  of
    	      those  parameters to a file.  The data can then be retrieved quickly from that file
    	      via _retrieve_cache, even in different instances of the shell.
    
    	      The cache_identifier specifies the file which the data should be	dumped	to.   The
    	      file  is	stored in a directory specified by the cache-path style which defaults to
    	      ~/.zcompcache.  The remaining params arguments are the parameters to  dump  to  the
    	      file.
    
    	      The  return  status  is  zero  if  storage  was successful.  The function will only
    	      attempt storage if the use-cache style is set, so you can call this function  with‐
    	      out worrying about whether the user wanted to use the caching layer.
    
    	      The  completion  function may avoid calling _retrieve_cache when it already has the
    	      completion data available as parameters.	However, in  that  case  it  should  call
    	      _cache_invalid  to  check  whether  the data in the parameters and in the cache are
    	      still valid.
    
    	      See the _perl_modules completion function for a simple example of the usage of  the
    	      caching layer.
    
           _tags [ [ -C name ] tag ... ]
    	      If called with arguments, these are taken to be the names of tags valid for comple‐
    	      tions in the current context.  These tags are stored internally and sorted by using
    	      the tag-order style.
    
    	      Next,  _tags  is called repeatedly without arguments from the same completion func‐
    	      tion.  This successively selects the first, second, etc. set of tags  requested  by
    	      the  user.   The return status is zero if at least one of the tags is requested and
    	      non-zero otherwise.  To test if a particular tag is to  be  tried,  the  _requested
    	      function should be called (see above).
    
    	      If `-C name' is given, name is temporarily stored in the argument field (the fifth)
    	      of the context in the curcontext parameter during the call to _tags; the	field  is
    	      restored	on exit.  This allows _tags to use a more specific context without having
    	      to change and reset the curcontext parameter (which has the same effect).
    
           _values [ -O name ] [ -s sep ] [ -S sep ] [ -wC ] desc spec ...
    	      This is used to complete arbitrary keywords (values) and their arguments, or  lists
    	      of such combinations.
    
    	      If  the  first argument is the option `-O name', it will be used in the same way as
    	      by the _arguments function.  In other words, the elements of the name array will be
    	      passed to compadd when executing an action.
    
    	      If  the  first  argument	(or the first argument after `-O name') is `-s', the next
    	      argument is used as the character that separates multiple values.   This	character
    	      is  automatically  added after each value in an auto-removable fashion (see below);
    	      all values completed by `_values -s' appear in the same word on the  command  line,
    	      unlike  completion  using _arguments.  If this option is not present, only a single
    	      value will be completed per word.
    
    	      Normally, _values will only use the current word	to  determine  which  values  are
    	      already  present	on  the command line and hence are not to be completed again.  If
    	      the -w option is given, other arguments are examined as well.
    
    	      The first non-option argument is used as a string to print as a description  before
    	      listing the values.
    
    	      All  other  arguments  describe the possible values and their arguments in the same
    	      format used for the description of options by the _arguments function (see  above).
    	      The  only  differences are that no minus or plus sign is required at the beginning,
    	      values can have only one argument, and the forms of action beginning with an  equal
    	      sign are not supported.
    
    	      The  character  separating a value from its argument can be set using the option -S
    	      (like -s, followed by the character to use as the separator in the next  argument).
    	      By  default  the equals sign will be used as the separator between values and argu‐
    	      ments.
    
    	      Example:
    
    		     _values -s , 'description' \
    			     '*foo[bar]' \
    			     '(two)*one[number]:first count:' \
    			     'two[another number]::second count:(1 2 3)'
    
    	      This describes three possible values:  `foo',  `one',  and  `two'.   The	first  is
    	      described as `bar', takes no argument and may appear more than once.  The second is
    	      described as `number', may appear more than once, and takes one mandatory  argument
    	      described  as  `first  count'; no action is specified, so it will not be completed.
    	      The `(two)' at the beginning says that if the value `one' is on the line, the value
    	      `two'  will no longer be considered a possible completion.  Finally, the last value
    	      (`two') is described as `another number' and takes an optional  argument	described
    	      as  `second count' for which the completions (to appear after an `=') are `1', `2',
    	      and `3'.	The _values function will complete lists of  these  values  separated  by
    	      commas.
    
    	      Like  _arguments,  this function temporarily adds another context name component to
    	      the arguments element (the fifth)  of  the  current  context  while  executing  the
    	      action.	Here  this  name  is just the name of the value for which the argument is
    	      completed.
    
    	      The style verbose is used to decide if the descriptions for  the	values	(but  not
    	      those for the arguments) should be printed.
    
    	      The  associative	array val_args is used to report values and their arguments; this
    	      works similarly to the opt_args associative array used by  _arguments.   Hence  the
    	      function	calling  _values  should declare the local parameters state, state_descr,
    	      line, context and val_args:
    
    		     local context state state_descr line
    		     typeset -A val_args
    
    	      when using an action of the form `->string'.  With this function the context param‐
    	      eter  will be set to the name of the value whose argument is to be completed.  Note
    	      that for _values, the state and state_descr are scalars rather than arrays.  Only a
    	      single matching state is returned.
    
    	      Note  also  that	_values normally adds the character used as the separator between
    	      values as an auto-removable suffix (similar to a `/' after a directory).	 However,
    	      this  is	not  possible for a `->string' action as the matches for the argument are
    	      generated by the calling function.  To get the usual behaviour, the  calling  func‐
    	      tion  can  add  the  separator  x as a suffix by passing the options `-qS x' either
    	      directly or indirectly to compadd.
    
    	      The option -C is treated in the same way as it is by _arguments.	In that case  the
    	      parameter curcontext should be made local instead of context (as described above).
    
           _wanted [ -x ] [ -C name ]  [ -12VJ ] tag name descr command [ arg ...]
    	      In  many contexts, completion can only generate one particular set of matches, usu‐
    	      ally corresponding to a single tag.  However,  it  is  still  necessary  to  decide
    	      whether  the user requires matches of this type.	This function is useful in such a
    	      case.
    
    	      The arguments to _wanted are the same as those to _requested, i.e. arguments to  be
    	      passed  to  _description.   However, in this case the command is not optional;  all
    	      the processing of tags, including the loop over both tags and tag  labels  and  the
    	      generation of matches, is carried out automatically by _wanted.
    
    	      Hence  to offer only one tag and immediately add the corresponding matches with the
    	      given description:
    
    		     local expl
    		     _wanted tag expl 'description' \
    			 compadd matches...
    
    	      Note that, as for _requested, the command must be able  to  accept  options  to  be
    	      passed down to compadd.
    
    	      Like  _tags  this  function supports the -C option to give a different name for the
    	      argument context field.  The -x option has the same meaning as for _description.
    
    COMPLETION DIRECTORIES
           In the source distribution, the files are contained in various subdirectories of the  Com‐
           pletion directory.  They may have been installed in the same structure, or into one single
           function directory.  The following is a description of the files  found	in  the  original
           directory  structure.  If you wish to alter an installed file, you will need to copy it to
           some directory which appears earlier in your fpath than the standard  directory	where  it
           appears.
    
           Base   The core functions and special completion widgets automatically bound to keys.  You
    	      will certainly need most of these, though will probably not  need  to  alter  them.
    	      Many of these are documented above.
    
           Zsh    Functions  for completing arguments of shell builtin commands and utility functions
    	      for this.  Some of these are also used by functions from the Unix directory.
    
           Unix   Functions for completing arguments of external commands  and  suites  of	commands.
    	      They  may  need  modifying  for your system, although in many cases some attempt is
    	      made to decide which version of a command is present.  For example, completion  for
    	      the  mount command tries to determine the system it is running on, while completion
    	      for many other utilities try to decide whether the GNU version of the command is in
    	      use, and hence whether the --help option is supported.
    
           X, AIX, BSD, ...
    	      Completion and utility function for commands available only on some systems.  These
    	      are not arranged hierarchically, so, for example, both the Linux and Debian  direc‐
    	      tories, as well as the X directory, may be useful on your system.
    
    ZSHCOMPCTL(1)			     General Commands Manual			    ZSHCOMPCTL(1)
    
    NAME
           zshcompctl - zsh programmable completion
    
    DESCRIPTION
           This  version  of  zsh has two ways of performing completion of words on the command line.
           New users of the shell may prefer to use the newer and more powerful system based on shell
           functions;  this  is described in zshcompsys(1), and the basic shell mechanisms which sup‐
           port it are described in zshcompwid(1).	This manual entry  describes  the  older  compctl
           command.
    
           compctl [ -CDT ] options [ command ... ]
           compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]
    	       [ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]
           compctl -M match-specs ...
           compctl -L [ -CDTM ] [ command ... ]
           compctl + command ...
    
           Control	the editor's completion behavior according to the supplied set of options.  Vari‐
           ous editing commands, notably expand-or-complete-word, usually bound to tab, will  attempt
           to  complete  a word typed by the user, while others, notably delete-char-or-list, usually
           bound to ^D in EMACS editing mode, list the possibilities;  compctl  controls  what  those
           possibilities are.  They may for example be filenames (the most common case, and hence the
           default), shell variables, or words from a user-specified list.
    
    COMMAND FLAGS
           Completion of the arguments of a command may be different for each command or may use  the
           default.   The  behavior  when  completing  the command word itself may also be separately
           specified.  These correspond to the following flags and arguments, all  of  which  (except
           for  -L) may be combined with any combination of the options described subsequently in the
           section `Option Flags':
    
           command ...
    	      controls completion for the named commands, which must be listed last on	the  com‐
    	      mand  line.   If	completion  is attempted for a command with a pathname containing
    	      slashes and no completion definition is found, the search is retried with the  last
    	      pathname	component.  If	the command starts with a =, completion is tried with the
    	      pathname of the command.
    
    	      Any of the command strings may be patterns of the form normally used  for  filename
    	      generation.   These  should be quoted to protect them from immediate expansion; for
    	      example the command string 'foo*' arranges for completion of the words of any  com‐
    	      mand beginning with foo.	When completion is attempted, all pattern completions are
    	      tried in the reverse order of their definition until one matches.  By default, com‐
    	      pletion  then  proceeds as normal, i.e. the shell will try to generate more matches
    	      for the specific command on the command line; this can be overridden  by	including
    	      -tn in the flags for the pattern completion.
    
    	      Note  that  aliases  are	expanded before the command name is determined unless the
    	      COMPLETE_ALIASES option is set.  Commands may not be combined with the -C, -D or -T
    	      flags.
    
           -C     controls completion when the command word itself is being completed.  If no compctl
    	      -C command has been issued,  the names of any executable command	(whether  in  the
    	      path or specific to the shell, such as aliases or functions) are completed.
    
           -D     controls default completion behavior for the arguments of commands not assigned any
    	      special behavior.  If no compctl -D command has been  issued,  filenames	are  com‐
    	      pleted.
    
           -T     supplies	completion  flags  to  be  used before any other processing is done, even
    	      before processing for compctls defined for specific commands.  This  is  especially
    	      useful  when  combined  with  extended  completion  (the	-x  flag, see the section
    	      `Extended Completion' below).  Using this flag  you  can	define	default  behavior
    	      which  will  apply to all commands without exception, or you can alter the standard
    	      behavior for all commands.  For example, if your access to the user database is too
    	      slow and/or it contains too many users (so that completion after `~' is too slow to
    	      be usable), you can use
    
    		     compctl -T -x 's[~] C[0,[^/]#]' -k friends -S/ -tn
    
    	      to complete the strings in the array friends after a `~'.  The C[...]  argument  is
    	      necessary  so  that this form of ~-completion is not tried after the directory name
    	      is finished.
    
           -L     lists the existing completion behavior in a manner  suitable  for  putting  into	a
    	      start-up	script;  the  existing	behavior  is not changed.  Any combination of the
    	      above forms, or the -M flag (which must follow the -L flag), may be specified, oth‐
    	      erwise all defined completions are listed.  Any other flags supplied are ignored.
    
           no argument
    	      If  no  argument	is given, compctl lists all defined completions in an abbreviated
    	      form;  with a list of options, all completions with those flags set  (not  counting
    	      extended completion) are listed.
    
           If the + flag is alone and followed immediately by the command list, the completion behav‐
           ior for all the commands in the list is reset to the default.  In other words,  completion
           will subsequently use the options specified by the -D flag.
    
           The  form with -M as the first and only option defines global matching specifications (see
           zshcompwid). The match specifications given will be  used  for  every  completion  attempt
           (only  when  using compctl, not with the new completion system) and are tried in the order
           in which they are defined until one generates at least one match. E.g.:
    
    	      compctl -M '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
    
           This will first try completion without any global match specifications (the empty  string)
           and, if that generates no matches, will try case insensitive completion.
    
    OPTION FLAGS
           [ -fcFBdeaRGovNAIOPZEnbjrzu/12 ]
           [ -k array ] [ -g globstring ] [ -s subststring ]
           [ -K function ]
           [ -Q ] [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
           [ -W file-prefix ] [ -H num pattern ]
           [ -q ] [ -X explanation ] [ -Y explanation ]
           [ -y func-or-var ] [ -l cmd ] [ -h cmd ] [ -U ]
           [ -t continue ] [ -J name ] [ -V name ]
           [ -M match-spec ]
    
           The remaining options specify the type of command arguments to look for during completion.
           Any combination of these flags may be specified; the result is a sorted list  of  all  the
           possibilities.  The options are as follows.
    
       Simple Flags
           These produce completion lists made up by the shell itself:
    
           -f     Filenames and file system paths.
    
           -/     Just file system paths.
    
           -c     Command names, including aliases, shell functions, builtins and reserved words.
    
           -F     Function names.
    
           -B     Names of builtin commands.
    
           -m     Names of external commands.
    
           -w     Reserved words.
    
           -a     Alias names.
    
           -R     Names of regular (non-global) aliases.
    
           -G     Names of global aliases.
    
           -d     This  can be combined with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G to get names of disabled func‐
    	      tions, builtins, reserved words or aliases.
    
           -e     This option (to show enabled commands) is in effect by default, but may be combined
    	      with  -d;  -de in combination with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G will complete names of
    	      functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases whether or not they are disabled.
    
           -o     Names of shell options (see zshoptions(1)).
    
           -v     Names of any variable defined in the shell.
    
           -N     Names of scalar (non-array) parameters.
    
           -A     Array names.
    
           -I     Names of integer variables.
    
           -O     Names of read-only variables.
    
           -p     Names of parameters used by the shell (including special parameters).
    
           -Z     Names of shell special parameters.
    
           -E     Names of environment variables.
    
           -n     Named directories.
    
           -b     Key binding names.
    
           -j     Job names:  the first word of the job leader's command line.  This is  useful  with
    	      the kill builtin.
    
           -r     Names of running jobs.
    
           -z     Names of suspended jobs.
    
           -u     User names.
    
       Flags with Arguments
           These  have user supplied arguments to determine how the list of completions is to be made
           up:
    
           -k array
    	      Names taken from the elements of $array (note that the `$' does not appear  on  the
    	      command  line).  Alternatively, the argument array itself may be a set of space- or
    	      comma-separated values in parentheses, in which any delimiter may be escaped with a
    	      backslash; in this case the argument should be quoted.  For example,
    
    		     compctl -k "(cputime filesize datasize stacksize
    				 coredumpsize resident descriptors)" limit
    
           -g globstring
    	      The  globstring is expanded using filename globbing; it should be quoted to protect
    	      it from immediate expansion. The resulting filenames are taken as the possible com‐
    	      pletions.  Use `*(/)' instead of `*/' for directories.  The fignore special parame‐
    	      ter is not applied to the resulting files.  More than one pattern may be given sep‐
    	      arated by blanks. (Note that brace expansion is not part of globbing.  Use the syn‐
    	      tax `(either|or)' to match alternatives.)
    
           -s subststring
    	      The subststring is split into words and these words are  than  expanded  using  all
    	      shell expansion mechanisms (see zshexpn(1)).  The resulting words are taken as pos‐
    	      sible completions.  The fignore special parameter is not applied to  the	resulting
    	      files.  Note that -g is faster for filenames.
    
           -K function
    	      Call  the  given	function  to get the completions.  Unless the name starts with an
    	      underscore, the function is passed two arguments: the prefix and the suffix of  the
    	      word on which completion is to be attempted, in other words those characters before
    	      the cursor position, and those from the cursor position onwards.	The whole command
    	      line  can  be  accessed  with the -c and -l flags of the read builtin. The function
    	      should set the variable reply to an array containing the completions  (one  comple‐
    	      tion  per element); note that reply should not be made local to the function.  From
    	      such a function the command line can be accessed with the -c and -l  flags  to  the
    	      read builtin.  For example,
    
    		     function whoson { reply=(`users`); }
    		     compctl -K whoson talk
    
    	      completes  only  logged-on  users  after `talk'.	Note that `whoson' must return an
    	      array, so `reply=`users`' would be incorrect.
    
           -H num pattern
    	      The possible completions are taken from the last num  history  lines.   Only  words
    	      matching	pattern  are  taken.   If  num	is  zero or negative the whole history is
    	      searched and if pattern is the empty string all words are taken (as with	`*').	A
    	      typical use is
    
    		     compctl -D -f + -H 0 ''
    
    	      which  forces completion to look back in the history list for a word if no filename
    	      matches.
    
       Control Flags
           These do not directly specify types of name to be completed, but  manipulate  the  options
           that do:
    
           -Q     This  instructs  the  shell not to quote any metacharacters in the possible comple‐
    	      tions.  Normally the results of a completion are inserted  into  the  command  line
    	      with  any  metacharacters quoted so that they are interpreted as normal characters.
    	      This is appropriate for filenames  and  ordinary	strings.   However,  for  special
    	      effects,	such as inserting a backquoted expression from a completion array (-k) so
    	      that the expression will not be evaluated until the complete line is executed, this
    	      option must be used.
    
           -P prefix
    	      The  prefix  is inserted just before the completed string; any initial part already
    	      typed will be completed and the whole prefix ignored for completion purposes.   For
    	      example,
    
    		     compctl -j -P "%" kill
    
    	      inserts a `%' after the kill command and then completes job names.
    
           -S suffix
    	      When  a  completion is found the suffix is inserted after the completed string.  In
    	      the case of menu completion the suffix is inserted immediately,  but  it	is  still
    	      possible	to  cycle  through the list of completions by repeatedly hitting the same
    	      key.
    
           -W file-prefix
    	      With directory file-prefix:  for command, file, directory and  globbing  completion
    	      (options	-c, -f, -/, -g), the file prefix is implicitly added in front of the com‐
    	      pletion.	For example,
    
    		     compctl -/ -W ~/Mail maildirs
    
    	      completes any subdirectories to any depth beneath the  directory	~/Mail,  although
    	      that  prefix  does  not appear on the command line.  The file-prefix may also be of
    	      the form accepted by the -k flag, i.e. the name of an array or a	literal  list  in
    	      parenthesis. In this case all the directories in the list will be searched for pos‐
    	      sible completions.
    
           -q     If used with a suffix as specified by the -S option, this causes the suffix  to  be
    	      removed  if  the	next character typed is a blank or does not insert anything or if
    	      the suffix consists of only one character and the next character typed is the  same
    	      character; this the same rule used for the AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH option.  The option is
    	      most useful for list separators (comma, colon, etc.).
    
           -l cmd This option restricts the range of command line words that  are  considered  to  be
    	      arguments.   If  combined  with  one  of the extended completion patterns `p[...]',
    	      `r[...]', or `R[...]'  (see the section `Extended Completion' below) the	range  is
    	      restricted to the range of arguments specified in the brackets.  Completion is then
    	      performed as if these had been given as arguments to  the  cmd  supplied	with  the
    	      option.  If the cmd string is empty the first word in the range is instead taken as
    	      the command name, and command name completion performed on the first  word  in  the
    	      range.  For example,
    
    		     compctl -x 'r[-exec,;]' -l '' -- find
    
    	      completes  arguments  between `-exec' and the following `;' (or the end of the com‐
    	      mand line if there is no such string) as if they were a separate command line.
    
           -h cmd Normally zsh completes quoted strings as a whole. With this option, completion  can
    	      be  done separately on different parts of such strings. It works like the -l option
    	      but makes the completion code work on the parts of the current word that are  sepa‐
    	      rated  by  spaces. These parts are completed as if they were arguments to the given
    	      cmd. If cmd is the empty string, the first part is completed as a command name,  as
    	      with -l.
    
           -U     Use  the whole list of possible completions, whether or not they actually match the
    	      word on the command line.  The word typed so far will be	deleted.   This  is  most
    	      useful  with  a function (given by the -K option) which can examine the word compo‐
    	      nents passed to it (or via the read builtin's -c and -l flags) and use its own cri‐
    	      teria  to  decide  what  matches.   If there is no completion, the original word is
    	      retained.  Since the produced possible completions seldom have  interesting  common
    	      prefixes	and  suffixes, menu completion is started immediately if AUTO_MENU is set
    	      and this flag is used.
    
           -y func-or-var
    	      The list provided by func-or-var is displayed instead of the  list  of  completions
    	      whenever	a  listing  is	required;  the	actual completions to be inserted are not
    	      affected.  It can be provided in two ways. Firstly, if func-or-var begins with a	$
    	      it  defines  a  variable,  or if it begins with a left parenthesis a literal array,
    	      which contains the list.	A variable may have been set by  a  call  to  a  function
    	      using  the  -K  option.  Otherwise it contains the name of a function which will be
    	      executed to create the list.  The function will be passed as an argument	list  all
    	      matching	completions, including prefixes and suffixes expanded in full, and should
    	      set the array reply to the result.  In both cases, the display list  will  only  be
    	      retrieved after a complete list of matches has been created.
    
    	      Note  that  the  returned  list does not have to correspond, even in length, to the
    	      original set of matches, and may be passed as a scalar instead  of  an  array.   No
    	      special  formatting  of characters is performed on the output in this case; in par‐
    	      ticular, newlines are printed literally and if they appear  output  in  columns  is
    	      suppressed.
    
           -X explanation
    	      Print  explanation  when trying completion on the current set of options. A `%n' in
    	      this string is replaced by the number of matches that were added for this  explana‐
    	      tion string.  The explanation only appears if completion was tried and there was no
    	      unique match, or when listing  completions.  Explanation	strings  will  be  listed
    	      together with the matches of the group specified together with the -X option (using
    	      the -J or -V option). If the same  explanation  string  is  given  to  multiple  -X
    	      options,	the  string  appears only once (for each group) and the number of matches
    	      shown for the `%n' is the total number of all matches for each of  these	uses.  In
    	      any case, the explanation string will only be shown if there was at least one match
    	      added for the explanation string.
    
    	      The sequences %B, %b, %S, %s, %U, and %u specify output attributes (bold, standout,
    	      and  underline),	%F,  %f,  %K,  %k  specify foreground and background colours, and
    	      %{...%} can be used to include literal escape sequences as in prompts.
    
           -Y explanation
    	      Identical to -X, except that the explanation first  undergoes  expansion	following
    	      the  usual  rules  for strings in double quotes.	The expansion will be carried out
    	      after any functions are called for the -K or -y options, allowing them to set vari‐
    	      ables.
    
           -t continue
    	      The  continue-string  contains  a  character that specifies which set of completion
    	      flags should be used next.  It is useful:
    
    	      (i) With -T, or when trying a list of pattern completions, when compctl would  usu‐
    	      ally  continue  with  ordinary  processing  after finding matches; this can be sup‐
    	      pressed with `-tn'.
    
    	      (ii) With a list of alternatives separated by +, when compctl would  normally  stop
    	      when  one  of the alternatives generates matches.  It can be forced to consider the
    	      next set of completions by adding `-t+' to the flags of the alternative before  the
    	      `+'.
    
    	      (iii)  In an extended completion list (see below), when compctl would normally con‐
    	      tinue until a set of conditions succeeded, then use only the immediately	following
    	      flags.   With  `-t-',  compctl  will continue trying extended completions after the
    	      next `-'; with `-tx' it will attempt completion with the default	flags,	in  other
    	      words those before the `-x'.
    
           -J name
    	      This gives the name of the group the matches should be placed in. Groups are listed
    	      and sorted separately; likewise, menu completion will  offer  the  matches  in  the
    	      groups  in  the order in which the groups were defined. If no group name is explic‐
    	      itly given, the matches are stored in a group named default. The first time a group
    	      name is encountered, a group with that name is created. After that all matches with
    	      the same group name are stored in that group.
    
    	      This can be useful with non-exclusive alternative completions.  For example, in
    
    		     compctl -f -J files -t+ + -v -J variables foo
    
    	      both files and variables are possible completions, as the -t+ forces both  sets  of
    	      alternatives  before  and  after the + to be considered at once.	Because of the -J
    	      options, however, all files are listed before all variables.
    
           -V name
    	      Like -J, but matches within the group will not be sorted in listings  nor  in  menu
    	      completion.  These  unsorted  groups  are in a different name space from the sorted
    	      ones, so groups defined as -J files and -V files are distinct.
    
           -1     If given together with the -V option, makes  only  consecutive  duplicates  in  the
    	      group be removed. Note that groups with and without this flag are in different name
    	      spaces.
    
           -2     If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all duplicates	be  kept.  Again,
    	      groups with and without this flag are in different name spaces.
    
           -M match-spec
    	      This  defines  additional  matching control specifications that should be used only
    	      when testing words for the list of flags this flag appears in. The  format  of  the
    	      match-spec string is described in zshcompwid.
    
    ALTERNATIVE COMPLETION
           compctl [ -CDT ] options + options [ + ... ] [ + ] command ...
    
           The  form  with	`+'  specifies	alternative options. Completion is tried with the options
           before the first `+'. If this produces no matches completion is tried with the flags after
           the `+' and so on. If there are no flags after the last `+' and a match has not been found
           up to that point, default completion is tried.  If the list of flags contains a -t with	a
           + character, the next list of flags is used even if the current list produced matches.
    
           Additional  options  are  available  that  restrict completion to some part of the command
           line; this is referred to as `extended completion'.
    
    EXTENDED COMPLETION
           compctl [ -CDT ] options -x pattern options - ... --
    	       [ command ... ]
           compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]
    	       [ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]
    
           The form with `-x' specifies extended completion for the commands given; as shown, it  may
           be combined with alternative completion using `+'.  Each pattern is examined in turn; when
           a match is found, the corresponding options, as described in the  section  `Option  Flags'
           above,  are  used  to  generate	possible completions.  If no pattern matches, the options
           given before the -x are used.
    
           Note that each pattern should be supplied as a single argument and  should  be  quoted  to
           prevent expansion of metacharacters by the shell.
    
           A  pattern  is  built  of  sub-patterns separated by commas; it matches if at least one of
           these sub-patterns matches (they are `or'ed). These sub-patterns are in turn  composed  of
           other  sub-patterns separated by white spaces which match if all of the sub-patterns match
           (they are `and'ed).  An element of the sub-patterns is of the  form  `c[...][...]',  where
           the  pairs  of  brackets  may be repeated as often as necessary, and matches if any of the
           sets of brackets match (an `or').  The example below makes this clearer.
    
           The elements may be any of the following:
    
           s[string]...
    	      Matches if the current word on the command line starts  with  one  of  the  strings
    	      given in brackets.  The string is not removed and is not part of the completion.
    
           S[string]...
    	      Like s[string] except that the string is part of the completion.
    
           p[from,to]...
    	      Matches  if  the number of the current word is between one of the from and to pairs
    	      inclusive. The comma and to are optional; to defaults to the same  value	as  from.
    	      The numbers may be negative: -n refers to the n'th last word on the line.
    
           c[offset,string]...
    	      Matches if the string matches the word offset by offset from the current word posi‐
    	      tion.  Usually offset will be negative.
    
           C[offset,pattern]...
    	      Like c but using pattern matching instead.
    
           w[index,string]...
    	      Matches if the word in position index is equal to the corresponding  string.   Note
    	      that the word count is made after any alias expansion.
    
           W[index,pattern]...
    	      Like w but using pattern matching instead.
    
           n[index,string]...
    	      Matches  if  the	current  word  contains string.  Anything up to and including the
    	      indexth occurrence of this string will not be considered part  of  the  completion,
    	      but  the	rest  will.   index may be negative to count from the end: in most cases,
    	      index will be 1 or -1.  For example,
    
    		     compctl -s '`users`' -x 'n[1,@]' -k hosts -- talk
    
    	      will usually complete usernames, but if you insert an @ after the name, names  from
    	      the array hosts (assumed to contain hostnames, though you must make the array your‐
    	      self) will be completed.	Other commands such as rcp can be handled similarly.
    
           N[index,string]...
    	      Like n except that the string will be taken as a character class.  Anything  up  to
    	      and including the indexth occurrence of any of the characters in string will not be
    	      considered part of the completion.
    
           m[min,max]...
    	      Matches if the total number of words lies between min and max inclusive.
    
           r[str1,str2]...
    	      Matches if the cursor is after a word with prefix str1.  If there is  also  a  word
    	      with  prefix str2 on the command line after the one matched by str1 it matches only
    	      if the cursor is before this word. If the comma and str2 are omitted, it matches if
    	      the cursor is after a word with prefix str1.
    
           R[str1,str2]...
    	      Like r but using pattern matching instead.
    
           q[str]...
    	      Matches  the  word currently being completed is in single quotes and the str begins
    	      with the letter `s', or if completion is done in double quotes and str starts  with
    	      the letter `d', or if completion is done in backticks and str starts with a `b'.
    
    EXAMPLE
    	      compctl -u -x 's[+] c[-1,-f],s[-f+]' \
    		-g '~/Mail/*(:t)' - 's[-f],c[-1,-f]' -f -- mail
    
           This is to be interpreted as follows:
    
           If the current command is mail, then
    
    	      if ((the current word begins with + and the previous word is -f)
    	      or (the current word begins with -f+)), then complete the
    	      non-directory part (the `:t' glob modifier) of files in the directory
    	      ~/Mail; else
    
    	      if the current word begins with -f or the previous word was -f, then
    	      complete any file; else
    
    	      complete user names.
    
    ZSHMODULES(1)			     General Commands Manual			    ZSHMODULES(1)
    
    NAME
           zshmodules - zsh loadable modules
    
    DESCRIPTION
           Some  optional  parts of zsh are in modules, separate from the core of the shell.  Each of
           these modules may be linked in to the shell at build time, or can  be  dynamically  linked
           while  the shell is running if the installation supports this feature.  Modules are linked
           at runtime with the zmodload command, see zshbuiltins(1).
    
           The modules that are bundled with the zsh distribution are:
    
           zsh/attr
    	      Builtins for manipulating extended attributes (xattr).
    
           zsh/cap
    	      Builtins for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability (privilege) sets.
    
           zsh/clone
    	      A builtin that can clone a running shell onto another terminal.
    
           zsh/compctl
    	      The compctl builtin for controlling completion.
    
           zsh/complete
    	      The basic completion code.
    
           zsh/complist
    	      Completion listing extensions.
    
           zsh/computil
    	      A module with utility builtins needed for the shell function based completion  sys‐
    	      tem.
    
           zsh/curses
    	      curses windowing commands
    
           zsh/datetime
    	      Some date/time commands and parameters.
    
           zsh/db/gdbm
    	      Builtins for managing associative array parameters tied to GDBM databases.
    
           zsh/deltochar
    	      A ZLE function duplicating EMACS' zap-to-char.
    
           zsh/example
    	      An example of how to write a module.
    
           zsh/files
    	      Some basic file manipulation commands as builtins.
    
           zsh/langinfo
    	      Interface to locale information.
    
           zsh/mapfile
    	      Access to external files via a special associative array.
    
           zsh/mathfunc
    	      Standard scientific functions for use in mathematical evaluations.
    
           zsh/newuser
    	      Arrange for files for new users to be installed.
    
           zsh/parameter
    	      Access to internal hash tables via special associative arrays.
    
           zsh/pcre
    	      Interface to the PCRE library.
    
           zsh/regex
    	      Interface to the POSIX regex library.
    
           zsh/sched
    	      A builtin that provides a timed execution facility within the shell.
    
           zsh/net/socket
    	      Manipulation of Unix domain sockets
    
           zsh/stat
    	      A builtin command interface to the stat system call.
    
           zsh/system
    	      A builtin interface to various low-level system features.
    
           zsh/net/tcp
    	      Manipulation of TCP sockets
    
           zsh/termcap
    	      Interface to the termcap database.
    
           zsh/terminfo
    	      Interface to the terminfo database.
    
           zsh/zftp
    	      A builtin FTP client.
    
           zsh/zle
    	      The Zsh Line Editor, including the bindkey and vared builtins.
    
           zsh/zleparameter
    	      Access to internals of the Zsh Line Editor via parameters.
    
           zsh/zprof
    	      A module allowing profiling for shell functions.
    
           zsh/zpty
    	      A builtin for starting a command in a pseudo-terminal.
    
           zsh/zselect
    	      Block and return when file descriptors are ready.
    
           zsh/zutil
    	      Some utility builtins, e.g. the one for supporting configuration via styles.
    
    THE ZSH/ATTR MODULE
           The  zsh/attr  module  is used for manipulating extended attributes.  The -h option causes
           all commands to operate on symbolic links instead of their targets.  The builtins in  this
           module are:
    
           zgetattr [ -h ] filename attribute [ parameter ]
    	      Get  the	extended attribute attribute from the specified filename. If the optional
    	      argument parameter is given, the attribute is set  on  that  parameter  instead  of
    	      being printed to stdout.
    
           zsetattr [ -h ] filename attribute value
    	      Set the extended attribute attribute on the specified filename to value.
    
           zdelattr [ -h ] filename attribute
    	      Remove the extended attribute attribute from the specified filename.
    
           zlistattr [ -h ] filename [ parameter ]
    	      List  the  extended  attributes  currently  set  on  the specified filename. If the
    	      optional argument parameter is given, the list of attributes is set on that parame‐
    	      ter instead of being printed to stdout.
    
           zgetattr  and  zlistattr  allocate  memory  dynamically.   If  the  attribute  or  list of
           attributes grows between the allocation and the call to get them, they return 2.   On  all
           other  errors, 1 is returned.  This allows the calling function to check for this case and
           retry.
    
    THE ZSH/CAP MODULE
           The zsh/cap module is used for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability  sets.   If  the
           operating system does not support this interface, the builtins defined by this module will
           do nothing.  The builtins in this module are:
    
           cap [ capabilities ]
    	      Change the shell's process capability sets to the specified capabilities, otherwise
    	      display the shell's current capabilities.
    
           getcap filename ...
    	      This  is	a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.  It displays the
    	      capability sets on each specified filename.
    
           setcap capabilities filename ...
    	      This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.	It sets the capa‐
    	      bility sets on each specified filename to the specified capabilities.
    
    THE ZSH/CLONE MODULE
           The zsh/clone module makes available one builtin command:
    
           clone tty
    	      Creates  a forked instance of the current shell, attached to the specified tty.  In
    	      the new shell, the PID, PPID and TTY special parameters are changed  appropriately.
    	      $!  is  set  to  zero  in the new shell, and to the new shell's PID in the original
    	      shell.
    
    	      The return status of the builtin is zero in both shells if successful, and non-zero
    	      on error.
    
    	      The target of clone should be an unused terminal, such as an unused virtual console
    	      or a virtual terminal created by
    
    		     xterm -e sh -c 'trap : INT QUIT TSTP; tty;
    			     while :; do sleep 100000000; done'
    
    	      Some words of explanation are warranted about this long xterm  command  line:  when
    	      doing  clone  on	a  pseudo-terminal, some other session ("session" meant as a unix
    	      session group, or SID) is already owning the terminal. Hence the cloned zsh  cannot
    	      acquire the pseudo-terminal as a controlling tty. That means two things:
    
    	      ·      the  job  control	signals  will go to the sh-started-by-xterm process group
    		     (that's why we disable INT QUIT and TSTP with trap; otherwise the while loop
    		     could get suspended or killed)
    
    	      ·      the  cloned  shell  will have job control disabled, and the job control keys
    		     (control-C, control-\ and control-Z) will not work.
    
    	      This does not apply when cloning to an unused vc.
    
    	      Cloning to a used (and unprepared) terminal will result in  two  processes  reading
    	      simultaneously  from  the  same terminal, with input bytes going randomly to either
    	      process.
    
    	      clone is mostly useful as a shell built-in replacement for openvt.
    
    THE ZSH/COMPCTL MODULE
           The zsh/compctl module makes available two builtin commands. compctl, is the  old,  depre‐
           cated  way to control completions for ZLE.  See zshcompctl(1).  The other builtin command,
           compcall can be used in user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).
    
    THE ZSH/COMPLETE MODULE
           The zsh/complete module makes available several builtin commands  which	can  be  used  in
           user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).
    
    THE ZSH/COMPLIST MODULE
           The  zsh/complist  module  offers  three extensions to completion listings: the ability to
           highlight matches in such a list, the ability to scroll through long lists and a different
           style of menu completion.
    
       Colored completion listings
           Whenever  one of the parameters ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS is set and the zsh/complist mod‐
           ule is loaded or linked into the shell, completion lists will be colored.  Note,  however,
           that  complist  will  not automatically be loaded if it is not linked in:  on systems with
           dynamic loading, `zmodload zsh/complist' is required.
    
           The parameters ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS describe how matches are highlighted.	 To  turn
           on  highlighting an empty value suffices, in which case all the default values given below
           will be used.  The format of the value of these parameters is the same as used by the  GNU
           version	of  the  ls  command:  a  colon-separated  list  of  specifications  of  the form
           `name=value'.  The name may be one of the following strings, most of  which  specify  file
           types for which the value will be used.	The strings and their default values are:
    
           no 0   for normal text (i.e. when displaying something other than a matched file)
    
           fi 0   for regular files
    
           di 32  for directories
    
           ln 36  for  symbolic  links.   If  this	has  the special value target, symbolic links are
    	      dereferenced and the target file used to determine the display format.
    
           pi 31  for named pipes (FIFOs)
    
           so 33  for sockets
    
           bd 44;37
    	      for block devices
    
           cd 44;37
    	      for character devices
    
           or none
    	      for a symlink to nonexistent file (default is the value defined for ln)
    
           mi none
    	      for a non-existent file (default is the value defined for fi); this  code  is  cur‐
    	      rently not used
    
           su 37;41
    	      for files with setuid bit set
    
           sg 30;43
    	      for files with setgid bit set
    
           tw 30;42
    	      for world writable directories with sticky bit set
    
           ow 34;43
    	      for world writable directories without sticky bit set
    
           sa none
    	      for  files with an associated suffix alias; this is only tested after specific suf‐
    	      fixes, as described below
    
           st 37;44
    	      for directories with sticky bit set but not world writable
    
           ex 35  for executable files
    
           lc \e[ for the left code (see below)
    
           rc m   for the right code
    
           tc 0   for the character  indicating  the  file	type   printed	after  filenames  if  the
    	      LIST_TYPES option is set
    
           sp 0   for the spaces printed after matches to align the next column
    
           ec none
    	      for the end code
    
           Apart  from  these strings, the name may also be an asterisk (`*') followed by any string.
           The value given for such a string will be used for all files  whose  name  ends	with  the
           string.	 The  name  may  also  be  an  equals  sign  (`=')  followed  by  a  pattern; the
           EXTENDED_GLOB option will be turned on for evaluation of the pattern.  The value given for
           this  pattern  will  be used for all matches (not just filenames) whose display string are
           matched by the pattern.	Definitions for the form with the leading equal sign take  prece‐
           dence  over the values defined for file types, which in turn take precedence over the form
           with the leading asterisk (file extensions).
    
           The leading-equals form also allows different parts of the displayed strings to be colored
           differently.   For  this,  the  pattern	has  to use the `(#b)' globbing flag and pairs of
           parentheses surrounding the parts of the strings that are to be colored	differently.   In
           this case the value may consist of more than one color code separated by equal signs.  The
           first code will be used for all parts for which no explicit code is specified and the fol‐
           lowing  codes  will be used for the parts matched by the sub-patterns in parentheses.  For
           example, the specification `=(#b)(?)*(?)=0=3=7' will be used for all matches which are  at
           least  two  characters long and will use the code `3' for the first character, `7' for the
           last character and `0' for the rest.
    
           All three forms of name may be preceded by a pattern in parentheses.  If  this  is  given,
           the  value  will be used only for matches in groups whose names are matched by the pattern
           given in the parentheses.  For example, `(g*)m*=43' highlights all matches beginning  with
           `m' in groups whose names  begin with `g' using the color code `43'.  In case of the `lc',
           `rc', and `ec' codes, the group pattern is ignored.
    
           Note also that all patterns are tried in the order in which they appear in  the	parameter
           value until the first one matches which is then used.
    
           When printing a match, the code prints the value of lc, the value for the file-type or the
           last matching specification with a `*', the value of rc, the string  to	display  for  the
           match  itself, and then the value of ec if that is defined or the values of lc, no, and rc
           if ec is not defined.
    
           The default values are ISO 6429 (ANSI) compliant and can be used on vt100 compatible  ter‐
           minals  such  as  xterms.  On monochrome terminals the default values will have no visible
           effect.	The colors function from the contribution can be used to get  associative  arrays
           containing  the	codes  for  ANSI  terminals (see the section `Other Functions' in zshcon‐
           trib(1)).  For example, after loading colors, one could use `$colors[red]' to get the code
           for foreground color red and `$colors[bg-green]' for the code for background color green.
    
           If  the	completion system invoked by compinit is used, these parameters should not be set
           directly because the system controls them itself.  Instead, the list-colors  style  should
           be used (see the section `Completion System Configuration' in zshcompsys(1)).
    
       Scrolling in completion listings
           To  enable scrolling through a completion list, the LISTPROMPT parameter must be set.  Its
           value will be used as the prompt; if it is the empty string,  a	default  prompt  will  be
           used.   The  value  may	contain  escapes of the form `%x'.  It supports the escapes `%B',
           `%b', `%S', `%s', `%U', `%u', `%F', `%f', `%K', `%k' and  `%{...%}'  used  also	in  shell
           prompts	as well as three pairs of additional sequences: a `%l' or `%L' is replaced by the
           number of the last line shown and the total number of lines in the form `number/total';	a
           `%m'  or  `%M' is replaced with the number of the last match shown and the total number of
           matches; and `%p' or `%P' is replaced with `Top', `Bottom' or the position  of  the  first
           line  shown in percent of the total number of lines, respectively.  In each of these cases
           the form with the uppercase letter will be replaced with a string of fixed  width,  padded
           to the right with spaces, while the lowercase form will not be padded.
    
           If the parameter LISTPROMPT is set, the completion code will not ask if the list should be
           shown.  Instead it immediately starts  displaying  the  list,  stopping	after  the  first
           screenful,  showing  the  prompt  at  the bottom, waiting for a keypress after temporarily
           switching to the listscroll keymap.  Some of the zle  functions	have  a  special  meaning
           while scrolling lists:
    
           send-break
    	      stops listing discarding the key pressed
    
           accept-line, down-history, down-line-or-history
           down-line-or-search, vi-down-line-or-history
    	      scrolls forward one line
    
           complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
           expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-complete-or-expand
    	      scrolls forward one screenful
    
           accept-search
    	      stop listing but take no other action
    
           Every  other  character stops listing and immediately processes the key as usual.  Any key
           that is not bound in the listscroll keymap or that is bound to undefined-key is looked  up
           in the keymap currently selected.
    
           As  for	the  ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters, LISTPROMPT should not be set directly
           when using the shell function based completion system.	Instead,  the  list-prompt  style
           should be used.
    
       Menu selection
           The zsh/complist module also offers an alternative style of selecting matches from a list,
           called menu selection, which can be used if the shell is set up	to  return  to	the  last
           prompt  after  showing  a  completion  list  (see  the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option in zshop‐
           tions(1)).
    
           Menu selection can be invoked directly by the widget menu-select defined by  this  module.
           This  is a standard ZLE widget that can be bound to a key in the usual way as described in
           zshzle(1).
    
           Alternatively, the parameter MENUSELECT can be set to an integer, which gives the  minimum
           number  of  matches that must be present before menu selection is automatically turned on.
           This second method requires that menu completion be started, either directly from a widget
           such  as menu-complete, or due to one of the options MENU_COMPLETE or AUTO_MENU being set.
           If MENUSELECT is set, but is 0, 1 or empty, menu selection will always be  started  during
           an ambiguous menu completion.
    
           When using the completion system based on shell functions, the MENUSELECT parameter should
           not be used (like the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters  described  above).	 Instead,
           the menu style should be used with the select=... keyword.
    
           After  menu  selection  is  started, the matches will be listed. If there are more matches
           than fit on the screen, only the first screenful is shown.  The matches to insert into the
           command	line  can be selected from this list.  In the list one match is highlighted using
           the value for ma from the ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS parameter.  The default value for this
           is  `7'	which  forces  the  selected  match  to  be  highlighted using standout mode on a
           vt100-compatible terminal.  If neither ZLS_COLORS nor ZLS_COLOURS is set, the same  termi‐
           nal control sequence as for the `%S' escape in prompts is used.
    
           If  there are more matches than fit on the screen and the parameter MENUPROMPT is set, its
           value will be shown below the matches.  It supports the same  escape  sequences	as  LIST‐
           PROMPT,	but  the number of the match or line shown will be that of the one where the mark
           is placed.  If its value is the empty string, a default prompt will be used.
    
           The MENUSCROLL parameter can be used to specify how the list is scrolled.  If the  parame‐
           ter  is unset, this is done line by line, if it is set to `0' (zero), the list will scroll
           half the number of lines of the screen.	If the value is positive, it gives the number  of
           lines  to  scroll  and if it is negative, the list will be scrolled the number of lines of
           the screen minus the (absolute) value.
    
           As for the ZLS_COLORS, ZLS_COLOURS  and	LISTPROMPT  parameters,  neither  MENUPROMPT  nor
           MENUSCROLL  should  be set directly when using the shell function based completion system.
           Instead, the select-prompt and select-scroll styles should be used.
    
           The completion code sometimes decides not to show all of the matches in the  list.   These
           hidden  matches	are  either  matches  for  which the completion function which added them
           explicitly requested that they not appear in the list (using the -n option of the  compadd
           builtin command) or they are matches which duplicate a string already in the list (because
           they differ only in things like prefixes or suffixes that are not displayed).  In the list
           used  for  menu selection, however, even these matches are shown so that it is possible to
           select them.  To highlight such matches the hi and du capabilities in the  ZLS_COLORS  and
           ZLS_COLOURS  parameters	are  supported	for  hidden matches of the first and second kind,
           respectively.
    
           Selecting matches is done by moving the mark around  using  the	zle  movement  functions.
           When  not all matches can be shown on the screen at the same time, the list will scroll up
           and down when crossing the top or bottom line.  The following zle functions  have  special
           meaning	during	menu  selection.   Note  that  the following always perform the same task
           within the menu selection map and cannot be replaced by user defined widgets, nor can  the
           set of functions be extended:
    
           accept-line, accept-search
    	      accept  the  current  match  and leave menu selection (but do not cause the command
    	      line to be accepted)
    
           send-break
    	      leaves menu selection and restores the previous contents of the command line
    
           redisplay, clear-screen
    	      execute their normal function without leaving menu selection
    
           accept-and-hold, accept-and-menu-complete
    	      accept the currently inserted match and continue selection allowing to  select  the
    	      next match to insert into the line
    
           accept-and-infer-next-history
    	      accepts  the current match and then tries completion with menu selection again;  in
    	      the case of files this allows one to select a directory and immediately attempt  to
    	      complete	files in it;  if there are no matches, a message is shown and one can use
    	      undo to go back to completion on the previous level, every other	key  leaves  menu
    	      selection  (including  the  other  zle functions which are otherwise special during
    	      menu selection)
    
           undo   removes matches inserted during the menu selection by one of  the  three	functions
    	      before
    
           down-history, down-line-or-history
           vi-down-line-or-history,  down-line-or-search
    	      moves the mark one line down
    
           up-history, up-line-or-history
           vi-up-line-or-history, up-line-or-search
    	      moves the mark one line up
    
           forward-char, vi-forward-char
    	      moves the mark one column right
    
           backward-char, vi-backward-char
    	      moves the mark one column left
    
           forward-word, vi-forward-word
           vi-forward-word-end, emacs-forward-word
    	      moves the mark one screenful down
    
           backward-word, vi-backward-word, emacs-backward-word
    	      moves the mark one screenful up
    
           vi-forward-blank-word, vi-forward-blank-word-end
    	      moves the mark to the first line of the next group of matches
    
           vi-backward-blank-word
    	      moves the mark to the last line of the previous group of matches
    
           beginning-of-history
    	      moves the mark to the first line
    
           end-of-history
    	      moves the mark to the last line
    
           beginning-of-buffer-or-history, beginning-of-line
           beginning-of-line-hist, vi-beginning-of-line
    	      moves the mark to the leftmost column
    
           end-of-buffer-or-history, end-of-line
           end-of-line-hist, vi-end-of-line
    	      moves the mark to the rightmost column
    
           complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
           expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-expand-or-complete
    	      moves the mark to the next match
    
           reverse-menu-complete
    	      moves the mark to the previous match
    
           vi-insert
    	      this  toggles  between  normal  and  interactive mode; in interactive mode the keys
    	      bound to self-insert and self-insert-unmeta insert into the command line as in nor‐
    	      mal  editing  mode but without leaving menu selection; after each character comple‐
    	      tion is tried again and the list changes to contain only the new matches; the  com‐
    	      pletion widgets make the longest unambiguous string be inserted in the command line
    	      and undo and backward-delete-char go back to the previous set of matches
    
           history-incremental-search-forward
           history-incremental-search-backward
    	      this starts incremental searches in the list  of	completions  displayed;  in  this
    	      mode,  accept-line  only	leaves	incremental search, going back to the normal menu
    	      selection mode
    
           All movement functions wrap around at the edges; any other zle function not listed  leaves
           menu  selection	and  executes that function.  It is possible to make widgets in the above
           list do the same by using the form of the widget with a `.' in front.   For  example,  the
           widget  `.accept-line'  has  the effect of leaving menu selection and accepting the entire
           command line.
    
           During this selection the widget uses the keymap menuselect.  Any key that is not  defined
           in  this  keymap  or  that  is bound to undefined-key is looked up in the keymap currently
           selected.  This is used to ensure that the  most  important  keys  used	during	selection
           (namely	the  cursor  keys, return, and TAB) have sensible defaults.  However, keys in the
           menuselect keymap can be modified directly using the bindkey builtin command (see  zshmod‐
           ules(1)).  For  example, to make the return key leave menu selection without accepting the
           match currently selected one could call
    
    	      bindkey -M menuselect '^M' send-break
    
           after loading the zsh/complist module.
    
    THE ZSH/COMPUTIL MODULE
           The zsh/computil module adds several builtin commands that are used by some of the comple‐
           tion  functions	in  the  completion system based on shell functions (see zshcompsys(1) ).
           Except for compquote these builtin commands are very specialised and thus not very  inter‐
           esting  when  writing  your  own completion functions.  In summary, these builtin commands
           are:
    
           comparguments
    	      This is used by the _arguments function to do the argument and command  line  pars‐
    	      ing.   Like  compdescribe it has an option -i to do the parsing and initialize some
    	      internal state and various options to access the state information to  decide  what
    	      should be completed.
    
           compdescribe
    	      This is used by the _describe function to build the displays for the matches and to
    	      get the strings to add as matches with their options.  On the first call one of the
    	      options -i or -I should be supplied as the first argument.  In the first case, dis‐
    	      play strings without the descriptions will be generated, in the  second  case,  the
    	      string  used  to	separate the matches from their descriptions must be given as the
    	      second argument and the descriptions (if any) will be shown.  All  other	arguments
    	      are like the definition arguments to _describe itself.
    
    	      Once  compdescribe  has  been called with either the -i or the -I option, it can be
    	      repeatedly called with the -g option and the names of four parameters as its  argu‐
    	      ments.  This will step through the different sets of matches and store the value of
    	      compstate[list] in the first scalar, the options for compadd in the  second  array,
    	      the  matches  in the third array, and the strings to be displayed in the completion
    	      listing in the fourth array.  The arrays may then be directly given to  compadd  to
    	      register the matches with the completion code.
    
           compfiles
    	      Used  by the _path_files function to optimize complex recursive filename generation
    	      (globbing).  It does three things.  With the -p and -P options it builds	the  glob
    	      patterns	to  use,  including  the paths already handled and trying to optimize the
    	      patterns with respect to the prefix and suffix from the line and the match specifi‐
    	      cation  currently used.  The -i option does the directory tests for the ignore-par‐
    	      ents style and the -r option tests if a component for some of the matches are equal
    	      to the string on the line and removes all other matches if that is true.
    
           compgroups
    	      Used  by	the  _tags  function to implement the internals of the group-order style.
    	      This only takes its arguments as names of completion groups and creates the  groups
    	      for  it (all six types: sorted and unsorted, both without removing duplicates, with
    	      removing all duplicates and with removing consecutive duplicates).
    
           compquote [ -p ] names ...
    	      There may be reasons to write completion functions that have  to	add  the  matches
    	      using  the  -Q option to compadd and perform quoting themselves.	Instead of inter‐
    	      preting the first character of the all_quotes key of the compstate special associa‐
    	      tion  and  using the q flag for parameter expansions, one can use this builtin com‐
    	      mand.  The arguments are the names of scalar or array parameters and the values  of
    	      these  parameters  are quoted as needed for the innermost quoting level.	If the -p
    	      option is given, quoting is done as if there is some prefix before  the  values  of
    	      the parameters, so that a leading equal sign will not be quoted.
    
    	      The return status is non-zero in case of an error and zero otherwise.
    
           comptags
           comptry
    	      These implement the internals of the tags mechanism.
    
           compvalues
    	      Like comparguments, but for the _values function.
    
    THE ZSH/CURSES MODULE
           The zsh/curses module makes available one builtin command and various parameters.
    
       Builtin
           zcurses init
           zcurses end
           zcurses addwin targetwin nlines ncols begin_y begin_x [ parentwin ]
           zcurses delwin targetwin
           zcurses refresh [ targetwin ... ]
           zcurses touch targetwin ...
           zcurses move targetwin new_y new_x
           zcurses clear targetwin [ redraw | eol | bot ]
           zcurses position targetwin array
           zcurses char targetwin character
           zcurses string targetwin string
           zcurses border targetwin border
           zcurses attr targetwin [ [+|-]attribute | fg_col/bg_col ] [...]
           zcurses bg targetwin [ [+|-]attribute | fg_col/bg_col | @char ] [...]
           zcurses scroll targetwin [ on | off | [+|-]lines ]
           zcurses input targetwin [ param [ kparam [ mparam ] ] ]
           zcurses mouse [ delay num | [+|-]motion ]
           zcurses timeout targetwin intval
           zcurses querychar targetwin [ param ]
    	      Manipulate  curses  windows.   All  uses	of  this  command  should be bracketed by
    	      `zcurses init' to initialise use of curses, and `zcurses end' to end  it;  omitting
    	      `zcurses end' can cause the terminal to be in an unwanted state.
    
    	      The  subcommand  addwin  creates a window with nlines lines and ncols columns.  Its
    	      upper left corner will be placed at row begin_y and column begin_x of  the  screen.
    	      targetwin  is  a	string	and  refers to the name of a window that is not currently
    	      assigned.  Note in particular the curses convention  that  vertical  values  appear
    	      before horizontal values.
    
    	      If addwin is given an existing window as the final argument, the new window is cre‐
    	      ated as a subwindow of parentwin.  This differs from an ordinary new window in that
    	      the  memory  of the window contents is shared with the parent's memory.  Subwindows
    	      must be deleted before their parent.  Note that the coordinates of  subwindows  are
    	      relative to the screen, not the parent, as with other windows.
    
    	      Use  the	subcommand  delwin to delete a window created with addwin.  Note that end
    	      does not implicitly delete windows, and that delwin does not erase the screen image
    	      of the window.
    
    	      The  window  corresponding  to  the full visible screen is called stdscr; it always
    	      exists after `zcurses init' and cannot be delete with delwin.
    
    	      The subcommand refresh will refresh window targetwin; this is necessary to make any
    	      pending changes (such as characters you have prepared for output with char) visible
    	      on the screen.  refresh without an argument causes the screen  to  be  cleared  and
    	      redrawn.	If multiple windows are given, the screen is updated once at the end.
    
    	      The  subcommand  touch  marks  the targetwins listed as changed.	This is necessary
    	      before refreshing windows if a window that was in front of  another  window  (which
    	      may be stdscr) is deleted.
    
    	      The subcommand move moves the cursor position in targetwin to new coordinates new_y
    	      and new_x.  Note that the subcommand string (but not the subcommand char)  advances
    	      the cursor position over the characters added.
    
    	      The  subcommand clear erases the contents of targetwin.  One (and no more than one)
    	      of three options may be specified.  With the option redraw, in  addition	the  next
    	      refresh  of  targetwin will cause the screen to be cleared and repainted.  With the
    	      option eol, targetwin is only cleared to the end of the current cursor line.   With
    	      the  option  bot,  targetwin is cleared to the end of the window, i.e everything to
    	      the right and below the cursor is cleared.
    
    	      The subcommand position writes various positions associated with targetwin into the
    	      array named array.  These are, in order:
    	      -      The y and x coordinates of the cursor relative to the top left of targetwin
    	      -      The y and x coordinates of the top left of targetwin on the screen
    	      -      The size of targetwin in y and x dimensions.
    
    	      Outputting characters and strings are achieved by char and string respectively.
    
    	      To  draw a border around window targetwin, use border.  Note that the border is not
    	      subsequently handled specially:  in other words, the border  is  simply  a  set  of
    	      characters  output  at  the  edge  of the window.  Hence it can be overwritten, can
    	      scroll off the window, etc.
    
    	      The subcommand attr will set targetwin's attributes or foreground/background  color
    	      pair  for any successive character output.  Each attribute given on the line may be
    	      prepended by a + to set or a - to unset that attribute; +  is  assumed  if  absent.
    	      The attributes supported are blink, bold, dim, reverse, standout, and underline.
    
    	      Each fg_col/bg_col attribute (to be read as `fg_col on bg_col') sets the foreground
    	      and background color for character output.  The color default is	sometimes  avail‐
    	      able  (in particular if the library is ncurses), specifying the foreground or back‐
    	      ground color with which the terminal started.  The color	pair  default/default  is
    	      always available.
    
    	      bg  overrides  the color and other attributes of all characters in the window.  Its
    	      usual use is to set the background initially, but it will overwrite the  attributes
    	      of  any  characters  at  the  time when it is called.  In addition to the arguments
    	      allowed with attr, an argument @char specifies a character to be shown in otherwise
    	      blank  areas of the window.  Owing to limitations of curses this cannot be a multi‐
    	      byte character (use of ASCII characters only is recommended).  As the specified set
    	      of attributes override the existing background, turning attributes off in the argu‐
    	      ments is not useful, though this does not cause an error.
    
    	      The subcommand scroll can be used with on or off to enabled or disable scrolling of
    	      a  window  when  the  cursor would otherwise move below the window due to typing or
    	      output.  It can also be used with a positive or negative integer to scroll the win‐
    	      dow  up or down the given number of lines without changing the current cursor posi‐
    	      tion (which therefore appears to move in the opposite  direction	relative  to  the
    	      window).	 In  the  second case, if scrolling is off it is temporarily turned on to
    	      allow the window to be scrolled.
    
    	      The subcommand input reads a single character from the window  without  echoing  it
    	      back.   If param is supplied the character is assigned to the parameter param, else
    	      it is assigned to the parameter REPLY.
    
    	      If both param and kparam are supplied, the key is read in `keypad' mode.	 In  this
    	      mode  special  keys such as function keys and arrow keys return the name of the key
    	      in the parameter kparam.	The key names are the macros defined in the  curses.h  or
    	      ncurses.h with the prefix `KEY_' removed; see also the description of the parameter
    	      zcurses_keycodes below.  Other keys cause a value to be set in param as before.  On
    	      a  successful  return  only one of param or kparam contains a non-empty string; the
    	      other is set to an empty string.
    
    	      If mparam is also supplied, input attempts to handle mouse  input.   This  is  only
    	      available  with the ncurses library; mouse handling can be detected by checking for
    	      the exit status of `zcurses mouse' with no arguments.  If a mouse button is clicked
    	      (or  double-  or	triple-clicked,  or pressed or released with a configurable delay
    	      from being clicked) then kparam is set to the string MOUSE, and mparam is set to an
    	      array consisting of the following elements:
    	      -      An  identifier  to discriminate different input devices; this is only rarely
    		     useful.
    	      -      The x, y and z coordinates of the mouse click relative to the  full  screen,
    		     as  three elements in that order (i.e. the y coordinate is, unusually, after
    		     the x coordinate).  The z coordinate is only available  for  a  few  unusual
    		     input devices and is otherwise set to zero.
    	      -      Any  events that occurred as separate items; usually there will be just one.
    		     An  event	consists  of  PRESSED,	RELEASED,  CLICKED,   DOUBLE_CLICKED   or
    		     TRIPLE_CLICKED  followed  immediately (in the same element) by the number of
    		     the button.
    	      -      If the shift key was pressed, the string SHIFT.
    	      -      If the control key was pressed, the string CTRL.
    	      -      If the alt key was pressed, the string ALT.
    
    	      Not all mouse events may be passed through to the terminal  window;  most  terminal
    	      emulators  handle  some  mouse  events  themselves.   Note  that the ncurses manual
    	      implies that using input both with and without mouse handling may cause  the  mouse
    	      cursor to appear and disappear.
    
    	      The  subcommand  mouse  can be used to configure the use of the mouse.  There is no
    	      window argument; mouse options are  global.   `zcurses  mouse'  with  no	arguments
    	      returns status 0 if mouse handling is possible, else status 1.  Otherwise, the pos‐
    	      sible arguments (which may be combined on the same command line)	are  as  follows.
    	      delay  num  sets the maximum delay in milliseconds between press and release events
    	      to be considered as a click; the value 0 disables click resolution, and the default
    	      is  one  sixth of a second.  motion proceeded by an optional `+' (the default) or -
    	      turns on or off reporting of mouse  motion  in  addition	to  clicks,  presses  and
    	      releases,  which are always reported.  However, it appears reports for mouse motion
    	      are not currently implemented.
    
    	      The subcommand timeout specifies a timeout value for input from targetwin.  If int‐
    	      val  is  negative,  `zcurses input' waits indefinitely for a character to be typed;
    	      this is the default.  If intval is zero, `zcurses input'	returns  immediately;  if
    	      there  is typeahead it is returned, else no input is done and status 1 is returned.
    	      If intval is positive, `zcurses input' waits intval milliseconds for input  and  if
    	      there is none at the end of that period returns status 1.
    
    	      The subcommand querychar queries the character at the current cursor position.  The
    	      return values are stored in the array named param if supplied, else  in  the  array
    	      reply.  The first value is the character (which may be a multibyte character if the
    	      system supports them); the second is the color  pair  in	the  usual  fg_col/bg_col
    	      notation,  or  0	if  color is not supported.  Any attributes other than color that
    	      apply to the character, as set with the subcommand attr, appear as additional  ele‐
    	      ments.
    
       Parameters
           ZCURSES_COLORS
    	      Readonly	integer.  The maximum number of colors the terminal supports.  This value
    	      is initialised by the curses library and is not  available  until  the  first  time
    	      zcurses init is run.
    
           ZCURSES_COLOR_PAIRS
    	      Readonly	integer.   The	maximum  number  of color pairs fg_col/bg_col that may be
    	      defined in `zcurses attr' commands; note this limit applies to all color pairs that
    	      have been used whether or not they are currently active.	This value is initialised
    	      by the curses library and is not available until the first  time	zcurses  init  is
    	      run.
    
           zcurses_attrs
    	      Readonly	array.	 The attributes supported by zsh/curses; available as soon as the
    	      module is loaded.
    
           zcurses_colors
    	      Readonly array.  The colors supported by zsh/curses; available as soon as the  mod‐
    	      ule is loaded.
    
           zcurses_keycodes
    	      Readonly	array.	 The values that may be returned in the second parameter supplied
    	      to `zcurses input' in the order in which they are  defined  internally  by  curses.
    	      Not all function keys are listed, only F0; curses reserves space for F0 up to F63.
    
           zcurses_windows
    	      Readonly	array.	The current list of windows, i.e. all windows that have been cre‐
    	      ated with `zcurses addwin' and not removed with `zcurses delwin'.
    
    THE ZSH/DATETIME MODULE
           The zsh/datetime module makes available one builtin command:
    
           strftime [ -s scalar ] format epochtime
           strftime -r [ -q ] [ -s scalar ] format timestring
    	      Output the date denoted by epochtime in the format specified.  See strftime(3)  for
    	      details.	The zsh extensions described in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES
    	      in zshmisc(1) are also available.
    
    	      -q     Run quietly; suppress  printing  of  all  error  messages	described  below.
    		     Errors for invalid epochtime values are always printed.
    
    	      -r     With  the	option	-r  (reverse),	use  format  to  parse	the  input string
    		     timestring and output the number of seconds since the  epoch  at  which  the
    		     time  occurred.  The parsing is implemented by the system function strptime;
    		     see strptime(3).  This means that zsh format extensions are  not  available,
    		     but for reverse lookup they are not required.
    
    		     In  most  implementations	of  strftime  any  timezone  in the timestring is
    		     ignored and the local timezone declared by the TZ	environment  variable  is
    		     used; other parameters are set to zero if not present.
    
    		     If  timestring does not match format the command returns status 1 and prints
    		     an error message.	If timestring matches format but not  all  characters  in
    		     timestring  were used, the conversion succeeds but also prints an error mes‐
    		     sage.
    
    		     If either of the system functions strptime or mktime is not available,  sta‐
    		     tus 2 is returned and an error message is printed.
    
    	      -s scalar
    		     Assign  the  date string (or epoch time in seconds if -r is given) to scalar
    		     instead of printing it.
    
    	      Note that depending on the system's declared integral time type, strftime may  pro‐
    	      duce incorrect results for epoch times greater than 2147483647 which corresponds to
    	      2038-01-19 03:14:07 +0000.
    
           The zsh/datetime module makes available several parameters; all are readonly:
    
           EPOCHREALTIME
    	      A floating point value representing the number of seconds  since	the  epoch.   The
    	      notional	accuracy  is to nanoseconds if the clock_gettime call is available and to
    	      microseconds otherwise, but in practice the  range  of  double  precision  floating
    	      point and shell scheduling latencies may be significant effects.
    
           EPOCHSECONDS
    	      An integer value representing the number of seconds since the epoch.
    
           epochtime
    	      An  array  value containing the number of seconds since the epoch in the first ele‐
    	      ment and the remainder of the time since the epoch in  nanoseconds  in  the  second
    	      element.	 To  ensure the two elements are consistent the array should be copied or
    	      otherwise referenced as a single substitution before the values are used.  The fol‐
    	      lowing idiom may be used:
    
    		     for secs nsecs in $epochtime; do
    		       ...
    		     done
    
    THE ZSH/DB/GDBM MODULE
           The zsh/db/gdbm module is used to create "tied" associative arrays that interface to data‐
           base files.  If the GDBM interface is not available, the builtins defined by  this  module
           will report an error.  This module is also intended as a prototype for creating additional
           database interfaces, so the ztie builtin may move to a more generic module in the future.
    
           The builtins in this module are:
    
           ztie -d db/gdbm -f filename [ -r ] arrayname
    	      Open the GDBM database identified by filename and, if successful, create the  asso‐
    	      ciative  array  arrayname  linked  to  the file.	To create a local tied array, the
    	      parameter must first be declared, so commands similar to	the  following	would  be
    	      executed inside a function scope:
    
    		     local -A sampledb
    		     ztie -d db/gdbm -f sample.gdbm sampledb
    
    	      The  -r  option opens the database file for reading only, creating a parameter with
    	      the readonly attribute.  Without this option, using `ztie' on a file for which  the
    	      user  does  not  have  write  permission is an error.  If writable, the database is
    	      opened synchronously so fields changed in  arrayname  are  immediately  written  to
    	      filename.
    
    	      Changes  to the file modes filename after it has been opened do not alter the state
    	      of arrayname, but `typeset -r arrayname' works as expected.
    
           zuntie [ -u ] arrayname ...
    	      Close the GDBM database associated with each arrayname and then unset  the  parame‐
    	      ter.  The -u option forces an unset of parameters made readonly with `ztie -r'.
    
    	      This  happens automatically if the parameter is explicitly unset or its local scope
    	      (function) ends.	Note that a readonly parameter may not be  explicitly  unset,  so
    	      the  only  way to unset a global parameter created with `ztie -r' is to use `zuntie
    	      -u'.
    
           The fields of an associative array tied to GDBM are neither cached nor otherwise stored in
           memory,	they are read from or written to the database on each reference.  Thus, for exam‐
           ple, the values in a readonly array may be changed by a second writer of the same database
           file.
    
    THE ZSH/DELTOCHAR MODULE
           The zsh/deltochar module makes available two ZLE functions:
    
           delete-to-char
    	      Read  a  character from the keyboard, and delete from the cursor position up to and
    	      including the next (or, with repeat count n, the nth) instance of  that  character.
    	      Negative repeat counts mean delete backwards.
    
           zap-to-char
    	      This behaves like delete-to-char, except that the final occurrence of the character
    	      itself is not deleted.
    
    THE ZSH/EXAMPLE MODULE
           The zsh/example module makes available one builtin command:
    
           example [ -flags ] [ args ... ]
    	      Displays the flags and arguments it is invoked with.
    
           The purpose of the module is to serve as an example of how to write a module.
    
    THE ZSH/FILES MODULE
           The zsh/files module makes  available  some  common  commands  for  file  manipulation  as
           builtins;  these  commands  are	probably not needed for many normal situations but can be
           useful in emergency recovery situations with constrained resources.  The commands  do  not
           implement all features now required by relevant standards committees.
    
           For  all  commands,  a  variant	beginning zf_ is also available and loaded automatically.
           Using the features capability of zmodload will let you load only  those	names  you  want.
           Note  that  it's possible to load only the builtins with zsh-specific names using the fol‐
           lowing command:
    
    	      zmodload -m -F zsh/files b:zf_\*
    
           The commands loaded by default are:
    
           chgrp [ -hRs ] group filename ...
    	      Changes group of files specified.  This is equivalent to	chown  with  a	user-spec
    	      argument of `:group'.
    
           chown [ -hRs ] user-spec filename ...
    	      Changes ownership and group of files specified.
    
    	      The user-spec can be in four forms:
    
    	      user   change owner to user; do not change group
    	      user:: change owner to user; do not change group
    	      user:  change owner to user; change group to user's primary group
    	      user:group
    		     change owner to user; change group to group
    	      :group do not change owner; change group to group
    
    	      In  each	case,  the  `:' may instead be a `.'.  The rule is that if there is a `:'
    	      then the separator is `:', otherwise if there is a `.' then the separator  is  `.',
    	      otherwise there is no separator.
    
    	      Each  of user and group may be either a username (or group name, as appropriate) or
    	      a decimal user ID (group ID).  Interpretation as a name takes precedence, if  there
    	      is an all-numeric username (or group name).
    
    	      If  the  target is a symbolic link, the -h option causes chown to set the ownership
    	      of the link instead of its target.
    
    	      The -R option causes chown to recursively descend into  directories,  changing  the
    	      ownership  of all files in the directory after changing the ownership of the direc‐
    	      tory itself.
    
    	      The -s option is a zsh extension to chown functionality.	It enables  paranoid  be‐
    	      haviour,	intended  to avoid security problems involving a chown being tricked into
    	      affecting files other than the ones intended.  It will refuse  to  follow  symbolic
    	      links,  so  that	(for  example) ``chown luser /tmp/foo/passwd'' can't accidentally
    	      chown /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to be a link to /etc.   It	will  also  check
    	      where  it  is after leaving directories, so that a recursive chown of a deep direc‐
    	      tory tree can't end up recursively chowning /usr as a result of  directories  being
    	      moved up the tree.
    
           ln [ -dfhins ] filename dest
           ln [ -dfhins ] filename ... dir
    	      Creates  hard (or, with -s, symbolic) links.  In the first form, the specified des‐
    	      tination is created, as a link to the specified filename.  In the second form, each
    	      of the filenames is taken in turn, and linked to a pathname in the specified direc‐
    	      tory that has the same last pathname component.
    
    	      Normally, ln will not attempt to create hard links to directories.  This check  can
    	      be overridden using the -d option.  Typically only the super-user can actually suc‐
    	      ceed in creating hard links to directories.  This does not apply to symbolic  links
    	      in any case.
    
    	      By  default,  existing files cannot be replaced by links.  The -i option causes the
    	      user to be queried about replacing existing files.  The -f option  causes  existing
    	      files to be silently deleted, without querying.  -f takes precedence.
    
    	      The  -h  and  -n options are identical and both exist for compatibility; either one
    	      indicates that if the target is a symlink then it should not be dereferenced.  Typ‐
    	      ically this is used in combination with -sf so that if an existing link points to a
    	      directory then it will be removed, instead of followed.  If  this  option  is  used
    	      with  multiple  filenames and the target is a symbolic link pointing to a directory
    	      then the result is an error.
    
           mkdir [ -p ] [ -m mode ] dir ...
    	      Creates directories.  With the -p option, non-existing parent directories are first
    	      created  if  necessary,  and  there  will  be no complaint if the directory already
    	      exists.  The -m option can be used to specify (in octal) a set of file  permissions
    	      for  the created directories, otherwise mode 777 modified by the current umask (see
    	      umask(2)) is used.
    
           mv [ -fi ] filename dest
           mv [ -fi ] filename ... dir
    	      Moves files.  In the first form, the specified filename is moved to  the	specified
    	      destination.  In the second form, each of the filenames is taken in turn, and moved
    	      to a pathname in the specified directory that has the same last pathname component.
    
    	      By default, the user will be queried before replacing any file that the user cannot
    	      write  to,  but  writable files will be silently removed.  The -i option causes the
    	      user to be queried about replacing any existing files.  The -f  option  causes  any
    	      existing files to be silently deleted, without querying.	-f takes precedence.
    
    	      Note  that  this mv will not move files across devices.  Historical versions of mv,
    	      when actual renaming is impossible, fall back on copying	and  removing  files;  if
    	      this  behaviour  is  desired,  use cp and rm manually.  This may change in a future
    	      version.
    
           rm [ -dfirs ] filename ...
    	      Removes files and directories specified.
    
    	      Normally, rm will not remove directories (except	with  the  -r  option).   The  -d
    	      option  causes rm to try removing directories with unlink (see unlink(2)), the same
    	      method used for files.  Typically only  the  super-user  can  actually  succeed  in
    	      unlinking directories in this way.  -d takes precedence over -r.
    
    	      By  default, the user will be queried before removing any file that the user cannot
    	      write to, but writable files will be silently removed.  The -i  option  causes  the
    	      user  to	be  queried  about  removing any files.  The -f option causes files to be
    	      silently deleted, without querying, and suppresses all error indications.  -f takes
    	      precedence.
    
    	      The -r option causes rm to recursively descend into directories, deleting all files
    	      in the directory before removing the directory with  the	rmdir  system  call  (see
    	      rmdir(2)).
    
    	      The  -s  option is a zsh extension to rm functionality.  It enables paranoid behav‐
    	      iour, intended to avoid common security problems	involving  a  root-run	rm  being
    	      tricked into removing files other than the ones intended.  It will refuse to follow
    	      symbolic links, so that (for example)  ``rm  /tmp/foo/passwd''  can't  accidentally
    	      remove  /etc/passwd  if  /tmp/foo happens to be a link to /etc.  It will also check
    	      where it is after leaving directories, so that a recursive removal of a deep direc‐
    	      tory  tree  can't end up recursively removing /usr as a result of directories being
    	      moved up the tree.
    
           rmdir dir ...
    	      Removes empty directories specified.
    
           sync   Calls the system call of the same name (see sync(2)), which flushes  dirty  buffers
    	      to disk.	It might return before the I/O has actually been completed.
    
    THE ZSH/LANGINFO MODULE
           The zsh/langinfo module makes available one parameter:
    
           langinfo
    	      An associative array that maps langinfo elements to their values.
    
    	      Your implementation may support a number of the following keys:
    
    	      CODESET,	D_T_FMT,  D_FMT,  T_FMT,  RADIXCHAR,  THOUSEP, YESEXPR, NOEXPR, CRNCYSTR,
    	      ABDAY_{1..7}, DAY_{1..7}, ABMON_{1..12}, MON_{1..12}, T_FMT_AMPM,  AM_STR,  PM_STR,
    	      ERA, ERA_D_FMT, ERA_D_T_FMT, ERA_T_FMT, ALT_DIGITS
    
    THE ZSH/MAPFILE MODULE
           The zsh/mapfile module provides one special associative array parameter of the same name.
    
           mapfile
    	      This associative array takes as keys the names of files; the resulting value is the
    	      content of the file.  The value is treated identically to  any  other  text  coming
    	      from  a  parameter.   The  value may also be assigned to, in which case the file in
    	      question is written (whether or not it originally existed); or an  element  may  be
    	      unset,  which  will  delete  the	file  in  question.   For  example,  `vared  map‐
    	      file[myfile]' works as expected, editing the file `myfile'.
    
    	      When the array is accessed as a whole, the keys are the names of files in the  cur‐
    	      rent directory, and the values are empty (to save a huge overhead in memory).  Thus
    	      ${(k)mapfile} has the same affect as the glob operator *(D), since files	beginning
    	      with  a  dot  are  not  special.	 Care  must  be taken with expressions such as rm
    	      ${(k)mapfile}, which will delete every file in the current  directory  without  the
    	      usual `rm *' test.
    
    	      The parameter mapfile may be made read-only; in that case, files referenced may not
    	      be written or deleted.
    
    	      A file may conveniently be read into an array as one line per element with the form
    	      `array=("${(f@)mapfile[filename]}")'.   The double quotes and the `@' are necessary
    	      to prevent empty lines from being removed.  Note that if the file ends with a  new‐
    	      line,  the  shell  will  split on the final newline, generating an additional empty
    	      field;   this   can   be	 suppressed   by   using   `array=("${(f@)${mapfile[file‐
    	      name]%$'\n'}}")'.
    
       Limitations
           Although  reading and writing of the file in question is efficiently handled, zsh's inter‐
           nal memory management may be arbitrarily baroque; however, mapfile is  usually  very  much
           more efficient than anything involving a loop.  Note in particular that the whole contents
           of the file will always reside physically  in  memory  when  accessed  (possibly  multiple
           times, due to standard parameter substitution operations).  In particular, this means han‐
           dling of sufficiently long files (greater than the machine's swap space, or than the range
           of the pointer type) will be incorrect.
    
           No errors are printed or flagged for non-existent, unreadable, or unwritable files, as the
           parameter mechanism is too low in the shell execution hierarchy to make this convenient.
    
           It is unfortunate that the mechanism for loading modules does not yet allow  the  user  to
           specify the name of the shell parameter to be given the special behaviour.
    
    THE ZSH/MATHFUNC MODULE
           The  zsh/mathfunc  module provides standard mathematical functions for use when evaluating
           mathematical formulae.  The syntax agrees with normal C and FORTRAN conventions, for exam‐
           ple,
    
    	      (( f = sin(0.3) ))
    
           assigns the sine of 0.3 to the parameter f.
    
           Most  functions take floating point arguments and return a floating point value.  However,
           any necessary conversions from or to integer type will be performed automatically  by  the
           shell.	Apart  from atan with a second argument and the abs, int and float functions, all
           functions behave as noted in the manual page for the corresponding C function, except that
           any  arguments out of range for the function in question will be detected by the shell and
           an error reported.
    
           The following functions take a single floating point argument: acos, acosh,  asin,  asinh,
           atan,  atanh,  cbrt,  ceil,  cos, cosh, erf, erfc, exp, expm1, fabs, floor, gamma, j0, j1,
           lgamma, log, log10, log1p, logb, sin, sinh, sqrt, tan, tanh, y0, y1.   The  atan  function
           can optionally take a second argument, in which case it behaves like the C function atan2.
           The ilogb function takes a single floating point argument, but returns an integer.
    
           The function signgam takes no arguments, and returns an integer, which is the  C  variable
           of the same name, as described in gamma(3).  Note that it is therefore only useful immedi‐
           ately after a call to gamma or lgamma.  Note also that `signgam()' and `signgam' are  dis‐
           tinct expressions.
    
           The  following  functions  take	two  floating  point  arguments:  copysign,  fmod, hypot,
           nextafter.
    
           The following take an integer first argument and a floating point second argument: jn, yn.
    
           The following take a floating point first argument and an integer second argument:  ldexp,
           scalb.
    
           The function abs does not convert the type of its single argument; it returns the absolute
           value of either a floating point number or an integer.  The functions float and	int  con‐
           vert their arguments into a floating point or integer value (by truncation) respectively.
    
           Note that the C pow function is available in ordinary math evaluation as the `**' operator
           and is not provided here.
    
           The function rand48 is available if your system's mathematical library  has  the  function
           erand48(3).  It returns a pseudo-random floating point number between 0 and 1.  It takes a
           single string optional argument.
    
           If the argument is not present, the random number seed is initialised by  three	calls  to
           the rand(3) function --- this produces the same random numbers as the next three values of
           $RANDOM.
    
           If the argument is present, it gives the name of a scalar parameter where the current ran‐
           dom number seed will be stored.	On the first call, the value must contain at least twelve
           hexadecimal digits (the remainder of the string is ignored), or	the  seed  will  be  ini‐
           tialised in the same manner as for a call to rand48 with no argument.  Subsequent calls to
           rand48(param) will then maintain the seed in the parameter param as  a  string  of  twelve
           hexadecimal  digits,  with  no  base signifier.	The random number sequences for different
           parameters are completely independent, and are also independent from that used by calls to
           rand48 with no argument.
    
           For example, consider
    
    	      print $(( rand48(seed) ))
    	      print $(( rand48() ))
    	      print $(( rand48(seed) ))
    
           Assuming  $seed	does  not exist, it will be initialised by the first call.  In the second
           call, the default seed is initialised; note, however, that because of  the  properties  of
           rand()  there  is a correlation between the seeds used for the two initialisations, so for
           more secure uses, you should generate your own 12-byte seed.  The third	call  returns  to
           the  same sequence of random numbers used in the first call, unaffected by the intervening
           rand48().
    
    THE ZSH/NEWUSER MODULE
           The zsh/newuser module is loaded at boot if it is available, the RCS option  is	set,  and
           the  PRIVILEGED option is not set (all three are true by default).  This takes place imme‐
           diately after commands in the global zshenv file (typically  /etc/zshenv),  if  any,  have
           been  executed.	 If  the module is not available it is silently ignored by the shell; the
           module may safely be removed from $MODULE_PATH by the administrator if it is not required.
    
           On loading, the module tests if any of the start-up files .zshenv,  .zprofile,  .zshrc  or
           .zlogin	exist  in  the directory given by the environment variable ZDOTDIR, or the user's
           home directory if that is not set.  The test is not performed and the  module  halts  pro‐
           cessing	if  the shell was in an emulation mode (i.e. had been invoked as some other shell
           than zsh).
    
           If none of the start-up files were found, the module then looks for the file newuser first
           in a sitewide directory, usually the parent directory of the site-functions directory, and
           if that is not found the module searches in a version-specific directory, usually the par‐
           ent  of the functions directory containing version-specific functions.  (These directories
           can  be	configured  when  zsh  is  built  using   the	--enable-site-scriptdir=dir   and
           --enable-scriptdir=dir flags to configure, respectively; the defaults are prefix/share/zsh
           and prefix/share/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION where the default prefix is /usr/local.)
    
           If the file newuser is found, it is then sourced in the same manner as  a  start-up  file.
           The  file  is expected to contain code to install start-up files for the user, however any
           valid shell code will be executed.
    
           The zsh/newuser module is then unconditionally unloaded.
    
           Note that it is possible to achieve exactly the same effect as the zsh/newuser  module  by
           adding  code to /etc/zshenv.  The module exists simply to allow the shell to make arrange‐
           ments for new users without the need for intervention by package  maintainers  and  system
           administrators.
    
           The  script supplied with the module invokes the shell function zsh-newuser-install.  This
           may be invoked directly by the user even if the zsh/newuser  module  is	disabled.   Note,
           however,  that  if  the module is not installed the function will not be installed either.
           The function is documented in the section User Configuration Functions in zshcontrib(1).
    
    THE ZSH/PARAMETER MODULE
           The zsh/parameter module gives access to some of the internal  hash  tables  used  by  the
           shell by defining some special parameters.
    
           options
    	      The  keys  for  this associative array are the names of the options that can be set
    	      and unset using the setopt and unsetopt builtins. The value of each key  is  either
    	      the  string  on  if the option is currently set, or the string off if the option is
    	      unset.  Setting a key to one of these strings is	like  setting  or  unsetting  the
    	      option, respectively. Unsetting a key in this array is like setting it to the value
    	      off.
    
           commands
    	      This array gives access to the command hash table. The keys are the names of exter‐
    	      nal commands, the values are the pathnames of the files that would be executed when
    	      the command would be invoked. Setting a key in this array defines a  new	entry  in
    	      this  table  in the same way as with the hash builtin. Unsetting a key as in `unset
    	      "commands[foo]"' removes the entry for the given key from the command hash table.
    
           functions
    	      This associative array maps names of enabled functions to their  definitions.  Set‐
    	      ting a key in it is like defining a function with the name given by the key and the
    	      body given by the value. Unsetting a key removes the definition  for  the  function
    	      named by the key.
    
           dis_functions
    	      Like functions but for disabled functions.
    
           builtins
    	      This  associative  array	gives  information  about  the builtin commands currently
    	      enabled. The keys are the names of the builtin commands and the values  are  either
    	      `undefined' for builtin commands that will automatically be loaded from a module if
    	      invoked or `defined' for builtin commands that are already loaded.
    
           dis_builtins
    	      Like builtins but for disabled builtin commands.
    
           reswords
    	      This array contains the enabled reserved words.
    
           dis_reswords
    	      Like reswords but for disabled reserved words.
    
           patchars
    	      This array contains the enabled pattern characters.
    
           dis_patchars
    	      Like patchars but for disabled pattern characters.
    
           aliases
    	      This maps the names of the regular aliases currently enabled to their expansions.
    
           dis_aliases
    	      Like aliases but for disabled regular aliases.
    
           galiases
    	      Like aliases, but for global aliases.
    
           dis_galiases
    	      Like galiases but for disabled global aliases.
    
           saliases
    	      Like raliases, but for suffix aliases.
    
           dis_saliases
    	      Like saliases but for disabled suffix aliases.
    
           parameters
    	      The keys in this associative array  are  the  names  of  the  parameters	currently
    	      defined.	The  values are strings describing the type of the parameter, in the same
    	      format used by the t parameter flag, see zshexpn(1) .  Setting or unsetting keys in
    	      this array is not possible.
    
           modules
    	      An  associative  array  giving information about modules. The keys are the names of
    	      the modules loaded, registered to be autoloaded, or aliased. The value  says  which
    	      state  the  named module is in and is one of the strings `loaded', `autoloaded', or
    	      `alias:name', where name is the name the module is aliased to.
    
    	      Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.
    
           dirstack
    	      A normal array holding the elements of the directory stack. Note that the output of
    	      the  dirs  builtin  command includes one more directory, the current working direc‐
    	      tory.
    
           history
    	      This associative array maps history event numbers to the full history lines.
    
           historywords
    	      A special array containing the words stored in the history.
    
           jobdirs
    	      This associative array maps job numbers to the directories from which the  job  was
    	      started (which may not be the current directory of the job).
    
    	      The keys of the associative arrays are usually valid job numbers, and these are the
    	      values output with, for example, ${(k)jobdirs}.  Non-numeric job references may  be
    	      used  when  looking  up  a value; for example, ${jobdirs[%+]} refers to the current
    	      job.
    
           jobtexts
    	      This associative array maps job numbers to the texts of the command lines that were
    	      used to start the jobs.
    
    	      Handling of the keys of the associative array is as described for jobdirs above.
    
           jobstates
    	      This  associative  array	gives  information about the states of the jobs currently
    	      known. The keys are the job  numbers  and  the  values  are  strings  of	the  form
    	      `job-state:mark:pid=state...'.  The job-state gives the state the whole job is cur‐
    	      rently in, one of `running', `suspended', or `done'. The mark is `+' for	the  cur‐
    	      rent  job,  `-'  for  the previous job and empty otherwise. This is followed by one
    	      `:pid=state' for every process in the job. The pids are, of course, the process IDs
    	      and the state describes the state of that process.
    
    	      Handling of the keys of the associative array is as described for jobdirs above.
    
           nameddirs
    	      This  associative  array	maps the names of named directories to the pathnames they
    	      stand for.
    
           userdirs
    	      This associative array maps user names to the pathnames of their home directories.
    
           usergroups
    	      This associative array maps names of system groups of which the current user  is	a
    	      member  to  the  corresponding group identifiers.  The contents are the same as the
    	      groups output by the id command.
    
           funcfiletrace
    	      This array contains the absolute line numbers and corresponding file names for  the
    	      point  where  the  current  function, sourced file, or (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval
    	      command was called.  The array is of the same length as funcsourcetrace  and  func‐
    	      trace,  but differs from funcsourcetrace in that the line and file are the point of
    	      call, not the point of definition, and differs from functrace in	that  all  values
    	      are  absolute  line  numbers in files, rather than relative to the start of a func‐
    	      tion, if any.
    
           funcsourcetrace
    	      This array contains the file names and line numbers of the points where  the  func‐
    	      tions,  sourced  files,  and  (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval commands currently being
    	      executed were defined.  The line number is the line where the  `function	name'  or
    	      `name  ()'  started.   In  the  case  of an autoloaded function  the line number is
    	      reported as zero.  The format of each element is	filename:lineno.   For	functions
    	      autoloaded  from	a  file in native zsh format, where only the body of the function
    	      occurs in the file, or for files that have been  executed  by  the  source  or  `.'
    	      builtins,  the  trace  information is shown as filename:0, since the entire file is
    	      the definition.
    
    	      Most users will be  interested  in  the  information  in	the  funcfiletrace  array
    	      instead.
    
           funcstack
    	      This  array contains the names of the functions, sourced files, and (if EVAL_LINENO
    	      is set) eval commands. currently being executed. The first element is the  name  of
    	      the function using the parameter.
    
    	      The  standard  shell  array  zsh_eval_context  can be used to determine the type of
    	      shell construct being executed at each depth: note, however, that is in  the  oppo‐
    	      site  order,  with  the most recent item last, and it is more detailed, for example
    	      including an entry for toplevel, the main shell code being executed either interac‐
    	      tively or from a script, which is not present in $funcstack.
    
           functrace
    	      This  array contains the names and line numbers of the callers corresponding to the
    	      functions currently being executed.  The format of  each	element  is  name:lineno.
    	      Callers  are also shown for sourced files; the caller is the point where the source
    	      or `.' command was executed.
    
    THE ZSH/PCRE MODULE
           The zsh/pcre module makes some commands available as builtins:
    
           pcre_compile [ -aimxs ] PCRE
    	      Compiles a perl-compatible regular expression.
    
    	      Option -a will force the	pattern  to  be  anchored.   Option  -i  will  compile	a
    	      case-insensitive	pattern.  Option -m will compile a multi-line pattern; that is, ^
    	      and $ will match newlines within the pattern.  Option -x will compile  an  extended
    	      pattern,	wherein  whitespace  and # comments are ignored.  Option -s makes the dot
    	      metacharacter match all characters, including those that indicate newline.
    
           pcre_study
    	      Studies the previously-compiled PCRE which may result in faster matching.
    
           pcre_match [ -v var ] [ -a arr ] [ -n offset ] [ -b ] string
    	      Returns successfully if string matches the previously-compiled PCRE.
    
    	      Upon successful match, if the expression captures  substrings  within  parentheses,
    	      pcre_match  will	set  the array match to those substrings, unless the -a option is
    	      given, in which case it will set the array arr.  Similarly, the variable MATCH will
    	      be  set to the entire matched portion of the string, unless the -v option is given,
    	      in which case the variable var will be set.  No variables are altered if	there  is
    	      no successful match.  A -n option starts searching for a match from the byte offset
    	      position in string.  If the -b option is given, the variable ZPCRE_OP will  be  set
    	      to  an  offset  pair  string,  representing the byte offset positions of the entire
    	      matched portion within the string.  For example, a ZPCRE_OP set to  "32  45"  indi‐
    	      cates that the matched portion began on byte offset 32 and ended on byte offset 44.
    	      Here, byte offset position 45 is the position directly after the	matched  portion.
    	      Keep  in	mind  that  the byte position isn't necessarily the same as the character
    	      position when UTF-8 characters are involved.  Consequently, the byte  offset  posi‐
    	      tions are only to be relied on in the context of using them for subsequent searches
    	      on string, using an offset position as an argument  to  the  -n  option.	 This  is
    	      mostly used to implement the "find all non-overlapping matches" functionality.
    
    	      A simple example of "find all non-overlapping matches":
    
    		     string="The following zip codes: 78884 90210 99513"
    		     pcre_compile -m "\d{5}"
    		     accum=()
    		     pcre_match -b -- $string
    		     while [[ $? -eq 0 ]] do
    			 b=($=ZPCRE_OP)
    			 accum+=$MATCH
    			 pcre_match -b -n $b[2] -- $string
    		     done
    		     print -l $accum
    
           The zsh/pcre module makes available the following test condition:
    
           expr -pcre-match pcre
    	      Matches a string against a perl-compatible regular expression.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     [[ "$text" -pcre-match ^d+$ ]] &&
    		     print text variable contains only "d's".
    
    	      If  the  REMATCH_PCRE  option is set, the =~ operator is equivalent to -pcre-match,
    	      and the NO_CASE_MATCH option may be used.  Note that NO_CASE_MATCH never applies to
    	      the pcre_match builtin, instead use the -i switch of pcre_compile.
    
    THE ZSH/REGEX MODULE
           The zsh/regex module makes available the following test condition:
    
           expr -regex-match regex
    	      Matches a string against a POSIX extended regular expression.  On successful match,
    	      matched portion of the string will normally be placed in the  MATCH  variable.   If
    	      there are any capturing parentheses within the regex, then the match array variable
    	      will contain those.  If the match is not successful, then the variables will not be
    	      altered.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     [[ alphabetical -regex-match ^a([^a]+)a([^a]+)a ]] &&
    		     print -l $MATCH X $match
    
    	      If the option REMATCH_PCRE is not set, then the =~ operator will automatically load
    	      this module as needed and will invoke the -regex-match operator.
    
    	      If BASH_REMATCH is set, then the array BASH_REMATCH will be set  instead	of  MATCH
    	      and match.
    
    THE ZSH/SCHED MODULE
           The zsh/sched module makes available one builtin command and one parameter.
    
           sched [-o] [+]hh:mm[:ss] command ...
           sched [-o] [+]seconds command ...
           sched [ -item ]
    	      Make an entry in the scheduled list of commands to execute.  The time may be speci‐
    	      fied in either absolute or relative time, and either as hours, minutes and (option‐
    	      ally)  seconds  separated by a colon, or seconds alone.  An absolute number of sec‐
    	      onds indicates the time since the epoch (1970/01/01 00:00); this is useful in  com‐
    	      bination	with the features in the zsh/datetime module, see the zsh/datetime module
    	      entry in zshmodules(1).
    
    	      With no arguments, prints the list of scheduled commands.  If the scheduled command
    	      has the -o flag set, this is shown at the start of the command.
    
    	      With  the argument `-item', removes the given item from the list.  The numbering of
    	      the list is continuous and entries are in time order, so the numbering  can  change
    	      when entries are added or deleted.
    
    	      Commands are executed either immediately before a prompt, or while the shell's line
    	      editor is waiting for input.  In the latter case it is useful to be able to produce
    	      output that does not interfere with the line being edited.  Providing the option -o
    	      causes the shell to clear the command line before the event and  redraw  it  after‐
    	      wards.   This  should be used with any scheduled event that produces visible output
    	      to the terminal; it is not needed, for example, with output that updates a terminal
    	      emulator's title bar.
    
    	      The  sched builtin is not made available by default when the shell starts in a mode
    	      emulating another shell.	It can be made available with the  command  `zmodload  -F
    	      zsh/sched b:sched'.
    
           zsh_scheduled_events
    	      A  readonly  array corresponding to the events scheduled by the sched builtin.  The
    	      indices of the array correspond to the numbers shown when  sched	is  run  with  no
    	      arguments (provided that the KSH_ARRAYS option is not set).  The value of the array
    	      consists of the scheduled time in seconds since the epoch  (see  the  section  `The
    	      zsh/datetime  Module'  for  facilities for using this number), followed by a colon,
    	      followed by any options (which may be empty but will be preceded by  a  `-'  other‐
    	      wise), followed by a colon, followed by the command to be executed.
    
    	      The  sched builtin should be used for manipulating the events.  Note that this will
    	      have an immediate effect on the contents of the array, so that indices  may  become
    	      invalid.
    
    THE ZSH/NET/SOCKET MODULE
           The zsh/net/socket module makes available one builtin command:
    
           zsocket [ -altv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
    	      zsocket  is  implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line edit‐
    	      ing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.
    
       Outbound Connections
           zsocket [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
    	      Open a new Unix domain connection to filename.  The shell parameter REPLY  will  be
    	      set to the file descriptor associated with that connection.  Currently, only stream
    	      connections are supported.
    
    	      If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target  file  descriptor  for
    	      the connection.
    
    	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.
    
       Inbound Connections
           zsocket -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
    	      zsocket  -l  will  open  a socket listening on filename.	The shell parameter REPLY
    	      will be set to the file descriptor associated with that listener.
    
    	      If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target  file  descriptor  for
    	      the connection.
    
    	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.
    
           zsocket -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
    	      zsocket  -a  will  accept an incoming connection to the socket associated with lis‐
    	      tenfd.  The shell parameter REPLY will be set to	the  file  descriptor  associated
    	      with the inbound connection.
    
    	      If  -d  is  specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for
    	      the connection.
    
    	      If -t is specified, zsocket will return if no incoming connection is pending.  Oth‐
    	      erwise it will wait for one.
    
    	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.
    
    THE ZSH/STAT MODULE
           The zsh/stat module makes available one builtin command under two possible names:
    
           zstat [ -gnNolLtTrs ] [ -f fd ] [ -H hash ] [ -A array ] [ -F fmt ]
    	     [ +element ] [ file ... ]
           stat ...
    	      The  command  acts  as a front end to the stat system call (see stat(2)).  The same
    	      command is provided with two names; as the name stat is often used by  an  external
    	      command  it  is  recommended that only the zstat form of the command is used.  This
    	      can be arranged by loading the  module  with  the  command  `zmodload  -F  zsh/stat
    	      b:zstat'.
    
    	      If  the  stat call fails, the appropriate system error message printed and status 1
    	      is returned.  The fields of struct stat give information about the  files  provided
    	      as arguments to the command.  In addition to those available from the stat call, an
    	      extra element `link' is provided.  These elements are:
    
    	      device The number of the device on which the file resides.
    
    	      inode  The unique number of the file on this device (`inode' number).
    
    	      mode   The mode of the file; that is, the file's type and access permissions.  With
    		     the  -s option, this will be returned as a string corresponding to the first
    		     column in the display of the ls -l command.
    
    	      nlink  The number of hard links to the file.
    
    	      uid    The user ID of the owner of the file.  With the -s option, this is displayed
    		     as a user name.
    
    	      gid    The  group ID of the file.  With the -s option, this is displayed as a group
    		     name.
    
    	      rdev   The raw device number.  This is only useful for special devices.
    
    	      size   The size of the file in bytes.
    
    	      atime
    	      mtime
    	      ctime  The last access, modification and inode change times of  the  file,  respec‐
    		     tively,  as  the  number of seconds since midnight GMT on 1st January, 1970.
    		     With the -s option, these are printed as strings for the  local  time  zone;
    		     the  format  can  be  altered with the -F option, and with the -g option the
    		     times are in GMT.
    
    	      blksize
    		     The number of bytes in one allocation block on the device on which the  file
    		     resides.
    
    	      block  The number of disk blocks used by the file.
    
    	      link   If the file is a link and the -L option is in effect, this contains the name
    		     of the file linked to, otherwise it is empty.  Note that if this element  is
    		     selected (``zstat +link'') then the -L option is automatically used.
    
    	      A particular element may be selected by including its name preceded by a `+' in the
    	      option list; only one element is allowed.  The element  may  be  shortened  to  any
    	      unique  set  of  leading characters.  Otherwise, all elements will be shown for all
    	      files.
    
    	      Options:
    
    	      -A array
    		     Instead of displaying the results on standard  output,  assign  them  to  an
    		     array, one struct stat element per array element for each file in order.  In
    		     this case neither the name of the element nor the name of the files  appears
    		     in  array	unless	the  -t or -n options were given, respectively.  If -t is
    		     given, the element name appears as a prefix to the  appropriate  array  ele‐
    		     ment; if -n is given, the file name appears as a separate array element pre‐
    		     ceding all the others.  Other formatting options are respected.
    
    	      -H hash
    		     Similar to -A, but instead assign the values to hash.  The keys are the ele‐
    		     ments  listed above.  If the -n option is provided then the name of the file
    		     is included in the hash with key name.
    
    	      -f fd  Use the file on file descriptor fd instead of named files; no list  of  file
    		     names is allowed in this case.
    
    	      -F fmt Supplies  a strftime (see strftime(3)) string for the formatting of the time
    		     elements.	The -s option is implied.
    
    	      -g     Show the time elements in the GMT time zone.  The -s option is implied.
    
    	      -l     List the names of the type elements (to  standard	output	or  an	array  as
    		     appropriate) and return immediately; options other than -A and arguments are
    		     ignored.
    
    	      -L     Perform an lstat (see lstat(2)) rather than a stat  system  call.	 In  this
    		     case,  if	the file is a link, information about the link itself rather than
    		     the target file is returned.  This option is required to make the link  ele‐
    		     ment  useful.   It's  important to note that this is the exact opposite from
    		     ls(1), etc.
    
    	      -n     Always show the names of files.  Usually these are only shown when output is
    		     to standard output and there is more than one file in the list.
    
    	      -N     Never show the names of files.
    
    	      -o     If  a  raw  file mode is printed, show it in octal, which is more useful for
    		     human consumption than the default of  decimal.   A  leading  zero  will  be
    		     printed  in this case.  Note that this does not affect whether a raw or for‐
    		     matted file mode is shown, which is controlled by the -r and -s options, nor
    		     whether a mode is shown at all.
    
    	      -r     Print  raw  data (the default format) alongside string data (the -s format);
    		     the string data appears in parentheses after the raw data.
    
    	      -s     Print mode, uid, gid and the three time elements as strings instead of  num‐
    		     bers.  In each case the format is like that of ls -l.
    
    	      -t     Always  show  the type names for the elements of struct stat.  Usually these
    		     are only shown when output is to standard output and no  individual  element
    		     has been selected.
    
    	      -T     Never show the type names of the struct stat elements.
    
    THE ZSH/SYSTEM MODULE
           The zsh/system module makes available various builtin commands and parameters.
    
       Builtins
           syserror [ -e errvar ] [ -p prefix ] [ errno | errname ]
    	      This  command  prints  out  the error message associated with errno, a system error
    	      number, followed by a newline to standard error.
    
    	      Instead of the error number, a name errname, for example ENOENT, may be used.   The
    	      set of names is the same as the contents of the array errnos, see below.
    
    	      If the string prefix is given, it is printed in front of the error message, with no
    	      intervening space.
    
    	      If errvar is supplied, the entire message, without a newline, is	assigned  to  the
    	      parameter names errvar and nothing is output.
    
    	      A  return  status  of 0 indicates the message was successfully printed (although it
    	      may not be useful if the error number was out of the system's range), a return sta‐
    	      tus  of  1 indicates an error in the parameters, and a return status of 2 indicates
    	      the error name was not recognised (no message is printed for this).
    
           sysopen [ -arw ] [ -m permissions ] [ -o options ]
    	       -u fd file
    	      This command opens a file. The -r, -w and -a flags indicate whether the file should
    	      be  opened  for  reading, writing and appending, respectively. The -m option allows
    	      the initial permissions to use when creating a file to be specified in octal  form.
    	      The file descriptor is specified with -u. Either an explicit file descriptor in the
    	      range 0 to 9 can be specified or a variable name can be given  to  which	the  file
    	      descriptor number will be assigned.
    
    	      The  -o  option  allows  various	system	specific  options  to  be  specified as a
    	      comma-separated list. The following is a	list  of  possible  options.  Note  that,
    	      depending on the system, some may not be available.
    	      cloexec
    		     mark file to be closed when other programs are executed
    
    	      create
    	      creat  create file if it does not exist
    
    	      excl   create file, error if it already exists
    
    	      noatime
    		     suppress updating of the file atime
    
    	      nofollow
    		     fail if file is a symbolic link
    
    	      sync   request that writes wait until data has been physically written
    
    	      truncate
    	      trunc  truncate file to size 0
    
    	      To close the file, use one of the following:
    
    		     exec {fd}<&-
    		     exec {fd}>&-
    
           sysread [ -c countvar ] [ -i infd ] [ -o outfd ]
    	       [ -s bufsize ] [ -t timeout ] [ param ]
    	      Perform  a  single  system  read	from file descriptor infd, or zero if that is not
    	      given.  The result of the read is stored in param or REPLY if that  is  not  given.
    	      If  countvar  is given, the number of bytes read is assigned to the parameter named
    	      by countvar.
    
    	      The maximum number of bytes read is bufsize or 8192 if that is not  given,  however
    	      the command returns as soon as any number of bytes was successfully read.
    
    	      If  timeout  is given, it specifies a timeout in seconds, which may be zero to poll
    	      the file descriptor.  This is handled by the poll system call if available,  other‐
    	      wise the select system call if available.
    
    	      If  outfd is given, an attempt is made to write all the bytes just read to the file
    	      descriptor outfd.  If this fails, because of a system error  other  than	EINTR  or
    	      because  of an internal zsh error during an interrupt, the bytes read but not writ‐
    	      ten are stored in the parameter named by param if supplied (no default is  used  in
    	      this case), and the number of bytes read but not written is stored in the parameter
    	      named by countvar if that is supplied.  If it was successful, countvar contains the
    	      full number of bytes transferred, as usual, and param is not set.
    
    	      The  error  EINTR  (interrupted  system  call)  is handled internally so that shell
    	      interrupts are transparent to the caller.  Any other error causes a return.
    
    	      The possible return statuses are
    	      0      At least one byte of data was successfully read and, if  appropriate,  writ‐
    		     ten.
    
    	      1      There was an error in the parameters to the command.  This is the only error
    		     for which a message is printed to standard error.
    
    	      2      There was an error on the read, or on polling the input file descriptor  for
    		     a timeout.  The parameter ERRNO gives the error.
    
    	      3      Data  were  successfully read, but there was an error writing them to outfd.
    		     The parameter ERRNO gives the error.
    
    	      4      The attempt to read timed out.  Note this does not set ERRNO as this is  not
    		     a system error.
    
    	      5      No  system error occurred, but zero bytes were read.  This usually indicates
    		     end of file.  The parameters are set according to the usual rules; no  write
    		     to outfd is attempted.
    
           sysseek [ -u fd ] [ -w start|end|current ] offset
    	      The  current  file  position  at	which  future reads and writes will take place is
    	      adjusted to the specified byte offset. The offset is evaluated as  a  math  expres‐
    	      sion. The -u option allows the file descriptor to be specified. By default the off‐
    	      set is specified relative to the start or the file but, with the -w option,  it  is
    	      possible	to  specify that the offset should be relative to the current position or
    	      the end of the file.
    
           syswrite [ -c countvar ] [ -o outfd ] data
    	      The data (a single string of bytes) are written to the file descriptor outfd, or	1
    	      if  that	is not given, using the write system call.  Multiple write operations may
    	      be used if the first does not write all the data.
    
    	      If countvar is given, the number of byte written is stored in the  parameter  named
    	      by countvar; this may not be the full length of data if an error occurred.
    
    	      The error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled internally by retrying; other‐
    	      wise an error causes the command to return.  For example, if the file descriptor is
    	      set  to  non-blocking  output,  an  error EAGAIN (on some systems, EWOULDBLOCK) may
    	      result in the command returning early.
    
    	      The return status may be 0 for success, 1 for an error in  the  parameters  to  the
    	      command,	or  2  for an error on the write; no error message is printed in the last
    	      case, but the parameter ERRNO will reflect the error that occurred.
    
           zsystem flock [ -t timeout ] [ -f var ] [-er] file
           zsystem flock -u fd_expr
    	      The builtin zsystem's subcommand flock performs  advisory  file  locking	(via  the
    	      fcntl(2)	system	call)  over  the entire contents of the given file.  This form of
    	      locking requires the processes accessing the file to cooperate;  its  most  obvious
    	      use is between two instances of the shell itself.
    
    	      In  the first form the named file, which must already exist, is locked by opening a
    	      file descriptor to the file and applying a lock to the file descriptor.	The  lock
    	      terminates  when	the  shell  process  that created the lock exits; it is therefore
    	      often convenient to create file locks within subshells, since the lock is automati‐
    	      cally released when the subshell exits.  Status 0 is returned if the lock succeeds,
    	      else status 1.
    
    	      In the second form the file descriptor given by the arithmetic  expression  fd_expr
    	      is  closed,  releasing a lock.  The file descriptor can be queried by using the `-f
    	      var' form during the lock; on a successful lock, the shell variable var is  set  to
    	      the  file  descriptor  used  for	locking.   The	lock will be released if the file
    	      descriptor is closed by any other means, for example using  `exec  {var}>&-';  how‐
    	      ever,  the  form described here performs a safety check that the file descriptor is
    	      in use for file locking.
    
    	      By default the shell waits indefinitely for the lock to  succeed.   The  option  -t
    	      timeout  specifies  a  timeout  for  the lock in seconds; currently this must be an
    	      integer.	The shell will attempt to lock the file once a second during this period.
    	      If the attempt times out, status 2 is returned.
    
    	      If  the  option -e is given, the file descriptor for the lock is preserved when the
    	      shell uses exec to start a new process; otherwise it is closed at  that  point  and
    	      the lock released.
    
    	      If  the option -r is given, the lock is only for reading, otherwise it is for read‐
    	      ing and writing.	The file descriptor is opened accordingly.
    
           zsystem supports subcommand
    	      The builtin zsystem's subcommand supports tests whether a given subcommand is  sup‐
    	      ported.	It  returns  status  0 if so, else status 1.  It operates silently unless
    	      there was a syntax error (i.e. the wrong number of arguments), in which case status
    	      255 is returned.	Status 1 can indicate one of two things:  subcommand is known but
    	      not supported by the current operating system, or subcommand is not known (possibly
    	      because this is an older version of the shell before it was implemented).
    
       Math Functions
           systell(fd)
    	      The systell math function returns the current file position for the file descriptor
    	      passed as an argument.
    
       Parameters
           errnos A readonly array of the names of errors defined on the system.  These are typically
    	      macros defined in C by including the system header file errno.h.	The index of each
    	      name (assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is unset) corresponds  to  the  error  number.
    	      Error numbers num before the last known error which have no name are given the name
    	      Enum in the array.
    
    	      Note that aliases for errors are not handled; only the canonical name is used.
    
           sysparams
    	      A readonly associative array.  The keys are:
    
    	      pid    Returns the process ID of the current process, even in  subshells.   Compare
    		     $$, which returns the process ID of the main shell process.
    
    	      ppid   Returns  the  process  ID of the parent of the current process, even in sub‐
    		     shells.  Compare $PPID, which returns the process ID of the  parent  of  the
    		     main shell process.
    
    THE ZSH/NET/TCP MODULE
           The zsh/net/tcp module makes available one builtin command:
    
           ztcp [ -acflLtv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
    	      ztcp  is	implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line editing,
    	      file I/O, and job control mechanisms.
    
    	      If ztcp is run with no options, it will output the contents of its session table.
    
    	      If it is run with only the option -L, it will output the contents  of  the  session
    	      table  in  a format suitable for automatic parsing.  The option is ignored if given
    	      with a command to open or close a session.  The output consists of a set of  lines,
    	      one per session, each containing the following elements separated by spaces:
    
    	      File descriptor
    		     The  file	descriptor in use for the connection.  For normal inbound (I) and
    		     outbound (O) connections this may be read and written  by	the  usual  shell
    		     mechanisms.  However, it should only be close with `ztcp -c'.
    
    	      Connection type
    		     A letter indicating how the session was created:
    
    		     Z	    A session created with the zftp command.
    
    		     L	    A connection opened for listening with `ztcp -l'.
    
    		     I	    An inbound connection accepted with `ztcp -a'.
    
    		     O	    An outbound connection created with `ztcp host ...'.
    
    	      The local host
    		     This  is  usually set to an all-zero IP address as the address of the local‐
    		     host is irrelevant.
    
    	      The local port
    		     This is likely to be zero unless the connection is for listening.
    
    	      The remote host
    		     This is the fully qualified domain name of the peer, if available,  else  an
    		     IP  address.   It is an all-zero IP address for a session opened for listen‐
    		     ing.
    
    	      The remote port
    		     This is zero for a connection opened for listening.
    
       Outbound Connections
           ztcp [ -v ] [ -d fd ] host [ port ]
    	      Open a new TCP connection to host.  If the port is omitted, it will default to port
    	      23.   The  connection  will  be  added to the session table and the shell parameter
    	      REPLY will be set to the file descriptor associated with that connection.
    
    	      If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target  file  descriptor  for
    	      the connection.
    
    	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.
    
       Inbound Connections
           ztcp -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] port
    	      ztcp  -l will open a socket listening on TCP port.  The socket will be added to the
    	      session table and the shell parameter REPLY will be  set	to  the  file  descriptor
    	      associated with that listener.
    
    	      If  -d  is  specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for
    	      the connection.
    
    	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.
    
           ztcp -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
    	      ztcp -a will accept an incoming connection to the port  associated  with	listenfd.
    	      The  connection  will  be  added to the session table and the shell parameter REPLY
    	      will be set to the file descriptor associated with the inbound connection.
    
    	      If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target  file  descriptor  for
    	      the connection.
    
    	      If  -t is specified, ztcp will return if no incoming connection is pending.  Other‐
    	      wise it will wait for one.
    
    	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.
    
       Closing Connections
           ztcp -cf [ -v ] [ fd ]
           ztcp -c [ -v ] [ fd ]
    	      ztcp -c will close the socket associated with fd.  The socket will be removed  from
    	      the  session table.  If fd is not specified, ztcp will close everything in the ses‐
    	      sion table.
    
    	      Normally, sockets registered by zftp (see zshmodules(1) )  cannot  be  closed  this
    	      way.  In order to force such a socket closed, use -f.
    
    	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.
    
       Example
           Here  is  how to create a TCP connection between two instances of zsh.  We need to pick an
           unassigned port; here we use the randomly chosen 5123.
    
           On host1,
    	      zmodload zsh/net/tcp
    	      ztcp -l 5123
    	      listenfd=$REPLY
    	      ztcp -a $listenfd
    	      fd=$REPLY
           The second from last command blocks until there is an incoming connection.
    
           Now create a connection from host2 (which may, of course, be the same machine):
    	      zmodload zsh/net/tcp
    	      ztcp host1 5123
    	      fd=$REPLY
    
           Now on each host, $fd contains a file descriptor for talking to the other.   For  example,
           on host1:
    	      print This is a message >&$fd
           and on host2:
    	      read -r line <&$fd; print -r - $line
           prints `This is a message'.
    
           To tidy up, on host1:
    	      ztcp -c $listenfd
    	      ztcp -c $fd
           and on host2
    	      ztcp -c $fd
    
    THE ZSH/TERMCAP MODULE
           The zsh/termcap module makes available one builtin command:
    
           echotc cap [ arg ... ]
    	      Output  the  termcap value corresponding to the capability cap, with optional argu‐
    	      ments.
    
           The zsh/termcap module makes available one parameter:
    
           termcap
    	      An associative array that maps termcap capability codes to their values.
    
    THE ZSH/TERMINFO MODULE
           The zsh/terminfo module makes available one builtin command:
    
           echoti cap [ arg ]
    	      Output the terminfo value corresponding to the capability  cap,  instantiated  with
    	      arg if applicable.
    
           The zsh/terminfo module makes available one parameter:
    
           terminfo
    	      An associative array that maps terminfo capability names to their values.
    
    THE ZSH/ZFTP MODULE
           The zsh/zftp module makes available one builtin command:
    
           zftp subcommand [ args ]
    	      The  zsh/zftp  module  is  a client for FTP (file transfer protocol).  It is imple‐
    	      mented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line editing, file I/O,  and
    	      job  control mechanisms.	Often, users will access it via shell functions providing
    	      a more powerful interface; a set is provided  with  the  zsh  distribution  and  is
    	      described  in  zshzftpsys(1).   However, the zftp command is entirely usable in its
    	      own right.
    
    	      All commands consist of the command name zftp followed by the name of a subcommand.
    	      These  are  listed  below.   The	return	status	of each subcommand is supposed to
    	      reflect the success or failure of the remote operation.  See a description  of  the
    	      variable	ZFTP_VERBOSE for more information on how responses from the server may be
    	      printed.
    
       Subcommands
           open host[:port] [ user [ password [ account ] ] ]
    	      Open a new FTP session to host, which may be the name of a TCP/IP connected host or
    	      an  IP  number  in  the  standard  dot  notation.   If  the argument is in the form
    	      host:port, open a connection to TCP port port instead of the standard FTP port  21.
    	      This  may  be  the  name	of  a  TCP  service  or a number:  see the description of
    	      ZFTP_PORT below for more information.
    
    	      If IPv6 addresses in colon format are used, the host should be surrounded by quoted
    	      square	brackets    to	  distinguish	 it    from   the   port,   for   example
    	      '[fe80::203:baff:fe02:8b56]'.  For consistency this is allowed with  all	forms  of
    	      host.
    
    	      Remaining  arguments are passed to the login subcommand.	Note that if no arguments
    	      beyond host are supplied, open will not automatically call login.  If no	arguments
    	      at all are supplied, open will use the parameters set by the params subcommand.
    
    	      After  a	successful  open,  the	shell variables ZFTP_HOST, ZFTP_PORT, ZFTP_IP and
    	      ZFTP_SYSTEM are available; see `Variables' below.
    
           login [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
           user [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
    	      Login the user name with parameters password and account.  Any  of  the  parameters
    	      can  be  omitted,  and  will  be read from standard input if needed (name is always
    	      needed).	If standard input is a terminal, a prompt for each one will be printed on
    	      standard	error  and password will not be echoed.  If any of the parameters are not
    	      used, a warning message is printed.
    
    	      After a successful login, the shell variables ZFTP_USER, ZFTP_ACCOUNT and  ZFTP_PWD
    	      are available; see `Variables' below.
    
    	      This command may be re-issued when a user is already logged in, and the server will
    	      first be reinitialized for a new user.
    
           params [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
           params -
    	      Store the given parameters for a later open command with no arguments.  Only  those
    	      given  on  the  command  line  will  be remembered.  If no arguments are given, the
    	      parameters currently set are printed, although the password will appear as  a  line
    	      of stars; the return status is one if no parameters were set, zero otherwise.
    
    	      Any  of  the  parameters	may be specified as a `?', which may need to be quoted to
    	      protect it from shell expansion.	In this case, the appropriate parameter  will  be
    	      read  from  stdin as with the login subcommand, including special handling of pass‐
    	      word.  If the `?' is followed by a string, that is used as the prompt  for  reading
    	      the  parameter instead of the default message (any necessary punctuation and white‐
    	      space should be included at the end of the prompt).  The first letter of the param‐
    	      eter  (only)  may be quoted with a `\'; hence an argument "\\$word" guarantees that
    	      the string from the shell parameter $word will be treated literally, whether or not
    	      it begins with a `?'.
    
    	      If instead a single `-' is given, the existing parameters, if any, are deleted.  In
    	      that case, calling open with no arguments will cause an error.
    
    	      The list of parameters is not deleted after a close, however it will be deleted  if
    	      the zsh/zftp module is unloaded.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     zftp params ftp.elsewhere.xx juser '?Password for juser: '
    
    	      will  store  the	host ftp.elsewhere.xx and the user juser and then prompt the user
    	      for the corresponding password with the given prompt.
    
           test   Test the connection; if the server has reported that it has closed  the  connection
    	      (maybe due to a timeout), return status 2; if no connection was open anyway, return
    	      status 1; else return status 0.  The test subcommand is silent, apart from messages
    	      printed by the $ZFTP_VERBOSE mechanism, or error messages if the connection closes.
    	      There is no network overhead for this test.
    
    	      The test is only supported on systems with either the select(2) or  poll(2)  system
    	      calls; otherwise the message `not supported on this system' is printed instead.
    
    	      The  test subcommand will automatically be called at the start of any other subcom‐
    	      mand for the current session when a connection is open.
    
           cd directory
    	      Change the remote directory to directory.  Also alters the shell variable ZFTP_PWD.
    
           cdup   Change the remote directory to the one higher in the directory tree.  Note that  cd
    	      .. will also work correctly on non-UNIX systems.
    
           dir [ arg ... ]
    	      Give  a (verbose) listing of the remote directory.  The args are passed directly to
    	      the server. The command's behaviour is implementation dependent, but a UNIX  server
    	      will  typically interpret args as arguments to the ls command and with no arguments
    	      return the result of `ls -l'. The directory is listed to standard output.
    
           ls [ arg ... ]
    	      Give a (short) listing of the remote directory.  With no arg, produces a	raw  list
    	      of  the  files  in  the  directory, one per line.  Otherwise, up to vagaries of the
    	      server implementation, behaves similar to dir.
    
           type [ type ]
    	      Change the type for the transfer to type, or print the  current  type  if  type  is
    	      absent.	The  allowed  values are `A' (ASCII), `I' (Image, i.e. binary), or `B' (a
    	      synonym for `I').
    
    	      The FTP default for a transfer is ASCII.	However, if zftp finds	that  the  remote
    	      host  is	a  UNIX  machine  with	8-bit byes, it will automatically switch to using
    	      binary for file transfers upon open.  This can subsequently be overridden.
    
    	      The transfer type is only passed to the remote  host  when  a  data  connection  is
    	      established; this command involves no network overhead.
    
           ascii  The same as type A.
    
           binary The same as type I.
    
           mode [ S | B ]
    	      Set  the	mode  type to stream (S) or block (B).	Stream mode is the default; block
    	      mode is not widely supported.
    
           remote file ...
           local [ file ... ]
    	      Print the size and last modification time of the remote or local files.	If  there
    	      is  more	than  one  item  on the list, the name of the file is printed first.  The
    	      first number is the file size, the second is the last modification time of the file
    	      in  the  format  CCYYMMDDhhmmSS  consisting of year, month, date, hour, minutes and
    	      seconds in GMT.  Note that this format, including the  length,  is  guaranteed,  so
    	      that  time strings can be directly compared via the [[ builtin's < and > operators,
    	      even if they are too long to be represented as integers.
    
    	      Not all servers support the commands for	retrieving  this  information.	 In  that
    	      case, the remote command will print nothing and return status 2, compared with sta‐
    	      tus 1 for a file not found.
    
    	      The local command (but not remote) may be used with no arguments, in which case the
    	      information  comes  from	examining file descriptor zero.  This is the same file as
    	      seen by a put command with no further redirection.
    
           get file ...
    	      Retrieve all files from the server, concatenating them and sending them to standard
    	      output.
    
           put file ...
    	      For  each  file,	read  a file from standard input and send that to the remote host
    	      with the given name.
    
           append file ...
    	      As put, but if the remote file already exists, data is appended to  it  instead  of
    	      overwriting it.
    
           getat file point
           putat file point
           appendat file point
    	      Versions of get, put and append which will start the transfer at the given point in
    	      the remote file.	This is useful for appending to an incomplete local  file.   How‐
    	      ever,  note  that  this ability is not universally supported by servers (and is not
    	      quite the behaviour specified by the standard).
    
           delete file ...
    	      Delete the list of files on the server.
    
           mkdir directory
    	      Create a new directory directory on the server.
    
           rmdir directory
    	      Delete the directory directory  on the server.
    
           rename old-name new-name
    	      Rename file old-name to new-name on the server.
    
           site arg ...
    	      Send a host-specific command to the server.  You will probably only  need  this  if
    	      instructed by the server to use it.
    
           quote arg ...
    	      Send  the  raw FTP command sequence to the server.  You should be familiar with the
    	      FTP command set as defined in  RFC959  before  doing  this.   Useful  commands  may
    	      include STAT and HELP.  Note also the mechanism for returning messages as described
    	      for the variable ZFTP_VERBOSE below, in particular that all messages from the  con‐
    	      trol connection are sent to standard error.
    
           close
           quit   Close  the  current  data  connection.  This unsets the shell parameters ZFTP_HOST,
    	      ZFTP_PORT, ZFTP_IP, ZFTP_SYSTEM, ZFTP_USER, ZFTP_ACCOUNT, ZFTP_PWD,  ZFTP_TYPE  and
    	      ZFTP_MODE.
    
           session [ sessname ]
    	      Allows  multiple	FTP  sessions  to be used at once.  The name of the session is an
    	      arbitrary string of characters; the default session is called `default'.	 If  this
    	      command  is called without an argument, it will list all the current sessions; with
    	      an argument, it will either switch to the existing session called sessname, or cre‐
    	      ate a new session of that name.
    
    	      Each session remembers the status of the connection, the set of connection-specific
    	      shell parameters (the same set as are unset when a connection closes, as	given  in
    	      the  description	of close), and any user parameters specified with the params sub‐
    	      command.	Changing to a previous session restores those values; changing to  a  new
    	      session initialises them in the same way as if zftp had just been loaded.  The name
    	      of the current session is given by the parameter ZFTP_SESSION.
    
           rmsession [ sessname ]
    	      Delete a session; if a name is not given, the current session is deleted.   If  the
    	      current  session	is deleted, the earliest existing session becomes the new current
    	      session, otherwise the current session  is  not  changed.   If  the  session  being
    	      deleted  is the only one, a new session called `default' is created and becomes the
    	      current session; note that this is a new session even if the session being  deleted
    	      is  also	called	`default'.  It	is recommended that sessions not be deleted while
    	      background commands which use zftp are still active.
    
       Parameters
           The following shell parameters are used by zftp.  Currently none of them are special.
    
           ZFTP_TMOUT
    	      Integer.	The time in seconds to wait for a network operation  to  complete  before
    	      returning an error.  If this is not set when the module is loaded, it will be given
    	      the default value 60.  A value of zero turns off timeouts.  If a timeout occurs  on
    	      the  control  connection	it will be closed.  Use a larger value if this occurs too
    	      frequently.
    
           ZFTP_IP
    	      Readonly.  The IP address of the current connection in dot notation.
    
           ZFTP_HOST
    	      Readonly.  The hostname of the current remote server.  If the host was opened as an
    	      IP  number,  ZFTP_HOST  contains	that  instead; this saves the overhead for a name
    	      lookup, as IP numbers are most commonly used when a nameserver is unavailable.
    
           ZFTP_PORT
    	      Readonly.  The number of the remote TCP port to which the connection is open  (even
    	      if  the  port  was  originally  specified as a named service).  Usually this is the
    	      standard FTP port, 21.
    
    	      In the unlikely event that your system does not  have  the  appropriate  conversion
    	      functions,  this	appears  in network byte order.  If your system is little-endian,
    	      the port then consists of two swapped bytes and the standard port will be  reported
    	      as  5376.   In that case, numeric ports passed to zftp open will also need to be in
    	      this format.
    
           ZFTP_SYSTEM
    	      Readonly.  The system type string returned by the server in response to an FTP SYST
    	      request.	 The  most  interesting case is a string beginning "UNIX Type: L8", which
    	      ensures maximum compatibility with a local UNIX host.
    
           ZFTP_TYPE
    	      Readonly.  The type to be used for data transfers , either `A' or  `I'.	 Use  the
    	      type subcommand to change this.
    
           ZFTP_USER
    	      Readonly.  The username currently logged in, if any.
    
           ZFTP_ACCOUNT
    	      Readonly.   The  account	name  of  the  current user, if any.  Most servers do not
    	      require an account name.
    
           ZFTP_PWD
    	      Readonly.  The current directory on the server.
    
           ZFTP_CODE
    	      Readonly.  The three digit code of the last FTP reply from the server as a  string.
    	      This  can still be read after the connection is closed, and is not changed when the
    	      current session changes.
    
           ZFTP_REPLY
    	      Readonly.  The last line of the last reply sent by the server.  This can	still  be
    	      read  after  the	connection is closed, and is not changed when the current session
    	      changes.
    
           ZFTP_SESSION
    	      Readonly.  The name of the current FTP session; see the description of the  session
    	      subcommand.
    
           ZFTP_PREFS
    	      A  string of preferences for altering aspects of zftp's behaviour.  Each preference
    	      is a single character.  The following are defined:
    
    	      P      Passive:  attempt to make the remote server initiate data	transfers.   This
    		     is slightly more efficient than sendport mode.  If the letter S occurs later
    		     in the string, zftp will use sendport mode if passive mode is not available.
    
    	      S      Sendport:	initiate transfers by the  FTP	PORT  command.	 If  this  occurs
    		     before any P in the string, passive mode will never be attempted.
    
    	      D      Dumb:   use  only the bare minimum of FTP commands.  This prevents the vari‐
    		     ables ZFTP_SYSTEM and ZFTP_PWD from being set, and will mean all connections
    		     default  to  ASCII  type.	 It may prevent ZFTP_SIZE from being set during a
    		     transfer if the server does not send it anyway (many servers do).
    
    	      If ZFTP_PREFS is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set to a default of  `PS',
    	      i.e. use passive mode if available, otherwise fall back to sendport mode.
    
           ZFTP_VERBOSE
    	      A  string  of digits between 0 and 5 inclusive, specifying which responses from the
    	      server should be printed.  All responses go to standard error.  If any of the  num‐
    	      bers  1  to  5 appear in the string, raw responses from the server with reply codes
    	      beginning with that digit will be printed to standard error.  The  first	digit  of
    	      the three digit reply code is defined by RFC959 to correspond to:
    
    	      1.     A positive preliminary reply.
    
    	      2.     A positive completion reply.
    
    	      3.     A positive intermediate reply.
    
    	      4.     A transient negative completion reply.
    
    	      5.     A permanent negative completion reply.
    
    	      It  should  be  noted that, for unknown reasons, the reply `Service not available',
    	      which forces termination of a connection, is classified  as  421,  i.e.  `transient
    	      negative', an interesting interpretation of the word `transient'.
    
    	      The  code  0  is	special:   it  indicates  that all but the last line of multiline
    	      replies read from the server will be printed to standard error in a processed  for‐
    	      mat.   By  convention,  servers  use this mechanism for sending information for the
    	      user to read.  The appropriate reply code, if it matches the same  response,  takes
    	      priority.
    
    	      If ZFTP_VERBOSE is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set to the default value
    	      450, i.e., messages destined for the user and all errors will be printed.   A  null
    	      string is valid and specifies that no messages should be printed.
    
       Functions
           zftp_chpwd
    	      If  this function is set by the user, it is called every time the directory changes
    	      on the server, including when a user is logged in, or when a connection is  closed.
    	      In the last case, $ZFTP_PWD will be unset; otherwise it will reflect the new direc‐
    	      tory.
    
           zftp_progress
    	      If this function is set by the user, it will be called during a get, put or  append
    	      operation each time sufficient data has been received from the host.  During a get,
    	      the data is sent to standard output, so it is vital that this function should write
    	      to standard error or directly to the terminal, not to standard output.
    
    	      When  it	is  called  with  a  transfer in progress, the following additional shell
    	      parameters are set:
    
    	      ZFTP_FILE
    		     The name of the remote file being transferred from or to.
    
    	      ZFTP_TRANSFER
    		     A G for a get operation and a P for a put operation.
    
    	      ZFTP_SIZE
    		     The total size of the complete file being transferred: the same as the first
    		     value  provided  by  the remote and local subcommands for a particular file.
    		     If the server cannot supply this value for a remote file being retrieved, it
    		     will  not	be  set.   If input is from a pipe the value may be incorrect and
    		     correspond simply to a full pipe buffer.
    
    	      ZFTP_COUNT
    		     The amount of data so far transferred; a number between zero and $ZFTP_SIZE,
    		     if that is set.  This number is always available.
    
    	      The   function  is  initially  called  with  ZFTP_TRANSFER  set  appropriately  and
    	      ZFTP_COUNT set to zero.  After the transfer  is  finished,  the  function  will  be
    	      called  one more time with ZFTP_TRANSFER set to GF or PF, in case it wishes to tidy
    	      up.  It is otherwise never called twice with the same value of ZFTP_COUNT.
    
    	      Sometimes the progress meter may cause disruption.  It is up to the user to  decide
    	      whether the function should be defined and to use unfunction when necessary.
    
       Problems
           A  connection  may  not be opened in the left hand side of a pipe as this occurs in a sub‐
           shell and the file information is not updated in the main shell.  In the case of  type  or
           mode  changes  or  closing  the	connection in a subshell, the information is returned but
           variables are not updated until the next call to zftp.  Other status changes in	subshells
           will not be reflected by changes to the variables (but should be otherwise harmless).
    
           Deleting  sessions  while  a  zftp command is active in the background can have unexpected
           effects, even if it does not use the session being deleted.  This  is  because  all  shell
           subprocesses  share  information  on  the state of all connections, and deleting a session
           changes the ordering of that information.
    
           On some operating systems, the control connection is not valid after  a	fork(),  so  that
           operations in subshells, on the left hand side of a pipeline, or in the background are not
           possible, as they should be.  This is presumably a bug in the operating system.
    
    THE ZSH/ZLE MODULE
           The zsh/zle module contains the Zsh Line Editor.  See zshzle(1).
    
    THE ZSH/ZLEPARAMETER MODULE
           The zsh/zleparameter module defines two special parameters that	can  be  used  to  access
           internal information of the Zsh Line Editor (see zshzle(1)).
    
           keymaps
    	      This array contains the names of the keymaps currently defined.
    
           widgets
    	      This  associative array contains one entry per widget defined. The name of the wid‐
    	      get is the key and the value gives information about the widget. It is  either  the
    	      string  `builtin'  for  builtin  widgets,  a  string  of	the  form `user:name' for
    	      user-defined widgets, where name is the name of the shell function implementing the
    	      widget,  or  it is a string of the form `completion:type:name', for completion wid‐
    	      gets. In the last case type is the name of the builtin widgets the completion  wid‐
    	      get  imitates in its behavior and name is the name of the shell function implement‐
    	      ing the completion widget.
    
    THE ZSH/ZPROF MODULE
           When loaded, the zsh/zprof causes shell functions to be profiled.  The  profiling  results
           can be obtained with the zprof builtin command made available by this module.  There is no
           way to turn profiling off other than unloading the module.
    
           zprof [ -c ]
    	      Without the -c option, zprof lists profiling results to standard output.	The  for‐
    	      mat is comparable to that of commands like gprof.
    
    	      At the top there is a summary listing all functions that were called at least once.
    	      This summary is sorted in decreasing order of the amount of  time  spent	in  each.
    	      The lines contain the number of the function in order, which is used in other parts
    	      of the list in suffixes of the form `[num]', then the number of calls made  to  the
    	      function.   The next three columns list the time in milliseconds spent in the func‐
    	      tion and its descendants, the average time in milliseconds spent	in  the  function
    	      and  its	descendants  per call and the percentage of time spent in all shell func‐
    	      tions used in this function and its descendants.	The following three columns  give
    	      the same information, but counting only the time spent in the function itself.  The
    	      final column shows the name of the function.
    
    	      After the summary, detailed information about every function that  was  invoked  is
    	      listed, sorted in decreasing order of the amount of time spent in each function and
    	      its descendants.	Each of these entries consists of descriptions for the	functions
    	      that  called  the  function  described, the function itself, and the functions that
    	      were called from it.  The description for the function itself has the  same  format
    	      as in the summary (and shows the same information).  The other lines don't show the
    	      number of the function at the beginning and have their function named  indented  to
    	      make  it	easier to distinguish the line showing the function described in the sec‐
    	      tion from the surrounding lines.
    
    	      The information shown in this case is almost the same as in the summary,	but  only
    	      refers  to the call hierarchy being displayed.  For example, for a calling function
    	      the column showing the total running time lists the time	spent  in  the	described
    	      function	and  its descendants only for the times when it was called from that par‐
    	      ticular calling function.  Likewise, for a called function, this columns lists  the
    	      total time spent in the called function and its descendants only for the times when
    	      it was called from the function described.
    
    	      Also in this case, the column showing the number of calls to a function also  shows
    	      a slash and then the total number of invocations made to the called function.
    
    	      As  long	as  the  zsh/zprof  module is loaded, profiling will be done and multiple
    	      invocations of the zprof builtin command will show the times and numbers	of  calls
    	      since  the  module  was loaded.  With the -c option, the zprof builtin command will
    	      reset its internal counters and will not show the listing.
    
    THE ZSH/ZPTY MODULE
           The zsh/zpty module offers one builtin:
    
           zpty [ -e ] [ -b ] name [ arg ... ]
    	      The arguments following name are concatenated with spaces between, then executed as
    	      a  command,  as  if  passed  to  the  eval builtin.  The command runs under a newly
    	      assigned pseudo-terminal; this is useful	for  running  commands	non-interactively
    	      which  expect an interactive environment.  The name is not part of the command, but
    	      is used to refer to this command in later calls to zpty.
    
    	      With the -e option, the pseudo-terminal is set up  so  that  input  characters  are
    	      echoed.
    
    	      With  the  -b  option,  input  to  and  output  from  the  pseudo-terminal are made
    	      non-blocking.
    
    	      The shell parameter REPLY is set to the file descriptor assigned to the master side
    	      of the pseudo-terminal.  This allows the terminal to be monitored with ZLE descrip‐
    	      tor handlers (see zshzle(1)) or manipulated with	sysread  and  syswrite	(see  THE
    	      ZSH/SYSTEM  MODULE  in zshmodules(1)).  Warning: Use of sysread and syswrite is not
    	      recommended, use zpty -r and zpty -w unless you know exactly what you are doing.
    
           zpty -d [ name ... ]
    	      The second form, with the -d option, is used to delete commands previously started,
    	      by supplying a list of their names.  If no name is given, all commands are deleted.
    	      Deleting a command causes the HUP signal to be sent to the corresponding process.
    
           zpty -w [ -n ] name [ string ... ]
    	      The -w option can be used to send the to command name the given  strings	as  input
    	      (separated  by  spaces).	 If the -n option is not given, a newline is added at the
    	      end.
    
    	      If no string is provided, the standard input is copied to the pseudo-terminal; this
    	      may stop before copying the full input if the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking.
    
    	      Note  that  the  command	under  the  pseudo-terminal sees this input as if it were
    	      typed, so beware when sending special tty driver	characters  such  as  word-erase,
    	      line-kill, and end-of-file.
    
           zpty -r [ -mt ] name [ param [ pattern ] ]
    	      The -r option can be used to read the output of the command name.  With only a name
    	      argument, the output read is copied to the standard output.  Unless the pseudo-ter‐
    	      minal  is non-blocking, copying continues until the command under the pseudo-termi‐
    	      nal exits; when non-blocking, only as much output as is  immediately  available  is
    	      copied.  The return status is zero if any output is copied.
    
    	      When also given a param argument, at most one line is read and stored in the param‐
    	      eter named param.  Less than a full line may be  read  if  the  pseudo-terminal  is
    	      non-blocking.   The  return  status  is zero if at least one character is stored in
    	      param.
    
    	      If a pattern is given as well, output is read until the whole string  read  matches
    	      the  pattern,  even  in  the  non-blocking  case.  The return status is zero if the
    	      string read matches the pattern, or if the command has  exited  but  at  least  one
    	      character  could	still be read.	If the option -m is present, the return status is
    	      zero only if the pattern matches.  As of this writing, a maximum of one megabyte of
    	      output  can  be  consumed this way; if a full megabyte is read without matching the
    	      pattern, the return status is non-zero.
    
    	      In all cases, the return status is non-zero if nothing could be read, and is  2  if
    	      this is because the command has finished.
    
    	      If  the  -r  option  is  combined  with the -t option, zpty tests whether output is
    	      available before trying to read.	If  no	output	is  available,	zpty  immediately
    	      returns  the status 1.  When used with a pattern, the behaviour on a failed poll is
    	      similar to when the command has exited:  the return value is zero if at  least  one
    	      character could still be read even if the pattern failed to match.
    
           zpty -t name
    	      The -t option without the -r option can be used to test whether the command name is
    	      still running.  It returns a zero status if the command is running and  a  non-zero
    	      value otherwise.
    
           zpty [ -L ]
    	      The  last  form,	without  any  arguments,  is  used to list the commands currently
    	      defined.	If the -L option is given, this is done in the form of calls to the  zpty
    	      builtin.
    
    THE ZSH/ZSELECT MODULE
           The zsh/zselect module makes available one builtin command:
    
           zselect [ -rwe ] [ -t timeout ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] [ fd ... ]
    	      The  zselect builtin is a front-end to the `select' system call, which blocks until
    	      a file descriptor is ready for reading or writing, or has an error condition,  with
    	      an  optional  timeout.  If this is not available on your system, the command prints
    	      an error message and returns status 2 (normal errors return status  1).	For  more
    	      information,  see  your systems documentation for select(3).  Note there is no con‐
    	      nection with the shell builtin of the same name.
    
    	      Arguments and options may be intermingled in any order.  Non-option  arguments  are
    	      file descriptors, which must be decimal integers.  By default, file descriptors are
    	      to be tested for reading, i.e. zselect will return when data  is	available  to  be
    	      read  from  the  file descriptor, or more precisely, when a read operation from the
    	      file descriptor will not block.  After a -r, -w and -e, the given file  descriptors
    	      are  to  be tested for reading, writing, or error conditions.  These options and an
    	      arbitrary list of file descriptors may be given in any order.
    
    	      (The presence of an `error condition' is not well defined in the documentation  for
    	      many  implementations  of  the select system call.  According to recent versions of
    	      the POSIX specification, it is really an exception condition,  of  which	the  only
    	      standard	example  is  out-of-band  data	received  on  a socket.  So zsh users are
    	      unlikely to find the -e option useful.)
    
    	      The option `-t timeout' specifies a timeout in hundredths of a second.  This may be
    	      zero,  in  which	case  the file descriptors will simply be polled and zselect will
    	      return immediately.  It is possible to call zselect with no file descriptors and	a
    	      non-zero timeout for use as a finer-grained replacement for `sleep'; note, however,
    	      the return status is always 1 for a timeout.
    
    	      The option `-a array' indicates that array should  be  set  to  indicate	the  file
    	      descriptor(s) which are ready.  If the option is not given, the array reply will be
    	      used for this purpose.  The array will contain a string similar  to  the	arguments
    	      for zselect.  For example,
    
    		     zselect -t 0 -r 0 -w 1
    
    	      might  return  immediately  with status 0 and $reply containing `-r 0 -w 1' to show
    	      that both file descriptors are ready for the requested operations.
    
    	      The option `-A assoc' indicates that the associative array assoc should be  set  to
    	      indicate	the file descriptor(s) which are ready.  This option overrides the option
    	      -a, nor will reply be modified.  The keys of assoc are the  file	descriptors,  and
    	      the corresponding values are any of the characters `rwe' to indicate the condition.
    
    	      The  command  returns  status 0 if some file descriptors are ready for reading.  If
    	      the operation timed out, or a timeout of 0 was given and no file	descriptors  were
    	      ready,  or  there  was  an error, it returns status 1 and the array will not be set
    	      (nor modified in any way).  If there was an  error  in  the  select  operation  the
    	      appropriate error message is printed.
    
    THE ZSH/ZUTIL MODULE
           The zsh/zutil module only adds some builtins:
    
           zstyle [ -L [ pattern [ style ] ] ]
           zstyle [ -e | - | -- ] pattern style string ...
           zstyle -d [ pattern [ style ... ] ]
           zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
           zstyle -{a|b|s} context style name [ sep ]
           zstyle -{T|t} context style [ string ... ]
           zstyle -m context style pattern
    	      This  builtin  command  is  used	to define and lookup styles.  Styles are pairs of
    	      names and values, where the values consist of any  number  of  strings.	They  are
    	      stored  together	with  patterns	and lookup is done by giving a string, called the
    	      `context', which is compared to the patterns.  The definition stored for the  first
    	      matching pattern will be returned.
    
    	      For ordering of comparisons, patterns are searched from most specific to least spe‐
    	      cific, and patterns that are equally specific keep the order  in	which  they  were
    	      defined.	 A  pattern is considered to be more specific than another if it contains
    	      more components (substrings separated by colons) or if the patterns for the  compo‐
    	      nents  are  more	specific, where simple strings are considered to be more specific
    	      than patterns and complex patterns are considered to be more specific than the pat‐
    	      tern `*'.
    
    	      The  first  form	(without  arguments)  lists the definitions.  Styles are shown in
    	      alphabetic order and patterns are shown in the order zstyle will test them.
    
    	      If the -L option is given, listing is done in the form of  calls	to  zstyle.   The
    	      optional	first argument is a pattern which will be matched against the string sup‐
    	      plied as the pattern for the context; note that this means, for example, `zstyle -L
    	      ":completion:*"' will match any supplied pattern beginning `:completion:', not just
    	      ":completion:*":	use ":completion:\*" to match that.  The optional second argument
    	      limits  the  output to a specific style (not a pattern).	-L is not compatible with
    	      any other options.
    
    	      The other forms are the following:
    
    	      zstyle [ - | -- | -e ] pattern style string ...
    		     Defines the given style for the pattern with the strings as the  value.   If
    		     the  -e option is given, the strings will be concatenated (separated by spa‐
    		     ces) and the resulting string will be evaluated (in the same way  as  it  is
    		     done by the eval builtin command) when the style is looked up.  In this case
    		     the parameter `reply' must be assigned to set the strings returned after the
    		     evaluation.  Before evaluating the value, reply is unset, and if it is still
    		     unset after the evaluation, the style is treated as if it were not set.
    
    	      zstyle -d [ pattern [ style ... ] ]
    		     Delete style definitions. Without arguments  all  definitions  are  deleted,
    		     with  a  pattern  all  definitions  for  that pattern are deleted and if any
    		     styles are given, then only those styles are deleted for the pattern.
    
    	      zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
    		     Retrieve a style definition. The name is used as the name	of  an	array  in
    		     which  the  results  are stored. Without any further arguments, all patterns
    		     defined are returned. With a pattern the styles defined for that pattern are
    		     returned and with both a pattern and a style, the value strings of that com‐
    		     bination is returned.
    
    	      The other forms can be used to look up or test patterns.
    
    	      zstyle -s context style name [ sep ]
    		     The parameter name is set to the value of the style interpreted as a string.
    		     If  the value contains several strings they are concatenated with spaces (or
    		     with the sep string if that is given) between them.
    
    	      zstyle -b context style name
    		     The value is stored in name as a boolean, i.e. as the string  `yes'  if  the
    		     value  has only one string and that string is equal to one of `yes', `true',
    		     `on', or `1'. If the value is any other string or has more than one  string,
    		     the parameter is set to `no'.
    
    	      zstyle -a context style name
    		     The  value is stored in name as an array. If name is declared as an associa‐
    		     tive array,  the first, third, etc. strings are used as  the  keys  and  the
    		     other strings are used as the values.
    
    	      zstyle -t context style [ string ... ]
    	      zstyle -T context style [ string ... ]
    		     Test  the	value  of a style, i.e. the -t option only returns a status (sets
    		     $?).  Without any string the return status is zero if the style  is  defined
    		     for  at  least  one  matching pattern, has only one string in its value, and
    		     that is equal to one of `true', `yes', `on' or `1'. If any strings are given
    		     the status is zero if and only if at least one of the strings is equal to at
    		     least one of the strings in the value. If the style is defined  but  doesn't
    		     match, the return status is 1. If the style is not defined, the status is 2.
    
    		     The  -T  option tests the values of the style like -t, but it returns status
    		     zero (rather than 2) if the style is not defined for any matching pattern.
    
    	      zstyle -m context style pattern
    		     Match a value. Returns status zero if the pattern matches at  least  one  of
    		     the strings in the value.
    
           zformat -f param format spec ...
           zformat -a array sep spec ...
    	      This builtin provides two different forms of formatting. The first form is selected
    	      with the -f option. In this case the format string will be  modified  by	replacing
    	      sequences  starting  with  a  percent sign in it with strings from the specs.  Each
    	      spec should be of the form `char:string' which will cause every appearance  of  the
    	      sequence `%char' in format to be replaced by the string.	The `%' sequence may also
    	      contain optional minimum and maximum field width specifications between the `%' and
    	      the `char' in the form `%min.maxc', i.e. the minimum field width is given first and
    	      if the maximum field width is used, it has to be preceded by a dot.   Specifying	a
    	      minimum  field  width  makes  the  result be padded with spaces to the right if the
    	      string is shorter than the requested width.  Padding to the left can be achieved by
    	      giving  a negative minimum field width.  If a maximum field width is specified, the
    	      string will be truncated after that many characters.  After all `%'  sequences  for
    	      the  given specs have been processed, the resulting string is stored in the parame‐
    	      ter param.
    
    	      The %-escapes also understand ternary expressions in the form used by prompts.  The
    	      % is followed by a `(' and then an ordinary format specifier character as described
    	      above.  There may be a set of digits either before or after the `('; these  specify
    	      a  test  number,	which  defaults  to zero.  Negative numbers are also allowed.  An
    	      arbitrary delimiter character follows the format specifier, which is followed by	a
    	      piece of `true' text, the delimiter character again, a piece of `false' text, and a
    	      closing parenthesis.  The complete expression (without the digits) thus looks  like
    	      `%(X.text1.text2)',  except  that  the `.' character is arbitrary.  The value given
    	      for the format specifier in the char:string expressions is evaluated as a mathemat‐
    	      ical expression, and compared with the test number.  If they are the same, text1 is
    	      output, else text2 is output.  A parenthesis may be escaped in text2 as %).  Either
    	      of text1 or text2 may contain nested %-escapes.
    
    	      For example:
    
    		     zformat -f REPLY "The answer is '%3(c.yes.no)'." c:3
    
    	      outputs  "The answer is 'yes'." to REPLY since the value for the format specifier c
    	      is 3, agreeing with the digit argument to the ternary expression.
    
    	      The second form, using the -a option, can be used for aligning strings.  Here,  the
    	      specs  are of the form `left:right' where `left' and `right' are arbitrary strings.
    	      These strings are modified by replacing the colons by the sep  string  and  padding
    	      the  left  strings  with	spaces to the right so that the sep strings in the result
    	      (and hence the right strings after them) are all aligned if the strings are printed
    	      below  each  other.  All strings without a colon are left unchanged and all strings
    	      with an empty right string have the trailing colon  removed.   In  both  cases  the
    	      lengths  of  the	strings are not used to determine how the other strings are to be
    	      aligned.	The resulting strings are stored in the array.
    
           zregexparse
    	      This implements some internals of the _regex_arguments function.
    
           zparseopts [ -DKME ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] spec ...
    	      This builtin simplifies the parsing of options in positional parameters,	i.e.  the
    	      set  of  arguments  given by $*.	Each spec describes one option and must be of the
    	      form `opt[=array]'.  If an option described by  opt  is  found  in  the  positional
    	      parameters  it  is  copied  into	the  array  specified  with the -a option; if the
    	      optional `=array' is given, it is instead copied into that array.
    
    	      Note that it is an error to give any spec without an `=array' unless one of the  -a
    	      or -A options is used.
    
    	      Unless  the  -E  option  is  given,  parsing  stops  at the first string that isn't
    	      described by one of the specs.  Even with -E, parsing always stops at a  positional
    	      parameter equal to `-' or `--'.
    
    	      The  opt	description  must be one of the following.  Any of the special characters
    	      can appear in the option name provided it is preceded by a backslash.
    
    	      name
    	      name+  The name is the name of the option without the leading `-'.   To  specify	a
    		     GNU-style	long option, one of the usual two leading `-' must be included in
    		     name; for example, a `--file' option is represented by a name of `-file'.
    
    		     If a `+' appears after name, the option is appended to array each time it is
    		     found in the positional parameters; without the `+' only the last occurrence
    		     of the option is preserved.
    
    		     If one of these forms is used, the option	takes  no  argument,  so  parsing
    		     stops  if the next positional parameter does not also begin with `-' (unless
    		     the -E option is used).
    
    	      name:
    	      name:-
    	      name:: If one or two colons are given, the  option  takes  an  argument;	with  one
    		     colon,  the  argument  is mandatory and with two colons it is optional.  The
    		     argument is appended to the array after the option itself.
    
    		     An optional argument is put into the same array element as the  option  name
    		     (note  that  this	makes  empty  strings as arguments indistinguishable).	A
    		     mandatory argument is added as a separate element unless the  `:-'  form  is
    		     used, in which case the argument is put into the same element.
    
    		     A `+' as described above may appear between the name and the first colon.
    
    	      The options of zparseopts itself are:
    
    	      -a array
    		     As  described  above,  this  names  the  default array in which to store the
    		     recognised options.
    
    	      -A assoc
    		     If this is given, the options and their values are also put into an associa‐
    		     tive  array  with the option names as keys and the arguments (if any) as the
    		     values.
    
    	      -D     If this option is given, all options found are removed from  the  positional
    		     parameters  of  the calling shell or shell function, up to but not including
    		     any not described by the specs.  This is similar to using the shift builtin.
    
    	      -K     With this option, the arrays specified with  the  -a  option  and	with  the
    		     `=array'  forms  are kept unchanged when none of the specs for them is used.
    		     Otherwise the entire array is replaced when any of the specs is used.  Indi‐
    		     vidual  elements of associative arrays specified with the -A option are pre‐
    		     served by -K.  This allows assignment of default  values  to  arrays  before
    		     calling zparseopts.
    
    	      -M     This changes the assignment rules to implement a map among equivalent option
    		     names.  If any spec uses the `=array' form, the string array is  interpreted
    		     as the name of another spec, which is used to choose where to store the val‐
    		     ues.  If no other spec is found, the  values  are	stored	as  usual.   This
    		     changes  only  the  way  the values are stored, not the way $* is parsed, so
    		     results may be unpredictable if the  `name+'  specifier  is  used	inconsis‐
    		     tently.
    
    	      -E     This  changes  the  parsing rules to not stop at the first string that isn't
    		     described by one of the specs.  It can be used  to  test  for  or	(if  used
    		     together  with  -D)  extract options and their arguments, ignoring all other
    		     options and arguments that may be in the positional parameters.
    
    	      For example,
    
    		     set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
    		     zparseopts a=foo b:=bar c+:=bar
    
    	      will have the effect of
    
    		     foo=(-a)
    		     bar=(-b x -c y -c z)
    
    	      The arguments from `baz' on will not be used.
    
    	      As an example for the -E option, consider:
    
    		     set -- -a x -b y -c z arg1 arg2
    		     zparseopts -E -D b:=bar
    
    	      will have the effect of
    
    		     bar=(-b y)
    		     set -- -a x -c z arg1 arg2
    
    	      I.e., the option -b and its arguments are taken from the positional parameters  and
    	      put into the array bar.
    
    	      The -M option can be used like this:
    
    		     set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
    		     zparseopts -A bar -M a=foo b+: c:=b
    
    	      to have the effect of
    
    		     foo=(-a)
    		     bar=(-a '' -b xyz)
    
    ZSHCALSYS(1)			     General Commands Manual			     ZSHCALSYS(1)
    
    NAME
           zshcalsys - zsh calendar system
    
    DESCRIPTION
           The  shell  is  supplied with a series of functions to replace and enhance the traditional
           Unix calendar programme, which warns the user of imminent or  future  events,  details  of
           which  are  stored  in a text file (typically calendar in the user's home directory).  The
           version provided here includes a mechanism for alerting the user when an event is due.
    
           In addition functions age, before and after are provided that can be used in a glob quali‐
           fier; they allow files to be selected based on their modification times.
    
           The  format  of	the calendar file and the dates used there in and in the age function are
           described first, then the functions that can be called to examine and modify the  calendar
           file.
    
           The  functions here depend on the availability of the zsh/datetime module which is usually
           installed with the shell.  The library  function  strptime()  must  be  available;  it  is
           present on most recent operating systems.
    
    FILE AND DATE FORMATS
       Calendar File Format
           The  calendar  file is by default ~/calendar.  This can be configured by the calendar-file
           style, see the section STYLES below.  The basic format consists of a  series  of  separate
           lines,  with  no  indentation,  each including a date and time specification followed by a
           description of the event.
    
           Various enhancements to this format are supported, based on the syntax of  Emacs  calendar
           mode.   An  indented  line indicates a continuation line that continues the description of
           the event from the preceding line (note the date may not be continued in  this  way).   An
           initial ampersand (&) is ignored for compatibility.
    
           An  indented  line  on which the first non-whitespace character is # is not displayed with
           the calendar entry, but is still scanned for information.  This can be used to hide infor‐
           mation  useful  to  the calendar system but not to the user, such as the unique identifier
           used by calendar_add.
    
           The Emacs extension that a date with no description may refer to a  number  of  succeeding
           events at different times is not supported.
    
           Unless  the  done-file  style  has  been altered, any events which have been processed are
           appended to the file with the same name as the calendar file with the suffix .done,  hence
           ~/calendar.done by default.
    
           An example is shown below.
    
       Date Format
           The format of the date and time is designed to allow flexibility without admitting ambigu‐
           ity.  (The words `date' and `time' are both used in the documentation below; except  where
           specifically  noted this implies a string that may include both a date and a time specifi‐
           cation.)  Note that there is no localization support; month and day names must be in  Eng‐
           lish and separator characters are fixed.  Matching is case insensitive, and only the first
           three letters of the names are significant, although as a special case  a  form	beginning
           "month"	does  not match "Monday".  Furthermore, time zones are not handled; all times are
           assumed to be local.
    
           It is recommended that, rather than exploring the intricacies of the system, users find	a
           date  format that is natural to them and stick to it.  This will avoid unexpected effects.
           Various key facts should be noted.
    
           ·      In particular, note the confusion between month/day/year	and  day/month/year  when
    	      the  month  is  numeric;	these formats should be avoided if at all possible.  Many
    	      alternatives are available.
    
           ·      The year must be given in full to avoid confusion, and only years from 1900 to 2099
    	      inclusive are matched.
    
           The  following  give  some obvious examples; users finding here a format they like and not
           subject to vagaries of style may skip the  full	description.   As  dates  and  times  are
           matched separately (even though the time may be embedded in the date), any date format may
           be mixed with any format for the time of day provide the separators are clear (whitespace,
           colons, commas).
    
    	      2007/04/03 13:13
    	      2007/04/03:13:13
    	      2007/04/03 1:13 pm
    	      3rd April 2007, 13:13
    	      April 3rd 2007 1:13 p.m.
    	      Apr 3, 2007 13:13
    	      Tue Apr 03 13:13:00 2007
    	      13:13 2007/apr/3
    
           More detailed rules follow.
    
           Times  are  parsed and extracted before dates.  They must use colons to separate hours and
           minutes, though a dot is allowed before seconds if they are  present.   This  limits  time
           formats to the following:
    
           ·      HH:MM[:SS[.FFFFF]] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]
    
           ·      HH:MM.SS[.FFFFF] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]
    
           Here,  square  brackets indicate optional elements, possibly with alternatives.	Fractions
           of a second are recognised but ignored.	For absolute times (the normal format require  by
           the  calendar file and the age, before and after functions) a date is mandatory but a time
           of day is not; the time returned is at the start of the date.  One variation  is  allowed:
           if  a.m. or p.m. or one of their variants is present, an hour without a minute is allowed,
           e.g. 3 p.m..
    
           Time zones are not handled, though if one is matched following  a  time	specification  it
           will be removed to allow a surrounding date to be parsed.  This only happens if the format
           of the timezone is not too unusual.  The following are examples of forms that  are  under‐
           stood:
    
    	      +0100
    	      GMT
    	      GMT-7
    	      CET+1CDT
    
           Any  part  of  the timezone that is not numeric must have exactly three capital letters in
           the name.
    
           Dates suffer from the ambiguity between DD/MM/YYYY and MM/DD/YYYY.  It is recommended this
           form  is  avoided  with	purely	numeric dates, but use of ordinals, eg. 3rd/04/2007, will
           resolve the ambiguity as the ordinal is always parsed as the day of the month.  Years must
           be  four  digits  (and the first two must be 19 or 20); 03/04/08 is not recognised.  Other
           numbers may have leading zeroes, but they are not required.  The following are handled:
    
           ·      YYYY/MM/DD
    
           ·      YYYY-MM-DD
    
           ·      YYYY/MNM/DD
    
           ·      YYYY-MNM-DD
    
           ·      DD[th|st|rd] MNM[,] [ YYYY ]
    
           ·      MNM DD[th|st|rd][,] [ YYYY ]
    
           ·      DD[th|st|rd]/MM[,] YYYY
    
           ·      DD[th|st|rd]/MM/YYYY
    
           ·      MM/DD[th|st|rd][,] YYYY
    
           ·      MM/DD[th|st|rd]/YYYY
    
           Here, MNM is at least the first three letters of a month name, matched case-insensitively.
           The  remainder of the month name may appear but its contents are irrelevant, so janissary,
           febrile, martial, apricot, maybe, junta, etc. are happily handled.
    
           Where the year is shown as optional, the current year is assumed.  There are only two such
           cases,  the form Jun 20 or 14 September (the only two commonly occurring forms, apart from
           a "the" in some forms of English, which isn't currently supported).  Such  dates  will  of
           course become ambiguous in the future, so should ideally be avoided.
    
           Times  may follow dates with a colon, e.g. 1965/07/12:09:45; this is in order to provide a
           format with no whitespace.  A comma and whitespace are allowed,	e.g.  1965/07/12,  09:45.
           Currently  the  order  of  these  separators  is not checked, so illogical formats such as
           1965/07/12, : ,09:45 will also be matched.  For simplicity such variations are  not  shown
           in  the	list above.  Otherwise, a time is only recognised as being associated with a date
           if there is only whitespace in between, or if the time was embedded in the date.
    
           Days of the week are not normally scanned, but will be ignored if they occur at the  start
           of  the date pattern only.  However, in contexts where it is useful to specify dates rela‐
           tive to today, days of the week with no other date specification may be given.  The day is
           assumed	to be either today or within the past week.  Likewise, the words yesterday, today
           and tomorrow are handled.  All matches are case-insensitive.  Hence if  today  is  Monday,
           then Sunday is equivalent to yesterday, Monday is equivalent to today, but Tuesday gives a
           date six days ago.  This is not generally useful within the calendar file.  Dates in  this
           format may be combined with a time specification; for example Tomorrow, 8 p.m..
    
           For example, the standard date format:
    
    	      Fri Aug 18 17:00:48 BST 2006
    
           is  handled  by	matching  HH:MM:SS and removing it together with the matched (but unused)
           time zone.  This leaves the following:
    
    	      Fri Aug 18 2006
    
           Fri is ignored and the rest is matched according to the standard rules.
    
       Relative Time Format
           In certain places relative times are handled.  Here, a date is not allowed; instead a com‐
           bination  of  various  supported periods are allowed, together with an optional time.  The
           periods must be in order from most to least significant.
    
           In some cases, a more accurate calculation is possible when there is an anchor date:  off‐
           sets  of months or years pick the correct day, rather than being rounded, and it is possi‐
           ble to pick a particular day in a month as `(1st Friday)',  etc.,  as  described  in  more
           detail below.
    
           Anchors are available in the following cases.  If one or two times are passed to the func‐
           tion calendar, the start time acts an anchor for the end time when the end time	is  rela‐
           tive  (even  if the start time is implicit).  When examining calendar files, the scheduled
           event being examined anchors the warning time when it is given explicitly by means of  the
           WARN  keyword; likewise, the scheduled event anchors a repetition period when given by the
           RPT keyword, so that specifications such as RPT 2 months, 3rd Thursday are  handled  prop‐
           erly.  Finally, the -R argument to calendar_scandate directly provides an anchor for rela‐
           tive calculations.
    
           The periods handled, with possible abbreviations are:
    
           Years  years, yrs, ys, year, yr, y, yearly.  A year is 365.25  days  unless  there  is  an
    	      anchor.
    
           Months months,  mons,  mnths,  mths, month, mon, mnth, mth, monthly.  Note that m, ms, mn,
    	      mns are ambiguous and are not handled.  A month is a period of 30 days rather  than
    	      a calendar month unless there is an anchor.
    
           Weeks  weeks, wks, ws, week, wk, w, weekly
    
           Days   days, dys, ds, day, dy, d, daily
    
           Hours  hours, hrs, hs, hour, hr, h, hourly
    
           Minutes
    	      minutes, mins, minute, min, but not m, ms, mn or mns
    
           Seconds
    	      seconds, secs, ss, second, sec, s
    
           Spaces  between the numbers are optional, but are required between items, although a comma
           may be used (with or without spaces).
    
           The forms yearly to hourly allow the number to be omitted; it is assumed  to  be  1.   For
           example,  1  d and daily are equivalent.  Note that using those forms with plurals is con‐
           fusing; 2 yearly is the same as 2 years, not twice yearly, so it is recommended they  only
           be used without numbers.
    
           When an anchor time is present, there is an extension to handle regular events in the form
           of the nth someday of the month.  Such a specification must occur  immediately  after  any
           year  and  month  specification,  but  before  any  time  of  day, and must be in the form
           n(th|st|rd) day, for example 1st Tuesday or 3rd Monday.	As  in	other  places,	days  are
           matched	case insensitively, must be in English, and only the first three letters are sig‐
           nificant except that a form beginning `month' does not match `Monday'.  No attempt is made
           to sanitize the resulting date; attempts to squeeze too many occurrences into a month will
           push the day into the next month (but in the obvious fashion, retaining the correct day of
           the week).
    
           Here are some examples:
    
    	      30 years 3 months 4 days 3:42:41
    	      14 days 5 hours
    	      Monthly, 3rd Thursday
    	      4d,10hr
    
       Example
           Here is an example calendar file.  It uses a consistent date format, as recommended above.
    
    	      Feb 1, 2006 14:30 Pointless bureaucratic meeting
    	      Mar 27, 2006 11:00 Mutual recrimination and finger pointing
    		Bring water pistol and waterproofs
    	      Mar 31, 2006 14:00 Very serious managerial pontification
    		# UID 12C7878A9A50
    	      Apr 10, 2006 13:30 Even more pointless blame assignment exercise WARN 30 mins
    	      May 18, 2006 16:00 Regular moaning session RPT monthly, 3rd Thursday
    
           The  second  entry  has a continuation line.  The third entry has a continuation line that
           will not be shown when the entry is displayed, but the unique identifier will be  used  by
           the  calendar_add function when updating the event.  The fourth entry will produce a warn‐
           ing 30 minutes before the event (to allow you to equip yourself appropriately).	The fifth
           entry repeats after a month on the 3rd Thursday, i.e. June 15, 2006, at the same time.
    
    USER FUNCTIONS
           This section describes functions that are designed to be called directly by the user.  The
           first part describes those functions associated with the user's calendar; the second  part
           describes the use in glob qualifiers.
    
       Calendar system functions
           calendar [ -abdDsv ] [ -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S showprog ]
    		[ [ start ] end ]
           calendar -r [ -abdDrsv ] [ -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S showprog ]
    		[ start ]
    	      Show events in the calendar.
    
    	      With  no	arguments,  show events from the start of today until the end of the next
    	      working day after today.	In other words, if today is Friday, Saturday, or  Sunday,
    	      show up to the end of the following Monday, otherwise show today and tomorrow.
    
    	      If end is given, show events from the start of today up to the time and date given,
    	      which is in the format described in the previous section.  Note that if this  is	a
    	      date  the  time  is assumed to be midnight at the start of the date, so that effec‐
    	      tively this shows all events before the given date.
    
    	      end may start with a +, in which case the remainder of the specification is a rela‐
    	      tive  time format as described in the previous section indicating the range of time
    	      from the start time that is to be included.
    
    	      If start is also given, show events starting from that time and date.  The word now
    	      can be used to indicate the current time.
    
    	      To  implement  an  alert	when events are due, include calendar -s in your ~/.zshrc
    	      file.
    
    	      Options:
    
    	      -a     Show all items in the calendar, regardless of the start and end.
    
    	      -b     Brief:  don't display continuation lines (i.e. indented lines following  the
    		     line with the date/time), just the first line.
    
    	      -B lines
    		     Brief:  display at most the first lines lines of the calendar entry.  `-B 1'
    		     is equivalent to `-b'.
    
    	      -C calfile
    		     Explicitly specify a calendar file instead of the value of the calendar-file
    		     style or the default ~/calendar.
    
    	      -d     Move  any events that have passed from the calendar file to the "done" file,
    		     as given by the done-file style or the default which is  the  calendar  file
    		     with .done appended.  This option is implied by the -s option.
    
    	      -D     Turns off the option -d, even if the -s option is also present.
    
    	      -n num, -num
    		     Show at least num events, if present in the calendar file, regardless of the
    		     start and end.
    
    	      -r     Show all the remaining options in the calendar, ignoring the given end time.
    		     The start time is respected; any argument given is treated as a start time.
    
    	      -s     Use  the  shell's sched command to schedule a timed event that will warn the
    		     user when an event is due.  Note that the sched command  only  runs  if  the
    		     shell  is	at  an interactive prompt; a foreground task blocks the scheduled
    		     task from running until it is finished.
    
    		     The timed event usually runs the programme calendar_show to show the  event,
    		     as described in the section UTILITY FUNCTIONS below.
    
    		     By  default,  a warning of the event is shown five minutes before it is due.
    		     The warning period can be configured by the style warn-time or for a  single
    		     calendar  entry  by  including  WARN reltime in the first line of the entry,
    		     where reltime is one of the usual relative time formats.
    
    		     A repeated event may be indicated by including RPT reldate in the first line
    		     of  the  entry.   After  the  scheduled  event has been displayed it will be
    		     re-entered into the calendar file at  a  time  reldate  after  the  existing
    		     event.   Note  that this is currently the only use made of the repeat count,
    		     so that it is not possible to query the schedule  for  a  recurrence  of  an
    		     event in the calendar until the previous event has passed.
    
    		     If  RPT  is used, it is also possible to specify that certain recurrences of
    		     an event are rescheduled or cancelled.  This is  done  with  the  OCCURRENCE
    		     keyword,  followed  by whitespace and the date and time of the occurrence in
    		     the regular sequence, followed by whitespace and either the date and time of
    		     the  rescheduled event or the exact string CANCELLED.  In this case the date
    		     and time must be in exactly the "date with local time" format  used  by  the
    		     text/calendar  MIME  type	(RFC 2445), <YYYY><MM><DD>T<hh><mm><ss> (note the
    		     presence of the literal character T).  The first word  (the  regular  recur‐
    		     rence)  may  be something other than a proper date/time to indicate that the
    		     event is additional to the normal sequence; a convention  that  retains  the
    		     formatting appearance is XXXXXXXXTXXXXXX.
    
    		     Furthermore, it is useful to record the next regular recurrence (as then the
    		     displayed date may be for a rescheduled event so cannot be used  for  calcu‐
    		     lating the regular sequence).  This is specified by RECURRENCE and a time or
    		     date in the same format.  calendar_add  adds  such  an  indication  when  it
    		     encounters  a  recurring event that does not include one, based on the head‐
    		     line date/time.
    
    		     If calendar_add is used to update	occurrences  the  UID  keyword	described
    		     there  should be present in both the existing entry and the added occurrence
    		     in order to identify recurring event sequences.
    
    		     For example,
    
    			    Thu May 6, 2010 11:00 Informal chat RPT 1 week
    			      # RECURRENCE 20100506T110000
    			      # OCCURRENCE 20100513T110000 20100513T120000
    			      # OCCURRENCE 20100520T110000 CANCELLED
    
    		     The event that occurs at 11:00 on 13th  May  2010	is  rescheduled  an  hour
    		     later.   The  event  that occurs a week later is cancelled.  The occurrences
    		     are given on a continuation line starting with a #  character  so	will  not
    		     usually be displayed as part of the event.  As elsewhere, no account of time
    		     zones is taken with the times. After the  next  event  occurs  the  headline
    		     date/time	will  be  `Thu May 13, 2010 12:00' while the RECURRENCE date/time
    		     will be `20100513T110000' (note that cancelled  and  moved  events  are  not
    		     taken  account  of  in  the  RECURRENCE, which records what the next regular
    		     recurrence is, but they are accounted for in the headline date/time).
    
    		     It is safe to run calendar -s to reschedule an existing event (if the calen‐
    		     dar file has changed, for example), and also to have it running in multiples
    		     instances of the shell since the calendar file is locked when in use.
    
    		     By default, expired events are moved to the "done" file; see the -d  option.
    		     Use -D to prevent this.
    
    	      -S showprog
    		     Explicitly  specify a programme to be used for showing events instead of the
    		     value of the show-prog style or the default calendar_show.
    
    	      -v     Verbose:  show more information about stages of processing.  This is  useful
    		     for  confirming  that  the function has successfully parsed the dates in the
    		     calendar file.
    
           calendar_add [ -BL ] event ...
    	      Adds a single event to the calendar in the appropriate  location.   The  event  can
    	      contain  multiple  lines,  as  described in the section Calendar File Format above.
    	      Using this function ensures that the calendar file  is  sorted  in  date	and  time
    	      order.   It  also  makes	special  arrangements  for  locking  the file while it is
    	      altered.	The old calendar is left in a file with the suffix .old.
    
    	      The option -B indicates that backing up the calendar file will be  handled  by  the
    	      caller  and  should not be performed by calendar_add.  The option -L indicates that
    	      calendar_add does not need to lock the calendar  file  as  it  is  already  locked.
    	      These options will not usually be needed by users.
    
    	      If  the  style  reformat-date  is  true, the date and time of the new entry will be
    	      rewritten into the standard date format:	see the descriptions of  this  style  and
    	      the style date-format.
    
    	      The  function  can  use  a  unique identifier stored with each event to ensure that
    	      updates to existing events are treated correctly.  The  entry  should  contain  the
    	      word  UID,  followed by whitespace, followed by a word consisting entirely of hexa‐
    	      decimal digits of arbitrary length (all digits are significant,  including  leading
    	      zeroes).	 As  the UID is not directly useful to the user, it is convenient to hide
    	      it on an indented continuation line starting with a #, for example:
    
    		     Aug 31, 2007 09:30  Celebrate the end of the holidays
    		       # UID 045B78A0
    
    	      The second line will not be shown by the calendar function.
    
    	      It is possible to specify the RPT keyword followed by CANCELLED instead of a  rela‐
    	      tive  time.  This causes any matched event or series of events to be cancelled (the
    	      original event does not have to be marked as recurring in order to be cancelled  by
    	      this  method).  A UID is required in order to match an existing event in the calen‐
    	      dar.
    
    	      calendar_add will attempt to manage recurrences and occurrences of repeating events
    	      as  described for event scheduling by calendar -s above.	To reschedule or cancel a
    	      single event calendar_add should be called with an entry that includes the  correct
    	      UID but does not include the RPT keyword as this is taken to mean the entry applies
    	      to a series of repeating events and hence replaces all existing information.   Each
    	      rescheduled  or  cancelled  occurrence must have an OCCURRENCE keyword in the entry
    	      passed to calendar_add which will be merged into the calendar file.   Any  existing
    	      reference  to  the  occurrence is replaced.  An occurrence that does not refer to a
    	      valid existing event is added as a one-off occurrence to the same calendar entry.
    
           calendar_edit
    	      This calls the user's editor to edit the calendar file.  If  there  are  arguments,
    	      they  are  taken	as the editor to use (the file name is appended to the commands);
    	      otherwise, the editor is given by the variable VISUAL, if set,  else  the  variable
    	      EDITOR.
    
    	      If  the  calendar scheduler was running, then after editing the file calendar -s is
    	      called to update it.
    
    	      This function locks out the calendar system during the edit.  Hence  it  should  be
    	      used  to	edit  the  calendar  file if there is any possibility of a calendar event
    	      occurring meanwhile.  Note this can lead to another shell with  calendar	functions
    	      enabled  hanging	waiting for a lock, so it is necessary to quit the editor as soon
    	      as possible.
    
           calendar_parse calendar-entry
    	      This is the internal function that analyses the parts of a calendar entry, which is
    	      passed  as  the only argument.  The function returns status 1 if the argument could
    	      not be parsed as a calendar entry and status 2 if the  wrong  number  of	arguments
    	      were  passed; it also sets the parameter reply to an empty associative array.  Oth‐
    	      erwise, it returns status 0 and sets elements of the  associative  array	reply  as
    	      follows:
    
    	      time   The time as a string of digits in the same units as $EPOCHSECONDS
    	      schedtime
    		     The  regularly  scheduled	time.  This may differ from the actual event time
    		     time if this is a recurring event and the next occurrence has been  resched‐
    		     uled.  Then time gives the actual time and schedtime the time of the regular
    		     recurrence before modification.
    	      text1  The text from the line not including the date and time  of  the  event,  but
    		     including any WARN or RPT keywords and values.
    	      warntime
    		     Any  warning time given by the WARN keyword as a string of digits containing
    		     the time at which to warn in the same units as $EPOCHSECONDS.  (Note this is
    		     an  absolute time, not the relative time passed down.)  Not set no WARN key‐
    		     word and value were matched.
    	      warnstr
    		     The raw string matched after the WARN keyword, else unset.
    	      rpttime
    		     Any recurrence time given by the RPT keyword as a string of digits  contain‐
    		     ing  the  time  of the recurrence in the same units as $EPOCHSECONDS.  (Note
    		     this is an absolute time.)  Not  set  if  no  RPT	keyword  and  value  were
    		     matched.
    	      schedrpttime
    		     The  next regularly scheduled occurrence of a recurring event before modifi‐
    		     cation.  This may differ from rpttime, which is the actual time of the event
    		     that may have been rescheduled from the regular time.
    	      rptstr The raw string matched after the RPT keyword, else unset.
    	      text2  The  text	from the line after removal of the date and any keywords and val‐
    		     ues.
    
           calendar_showdate [ -r ] [ -f fmt ] date-spec ...
    	      The given date-spec is interpreted and the corresponding date and time printed.  If
    	      the initial date-spec begins with a + or - it is treated as relative to the current
    	      time; date-specs after the first are treated as relative to the date calculated  so
    	      far and a leading + is optional in that case.  This allows one to use the system as
    	      a date calculator.  For example, calendar_showdate '+1 month, 1st Friday' shows the
    	      date of the first Friday of next month.
    
    	      With the option -r nothing is printed but the value of the date and time in seconds
    	      since the epoch is stored in the parameter REPLY.
    
    	      With the option -f fmt the given date/time conversion format is passed to strftime;
    	      see notes on the date-format style below.
    
    	      In  order  to  avoid  ambiguity with negative relative date specifications, options
    	      must occur in separate words; in other words, -r and -f should not be  combined  in
    	      the same word.
    
           calendar_sort
    	      Sorts  the calendar file into date and time order.    The old calendar is left in a
    	      file with the suffix .old.
    
       Glob qualifiers
           age    The function age can be autoloaded and use separately  from  the	calendar  system,
    	      although	it  uses the function calendar_scandate for date formatting.  It requires
    	      the zsh/stat builtin, but uses only the builtin zstat.
    
    	      age selects files having a given modification time for use  as  a  glob  qualifier.
    	      The  format  of  the  date  is  the same as that understood by the calendar system,
    	      described in the section FILE AND DATE FORMATS above.
    
    	      The function can take one or two arguments, which can be supplied  either  directly
    	      as command or arguments, or separately as shell parameters.
    
    		     print *(e:age 2006/10/04 2006/10/09:)
    
    	      The example above matches all files modified between the start of those dates.  The
    	      second argument may alternatively be a relative time introduced by a +:
    
    		     print *(e:age 2006/10/04 +5d:)
    
    	      The example above is equivalent to the previous example.
    
    	      In addition to the special use of days of the week, today and yesterday, times with
    	      no  date	may be specified; these apply to today.  Obviously such uses become prob‐
    	      lematic around midnight.
    
    		     print *(e-age 12:00 13:30-)
    
    	      The example above shows files modified between 12:00 and 13:00 today.
    
    		     print *(e:age 2006/10/04:)
    
    	      The example above matches all files modified on that date.  If the second  argument
    	      is omitted it is taken to be exactly 24 hours after the first argument (even if the
    	      first argument contains a time).
    
    		     print *(e-age 2006/10/04:10:15 2006/10/04:10:45-)
    
    	      The example above supplies times.  Note that whitespace within the  time	and  date
    	      specification  must  be  quoted to ensure age receives the correct arguments, hence
    	      the use of the additional colon to separate the date and time.
    
    		     AGEREF=2006/10/04:10:15
    		     AGEREF2=2006/10/04:10:45
    		     print *(+age)
    
    	      This shows the same example before using another form  of  argument  passing.   The
    	      dates  and  times  in the parameters AGEREF and AGEREF2 stay in effect until unset,
    	      but will be overridden if any argument is passed as an explicit  argument  to  age.
    	      Any explicit argument causes both parameters to be ignored.
    
    	      Instead of an explicit date and time, it's possible to use the modification time of
    	      a file as the date and time for either argument by introducing the file name with a
    	      colon:
    
    		     print *(e-age :file1-)
    
    	      matches  all  files  created  on	the same day (24 hours starting from midnight) as
    	      file1.
    
    		     print *(e-age :file1 :file2-)
    
    	      matches all files modified no earlier than file1 and no later than file2; precision
    	      here is to the nearest second.
    
           after
           before The functions after and before are simpler versions of age that take just one argu‐
    	      ment.  The argument is parsed similarly to an argument of age; if it is  not  given
    	      the  variable  AGEREF  is consulted.  As the names of the functions suggest, a file
    	      matches if its modification time is after or before the time  and  date  specified.
    	      If a time only is given the date is today.
    
    	      The two following examples are therefore equivalent:
    		     print *(e-after 12:00-)
    		     print *(e-after today:12:00-)
    
    STYLES
           The  zsh  style	mechanism using the zstyle command is describe in zshmodules(1).  This is
           the same mechanism used in the completion system.
    
           The styles below are all examined in the context :datetime:function:, for  example  :date‐
           time:calendar:.
    
           calendar-file
    	      The location of the main calendar.  The default is ~/calendar.
    
           date-format
    	      A  strftime format string (see strftime(3)) with the zsh extensions providing vari‐
    	      ous numbers with no leading zero or space if  the  number  is  a	single	digit  as
    	      described  for  the  %D{string}  prompt  format  in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT
    	      SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).
    
    	      This is used for outputting dates in calendar, both to support the  -v  option  and
    	      when adding recurring events back to the calendar file, and in calendar_showdate as
    	      the final output format.
    
    	      If the style is not set, the default used is similar the standard system format  as
    	      output  by  the  date command (also known as `ctime format'): `%a %b %d %H:%M:%S %Z
    	      %Y'.
    
           done-file
    	      The location of the file to which events	which  have  passed  are  appended.   The
    	      default  is the calendar file location with the suffix .done.  The style may be set
    	      to an empty string in which case a "done" file will not be maintained.
    
           reformat-date
    	      Boolean, used by calendar_add.  If it is true, the date and  time  of  new  entries
    	      added  to  the  calendar	will  be  reformatted  to  the	format given by the style
    	      date-format or its default.  Only the date and time of the event itself  is  refor‐
    	      matted;  any  subsidiary	dates  and times such as those associated with repeat and
    	      warning times are left alone.
    
           show-prog
    	      The programme run by calendar for showing events.  It will be passed the start time
    	      and  stop  time  of the events requested in seconds since the epoch followed by the
    	      event text.  Note that calendar -s uses a start time and stop  time  equal  to  one
    	      another to indicate alerts for specific events.
    
    	      The default is the function calendar_show.
    
           warn-time
    	      The time before an event at which a warning will be displayed, if the first line of
    	      the event does not include the text EVENT reltime.  The default is 5 minutes.
    
    UTILITY FUNCTIONS
           calendar_lockfiles
    	      Attempt to lock the files given in the argument.	To prevent problems with  network
    	      file  locking  this is done in an ad hoc fashion by attempting to create a symbolic
    	      link to the file with the name file.lockfile.  No other system level functions  are
    	      used  for  locking,  i.e. the file can be accessed and modified by any utility that
    	      does not use this mechanism.  In particular, the user is not prevented from editing
    	      the calendar file at the same time unless calendar_edit is used.
    
    	      Three  attempts are made to lock the file before giving up.  If the module zsh/zse‐
    	      lect is available, the  times  of  the  attempts	are  jittered  so  that  multiple
    	      instances of the calling function are unlikely to retry at the same time.
    
    	      The  files locked are appended to the array lockfiles, which should be local to the
    	      caller.
    
    	      If all files were successfully locked, status zero is returned, else status one.
    
    	      This function may be used as a general file locking function,  although  this  will
    	      only work if only this mechanism is used to lock files.
    
           calendar_read
    	      This is a backend used by various other functions to parse the calendar file, which
    	      is passed as the only argument.  The array calendar_entries is set to the  list  of
    	      events  in the file; no pruning is done except that ampersands are removed from the
    	      start of the line.  Each entry may contain multiple lines.
    
           calendar_scandate
    	      This is a generic function to parse dates and times that	may  be  used  separately
    	      from  the  calendar  system.   The  argument  is	a  date  or time specification as
    	      described in the section FILE AND DATE FORMATS above.  The parameter REPLY  is  set
    	      to  the  number  of seconds since the epoch corresponding to that date or time.  By
    	      default, the date and time may occur anywhere within the given argument.
    
    	      Returns status zero if the date and time were successfully parsed, else one.
    
    	      Options:
    	      -a     The date and time are anchored to the start of the argument; they	will  not
    		     be matched if there is preceding text.
    
    	      -A     The  date	and  time are anchored to both the start and end of the argument;
    		     they will not be matched if the is any other text in the argument.
    
    	      -d     Enable additional debugging output.
    
    	      -m     Minus.  When -R anchor_time is also given the relative  time  is  calculated
    		     backwards from anchor_time.
    
    	      -r     The argument passed is to be parsed as a relative time.
    
    	      -R anchor_time
    		     The  argument  passed is to be parsed as a relative time.	The time is rela‐
    		     tive to anchor_time, a time in seconds since the  epoch,  and  the  returned
    		     value  is	the  absolute  time corresponding to advancing anchor_time by the
    		     relative time given.  This allows lengths of months to  be  correctly  taken
    		     into  account.  If the final day does not exist in the given month, the last
    		     day of the final month is given.  For example, if the anchor time is  during
    		     31st  January  2007  and the relative time is 1 month, the final time is the
    		     same time of day during 28th February 2007.
    
    	      -s     In addition to setting REPLY, set REPLY2 to the remainder	of  the  argument
    		     after  the date and time have been stripped.  This is empty if the option -A
    		     was given.
    
    	      -t     Allow a time with no date specification.  The date is assumed to  be  today.
    		     The  behaviour  is  unspecified  if  the  iron tongue of midnight is tolling
    		     twelve.
    
           calendar_show
    	      The function used by default to display events.  It accepts a start  time  and  end
    	      time for events, both in epoch seconds, and an event description.
    
    	      The  event  is  always  printed  to standard output.  If the command line editor is
    	      active (which will usually be the case) the command line will be redisplayed  after
    	      the output.
    
    	      If  the parameter DISPLAY is set and the start and end times are the same (indicat‐
    	      ing a scheduled event), the function uses the command xmessage to display a  window
    	      with the event details.
    
    BUGS
           As  the	system	is  based  entirely  on  shell	functions (with a little support from the
           zsh/datetime module) the mechanisms used are not as robust as those provided  by  a  dedi‐
           cated  calendar	utility.   Consequently  the  user should not rely on the shell for vital
           alerts.
    
           There is no calendar_delete function.
    
           There is no localization support for dates and times, nor any support for the use of  time
           zones.
    
           Relative periods of months and years do not take into account the variable number of days.
    
           The calendar_show function is currently hardwired to use xmessage for displaying alerts on
           X Window System displays.  This should be configurable and ideally integrate  better  with
           the desktop.
    
           calendar_lockfiles  hangs  the shell while waiting for a lock on a file.  If called from a
           scheduled task, it should instead reschedule the event that caused it.
    
    ZSHTCPSYS(1)			     General Commands Manual			     ZSHTCPSYS(1)
    
    NAME
           zshtcpsys - zsh tcp system
    
    DESCRIPTION
           A module zsh/net/tcp is provided to provide network I/O over TCP/IP from within the shell;
           see  its  description in zshmodules(1).	This manual page describes a function suite based
           on the module.  If the module is installed, the functions are  usually  installed  at  the
           same  time,  in	which case they will be available for autoloading in the default function
           search path.  In addition to the zsh/net/tcp module, the zsh/zselect  module  is  used  to
           implement  timeouts on read operations.	For troubleshooting tips, consult the correspond‐
           ing advice for the zftp functions described in zshzftpsys(1).
    
           There are functions corresponding to the basic I/O operations open, close, read and  send,
           named  tcp_open	etc., as well as a function tcp_expect for pattern match analysis of data
           read as input.  The system makes it easy to receive data from and send  data  to  multiple
           named  sessions	at  once.   In addition, it can be linked with the shell's line editor in
           such a way that input data is automatically  shown  at  the  terminal.	Other  facilities
           available including logging, filtering and configurable output prompts.
    
           To use the system where it is available, it should be enough to `autoload -U tcp_open' and
           run tcp_open as documented below to start a session.  The tcp_open function will  autoload
           the remaining functions.
    
    TCP USER FUNCTIONS
       Basic I/O
           tcp_open [ -qz ] host port [ sess ]
           tcp_open [ -qz ] [ -s sess | -l sess[,...] ] ...
           tcp_open [ -qz ] [ -a fd | -f fd ] [ sess ]
    	      Open  a new session.  In the first and simplest form, open a TCP connection to host
    	      host at port port; numeric and symbolic forms are understood for both.
    
    	      If sess is given, this becomes the name of the session which can be used	to  refer
    	      to  multiple  different  TCP  connections.  If sess is not given, the function will
    	      invent a numeric name value (note this is not the same as the  file  descriptor  to
    	      which  the  session is attached).  It is recommended that session names not include
    	      `funny' characters, where funny characters are not well-defined  but  certainly  do
    	      not include alphanumerics or underscores, and certainly do include whitespace.
    
    	      In  the second case, one or more sessions to be opened are given by name.  A single
    	      session name is given after -s and a comma-separated list after  -l;  both  options
    	      may  be  repeated as many times as necessary.  A failure to open any session causes
    	      tcp_open to abort.  The host and port are read from the file .ztcp_sessions in  the
    	      same directory as the user's zsh initialisation files, i.e. usually the home direc‐
    	      tory, but $ZDOTDIR if that is set.  The file consists of lines each giving  a  ses‐
    	      sion name and the corresponding host and port, in that order (note the session name
    	      comes first, not last), separated by whitespace.
    
    	      The third form allows passive and fake TCP connections.  If the option -a is  used,
    	      its  argument is a file descriptor open for listening for connections.  No function
    	      front-end is provided to open such a file descriptor, but a call to `ztcp -l  port'
    	      will  create one with the file descriptor stored in the parameter $REPLY.  The lis‐
    	      tening port can be closed with `ztcp -c fd'.  A call to `tcp_open -a fd' will block
    	      until a remote TCP connection is made to port on the local machine.  At this point,
    	      a session is created in the usual way and  is  largely  indistinguishable  from  an
    	      active connection created with one of the first two forms.
    
    	      If  the option -f is used, its argument is a file descriptor which is used directly
    	      as if it were a TCP session.  How well the remainder of  the  TCP  function  system
    	      copes with this depends on what actually underlies this file descriptor.	A regular
    	      file is likely to be unusable; a FIFO (pipe) of some sort  will  work  better,  but
    	      note  that it is not a good idea for two different sessions to attempt to read from
    	      the same FIFO at once.
    
    	      If the option -q is given with any of the three  forms,  tcp_open  will  not  print
    	      informational  messages, although it will in any case exit with an appropriate sta‐
    	      tus.
    
    	      If the line editor (zle) is in use, which is typically the case  if  the	shell  is
    	      interactive,  tcp_open  installs a handler inside zle which will check for new data
    	      at the same time as it checks for keyboard input.  This is convenient as the  shell
    	      consumes	no CPU time while waiting; the test is performed by the operating system.
    	      Giving the option -z to any of the forms of  tcp_open  prevents  the  handler  from
    	      being  installed, so data must be read explicitly.  Note, however, this is not nec‐
    	      essary for executing complete sets of send and read commands from  a  function,  as
    	      zle  is  not  active at this point.  Generally speaking, the handler is only active
    	      when the shell is waiting for input at a command prompt or in  the  vared  builtin.
    	      The option has no effect if zle is not active; `[[ -o zle]]' will test for this.
    
    	      The  first session to be opened becomes the current session and subsequent calls to
    	      tcp_open do not change  it.   The  current  session  is  stored  in  the	parameter
    	      $TCP_SESS; see below for more detail about the parameters used by the system.
    
    	      The  function tcp_on_open, if defined, is called when a session is opened.  See the
    	      description below.
    
           tcp_close [ -qn ] [ -a | -l sess[,...] | sess ... ]
    	      Close the named sessions, or the current session if none is given, or all open ses‐
    	      sions  if -a is given.  The options -l and -s are both handled for consistency with
    	      tcp_open, although the latter is redundant.
    
    	      If the session being closed is the current one, $TCP_SESS is unset, leaving no cur‐
    	      rent session, even if there are other sessions still open.
    
    	      If  the  session was opened with tcp_open -f, the file descriptor is closed so long
    	      as it is in the range 0 to 9 accessible directly from the  command  line.   If  the
    	      option -n is given, no attempt will be made to close file descriptors in this case.
    	      The -n option is not used for genuine ztcp session; the file descriptors are always
    	      closed with the session.
    
    	      If the option -q is given, no informational messages will be printed.
    
           tcp_read [ -bdq ] [ -t TO ] [ -T TO ]
    		[ -a | -u fd[,...] | -l sess[,...] | -s sess ... ]
    	      Perform  a  read	operation on the current session, or on a list of sessions if any
    	      are given with -u, -l or -s, or all open sessions if the option -a is  given.   Any
    	      of the -u, -l or -s options may be repeated or mixed together.  The -u option spec‐
    	      ifies a file descriptor directly (only those managed by this  system  are  useful),
    	      the other two specify sessions as described for tcp_open above.
    
    	      The  function checks for new data available on all the sessions listed.  Unless the
    	      -b option is given, it will not block waiting for new data.  Any one line  of  data
    	      from any of the available sessions will be read, stored in the parameter $TCP_LINE,
    	      and displayed to standard output unless $TCP_SILENT contains  a  non-empty  string.
    	      When  printed  to standard output the string $TCP_PROMPT will be shown at the start
    	      of the line; the default form for this includes the name of the session being read.
    	      See  below for more information on these parameters.  In this mode, tcp_read can be
    	      called repeatedly until it returns status 2 which indicates all pending input  from
    	      all specified sessions has been handled.
    
    	      With  the  option  -b,  equivalent  to an infinite timeout, the function will block
    	      until a line is available to read from one of  the  specified  sessions.	 However,
    	      only a single line is returned.
    
    	      The  option  -d  indicates  that all pending input should be drained.  In this case
    	      tcp_read may process multiple lines in the manner given above;  only  the  last  is
    	      stored  in $TCP_LINE, but the complete set is stored in the array $tcp_lines.  This
    	      is cleared at the start of each call to tcp_read.
    
    	      The options -t and -T specify a timeout in seconds, which may be a  floating  point
    	      number  for  increased  accuracy.   With -t the timeout is applied before each line
    	      read.  With -T, the timeout applies to the overall  operation,  possibly	including
    	      multiple read operations if the option -d is present; without this option, there is
    	      no distinction between -t and -T.
    
    	      The function does not print informational messages, but if the option -q is  given,
    	      no error message is printed for a non-existent session.
    
    	      A  return  status  of 2 indicates a timeout or no data to read.  Any other non-zero
    	      return status indicates some error condition.
    
    	      See tcp_log for how to control where data is sent by tcp_read.
    
           tcp_send [ -cnq ] [ -s sess | -l sess[,...] ] data ...
           tcp_send [ -cnq ] -a data ...
    	      Send the supplied data strings to all the specified sessions in turn.  The underly‐
    	      ing  operation  differs  little from a `print -r' to the session's file descriptor,
    	      although it attempts to prevent the shell from dying owing to a SIGPIPE  caused  by
    	      an attempt to write to a defunct session.
    
    	      The  option  -c  causes  tcp_send to behave like cat.  It reads lines from standard
    	      input until end of input and sends them in turn to the specified session(s) exactly
    	      as if they were given as data arguments to individual tcp_send commands.
    
    	      The  option  -n  prevents  tcp_send  from  putting a newline at the end of the data
    	      strings.
    
    	      The remaining options all behave as for tcp_read.
    
    	      The data arguments are  not  further  processed  once  they  have  been  passed  to
    	      tcp_send; they are simply passed down to print -r.
    
    	      If  the parameter $TCP_OUTPUT is a non-empty string and logging is enabled then the
    	      data sent to each session will be echoed to the log  file(s)  with  $TCP_OUTPUT  in
    	      front where appropriate, much in the manner of $TCP_PROMPT.
    
       Session Management
           tcp_alias [ -q ] alias=sess ...
           tcp_alias [ -q ] [ alias ... ]
           tcp_alias -d [ -q ] alias ...
    	      This function is not particularly well tested.
    
    	      The first form creates an alias for a session name; alias can then be used to refer
    	      to the existing session sess.  As many aliases may be listed as required.
    
    	      The second form lists any aliases specified, or all aliases if none.
    
    	      The third form deletes all the aliases listed.  The  underlying  sessions  are  not
    	      affected.
    
    	      The option -q suppresses an inconsistently chosen subset of error messages.
    
           tcp_log [ -asc ] [ -n | -N ] [ logfile ]
    	      With  an	argument  logfile,  all  future input from tcp_read will be logged to the
    	      named file.  Unless -a (append) is given, this file will first be truncated or cre‐
    	      ated empty.  With no arguments, show the current status of logging.
    
    	      With  the option -s, per-session logging is enabled.  Input from tcp_read is output
    	      to the file logfile.sess.  As the session is  automatically  discriminated  by  the
    	      filename,  the contents are raw (no $TCP_PROMPT).  The option  -a applies as above.
    	      Per-session logging and logging of all data in one file are not mutually exclusive.
    
    	      The option -c closes all logging, both complete and per-session logs.
    
    	      The options -n and -N respectively turn off or  restore  output  of  data  read  by
    	      tcp_read to standard output; hence `tcp_log -cn' turns off all output by tcp_read.
    
    	      The  function  is purely a convenient front end to setting the parameters $TCP_LOG,
    	      $TCP_LOG_SESS, $TCP_SILENT, which are described below.
    
           tcp_rename old new
    	      Rename session old to session new.  The old name becomes invalid.
    
           tcp_sess [ sess [ command [ arg ... ] ] ]
    	      With no arguments, list all the open sessions and associated file descriptors.  The
    	      current  session is marked with a star.  For use in functions, direct access to the
    	      parameters $tcp_by_name, $tcp_by_fd and $TCP_SESS is probably more convenient;  see
    	      below.
    
    	      With  a  sess  argument,	set  the  current session to sess.  This is equivalent to
    	      changing $TCP_SESS directly.
    
    	      With additional arguments, temporarily set  the  current	session  while	executing
    	      `command	arg  ...'.  command is re-evaluated so as to expand aliases etc., but the
    	      remaining args are passed through as that appear to tcp_sess.  The original session
    	      is restored when tcp_sess exits.
    
       Advanced I/O
           tcp_command send-option ... send-argument ...
    	      This  is a convenient front-end to tcp_send.  All arguments are passed to tcp_send,
    	      then the function pauses waiting for data.  While data is arriving at  least  every
    	      $TCP_TIMEOUT  (default  0.3)  seconds, data is handled and printed out according to
    	      the current settings.  Status 0 is always returned.
    
    	      This is generally only useful for interactive use, to prevent the display  becoming
    	      fragmented  by output returned from the connection.  Within a programme or function
    	      it is generally better to handle reading data by a more explicit method.
    
           tcp_expect [ -q ] [ -p var | -P var ] [ -t TO | -T TO ]
    		  [ -a | -s sess | -l sess[,...] ] pattern ...
    	      Wait for input matching any of the given patterns from any of  the  specified  ses‐
    	      sions.   Input is ignored until an input line matches one of the given patterns; at
    	      this point status zero is returned, the matching line is stored in  $TCP_LINE,  and
    	      the  full  set  of  lines read during the call to tcp_expect is stored in the array
    	      $tcp_expect_lines.
    
    	      Sessions are specified in the same way as tcp_read: the default is to use the  cur‐
    	      rent session, otherwise the sessions specified by -a, -s, or -l are used.
    
    	      Each  pattern is a standard zsh extended-globbing pattern; note that it needs to be
    	      quoted to avoid it being expanded immediately  by  filename  generation.	 It  must
    	      match  the  full line, so to match a substring there must be a `*' at the start and
    	      end.  The line matched against includes the $TCP_PROMPT added by tcp_read.   It  is
    	      possible	to  include the globbing flags `#b' or `#m' in the patterns to make back‐
    	      references available in the parameters $MATCH, $match, etc., as  described  in  the
    	      base zsh documentation on pattern matching.
    
    	      Unlike tcp_read, the default behaviour of tcp_expect is to block indefinitely until
    	      the required input is found.  This can be modified by specifying a timeout with  -t
    	      or  -T;  these  function	as in tcp_read, specifying a per-read or overall timeout,
    	      respectively, in seconds, as an integer or floating-point number.  As tcp_read, the
    	      function returns status 2 if a timeout occurs.
    
    	      The function returns as soon as any one of the patterns given match.  If the caller
    	      needs to know which of the patterns matched, the option -p  var  can  be	used;  on
    	      return,  $var is set to the number of the pattern using ordinary zsh indexing, i.e.
    	      the first is 1, and so on.  Note the absence of a `$' in front of  var.	To  avoid
    	      clashes,	the parameter cannot begin with `_expect'.  The index -1 is used if there
    	      is a timeout and 0 if there is no match.
    
    	      The option -P var works similarly to -p, but instead of numerical indexes the regu‐
    	      lar  arguments  must  begin  with a prefix followed by a colon: that prefix is then
    	      used as a tag to which var is set when the argument matches.  The  tag  timeout  is
    	      used  if	there is a timeout and the empty string if there is no match.  Note it is
    	      acceptable for different arguments to start with the same prefix if the matches  do
    	      not need to be distinguished.
    
    	      The option -q is passed directly down to tcp_read.
    
    	      As  all  input is done via tcp_read, all the usual rules about output of lines read
    	      apply.  One exception is that the parameter $tcp_lines will only reflect	the  line
    	      actually	matched  by  tcp_expect;  use $tcp_expect_lines for the full set of lines
    	      read during the function call.
    
           tcp_proxy
    	      This is a simple-minded function to accept a TCP connection and execute  a  command
    	      with I/O redirected to the connection.  Extreme caution should be taken as there is
    	      no security whatsoever and this can leave your computer open to  the  world.   Ide‐
    	      ally, it should only be used behind a firewall.
    
    	      The first argument is a TCP port on which the function will listen.
    
    	      The  remaining  arguments give a command and its arguments to execute with standard
    	      input, standard output and standard error redirected  to	the  file  descriptor  on
    	      which  the  TCP  session	has  been accepted.  If no command is given, a new zsh is
    	      started.	This gives everyone on your network direct access to your account,  which
    	      in many cases will be a bad thing.
    
    	      The command is run in the background, so tcp_proxy can then accept new connections.
    	      It continues to accept new connections until interrupted.
    
           tcp_spam [ -ertv ] [ -a | -s sess | -l sess[,...] ] cmd [ arg ... ]
    	      Execute `cmd [ arg ... ]' for each session in turn.  Note this executes the command
    	      and  arguments;  it does not send the command line as data unless the -t (transmit)
    	      option is given.
    
    	      The sessions may be selected explicitly with the standard -a, -s or -l options,  or
    	      may  be  chosen  implicitly.   If none of the three options is given the rules are:
    	      first, if the array $tcp_spam_list is set, this is taken as the list  of	sessions,
    	      otherwise  all  sessions	are  taken.   Second,  any  sessions  given  in the array
    	      $tcp_no_spam_list are removed from the list of sessions.
    
    	      Normally, any sessions added by the `-a' flag  or  when  all  sessions  are  chosen
    	      implicitly  are  spammed	in alphabetic order; sessions given by the $tcp_spam_list
    	      array or on the command line are spammed in the order given.  The -r flag  reverses
    	      the order however it was arrived it.
    
    	      The  -v flag specifies that a $TCP_PROMPT will be output before each session.  This
    	      is output after any modification to TCP_SESS by the user-defined tcp_on_spam  func‐
    	      tion  described  below.	(Obviously that function is able to generate its own out‐
    	      put.)
    
    	      If the option -e is present, the line given as `cmd [ arg ... ]' is executed  using
    	      eval, otherwise it is executed without any further processing.
    
           tcp_talk
    	      This  is	a  fairly  simple-minded  attempt to force input to the line editor to go
    	      straight to the default TCP_SESS.
    
    	      An escape string, $TCP_TALK_ESCAPE, default `:', is used to allow access to  normal
    	      shell operation.	If it is on its own at the start of the line, or followed only by
    	      whitespace, the line editor returns to normal operation.	Otherwise, the string and
    	      any  following  whitespace  are  skipped	and the remainder of the line executed as
    	      shell input without any change of the line editor's operating mode.
    
    	      The current implementation is somewhat deficient in terms of  use  of  the  command
    	      history.	 For  this reason, many users will prefer to use some form of alternative
    	      approach for sending data easily to the current session.	One simple approach is to
    	      alias some special character (such as `%') to `tcp_command --'.
    
           tcp_wait
    	      The sole argument is an integer or floating point number which gives the seconds to
    	      delay.  The shell will do nothing for that period except wait for input on all  TCP
    	      sessions	by  calling tcp_read -a.  This is similar to the interactive behaviour at
    	      the command prompt when zle handlers are installed.
    
       `One-shot' file transfer
           tcp_point port
           tcp_shoot host port
    	      This pair of functions provide a simple way to transfer a file  between  two  hosts
    	      within  the  shell.  Note, however, that bulk data transfer is currently done using
    	      cat.  tcp_point reads any data arriving at port and sends it  to	standard  output;
    	      tcp_shoot  connects  to port on host and sends its standard input.  Any unused port
    	      may be used; the standard mechanism for picking a port is  to  think  of	a  random
    	      four-digit number above 1024 until one works.
    
    	      To transfer a file from host woodcock to host springes, on springes:
    
    		     tcp_point 8091 >output_file
    
    	      and on woodcock:
    
    		     tcp_shoot springes 8091 <input_file
    
    	      As  these  two  functions do not require tcp_open to set up a TCP connection first,
    	      they may need to be autoloaded separately.
    
    TCP USER-DEFINED FUNCTIONS
           Certain functions, if defined by the user, will be called by the function system  in  cer‐
           tain contexts.  This facility depends on the module zsh/parameter, which is usually avail‐
           able in interactive shells as the completion system depends on it.  None of the	functions
           need be defined; they simply provide convenient hooks when necessary.
    
           Typically, these are called after the requested action has been taken, so that the various
           parameters will reflect the new state.
    
           tcp_on_alias alias fd
    	      When an alias is defined, this function will be called with two arguments: the name
    	      of the alias, and the file descriptor of the corresponding session.
    
           tcp_on_awol sess fd
    	      If  the  function tcp_fd_handler is handling input from the line editor and detects
    	      that the file descriptor is no longer reusable, by default it removes it	from  the
    	      list of file descriptors handled by this method and prints a message.  If the func‐
    	      tion tcp_on_awol is defined it is called immediately before  this  point.   It  may
    	      return  status  100,  which indicates that the normal handling should still be per‐
    	      formed; any other return status indicates that no further action	should	be  taken
    	      and  the tcp_fd_handler should return immediately with the given status.	Typically
    	      the action of tcp_on_awol will be to close the session.
    
    	      The variable TCP_INVALIDATE_ZLE will be a non-empty string if it	is  necessary  to
    	      invalidate  the  line editor display using `zle -I' before printing output from the
    	      function.
    
    	      (`AWOL' is military jargon for `absent without leave' or some variation.	It has no
    	      pre-existing technical meaning known to the author.)
    
           tcp_on_close sess fd
    	      This  is	called	with  the  name of a session being closed and the file descriptor
    	      which corresponded to that session.  Both will be invalid by the time the  function
    	      is called.
    
           tcp_on_open sess fd
    	      This  is called after a new session has been defined with the session name and file
    	      descriptor as arguments.	If it returns a non-zero status, opening the  session  is
    	      assumed to fail and the session is closed again; however, tcp_open will continue to
    	      attempt to open any remaining sessions given on the command line.
    
           tcp_on_rename oldsess fd newsess
    	      This is called after a session has been renamed with the three arguments	old  ses‐
    	      sion name, file descriptor, new session name.
    
           tcp_on_spam sess command ...
    	      This is called once for each session spammed, just before a command is executed for
    	      a session by tcp_spam.  The arguments are the session name followed by the  command
    	      list  to be executed.  If tcp_spam was called with the option -t, the first command
    	      will be tcp_send.
    
    	      This function is called after $TCP_SESS  is  set	to  reflect  the  session  to  be
    	      spammed, but before any use of it is made.  Hence it is possible to alter the value
    	      of $TCP_SESS within this function.  For example, the session arguments to  tcp_spam
    	      could include extra information to be stripped off and processed in tcp_on_spam.
    
    	      If  the  function sets the parameter $REPLY to `done', the command line is not exe‐
    	      cuted; in addition, no prompt is printed for the -v option to tcp_spam.
    
           tcp_on_unalias alias fd
    	      This is called with the name of an  alias  and  the  corresponding  session's  file
    	      descriptor after an alias has been deleted.
    
    TCP UTILITY FUNCTIONS
           The  following  functions are used by the TCP function system but will rarely if ever need
           to be called directly.
    
           tcp_fd_handler
    	      This is the function installed by tcp_open for handling input from within the  line
    	      editor,  if  that is required.  It is in the format documented for the builtin `zle
    	      -F' in zshzle(1) .
    
    	      While active, the function sets the parameter TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE to 1.  This allows
    	      shell  code  called  internally (for example, by setting tcp_on_read) to tell if is
    	      being called when the shell is otherwise idle at the editor prompt.
    
           tcp_output [ -q ] -P prompt -F fd -S sess
    	      This function is used for both logging and handling output to standard output, from
    	      within tcp_read and (if $TCP_OUTPUT is set) tcp_send.
    
    	      The prompt to use is specified by -P; the default is the empty string.  It can con‐
    	      tain:
    	      %c     Expands to 1 if the session is the current session, otherwise 0.  Used  with
    		     ternary expressions such as `%(c.-.+)' to output `+' for the current session
    		     and `-' otherwise.
    
    	      %f     Replaced by the session's file descriptor.
    
    	      %s     Replaced by the session name.
    
    	      %%     Replaced by a single `%'.
    
    	      The option -q suppresses output to standard output, but not to any log files  which
    	      are configured.
    
    	      The  -S and -F options are used to pass in the session name and file descriptor for
    	      possible replacement in the prompt.
    
    TCP USER PARAMETERS
           Parameters follow the usual convention that uppercase is used for  scalars  and	integers,
           while lowercase is used for normal and associative array.  It is always safe for user code
           to read these parameters.  Some parameters may also be set; these  are  noted  explicitly.
           Others  are  included  in this group as they are set by the function system for the user's
           benefit, i.e. setting them is typically not useful but is benign.
    
           It is often also useful to make settable parameters local to  a	function.   For  example,
           `local TCP_SILENT=1' specifies that data read during the function call will not be printed
           to standard output, regardless of the setting  outside  the  function.	Likewise,  `local
           TCP_SESS=sess'  sets  a	session  for  the duration of a function, and `local TCP_PROMPT='
           specifies that no prompt is used for input during the function.
    
           tcp_expect_lines
    	      Array.  The set of lines read during the last call  to  tcp_expect,  including  the
    	      last ($TCP_LINE).
    
           tcp_filter
    	      Array.  May be set directly.  A set of extended globbing patterns which, if matched
    	      in tcp_output, will cause the line not to be printed to standard output.	The  pat‐
    	      terns  should  be  defined as described for the arguments to tcp_expect.	Output of
    	      line to log files is not affected.
    
           TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE
    	      Scalar.  Set to 1 within tcp_fd_handler to indicate to functions called recursively
    	      that they have been called during an editor session.  Otherwise unset.
    
           TCP_LINE
    	      The last line read by tcp_read, and hence also tcp_expect.
    
           TCP_LINE_FD
    	      The file descriptor from which $TCP_LINE was read.  ${tcp_by_fd[$TCP_LINE_FD]} will
    	      give the corresponding session name.
    
           tcp_lines
    	      Array. The set of lines read during the last call to tcp_read, including	the  last
    	      ($TCP_LINE).
    
           TCP_LOG
    	      May be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.  The name of a file
    	      to which output from all sessions will be sent.  The output  is  proceeded  by  the
    	      usual  $TCP_PROMPT.   If it is not an absolute path name, it will follow the user's
    	      current directory.
    
           TCP_LOG_SESS
    	      May be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.  The prefix  for	a
    	      set  of  files  to which output from each session separately will be sent; the full
    	      filename is ${TCP_LOG_SESS}.sess.  Output to each file is raw; no prompt is  added.
    	      If it is not an absolute path name, it will follow the user's current directory.
    
           tcp_no_spam_list
    	      Array.  May be set directly.  See tcp_spam for how this is used.
    
           TCP_OUTPUT
    	      May be set directly.  If a non-empty string, any data sent to a session by tcp_send
    	      will be logged.  This parameter gives the prompt to be used in a file specified  by
    	      $TCP_LOG but not in a file generated from $TCP_LOG_SESS.	The prompt string has the
    	      same format as TCP_PROMPT and the same rules for its use apply.
    
           TCP_PROMPT
    	      May be set directly.  Used as the prefix for data read by tcp_read which is printed
    	      to standard output or to the log file given by $TCP_LOG, if any.	Any `%s', `%f' or
    	      `%%' occurring in the string will be replaced by the name of the session, the  ses‐
    	      sion's  underlying  file descriptor, or a single `%', respectively.  The expression
    	      `%c' expands to 1 if the session being read is the current session, else 0; this is
    	      most useful in ternary expressions such as `%(c.-.+)' which outputs `+' if the ses‐
    	      sion is the current one, else `-'.
    
    	      If the prompt starts with %P, this is stripped and the complete result of the  pre‐
    	      vious  stage is passed through standard prompt %-style formatting before being out‐
    	      put.
    
           TCP_READ_DEBUG
    	      May be set directly.  If this has non-zero length, tcp_read will give some  limited
    	      diagnostics about data being read.
    
           TCP_SECONDS_START
    	      This value is created and initialised to zero by tcp_open.
    
    	      The  functions  tcp_read and tcp_expect use the shell's SECONDS parameter for their
    	      own timing purposes.  If that parameter is not of floating point type on	entry  to
    	      one  of  the  functions, it will create a local parameter SECONDS which is floating
    	      point and set the parameter TCP_SECONDS_START to the previous  value  of	$SECONDS.
    	      If  the  parameter is already floating point, it is used without a local copy being
    	      created and TCP_SECONDS_START is not set.  As the global value is zero,  the  shell
    	      elapsed time is guaranteed to be the sum of $SECONDS and $TCP_SECONDS_START.
    
    	      This  can  be  avoided  by setting SECONDS globally to a floating point value using
    	      `typeset -F SECONDS'; then the TCP functions will never make a local copy and never
    	      set TCP_SECONDS_START to a non-zero value.
    
           TCP_SESS
    	      May be set directly.  The current session; must refer to one of the sessions estab‐
    	      lished by tcp_open.
    
           TCP_SILENT
    	      May be set directly, although it is also controlled by  tcp_log.	 If  of  non-zero
    	      length,  data  read  by tcp_read will not be written to standard output, though may
    	      still be written to a log file.
    
           tcp_spam_list
    	      Array.  May be set directly.  See the description of the function tcp_spam for  how
    	      this is used.
    
           TCP_TALK_ESCAPE
    	      May  be set directly.  See the description of the function tcp_talk for how this is
    	      used.
    
           TCP_TIMEOUT
    	      May be set directly.  Currently this is only used by the function tcp_command,  see
    	      above.
    
    TCP USER-DEFINED PARAMETERS
           The  following parameters are not set by the function system, but have a special effect if
           set by the user.
    
           tcp_on_read
    	      This should be an associative array; if it is  not,  the	behaviour  is  undefined.
    	      Each  key  is  the name of a shell function or other command, and the corresponding
    	      value is a shell pattern (using EXTENDED_GLOB).  Every line read from a TCP session
    	      directly	or indirectly using tcp_read (which includes lines read by tcp_expect) is
    	      compared against the pattern.  If the line matches, the command given in the key is
    	      called  with  two  arguments: the name of the session from which the line was read,
    	      and the line itself.
    
    	      If any function called to handle a line returns a non-zero status, the line is  not
    	      output.	Thus a tcp_on_read handler containing only the instruction `return 1' can
    	      be used to suppress output of particular lines (see,  however,  tcp_filter  above).
    	      However,	the line is still stored in TCP_LINE and tcp_lines; this occurs after all
    	      tcp_on_read processing.
    
    TCP UTILITY PARAMETERS
           These parameters are controlled by the function system; they may  be  read  directly,  but
           should not usually be set by user code.
    
           tcp_aliases
    	      Associative  array.   The keys are the names of sessions established with tcp_open;
    	      each value is a space-separated list of aliases which refer to that session.
    
           tcp_by_fd
    	      Associative array.  The keys are session file descriptors; each value is	the  name
    	      of that session.
    
           tcp_by_name
    	      Associative  array.   The  keys  are  the names of sessions; each value is the file
    	      descriptor associated with that session.
    
    TCP EXAMPLES
           Here is a trivial example using a remote calculator.
    
           To create a calculator server on port 7337 (see the dc manual page for quite how infuriat‐
           ing the underlying command is):
    
    	      tcp_proxy 7337 dc
    
           To connect to this from the same host with a session also named `dc':
    
    	      tcp_open localhost 7337 dc
    
           To  send a command to the remote session and wait a short while for output (assuming dc is
           the current session):
    
    	      tcp_command 2 4 + p
    
           To close the session:
    
    	      tcp_close
    
           The tcp_proxy needs to be killed to be stopped.	Note this will not usually kill any  con‐
           nections  which	have  already  been  accepted,	and also that the port is not immediately
           available for reuse.
    
           The following chunk of code puts a list of sessions into an xterm header, with the current
           session followed by a star.
    
    	      print -n "\033]2;TCP:" ${(k)tcp_by_name:/$TCP_SESS/$TCP_SESS\*} "\a"
    
    TCP BUGS
           The function tcp_read uses the shell's normal read builtin.  As this reads a complete line
           at once, data arriving without a terminating newline  can  cause  the  function	to  block
           indefinitely.
    
           Though  the  function  suite works well for interactive use and for data arriving in small
           amounts, the performance when large amounts of data are being exchanged is  likely  to  be
           extremely poor.
    
    ZSHZFTPSYS(1)			     General Commands Manual			    ZSHZFTPSYS(1)
    
    NAME
           zshzftpsys - zftp function front-end
    
    DESCRIPTION
           This  describes	the  set  of  shell functions supplied with the source distribution as an
           interface to the zftp builtin command, allowing you to perform  FTP  operations	from  the
           shell  command  line or within functions or scripts.  The interface is similar to a tradi‐
           tional FTP client (e.g. the ftp command itself, see ftp(1)), but as it  is  entirely  done
           within  the  shell  all the familiar completion, editing and globbing features, and so on,
           are present, and macros are particularly simple to write as they are just  ordinary  shell
           functions.
    
           The  prerequisite is that the zftp command, as described in zshmodules(1) , must be avail‐
           able in the version of zsh installed at your site.  If the shell is configured to load new
           commands  at  run time, it probably is: typing `zmodload zsh/zftp' will make sure (if that
           runs silently, it has worked).  If this is not the case, it is possible	zftp  was  linked
           into  the  shell anyway: to test this, type `which zftp' and if zftp is available you will
           get the message `zftp: shell built-in command'.
    
           Commands given directly with zftp builtin may be interspersed  between  the  functions  in
           this  suite;  in a few cases, using zftp directly may cause some of the status information
           stored in shell parameters to become invalid.  Note in particular the description  of  the
           variables $ZFTP_TMOUT, $ZFTP_PREFS and $ZFTP_VERBOSE for zftp.
    
    INSTALLATION
           You  should  make  sure	all the functions from the Functions/Zftp directory of the source
           distribution are available; they all begin with the two letters `zf'.   They  may  already
           have  been  installed on your system; otherwise, you will need to find them and copy them.
           The directory should appear as one of the  elements  of	the  $fpath  array  (this  should
           already	be  the  case if they were installed), and at least the function zfinit should be
           autoloaded; it will autoload the rest.  Finally, to initialize the use of the  system  you
           need  to  call  the  zfinit  function.  The following code in your .zshrc will arrange for
           this; assume the functions are stored in the directory ~/myfns:
    
    	      fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
    	      autoload -U zfinit
    	      zfinit
    
           Note that zfinit assumes you are using the zmodload method to load the zftp  command.   If
           it is already built into the shell, change zfinit to zfinit -n.	It is helpful (though not
           essential) if the call to zfinit appears after any code to initialize the  new  completion
           system, else unnecessary compctl commands will be given.
    
    FUNCTIONS
           The  sequence  of operations in performing a file transfer is essentially the same as that
           in a standard FTP client.  Note that, due to a quirk of the shell's getopts  builtin,  for
           those  functions  that  handle  options	you  must  use `--' rather than `-' to ensure the
           remaining arguments are treated literally (a single `-' is treated as an argument).
    
       Opening a connection
           zfparams [ host [ user [ password ... ] ] ]
    	      Set or show the parameters for a future zfopen with no arguments.  If no	arguments
    	      are  given,  the	current parameters are displayed (the password will be shown as a
    	      line of asterisks).  If a host is given, and either the user or  password  is  not,
    	      they  will  be prompted for; also, any parameter given as `?' will be prompted for,
    	      and if the `?' is followed by a string, that will be used as the prompt.	As zfopen
    	      calls zfparams to store the parameters, this usually need not be called directly.
    
    	      A  single argument `-' will delete the stored parameters.  This will also cause the
    	      memory of the last directory (and so on) on the other host to be deleted.
    
           zfopen [ -1 ] [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
    	      If host is present, open a connection to that host under username user  with  pass‐
    	      word  password  (and, on the rare occasions when it is necessary, account account).
    	      If a necessary parameter is missing or given as `?' it will be  prompted	for.   If
    	      host is not present, use a previously stored set of parameters.
    
    	      If  the  command	was  successful,  and the terminal is compatible with xterm or is
    	      sun-cmd, a summary will appear in the title bar, giving  the  local  host:directory
    	      and  the	remote	host:directory;  this  is  handled  by	the  function zftp_chpwd,
    	      described below.
    
    	      Normally, the host, user and password are internally recorded for later re-opening,
    	      either  by  a  zfopen  with  no  arguments, or automatically (see below).  With the
    	      option `-1', no information is stored.  Also, if an  open  command  with	arguments
    	      failed,  the parameters will not be retained (and any previous parameters will also
    	      be deleted).  A zfopen on its own, or a zfopen -1, never alters the stored  parame‐
    	      ters.
    
    	      Both   zfopen   and   zfanon  (but  not  zfparams)  understand  URLs  of	the  form
    	      ftp://host/path... as meaning to connect to the host, then change directory to path
    	      (which must be a directory, not a file).	The `ftp://' can be omitted; the trailing
    	      `/' is enough to trigger recognition of the path.  Note prefixes other than  `ftp:'
    	      are  not	recognized, and that all characters after the first slash beyond host are
    	      significant in path.
    
           zfanon [ -1 ] host
    	      Open a connection host for anonymous FTP.  The username used is  `anonymous'.   The
    	      password (which will be reported the first time) is generated as user@host; this is
    	      then stored in the shell parameter $EMAIL_ADDR which can alternatively be set manu‐
    	      ally to a suitable string.
    
       Directory management
           zfcd [ dir ]
           zfcd -
           zfcd old new
    	      Change  the  current  directory  on the remote server:  this is implemented to have
    	      many of the features of the shell builtin cd.
    
    	      In the first form with dir present, change to the directory dir.	The command `zfcd
    	      ..'  is  treated specially, so is guaranteed to work on non-UNIX servers (note this
    	      is handled internally by zftp).  If dir is omitted, has the effect of `zfcd ~'.
    
    	      The second form changes to the directory previously current.
    
    	      The third form attempts to change the current  directory	by  replacing  the  first
    	      occurrence of the string old with the string new in the current directory.
    
    	      Note  that  in this command, and indeed anywhere a remote filename is expected, the
    	      string which on the local host corresponds to `~' is converted back to a `~' before
    	      being  passed  to the remote machine.  This is convenient because of the way expan‐
    	      sion is performed on the command line before zfcd receives a string.  For  example,
    	      suppose  the  command  is  `zfcd ~/foo'.	The shell will expand this to a full path
    	      such as `zfcd /home/user2/pws/foo'.  At this stage,  zfcd  recognises  the  initial
    	      path  as	corresponding  to  `~'	and will send the directory to the remote host as
    	      ~/foo, so that the `~' will be expanded by the server to the  correct  remote  host
    	      directory.   Other  named  directories  of the form `~name' are not treated in this
    	      fashion.
    
           zfhere Change directory on the remote server to the one corresponding to the current local
    	      directory,  with	special  handling of `~' as in zfcd.  For example, if the current
    	      local directory is ~/foo/bar, then zfhere performs the effect of `zfcd ~/foo/bar'.
    
           zfdir [ -rfd ] [ - ] [ dir-options ] [ dir ]
    	      Produce a long directory listing.  The arguments dir-options  and  dir  are  passed
    	      directly to the server and their effect is implementation dependent, but specifying
    	      a particular remote directory dir  is  usually  possible.   The  output  is  passed
    	      through  a pager given by the environment variable $PAGER, or `more' if that is not
    	      set.
    
    	      The directory is usually cached for re-use.  In fact, two  caches  are  maintained.
    	      One is for use when there is no dir-options or dir, i.e. a full listing of the cur‐
    	      rent remote directory; it is flushed when the  current  remote  directory  changes.
    	      The  other  is kept for repeated use of zfdir with the same arguments; for example,
    	      repeated use of `zfdir /pub/gnu' will only require the directory to be retrieved on
    	      the first call.  Alternatively, this cache can be re-viewed with the -r option.  As
    	      relative directories will confuse zfdir, the -f option can be  used  to  force  the
    	      cache to be flushed before the directory is listed.  The option -d will delete both
    	      caches without showing a directory listing; it will also delete the cache  of  file
    	      names in the current remote directory, if any.
    
           zfls [ ls-options ] [ dir ]
    	      List  files  on  the  remote server.  With no arguments, this will produce a simple
    	      list of file names for the current remote  directory.   Any  arguments  are  passed
    	      directly to the server.  No pager and no caching is used.
    
       Status commands
           zftype [ type ]
    	      With  no	arguments,  show  the  type  of  data to be transferred, usually ASCII or
    	      binary.  With an argument, change the type: the types `A' or `ASCII' for ASCII data
    	      and  `B'	or  `BINARY', `I' or `IMAGE' for binary data are understood case-insensi‐
    	      tively.
    
           zfstat [ -v ]
    	      Show the status of the current or last connection, as well as the status of some of
    	      zftp's status variables.	With the -v option, a more verbose listing is produced by
    	      querying the server for its version of events, too.
    
       Retrieving files
           The commands for retrieving files all take at least  two  options.  -G  suppresses  remote
           filename  expansion  which  would  otherwise  be  performed (see below for a more detailed
           description of that).  -t attempts to set the modification time of the local file to  that
           of  the	remote	file: see the description of the function zfrtime below for more informa‐
           tion.
    
           zfget [ -Gtc ] file1 ...
    	      Retrieve all the listed files file1 ... one at a time from the remote server.  If a
    	      file  contains a `/', the full name is passed to the remote server, but the file is
    	      stored locally under the name given by the part after the final `/'.  The option -c
    	      (cat)  forces  all  files to be sent as a single stream to standard output; in this
    	      case the -t option has no effect.
    
           zfuget [ -Gvst ] file1 ...
    	      As zfget, but only retrieve files where the version on the remote server	is  newer
    	      (has  a  later  modification time), or where the local file does not exist.  If the
    	      remote file is older but the files have different sizes, or if the  sizes  are  the
    	      same  but  the  remote  file  is newer, the user will usually be queried.  With the
    	      option -s, the command runs silently and will always retrieve the file in either of
    	      those two cases.	With the option -v, the command prints more information about the
    	      files while it is working out whether or not to transfer them.
    
           zfcget [ -Gt ] file1 ...
    	      As zfget, but if any of the local files exists, and is shorter than the correspond‐
    	      ing remote file, the command assumes that it is the result of a partially completed
    	      transfer and attempts to transfer the rest of the file.  This is useful on  a  poor
    	      connection which keeps failing.
    
    	      Note  that  this	requires a commonly implemented, but non-standard, version of the
    	      FTP protocol, so is not guaranteed to work on all servers.
    
           zfgcp [ -Gt ] remote-file local-file
           zfgcp [ -Gt ] rfile1 ... ldir
    	      This retrieves files from the remote server with arguments  behaving  similarly  to
    	      the cp command.
    
    	      In the first form, copy remote-file from the server to the local file local-file.
    
    	      In  the  second form, copy all the remote files rfile1 ... into the local directory
    	      ldir retaining the same basenames.  This assumes UNIX directory semantics.
    
       Sending files
           zfput [ -r ] file1 ...
    	      Send all the file1 ... given separately to the remote server.  If a  filename  con‐
    	      tains a `/', the full filename is used locally to find the file, but only the base‐
    	      name is used for the remote file name.
    
    	      With the option -r, if any of the files are directories they are	sent  recursively
    	      with  all  their subdirectories, including files beginning with `.'.  This requires
    	      that the remote machine understand UNIX file semantics, since  `/'  is  used  as	a
    	      directory separator.
    
           zfuput [ -vs ] file1 ...
    	      As  zfput, but only send files which are newer than their remote equivalents, or if
    	      the remote file does not exist.  The logic is the same as for zfuget, but  reversed
    	      between local and remote files.
    
           zfcput file1 ...
    	      As  zfput,  but  if  any	remote	file already exists and is shorter than the local
    	      equivalent, assume it is the result of an incomplete transfer and send the rest  of
    	      the  file to append to the existing part.  As the FTP append command is part of the
    	      standard set, this is in principle more likely to work than zfcget.
    
           zfpcp local-file remote-file
           zfpcp lfile1 ... rdir
    	      This sends files to the remote server with arguments behaving similarly to  the  cp
    	      command.
    
    	      With two arguments, copy local-file to the server as remote-file.
    
    	      With more than two arguments, copy all the local files lfile1 ... into the existing
    	      remote directory rdir retaining the same basenames.  This  assumes  UNIX	directory
    	      semantics.
    
    	      A  problem  arises if you attempt to use zfpcp lfile1 rdir, i.e. the second form of
    	      copying but with two arguments, as the command has no simple way of knowing if rdir
    	      corresponds  to  a directory or a filename.  It attempts to resolve this in various
    	      ways.  First, if the rdir argument is `.' or `..' or ends in a slash, it is assumed
    	      to  be  a directory.  Secondly, if the operation of copying to a remote file in the
    	      first form failed, and the remote server sends back the expected failure	code  553
    	      and  a reply including the string `Is a directory', then zfpcp will retry using the
    	      second form.
    
       Closing the connection
           zfclose
    	      Close the connection.
    
       Session management
           zfsession [ -lvod ] [ sessname ]
    	      Allows you to manage multiple FTP sessions at once.  By default,	connections  take
    	      place in a session called `default'; by giving the command `zfsession sessname' you
    	      can change to a new or existing session with a name of your choice.  The	new  ses‐
    	      sion remembers its own connection, as well as associated shell parameters, and also
    	      the host/user parameters set by zfparams.  Hence you can	have  different  sessions
    	      set  up  to connect to different hosts, each remembering the appropriate host, user
    	      and password.
    
    	      With no arguments, zfsession prints the name  of	the  current  session;	with  the
    	      option  -l  it  lists all sessions which currently exist, and with the option -v it
    	      gives a verbose list showing the host and directory for  each  session,  where  the
    	      current  session	is  marked with an asterisk.  With -o, it will switch to the most
    	      recent previous session.
    
    	      With -d, the given session (or else the current one) is removed; everything  to  do
    	      with  it is completely forgotten.  If it was the only session, a new session called
    	      `default' is created and made current.  It is safest not to delete  sessions  while
    	      background commands using zftp are active.
    
           zftransfer sess1:file1 sess2:file2
    	      Transfer	files between two sessions; no local copy is made.  The file is read from
    	      the session sess1 as file1 and written to session sess2 as file  file2;  file1  and
    	      file2  may  be relative to the current directories of the session.  Either sess1 or
    	      sess2 may be omitted (though the colon should be retained if there is a possibility
    	      of  a  colon appearing in the file name) and defaults to the current session; file2
    	      may be omitted or may end with a slash, in which case the basename of file1 will be
    	      added.  The sessions sess1 and sess2 must be distinct.
    
    	      The  operation  is  performed  using  pipes, so it is required that the connections
    	      still be valid in a subshell, which is not the case under versions of some  operat‐
    	      ing systems, presumably due to a system bug.
    
       Bookmarks
           The  two  functions  zfmark and zfgoto allow you to `bookmark' the present location (host,
           user and directory) of the current FTP connection for later use.  The file to be used  for
           storing	and  retrieving bookmarks is given by the parameter $ZFTP_BMFILE; if not set when
           one of the two functions is called, it will be set to the file .zfbkmarks in the directory
           where your zsh startup files live (usually ~).
    
           zfmark [ bookmark ]
    	      If  given  an  argument,	mark  the current host, user and directory under the name
    	      bookmark for later use by zfgoto.  If there is no connection open, use  the  values
    	      for  the	last connection immediately before it was closed; it is an error if there
    	      was none.  Any existing bookmark under the same name will be silently replaced.
    
    	      If not given an argument, list the existing bookmarks and the points to which  they
    	      refer in the form user@host:directory; this is the format in which they are stored,
    	      and the file may be edited directly.
    
           zfgoto [ -n ] bookmark
    	      Return to the location given by bookmark, as previously  set  by	zfmark.   If  the
    	      location has user `ftp' or `anonymous', open the connection with zfanon, so that no
    	      password is required.  If the user and host parameters match those stored  for  the
    	      current  session,  if  any,  those will be used, and again no password is required.
    	      Otherwise a password will be prompted for.
    
    	      With the option -n, the bookmark is taken to be a nickname stored by the ncftp pro‐
    	      gram in its bookmark file, which is assumed to be ~/.ncftp/bookmarks.  The function
    	      works identically in other ways.	Note that there is no  mechanism  for  adding  or
    	      modifying ncftp bookmarks from the zftp functions.
    
       Other functions
           Mostly, these functions will not be called directly (apart from zfinit), but are described
           here for completeness.  You may wish to alter zftp_chpwd and zftp_progress, in particular.
    
           zfinit [ -n ]
    	      As described above, this is used to initialize the zftp function	system.   The  -n
    	      option should be used if the zftp command is already built into the shell.
    
           zfautocheck [ -dn ]
    	      This function is called to implement automatic reopening behaviour, as described in
    	      more detail below.  The options must appear in the first argument; -n prevents  the
    	      command  from  changing to the old directory, while -d prevents it from setting the
    	      variable do_close, which it otherwise does as a flag for automatically closing  the
    	      connection  after  a  transfer.	The  host  and directory for the last session are
    	      stored in the variable $zflastsession, but the internal host/user/password  parame‐
    	      ters must also be correctly set.
    
           zfcd_match prefix suffix
    	      This  performs  matching	for  completion of remote directory names.  If the remote
    	      server is UNIX, it will attempt to persuade the server to list the remote directory
    	      with  subdirectories  marked,  which usually works but is not guaranteed.  On other
    	      hosts it simply calls zfget_match and hence completes all files, not just  directo‐
    	      ries.  On some systems, directories may not even look like filenames.
    
           zfget_match prefix suffix
    	      This performs matching for completion of remote filenames.  It caches files for the
    	      current directory (only) in the shell parameter $zftp_fcache.  It is in the form to
    	      be  called  by  the  -K  option  of compctl, but also works when called from a wid‐
    	      get-style completion function with prefix and suffix set appropriately.
    
           zfrglob varname
    	      Perform remote globbing, as describes in more detail below.  varname is the name of
    	      a  variable  containing  the pattern to be expanded; if there were any matches, the
    	      same variable will be set to the expanded set of filenames on return.
    
           zfrtime lfile rfile [ time ]
    	      Set the local file lfile to have the same modification  time  as	the  remote  file
    	      rfile, or the explicit time time in FTP format CCYYMMDDhhmmSS for the GMT timezone.
    	      This uses the shell's zsh/datetime module to perform the	conversion  from  GMT  to
    	      local time.
    
           zftp_chpwd
    	      This function is called every time a connection is opened, or closed, or the remote
    	      directory changes.  This version alters the title bar  of  an  xterm-compatible  or
    	      sun-cmd  terminal  emulator  to  reflect the local and remote hostnames and current
    	      directories.  It works best when combined with the function chpwd.  In  particular,
    	      a function of the form
    
    		     chpwd() {
    		       if [[ -n $ZFTP_USER ]]; then
    			 zftp_chpwd
    		       else
    			 # usual chpwd e.g put host:directory in title bar
    		       fi
    		     }
    
    	      fits in well.
    
           zftp_progress
    	      This  function shows the status of the transfer.	It will not write anything unless
    	      the output is going to a terminal; however, if you  transfer  files  in  the  back‐
    	      ground,  you  should  turn  off  progress  reports  by hand using `zstyle ':zftp:*'
    	      progress none'.  Note also that if you alter it, any output  must  be  to  standard
    	      error,  as  standard output may be a file being received.  The form of the progress
    	      meter, or whether it is used at all, can be configured without altering  the  func‐
    	      tion, as described in the next section.
    
           zffcache
    	      This  is	used to implement caching of files in the current directory for each ses‐
    	      sion separately.	It is used by zfget_match and zfrglob.
    
    MISCELLANEOUS FEATURES
       Configuration
           Various styles are available using the standard shell style mechanism, described  in  zsh‐
           modules(1). Briefly, the command `zstyle ':zftp:*' style value ...'.  defines the style to
           have value value; more than one value may be given, although that is  not  useful  in  the
           cases described here.  These values will then be used throughout the zftp function system.
           For more precise control, the first argument, which gives a context  in	which  the  style
           applies,  can  be modified to include a particular function, as for example `:zftp:zfget':
           the style will then have the given value only in the zfget function.  Values for the  same
           style  in  different  contexts  may be set; the most specific function will be used, where
           strings are held to be more specific than patterns, and longer patterns and  shorter  pat‐
           terns.	Note that only the top level function name, as called by the user, is used; call‐
           ing of lower level functions is transparent to the user.  Hence modifications to the title
           bar  in zftp_chpwd use the contexts :zftp:zfopen, :zftp:zfcd, etc., depending where it was
           called from.  The following styles are understood:
    
           progress
    	      Controls the way that zftp_progress reports on the  progress  of	a  transfer.   If
    	      empty,  unset,  or  `none',  no  progress report is made; if `bar' a growing bar of
    	      inverse video is shown; if `percent' (or any other string, though this  may  change
    	      in  future),  the  percentage  of  the  file  transferred  is shown.  The bar meter
    	      requires that the width of the terminal be available  via  the  $COLUMNS	parameter
    	      (normally this is set automatically).  If the size of the file being transferred is
    	      not available, bar and percent meters will simply show the number of  bytes  trans‐
    	      ferred so far.
    
    	      When  zfinit  is run, if this style is not defined for the context :zftp:*, it will
    	      be set to `bar'.
    
           update Specifies the minimum time interval between updates of the progress meter  in  sec‐
    	      onds.   No  update  is  made  unless new data has been received, so the actual time
    	      interval is limited only by $ZFTP_TIMEOUT.
    
    	      As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to 1.
    
           remote-glob
    	      If set to `1', `yes' or `true', filename generation (globbing) is performed on  the
    	      remote machine instead of by zsh itself; see below.
    
           titlebar
    	      If  set  to  `1',  `yes'	or `true', zftp_chpwd will put the remote host and remote
    	      directory into the titlebar of terminal emulators such as  xterm	or  sun-cmd  that
    	      allow this.
    
    	      As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to 1.
    
           chpwd  If  set to `1' `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will call the function chpwd when a con‐
    	      nection is closed.  This is useful if the remote host details  were  put	into  the
    	      terminal title bar by zftp_chpwd and your usual chpwd also modifies the title bar.
    
    	      When  zfinit  is	run, it will determine whether chpwd exists and if so it will set
    	      the default value for the style to 1 if none exists already.
    
           Note that there is also an associative array zfconfig which contains values  used  by  the
           function system.  This should not be modified or overwritten.
    
       Remote globbing
           The  commands for retrieving files usually perform filename generation (globbing) on their
           arguments; this can be turned off by passing the option -G to each of the commands.   Nor‐
           mally  this operates by retrieving a complete list of files for the directory in question,
           then matching these locally against the pattern supplied.  This has the advantage that the
           full  range  of	zsh  patterns (respecting the setting of the option EXTENDED_GLOB) can be
           used.  However, it means that the directory part of a filename will not	be  expanded  and
           must  be  given	exactly.  If the remote server does not support the UNIX directory seman‐
           tics, directory handling is problematic and it is recommended that globbing only  be  used
           within  the  current directory.	The list of files in the current directory, if retrieved,
           will be cached, so that subsequent globs in the same directory without an intervening zfcd
           are much faster.
    
           If  the	remote-glob style (see above) is set, globbing is instead performed on the remote
           host: the server is asked for a list of matching files.	This is highly dependent  on  how
           the  server  is	implemented, though typically UNIX servers will provide support for basic
           glob patterns.  This may in some cases be faster, as it avoids retrieving the entire  list
           of directory contents.
    
       Automatic and temporary reopening
           As  described  for  the zfopen command, a subsequent zfopen with no parameters will reopen
           the connection to the last host (this includes connections made with the zfanon	command).
           Opened  in  this  fashion,  the connection starts in the default remote directory and will
           remain open until explicitly closed.
    
           Automatic re-opening is also available.	If a connection is not currently open and a  com‐
           mand requiring a connection is given, the last connection is implicitly reopened.  In this
           case the directory which was current when the connection was closed again becomes the cur‐
           rent  directory	(unless,  of  course, the command given changes it).  Automatic reopening
           will also take place if the connection was close by the remote server for whatever  reason
           (e.g. a timeout).  It is not available if the -1 option to zfopen or zfanon was used.
    
           Furthermore, if the command issued is a file transfer, the connection will be closed after
           the transfer is finished, hence providing a one-shot mode for transfers.   This	does  not
           apply  to directory changing or listing commands; for example a zfdir may reopen a connec‐
           tion but will leave it open.  Also, automatic closure will only ever happen  in	the  same
           command	as  automatic  opening, i.e a zfdir directly followed by a zfget will never close
           the connection automatically.
    
           Information about the previous connection is given by the zfstat function.  So, for  exam‐
           ple, if that reports:
    
    	      Session:	      default
    	      Not connected.
    	      Last session:   ftp.bar.com:/pub/textfiles
    
           then  the  command  zfget  file.txt  will  attempt  to reopen a connection to ftp.bar.com,
           retrieve the file /pub/textfiles/file.txt, and immediately close the connection again.  On
           the other hand, zfcd ..	will open the connection in the directory /pub and leave it open.
    
           Note that all the above is local to each session; if you return to a previous session, the
           connection for that session is the one which will be reopened.
    
       Completion
           Completion of local and remote files, directories, sessions and	bookmarks  is  supported.
           The  older, compctl-style completion is defined when zfinit is called; support for the new
           widget-based completion system is provided in the  function  Completion/Zsh/Command/_zftp,
           which  should  be  installed  with  the other functions of the completion system and hence
           should automatically be available.
    
    ZSHCONTRIB(1)			     General Commands Manual			    ZSHCONTRIB(1)
    
    NAME
           zshcontrib - user contributions to zsh
    
    DESCRIPTION
           The Zsh source distribution includes a number of items contributed by the user  community.
           These  are  not inherently a part of the shell, and some may not be available in every zsh
           installation.  The most significant of these are documented here.   For	documentation  on
           other  contributed items such as shell functions, look for comments in the function source
           files.
    
    UTILITIES
       Accessing On-Line Help
           The key sequence ESC h is normally bound by ZLE to execute the run-help widget  (see  zsh‐
           zle(1)).   This	invokes the run-help command with the command word from the current input
           line as its argument.  By default, run-help is an alias for the man command, so this often
           fails  when the command word is a shell builtin or a user-defined function.  By redefining
           the run-help alias, one can improve the on-line help provided by the shell.
    
           The helpfiles utility, found in the Util directory of the distribution, is a Perl  program
           that  can be used to process the zsh manual to produce a separate help file for each shell
           builtin and for many other shell features as well.  The	autoloadable  run-help	function,
           found  in Functions/Misc, searches for these helpfiles and performs several other tests to
           produce the most complete help possible for the command.
    
           Help  files  are  installed  by	default  to   a   subdirectory	 of   /usr/share/zsh   or
           /usr/local/share/zsh.
    
           To create your own help files with helpfiles, choose or create a directory where the indi‐
           vidual command help files will reside.  For example, you might choose ~/zsh_help.  If  you
           unpacked the zsh distribution in your home directory, you would use the commands:
    
    	      mkdir ~/zsh_help
    	      perl ~/zsh-5.1.1/Util/helpfiles ~/zsh_help
    
           The HELPDIR parameter tells run-help where to look for the help files. When unset, it uses
           the default installation path.  To use your own set of help files, set this to the  appro‐
           priate path in one of your startup files:
    
    	      HELPDIR=~/zsh_help
    
           To  use	the run-help function, you need to add lines something like the following to your
           .zshrc or equivalent startup file:
    
    	      unalias run-help
    	      autoload run-help
    
           Note that in order for `autoload run-help' to work, the run-help file must be  in  one  of
           the  directories  named in your fpath array (see zshparam(1)).  This should already be the
           case if you have a standard zsh installation; if it is not,  copy  Functions/Misc/run-help
           to an appropriate directory.
    
       Recompiling Functions
           If you frequently edit your zsh functions, or periodically update your zsh installation to
           track the latest developments, you may find that function digests compiled with the  zcom‐
           pile  builtin  are frequently out of date with respect to the function source files.  This
           is not usually a problem, because zsh always looks for the  newest  file  when  loading	a
           function,  but  it may cause slower shell startup and function loading.	Also, if a digest
           file is explicitly used as an element of fpath, zsh won't check whether any of its  source
           files has changed.
    
           The  zrecompile	autoloadable function, found in Functions/Misc, can be used to keep func‐
           tion digests up to date.
    
           zrecompile [ -qt ] [ name ... ]
           zrecompile [ -qt ] -p arg ... [ -- arg ... ]
    	      This tries to find *.zwc files and automatically re-compile them if at least one of
    	      the  original  files is newer than the compiled file.  This works only if the names
    	      stored in the compiled files are full paths or are relative to the  directory  that
    	      contains the .zwc file.
    
    	      In the first form, each name is the name of a compiled file or a directory contain‐
    	      ing *.zwc files that should be checked.  If no arguments are given, the directories
    	      and *.zwc files in fpath are used.
    
    	      When  -t	is given, no compilation is performed, but a return status of zero (true)
    	      is set if there are files that need to be re-compiled and non-zero  (false)  other‐
    	      wise.   The  -q  option  quiets the chatty output that describes what zrecompile is
    	      doing.
    
    	      Without the -t option, the return status is zero if all files that needed re-compi‐
    	      lation  could be compiled and non-zero if compilation for at least one of the files
    	      failed.
    
    	      If the -p option is given, the args are interpreted as one or more  sets	of  argu‐
    	      ments for zcompile, separated by `--'.  For example:
    
    		     zrecompile -p \
    				-R ~/.zshrc -- \
    				-M ~/.zcompdump -- \
    				~/zsh/comp.zwc ~/zsh/Completion/*/_*
    
    	      This  compiles  ~/.zshrc	into ~/.zshrc.zwc if that doesn't exist or if it is older
    	      than ~/.zshrc. The compiled file will be marked for reading instead of mapping. The
    	      same  is	done  for  ~/.zcompdump  and  ~/.zcompdump.zwc, but this compiled file is
    	      marked for mapping. The last line re-creates the file ~/zsh/comp.zwc if any of  the
    	      files matching the given pattern is newer than it.
    
    	      Without  the  -p	option,  zrecompile  does not create function digests that do not
    	      already exist, nor does it add new functions to the digest.
    
           The following shell loop is an example of a method for creating function digests  for  all
           functions in your fpath, assuming that you have write permission to the directories:
    
    	      for ((i=1; i <= $#fpath; ++i)); do
    		dir=$fpath[i]
    		zwc=${dir:t}.zwc
    		if [[ $dir == (.|..) || $dir == (.|..)/* ]]; then
    		  continue
    		fi
    		files=($dir/*(N-.))
    		if [[ -w $dir:h && -n $files ]]; then
    		  files=(${${(M)files%/*/*}#/})
    		  if ( cd $dir:h &&
    		       zrecompile -p -U -z $zwc $files ); then
    		    fpath[i]=$fpath[i].zwc
    		  fi
    		fi
    	      done
    
           The -U and -z options are appropriate for functions in the default zsh installation fpath;
           you may need to use different options for your personal function directories.
    
           Once the digests have been created and your fpath modified to refer to them, you can  keep
           them up to date by running zrecompile with no arguments.
    
       Keyboard Definition
           The  large  number  of possible combinations of keyboards, workstations, terminals, emula‐
           tors, and window systems makes it impossible for zsh to have  built-in  key  bindings  for
           every  situation.   The zkbd utility, found in Functions/Misc, can help you quickly create
           key bindings for your configuration.
    
           Run zkbd either as an autoloaded function, or as a shell script:
    
    	      zsh -f ~/zsh-5.1.1/Functions/Misc/zkbd
    
           When you run zkbd, it first asks you to enter your terminal type; if the default it offers
           is  correct,  just  press return.  It then asks you to press a number of different keys to
           determine characteristics of your keyboard and terminal; zkbd warns you if it  finds  any‐
           thing out of the ordinary, such as a Delete key that sends neither ^H nor ^?.
    
           The  keystrokes	read  by zkbd are recorded as a definition for an associative array named
           key, written to a file in the subdirectory .zkbd within either your HOME or ZDOTDIR direc‐
           tory.   The  name  of  the  file  is composed from the TERM, VENDOR and OSTYPE parameters,
           joined by hyphens.
    
           You may read this file into your .zshrc or another startup file with the `source'  or  `.'
           commands, then reference the key parameter in bindkey commands, like this:
    
    	      source ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.zkbd/$TERM-$VENDOR-$OSTYPE
    	      [[ -n ${key[Left]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Left]}" backward-char
    	      [[ -n ${key[Right]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Right]}" forward-char
    	      # etc.
    
           Note that in order for `autoload zkbd' to work, the zkdb file must be in one of the direc‐
           tories named in your fpath array (see zshparam(1)).  This should already be  the  case  if
           you  have a standard zsh installation; if it is not, copy Functions/Misc/zkbd to an appro‐
           priate directory.
    
       Dumping Shell State
           Occasionally you may encounter what appears to be a bug in the shell, particularly if  you
           are  using  a  beta  version of zsh or a development release.  Usually it is sufficient to
           send a description of the problem to one of the zsh mailing lists (see zsh(1)), but  some‐
           times  one  of the zsh developers will need to recreate your environment in order to track
           the problem down.
    
           The script named reporter, found in the Util directory of the  distribution,  is  provided
           for  this  purpose.   (It  is  also  possible  to  autoload  reporter, but reporter is not
           installed in fpath by default.)	This script outputs a detailed dump of the  shell  state,
           in the form of another script that can be read with `zsh -f' to recreate that state.
    
           To  use	reporter,  read  the script into your shell with the `.' command and redirect the
           output into a file:
    
    	      . ~/zsh-5.1.1/Util/reporter > zsh.report
    
           You should check the zsh.report file for any sensitive information such as  passwords  and
           delete  them by hand before sending the script to the developers.  Also, as the output can
           be voluminous, it's best to wait for the developers to ask  for	this  information  before
           sending it.
    
           You  can  also  use  reporter to dump only a subset of the shell state.	This is sometimes
           useful for creating startup files for the first time.  Most of the output from reporter is
           far  more detailed than usually is necessary for a startup file, but the aliases, options,
           and zstyles states may be useful because they include only changes from the defaults.  The
           bindings state may be useful if you have created any of your own keymaps, because reporter
           arranges to dump the keymap creation commands as well as the bindings for every keymap.
    
           As is usual with automated tools, if you create a startup file with reporter,  you  should
           edit  the  results to remove unnecessary commands.  Note that if you're using the new com‐
           pletion system, you should not dump  the  functions  state  to  your  startup  files  with
           reporter; use the compdump function instead (see zshcompsys(1)).
    
           reporter [ state ... ]
    	      Print  to  standard  output  the	indicated subset of the current shell state.  The
    	      state arguments may be one or more of:
    
    	      all    Output everything listed below.
    	      aliases
    		     Output alias definitions.
    	      bindings
    		     Output ZLE key maps and bindings.
    	      completion
    		     Output old-style compctl commands.  New completion is covered  by	functions
    		     and zstyles.
    	      functions
    		     Output autoloads and function definitions.
    	      limits Output limit commands.
    	      options
    		     Output setopt commands.
    	      styles Same as zstyles.
    	      variables
    		     Output shell parameter assignments, plus export commands for any environment
    		     variables.
    	      zstyles
    		     Output zstyle commands.
    
    	      If the state is omitted, all is assumed.
    
           With the exception of `all', every state can be abbreviated by any prefix, even	a  single
           letter; thus a is the same as aliases, z is the same as zstyles, etc.
    
       Manipulating Hook Functions
           add-zsh-hook [ -dD ] [ -Uzk ] hook function
    	      Several  functions  are  special	to the shell, as described in the section SPECIAL
    	      FUNCTIONS, see zshmisc(1), in that they are automatic called at  a  specific  point
    	      during  shell execution.	Each has an associated array consisting of names of func‐
    	      tions to be called at the same point; these are so-called  `hook	functions'.   The
    	      shell  function  add-zsh-hook provides a simple way of adding or removing functions
    	      from the array.
    
    	      hook is one  of  chpwd,  periodic,  precmd,  preexec,  zshaddhistory,  zshexit,  or
    	      zsh_directory_name,  the	special  functions  in	question.   Note  that zsh_direc‐
    	      tory_name is called in a different way from the other functions, but may	still  be
    	      manipulated as a hook.
    
    	      function	is name of an ordinary shell function.	If no options are given this will
    	      be added to the array of functions to be executed in the given context.
    
    	      If the option -d is given, the function is removed from the array of  functions  to
    	      be executed.
    
    	      If  the  option  -D is given, the function is treated as a pattern and any matching
    	      names of functions are removed from the array of functions to be executed.
    
    	      The options -U, -z and -k are passed as arguments to autoload  for  function.   For
    	      functions contributed with zsh, the options -Uz are appropriate.
    
    REMEMBERING RECENT DIRECTORIES
           The  function  cdr allows you to change the working directory to a previous working direc‐
           tory from a list maintained automatically.  It is similar  in  concept  to  the	directory
           stack controlled by the pushd, popd and dirs builtins, but is more configurable, and as it
           stores all entries in files it is maintained across sessions and (by default) between ter‐
           minal emulators in the current session.	Duplicates are automatically removed, so that the
           list reflects the single most recent use of each directory.
    
           Note that the pushd directory stack is not actually modified or used  by  cdr  unless  you
           configure it to do so as described in the configuration section below.
    
       Installation
           The  system  works  by  means  of  a hook function that is called every time the directory
           changes.  To install the system, autoload the required functions and use the  add-zsh-hook
           function described above:
    
    	      autoload -Uz chpwd_recent_dirs cdr add-zsh-hook
    	      add-zsh-hook chpwd chpwd_recent_dirs
    
           Now  every  time  you  change directly interactively, no matter which command you use, the
           directory to which you change will be remembered in most-recent-first order.
    
       Use
           All direct user interaction is via the cdr function.
    
           The argument to cdr is a number N corresponding to the Nth most recently changed-to direc‐
           tory.   1  is the immediately preceding directory; the current directory is remembered but
           is not offered as a destination.  Note that if you have multiple windows open 1 may  refer
           to  a  directory  changed  to in another window; you can avoid this by having per-terminal
           files for storing directory as described for the recent-dirs-file style below.
    
           If you set the recent-dirs-default style described below cdr will behave the same as cd if
           given  a  non-numeric  argument,  or more than one argument.  The recent directory list is
           updated just the same however you change directory.
    
           If the argument is omitted, 1 is assumed.  This is similar to pushd's behaviour	of  swap‐
           ping the two most recent directories on the stack.
    
           Completion  for	the argument to cdr is available if compinit has been run; menu selection
           is recommended, using:
    
    	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:cdr:*:*' menu selection
    
           to allow you to cycle through recent directories; the order is  preserved,  so  the  first
           choice  is  the	most  recent directory before the current one.	The verbose style is also
           recommended to ensure the directory is shown; this style is on by default so no action  is
           required unless you have changed it.
    
       Options
           The behaviour of cdr may be modified by the following options.
    
           -l     lists  the numbers and the corresponding directories in abbreviated form (i.e. with
    	      ~ substitution reapplied), one per line.	The directories here are not quoted (this
    	      would  only  be an issue if a directory name contained a newline).  This is used by
    	      the completion system.
    
           -r     sets the variable reply to the current set of directories.  Nothing is printed  and
    	      the directory is not changed.
    
           -e     allows  you  to edit the list of directories, one per line.  The list can be edited
    	      to any extent you like; no sanity checking is performed.	Completion is  available.
    	      No  quoting  is  necessary (except for newlines, where I have in any case no sympa‐
    	      thy); directories are in unabbreviated from and contain an absolute path, i.e. they
    	      start with /.  Usually the first entry should be left as the current directory.
    
       Configuration
           Configuration is by means of the styles mechanism that should be familiar from completion;
           if not, see the description of the zstyle command in see zshmodules(1).	The  context  for
           setting	styles	should	be  ':chpwd:*'	in case the meaning of the context is extended in
           future, for example:
    
    	      zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-max 0
    
           sets the value of the recent-dirs-max style to 0.  In practice the style name is  specific
           enough that a context of '*' should be fine.
    
           An exception is recent-dirs-insert, which is used exclusively by the completion system and
           so has the usual completion system context (':completion:*' if nothing  more  specific  is
           needed), though again '*' should be fine in practice.
    
           recent-dirs-default
    	      If true, and the command is expecting a recent directory index, and either there is
    	      more than one argument or the argument is not an	integer,  then	fall  through  to
    	      "cd".   This  allows the lazy to use only one command for directory changing.  Com‐
    	      pletion recognises this, too; see recent-dirs-insert for how to control  completion
    	      when this option is in use.
    
           recent-dirs-file
    	      The  file  where	the  list  of  directories  is	saved.	 The  default  is ${ZDOT‐
    	      DIR:-$HOME}/.chpwd-recent-dirs, i.e. this is in your home directory unless you have
    	      set  the	variable  ZDOTDIR  to point somewhere else.  Directory names are saved in
    	      $'...' quoted form, so each line in the file can be supplied directly to the  shell
    	      as an argument.
    
    	      The  value of this style may be an array.  In this case, the first file in the list
    	      will always be  used  for  saving  directories  while  any  other  files	are  left
    	      untouched.   When  reading  the  recent directory list, if there are fewer than the
    	      maximum number of entries in the first file, the contents of  later  files  in  the
    	      array  will  be appended with duplicates removed from the list shown.  The contents
    	      of the two files are not sorted together, i.e. all the entries in  the  first  file
    	      are  shown  first.   The	special  value	+  can appear in the list to indicate the
    	      default file should be read at that point.  This allows effects like the following:
    
    		     zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file \
    		     ~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-${TTY##*/} +
    
    	      Recent directories are read from a file numbered according  to  the  terminal.   If
    	      there are insufficient entries the list is supplemented from the default file.
    
    	      It is possible to use zstyle -e to make the directory configurable at run time:
    
    		     zstyle -e ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file pick-recent-dirs-file
    		     pick-recent-dirs-file() {
    		       if [[ $PWD = ~/text/writing(|/*) ]]; then
    			 reply=(~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-writing)
    		       else
    			 reply=(+)
    		       fi
    		     }
    
    	      In  this	example,  if the current directory is ~/text/writing or a directory under
    	      it, then use a special file for saving recent directories, else use the default.
    
           recent-dirs-insert
    	      Used by completion.  If recent-dirs-default is true,  then  setting  this  to  true
    	      causes  the  actual directory, rather than its index, to be inserted on the command
    	      line; this has the same effect as using the corresponding index, but makes the his‐
    	      tory  clearer  and the line easier to edit.  With this setting, if part of an argu‐
    	      ment was already typed, normal directory completion rather  than	recent	directory
    	      completion  is  done; this is because recent directory completion is expected to be
    	      done by cycling through entries menu fashion.
    
    	      If the value of the style is always, then only  recent  directories  will  be  com‐
    	      pleted;  in  that case, use the cd command when you want to complete other directo‐
    	      ries.
    
    	      If the value is fallback, recent directories  will  be  tried  first,  then  normal
    	      directory  completion  is performed if recent directory completion failed to find a
    	      match.
    
    	      Finally, if the value is both then both sets  of	completions  are  presented;  the
    	      usual  tag  mechanism  can  be used to distinguish results, with recent directories
    	      tagged as recent-dirs.  Note that the recent directories inserted  are  abbreviated
    	      with directory names where appropriate.
    
           recent-dirs-max
    	      The maximum number of directories to save to the file.  If this is zero or negative
    	      there is no maximum.  The default is 20.	Note this includes the current directory,
    	      which  isn't  offered,  so the highest number of directories you will be offered is
    	      one less than the maximum.
    
           recent-dirs-prune
    	      This style is an array determining what directories should (or should not) be added
    	      to the recent list.  Elements of the array can include:
    
    	      parent Prune  parents  (more  accurately,  ancestors)  from  the	recent	list.  If
    		     present, changing directly down by any number of directories causes the cur‐
    		     rent  directory  to  be  overwritten.   For  example,  changing from ~pws to
    		     ~pws/some/other/dir causes ~pws not to  be  left  on  the	recent	directory
    		     stack.   This only applies to direct changes to descendant directories; ear‐
    		     lier directories on the list are not pruned.   For  example,  changing  from
    		     ~pws/yet/another to ~pws/some/other/dir does not cause ~pws to be pruned.
    
    	      pattern:pattern
    		     Gives  a  zsh pattern for directories that should not be added to the recent
    		     list (if not already there).  This element can be repeated to add	different
    		     patterns.	 For  example,	'pattern:/tmp(|/*)' stops /tmp or its descendants
    		     from being added.	The EXTENDED_GLOB option is always turned  on  for  these
    		     patterns.
    
           recent-dirs-pushd
    	      If  set  to  true, cdr will use pushd instead of cd to change the directory, so the
    	      directory is saved on the directory stack.  As the directory  stack  is  completely
    	      separate	from  the list of files saved by the mechanism used in this file there is
    	      no obvious reason to do this.
    
       Use with dynamic directory naming
           It is possible to refer to recent directories using the dynamic directory name  syntax  by
           using the supplied function zsh_directory_name_cdr a hook:
    
    	      autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook
    	      add-zsh-hook -Uz zsh_directory_name zsh_directory_name_cdr
    
           When  this  is  done, ~[1] will refer to the most recent directory other than $PWD, and so
           on.  Completion after ~[...  also works.
    
       Details of directory handling
           This section is for the curious or confused; most users will not need to know this  infor‐
           mation.
    
           Recent  directories  are  saved	to a file immediately and hence are preserved across ses‐
           sions.  Note currently no file locking is applied: the  list  is  updated  immediately  on
           interactive  commands  and  nowhere  else (unlike history), and it is assumed you are only
           going to change directory in one window at once.  This is not safe on shared accounts, but
           in  any	case  the system has limited utility when someone else is changing to a different
           set of directories behind your back.
    
           To make this a little safer, only directory changes  instituted	from  the  command  line,
           either  directly  or  indirectly  through shell function calls (but not through subshells,
           evals, traps, completion functions and the like) are saved.  Shell functions should use cd
           -q  or pushd -q to avoid side effects if the change to the directory is to be invisible at
           the command line.  See the contents of the function chpwd_recent_dirs for more details.
    
    GATHERING INFORMATION FROM VERSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
           In a lot of cases, it is nice to automatically retrieve information from  version  control
           systems (VCSs), such as subversion, CVS or git, to be able to provide it to the user; pos‐
           sibly in the user's prompt. So that you can instantly tell which branch you are	currently
           on, for example.
    
           In order to do that, you may use the vcs_info function.
    
           The  following VCSs are supported, showing the abbreviated name by which they are referred
           to within the system:
           Bazaar (bzr)
    	      http://bazaar.canonical.com/
           Codeville (cdv)
    	      http://freecode.com/projects/codeville/
           Concurrent Versioning System (cvs)
    	      http://www.nongnu.org/cvs/
           Darcs (darcs)
    	      http://darcs.net/
           Fossil (fossil)
    	      http://fossil-scm.org/
           Git (git)
    	      http://git-scm.com/
           GNU arch (tla)
    	      http://www.gnu.org/software/gnu-arch/
           Mercurial (hg)
    	      http://mercurial.selenic.com/
           Monotone (mtn)
    	      http://monotone.ca/
           Perforce (p4)
    	      http://www.perforce.com/
           Subversion (svn)
    	      http://subversion.apache.org/
           SVK (svk)
    	      http://svk.bestpractical.com/
    
           There  is  also	support  for   the   patch   management   system   quilt   (http://savan‐
           nah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt). See Quilt Support below for details.
    
           To load vcs_info:
    
    	      autoload -Uz vcs_info
    
           It  can	be  used  in any existing prompt, because it does not require any specific $psvar
           entries to be available.
    
       Quickstart
           To get this feature working quickly (including colors), you can do the  following  (assum‐
           ing, you loaded vcs_info properly - see above):
    
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' actionformats \
    		  '%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{3}|%F{1}%a%F{5}]%f '
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' formats	 \
    		  '%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{5}]%f '
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:(sv[nk]|bzr):*' branchformat '%b%F{1}:%F{3}%r'
    	      precmd () { vcs_info }
    	      PS1='%F{5}[%F{2}%n%F{5}] %F{3}%3~ ${vcs_info_msg_0_}%f%# '
    
           Obviously,  the last two lines are there for demonstration. You need to call vcs_info from
           your precmd function. Once that is done you need a single quoted  '${vcs_info_msg_0_}'  in
           your prompt.
    
           To be able to use '${vcs_info_msg_0_}' directly in your prompt like this, you will need to
           have the PROMPT_SUBST option enabled.
    
           Now call the vcs_info_printsys utility from the command line:
    
    	      % vcs_info_printsys
    	      ## list of supported version control backends:
    	      ## disabled systems are prefixed by a hash sign (#)
    	      bzr
    	      cdv
    	      cvs
    	      darcs
    	      fossil
    	      git
    	      hg
    	      mtn
    	      p4
    	      svk
    	      svn
    	      tla
    	      ## flavours (cannot be used in the enable or disable styles; they
    	      ## are enabled and disabled with their master [git-svn -> git])
    	      ## they *can* be used in contexts: ':vcs_info:git-svn:*'.
    	      git-p4
    	      git-svn
    	      hg-git
    	      hg-hgsubversion
    	      hg-hgsvn
    
           You may not want all of these because there is no point in running the code to detect sys‐
           tems you do not use.  So there is a way to disable some backends altogether:
    
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr cdv darcs mtn svk tla
    
           You may also pick a few from that list and enable only those:
    
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable git cvs svn
    
           If  you	rerun  vcs_info_printsys  after  one of these commands, you will see the backends
           listed in the disable style (or backends not in the enable  style  -  if  you  used  that)
           marked  as  disabled by a hash sign.  That means the detection of these systems is skipped
           completely. No wasted time there.
    
       Configuration
           The vcs_info feature can be configured via zstyle.
    
           First, the context in which we are working:
    	      :vcs_info:vcs-string:user-context:repo-root-name
    
           vcs-string
    	      is one of: git, git-svn, git-p4, hg, hg-git, hg-hgsubversion, hg-hgsvn, darcs, bzr,
    	      cdv, mtn, svn, cvs, svk, tla, p4 or fossil. When hooks are active the hooks name is
    	      added after a `+'. (See Hooks in vcs_info below.)
    
           user-context
    	      is a freely configurable string, assignable by the user as the  first  argument  to
    	      vcs_info (see its description below).
    
           repo-root-name
    	      is  the  name of a repository in which you want a style to match. So, if you want a
    	      setting specific to /usr/src/zsh, with that being  a  CVS  checkout,  you  can  set
    	      repo-root-name to zsh to make it so.
    
           There  are  three  special  values  for	vcs-string: The first is named -init-, that is in
           effect as long as there was no decision what VCS backend to use. The second is  -preinit-;
           it  is  used  before  vcs_info is run, when initializing the data exporting variables. The
           third special value is formats and is used by the  vcs_info_lastmsg  for  looking  up  its
           styles.
    
           The  initial  value of repo-root-name is -all- and it is replaced with the actual name, as
           soon as it is known. Only use this part of the context for defining the	formats,  action‐
           formats	or  branchformat  styles,  as it is guaranteed that repo-root-name is set up cor‐
           rectly for these only. For all other styles, just use '*' instead.
    
           There are two pre-defined values for user-context:
           default
    	      the one used if none is specified
           command
    	      used by vcs_info_lastmsg to lookup its styles
    
           You can of course use ':vcs_info:*' to match all VCSs in all user-contexts at once.
    
           This is a description of all styles that are looked up.
    
           formats
    	      A list of formats, used when actionformats is not used (which is most of the time).
    
           actionformats
    	      A list of formats, used if there is a special  action  going  on	in  your  current
    	      repository; like an interactive rebase or a merge conflict.
    
           branchformat
    	      Some backends replace %b in the formats and actionformats styles above, not only by
    	      a branch name but also by a revision number. This style lets you	modify	how  that
    	      string should look.
    
           nvcsformats
    	      These "formats" are set when we didn't detect a version control system for the cur‐
    	      rent directory or vcs_info was disabled. This is useful if  you  want  vcs_info  to
    	      completely  take	over  the  generation of your prompt. You would do something like
    	      PS1='${vcs_info_msg_0_}' to accomplish that.
    
           hgrevformat
    	      hg uses both a hash and a revision number to reference a specific  changeset  in	a
    	      repository.  With  this style you can format the revision string (see branchformat)
    	      to include either or both. It's only useful when get-revision is	true.  Note,  the
    	      full  40-character  revision  id is not available (except when using the use-simple
    	      option) because executing hg more than once per prompt is too slow; you may custom‐
    	      ize this behavior using hooks.
    
           max-exports
    	      Defines the maximum number of vcs_info_msg_*_ variables vcs_info will set.
    
           enable A  list  of  backends  you want to use. Checked in the -init- context. If this list
    	      contains an item called NONE no backend is used at all and vcs_info will	do  noth‐
    	      ing. If this list contains ALL, vcs_info will use all known backends. Only with ALL
    	      in enable will the disable style have any effect. ALL and NONE  are  case  insensi‐
    	      tive.
    
           disable
    	      A  list  of  VCSs  you don't want vcs_info to test for repositories (checked in the
    	      -init- context, too). Only used if enable contains ALL.
    
           disable-patterns
    	      A list of patterns that are checked against $PWD. If a  pattern  matches,  vcs_info
    	      will be disabled. This style is checked in the :vcs_info:-init-:*:-all- context.
    
    	      Say, ~/.zsh is a directory under version control, in which you do not want vcs_info
    	      to be active, do:
    		     zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable-patterns "$HOME/.zsh(|/*)"
    
           use-quilt
    	      If enabled, the quilt support code is active in `addon' mode.   See  Quilt  Support
    	      for details.
    
           quilt-standalone
    	      If enabled, `standalone' mode detection is attempted if no VCS is active in a given
    	      directory. See Quilt Support for details.
    
           quilt-patch-dir
    	      Overwrite the value of the $QUILT_PATCHES environment variable. See  Quilt  Support
    	      for details.
    
           quiltcommand
    	      When quilt itself is called in quilt support the value of this style is used as the
    	      command name.
    
           check-for-changes
    	      If enabled, this style causes the %c and %u format escapes to show when the working
    	      directory  has  uncommitted  changes. The strings displayed by these escapes can be
    	      controlled via the stagedstr and unstagedstr styles. The only  backends  that  cur‐
    	      rently  support  this  option  are  git,	hg,  and bzr (the latter two only support
    	      unstaged).
    
    	      For this style to be evaluated with the hg backend, the get-revision style needs to
    	      be  set  and the use-simple style needs to be unset. The latter is the default; the
    	      former is not.
    
    	      With the bzr backend, lightweight checkouts only honor this style if the use-server
    	      style is set.
    
    	      Note,  the  actions taken if this style is enabled are potentially expensive (read:
    	      they may be slow, depending on how big the current repository is).   Therefore,  it
    	      is disabled by default.
    
           check-for-staged-changes
    	      This  style is like check-for-changes, but it never checks the worktree files, only
    	      the metadata in the .${vcs} dir.	Therefore, this style  initializes  only  the  %c
    	      escape  (with  stagedstr)  but  not  the	%u  escape.   This  style  is faster than
    	      check-for-changes.
    
    	      In the git backend, this style checks for changes in the index.  Other backends  do
    	      not currently implement this style.
    
    	      This style is disabled by default.
    
           stagedstr
    	      This string will be used in the %c escape if there are staged changes in the repos‐
    	      itory.
    
           unstagedstr
    	      This string will be used in the %u escape if there  are  unstaged  changes  in  the
    	      repository.
    
           command
    	      This  style causes vcs_info to use the supplied string as the command to use as the
    	      VCS's binary. Note, that setting this in ':vcs_info:*' is not a good idea.
    
    	      If the value of this style is empty (which is the default), the used binary name is
    	      the name of the backend in use (e.g. svn is used in an svn repository).
    
    	      The  repo-root-name part in the context is always the default -all- when this style
    	      is looked up.
    
    	      For example, this style can be used to use binaries from	non-default  installation
    	      directories.  Assume,  git  is  installed in /usr/bin but your sysadmin installed a
    	      newer version in /usr/local/bin. Instead of changing the order of your $PATH param‐
    	      eter, you can do this:
    		     zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*:-all-' command /usr/local/bin/git
    
           use-server
    	      This  is	used by the Perforce backend (p4) to decide if it should contact the Per‐
    	      force server to find out if a directory is managed by Perforce.  This is	the  only
    	      reliable	way of doing this, but runs the risk of a delay if the server name cannot
    	      be found.  If the server (more specifically,  the  host:port  pair  describing  the
    	      server)	cannot	be  contacted,	its  name  is  put  into  the  associative  array
    	      vcs_info_p4_dead_servers and is not contacted again during the session until it  is
    	      removed  by  hand.   If you do not set this style, the p4 backend is only usable if
    	      you have set the environment variable P4CONFIG to a file name and have  correspond‐
    	      ing  files  in  the  root directories of each Perforce client.  See comments in the
    	      function VCS_INFO_detect_p4 for more detail.
    
    	      The Bazaar backend (bzr) uses this to permit contacting  the  server  about  light‐
    	      weight checkouts, see the check-for-changes style.
    
           use-simple
    	      If  there  are two different ways of gathering information, you can select the sim‐
    	      pler one by setting this style to true; the default is to use  the  not-that-simple
    	      code,  which is potentially a lot slower but might be more accurate in all possible
    	      cases. This style is used by the bzr and hg backends. In the case  of  hg  it  will
    	      invoke  the  external hexdump program to parse the binary dirstate cache file; this
    	      method will not return the local revision number.
    
           get-revision
    	      If set to true, vcs_info goes the extra mile to figure out the revision of a repos‐
    	      itory's work tree (currently for the git and hg backends, where this kind of infor‐
    	      mation is not always vital). For git, the hash value of the currently  checked  out
    	      commit  is  available  via the %i expansion. With hg, the local revision number and
    	      the corresponding global hash are available via %i.
    
           get-mq If set to true, the hg backend will look for a Mercurial Queue  (mq)  patch  direc‐
    	      tory. Information will be available via the `%m' replacement.
    
           get-bookmarks
    	      If  set  to  true, the hg backend will try to get a list of current bookmarks. They
    	      will be available via the `%m' replacement.
    
    	      The default is to generate a comma-separated list of all bookmark names that  refer
    	      to  the  currently checked out revision.	If a bookmark is active, its name is suf‐
    	      fixed an asterisk and placed first in the list.
    
           use-prompt-escapes
    	      Determines if we assume that the assembled string  from  vcs_info  includes  prompt
    	      escapes. (Used by vcs_info_lastmsg.)
    
           debug  Enable  debugging  output  to track possible problems. Currently this style is only
    	      used by vcs_info's hooks system.
    
           hooks  A list style that defines hook-function names. See  Hooks  in  vcs_info  below  for
    	      details.
    
           patch-format
           nopatch-format
    	      This  pair of styles format the patch information used by the %m expando in formats
    	      and actionformats for the git and hg backends.  The value  is  subject  to  certain
    	      %-expansions described below.
    
           get-unapplied
    	      This  boolean  style  controls whether a backend should attempt to gather a list of
    	      unapplied patches (for example with Mercurial Queue patches).
    
    	      Used by the quilt and hg backends.
    
           The default values for these styles in all contexts are:
    
           formats
    	      " (%s)-[%b]%u%c-"
           actionformats
    	      " (%s)-[%b|%a]%u%c-"
           branchformat
    	      "%b:%r" (for bzr, svn, svk and hg)
           nvcsformats
    	      ""
           hgrevformat
    	      "%r:%h"
           max-exports
    	      2
           enable ALL
           disable
    	      (empty list)
           disable-patterns
    	      (empty list)
           check-for-changes
    	      false
           check-for-staged-changes
    	      false
           stagedstr
    	      (string: "S")
           unstagedstr
    	      (string: "U")
           command
    	      (empty string)
           use-server
    	      false
           use-simple
    	      false
           get-revision
    	      false
           get-mq true
           get-bookmarks
    	      false
           use-prompt-escapes
    	      true
           debug  false
           hooks  (empty list)
           use-quilt
    	      false
           quilt-standalone
    	      false
           quilt-patch-dir
    	      empty - use $QUILT_PATCHES
           quiltcommand
    	      quilt
           patch-format
    	      backend dependent
           nopatch-format
    	      backend dependent
           get-unapplied
    	      false
    
           In normal formats and actionformats the following replacements are done:
    
           %s     The VCS in use (git, hg, svn, etc.).
           %b     Information about the current branch.
           %a     An identifier that describes the action. Only makes sense in actionformats.
           %i     The current revision number or identifier. For hg the hgrevformat style may be used
    	      to customize the output.
           %c     The string from the stagedstr style if there are staged changes in the repository.
           %u     The  string from the unstagedstr style if there are unstaged changes in the reposi‐
    	      tory.
           %R     The base directory of the repository.
           %r     The repository name. If %R is /foo/bar/repoXY, %r is repoXY.
           %S     A subdirectory within a repository. If $PWD is  /foo/bar/repoXY/beer/tasty,  %S  is
    	      beer/tasty.
           %m     A  "misc"  replacement.  It is at the discretion of the backend to decide what this
    	      replacement expands to.
    
    	      The hg and git backends use this expando to display patch information.  hg  sources
    	      patch  information from the mq extensions; git from the rebase command and from the
    	      and stgit extension.  The patch-format and nopatch-format styles control the gener‐
    	      ated  string.   The former is used when at least one patch from the patch queue has
    	      been applied, and the latter otherwise.
    
    	      The hg backend displays bookmark information in this expando  (in  addition  to  mq
    	      information).   See  the get-mq and get-bookmarks styles.  Both of these styles may
    	      be enabled at the same time.  If both are enabled, both resulting strings  will  be
    	      shown separated by a semicolon (that cannot currently be customized).
    
           In branchformat these replacements are done:
    
           %b     The branch name.
           %r     The current revision number or the hgrevformat style for hg.
    
           In hgrevformat these replacements are done:
    
           %r     The current local revision number.
           %h     The current global revision identifier.
    
           In patch-format and nopatch-format these replacements are done:
    
           %p     The name of the top-most applied patch (applied-string).
           %u     The number of unapplied patches (unapplied-string).
           %n     The number of applied patches.
           %c     The number of unapplied patches.
           %a     The number of all patches.
           %g     The names of active mq guards (hg backend).
           %G     The number of active mq guards (hg backend).
    
           Not all VCS backends have to support all replacements. For nvcsformats no replacements are
           performed at all, it is just a string.
    
       Oddities
           If you want to use the %b (bold off) prompt expansion in formats, which expands %b itself,
           use  %%b.  That	will  cause  the vcs_info expansion to replace %%b with %b, so that zsh's
           prompt expansion mechanism can handle it. Similarly, to hand down  %b  from  branchformat,
           use  %%%%b.  Sorry  for this inconvenience, but it cannot be easily avoided. Luckily we do
           not clash with a lot of prompt expansions and this only needs to be done for those.
    
       Quilt Support
           Quilt is not a version control system, therefore this is not implemented as a backend.  It
           can help keeping track of a series of patches. People use it to keep a set of changes they
           want to use on top of software packages (which is  tightly  integrated  into  the  package
           build  process  -  the Debian project does this for a large number of packages). Quilt can
           also help individual developers keep track of their own patches on  top	of  real  version
           control systems.
    
           The  vcs_info integration tries to support both ways of using quilt by having two slightly
           different modes of operation: `addon' mode and `standalone' mode).
    
           For `addon' mode to become active vcs_info must have already detected a real version  con‐
           trol system controlling the directory. If that is the case, a directory that holds quilt's
           patches needs to be found. That directory is configurable via the `QUILT_PATCHES' environ‐
           ment variable. If that variable exists its value is used, otherwise the value `patches' is
           assumed. The value from $QUILT_PATCHES can be overwritten using the `quilt-patches' style.
           (Note:  you  can use vcs_info to keep the value of $QUILT_PATCHES correct all the time via
           the post-quilt hook).
    
           When the directory in question is found, quilt is assumed to be	active.  To  gather  more
           information,  vcs_info  looks  for  a directory called `.pc'; Quilt uses that directory to
           track its current state. If this directory does not exist we know that quilt has not  done
           anything to the working directory (read: no patches have been applied yet).
    
           If  patches  are  applied,  vcs_info will try to find out which. If you want to know which
           patches of a series are not yet applied, you need to activate the get-unapplied	style  in
           the appropriate context.
    
           vcs_info  allows  for very detailed control over how the gathered information is presented
           (see the below sections, Styles and Hooks in vcs_info), all of which are documented below.
           Note there are a number of other patch tracking systems that work on top of a certain ver‐
           sion control system (like stgit for git, or mq for hg); the configuration for systems like
           that are generally configured the same way as the quilt support.
    
           If  the	quilt  support	is working in `addon' mode, the produced string is available as a
           simple format replacement (%Q to be precise), which can be used in formats and  actionfor‐
           mats; see below for details).
    
           If,  on	the  other  hand, the support code is working in `standalone' mode, vcs_info will
           pretend as if quilt were an actual version control system. That	means  that  the  version
           control system identifier (which otherwise would be something like `svn' or `cvs') will be
           set to `-quilt-'. This has implications on the used style context where this identifier is
           the  second  element.  vcs_info	will have filled in a proper value for the "repository's"
           root directory and the string containing the  information  about  quilt's  state  will  be
           available as the `misc' replacement (and %Q for compatibility with `addon' mode.
    
           What  is  left  to discuss is how `standalone' mode is detected. The detection itself is a
           series of searches for directories. You can have this detection enabled all  the  time  in
           every  directory  that is not otherwise under version control. If you know there is only a
           limited set of trees where you would like vcs_info to try and look for  Quilt  in  `stand‐
           alone'  mode  to  minimise  the amount of searching on every call to vcs_info, there are a
           number of ways to do that:
    
           Essentially, `standalone' mode detection is controlled by  a  style  called  `quilt-stand‐
           alone'. It is a string style and its value can have different effects. The simplest values
           are: `always' to run detection every time vcs_info is run, and `never' to turn the  detec‐
           tion off entirely.
    
           If  the value of quilt-standalone is something else, it is interpreted differently. If the
           value is the name of a scalar variable the value of that  variable  is  checked	and  that
           value is used in the same `always'/`never' way as described above.
    
           If  the	value  of  quilt-standalone  is  an array, the elements of that array are used as
           directory names under which you want the detection to be active.
    
           If quilt-standalone is an associative array, the keys are taken as directory  names  under
           which  you  want  the  detection  to be active, but only if the corresponding value is the
           string `true'.
    
           Last, but not least, if the value of quilt-standalone is the name of a function, the func‐
           tion  is called without arguments and the return value decides whether detection should be
           active. A `0' return value is true; a non-zero return value is interpreted as false.
    
           Note, if there is both a function and a variable by  the  name  of  quilt-standalone,  the
           function will take precedence.
    
       Function Descriptions (Public API)
           vcs_info [user-context]
    	      The   main   function,   that  runs  all	backends  and  assembles  all  data  into
    	      ${vcs_info_msg_*_}. This is the function you want to call from precmd if	you  want
    	      to  include up-to-date information in your prompt (see Variable description below).
    	      If an argument is given, that string  will  be  used  instead  of  default  in  the
    	      user-context field of the style context.
    
           vcs_info_hookadd
    	      Statically  registers  a	number of functions to a given hook. The hook needs to be
    	      given as the first argument; what follows is a list of hook-function names to  reg‐
    	      ister  to  the  hook.  The  `+vi-'  prefix  needs to be left out here. See Hooks in
    	      vcs_info below for details.
    
           vcs_info_hookdel
    	      Remove hook-functions from a given hook. The hook needs to be given  as  the  first
    	      non-option  argument;  what follows is a list of hook-function names to un-register
    	      from the hook. If `-a' is used as the first argument, all occurrences of the  func‐
    	      tions  are  unregistered. Otherwise only the last occurrence is removed (if a func‐
    	      tion was registered to a hook more than once) . The `+vi-' prefix needs to be  left
    	      out here. See Hooks in vcs_info below for details.
    
           vcs_info_lastmsg
    	      Outputs  the  last  ${vcs_info_msg_*_}  value.  Takes into account the value of the
    	      use-prompt-escapes style in ':vcs_info:formats:command:-all-'. It also only  prints
    	      max-exports values.
    
           vcs_info_printsys [user-context]
    	      Prints a list of all supported version control systems. Useful to find out possible
    	      contexts (and which of them are enabled) or values for the disable style.
    
           vcs_info_setsys
    	      Initializes vcs_info's internal list of available backends. With this function, you
    	      can add support for new VCSs without restarting the shell.
    
           All functions named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.
    
       Variable Description
           ${vcs_info_msg_N_} (Note the trailing underscore)
    	      Where  N	is an integer, e.g., vcs_info_msg_0_. These variables are the storage for
    	      the informational message the last vcs_info call has assembled. These are  strongly
    	      connected  to  the  formats,  actionformats and nvcsformats styles described above.
    	      Those styles  are  lists.  The  first  member  of  that  list  gets  expanded  into
    	      ${vcs_info_msg_0_},   the   second   into   ${vcs_info_msg_1_}  and  the	Nth  into
    	      ${vcs_info_msg_N-1_}. (See the max-exports style above.)
    
           All variables named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.
    
       Hooks in vcs_info
           Hooks are places in vcs_info where you can run your own code. That  code  can  communicate
           with the code that called it and through that, change the system's behaviour.
    
           For configuration, hooks change the style context:
    	      :vcs_info:vcs-string+hook-name:user-context:repo-root-name
    
           To register functions to a hook, you need to list them in the hooks style in the appropri‐
           ate context.
    
           Example:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*+foo:*' hooks bar baz
    
           This registers functions to the hook `foo' for all backends. In order to  avoid	namespace
           problems, all registered function names are prepended by a `+vi-', so the actual functions
           called for the `foo' hook are `+vi-bar' and `+vi-baz'.
    
           If you would like to register a function to a hook regardless of the current context,  you
           may  use the vcs_info_hookadd function. To remove a function that was added like that, the
           vcs_info_hookdel function can be used.
    
           If something seems weird, you can enable the `debug' boolean style in the  proper  context
           and  the hook-calling code will print what it tried to execute and whether the function in
           question existed.
    
           When you register more than one function to a hook, all functions are executed  one  after
           another	until one function returns non-zero or until all functions have been called. Con‐
           text-sensitive hook functions are executed before statically  registered  ones  (the  ones
           added by vcs_info_hookadd).
    
           You may pass data between functions via an associative array, user_data.  For example:
    	      +vi-git-myfirsthook(){
    		  user_data[myval]=$myval
    	      }
    	      +vi-git-mysecondhook(){
    		  # do something with ${user_data[myval]}
    	      }
    
           There are a number of variables that are special in hook contexts:
    
           ret    The return value that the hooks system will return to the caller. The default is an
    	      integer `zero'. If and how a changed ret value changes the execution of the  caller
    	      depends on the specific hook. See the hook documentation below for details.
    
           hook_com
    	      An  associated  array which is used for bidirectional communication from the caller
    	      to hook functions. The used keys depend on the specific hook.
    
           context
    	      The active context of the hook. Functions that wish to change this variable  should
    	      make it local scope first.
    
           vcs    The  current  VCS  after	it was detected. The same values as in the enable/disable
    	      style are used. Available in all hooks except start-up.
    
           Finally, the full list of currently available hooks:
    
           start-up
    	      Called after starting vcs_info but before the VCS in this directory is  determined.
    	      It  can be used to deactivate vcs_info temporarily if necessary. When ret is set to
    	      1, vcs_info aborts and does nothing; when set to 2, vcs_info sets up everything  as
    	      if no version control were active and exits.
    
           pre-get-data
    	      Same as start-up but after the VCS was detected.
    
           gen-hg-bookmark-string
    	      Called  in the Mercurial backend when a bookmark string is generated; the get-revi‐
    	      sion and get-bookmarks styles must be true.
    
    	      This hook gets the names of the Mercurial bookmarks that	vcs_info  collected  from
    	      `hg'.
    
    	      If  a  bookmark  is  active,  the key ${hook_com[hg-active-bookmark]} is set to its
    	      name.  The key is otherwise unset.
    
    	      When setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]} will be
    	      used  in	the  %m  escape in formats and actionformats and will be available in the
    	      global backend_misc array as ${backend_misc[bookmarks]}.
    
           gen-applied-string
    	      Called in the git (with stgit or during rebase or merge), and hg (with mq) backends
    	      and  in  quilt  support  when the applied-string is generated; the use-quilt zstyle
    	      must be true for quilt (the mq and stgit backends are active by default).
    
    	      This hook gets the names of all applied patches which vcs_info collected so far  in
    	      the  opposite  order, which means that the first argument is the top-most patch and
    	      so forth.
    
    	      When setting ret to non-zero, the string	in  ${hook_com[applied-string]}  will  be
    	      used  in	the  %m  escape in formats and actionformats; it will be available in the
    	      global backend_misc array as $backend_misc[patches]}; and it will be  available  as
    	      %p in the patch-format and nopatch-format styles.
    
           gen-unapplied-string
    	      Called  in  the  git (with stgit or during rebase), and hg (with mq) backend and in
    	      quilt support when the unapplied-string is generated; the get-unapplied style  must
    	      be true.
    
    	      This  hook  gets the names of all unapplied patches which vcs_info collected so far
    	      in the opposite order, which mean that the first argument is the patch next-in-line
    	      to be applied and so forth.
    
    	      When  setting  ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[unapplied-string]} will be
    	      available as %u in the patch-format and nopatch-format styles.
    
           gen-mqguards-string
    	      Called in the hg backend when guards-string is generated; the get-mq style must  be
    	      true (default).
    
    	      This hook gets the names of any active mq guards.
    
    	      When setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[guards-string]} will be used
    	      in the %g escape in the patch-format and nopatch-format styles.
    
           no-vcs This hooks is called when no version control system was detected.
    
    	      The `hook_com' parameter is not used.
    
           post-backend
    	      Called as soon as the backend has finished collecting information.
    
    	      The `hook_com' keys available are as for the set-message hook.
    
           post-quilt
    	      Called after the quilt support is done. The  following  information  is  passed  as
    	      arguments  to the hook: 1. the quilt-support mode (`addon' or `standalone'); 2. the
    	      directory that contains the patch series; 3. the directory that holds quilt's  sta‐
    	      tus  information	(the  `.pc'  directory)  or the string "-nopc-" if that directory
    	      wasn't found.
    
    	      The `hook_com' parameter is not used.
    
           set-branch-format
    	      Called before `branchformat' is set. The only argument to the hook  is  the  format
    	      that is configured at this point.
    
    	      The  `hook_com'  keys  considered are `branch' and `revision'.  They are set to the
    	      values figured out so far by vcs_info and any change will be used directly when the
    	      actual replacement is done.
    
    	      If  ret  is set to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[branch-replace]} will be used
    	      unchanged as the `%b' replacement in the variables set by vcs_info.
    
           set-hgrev-format
    	      Called before a `hgrevformat' is set. The only argument to the hook is  the  format
    	      that is configured at this point.
    
    	      The `hook_com' keys considered are `hash' and `localrev'.  They are set to the val‐
    	      ues figured out so far by vcs_info and any change will be used  directly	when  the
    	      actual replacement is done.
    
    	      If  ret  is  set	to  non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[rev-replace]} will be used
    	      unchanged as the `%i' replacement in the variables set by vcs_info.
    
           pre-addon-quilt
    	      This hook is used when vcs_info's quilt functionality is	active	in  "addon"  mode
    	      (quilt  used on top of a real version control system). It is activated right before
    	      any quilt specific action is taken.
    
    	      Setting the `ret' variable in this hook to a non-zero value avoids any  quilt  spe‐
    	      cific actions from being run at all.
    
           set-patch-format
    	      This  hook  is  used to control some of the possible expansions in patch-format and
    	      nopatch-format styles with patch queue systems such as quilt, mqueue and the like.
    
    	      This hook is used in the git, hg and quilt backends.
    
    	      The  hook  allows  the  control	of   the   %p	(${hook_com[applied]})	 and   %u
    	      (${hook_com[unapplied]}) expansion in all backends that use the hook. With the mer‐
    	      curial backend, the %g (${hook_com[guards]}) expansion is controllable in  addition
    	      to that.
    
    	      If  ret  is  set to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[patch-replace]} will be used
    	      unchanged instead of an expanded format from patch-format or nopatch-format.
    
           set-message
    	      Called each time before a `vcs_info_msg_N_' message is set.   It	takes  two  argu‐
    	      ments; the first being the `N' in the message variable name, the second is the cur‐
    	      rently configured formats or actionformats.
    
    	      There are a number of `hook_com' keys, that  are	used  here:  `action',	`branch',
    	      `base',  `base-name', `subdir', `staged', `unstaged', `revision', `misc', `vcs' and
    	      one `miscN' entry for each backend-specific data field (N starting at  zero).  They
    	      are  set	to  the values figured out so far by vcs_info and any change will be used
    	      directly when the actual replacement is done.
    
    	      Since this hook is triggered multiple times (once for each  configured  formats  or
    	      actionformats),  each  of the `hook_com' keys mentioned above (except for the miscN
    	      entries) has an `_orig' counterpart, so even if you changed a value to your  liking
    	      you  can	still get the original value in the next run. Changing the `_orig' values
    	      is probably not a good idea.
    
    	      If ret is set  to  non-zero,  the  string  in  ${hook_com[message]}  will  be  used
    	      unchanged as the message by vcs_info.
    
           If all of this sounds rather confusing, take a look at the Examples section below and also
           in the Misc/vcs_info-examples file in the Zsh source.  They contain some explanatory code.
    
       Examples
           Don't use vcs_info at all (even though it's in your prompt):
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable NONE
    
           Disable the backends for bzr and svk:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr svk
    
           Disable everything but bzr and svk:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable bzr svk
    
           Provide a special formats for git:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' formats	     ' GIT, BABY! [%b]'
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' actionformats ' GIT ACTION! [%b|%a]'
    
           All %x expansion in all sorts of formats (formats, actionformats, branchformat,	you  name
           it)  are  done using the `zformat' builtin from the `zsh/zutil' module. That means you can
           do everything with these %x items what zformat supports. In particular, if you want  some‐
           thing  that is really long to have a fixed width, like a hash in a mercurial branchformat,
           you can do this: %12.12i. That'll shrink the 40 character hash to its 12  leading  charac‐
           ters.  The form is actually `%min.maxx'. More is possible.  See the section `The zsh/zutil
           Module' in zshmodules(1) for details.
    
           Use the quicker bzr backend
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:bzr:*' use-simple true
    
           If you do use use-simple, please report if it does `the-right-thing[tm]'.
    
           Display the revision number in yellow for bzr and svn:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:(svn|bzr):*' \
    		     branchformat '%b%{'${fg[yellow]}'%}:%r'
    
           If you want colors, make sure you enclose the color codes in %{...%} if you  want  to  use
           the string provided by vcs_info in prompts.
    
           Here is how to print the VCS information as a command (not in a prompt):
    	      alias vcsi='vcs_info command; vcs_info_lastmsg'
    
           This  way,  you	can  even define different formats for output via vcs_info_lastmsg in the
           ':vcs_info:*:command:*' namespace.
    
           Now as promised, some code that uses hooks: say, you'd like to replace the string `svn' by
           `subversion' in vcs_info's %s formats replacement.
    
           First, we will tell vcs_info to call a function when populating the message variables with
           the gathered information:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion
    
           Nothing happens. Which is reasonable, since we didn't define the actual function  yet.  To
           see what the hooks subsystem is trying to do, enable the `debug' style:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug true
    
           That  should  give  you	an  idea what is going on. Specifically, the function that we are
           looking for is `+vi-svn2subversion'. Note, the `+vi-' prefix. So, everything is in  order,
           just as documented. When you are done checking out the debugging output, disable it again:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug false
    
           Now, let's define the function:
    	      function +vi-svn2subversion() {
    		  [[ ${hook_com[vcs_orig]} == svn ]] && hook_com[vcs]=subversion
    	      }
    
           Simple enough. And it could have even been simpler, if only we had registered our function
           in a less generic context. If we do it only in the `svn' backend's context, we don't  need
           to test which the active backend is:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:svn+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion
    	      function +vi-svn2subversion() {
    		  hook_com[vcs]=subversion
    	      }
    
           And finally a little more elaborate example, that uses a hook to create a customised book‐
           mark string for the hg backend.
    
           Again, we start off by registering a function:
    	      zstyle ':vcs_info:hg+gen-hg-bookmark-string:*' hooks hgbookmarks
    
           And then we define the `+vi-hgbookmarks function:
    	      function +vi-hgbookmarks() {
    		  # The default is to connect all bookmark names by
    		  # commas. This mixes things up a little.
    		  # Imagine, there's one type of bookmarks that is
    		  # special to you. Say, because it's *your* work.
    		  # Those bookmarks look always like this: "sh/*"
    		  # (because your initials are sh, for example).
    		  # This makes the bookmarks string use only those
    		  # bookmarks. If there's more than one, it
    		  # concatenates them using commas.
    		  # The bookmarks returned by `hg' are available in
    		  # the function's positional parameters.
    		  local s="${(Mj:,:)@:#sh/*}"
    		  # Now, the communication with the code that calls
    		  # the hook functions is done via the hook_com[]
    		  # hash. The key at which the `gen-hg-bookmark-string'
    		  # hook looks is `hg-bookmark-string'. So:
    		  hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]=$s
    		  # And to signal that we want to use the string we
    		  # just generated, set the special variable `ret' to
    		  # something other than the default zero:
    		  ret=1
    		  return 0
    	      }
    
           Some longer examples and code snippets which might be useful are available in the examples
           file located at Misc/vcs_info-examples in the Zsh source directory.
    
           This concludes our guided tour through zsh's vcs_info.
    
    PROMPT THEMES
       Installation
           You  should make sure all the functions from the Functions/Prompts directory of the source
           distribution are available; they all begin with the string `prompt_' except for	the  spe‐
           cial  function`promptinit'.  You also need the `colors' function from Functions/Misc.  All
           of these functions may already have been installed on your system; if not, you  will  need
           to  find  them  and  copy them.	The directory should appear as one of the elements of the
           fpath array (this should already be the case if they were installed),  and  at  least  the
           function promptinit should be autoloaded; it will autoload the rest.  Finally, to initial‐
           ize the use of the system you need to call the promptinit function.  The following code in
           your  .zshrc  will  arrange  for  this;	assume	the functions are stored in the directory
           ~/myfns:
    
    	      fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
    	      autoload -U promptinit
    	      promptinit
    
       Theme Selection
           Use the prompt command to select your preferred theme.  This command may be added to  your
           .zshrc  following  the  call  to  promptinit  in  order	to start zsh with a theme already
           selected.
    
           prompt [ -c | -l ]
           prompt [ -p | -h ] [ theme ... ]
           prompt [ -s ] theme [ arg ... ]
    	      Set or examine the prompt theme.	With no options and a theme argument,  the  theme
    	      with that name is set as the current theme.  The available themes are determined at
    	      run time; use the -l option to see a list.  The special theme `random'  selects  at
    	      random one of the available themes and sets your prompt to that.
    
    	      In  some	cases the theme may be modified by one or more arguments, which should be
    	      given after the theme name.  See the help for each theme for descriptions of  these
    	      arguments.
    
    	      Options are:
    
    	      -c     Show the currently selected theme and its parameters, if any.
    	      -l     List all available prompt themes.
    	      -p     Preview the theme named by theme, or all themes if no theme is given.
    	      -h     Show  help  for  the  theme named by theme, or for the prompt function if no
    		     theme is given.
    	      -s     Set theme as the current theme and save state.
    
           prompt_theme_setup
    	      Each available theme has a setup function which is called by the prompt function to
    	      install that theme.  This function may define other functions as necessary to main‐
    	      tain the prompt, including functions used to preview the prompt or provide help for
    	      its use.	You should not normally call a theme's setup function directly.
    
    ZLE FUNCTIONS
       Widgets
           These  functions all implement user-defined ZLE widgets (see zshzle(1)) which can be bound
           to keystrokes in interactive shells.  To use them, your .zshrc should contain lines of the
           form
    
    	      autoload function
    	      zle -N function
    
           followed  by an appropriate bindkey command to associate the function with a key sequence.
           Suggested bindings are described below.
    
           bash-style word functions
    	      If you are looking for functions to implement moving over and editing words in  the
    	      manner  of bash, where only alphanumeric characters are considered word characters,
    	      you can use the functions described in the next section.	The following  is  suffi‐
    	      cient:
    
    		     autoload -U select-word-style
    		     select-word-style bash
    
           forward-word-match, backward-word-match
           kill-word-match, backward-kill-word-match
           transpose-words-match, capitalize-word-match
           up-case-word-match, down-case-word-match
           select-word-style, match-word-context, match-words-by-style
    	      The eight `-match' functions are drop-in replacements for the builtin widgets with‐
    	      out the suffix.  By default they behave in a similar way.  However, by the  use  of
    	      styles  and  the	function  select-word-style,  the  way	words  are matched can be
    	      altered.
    
    	      The simplest way of configuring the functions is to  use	select-word-style,  which
    	      can either be called as a normal function with the appropriate argument, or invoked
    	      as a user-defined widget that will prompt for the first character of the word style
    	      to be used.  The first time it is invoked, the eight -match functions will automat‐
    	      ically replace the builtin versions, so they do not need to be loaded explicitly.
    
    	      The word styles available are as follows.  Only the first character is examined.
    
    	      bash   Word characters are alphanumeric characters only.
    
    	      normal As in normal shell operation:  word characters are  alphanumeric  characters
    		     plus any characters present in the string given by the parameter $WORDCHARS.
    
    	      shell  Words  are  complete  shell  command  arguments, possibly including complete
    		     quoted strings, or any tokens special to the shell.
    
    	      whitespace
    		     Words are any set of characters delimited by whitespace.
    
    	      default
    		     Restore the default settings; this is usually the same as `normal'.
    
    	      All but `default' can be input as an upper  case	character,  which  has	the  same
    	      effect  but  with  subword matching turned on.  In this case, words with upper case
    	      characters are treated specially: each separate run of upper case characters, or an
    	      upper  case  character  followed by any number of other characters, is considered a
    	      word.  The style subword-range can supply an alternative	character  range  to  the
    	      default `[:upper:]'; the value of the style is treated as the contents of a `[...]'
    	      pattern (note that the outer brackets should not be supplied, only those	surround‐
    	      ing named ranges).
    
    	      More  control  can  be  obtained	using the zstyle command, as described in zshmod‐
    	      ules(1).	Each style is looked up in the context :zle:widget where  widget  is  the
    	      name  of	the user-defined widget, not the name of the function implementing it, so
    	      in the case of the definitions supplied by select-word-style the	appropriate  con‐
    	      texts  are  :zle:forward-word,  and  so  on.  The function select-word-style itself
    	      always defines styles for the context `:zle:*' which can be overridden by more spe‐
    	      cific (longer) patterns as well as explicit contexts.
    
    	      The  style word-style specifies the rules to use.  This may have the following val‐
    	      ues.
    
    	      normal Use the standard shell rules,  i.e.  alphanumerics  and  $WORDCHARS,  unless
    		     overridden by the styles word-chars or word-class.
    
    	      specified
    		     Similar  to normal, but only the specified characters, and not also alphanu‐
    		     merics, are considered word characters.
    
    	      unspecified
    		     The negation of specified.  The given characters are those which will not be
    		     considered part of a word.
    
    	      shell  Words are obtained by using the syntactic rules for generating shell command
    		     arguments.  In addition, special tokens which are	never  command	arguments
    		     such as `()' are also treated as words.
    
    	      whitespace
    		     Words are whitespace-delimited strings of characters.
    
    	      The first three of those rules usually use $WORDCHARS, but the value in the parame‐
    	      ter can be overridden by the style word-chars, which works in exactly the same  way
    	      as  $WORDCHARS.	In  addition, the style word-class uses character class syntax to
    	      group characters and takes  precedence  over  word-chars	if  both  are  set.   The
    	      word-class  style does not include the surrounding brackets of the character class;
    	      for example, `-:[:alnum:]' is a valid word-class to include all alphanumerics  plus
    	      the  characters  `-'  and  `:'.  Be careful including `]', `^' and `-' as these are
    	      special inside character classes.
    
    	      word-style may also have `-subword' appended to its value to turn on subword match‐
    	      ing, as described above.
    
    	      The  style  skip-chars  is mostly useful for transpose-words and similar functions.
    	      If set, it gives a count of characters starting at the cursor position  which  will
    	      not  be  considered  part  of the word and are treated as space, regardless of what
    	      they actually are.  For example, if
    
    		     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words' skip-chars 1
    
    	      has been set, and transpose-words-match is called with  the  cursor  on  the  X  of
    	      fooXbar, where X can be any character, then the resulting expression is barXfoo.
    
    	      Finer grained control can be obtained by setting the style word-context to an array
    	      of pairs of entries.  Each pair of entries consists of a pattern and a  subcontext.
    	      The  shell  argument the cursor is on is matched against each pattern in turn until
    	      one matches; if it does, the context is extended by a colon and  the  corresponding
    	      subcontext.  Note that the test is made against the original word on the line, with
    	      no stripping of quotes.  Special handling is done between words: the  current  con‐
    	      text  is examined and if it contains the string back, the word before the cursor is
    	      considered, else the word after cursor  is  considered.  Some  examples  are  given
    	      below.
    
    	      The  style  skip-whitespace-first is only used with the forward-word widget.  If it
    	      is set to true, then forward-word skips any non-word-characters,	followed  by  any
    	      non-word-characters: this is similar to the behaviour of other word-orientated wid‐
    	      gets, and also that used by other editors, however it differs from the standard zsh
    	      behaviour.  When using select-word-style the widget is set in the context :zle:* to
    	      true if the word style is bash and false otherwise.  It may be overridden  by  set‐
    	      ting it in the more specific context :zle:forward-word*.
    
    	      Here  are  some  examples  of use of the styles, actually taken from the simplified
    	      interface in select-word-style:
    
    		     zstyle ':zle:*' word-style standard
    		     zstyle ':zle:*' word-chars ''
    
    	      Implements bash-style word handling for all widgets, i.e.  only  alphanumerics  are
    	      word  characters; equivalent to setting the parameter WORDCHARS empty for the given
    	      context.
    
    		     style ':zle:*kill*' word-style space
    
    	      Uses space-delimited words for widgets with the word `kill' in the  name.   Neither
    	      of the styles word-chars nor word-class is used in this case.
    
    	      Here are some examples of use of the word-context style to extend the context.
    
    		     zstyle ':zle:*' word-context \
    			    "*/*" file "[[:space:]]" whitespace
    		     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:whitespace' word-style shell
    		     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-style normal
    		     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-chars ''
    
    	      This  provides two different ways of using transpose-words depending on whether the
    	      cursor is on whitespace between words or on a filename, here any word containing	a
    	      /.   On  whitespace,  complete arguments as defined by standard shell rules will be
    	      transposed.  In a filename, only	alphanumerics  will  be  transposed.   Elsewhere,
    	      words will be transposed using the default style for :zle:transpose-words.
    
    	      The  word  matching and all the handling of zstyle settings is actually implemented
    	      by the function match-words-by-style.  This can be used to create new  user-defined
    	      widgets.	 The  calling  function  should  set  the  local  parameter curcontext to
    	      :zle:widget, create the local parameter matched_words and call match-words-by-style
    	      with  no arguments.  On return, matched_words will be set to an array with the ele‐
    	      ments: (1) the start of the line (2) the word before the cursor  (3)  any  non-word
    	      characters  between that word and the cursor (4) any non-word character at the cur‐
    	      sor position plus any remaining non-word characters before the next word, including
    	      all  characters specified by the skip-chars style, (5) the word at or following the
    	      cursor (6) any non-word characters following that word (7)  the  remainder  of  the
    	      line.  Any of the elements may be an empty string; the calling function should test
    	      for this to decide whether it can perform its function.
    
    	      It is possible to pass options with arguments to match-words-by-style  to  override
    	      the use of styles.  The options are:
    	      -w     word-style
    	      -s     skip-chars
    	      -c     word-class
    	      -C     word-chars
    	      -r     subword-range
    
    	      For  example, match-words-by-style -w shell -c 0 may be used to extract the command
    	      argument around the cursor.
    
    	      The word-context style is implemented by	the  function  match-word-context.   This
    	      should not usually need to be called directly.
    
           copy-earlier-word
    	      This  widget works like a combination of insert-last-word and copy-prev-shell-word.
    	      Repeated invocations of the widget retrieve earlier words on the	relevant  history
    	      line.   With a numeric argument N, insert the Nth word from the history line; N may
    	      be negative to count from the end of the line.
    
    	      If insert-last-word has been used to retrieve the last word on a	previous  history
    	      line,  repeated invocations will replace that word with earlier words from the same
    	      line.
    
    	      Otherwise, the widget applies to words on the line  currently  being  edited.   The
    	      widget  style  can  be  set  to the name of another widget that should be called to
    	      retrieve	words.	 This  widget  must  accept   the   same   three   arguments   as
    	      insert-last-word.
    
           cycle-completion-positions
    	      After inserting an unambiguous string into the command line, the new function based
    	      completion system may know about multiple places in this	string	where  characters
    	      are  missing  or	differ	from  at least one of the possible matches.  It will then
    	      place the cursor on the position it considers to be the most interesting one,  i.e.
    	      the one where one can disambiguate between as many matches as possible with as lit‐
    	      tle typing as possible.
    
    	      This widget allows the cursor to be easily moved to the  other  interesting  spots.
    	      It can be invoked repeatedly to cycle between all positions reported by the comple‐
    	      tion system.
    
           delete-whole-word-match
    	      This is another function which works like the -match  functions  described  immedi‐
    	      ately above, i.e. using styles to decide the word boundaries.  However, it is not a
    	      replacement for any existing function.
    
    	      The basic behaviour is to delete the word around the cursor.  There is  no  numeric
    	      argument	handling;  only  the single word around the cursor is considered.  If the
    	      widget contains the string kill, the removed text will be placed in  the	cutbuffer
    	      for future yanking.  This can be obtained by defining kill-whole-word-match as fol‐
    	      lows:
    
    		     zle -N kill-whole-word-match delete-whole-word-match
    
    	      and then binding the widget kill-whole-word-match.
    
           up-line-or-beginning-search, down-line-or-beginning-search
    	      These  widgets  are  similar  to	the  builtin  functions   up-line-or-search   and
    	      down-line-or-search:  if in a multiline buffer they move up or down within the buf‐
    	      fer, otherwise they search for a history line matching the  start  of  the  current
    	      line.  In this case, however, they search for a line which matches the current line
    	      up to the current cursor position, in the manner of  history-beginning-search-back‐
    	      ward and -forward, rather than the first word on the line.
    
           edit-command-line
    	      Edit the command line using your visual editor, as in ksh.
    
    		     bindkey -M vicmd v edit-command-line
    
           expand-absolute-path
    	      Expand  the  file  name  under  the  cursor to an absolute path, resolving symbolic
    	      links.  Where possible, the initial path segment is turned into a  named	directory
    	      or reference to a user's home directory.
    
           history-search-end
    	      This function implements the widgets history-beginning-search-backward-end and his‐
    	      tory-beginning-search-forward-end.  These commands work by first calling the corre‐
    	      sponding	builtin  widget  (see `History Control' in zshzle(1)) and then moving the
    	      cursor to the end of the line.  The original  cursor  position  is  remembered  and
    	      restored	before	calling the builtin widget a second time, so that the same search
    	      is repeated to look farther through the history.
    
    	      Although you autoload only one function, the commands to use it are  slightly  dif‐
    	      ferent because it implements two widgets.
    
    		     zle -N history-beginning-search-backward-end \
    			    history-search-end
    		     zle -N history-beginning-search-forward-end \
    			    history-search-end
    		     bindkey '\e^P' history-beginning-search-backward-end
    		     bindkey '\e^N' history-beginning-search-forward-end
    
           history-beginning-search-menu
    	      This  function  implements  yet another form of history searching.  The text before
    	      the cursor is used  to  select  lines  from  the	history,  as  for  history-begin‐
    	      ning-search-backward  except that all matches are shown in a numbered menu.  Typing
    	      the appropriate digits inserts the full history line.   Note  that  leading  zeroes
    	      must  be	typed  (they  are only shown when necessary for removing ambiguity).  The
    	      entire history is searched; there is no distinction between forwards and backwards.
    
    	      With a numeric argument, the search is not anchored to the start of the  line;  the
    	      string typed by the use may appear anywhere in the line in the history.
    
    	      If  the  widget  name  contains  `-end'  the cursor is moved to the end of the line
    	      inserted.  If the widget name contains `-space' any space  in  the  text	typed  is
    	      treated  as  a wildcard and can match anything (hence a leading space is equivalent
    	      to giving a numeric argument).  Both forms can be combined, for example:
    
    		     zle -N history-beginning-search-menu-space-end \
    			    history-beginning-search-menu
    
           history-pattern-search
    	      The function history-pattern-search implements widgets which prompt for  a  pattern
    	      with  which  to  search  the  history backwards or forwards.  The pattern is in the
    	      usual zsh format, however the first character may be ^ to anchor the search to  the
    	      start  of the line, and the last character may be $ to anchor the search to the end
    	      of the line.  If the search was not anchored to the end of the line the  cursor  is
    	      positioned just after the pattern found.
    
    	      The commands to create bindable widgets are similar to those in the example immedi‐
    	      ately above:
    
    		     autoload -U history-pattern-search
    		     zle -N history-pattern-search-backward history-pattern-search
    		     zle -N history-pattern-search-forward history-pattern-search
    
           incarg Typing the keystrokes for this widget with the cursor placed on or to the  left  of
    	      an  integer causes that integer to be incremented by one.  With a numeric argument,
    	      the number is incremented by the amount of the argument (decremented if the numeric
    	      argument is negative).  The shell parameter incarg may be set to change the default
    	      increment to something other than one.
    
    		     bindkey '^X+' incarg
    
           incremental-complete-word
    	      This allows incremental completion of a word.  After starting this command, a  list
    	      of  completion  choices  can be shown after every character you type, which you can
    	      delete with ^H or DEL.  Pressing return accepts the completion so far  and  returns
    	      you to normal editing (that is, the command line is not immediately executed).  You
    	      can hit TAB to do normal completion, ^G  to  abort  back	to  the  state	when  you
    	      started, and ^D to list the matches.
    
    	      This works only with the new function based completion system.
    
    		     bindkey '^Xi' incremental-complete-word
    
           insert-composed-char
    	      This function allows you to compose characters that don't appear on the keyboard to
    	      be inserted into the command line.  The command is followed by two keys correspond‐
    	      ing  to  ASCII  characters  (there is no prompt).  For accented characters, the two
    	      keys are a base character followed by a code for the accent, while for  other  spe‐
    	      cial characters the two characters together form a mnemonic for the character to be
    	      inserted.  The two-character codes are a subset of those given by RFC 1345 (see for
    	      example http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc1345.html).
    
    	      The  function  may optionally be followed by up to two characters which replace one
    	      or both of the characters read from the keyboard; if both characters are	supplied,
    	      no input is read.  For example, insert-composed-char a: can be used within a widget
    	      to insert an a with umlaut into the command line.  This has the advantages over use
    	      of a literal character that it is more portable.
    
    	      For  best  results zsh should have been built with support for multibyte characters
    	      (configured with --enable-multibyte); however, the function works for  the  limited
    	      range of characters available in single-byte character sets such as ISO-8859-1.
    
    	      The character is converted into the local representation and inserted into the com‐
    	      mand line at the cursor position.  (The conversion is done within the shell,  using
    	      whatever	facilities the C library provides.)  With a numeric argument, the charac‐
    	      ter and its code are previewed in the status line
    
    	      The function may be run outside zle in which case it prints the character (together
    	      with a newline) to standard output.  Input is still read from keystrokes.
    
    	      See  insert-unicode-char	for  an  alternative  way of inserting Unicode characters
    	      using their hexadecimal character number.
    
    	      The set of accented characters is  reasonably  complete  up  to  Unicode	character
    	      U+0180,  the  set of special characters less so.	However, it is very sporadic from
    	      that point.  Adding new characters is easy, however; see the  function  define-com‐
    	      posed-chars.  Please send any additions to [email protected].
    
    	      The  codes  for  the second character when used to accent the first are as follows.
    	      Note that not every character can take every accent.
    	      !      Grave.
    	      '      Acute.
    	      >      Circumflex.
    	      ?      Tilde.  (This is not ~ as RFC 1345 does not assume that character is present
    		     on the keyboard.)
    	      -      Macron.  (A horizontal bar over the base character.)
    	      (      Breve.  (A shallow dish shape over the base character.)
    	      .      Dot  above the base character, or in the case of i no dot, or in the case of
    		     L and l a centered dot.
    	      :      Diaeresis (Umlaut).
    	      c      Cedilla.
    	      _      Underline, however there are currently no underlined characters.
    	      /      Stroke through the base character.
    	      "      Double acute (only supported on a few letters).
    	      ;      Ogonek.  (A little forward facing hook at the bottom right  of  the  charac‐
    		     ter.)
    	      <      Caron.  (A little v over the letter.)
    	      0      Circle over the base character.
    	      2      Hook over the base character.
    	      9      Horn over the base character.
    
    	      The  most  common  characters from the Arabic, Cyrillic, Greek and Hebrew alphabets
    	      are available; consult RFC 1345 for the appropriate sequences.  In addition, a  set
    	      of  two  letter codes not in RFC 1345 are available for the double-width characters
    	      corresponding to ASCII characters from !	to ~ (0x21  to	0x7e)  by  preceding  the
    	      character with ^, for example ^A for a double-width A.
    
    	      The following other two-character sequences are understood.
    
    	      ASCII characters
    		     These are already present on most keyboards:
    	      <(     Left square bracket
    	      //     Backslash (solidus)
    	      )>     Right square bracket
    	      (!     Left brace (curly bracket)
    	      !!     Vertical bar (pipe symbol)
    	      !)     Right brace (curly bracket)
    	      '?     Tilde
    
    	      Special letters
    		     Characters found in various variants of the Latin alphabet:
    	      ss     Eszett (scharfes S)
    	      D-, d- Eth
    	      TH, th Thorn
    	      kk     Kra
    	      'n     'n
    	      NG, ng Ng
    	      OI, oi Oi
    	      yr     yr
    	      ED     ezh
    
    	      Currency symbols
    	      Ct     Cent
    	      Pd     Pound sterling (also lira and others)
    	      Cu     Currency
    	      Ye     Yen
    	      Eu     Euro (N.B. not in RFC 1345)
    
    	      Punctuation characters
    		     References  to  "right"  quotes  indicate the shape (like a 9 rather than 6)
    		     rather than their grammatical use.  (For example, a "right" low double quote
    		     is used to open quotations in German.)
    	      !I     Inverted exclamation mark
    	      BB     Broken vertical bar
    	      SE     Section
    	      Co     Copyright
    	      -a     Spanish feminine ordinal indicator
    	      <<     Left guillemet
    	      --     Soft hyphen
    	      Rg     Registered trade mark
    	      PI     Pilcrow (paragraph)
    	      -o     Spanish masculine ordinal indicator
    	      >>     Right guillemet
    	      ?I     Inverted question mark
    	      -1     Hyphen
    	      -N     En dash
    	      -M     Em dash
    	      -3     Horizontal bar
    	      :3     Vertical ellipsis
    	      .3     Horizontal midline ellipsis
    	      !2     Double vertical line
    	      =2     Double low line
    	      '6     Left single quote
    	      '9     Right single quote
    	      .9     "Right" low quote
    	      9'     Reversed "right" quote
    	      "6     Left double quote
    	      "9     Right double quote
    	      :9     "Right" low double quote
    	      9"     Reversed "right" double quote
    	      /-     Dagger
    	      /=     Double dagger
    
    	      Mathematical symbols
    	      DG     Degree
    	      -2, +-, -+
    		     - sign, +/- sign, -/+ sign
    	      2S     Superscript 2
    	      3S     Superscript 3
    	      1S     Superscript 1
    	      My     Micro
    	      .M     Middle dot
    	      14     Quarter
    	      12     Half
    	      34     Three quarters
    	      *X     Multiplication
    	      -:     Division
    	      %0     Per mille
    	      FA, TE, /0
    		     For all, there exists, empty set
    	      dP, DE, NB
    		     Partial derivative, delta (increment), del (nabla)
    	      (-, -) Element of, contains
    	      *P, +Z Product, sum
    	      *-, Ob, Sb
    		     Asterisk, ring, bullet
    	      RT, 0(, 00
    		     Root sign, proportional to, infinity
    
    	      Other symbols
    	      cS, cH, cD, cC
    		     Card suits: spades, hearts, diamonds, clubs
    	      Md, M8, M2, Mb, Mx, MX
    		     Musical notation: crotchet (quarter note), quaver (eighth note), semiquavers
    		     (sixteenth notes), flag sign, natural sign, sharp sign
    	      Fm, Ml Female, male
    
    	      Accents on their own
    	      '>     Circumflex (same as caret, ^)
    	      '!     Grave (same as backtick, `)
    	      ',     Cedilla
    	      ':     Diaeresis (Umlaut)
    	      'm     Macron
    	      ''     Acute
    
           insert-files
    	      This function allows you type a file pattern, and see the results of the	expansion
    	      at  each	step.	When you hit return, all expansions are inserted into the command
    	      line.
    
    		     bindkey '^Xf' insert-files
    
           insert-unicode-char
    	      When first executed, the user inputs a set of hexadecimal digits.  This  is  termi‐
    	      nated  with  another  call to insert-unicode-char.  The digits are then turned into
    	      the corresponding Unicode character.  For example, if the widget is bound  to  ^XU,
    	      the character sequence `^XU 4 c ^XU' inserts L (Unicode U+004c).
    
    	      See  insert-composed-char  for  a way of inserting characters using a two-character
    	      mnemonic.
    
           narrow-to-region [ -p pre ] [ -P post ]
    			[ -S statepm | -R statepm | [ -l lbufvar ] [ -r rbufvar ] ]
    			[ -n ] [ start end ]
           narrow-to-region-invisible
    	      Narrow the editable portion of the buffer to the region between the cursor and  the
    	      mark, which may be in either order.  The region may not be empty.
    
    	      narrow-to-region	may  be  used  as  a  widget  or  called  as  a  function  from a
    	      user-defined widget; by default, the text outside the editable area  remains  visi‐
    	      ble.   A	recursive-edit	is  performed  and  the  original widening status is then
    	      restored.  Various options and arguments are available when it is called as a func‐
    	      tion.
    
    	      The  options  -p pretext and -P posttext may be used to replace the text before and
    	      after the display for the duration of the function; either or both may be an  empty
    	      string.
    
    	      If  the option -n is also given, pretext or posttext will only be inserted if there
    	      is text before or after the region respectively which will be made invisible.
    
    	      Two numeric arguments may be given which will be used instead  of  the  cursor  and
    	      mark positions.
    
    	      The option -S statepm is used to narrow according to the other options while saving
    	      the original state in the parameter with name statepm, while the option -R  statepm
    	      is used to restore the state from the parameter; note in both cases the name of the
    	      parameter is required.  In the second case, other options and arguments are irrele‐
    	      vant.  When this method is used, no recursive-edit is performed; the calling widget
    	      should call this function with the option -S, perform its own editing on	the  com‐
    	      mand  line  or  pass  control  to the user via `zle recursive-edit', then call this
    	      function with the option -R.  The argument statepm must be a suitable name  for  an
    	      ordinary	parameter,  except  that  parameters  beginning with the prefix _ntr_ are
    	      reserved for use within narrow-to-region.  Typically the parameter will be local to
    	      the calling function.
    
    	      The  options  -l lbufvar and -r rbufvar may be used to specify parameters where the
    	      widget will store the resulting text from the  operation.   The  parameter  lbufvar
    	      will  contain  LBUFFER  and  rbufvar  will  contain  RBUFFER.  Neither of these two
    	      options may be used with -S or -R.
    
    	      narrow-to-region-invisible is a simple widget  which  calls  narrow-to-region  with
    	      arguments  which	replace any text outside the region with `...'.  It does not take
    	      any arguments.
    
    	      The display is restored (and the widget returns) upon any zle command  which  would
    	      usually cause the line to be accepted or aborted.  Hence an additional such command
    	      is required to accept or abort the current line.
    
    	      The return status of both widgets is zero if the line was accepted, else non-zero.
    
    	      Here is a trivial example of a widget using this feature.
    		     local state
    		     narrow-to-region -p $'Editing restricted region\n' \
    		       -P '' -S state
    		     zle recursive-edit
    		     narrow-to-region -R state
    
           predict-on
    	      This set of functions implements predictive typing  using  history  search.   After
    	      predict-on, typing characters causes the editor to look backward in the history for
    	      the first line beginning with what you have typed so far.  After predict-off, edit‐
    	      ing  returns  to	normal for the line found.  In fact, you often don't even need to
    	      use predict-off, because if the line doesn't match something in the history, adding
    	      a  key performs standard completion, and then inserts itself if no completions were
    	      found.  However, editing in the middle of a line is liable to  confuse  prediction;
    	      see the toggle style below.
    
    	      With the function based completion system (which is needed for this), you should be
    	      able to type TAB at almost any point to advance the cursor to the next  ``interest‐
    	      ing''  character position (usually the end of the current word, but sometimes some‐
    	      where in the middle of the word).  And of course as soon as the entire line is what
    	      you want, you can accept with return, without needing to move the cursor to the end
    	      first.
    
    	      The first time predict-on is used, it creates several additional widget functions:
    
    	      delete-backward-and-predict
    		     Replaces the backward-delete-char widget.	You do	not  need  to  bind  this
    		     yourself.
    	      insert-and-predict
    		     Implements  predictive  typing  by replacing the self-insert widget.  You do
    		     not need to bind this yourself.
    	      predict-off
    		     Turns off predictive typing.
    
    	      Although you autoload only the predict-on function, it is  necessary  to	create	a
    	      keybinding for predict-off as well.
    
    		     zle -N predict-on
    		     zle -N predict-off
    		     bindkey '^X^Z' predict-on
    		     bindkey '^Z' predict-off
    
           read-from-minibuffer
    	      This  is	most useful when called as a function from inside a widget, but will work
    	      correctly as a widget in its own right.  It prompts for a value below  the  current
    	      command  line;  a  value may be input using all of the standard zle operations (and
    	      not  merely  the	restricted  set  available  when  executing,  for  example,  exe‐
    	      cute-named-cmd).	The value is then returned to the calling function in the parame‐
    	      ter $REPLY and the editing buffer restored to its previous state.  If the read  was
    	      aborted  by  a  keyboard	break  (typically  ^G), the function returns status 1 and
    	      $REPLY is not set.
    
    	      If one argument is supplied to the function it is taken as a prompt, otherwise `? '
    	      is  used.  If two arguments are supplied, they are the prompt and the initial value
    	      of $LBUFFER, and if a third argument is given it is the initial value of	$RBUFFER.
    	      This  provides  a  default  value  and  starting cursor placement.  Upon return the
    	      entire buffer is the value of $REPLY.
    
    	      One option is available: `-k num' specifies that num  characters	are  to  be  read
    	      instead  of a whole line.  The line editor is not invoked recursively in this case,
    	      so depending on the terminal settings the input may not be visible,  and	only  the
    	      input  keys are placed in $REPLY, not the entire buffer.	Note that unlike the read
    	      builtin num must be given; there is no default.
    
    	      The name is a slight misnomer, as in fact the shell's own minibuffer is  not  used.
    	      Hence  it  is still possible to call executed-named-cmd and similar functions while
    	      reading a value.
    
           replace-argument, replace-argument-edit
    	      The function replace-argument can be used to replace a command line argument in the
    	      current  command line or, if the current command line is empty, in the last command
    	      line executed (the new command line is not executed).  Arguments are  as	delimited
    	      by standard shell syntax,
    
    	      If  a  numeric  argument	is  given, that specifies the argument to be replaced.	0
    	      means the command name, as in  history  expansion.   A  negative	numeric  argument
    	      counts backward from the last word.
    
    	      If no numeric argument is given, the current argument is replaced; this is the last
    	      argument if the previous history line is being used.
    
    	      The function prompts for a replacement argument.
    
    	      If the widget contains the string edit, for example is defined as
    
    		     zle -N replace-argument-edit replace-argument
    
    	      then the function presents the current value of the argument for editing, otherwise
    	      the editing buffer for the replacement is initially empty.
    
           replace-string, replace-pattern
           replace-string-again, replace-pattern-again
    	      The  function  replace-string  implements three widgets.	If defined under the same
    	      name as the function, it prompts for two strings; the first (source) string will be
    	      replaced by the second everywhere it occurs in the line editing buffer.
    
    	      If  the widget name contains the word `pattern', for example by defining the widget
    	      using the command `zle -N replace-pattern replace-string',  then	the  matching  is
    	      performed  using	zsh  patterns.	All zsh extended globbing patterns can be used in
    	      the source string; note that unlike filename generation the pattern does	not  need
    	      to  match an entire word, nor do glob qualifiers have any effect.  In addition, the
    	      replacement string can contain parameter or command substitutions.  Furthermore,	a
    	      `&'  in the replacement string will be replaced with the matched source string, and
    	      a backquoted digit `\N' will  be	replaced  by  the  Nth	parenthesised  expression
    	      matched.	The form `\{N}' may be used to protect the digit from following digits.
    
    	      If the widget instead contains the word `regex' (or `regexp'), then the matching is
    	      performed  using	regular  expressions,  respecting  the	setting  of  the   option
    	      RE_MATCH_PCRE (see the description of the function regexp-replace below).  The spe‐
    	      cial replacement facilities described above for pattern matching are available.
    
    	      By default the previous source or replacement string will not be offered for  edit‐
    	      ing.   However, this feature can be activated by setting the style edit-previous in
    	      the context :zle:widget (for example, :zle:replace-string) to true.  In addition, a
    	      positive	numeric  argument forces the previous values to be offered, a negative or
    	      zero argument forces them not to be.
    
    	      The function replace-string-again can be used to repeat the  previous  replacement;
    	      no  prompting  is done.  As with replace-string, if the name of the widget contains
    	      the word `pattern' or `regex', pattern or regular expression matching is performed,
    	      else  a  literal string replacement.  Note that the previous source and replacement
    	      text are the same whether pattern, regular expression or string matching is used.
    
    	      In addition, replace-string shows the previous replacement  above  the  prompt,  so
    	      long  as	there  was one during the current session; if the source string is empty,
    	      that replacement will be repeated without the widget prompting  for  a  replacement
    	      string.
    
    	      For example, starting from the line:
    
    		     print This line contains fan and fond
    
    	      and  invoking  replace-pattern  with  the source string `f(?)n' and the replacement
    	      string `c\1r' produces the not very useful line:
    
    		     print This line contains car and cord
    
    	      The  range  of  the  replacement	string	can  be  limited  by   using   the   nar‐
    	      row-to-region-invisible widget.  One limitation of the current version is that undo
    	      will cycle through changes to the replacement and source strings before undoing the
    	      replacement itself.
    
           send-invisible
    	      This is similar to read-from-minibuffer in that it may be called as a function from
    	      a widget or as a widget of its own, and interactively reads  input  from	the  key‐
    	      board.  However, the input being typed is concealed and a string of asterisks (`*')
    	      is shown instead.  The value is saved in the parameter $INVISIBLE to which a refer‐
    	      ence  is	inserted into the editing buffer at the restored cursor position.  If the
    	      read was aborted by a keyboard break (typically ^G) or another escape from  editing
    	      such  as	push-line, $INVISIBLE is set to empty and the original buffer is restored
    	      unchanged.
    
    	      If one argument is supplied to the function it is  taken	as  a  prompt,	otherwise
    	      `Non-echoed text: ' is used (as in emacs).  If a second and third argument are sup‐
    	      plied they are used to begin and end the reference to $INVISIBLE that  is  inserted
    	      into the buffer.	The default is to open with ${, then INVISIBLE, and close with },
    	      but many other effects are possible.
    
           smart-insert-last-word
    	      This function may replace the insert-last-word widget, like so:
    
    		     zle -N insert-last-word smart-insert-last-word
    
    	      With a numeric argument, or when passed command  line  arguments	in  a  call  from
    	      another widget, it behaves like insert-last-word, except that words in comments are
    	      ignored when INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS is set.
    
    	      Otherwise, the rightmost ``interesting'' word from the previous  command	is  found
    	      and  inserted.  The default definition of ``interesting'' is that the word contains
    	      at least one alphabetic character, slash, or backslash.	This  definition  may  be
    	      overridden by use of the match style.  The context used to look up the style is the
    	      widget name, so usually the context is :insert-last-word.  However,  you	can  bind
    	      this function to different widgets to use different patterns:
    
    		     zle -N insert-last-assignment smart-insert-last-word
    		     zstyle :insert-last-assignment match '[[:alpha:]][][[:alnum:]]#=*'
    		     bindkey '\e=' insert-last-assignment
    
    	      If no interesting word is found and the auto-previous style is set to a true value,
    	      the search continues upward through the history.	When auto-previous  is	unset  or
    	      false  (the default), the widget must be invoked repeatedly in order to search ear‐
    	      lier history lines.
    
           transpose-lines
    	      Only useful with a multi-line editing buffer; the lines here are lines  within  the
    	      current on-screen buffer, not history lines.  The effect is similar to the function
    	      of the same name in Emacs.
    
    	      Transpose the current line with the previous line and move the cursor to the  start
    	      of  the  next  line.   Repeating	this  (which  can be done by providing a positive
    	      numeric argument) has the effect of moving the line above the cursor down by a num‐
    	      ber of lines.
    
    	      With  a  negative numeric argument, requires two lines above the cursor.	These two
    	      lines are transposed and the cursor moved to the start of the previous line.  Using
    	      a  numeric argument less than -1 has the effect of moving the line above the cursor
    	      up by minus that number of lines.
    
           which-command
    	      This function is a drop-in replacement for the builtin  widget  which-command.   It
    	      has  enhanced  behaviour,  in  that it correctly detects whether or not the command
    	      word needs to be expanded as an alias; if so, it continues tracing the command word
    	      from the expanded alias until it reaches the command that will be executed.
    
    	      The  style  whence  is available in the context :zle:$WIDGET; this may be set to an
    	      array to give the command and options that will be used to investigate the  command
    	      word found.  The default is whence -c.
    
           zcalc-auto-insert
    	      This  function  is useful together with the zcalc function described in the section
    	      Mathematical Functions.  It should be bound to a key representing a binary operator
    	      such  as	`+',  `-',  `*'  or `/'.  When running in zcalc, if the key occurs at the
    	      start of the line or immediately following an open parenthesis, the text "ans "  is
    	      inserted	before the representation of the key itself.  This allows easy use of the
    	      answer from the previous calculation in the current line.  The text to be  inserted
    	      before   the   symbol   typed   can   be	 modified   by	 setting   the	 variable
    	      ZCALC_AUTO_INSERT_PREFIX.
    
    	      Hence, for example, typing `+12' followed by return adds 12 to the previous result.
    
    	      When not in zcalc, the key simply inserts the symbol itself.
    
       Utility Functions
           These functions are useful in constructing widgets.  They should be loaded with	`autoload
           -U function' and called as indicated from user-defined widgets.
    
           split-shell-arguments
    	      This  function  splits  the  line  currently  being edited into shell arguments and
    	      whitespace.  The result is stored in the array reply.  The array contains  all  the
    	      parts of the line in order, starting with any whitespace before the first argument,
    	      and finishing with any whitespace after the last argument.  Hence (so long  as  the
    	      option  KSH_ARRAYS  is not set) whitespace is given by odd indices in the array and
    	      arguments by even indices.  Note that no	stripping  of  quotes  is  done;  joining
    	      together	all  the elements of reply in order is guaranteed to produce the original
    	      line.
    
    	      The parameter REPLY is set to the index of the word in  reply  which  contains  the
    	      character  after	the  cursor,  where the first element has index 1.  The parameter
    	      REPLY2 is set to the index of the character under the cursor in  that  word,  where
    	      the first character has index 1.
    
    	      Hence reply, REPLY and REPLY2 should all be made local to the enclosing function.
    
    	      See the function modify-current-argument, described below, for an example of how to
    	      call this function.
    
           modify-current-argument [ expr-using-$ARG | func ]
    	      This function provides a simple method of allowing user-defined widgets  to  modify
    	      the  command line argument under the cursor (or immediately to the left of the cur‐
    	      sor if the cursor is between arguments).
    
    	      The argument can be an expression which when evaluated operates on the shell param‐
    	      eter  ARG,  which will have been set to the command line argument under the cursor.
    	      The expression should be suitably quoted to prevent it being evaluated too early.
    
    	      Alternatively, if the argument does not contain the string ARG, it is assumed to be
    	      a  shell function, to which the current command line argument is passed as the only
    	      argument.  The function should set the variable REPLY to the new value for the com‐
    	      mand  line  argument.  If the function returns non-zero status, so does the calling
    	      function.
    
    	      For example, a user-defined widget containing the following code converts the char‐
    	      acters in the argument under the cursor into all upper case:
    
    		     modify-current-argument '${(U)ARG}'
    
    	      The  following strips any quoting from the current word (whether backslashes or one
    	      of the styles of quotes), and replaces it with single quoting throughout:
    
    		     modify-current-argument '${(qq)${(Q)ARG}}'
    
    	      The following performs  directory  expansion  on	the  command  line  argument  and
    	      replaces it by the absolute path:
    
    		     expand-dir() {
    		       REPLY=${~1}
    		       REPLY=${REPLY:a}
    		     }
    		     modify-current-argument expand-dir
    
    	      In practice the function expand-dir would probably not be defined within the widget
    	      where modify-current-argument is called.
    
       Styles
           The behavior of several of the above widgets can be controlled by the use  of  the  zstyle
           mechanism.   In	particular,  widgets  that interact with the completion system pass along
           their context to any completions that they invoke.
    
           break-keys
    	      This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget. Its value should  be	a
    	      pattern, and all keys matching this pattern will cause the widget to stop incremen‐
    	      tal completion without the key having any further  effect.  Like	all  styles  used
    	      directly	by  incremental-complete-word,	this style is looked up using the context
    	      `:incremental'.
    
           completer
    	      The incremental-complete-word and insert-and-predict widgets set up their top-level
    	      context  name  before calling completion.  This allows one to define different sets
    	      of completer functions for normal completion and for these widgets.   For  example,
    	      to  use  completion, approximation and correction for normal completion, completion
    	      and correction for incremental completion and only completion  for  prediction  one
    	      could use:
    
    		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
    			     _complete _correct _approximate
    		     zstyle ':completion:incremental:*' completer \
    			     _complete _correct
    		     zstyle ':completion:predict:*' completer \
    			     _complete
    
    	      It  is  a good idea to restrict the completers used in prediction, because they may
    	      be automatically invoked as you type.  The _list and _menu completers should  never
    	      be  used	with  prediction.   The  _approximate, _correct, _expand, and _match com‐
    	      pleters may be used, but be aware that they may change characters anywhere  in  the
    	      word  behind the cursor, so you need to watch carefully that the result is what you
    	      intended.
    
           cursor The insert-and-predict widget uses this style, in the context `:predict', to decide
    	      where to place the cursor after completion has been tried.  Values are:
    
    	      complete
    		     The  cursor is left where it was when completion finished, but only if it is
    		     after a character equal to the one just inserted by  the  user.   If  it  is
    		     after another character, this value is the same as `key'.
    
    	      key    The  cursor is left after the nth occurrence of the character just inserted,
    		     where n is the number of times that character appeared in	the  word  before
    		     completion was attempted.	In short, this has the effect of leaving the cur‐
    		     sor after the character just typed even if the  completion  code  found  out
    		     that no other characters need to be inserted at that position.
    
    	      Any  other  value  for this style unconditionally leaves the cursor at the position
    	      where the completion code left it.
    
           list   When using the incremental-complete-word widget, this style  says  if  the  matches
    	      should  be  listed on every key press (if they fit on the screen).  Use the context
    	      prefix `:completion:incremental'.
    
    	      The insert-and-predict widget uses this style to decide if the completion should be
    	      shown  even if there is only one possible completion.  This is done if the value of
    	      this style is the string always.	In this  case  the  context  is  `:predict'  (not
    	      `:completion:predict').
    
           match  This  style  is  used  by  smart-insert-last-word  to provide a pattern (using full
    	      EXTENDED_GLOB syntax) that matches an interesting word.  The context is the name of
    	      the  widget  to  which  smart-insert-last-word  is  bound (see above).  The default
    	      behavior of smart-insert-last-word is equivalent to:
    
    		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:]/\]*'
    
    	      However, you might want to include words that contain spaces:
    
    		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:][:space:]/\]*'
    
    	      Or include numbers as long as the word is at least two characters long:
    
    		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*([[:digit:]]?|[[:alpha:]/\])*'
    
    	      The above example causes redirections like "2>" to be included.
    
           prompt The incremental-complete-word widget shows the value of this style  in  the  status
    	      line  during  incremental completion.  The string value may contain any of the fol‐
    	      lowing substrings in the manner of the PS1 and other prompt parameters:
    
    	      %c     Replaced by the name of the completer function that  generated  the  matches
    		     (without the leading underscore).
    
    	      %l     When  the list style is set, replaced by `...' if the list of matches is too
    		     long to fit on the screen and with an empty string otherwise.  If	the  list
    		     style is `false' or not set, `%l' is always removed.
    
    	      %n     Replaced by the number of matches generated.
    
    	      %s     Replaced  by  `-no match-', `-no prefix-', or an empty string if there is no
    		     completion matching the word on the line, if the matches have no common pre‐
    		     fix  different  from the word on the line, or if there is such a common pre‐
    		     fix, respectively.
    
    	      %u     Replaced by the unambiguous part of all matches, if there is any, and if  it
    		     is different from the word on the line.
    
    	      Like `break-keys', this uses the `:incremental' context.
    
           stop-keys
    	      This  style  is used by the incremental-complete-word widget.  Its value is treated
    	      similarly to the one for the break-keys style (and uses the same context:  `:incre‐
    	      mental').   However,  in this case all keys matching the pattern given as its value
    	      will stop incremental completion and will then execute their usual function.
    
           toggle This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related	widgets  in  the  context
    	      `:predict'.   If	set  to  one  of the standard `true' values, predictive typing is
    	      automatically toggled off in situations where it is unlikely to be useful, such  as
    	      when editing a multi-line buffer or after moving into the middle of a line and then
    	      deleting a character.  The default is  to  leave	prediction  turned  on	until  an
    	      explicit call to predict-off.
    
           verbose
    	      This  boolean  style  is	used by predict-on and its related widgets in the context
    	      `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true' values, these widgets  display	a
    	      message below the prompt when the predictive state is toggled.  This is most useful
    	      in combination with the toggle style.  The default does not display these messages.
    
           widget This style is similar to the command style: For widget functions that  use  zle  to
    	      call  other  widgets, this style can sometimes be used to override the widget which
    	      is called.  The context for this style is the name of the calling widget	(not  the
    	      name  of the calling function, because one function may be bound to multiple widget
    	      names).
    
    		     zstyle :copy-earlier-word widget smart-insert-last-word
    
    	      Check the documentation for the calling widget or function to determine whether the
    	      widget style is used.
    
    EXCEPTION HANDLING
           Two  functions  are  provided  to  enable zsh to provide exception handling in a form that
           should be familiar from other languages.
    
           throw exception
    	      The function throw throws the named exception.  The name is an arbitrary string and
    	      is  only	used by the throw and catch functions.	An exception is for the most part
    	      treated the same as a shell error, i.e. an unhandled exception will cause the shell
    	      to  abort  all processing in a function or script and to return to the top level in
    	      an interactive shell.
    
           catch exception-pattern
    	      The function catch returns status zero if an exception was thrown and  the  pattern
    	      exception-pattern matches its name.  Otherwise it returns status 1.  exception-pat‐
    	      tern  is	a  standard  shell  pattern,  respecting  the  current	setting  of   the
    	      EXTENDED_GLOB  option.   An  alias catch is also defined to prevent the argument to
    	      the function from matching filenames, so patterns may be used unquoted.  Note  that
    	      as  exceptions are not fundamentally different from other shell errors it is possi‐
    	      ble to catch shell errors by using an empty string  as  the  exception  name.   The
    	      shell  variable  CAUGHT is set by catch to the name of the exception caught.  It is
    	      possible to rethrow an exception by calling the throw function again once an excep‐
    	      tion has been caught.
    
           The functions are designed to be used together with the always construct described in zsh‐
           misc(1).  This is important as only this  construct  provides  the  required  support  for
           exceptions.  A typical example is as follows.
    
    	      {
    		# "try" block
    		# ... nested code here calls "throw MyExcept"
    	      } always {
    		# "always" block
    		if catch MyExcept; then
    		  print "Caught exception MyExcept"
    		elif catch ''; then
    		  print "Caught a shell error.	Propagating..."
    		  throw ''
    		fi
    		# Other exceptions are not handled but may be caught further
    		# up the call stack.
    	      }
    
           If all exceptions should be caught, the following idiom might be preferable.
    
    	      {
    		# ... nested code here throws an exception
    	      } always {
    		if catch *; then
    		  case $CAUGHT in
    		    (MyExcept)
    		    print "Caught my own exception"
    		    ;;
    		    (*)
    		    print "Caught some other exception"
    		    ;;
    		  esac
    		fi
    	      }
    
           In  common with exception handling in other languages, the exception may be thrown by code
           deeply nested inside the `try' block.  However, note that it must  be  thrown  inside  the
           current	shell,	not in a subshell forked for a pipeline, parenthesised current-shell con‐
           struct, or some form of command or process substitution.
    
           The system internally uses the shell variable EXCEPTION to record the name of  the  excep‐
           tion  between throwing and catching.  One drawback of this scheme is that if the exception
           is not handled the variable EXCEPTION remains set and may be incorrectly recognised as the
           name  of an exception if a shell error subsequently occurs.  Adding unset EXCEPTION at the
           start of the outermost layer of any code that uses exception handling will eliminate  this
           problem.
    
    MIME FUNCTIONS
           Three  functions  are  available to provide handling of files recognised by extension, for
           example to dispatch a file text.ps when executed as a command to an appropriate viewer.
    
           zsh-mime-setup [ -fv ] [ -l [ suffix ... ] ]
           zsh-mime-handler [ -l ] command argument ...
    	      These two functions use the files ~/.mime.types and  /etc/mime.types,  which  asso‐
    	      ciate types and extensions, as well as ~/.mailcap and /etc/mailcap files, which as‐
    	      sociate types and the programs that handle them.	These are provided on  many  sys‐
    	      tems with the Multimedia Internet Mail Extensions.
    
    	      To  enable  the  system,	the function zsh-mime-setup should be autoloaded and run.
    	      This allows files with extensions to be treated as executable; such files  be  com‐
    	      pleted by the function completion system.  The function zsh-mime-handler should not
    	      need to be called by the user.
    
    	      The system works by setting up suffix aliases  with  `alias  -s'.   Suffix  aliases
    	      already installed by the user will not be overwritten.
    
    	      For  suffixes defined in lower case, upper case variants will also automatically be
    	      handled (e.g. PDF is automatically handled  if  handling	for  the  suffix  pdf  is
    	      defined), but not vice versa.
    
    	      Repeated	calls to zsh-mime-setup do not override the existing mapping between suf‐
    	      fixes and executable files unless the option -f is given.  Note, however, that this
    	      does  not  override  existing  suffix  aliases  assigned	to  handlers  other  than
    	      zsh-mime-handler.
    
    	      Calling zsh-mime-setup with the option  -l  lists  the  existing	mappings  without
    	      altering	them.  Suffixes to list (which may contain pattern characters that should
    	      be quoted from immediate interpretation on the command line) may be given as  addi‐
    	      tional arguments, otherwise all suffixes are listed.
    
    	      Calling  zsh-mime-setup with the option -v causes verbose output to be shown during
    	      the setup operation.
    
    	      The system respects the mailcap flags needsterminal and  copiousoutput,  see  mail‐
    	      cap(4).
    
    	      The  functions  use the following styles, which are defined with the zstyle builtin
    	      command (see zshmodules(1)).  They should be defined before zsh-mime-setup is  run.
    	      The  contexts used all start with :mime:, with additional components in some cases.
    	      It is recommended that a trailing * (suitably quoted) be appended to style patterns
    	      in case the system is extended in future.  Some examples are given below.
    
    	      For files that have multiple suffixes, e.g. .pdf.gz, where the context includes the
    	      suffix it will be looked up starting with the longest possible suffix until a match
    	      for  the style is found.	For example, if .pdf.gz produces a match for the handler,
    	      that will be used; otherwise the handler for .gz will be used.  Note that, owing to
    	      the  way suffix aliases work, it is always required that there be a handler for the
    	      shortest possible suffix, so in this example .pdf.gz can only be handled if .gz  is
    	      also  handled  (though not necessarily in the same way).	Alternatively, if no han‐
    	      dling for .gz on its own is needed, simply adding the command
    
    		     alias -s gz=zsh-mime-handler
    
    	      to the initialisation code is sufficient; .gz will not be handled on its	own,  but
    	      may be in combination with other suffixes.
    
    	      current-shell
    		     If  this boolean style is true, the mailcap handler for the context in ques‐
    		     tion is run using the eval builtin instead of by starting a new sh  process.
    		     This  is  more efficient, but may not work in the occasional cases where the
    		     mailcap handler uses strict POSIX syntax.
    
    	      disown If this boolean style is true, mailcap handlers started  in  the  background
    		     will  be  disowned, i.e. not subject to job control within the parent shell.
    		     Such handlers nearly always produce their own windows, so	the  only  likely
    		     harmful  side  effect of setting the style is that it becomes harder to kill
    		     jobs from within the shell.
    
    	      execute-as-is
    		     This style gives a list of patterns to be matched against files  passed  for
    		     execution	with  a  handler  program.   If the file matches the pattern, the
    		     entire command line is executed in its current form, with no handler.   This
    		     is  useful for files which might have suffixes but nonetheless be executable
    		     in their own right.  If the style is not set, the pattern *(*) *(/) is used;
    		     hence  executable	files  are executed directly and not passed to a handler,
    		     and the option AUTO_CD may be used to change to directories that  happen  to
    		     have MIME suffixes.
    
    	      execute-never
    		     This  style  is  useful  in combination with execute-as-is.  It is set to an
    		     array of patterns corresponding to full paths to files that should never  be
    		     treated  as  executable, even if the file passed to the MIME handler matches
    		     execute-as-is.  This is useful for file systems that  don't  handle  execute
    		     permission  or  that contain executables from another operating system.  For
    		     example, if /mnt/windows is a Windows mount, then
    
    			    zstyle ':mime:*' execute-never '/mnt/windows/*'
    
    		     will ensure that any files found in that area will be executed as MIME types
    		     even  if they are executable.  As this example shows, the complete file name
    		     is matched against the pattern, regardless of how the file was passed to the
    		     handler.	The  file  is  resolved  to  a	full  path  using the :A modifier
    		     described in the subsection Modifiers in zshexpn(1); this	means  that  sym‐
    		     bolic  links are resolved where possible, so that links into other file sys‐
    		     tems behave in the correct fashion.
    
    	      file-path
    		     Used if the style find-file-in-path is true for the same context.	Set to an
    		     array of directories that are used for searching for the file to be handled;
    		     the default is the command path given by the special  parameter  path.   The
    		     shell  option  PATH_DIRS  is respected; if that is set, the appropriate path
    		     will be searched even if the name of the file to be handled as it appears on
    		     the  command  line  contains  a `/'.  The full context is :mime:.suffix:, as
    		     described for the style handler.
    
    	      find-file-in-path
    		     If set, allows files whose  names	do  not  contain  absolute  paths  to  be
    		     searched  for  in	the  command  path or the path specified by the file-path
    		     style.  If the file is not found in the  path,  it  is  looked  for  locally
    		     (whether  or  not	the current directory is in the path); if it is not found
    		     locally, the handler will abort unless the handle-nonexistent style is  set.
    		     Files found in the path are tested as described for the style execute-as-is.
    		     The full context is :mime:.suffix:, as described for the style handler.
    
    	      flags  Defines flags to go with a handler; the context is as for the handler style,
    		     and the format is as for the flags in mailcap.
    
    	      handle-nonexistent
    		     By  default,  arguments that don't correspond to files are not passed to the
    		     MIME handler in order to prevent it from intercepting commands found in  the
    		     path  that  happen  to  have suffixes.  This style may be set to an array of
    		     extended glob patterns for arguments that will be passed to the handler even
    		     if  they  don't  exist.   If  it  is  not	explicitly  set  it  defaults  to
    		     [[:alpha:]]#:/* which allows URLs to be passed  to  the  MIME  handler  even
    		     though they don't exist in that format in the file system.  The full context
    		     is :mime:.suffix:, as described for the style handler.
    
    	      handler
    		     Specifies a handler for a suffix; the suffix is  given  by  the  context  as
    		     :mime:.suffix:,  and  the	format of the handler is exactly that in mailcap.
    		     Note in particular the `.' and trailing colon to distinguish this use of the
    		     context.  This overrides any handler specified by the mailcap files.  If the
    		     handler requires a terminal, the flags style should be set  to  include  the
    		     word needsterminal, or if the output is to be displayed through a pager (but
    		     not if the handler is itself a pager), it should include copiousoutput.
    
    	      mailcap
    		     A list of files in the format of ~/.mailcap and /etc/mailcap to be read dur‐
    		     ing  setup,  replacing  the  default list which consists of those two files.
    		     The context is :mime:.  A + in the list will  be  replaced  by  the  default
    		     files.
    
    	      mailcap-priorities
    		     This  style  is  used  to resolve multiple mailcap entries for the same MIME
    		     type.  It consists of an array of	the  following	elements,  in  descending
    		     order  of priority; later entries will be used if earlier entries are unable
    		     to resolve the entries being compared.  If none of  the  tests  resolve  the
    		     entries, the first entry encountered is retained.
    
    		     files  The  order	of  files  (entries  in the mailcap style) read.  Earlier
    			    files are preferred.  (Note this does not resolve entries in the same
    			    file.)
    
    		     priority
    			    The priority flag from the mailcap entry.  The priority is an integer
    			    from 0 to 9 with the default value being 5.
    
    		     flags  The test given by the mailcap-prio-flags option is	used  to  resolve
    			    entries.
    
    		     place  Later  entries  are  preferred;  as the entries are strictly ordered,
    			    this test always succeeds.
    
    		     Note that as this style is handled during	initialisation,  the  context  is
    		     always :mime:, with no discrimination by suffix.
    
    	      mailcap-prio-flags
    		     This  style  is  used  when  the keyword flags is encountered in the list of
    		     tests specified by the mailcap-priorities style.  It should be set to a list
    		     of  patterns,  each  of  which  is tested against the flags specified in the
    		     mailcap entry (in other words, the  sets  of  assignments	found  with  some
    		     entries in the mailcap file).  Earlier patterns in the list are preferred to
    		     later ones, and matched patterns are preferred to unmatched ones.
    
    	      mime-types
    		     A list of files in the format of ~/.mime.types  and  /etc/mime.types  to  be
    		     read  during  setup,  replacing the default list which consists of those two
    		     files.  The context is :mime:.  A + in the list  will  be	replaced  by  the
    		     default files.
    
    	      never-background
    		     If  this  boolean	style is set, the handler for the given context is always
    		     run in the foreground, even if the flags provided in the mailcap entry  sug‐
    		     gest it need not be (for example, it doesn't require a terminal).
    
    	      pager  If  set, will be used instead of $PAGER or more to handle suffixes where the
    		     copiousoutput flag is set.  The context is as for handler, i.e.  :mime:.suf‐
    		     fix: for handling a file with the given suffix.
    
    	      Examples:
    
    		     zstyle ':mime:*' mailcap ~/.mailcap /usr/local/etc/mailcap
    		     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' handler less %s
    		     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' flags needsterminal
    
    	      When  zsh-mime-setup  is	subsequently run, it will look for mailcap entries in the
    	      two files given.	Files of suffix .txt will be handled by running `less  file.txt'.
    	      The flag needsterminal is set to show that this program must run attached to a ter‐
    	      minal.
    
    	      As there are several steps to  dispatching  a  command,  the  following  should  be
    	      checked  if  attempting  to  execute  a  file  by  extension .ext does not have the
    	      expected effect.
    
    	      The command `alias -s ext' should show `ps=zsh-mime-handler'.  If  it  shows  some‐
    	      thing else, another suffix alias was already installed and was not overwritten.  If
    	      it shows nothing, no handler was installed:  this is most likely because no handler
    	      was found in the .mime.types and mailcap combination for .ext files.  In that case,
    	      appropriate handling should be added to ~/.mime.types and mailcap.
    
    	      If the extension is handled by zsh-mime-handler but the file  is	not  opened  cor‐
    	      rectly,  either the handler defined for the type is incorrect, or the flags associ‐
    	      ated with it are in appropriate.	Running zsh-mime-setup -l will show  the  handler
    	      and,  if	there  are  any,  the flags.  A %s in the handler is replaced by the file
    	      (suitably quoted if necessary).  Check that the handler program  listed  lists  and
    	      can  be  run  in	the  way shown.  Also check that the flags needsterminal or copi‐
    	      ousoutput are set if the handler needs to be run under a terminal; the second  flag
    	      is  used if the output should be sent to a pager.  An example of a suitable mailcap
    	      entry for such a program is:
    
    		     text/html; /usr/bin/lynx '%s'; needsterminal
    
    	      Running `zsh-mime-handler -l command line' prints the command line  that	would  be
    	      executed, simplified to remove the effect of any flags, and quoted so that the out‐
    	      put can be run as a complete zsh command line.  This is used by the completion sys‐
    	      tem to decide how to complete after a file handled by zsh-mime-setup.
    
           pick-web-browser
    	      This  function  is  separate from the two MIME functions described above and can be
    	      assigned directly to a suffix:
    
    		     autoload -U pick-web-browser
    		     alias -s html=pick-web-browser
    
    	      It is provided as an intelligent front end to dispatch a web browser.   It  may  be
    	      run  as  either  a  function  or	a shell script.  The status 255 is returned if no
    	      browser could be started.
    
    	      Various styles are available to customize the choice of browsers:
    
    	      browser-style
    		     The value of the style is an array giving preferences  in	decreasing  order
    		     for the type of browser to use.  The values of elements may be
    
    		     running
    			    Use a GUI browser that is already running when an X Window display is
    			    available.	The browsers listed in the x-browsers style are tried  in
    			    order  until  one  is  found; if it is, the file will be displayed in
    			    that browser, so the user may need to check whether it has	appeared.
    			    If	no  running browser is found, one is not started.  Browsers other
    			    than Firefox, Opera and  Konqueror	are  assumed  to  understand  the
    			    Mozilla syntax for opening a URL remotely.
    
    		     x	    Start  a  new  GUI	browser  when  an  X Window display is available.
    			    Search for the availability of one of  the	browsers  listed  in  the
    			    x-browsers	style and start the first one that is found.  No check is
    			    made for an already running browser.
    
    		     tty    Start a terminal-based browser.  Search for the availability  of  one
    			    of	the browsers listed in the tty-browsers style and start the first
    			    one that is found.
    
    		     If the style is not set the default running x tty is used.
    
    	      x-browsers
    		     An array in decreasing order of preference of browsers to use  when  running
    		     under  the  X  Window  System.  The array consists of the command name under
    		     which to start the browser.  They are looked up in the context :mime: (which
    		     may be extended in future, so appending `*' is recommended).  For example,
    
    			    zstyle ':mime:*' x-browsers opera konqueror firefox
    
    		     specifies	that pick-web-browser should first look for a running instance of
    		     Opera, Konqueror or Firefox, in that order, and if  it  fails  to	find  any
    		     should  attempt  to  start  Opera.   The default is firefox mozilla netscape
    		     opera konqueror.
    
    	      tty-browsers
    		     An array similar to x-browsers, except that it gives browsers to use when no
    		     X Window display is available.  The default is elinks links lynx.
    
    	      command
    		     If  it is set this style is used to pick the command used to open a page for
    		     a browser.  The  context  is  :mime:browser:new:$browser:	to  start  a  new
    		     browser  or  :mime:browser:running:$browser:  to  open  a	URL  in a browser
    		     already running on the current  X	display,  where  $browser  is  the  value
    		     matched  in the x-browsers or tty-browsers style.	The escape sequence %b in
    		     the style's value will be replaced by the browser, while %u will be replaced
    		     by  the  URL.  If the style is not set, the default for all new instances is
    		     equivalent to %b %u and the defaults for using running browsers are  equiva‐
    		     lent  to  the values kfmclient openURL %u for Konqueror, firefox -new-tab %u
    		     for Firefox, opera -newpage %u for Opera, and %b -remote  "openUrl(%u)"  for
    		     all others.
    
    MATHEMATICAL FUNCTIONS
           zcalc [ -ef ] [ expression ... ]
    	      A  reasonably  powerful  calculator  based on zsh's arithmetic evaluation facility.
    	      The syntax is similar to that of formulae in most programming  languages;  see  the
    	      section `Arithmetic Evaluation' in zshmisc(1) for details.
    
    	      Non-programmers  should  note that, as in many other programming languages, expres‐
    	      sions involving only integers (whether constants without a `.', variables  contain‐
    	      ing such constants as strings, or variables declared to be integers) are by default
    	      evaluated using integer arithmetic, which is not how an  ordinary  desk  calculator
    	      operates.  To force floating point operation, pass the option -f; see further notes
    	      below.
    
    	      The mathematical library zsh/mathfunc will be loaded if it is  available;  see  the
    	      section  `The  zsh/mathfunc  Module'  in zshmodules(1).  The mathematical functions
    	      correspond to the raw system libraries, so trigonometric	functions  are	evaluated
    	      using radians, and so on.
    
    	      Each  line  typed  is evaluated as an expression.  The prompt shows a number, which
    	      corresponds to a positional parameter where  the	result	of  that  calculation  is
    	      stored.	For  example, the result of the calculation on the line preceded by `4> '
    	      is available as $4.  The last value calculated is available as ans.   Full  command
    	      line  editing,  including  the  history of previous calculations, is available; the
    	      history is saved in the file ~/.zcalc_history.  To exit, enter a blank line or type
    	      `:q' on its own (`q' is allowed for historical compatibility).
    
    	      A  line  ending  with a single backslash is treated in the same fashion as it is in
    	      command line editing:  the backslash is removed,	the  function  prompts	for  more
    	      input  (the  prompt  is preceded by `...' to indicate this), and the lines are com‐
    	      bined into one to get the final result.  In addition, if the input so far  contains
    	      more open than close parentheses zcalc will prompt for more input.
    
    	      If  arguments  are given to zcalc on start up, they are used to prime the first few
    	      positional parameters.  A visual indication of this is given  when  the  calculator
    	      starts.
    
    	      The  constants  PI (3.14159...) and E (2.71828...) are provided.	Parameter assign‐
    	      ment is possible, but note that all parameters will be put into the  global  names‐
    	      pace.
    
    	      The  output  base  can  be  initialised by passing the option `-#base', for example
    	      `zcalc -#16' (the `#' may have to be quoted,  depending  on  the	globbing  options
    	      set).
    
    	      If  the  option `-e' is set, the function runs non-interactively: the arguments are
    	      treated as expressions to be evaluated as if entered interactively line by line.
    
    	      If the option `-f' is set, all numbers are treated as  floating  point,  hence  for
    	      example  the expression `3/4' evaluates to 0.75 rather than 0.  Options must appear
    	      in separate words.
    
    	      The prompt is configurable via the parameter ZCALCPROMPT, which undergoes  standard
    	      prompt  expansion.   The	index of the current entry is stored locally in the first
    	      element of the array psvar, which can be referred to in ZCALCPROMPT as `%1v'.   The
    	      default prompt is `%1v> '.
    
    	      A  few  special commands are available; these are introduced by a colon.	For back‐
    	      ward compatibility, the colon may be omitted for certain commands.   Completion  is
    	      available if compinit has been run.
    
    	      The  output  precision  may  be specified within zcalc by special commands familiar
    	      from many calculators.
    	      :norm  The default output format.  It corresponds to the printf  %g  specification.
    		     Typically this shows six decimal digits.
    
    	      :sci digits
    		     Scientific  notation,  corresponding to the printf %g output format with the
    		     precision given by digits.  This produces either fixed point or  exponential
    		     notation depending on the value output.
    
    	      :fix digits
    		     Fixed  point notation, corresponding to the printf %f output format with the
    		     precision given by digits.
    
    	      :eng digits
    		     Exponential notation, corresponding to the printf %E output format with  the
    		     precision given by digits.
    
    	      :raw   Raw  output:  this is the default form of the output from a math evaluation.
    		     This may show more precision than the number actually possesses.
    
    	      Other special commands:
    	      :!line...
    		     Execute line... as a normal shell command line.  Note that it is executed in
    		     the  context  of the function, i.e. with local variables.	Space is optional
    		     after :!.
    
    	      :local arg ...
    		     Declare variables local to the function.  Note that  certain  variables  are
    		     used  by  the  function  for its own purposes.  Other variables may be used,
    		     too, but they will be taken from or put into the global scope.
    
    	      :function name [ body ]
    		     Define a mathematical function or (with no body) delete it.   :function  may
    		     be abbreviated to :func or simply :f.  The name may contain the same charac‐
    		     ters as a shell function name.  The function is defined using  zmathfuncdef,
    		     see below.
    
    		     Note that zcalc takes care of all quoting.  Hence for example:
    
    			    :f cube $1 * $1 * $1
    
    		     defines a function to cube the sole argument.
    
    	      [#base]
    		     This is not a special command, rather part of normal arithmetic syntax; how‐
    		     ever, when this form appears on a line by itself the default output radix is
    		     set  to  base.  Use, for example, `[#16]' to display hexadecimal output pre‐
    		     ceded by an indication of the base, or `[##16]' just to display the raw num‐
    		     ber  in  the  given base.	Bases themselves are always specified in decimal.
    		     `[#]' restores the normal output format.  Note that setting an  output  base
    		     suppresses floating point output; use `[#]' to return to normal operation.
    
    	      See the comments in the function for a few extra tips.
    
           zmathfuncdef [ mathfunc [ body ] ]
    	      A convenient front end to functions -M.
    
    	      With two arguments, define a mathematical function named mathfunc which can be used
    	      in any form of arithmetic evaluation.  body is a mathematical expression to  imple‐
    	      ment  the  function.   It may contain references to position parameters $1, $2, ...
    	      to refer to mandatory parameters and  ${1:-defvalue}  ...   to  refer  to  optional
    	      parameters.   Note  that	the forms must be strictly adhered to for the function to
    	      calculate the correct number of arguments.  The implementation is held in  a  shell
    	      function	named  zsh_math_func_mathfunc; usually the user will not need to refer to
    	      the shell function directly.  Any existing function of the same  name  is  silently
    	      replaced.
    
    	      With  one  argument, remove the mathematical function mathfunc as well as the shell
    	      function implementation.
    
    	      With no arguments, list all mathfunc functions in a form suitable for restoring the
    	      definition.  The functions have not necessarily been defined by zmathfuncdef.
    
    USER CONFIGURATION FUNCTIONS
           The  zsh/newuser  module comes with a function to aid in configuring shell options for new
           users.  If the module is installed, this function can also be run by hand.  It  is  avail‐
           able  even  if  the module's default behaviour, namely running the function for a new user
           logging in without startup files, is inhibited.
    
           zsh-newuser-install [ -f ]
    	      The function presents the user with various options for customizing their  initial‐
    	      ization  scripts.   Currently  only  ~/.zshrc  is handled.  $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc is used
    	      instead if the parameter ZDOTDIR is set; this provides a way for the user  to  con‐
    	      figure a file without altering an existing .zshrc.
    
    	      By  default  the	function  exits immediately if it finds any of the files .zshenv,
    	      .zprofile, .zshrc, or .zlogin in the  appropriate  directory.   The  option  -f  is
    	      required	in order to force the function to continue.  Note this may happen even if
    	      .zshrc itself does not exist.
    
    	      As currently configured, the function will exit immediately if the  user	has  root
    	      privileges; this behaviour cannot be overridden.
    
    	      Once activated, the function's behaviour is supposed to be self-explanatory.  Menus
    	      are present allowing the user to alter the value of options and  parameters.   Sug‐
    	      gestions for improvements are always welcome.
    
    	      When  the  script  exits, the user is given the opportunity to save the new file or
    	      not; changes are not irreversible until this point.  However, the script is careful
    	      to  restrict  changes to the file only to a group marked by the lines `# Lines con‐
    	      figured	by   zsh-newuser-install'   and   `#   End   of   lines   configured   by
    	      zsh-newuser-install'.   In  addition,  the old version of .zshrc is saved to a file
    	      with the suffix .zni appended.
    
    	      If the function edits an existing .zshrc, it is up to the user to ensure	that  the
    	      changes  made will take effect.  For example, if control usually returns early from
    	      the existing .zshrc the lines will not be executed; or a later initialization  file
    	      may  override  options  or  parameters,  and  so	on.  The function itself does not
    	      attempt to detect any such conflicts.
    
    OTHER FUNCTIONS
           There are a large number of helpful functions in the Functions/Misc directory of  the  zsh
           distribution.   Most  are very simple and do not require documentation here, but a few are
           worthy of special mention.
    
       Descriptions
           colors This function initializes several associative arrays to map  color  names  to  (and
    	      from)  the  ANSI standard eight-color terminal codes.  These are used by the prompt
    	      theme system (see above).  You seldom should need to run colors more than once.
    
    	      The eight base colors are: black, red, green,  yellow,  blue,  magenta,  cyan,  and
    	      white.   Each  of these has codes for foreground and background.	In addition there
    	      are seven intensity attributes: bold, faint, standout, underline,  blink,  reverse,
    	      and conceal.  Finally, there are seven codes used to negate attributes: none (reset
    	      all attributes to the defaults), normal  (neither  bold  nor  faint),  no-standout,
    	      no-underline, no-blink, no-reverse, and no-conceal.
    
    	      Some terminals do not support all combinations of colors and intensities.
    
    	      The associative arrays are:
    
    	      color
    	      colour Map  all  the  color  names to their integer codes, and integer codes to the
    		     color names.  The eight base names map to the foreground color codes, as  do
    		     names  prefixed  with  `fg-',  such as `fg-red'.  Names prefixed with `bg-',
    		     such as `bg-blue', refer to the background codes.	The reverse mapping  from
    		     code  to  color  yields  base name for foreground codes and the bg- form for
    		     backgrounds.
    
    		     Although it is a misnomer to call them `colors', these arrays also  map  the
    		     other fourteen attributes from names to codes and codes to names.
    
    	      fg
    	      fg_bold
    	      fg_no_bold
    		     Map  the  eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape sequences that set
    		     the corresponding foreground text properties.  The fg sequences  change  the
    		     color without changing the eight intensity attributes.
    
    	      bg
    	      bg_bold
    	      bg_no_bold
    		     Map  the  eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape sequences that set
    		     the corresponding background properties.  The bg sequences change the  color
    		     without changing the eight intensity attributes.
    
    	      In  addition,  the scalar parameters reset_color and bold_color are set to the ANSI
    	      terminal escapes that turn off all attributes and turn on bold  intensity,  respec‐
    	      tively.
    
           fned [ -x num ] name
    	      Same  as zed -f.	This function does not appear in the zsh distribution, but can be
    	      created by linking zed to the name fned in some directory in your fpath.
    
           is-at-least needed [ present ]
    	      Perform a greater-than-or-equal-to comparison of two strings having the format of a
    	      zsh  version  number; that is, a string of numbers and text with segments separated
    	      by dots or dashes.  If the present string is not provided,  $ZSH_VERSION	is  used.
    	      Segments	are paired left-to-right in the two strings with leading non-number parts
    	      ignored.	If one string has fewer segments than the other, the missing segments are
    	      considered zero.
    
    	      This  is useful in startup files to set options and other state that are not avail‐
    	      able in all versions of zsh.
    
    		     is-at-least 3.1.6-15 && setopt NO_GLOBAL_RCS
    		     is-at-least 3.1.0 && setopt HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
    		     is-at-least 2.6-17 || print "You can't use is-at-least here."
    
           nslookup [ arg ... ]
    	      This wrapper function for the nslookup command requires the  zsh/zpty  module  (see
    	      zshmodules(1)).	It behaves exactly like the standard nslookup except that it pro‐
    	      vides customizable prompts  (including  a  right-side  prompt)  and  completion  of
    	      nslookup	commands, host names, etc. (if you use the function-based completion sys‐
    	      tem).  Completion styles may be set with the context prefix `:completion:nslookup'.
    
    	      See also the pager, prompt and rprompt styles below.
    
           regexp-replace var regexp replace
    	      Use regular expressions to perform a global search and replace operation on a vari‐
    	      able.   If  the option RE_MATCH_PCRE is not set, POSIX extended regular expressions
    	      are used, else Perl-compatible regular expressions (this requires the shell  to  be
    	      linked against the pcre library).
    
    	      var  is the name of the variable containing the string to be matched.  The variable
    	      will be modified directly by the function.   The	variables  MATCH,  MBEGIN,  MEND,
    	      match,  mbegin,  mend should be avoided as these are used by the regular expression
    	      code.
    
    	      regexp is the regular expression to match against the string.
    
    	      replace is the replacement text.	This can contain parameter,  command  and  arith‐
    	      metic  expressions  which  will  be replaced:  in particular, a reference to $MATCH
    	      will be replaced by the text matched by the pattern.
    
    	      The return status is 0 if at least one match was performed, else 1.
    
           run-help cmd
    	      This function is designed to be invoked by the run-help ZLE widget, in place of the
    	      default alias.  See `Accessing On-Line Help' above for setup instructions.
    
    	      In  the discussion which follows, if cmd is a file system path, it is first reduced
    	      to its rightmost component (the file name).
    
    	      Help is first sought by looking for a file named cmd in the directory named by  the
    	      HELPDIR  parameter.   If no file is found, an assistant function, alias, or command
    	      named run-help-cmd is sought.  If found, the assistant is executed with the rest of
    	      the  current command line (everything after the command name cmd) as its arguments.
    	      When neither file nor assistant is found, the external command `man cmd' is run.
    
    	      An example assistant for the "ssh" command:
    
    		     run-help-ssh() {
    			 emulate -LR zsh
    			 local -a args
    			 # Delete the "-l username" option
    			 zparseopts -D -E -a args l:
    			 # Delete other options, leaving: host command
    			 args=(${@:#-*})
    			 if [[ ${#args} -lt 2 ]]; then
    			     man ssh
    			 else
    			     run-help $args[2]
    			 fi
    		     }
    
    	      Several of these assistants are provided in the  Functions/Misc  directory.   These
    	      must  be	autoloaded, or placed as executable scripts in your search path, in order
    	      to be found and used by run-help.
    
    	      run-help-git
    	      run-help-svk
    	      run-help-svn
    		     Assistant functions for the git, svk, and svn commands.
    
           tetris Zsh was once accused of not being as complete as Emacs, because it lacked a  Tetris
    	      game.  This function was written to refute this vicious slander.
    
    	      This function must be used as a ZLE widget:
    
    		     autoload -U tetris
    		     zle -N tetris
    		     bindkey keys tetris
    
    	      To  start a game, execute the widget by typing the keys.	Whatever command line you
    	      were editing disappears temporarily, and your keymap is also  temporarily  replaced
    	      by  the  Tetris  control keys.  The previous editor state is restored when you quit
    	      the game (by pressing `q') or when you lose.
    
    	      If you quit in the middle of a game, the next invocation of the tetris widget  will
    	      continue where you left off.  If you lost, it will start a new game.
    
           tetriscurses
    	      This  is	a  port of the above to zcurses.  The input handling is improved a bit so
    	      that moving a block sideways doesn't automatically  advance  a  timestep,  and  the
    	      graphics use unicode block graphics.
    
    	      This  version  does not save the game state between invocations, and is not invoked
    	      as a widget, but rather as:
    
    		     autoload -U tetriscurses
    		     tetriscurses
    
           zargs [ option ... -- ] [ input ... ] [ -- command [ arg ... ] ]
    	      This function has a similar purpose to GNU xargs.   Instead  of  reading	lines  of
    	      arguments  from  the  standard input, it takes them from the command line.  This is
    	      useful because zsh, especially with recursive glob operators, often can construct a
    	      command  line for a shell function that is longer than can be accepted by an exter‐
    	      nal command.
    
    	      The option list represents options of the zargs command itself, which are the  same
    	      as  those of xargs.  The input list is the collection of strings (often file names)
    	      that become the arguments of the command, analogous to the standard input of xargs.
    	      Finally, the arg list consists of those arguments (usually options) that are passed
    	      to the command each time it runs.  The arg list  precedes  the  elements	from  the
    	      input  list  in  each run.  If no command is provided, then no arg list may be pro‐
    	      vided, and in that event the default command is `print' with arguments `-r --'.
    
    	      For example, to get a long ls listing of all plain files in the  current	directory
    	      or its subdirectories:
    
    		     autoload -U zargs
    		     zargs -- **/*(.) -- ls -l
    
    	      Note  that `--' is used both to mark the end of the option list and to mark the end
    	      of the input list, so it must appear twice whenever the input list  may  be  empty.
    	      If  there is guaranteed to be at least one input and the first input does not begin
    	      with a `-', then the first `--' may be omitted.
    
    	      In the event that the string `--' is or may be an input, the -e option may be  used
    	      to   change  the	end-of-inputs  marker.	 Note  that  this  does  not  change  the
    	      end-of-options marker.  For example, to use `..' as the marker:
    
    		     zargs -e.. -- **/*(.) .. ls -l
    
    	      This is a good choice in that example because no plain file can be named `..',  but
    	      the best end-marker depends on the circumstances.
    
    	      The  options  -i,  -I,  -l,  -L,	and -n differ slightly from their usage in xargs.
    	      There are no input lines for zargs to count, so -l and -L count through  the  input
    	      list,  and  -n  counts the number of arguments passed to each execution of command,
    	      including any arg list.  Also, any time -i or -I is used, each input  is	processed
    	      separately as if by `-L 1'.
    
    	      For  details  of	the other zargs options, see xargs(1) (but note the difference in
    	      function between zargs and xargs) or run zargs with the --help option.
    
           zed [ -f [ -x num ] ] name
           zed -b This function uses the ZLE editor to edit a file or function.
    
    	      Only one name argument is allowed.  If the -f option is given, the name is taken to
    	      be  that of a function; if the function is marked for autoloading, zed searches for
    	      it in the fpath and loads it.  Note that functions edited this  way  are	installed
    	      into  the  current  shell, but not written back to the autoload file.  In this case
    	      the -x option specifies that leading tabs indenting the function according to  syn‐
    	      tax  should be converted into the given number of spaces; `-x 2' is consistent with
    	      the layout of functions distributed with the shell.
    
    	      Without -f, name is the path name of the file to edit, which need not exist; it  is
    	      created on write, if necessary.
    
    	      While  editing,  the function sets the main keymap to zed and the vi command keymap
    	      to zed-vicmd.  These will be copied from the existing main  and  vicmd  keymaps  if
    	      they  do	not exist the first time zed is run.  They can be used to provide special
    	      key bindings used only in zed.
    
    	      If it creates the keymap, zed rebinds the return key to insert  a  line  break  and
    	      `^X^W'  to  accept the edit in the zed keymap, and binds `ZZ' to accept the edit in
    	      the zed-vicmd keymap.
    
    	      The bindings alone can be installed by running `zed  -b'.   This	is  suitable  for
    	      putting into a startup file.  Note that, if rerun, this will overwrite the existing
    	      zed and zed-vicmd keymaps.
    
    	      Completion is available, and styles may be set with the  context	prefix	`:comple‐
    	      tion:zed'.
    
    	      A  zle  widget  zed-set-file-name  is  available.   This can be called by name from
    	      within zed using `\ex zed-set-file-name' (note,  however,  that  because	of  zed's
    	      rebindings  you  will have to type ^j at the end instead of the return key), or can
    	      be bound to a key in either of the zed or zed-vicmd keymaps after `zed -b' has been
    	      run.   When  the	widget	is  called,  it prompts for a new name for the file being
    	      edited.  When zed exits the file will be written under that name and  the  original
    	      file will be left alone.	The widget has no effect with `zed -f'.
    
    	      While zed-set-file-name is running, zed uses the keymap zed-normal-keymap, which is
    	      linked from the main keymap in effect at the time  zed  initialised  its	bindings.
    	      (This  is to make the return key operate normally.)  The result is that if the main
    	      keymap has been changed, the widget won't notice.  This is not a concern	for  most
    	      users.
    
           zcp [ -finqQvwW ] srcpat dest
           zln [ -finqQsvwW ] srcpat dest
    	      Same  as zmv -C and zmv -L, respectively.  These functions do not appear in the zsh
    	      distribution, but can be created by linking zmv to the names zcp and  zln  in  some
    	      directory in your fpath.
    
           zkbd   See `Keyboard Definition' above.
    
           zmv [ -finqQsvwW ] [ -C | -L | -M | -{p|P} program ] [ -o optstring ]
    	   srcpat dest
    	      Move  (usually,  rename)	files  matching the pattern srcpat to corresponding files
    	      having names of the form given by dest, where srcpat contains parentheses surround‐
    	      ing patterns which will be replaced in turn by $1, $2, ... in dest.  For example,
    
    		     zmv '(*).lis' '$1.txt'
    
    	      renames  `foo.lis'  to  `foo.txt', `my.old.stuff.lis' to `my.old.stuff.txt', and so
    	      on.
    
    	      The pattern is always treated as an EXTENDED_GLOB pattern.  Any file whose name  is
    	      not  changed  by	the  substitution  is  simply ignored.	Any error (a substitution
    	      resulted in an empty string, two substitutions gave the same result,  the  destina‐
    	      tion  was an existing regular file and -f was not given) causes the entire function
    	      to abort without doing anything.
    
    	      In addition to pattern replacement, the variable $f can be referrred to in the sec‐
    	      ond (replacement) argument.  This makes it possible to use variable substitution to
    	      alter the argument; see examples below.
    
    	      Options:
    
    	      -f     Force overwriting of destination files.  Not currently passed  down  to  the
    		     mv/cp/ln command due to vagaries of implementations (but you can use -o-f to
    		     do that).
    	      -i     Interactive: show each line to be executed and ask the user whether to  exe‐
    		     cute it.  `Y' or `y' will execute it, anything else will skip it.	Note that
    		     you just need to type one character.
    	      -n     No execution: print what would happen, but don't do it.
    	      -q     Turn bare glob qualifiers off: now  assumed  by  default,	so  this  has  no
    		     effect.
    	      -Q     Force  bare  glob qualifiers on.  Don't turn this on unless you are actually
    		     using glob qualifiers in a pattern.
    	      -s     Symbolic, passed down to ln; only works with -L.
    	      -v     Verbose: print each command as it's being executed.
    	      -w     Pick out wildcard parts of the pattern, as described above,  and  implicitly
    		     add parentheses for referring to them.
    	      -W     Just like -w, with the addition of turning wildcards in the replacement pat‐
    		     tern into sequential ${1} .. ${N} references.
    	      -C
    	      -L
    	      -M     Force cp, ln or mv, respectively, regardless of the name of the function.
    	      -p program
    		     Call program instead of cp, ln or mv.  Whatever it does, it should at  least
    		     understand  the  form `program -- oldname newname' where oldname and newname
    		     are filenames generated by zmv.  program will be split into words, so  might
    		     be e.g. the name of an archive tool plus a copy or rename subcommand.
    	      -P program
    		     As  -p  program, except that program does not accept a following -- to indi‐
    		     cate the end of options.  In this case filenames must already be in  a  sane
    		     form for the program in question.
    	      -o optstring
    		     The  optstring is split into words and passed down verbatim to the cp, ln or
    		     mv command called to perform the work.  It should probably begin with a `-'.
    
    	      Further examples:
    
    		     zmv -v '(* *)' '${1// /_}'
    
    	      For any file in the current directory with at least one space in the name,  replace
    	      every space by an underscore and display the commands executed.
    
    		     zmv -v '* *' '${f// /_}'
    
    	      This does exactly the same by referring to the file name stored in $f.
    
    	      For  more  complete  examples  and other implementation details, see the zmv source
    	      file, usually located in one of the directories named in your fpath,  or	in  Func‐
    	      tions/Misc/zmv in the zsh distribution.
    
           zrecompile
    	      See `Recompiling Functions' above.
    
           zstyle+ context style value [ + subcontext style value ... ]
    	      This  makes  defining styles a bit simpler by using a single `+' as a special token
    	      that allows you to append a context name to the previously used context name.  Like
    	      this:
    
    		     zstyle+ ':foo:bar' style1 value1 \
    			    +':baz'	style2 value2 \
    			    +':frob'	style3 value3
    
    	      This  defines  style1  with  value1  for the context :foo:bar as usual, but it also
    	      defines style2 with value2 for the context :foo:bar:baz and style3 with value3  for
    	      :foo:bar:frob.   Any subcontext may be the empty string to re-use the first context
    	      unchanged.
    
       Styles
           insert-tab
    	      The zed function sets this style in context `:completion:zed:*' to turn off comple‐
    	      tion  when  TAB is typed at the beginning of a line.  You may override this by set‐
    	      ting your own value for this context and style.
    
           pager  The nslookup function looks up this style in the context `:nslookup'  to	determine
    	      the program used to display output that does not fit on a single screen.
    
           prompt
           rprompt
    	      The  nslookup  function  looks  up this style in the context `:nslookup' to set the
    	      prompt and the right-side prompt, respectively.  The usual expansions for  the  PS1
    	      and RPS1 parameters may be used (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)).
    
    ZSHALL(1)			     General Commands Manual				ZSHALL(1)
    
    FILES
           $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv
           $ZDOTDIR/.zprofile
           $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc
           $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin
           $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout
           ${TMPPREFIX}*   (default is /tmp/zsh*)
           /etc/zshenv
           /etc/zprofile
           /etc/zshrc
           /etc/zlogin
           /etc/zlogout    (installation-specific - /etc is the default)
    
    SEE ALSO
           sh(1), csh(1), tcsh(1), rc(1), bash(1), ksh(1)
    
           IEEE  Standard  for information Technology - Portable Operating System Interface (POSIX) -
           Part 2: Shell and Utilities, IEEE Inc, 1993, ISBN 1-55937-255-9.
    
    zsh 5.1.1				September 11, 2015				ZSHALL(1)
    

Log in to reply
 

© Lightnetics 2024